Loading...
HomeMy WebLinkAboutB04-0033 LEGALTOWN OF VAIL DEPARTMENT OF COMMLINIry DEVELOPMENT 75 S.FRONTAGEROAD vArL, co 81657 970-479-2138 NOTE: THIS PERMIT MUST BE POSTED ON JOBSITE AT ALL TIMES ADDiALT MF BUILD PERMIT Permit #: 804-0033 Job Address.: 352 E MEADOW DR VAIL Status.....: ISSUED Location......: 352 EAST MEADOW DRIVE Applied...: 03/2512004 Parcel No....: 210108255001 Issued ...: 05/13/2004 Project No...: Expires...: 1l/09/2004 oliINER VMIJ IJLC 03/25/2004 Phone: 285 BRIDGE ST VAIL co 81657 License: coNrRAcToR SHAW CONSTRUCTTON COMPATIY 03/25/2OO4 Phone: 970-242-9236 750 HORIZON DR GRJNiID 'JI'NCTIOIT CO 81s05 Lricense: L08-A ARCHTTECT ZEHREN & ASSOCTATES, rNC. 03/25/2004 Phonez 970-949-0257 P.O. BOX 1976 AVON, CO 81620 License: C00000162 6 APPr-,rCANr SHAW CONSTRUCTTOII COMPATTY 03 /25/2004 Phone : 970-242-9236 760 HORIZON DR GRAND iTI]NCTION CO 81505 Li.cense:108-A Desciption: FINAL REMODEL OF MIXED USE LODGE & SPA Occupancy: Rl,R2,A3 Type Construction: IIA Type Occupancy: ?? Valuation: 5,005,000.00 Fireolace Information: Restricted: Y # ofcas Appliances: 0 Add Sq Ft: 0 # ofGas Logs: 0 # of Wood Pellet 0 *a**'1,| | * a:t 'l*,|** *'r 'r*:r,r FEE SUMMARY :**r*'+r:l*r*'t'r***r*t****:t't*t*'tttll'*:tr*'ir Building--> S2o ,22'l . oo Restusrant Plan Review->So. oo Total Calculated Fees-> $33 , 37? .55 plan Check-> 913,14?. SS DRB Fee-_-> $0. OO Additiond Fees----> 90. O0 Investigation-> SO. OO Recreation Fee-> $0. O0 Total Permit Fee--> S33 , 3?7 .55 Wilt Call-> S3 . O0 Clean-up Deprosil--> $0. oo Payments---_---2 S33,377.55 TOTAL FEES----> 933 , 3?? . s5 BAIANCE DUE-----> 90. 00 t*a* l* +t +ar **,*,r a* Approvals:Ifem: 05100 BUILDING DEPARTIUENI o5/t3/2oo4 cdavis Action: AP PER REVIEW BY HOUGLAI{D & ASSOCTATES Ttem: 05400 PIJANNING DEPARTMENI 04/30/2004 George Action: Ap ITEM: 05600 FIRE DEPARTMENT o4/27/2OO4 mcgee Action: Ap Item: 05500 PITBLIC WORKS 04/o2/2OO4 L8 additional information. j4/3O/2OO4 Ls Action: DN Bilty a supervisor for Shaw on the VaiI he is to bring me a new revise sEaging control plal and a bond for staging on 2004. O5/O3/2OO4 Ls Action: Ap Control and Staging Plan subnitted arld Action: DN Awaiting for T trave meet with Mountain Lodge, plan, traffic Monday May 3, Bond, Traf f j.c approved. il *l +l{ lt+r* +t+l+ l l+ lltt*t*itiir *t* r See page 2 of this Document for any conditions that may apply to this permit. DECLARATIONS I hereby acknowledge that I have read this application, filled out in full the information required, completed an accurate plot plan, and state that all the information as required is correct. I agree to comply with the information and plot plan, to comply with all Town ordinances and state laws, and to build this shucture according to the towns zoning and subdivision codes, design review approved, Uniform Building Code and other ordinances of the Town applicable thereto. REQUESTS FOR INSPECTION SHALL BE MADE TWENTY-FOI]R HOURS IN ADYANCE /--''"/ N 479-2t49 OFFICE FROM 8:00 AM - 4 PM. SIGNATURE OF O OR CONTRACTORFOR HIMSELF AND OWNET PAGE 2 ***.*t*****'**!t** * *****|****'i,1.,|!:t****:t'*t******,t 't*,*{.********* ********:**1i,}!t****:f **x.:*** *'i,i****'**:i**** *** ** * ** * CONDITIONS OF APPROVAL Permit #: 804-0033 as of 05-13-2004 Status: ISSUED ,i**'**:t,t+'**:f******{i'}***.|*+'t*:f,|tl'!i*'|{.!t{.,}:***.f********'},l*,}:|*'}**t:t,*****!***'t*:t*:***!t***+********** Permit Type: ADD/ALT MF BUILD PERMIT Applied: 03/2512004 Applicant: SHAW CONSTRUCTION COMPANY Issued: 05/13/2004 970-242-9236 To Expire: 11109/2004 Job Address: 352 E MEADOW DR VAIL l,ocation: 352 EAST MEADOW DRIVE ParcelNo: 210108255001 Description: FINAL REMODEL OF MIXED USE LODGE & SPA Conditions: Cond: l2 (BLDG.): FIELD INSPECTIONS ARE REQUIRED TO CHECK FOR CODE COMPLIANCE.' Cond:14 (BLDG.): ALL PENETRATIONS IN WALLS,CEILINGS,AND FLOORS TO BE SEALED WITH AN APPROVED FIRE MATERIAL. Cond: l6 (BLDG.): SMOKE DETECTORS ARE REQUIRED IN ALL BEDROOMS AND EVERY STORY AS PER SEC.3IO.9.I OF THE 1997 UBC. Cond: I (FIRE): FIRE DEPARTMENT APPROVAL IS REQUIRED BEFORE ANY WORK CAN BE STARTED. Cond: CON0006347 Public Way permit is require for staging with ROW. No Staging or use of Vail Valley Drive for deliveries or dropoffs. Trafiic not allow to be delayed. Use of Sidewalk also not allowed during construction. Cond: CON0006402 Compliance with Planing andEnvironmental Conditions of Approval (ie, ehu deed restrictions, offsite improvements) shall be required prior to the issuance ofa TCO from Planning Department. NNNW 75 S, Frontaqe Rd. Vall. Colorado- 8165i APPLICANON WILL NOT BE ACCEPTET' IF INGOTPLETE OR Proiect#: Building Permit #: 970,479.2149 CONTRACTOR II{FORTATION General Conlractor: Srt+t Ccosrloond Toum of Vail Reg. ltlo.: lo 8-A Contact and Phone #'s: /c,ra gntP,*e lot't?2b Email address: kcilo e SAa.rh o r.cc+Pnu //n c. igY- l11B W ,/r1/"2Contractor Signature: VALUATIONS FOR BUILIIING PERUIT & taterials BUfLDING: S 3, BQo, O.2O ELECTRTCAL: $ /(&. Oo o orHER: s X ZOSTC6O PLUMBING: $ 3@. OEO MECIfANfCAL:$ Z1O, oao rorAL:t &;Ao d.iaOLt nao /tn uf t4vu, aannt ,g -S For Parcel * Contact Assessors Officc at 97G328-8610 or visit .@m Parcel #2/o1-os.ffi,r\ JobName: lr/4,. t/"".'r4t,) Lnoo, - f JobAddress: 3sz E"t, H"*--, Darc Legal Descriptlon I Lot: I Block: I Flllng:Subdlvlslon: tucfiitecuDesign",, 2 aLq u,. /lt s o<. Ad&e*i/8 t. 6t,t*- a.c*z Dt uL &1 Phontt 1{g-ozt? Engin@t" f/ c. P*, I A) tuteo.Address: F (ruvc*.rant lo., zL-J Prtplne:9fr- ?7b g Detailed des€riotitn of work:-.-htNtlu Etneo€t- ,,a'. N*ta - Use L"o"t '. S,na I t \,/ Work Ctass: New( ) Addition X) nemodel ({ R.ryjt ( ) eto( ) oh", ( ) WorkType: Interbr( ) E:rlerior( ) Bo0rp{ooes an EHU exist at this localion: vesX t'to ( ) Typeof Blcg.: Singb-fatnily( l@ No. of Existing Owelling Units in this building: 7 No. of Accommodation Units in this building: / g No/Tvpe of Fireolacas Existhsr Gas Applbnces ( ) Gas LoSs ( ) Wood/Pellet ( l Wood Buming (3) (& 4et'Co /4t No/Tvpe of Firephc€s propo6ed: gas Apptiarms ffi 6." t-ogs (e) Wood/Pe{et ( } Wood guming (NOT 4LLOWED) Does a Fire Alarm Exist Yes (y') No ( )Ooes a fire Sprinkler System Exist Yes (Lf No ( ) r.ir.!Et.H,E!r'*{arHrhjr**t.*61ffiFoR OFFICE USE ONLY.**i..i*|"ffit'ffir*r.rh Siif&" ) DRB F:\Users\cdev\FORMSIPERMITS|BLDGPERM.DOC oao:l,z(xx Department of Gornmunity Development Project Name: l/rrt /--'u*u Lo.t - f Project Mdress: I This Checklist mud be ompleted before a Buildlng turmlt appliation is acceoted. / Nt pa€lesot applicdion is comdete / t* Wapprwat obtained (if reguir€d) Ffov*le a copy of +prod form r/ Oondominium Asseidioo letter of apFond attadred if prq€d is a Mdti-Family compls( - t), ne &<.+t le&t { Cornptete Ste plan sibmitted /. auat;"wn1ftfmit eplication induded if applicaue (ref€r to Rrblic worts ch€ddisr) $aging plan induded (refer to Riblic Works dpddisl) l{o dumpster-parllno or materlal storaoe allowed on roadwavs and shoulders wlthout urltton aporovat o{ nsUestos test and tesilts $brnitted if dernolitbn is ocarning - l) , tzt €., e ,' ". /wt ese/ Rrchited *amp and signature (Al Conrnercirt ard Muti fariity) / nn tW plans incftrding hlldir€ sectaons and d6ration{5 sts of ptils for ltfulti-Famity and Oommercial &rildings) er' Wndor, and dmr scfi€dule c/ Frll structurat ptans, induding de*rn criteft (i-e-16) / sructural &€ineer gamp ard ggndure on srrudurd dans (Al ornrn€.cid dd rilta tunily) r/ Sift *pct must be srbmatt€d praor lo foottq fuEpectaon - tJtra O*,6r.n f '** t e/ Fire resigive.tssernuies spedfied and pen€trdions iiltacded y' -gndre daeacs dlorn m plans - P&a, Dtstr .> -8oro S,ro.^-, n^-r.n-.- t/ Type and quantity of tireplrc sfroln Appllcant's Signature: Date of submittal: 3/zv/ov F:\UserslcdevlFORMS:IPERM(TSIaIOGPERM,OOC Received By: @n8/?'JoA BUI LDI NG PERMI T I SSUANCE TI ME FRAIIE lf this permit requires a Twm of Vail Fre Departmqrt epprova, Egineer's (tublic Works) revievrr ard apprwd, a Hanning @atment reviqr or l-bdth Department rwiil, and a revaew by the &rilding Departrnent, the estimded time for a totd reviert will take as long as three (3) weeks Al ornnrercid (lage or vndl) and dl multi-tamily permits wi$ harc to fdlow the abore mentioned maximum requirenrents. kidentid ard srndl prcieds $qid take a lesser amount of time- tlowwer, if residentid or srnaller prqeds im@ the vaious abore mentioned departments with regard to nece€sny review, these proieds rnry dso td<e three (3) weeks to revieur and appnove, Every attempt will be made by this @artment to e>(@ite this prmit as sl as posdble. l, the underdgned, understtrd the dan cfied< prooedure and time hane. I dso underdand that if the permit is mt picked ry by the expiratim dde. thd I must stifi pay the plan cfreck fee and thd if I fail to do so it mry affed future permits that | 4ly for. Agreed to by: //rr*g.9. ,-u.- Sgnature )4r,- r4o,'.r+a /-tno -P,*ne -EFtoied l{ame: Date:>4" ls F:lt so,sld€dFmlt$P€R |TSALOGPCRIa.IXIC etlmt?o,x T0r]tIw WHEN A..PUBLIC WAY PERUIT' IS REQI'IRED PISASE READ AM) CIECK OFF EACTI OF T}E FOI.I-CI'I'IT{G o|.ESTIO}6 RreARDITG TI.E IGED Fffi A ?TJBLICWAYPERMIT.: o ls thb a new residence?YE T{O Does demotitkrn ryork b€ing performed JBquire the use of the Right'of-Way, eas€tnents or pubfic property? \6 Y- i.lO- YES -/tlO (E- T o. tt. ")^--) z .furturSiignahrrc. JoborPqiect Narre: t'At t{uo>a-, hqe 'P,*c A ls any utility rvort needed? YGS- \QJZ- Are 0rere arry improvements being dorE to tle ddveuay ? ls a different c needed to the dte other thil the exhlirg ddY€ffiy?vs/ts ts any drainage work bgDS done that affects the Rght-of-Way, eaenrents, or puuic property? YES- IQ--/- lsa"Reryod|eRigfttof-WayFermit'reqdted? YEq NO ls the Rigbtd-Way, eesnents or priblb property to be used br staging, parking or Encing? \B/ NO ff r"t-* i. lp is"r"** stagkg orfendngptan re$ftdbytub$cWorks?.IES NO tf you ansvered YE b any of these qu€cilbns, a ?r$lc Way Fermit' murst be obtained- "Public way Fermit' applicatfttos may be obtslned at the R.Olh Wdkb offce or at Community Dg/etoprnent (a sanple b attach€d). lf lou harre ary quesiions dease call Leona(t Satdovd h Rrbftc Worksat4Tg-2198. y'C. t/+,/.t. O- I HAVE READ AI.ID ANSVI/ERED AI- T}E AFVC CI6I|OTS. 3*+t C*sto-''.,'-,.., Date S[ned:3/at/ot F:Ws€.slc&vtFOR S|PERi||T$aLOGPERI.OOC F:/crrsryon€tb.flEib5pdm4 Corpany Narne @M;m NWfiWN PUBLIC WORKS AND THE PUBLTG WAY PERilIT PROCESS How it rclates to Buildlng Permits: vl nX wt the attrctred cfi€ck list with the &rildng Fernit Applbation. lf ycs rns ans*ercd to any of the questbns then a ?ublic Wayf permit b requlred. You can pid< up an application at either Conrmunity Derrelopnent, let€d at 75 South Fpntagp Road or PuHic Works. located at 1il)9 Ekhom Drirre. S)4 ftfie sQnofts for utility ornpanies. A|.I- utlitbs must fieU verifo (locate) respectivet l' ' utilities prior to signing application. Sorne utility ompanies require up to 46 trours notice to schedule a locate. tr' A constructim traffic co.ttrcUst4ing plan musl be prepared on a separate street of paper. Arl appmred site phn may abo be used. Thb plan will show locatiors of all traffic conlrol devices (s!ns, cone, etc.) and the wort zore, (area of onstruction, st4ing, etc-). Thb plan will expire on l{orember lst ard wifl need to be resrbmitted for consilelation for approrral through the winter. Be aware that yorr resrbmisrbn for winter rnay be denied depending on the localion of onstnrction. ;/ Sketch of work being perforned must be subrnitted indbating dimenr*rrp (lengsr, wid0t and depth of trvotk). This rnay be drawn on the traffic contnol plan or a sate plan for the job. O/StOmit completed application to fre R.6laclrtb.k's office for revietrr. lf retpired. locaEs will be scfpduled for the Town of Vail electricians and inigation qew. The locates take plae in the moming. but nny require up to 48 hours to perform. E/ The Rtblic Work's Gonstnrction lnspector will raview the applicalion and approve or deny the permit- You will be ontacied as to the status ard any requiremenG that may be needed. MGt permits are releed within 48 lpurs of beirg rcceived, but please ailow up to one (1) week to process. ;7,zAs mon as the permit is approved, the BuiHing Department will be notified, atbwing the' "Building Pemft. b be released. Please do not conftrse the ?ublb l/Vay Fermit' with a 'Building Permit'. gr' NO'IE: The above process is for work in a public way ONLY. Public Way' Permits are valid only until November 15th. A new Public Way Permit is required each year if work is not complete. Re-appllcauon each November l5th does not mean an automatic renewal. t,/tt /ot erstand the above. Date Signed anGJnw ?p/VtlW DRAI NAGE AND CULVERT I NSPECTI OTTIS ARE RBAUI RED BY PUBLI C WORKS! Please read and cbeck off each of the iterns below: The Torrn of Vn'l Brilding Department has devdoped the following ploedures to ensgre that new @nstruclion sites have adequately established proper drainage frorn buitding sites along ad adjacent to Torn of Vail roads or strcets. The Town of Vdl Rrblic Works Department will be required to insped ard approve drainage adjacent to Torn of Vdl roads or streels and the installation of ternporary or perrntrEnt culverts at access points from the road or $reet onto the construdion dte. S.tdr appro\ral must be obtained prior to any requeds for inspeclion by the Town of Vail &rilding Department for footings, temPorary eledrical or any other inspedion. Here call leonard Srdoval at 479-2198 to reque$ an inspedion frorn the Rrblic works Department. Alov a minimum of 24 hour notice. e Aso, the Tourn of Vail fublic Works Department will be ryroving dl final drzl'n4e and cutvert instdlation with restlting road patcfiing irs necess:rll Srcfi 4provd must be obtained prior to any Fnal Oertificate of Omrpancy issrance. Agreed tonv, ,4rrz ArQea4rrn Rc1'ed ltlame: Date $gned:t/t lt Print hlarne hr- ,{**u /e*c --E F:\Us€6\oderiFORMStPERMlTStsU)GpERfr.OOC @,JBt?fit4 MATERIAL STORAGE AND CONSTRUCTION PARKING Please read and check off e*h of the items balow. (@bs of corplete text are avdbue upon leqrest) CODE 5-2-10: DEPTOISITS ON PUBLTC WAYS PROtilBtTED 0 Ur{aurful deposits: Suq*}ct to srbseciion C frercof. il b unlawful br arry person to litter, track or depciit or c:use to be 6ttet€d, tedGd or depGitedr sand, gravel, rocks, mud, dirt, snow, ie, or any other debris or material updr any street. sidaf,a|k. dby or publb plm. or any portbn thereof. e Notice; Abatement: The Dtuector of Rrtrlb Wo*s may noflfy ard requare any person wtro vidates or canses another to violato the provision of subseciinn A her€of, or who has in tfie Dirccior,s erndoyment a petson who vitates (r caasr ao0|er to vitate the sa|fE. @ rerwe such sand. gravel. rccks, mud, dirt' srnw. ioe or any ofrler debrb or lnaterial withh twenty b.tr (24, hours after re€ipt of said notice by the Oirecbr of Publb Works. tn the errent the person so notified &es not comply with the rrctice within the period of frne herein +erineO, the tXrecior of R.rbfrc Wod<s, or other authorized agent, may ciuse any $dl satd, gravd, rodcs. tnd, dirt, sarow. ice. debris or any other material to be reflEved from any street or alby at the elpense of ttre notifred. s Summons and Penalty: As an altemative to the notce for renronal prwided in sr.bceclbn B Sove, any person n'ho violates or causes anoher lo violate the sanE. rnay be issrred a sumrrrns to appear before lhe rtunidpal Court of the Town &r saU vbHions. ard rryon being found gullty of a veotbtion heresnder be nmisted as provitd h Secibn 14-l of thts ode. e Notace and Penalty: lt is udawful br any person to fail or refuse to conply with the notice of the Oirector of Pubfic Worlrs as Fovided h su06ecfioo B hereof, and any crdt pecson shall, in addition to payment of the expetrse of renrona{ hcurred by the Dircctor of PuUb WbrlG" as proviled in subs€ctbn B hereol upon being found guilty of a vir|atin hereunder. be p.nishsle 6 provided in Secfion 14-1 d th's Code. (1997 Code: Odinance 6 (1979)- CODES 7.34-1 AND 7-3A.3: PARKII{G OB{'TRUGTIXG TRAFFTC & IXPiOUNDIE!|TAUTHORIZED e No person shall paft any v€h&Je upon a street or at any other flam within this Muniipdity in s^rcfi a rnanner or under g.dt q|ddbm e to hterbre with the free morerent of wfrkufar hffic or poper sfeet or hbhway maintenance- (ord. 2(1968) S f ) e ly'Vhenever arry police officer flrds a yef*le auendd (x unattended, sianding upon any podbn of a sbeet or upon any pbce within thb lftrfdpafty in such a nanner as to corrtitute a viilation of any sectlrn of this Artide, or l€fr unatterded for a period of tuuenty bnr (24) lrours or npre ard pr€surEd to be abandoned under th€ condims presoteO by Aobrado Rarised Statites sdim 42-4-1102, e amended. ttp officer shalt reqtire the whirJe to be rsnoved or cause it to be rernored and daed in stoEge in the nearest gar4e or other place of safety deqtmbd or maintaaned by this Munkipatity, and the charges for towirqg and storage of $Jdr vddde shafl be dlalged to the owner of the ve*rile h addition to a ten dollar ($1O) irpot n&nent charye. (Ord. 2(1968) g 3: Od. 28(1981) S t) I have read and will comply with flre above code provisions: PositionorRelationshiproProjecr: f** r4*'.rr- - Srffll5 Eh$6Sg!.dFoRMslpERMtrslBLocpERM.ooc F/svcryqrdainus/b*s:rn7 sa^l <- tr^r'-r TDTlBEiJfl/. 5H[Lll Commence building and site demolitiorVexcavation Phase V Construction Duration Exterior Construction substantially complete VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE - PhA!€ \/ Remodel Project Construction Plan SCHEDTJLE The construction schedule of the Vail Mountain Lodge shall generally be as follows: March 24,2004 April 5, 2004 April 26 - December 21,2004 Seotember 2004 TRUCKACCESS & TRAFFIC CONTROL . Shaw Construction Traffic Conffol supervisors will be Paul Hooyer and Foreman TBD. (On- site phone number TBD) . Delivery drivers shall contact the Shaw Superintendent a minimum of two (2) business days prior to a delivery to coordinate the delivery and unloading' . All delivery trucks shall enter the site from Vail Valley Drive. When ready to exit, all drivers shall contact the Shaw Superintendent to arrange radio-controlled traffic exit with the assistance of the Shaw Traffic Controller. No delivery trucks shall leave the site without clearance for the Shaw Traffic Controller. All delivery trucks shall exit the site to the east back to Vail Valley Drive. . Qualified traffic control personnel shall be employed by the Contractor. All traffic control personnel shall be equipped with a radio and appropriate flagging/signage equipment. The traffic control personnel will coordinate the entering and exiting of delivery tnrcks with buses and pedestrian traffic. Public busses shall take priority over all construction traffic. All traffic control shall conform to the Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices. . During construction related deliveries and work activities which occur on public roads or walkways, a traffic control person shall be stationed at the exit gate and one traffic control person shall be stationed at the corner of Vail Valley Drive & East Meadow Drive. All traffic control personnel shall be equipped with a radio and the appropriate signs. The traffic control personnel shall signal when trucks are to exit the site only after making visual clearance for oncoming busses and stopping pedestrian traffic in all directions. . The Contractor shall designate a "Contract Enforcement Officer" to enforce the provisions of this plan. r Contractor to work with Public Works on coordinating deliveries on West Side with construction of neighboring construction sites (on Mill Creek and Gore Creek Circle) CONSTRUCTION FENCE r Fence construction will be by Shaw Construction (On-site Contacts: Paul Hooyer). r Fence will be an 8'-0" Chain Link Fence with "TOV Green" mesh and/or Plywood painted "TOV Green". CRANE USE . Proposed on site crane duration will be during the weeks of April through Mid-May on SE and NE Corner and from Mid May through September on the NW Corner. We will work with TOV Public Works on moving crane off of TOV streets and in to site areas during sensitive, holiday, and weekend time periods.. Crane set-up locations (3) are shown on Construction Staging Plan. Both locations will not be used simultaneously. PARTilNG r Construction worker parking shall be in the Vail Transportation Center. Contractor recognizes that this is a paid-parking facility in the winter months. . There shall be no parking on Town of Vail sfreets. PEDESTRIAN SAFETY AND TRAFFIC DIRECTION r The Contractor shall install warning signs informing the public of the construction activity. The signs shall be installed in the locations identified on the approved construction staging plan. r The Contractor shall install a consffuction fence as indicated on the approved construction staging plan (see "Construction Fence" above). TREE PROTECTION & EROSION CONTROL . Silt Fences and/or Straw Bale Dikes will be installed for erosion control on the outside of the perimeter fence along the south side. These barriers will be constructed as detailed in Construction Staging Plan WORI(HOURS . Work hours will comply with the TAIL 2004 Yail Village Construction Hours Handout and as summarized below: . Access for workers to the site will be after 7:00 am Monday through Saturday. (Shaw Office workers may access site at 6:00 am.) Work will be shut down by 7:00 pm (4:00 pm on Fridays, Saturdays, and Sundays, when permitted)' ' Equipment start-ups will be after 7:00am and must be shut down by 6:00pm Monday through Saturday, and 8:00am to 5:00pm during the ski season, except as follows: No construction work will be performed during specially designated holidays and events, to be determined. r Interior work (non-obtrusive) can occur at any time. r Construction activity required for Sundays, Holidays or for extended work hours shall be reviewed three working days in advance and approved by the Town of Vail. When required, construction hours on Sundays will be limited to the hours of 9:00am to 5:00pm. ROAD CLEANING AND MAINTENANCE r The Contractor shall keep Vail Valley Drive, East Meadow Drive and areas adjacent to the outside of the construction fence clean from construction debris, mud or other undesirable materials resulting from the Vail Mountain Lodge construction activities at all times. . Anti-tracking material (gravel) will be laid at the entrances/exits from the construction site for approximately 30ft. in length. SNOW REMOVAL I The Contractor shall remove snow from within the site and disposed of in an appropriate manner off site, as needed. DUST AND NOISE CONTROL . The Contractor shall limit unusually noisy construction activities to the hours of 7:30am to 6:00pm Monday - Saturday, with the additional restriction of 8:00am to 5:00pm each during the ski season. Unusually noisy construction activities include, but are not limited to: . Jackhammers . Diesel-powered equipment including excavation equipment, mobile welders, generators, cftrne, concrete pump trucks ! Masonry saws outside of the building . The Contractor shall advise all trade workers of the need to use tools and machines with manufacturer-approved sound attenuating devices. . The Contractor shall control the dust emanating from the construction site during demolition and earth-working activities with water. r The Town of Vail Noise Ordinance shall be waived for this property during the approved days & times of construction and as outlined in the Vail 2004 Construction Hours Handout. FIRE IIYDRANT ACCESS/SAFETY r The fire hydrant at the SE entrance to the TOV parking structure shall remain free and accessible to the Fire Department at all times. r All construction activities will be performed in accordance with OSHA. . The Contractor will post the emergency response phone numbers on the site. . Fire suppression equipment and first aid equipment will be on site in the site construction office and on site in appropriate areas. TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN COMPLIANCE l. Shaw Construction will mail a copy of this plan to all material vendors with purchase orders and confirm that delivery truck drivers acknowledge the rules and the potential fines outlined. 2. Shaw Constmction will make these rules a part of each subcontact, will review them with the subcontactor prior to their fust activity on site, will reference them in the weekly Subconfactor Meeting Notes as a condition of employment on the Vail Mormtain Iodge project. ENFORCEMENT . The Contractor shall designate a "Contract Enforceme,nt Officet''to enforce the provisions of this plan. . It is understood that all terms and conditions contained herein shall be subject to enforcement by the Town Manager. In the event any condition or violation of the terms herein is not remedied in five (5) days ofnotification, the project is subject to a stop work order until such time as rernedied. Inspecfron Reque.tt R R€quested Inspect OrE: lnsp€cuon Area: SIE Address: Typs: A-MF Occuponcy: Frldty, August 12, 2005 352 E IUEAOOW DR VAIL 352 EAST MEADOWORIVE A/P/D lnformadon Aclivlty: Const Type: OrYn€r: Apdlcsnt Contactor: Archltscl: D.scrlpllon: Cominent: Sub Ty"o: AMF SEfuS: ISSUEDl3e: llA Insp fue.: CD Phone: 970'242-9236 Phone: 97G242-9236 ZEHREN & ASSOCIATES. ltlc. Phon€: 970'949C257 FltlAL REiTODEL OF MIXED USE LOOGE & SPA ROUTED TO Cf{ARLIE DAVIS. GEORGE RUTHER, FIRE DEPARTMENT AND PUBLIC I,,\rcRKS . GRUfiER . LCAMPBELL Eond and EHU lntofmrtlon r€walv.d and rotrted io G€org€ Ruli€t . CDAVIS REVISIONS TO UMT'Tf, SUBMTTTED AND ROUTED TO CI-I,ARLIE DAVIS, GEORGE RUTHER, FIRE AND PUBL]C VIICRKS. IADDED VALUATIO$I OF S3sO.MO.OOI . JSUTHER hl€w r€vblon for Strannon Res. requlrcd. ftom KH lfttebb fuchnecb. See comm€ts uti&r appro€l (Pt/V) - CDAVIS RIGHT OF WAY REVISIONS SUBMITTED AND ROUTED TO PUBTle I'\ORKS . JSUIHER REVISED DRAWI.IGS SUBMITTED AND ROUIED TO GEORGE RUTHER ANO CFIARUE DAVIS - JSUTHER Corscltorrs r€porl s€nt to fuch. K.H.tltdebb on 3/14(}5 Responsa h l€qulred Chadb D6vts A rep. ftom K.H.l,lrBbb t|as bk€n ileld plam from ofilc€ on 31710 at l PM REVISIONS RECIEVED AND APPROVEO Y21lO5 CD. CDAVIS Revocabl€ ROW D€rmtt submlt[.rl to tha PW Dooafin€nt fo] Shannon R€s. Unn M - ISAhDOVAL drawlnos subtnlErid br resDonse to commenb.odad to Charllo Davb - JSUT}IER C,aw Shannon check t 4'164 ln the anrount ot $3952.68 to Paul wtlh shtw consbuclbn on 321{5. n was the wong anowtt Paul gove us a n€w ch€ck llom Vall Mtn Lodge & Sp. In ths cor€ct amunl. - DGOTD€N Requastor: SFtAWCON.{nTtlt,FBOttco,rFe}|\ Phone: $44035 g)4-m33 VML LLC SFIAW COI.f SIRUCIION COMPANY SH,AW COhtSTRtrcnON COiTPANY Comment Addltlonal Intomatlon ts n€€ded .€oardlno staolno plan. To b€ revbwsd on Aprll 6, 2004 @ PVI/. - COAVIS COMMENT: PTANS ROUIED TO HOI'GLANDAND trSS&.TbR PI-AN REVIEWSS% CF PI-AN CHECK FEE v\,lLL BE CHARGED FOR REVIEW . CDAVISib mor€ lnso€ctlons undl retdslons are submliled lnd apqoved. - cDAvlS REVISED DRAWT.IGS RECIEVED 421/(X ROUTED TO'CFI,ARLIE AISO 'OUIEd tO G€OTgE d25l04 ADdovBd bv Ptrnnlm 7/7/04 Shnalure on revls.d omcs plsns - CDAVIS Sblond Round ol re*$ons lor drascd oocuDancv cppfovd bv Bulldhs. PI<ASTIO PIAN SUBTilTTEO AND ROI'TEb Td CF(ARLIE DAVIS. GEORGE RUTHER, FIRE ANO PUBLIC r/rpRKs - cDAvlS Coo mnt: Pbrrniro Commeffi on TCO Plt sin Pbn 1 . EHI-frs must bc codrphfod prbr b-fCO of entre buildirg ilour ono{edroofi|s one twDb.dtoom = Cx smpby.€s) 2. Parklm m€(b b be Droylded I Erldno structu]e is to be tFed fol siaqlm 3. A n€wh ls r€qulrbd lor ALL ln com-plete worx (h bndsc.phg. gsdgs- door, etc.l ln lh€ amoml ot 15096 Comment Comment: Commonl: Comment: Comrnent Commont: Comm€nt: Comrn€nl: Comtn€ril: Comm€nt: Commont Commont: % -TZo/a^r*,Nk e em!LITo,,J#,.gx.- /tmasrdt- Assloned To:- Action: Cor nant Coffimril: cDAVtS Entersd By: DGOLDEN K OFF Nlo GUARDRAILS. COMMENT ET/FLOYEE HOI,,SIT.IG I.JNITS 3t)7,3{X},31 .l TFG EGRESS VI'NDOI,I'S DO NOT MEET 5.7 SO FT AREA, AND THE SILL HEIGHT IS OI/ER 44' MAX. Comment THE !3IBC SEC 1M52 EXECPTON ALLoI/I,S 5 SO FT FOR GRADE FLOOR OPENINGS. Comrnent UNITS FINALS 4{F.4o7.&9.413.417 REpr131 '.' \ Run Id: 3516 Contlnued: Comm€nt: Corrunent Comm€nt: Comm€nt: Comm€nt Cornm€nt APPR. UNIT4O4 t'|oTIITSPECTED. UNITS 411 REOS GRAB BARS FOR ADA. LNIT 4O4 GUARDRAIL I.IO D€CK LESS THAN 42'.tP GUARD'RAIL AT EAST ROitEO E JULIETTE B LCONY GUARDRAIL FROM 01.1 3O5 APPROVED Unns 503.505.507.509 uNtTs 701,702. CORRIOOR FROi' CLUB DESK RAMP TO UNIT M, AT flrcT V\'lf,RK HEAD HEIGHT IS APPROVED TO BE 8(r PER 03 rBC SEC 1010.5.? PROVIO€ 2 LAYERS OF 5/r X GYP ATCEILIiIG FOR EXlSTltfG CORRIDOR. COMM€NI I,I'OMENS NEW TOCKER ROOT' AP9ROVED. - C^^AeTz' EUcfWcftL CowEcn'^HS€ trh:,.ru Oa EYkAPre fleWf €orL /U(eb 9qszavt' APPPIuEO+ [ZfAoqrc'N To &m6osT8cL (ufl!a4a4, +fPWez;,ffi^tq@ nLL lnsoecton HistorY *Approwcl - Atlbn: Pl PARTIAT INSPECTIONofl1l]lsDector: GCD PERMIETER FO(PERMIETER FooTII.IG AND THICKENED FTG AND 1 PAD PER REVISED PIAN DATED O4.G}-Comment:(X AS I.IOTED ON PI-AI.IS zuILD APPROVED SET.06/1t(X Inspoctor: GCO Actlon: CR CORRECTION REOUIRED Comment I PILASTER FTG FULL OF WATER.o8/(Xi04 ln3p€ctof: GCD Acdon: PA PARIAL APPRoVAL ComnEnt 1 PADFOR PILASIER. 08'20/04 Insg€clor: GCD Acton: Pl PARIAL INSP€CTION ComlrEnt CIP STAIR 263 RISERUN ROTJGH APPROVED. Insp€clor: cdavls Actlrn: AP APPROVED loHnosl€lb for sDs locatad on south slde ot bulldano lnsp€-ctor: cda'vis Ac*rn: AP APFROVED Sbb lnsDcction for sm on soslh lid€ of bulldlno TNSOOCT,OT: GCD ACTJON' PIPARTIAL INSPECTION SLAB FOR SPA DECK.lmp.cior: GCD I{C'T TUB CAP SLAB. Actbn: PA PARTIAL APPROVAL lmpeclor: @D Acton: l.|(' tlOTlFlED UMT M SHANT{ON RESIDEIIGE }lO FURTHER lNSPEcllO}l UNTIL PLAN REVIEW CORRECTIONS ARE RECE]VED ANO APPROVED. 03V17/oS InsD€clor: C'cD Acilon: Pf PARnALNSPECTION Comm€nt: 2 FILASTERS FOR RESTARAUNT ADOITION PER CHANGE FROI, tvlOllRO€/NEVtGLL DATEDO}O&05, 03/22105 lmp€ctor: cCD Ac$on: AP APPROVED Comm€nt: UNIT M Sl.|.ANhloN RESIDENCE FOOTIhGS.BlDc-Foundatlorvst€€l -ADproved"06'2404 Insp€ctor: Art Actlon: AP APPROVED Comment APPROVED SLAB AT NORTHEAST CORNER OF BUILDING07/13M Insp€clor: e'CD Actlon: Pl PARTIALINSPECTION Comm€nt: FOUNDANON WATLS & PILAS1ERS PER REVISED PIINS.(E/23'04 lnsgaclor: GCD Action: Pl PARIAL INSPECTION Comm€nt PAD AID PILASTER S SIDE. 11lfi2lo4- lnsp€clor: @D Acfon: CR CORRECTION REOURED Comm€nt STEEL t\|oT PER DETAIL 3 S3.1. | 1O3/(X tnsp€ctor: GCO Acflon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Comm6nI: P@L FOUNDATIONWALLS SOUTH SID€. 111'i.1!M lnspeclor: GCD Comm€nt: FOT ru8 WALLS Acdon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION 03'18rOS fnsp€clor: C+CD Action: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Comment GRADE EEAMS PER REVTSION OATED 03{&05 FROM MONROETNEIJIELL EI\IG. RRE226 to lbm: item: 10t27tU Comment t1lo5/o4 Comment 11!2404 Commant: 12io{ji0d Comn|3nt: 031e06 Comm.nt: It€m: 20 REPT131 Run fd: 3516 Requested Inspect Orte:- Insp€c'Uon Area: Site Addre3s: l/D€: FPLMB Occ upoit'cy: Tuesday, August 09, 2005 352 E MEADOW OR VAIL SHANNON, \'T{L.UNIT M Strtus: lnsp fuor: 290 PLIfB#lnal subQg: AMF Requested Time: 00:30 All' Phone: 331.45OG Enl€rsd By: DGOLD€N K APAPPROVED I8AND. APAPFROVED COI',ICEPTMEC will call 331-4506JliolDRAGOtt <-< &oA 6*s Sd^rT oFF ro &r. e,+: uu6' /,ure k Qtaea@ tuEcrf, frt-ttTt-- lnspecton Hktorv Acllon: TEST. REPLACECommsnl: 06/01/o5 Comment: tbm: 250 PLlvBPooUHot Tublism: 260 PLl,BMbc. ll€m: 29O PLilBRnsl t nePorttng ---Fag9Z _4'.17 pm Vail, CO-_Chr Ot ___j_ AFrD lnlormrdort Acfvttv: Consi Typ5: Own6r: Aoollcant: Cohlractor: Dascrlpoon: Nolhe: Commenl: Request d lnsoecflon(sl Item: R€qu€stor: Commsnts: Assbn€d To:- Actlon: P0$(x'23 VML LLC CO|.ICEPTMECI-|ANICAL. lIrc Phone: 97$949t12fl) CONCEPTMEeHAMCAL. INC Phone; 97G949O2q) ROTJGH IN DVW AND WATER PIPING TC' RXTURES. SET FIXruRES, RUN GAS RPII.IG. REVISED MECI-IANICAL AND PLUMBII.E PI-ANS ISSUED V\NTH TI,IE PERMIT SEE PIAT-IS DA1ED APRO/ED rl14l05 FOR ALt INSPECIONS - CGUMON REVISIOIIS SUBMITTED AND ROt'TED TO CHRIS GUMON . CGI,''iflON ISSUED CG pLd'$O lbm: 210 Item: 2Z) Item: 230 Pli/BRough{rllater * Approv?d " 05t0,fr05 lrgpecto.: CiCD Actlon: APAPPROVED Comrnont l0O p6l TEST. ttem: 240 PLIFC'8S PlDano " ADorov.d -' 0t0405 lmbeaor: C€D " Aclbn: APAPPROVEO comm€nt: 15psl TEST. IJO'IE IFCG sEC 403.4.3 COPPER VENT FOR REGUIATOR.60lr'06 lnio3clor: cCD Ac$on' APAPPROVED comn r{: GAs PIPE FOR DEC|(S 15per TEST. REPTl31 Run Id: 3502 equest Reporting Page224:21_pn_--'- Vall, CO- C|tr Of Requested tnspect Date: Frlday, August 12, 2005- lnsoecton Area: CG Slte Address: 352 E MEAOOW OR VAIL SHANNON. VITIL-UNIT IU A/P,D lntormadon Acttutty: Comt Type: o!flnsr: Applkant Cohkaclor: D€scrlpuon: l.lotlca: Commoril: M(}s.fiX7 1ype: SMECH occupah'cy: VML LLC COI.ICEPT MECMNICAL, INC. rssrJ€oc6 Phone: 97G949@0O CONCEPTMECI-IANICAL, lNC Phona: 97S949{v2@ - _ DEilIO. REMOVBE ilJCT'/IICRK. TNSTALL TI,I'O FAI.ICONL UNITS WTH DUCTING. RUN BC'TH DRYER AND RANGE EXHAUST DUCTING, SNO$'ELT ONE DECK. REVISED MECI.IAMCAL AND PI-UMBING PLANS TSSUED VI'TH THE PERMIT SEE PLANS DATED APROVED 4I4lO5 FOR ALL INSPECTIONS - CGUNION REVISIONS SUBMITTEO AND ROt'TED TO CHRIS GUNION . JSUTHER Status: Insp Area: ICAL, INC Requesbd Tlme: 09:30 Alf,' PhonE: 970'94(XB$ -or- 331- ,f5O9 Enlered By: DGOLDEN K tnsoecton HtsordbA - 3 r*,f oL MaLT l+frs lSocuru^-l Uvtz-of BEEI fuOM llem: AX) MECI-l-Rouoh * ADorov€d * 06'05/05" InsDector: GCD " Actlon: PA PART1AL APPROVAL COMMONI: BATH EX}IAUST. DRYER OUCT. SUPPLY AT{D RETURN DUCT.. NEED TO II{SPECTTERMNANONS VII}IEN INSTALLEO. O525/O5 InsD€CiOr: GCD ACIION: PA PARIIAL APPROVAI- Commant SI{CWMELT FOR UPPER OECK AND EXTERIOR STAIRS l(Epsl TEST.(H15/05 lnrgocior: cicD Actbn: APAPPROVED Commsnt REruRN FOR RESTARAUNT. MECH-l-leatlng PLM&Gas PiFlng MECH-ExhaGt lioods i/ECFlSuDglyAl. MECf+Mria.-- Approved '* InsDoclor: GCO' Action: APAPPROVED R.Z2 REFRIGERAI.'T 3OQ9.I NIIROGEN PRESSU.RE_ TES]FRESSU-BE* TEST FOR AC Ll NE S ll€m: 310 hem:315 ilem: 320 ftem: 33[} ttem: 340 qt05,05 Comment Itsm: 3S,O MECI-lFin l 07/01/o5 Comnrnt: GCD Ac[on: PAPARTIALAPP REP?131 APPROVED RNISH INSTALLIT.IG GRILL. mn} Run Id: 3516 4:16 pm Vall, CO- Cltr Oi Reguested lnspec't 9aEr luesday, July 26, 2005- InspedflonArea: JS Slb Addrss: 352 E TEADOW DR VAIL VAIL IUOUNTA|N LODGE g SPA ArPrD lntormrfron Actfuhv: trG$O121 T\oa: SIECHConslTypi: occupairty: Or*r€r: VML LLC Agg|cant R& HMECMNICALLLC Co-nbrclor: R & H MECI-{ANICAL LLC S.lDtrs: Inlp A!aa: ISSUED JS *Tffistrffit/ ^**Q(k;F' dffiH: i'#ffiBHie"ffid^' ;:fi,-'" 35 subTlH: AcoM Phon€: (970) 32&26t9 Pftone: €70)?&2SXlOc$np{bn: SIDEWALK AnD R flP S}lq , MELT TUBI}.IG ADOITION AsshnedTo: JMONDRAGOMTT) - <K Enbnd qfi LCAIIPBELL Kltctlon'. fFl/ Tinte Exp: n ,U"r'N-t tat / /:,v,y, / 7a;4/- lnspecton Hlsbrv lbm: 2(tr Item: 310 MECFGRouofiMECI-t-Flea[no * Aooroved - OB?Oo5 firspedor: JRM " Acdon: APAPPRoI/ED Commsnt StJo|ftt'tELT SIDEwALK 10O, AIR TESTcF,lz4lo' l]l3Decior JRM Actbn: APAPPRoVED Comm€nt DRIVEWAY SiIoI,I/MELT FOR VML PLM&C'€S PlDlno MECI'l-Erharfu l{oo& MECH-SuppfyAh IIECI-l-MLc. lrEcl'lFln lOTnKE |n3pectoc @O Acton: NRiIOTREADYFORINSPECnOiI Commont: PRbVIDE WILL CALL NtntBER AND SOMEOI.IE AVAILABLE TO BE Otl SITE. lbm: 315 liem: 320 Itom: 3dtlbm: 3{O hem: 3€X) REPT131 Run Id: 3443 Requested Inspect O.te:- Asilgned To: Inlpec{On Type: Insirccdon Arar:SlbArklre$: Ilpe: A-liF Occupciay Fddav. Julv 01.2fi)5 JilCNbRAGOTiI BLDG CD 352 E T||EADOUI'DR VA|L 352 EAST T{EADo!IV DRTVE Sub A,P,D lnlormaion Acthrilt,: Conrt Typ5:ol br: Applbant Conha&r: Archliec{: D.$rboon: Co{n|mnt HX4m3 VML LLC : AlrlF St tls: ISSUED: llA lrEpAFa: CD sFlAw co,NsTRUcnoN coitPAtfY sFtAw co$tsTRlJcTtot{ cotpANY ZEHREN & ASSOCIATES, ll.lC. FIML REUC'OEL OF ITXED t'SE LOOGE & SPA ROt'TED TO C}TARLIE DAVIS, GEORGE RUT}€R, RRE OEPARTTffiNT A}ID Pt',BLlc Urc'RTS . GRUTHER . LCAT'PB€LL Eond tnd EFlt lniofln Uon Errc.hrad and |oubd to G€otgs RuttF. CDAVIS REVIS]OIMT TO UMT.T,I St,BI,ilTlED AND ROt'IED TO CI-IARL]E DAVIS, GEORGE RUTHER, FIRE AhD PI'BLIC I/TPRKS. (ADDED VAIUATIOI.I OF 335O.(xx).OO . JSUIHER t{ery revFlon tor Slraruron Ros. leqqhed,ltom KH Ulbbb Archlhcts. So. commels undel .p'pro\€l (PW) - CDAVIS RIGHT OF WAY REVISIONS St BIdTTED At\D ROtmD TO R.ELIC !/K,RKS - JSUTHER REVISED DRAWII'IGS SUBTTITED AND ROUIED TC, GEORGE RUTHER AND CM'RLIE OAVIS . Phonc: 97$242-92i16 Phone: 9D242-92i5 Phone: 97O94(XI257 Cornment Commont Commcril; Comment AddUorul lfomdbn b modod no.rdho sLohd Dbn. To be revleryod on Aprll6,2flX O PryV. - CDAVIS Commont: PL"ANSR4fiEDTOIIOUGLANDINDTS@.FORPtANREVIEWE{tSCFPtANCIECfiFEEWILLBE C}IARGED FOR REVIEW cDAV|S ilo more Insoec0om untl rsytsbns lra submllbd and aItfo more InsD€c0orls untl rsytsbrr lro submlted and aDgrowd. - CDAVIS REVTSED DRAYVIIr|GS RECIEVED 621/(}4 RO[rrED TOCI-IARLlE_4S_foubd b G.oqB g2StX ADDrotnd bv Phmho 7ftl0,l Shn ts. on rrvbcd olllce gbnr - CtlAVlS Sbbord Rorind dro6brbr dnred ooqornsy.Dprolbd by Bufdm. PIIASII.IGPI.ANSI.JBUITTEDAT.IDROUTEDTUCTARL|E MUS.GEORGE RUTHER, FIRE AIDPTEI.IC UK'RKS - CDAVIS @mme : Plrnnho Conm.rfl on T@ Pharho PLn 1 . El-fi..f3 muC b. comphtcd gbr io-ltco ot o lr€ brddlDg four one.badroornJone Mdtoom = rlx amDbtlasl 2. PaiUm'needg b be omvlded I Effrro $rrdurl b b be usod br sttdm 3. A mwh b rocFrfic or ltt ln coadFtm wo* (b hn(hc'pang, gpnga (bor, rtc,, h lh. tmorttt ot 150* JSUTTIERCorment Con cllOlE ropo.t $nl io tuch. K.Fl.Vhbb on 31406 ResporF b requked Ch.rfe D.vb - A rep. tlom K.H.Urebb h.s tlh3n tl€ld plorc tom ottlc€ on 31 7/O at I Pi, trrv Conrrnanl: Cottrmer{: Commel* Comm€rt Comm€nt REPT131 Run Id: 3371 07-01-2005 Inspecfron Rcgucrt Reportlng PagB 1E 7:36 am valt_ co - ctty ol Requesbd lnspect 9!b: E4dry, July 01,2005- lnseeclon Aree: GD - - Slte Addrws: 352 E ilEADOW DR VAIL VAIL TOI'I{TAIN LODGE BAR ArP,D Informrllon Actlvltr til0$0116 I\ae: &MECHConetTni: Occnpo'riry: Chilriel: VML LLC AFplhtnt R& HIIEC}IANICALLLC CohTr&r: R&HMEC}IANrcALLLC D..cthdon: I'{DERGROLr\D Dt CT SYStEll Reauccbd lnsp€cdo]ilct *tH.ACOM Slrt|s:lmpAnt: l97O) 32&2ext (97q 3A&2699 oTA/a{ ISSIJED GD Phone: PhorE: Item: R.qFstor: Agsl$red To:- Acdon: tLC / ].lancy Tlma Exp: lnsoecUon Hlstorv nem: AX) iGCl-lRowh "Appowd*m/ls,ot IffiDecbr: C€D'' Com'FnT SI,PPLY FOR RESTARAI,NT. f@ Acdon: APAPPROI/ED 310 315fro 3Kx) 3,lO 3q) It m: lbm: tbm:bm: lbm: lbm: 390 REPT131 Run Id: 3369 J fFo o o oqto E** ttt 6 .s|I.E E<< F==zzz aE * trsttovE'c fie;x 9<" gzzzzz I Eoro-ooll!F(DO(D<Dl _()c{FF-?l.gl EF=eqcc 9R8888 J=-34rCcr(ct zo U' IUo g E:' (U ootr LHroolfi=t F Crlxol G-ldl oE El1 EI EIot ol'5t 6lot >lut(/)l (5 oo ooc -gom oo. U) Eco o ct)EoJcE-co =oo(\lE.; = (vt{o ot?.9 irtet6lo.lol o .9co -coo r €E .F5t*t* o9"'5 SadE<g==zzz c 6Per$rNN<.lb OFFFFT\<a U ciiiitlgSi,<IIJrtL@@oco6 cn ----- c,J'=b F(\t.otro h.^,Q tr EiriiiF9bGobbbaF!-FFF ZEHREN AND ASSOCIATES, INC. ARCHITECTURT. PLANNINC INTERIOR5. LANDSCAP€ ARCHITECTURE P.O.8ox 1976 Avon. Colondo 81520 $ml9494257 FAX {9m) 9491oEO LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL TO: Town of Vail DATE: November 30,2004 Dept of Community Development JOB #: 20021501.08 75 South Frontage Road ATTN: Charlie Davis Vail, CO 81657 RE: Vail Mountain Lodse WE ARE DELIVERING: ffi Attached ! Under separate cover via x the following items: I Shop Drawings fi Prints ! Plans ! Samples ! Specifications n Copy of Letter I Change Order ! Other COPIES DATE NO.DESCRIPTION 1 3lz1l04 Copy of Division 83 1 1 Vail Mountain Lodge Proiect Manual 1 tr/30t04 Cut Sheet of Fire Rated Access Panel I rr/23/04 SK-I83 Updated with Occuoancv Load lnformation THESE ARE TRANSMITTED as checked below: ffi For Approval ! Approved as submitted I Re-submit copies for approval ! For your use E Approved as noted fl Submlt copies for distribution I As requested ! Returned for corrections ! Retum corrected prints ! For review & comment I ron BIDS DUE 20 n pn-nqrs RETURNED AFTER LoAN To us REMARKS: SIGNED: Ben White for Tim Losa COPY TO: fi]e %ir JO HrVd,,0-,29 Eg ^lra.^ AV,I\ITQVSSYd TIXd N) 14x< Y(/r ? F T3g <F3 ca a R elolx 5l;l: r.t[-J a lgr, I -l!lr :F+ ts =r--ril Elelz-tldlz url Iva-f 6Qr-rat<l ^'/ | 4'\ | =tc.tl--rl Hl-l -:-_=f-2- r t-i ->:I /. i,\ / ?.a t-t / r JEE]x=:1! =e DRAWN BY: BW CIIECKED BY: TL ISSUE: CA SHEET: sK- 183 REF: A1.2 &oe 4&oQ ()o c\l I 0 t ff, iIr.lth \ohl + t;rfl z F(A X rq \o\o FlfYl r!Fl I z J O Flt! H oQ I r'l M z RFl E d,&ur t! &4&4 r! 14&x t& Eid& : e'l PROJECT N0: 20q2r501.m VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE VAIL, COLORADO DRAWING TITLE: LEVEL 166 - E)ilT PASSAGEWAY 268 CHANGES SCALE: l/8'= l'-0' DATE: ll/19/04 .-.-Lrrr\Lrr - .a AND AssocrATEs, rNc. - .I ArctmCnl1E. pi.11NNtNG. N11npx9 7 .- '8^ltl%";"fffi;iffiiffi' - (ros)e6348!m rex 6os) xr-sior (3) F/S D AS PLANNED FIRE-RATED S}IAFT CLOSURE PER 707.12 NEW I HR SHAFTWALL SYSTEM I HR RATED FLOOWCEILING ASSEMBLY NEW l HR SHAFT WALL SYSTEM (2) F/S D PER REV 24 DATED lotzv0/. (l) F/s D PER REV 24 DATED tumtM I) F/S DAMPER NEWDUCT I) F/S DAMPER PROJECTNAME: PROJECTNoT 20021501.00 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE VAIL, COLORADO DRAWING TITLE: LEVELS 186, 196 & 2O'1 F/S DAMPER LOCATIONS SCALE: NTS DATE: I l/1504 20x26 .- t- L rr r\ L rr - .l AND AssoclATEs, tNc. - ^I mcxrncruRE. prANNrNG. rNrERrof,s 7 .-'3#e$1,;'^ffi',5ffi?i$ - t&)5! 963-6090 t-Ai(.msr 96,3-8i@ lF-lltotl lor lll,.lll trI]tlt>iltrI]il[l! H z Fl o o- [-rl l!!<llF->lt?-t oldlrl =tF<<t =IHII| - /)1 O trltrllrll!lItltl/\\ *-, r- X c.l Fl 7 Fr(J IJ PROJECTNAME: PROJECTNo: 2002150:.00 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE VAIL. COLORADO DRAWINC TITLE: LEVELS 186 ,196, 207 F/S DAMPER LOCATIONS SCALET NTS DATE: I l/8IX .- L I- rr r\ L ir - .l AND AssocrATEs, lNc. - ^I encxmcruRE. pr.ANNrNG. rNTERroRs 7 .-'3.3e*1',;'tr,5ffit133' - !oosr!r6,-65so,trrsoslg534io: From: "Benjamin White" <benw@zehren.com> To: <CDavis@vailgov.com> Date: 1'll17l2$4 5:35:29 PMSubject: Vail Mountain Lodge - Shaft Rating Proposal November '18,2004 RE: Proposed Fire/Smoke Damper Locations at Shaft 401A - Vail Mounlain Lodge Mr. Davis: I am working under Tim Losa on the Vail Mountain Lodge. I am writing in regards to lour correspondence with Corey Rhodes of Beaudin Ganze Engineers concerning exhaust shaft penebations and our proposed used of fire/ smoke dampers. Attached are two PDF architectural sketches depicting the location of the proposed fire/ smoke dampers and access panels. SK-177 is a diagrammatic section showing the three shafts in question. The area of most concern is Level 186 where space considerations and the confluence of several existing ducts complicates the construction of a shaft wall system. Per Corey's proposal, we would like to isolate Level 186 by placing fire/ smoke dampers in both the floor and ceiling assemblies. Construction from Level 196 up would continue in a shafi wall sptem. I am proposing to use a t hour-rated shaft wall as the ducts at that point only penetrate three levels. SK-178 shows enlarged plans of the areas in question and the location of all access panels. It is my understanding that you have approved the mechanical solution and the aftached sketches depicting the locations of fire/smoke dampers and access panels were necessary for final approval. Please do not hesitate to call with any questions. Your comments are most welcome and I look forward to hearing back from you. Thank you, Ben White Zehren & Associates (970) 9494257 GC: "Timothy Losa" <timl@zehren.com>, 'Steve Ritchey'' <SteveR@ShawConstruction.net>, "Corey M. Rhodes" <cmr@bgce.com> Vruu NlourvrruN lLonon & Spn January 25,2005 Mr. Charley Davis Chief Building Department Manager Townof Vail Building Department Mr. Davis, We are presently working on a repair of the Vail Mormtain Lodge & Spa's main elevator' We have contracted with Amtech Elevator Services and they will have a crew out here next week commencing on Monday January 31, the work should be conrpleted by Friday ofthe same week. The handicap elevator that services the lower level accessing the club and spa and the main level accessing the restaurant is operational providing access from the main entrance. If you have further questions regarding this maintenance issue please do not hesitate to contact me. Kindest regards, turJp.,gw Chadd Ziegler General Manager Vail Mountain Lodge & Spa Direct. 970-477-3232 Cell. 970-445-0122 352 East Meadow Drive Vail, CO 81557 Hotel (970) 476-0700. Spa (970) 476-7721. Fa< (970) 476-6451 0t/10/200s Shaw Construction Billy Sallee RE: Vail Mountain todge TCO Provide additional information on proposed staging plan before TCO approval will be issued . l. In order to use walk path steps on south east side of building. The Vail Mountain l.odge must provide the Town ofVail with and additional insured policy, for the term the construction access is to be used. 2. Revocable Right of Way Permit is required for access across TOV property on the south, south west side of building. 3. Construction schedule, showing when underground parking garage will b€ open to guest ofthe VML 4. Construction schedule for work on South east side of building near Vail Valley Drive. 5. Erosion Control Plan for South side ofbuilding.6. Provide detail information on wbat walk path steps will be use for, construction use only sign is required. 7. Traffic control plan for work or any proposed use of Vail Valley Drive during completion of construction work to east side ofbuilding. 8. Construction completion date. 9. Bond in the amount of $ 90,000.00 dollars shall be in place. I recognize that an existing bond is in place for the public improvements that are required but amount must total $ 90, 000.00 dollars. The addition amount is required for the following. a) Replacement for curb and gutter along Vail Valley Drive from intersection of E. Meadow Dr.A/ail Valley Drive to Bridge. Cost to be split between Vail Mountain Lodge and TOV. b) Repair damage to walk path light fixtures, walk path stone entrance walk way. c) Bond for use ofvialk path during construction. Vail Mountain Lodge Shaw Construction Stan Cope William Sallee Managing Director Ifyou have any questions, please feel fiee to call me ^t 479-2198 Thank you, Leonard Sandoval Town of Vail Construction Inspector. - E.L.C.. Vail Mountain Paoe 1 From: Mike Vaughan To: charlie davis; Mike Mccee; Pam Brandmeyer; Stan Zemler Date: 01/06/2005 4:47:30 PMSubject: E.L.C., Vail Mountain Lodge Good afternoon folks. I wanted to just lake a minute and pass on some siatus reports for the above listed buildings. Early leaming center will be ready for a sprinkler final tomonow. Todays inspection was put off due to the fact that the tamper switches were wire incorrectly. (Backwards). Other Middle Creek issues: Backflow in building A is still leaking. All State has yet to give me a schedule for completion. Fittings are still mixed on the sprinkler trim package and must be changed. Building B still has single action pull stations- Paul is aware and has told me that the replacements are on order. Barry Monroe is to come into the F.D. to order a knox box for ELC. The other Knox Boxes have been recieved and are scheduled to be installed tomorrow. VF&ES is denying the proposed fire hydrant landscaping as there is not seven feet of clear access shown on the plan. This is a water district standard as well, and relates to the clearance around lhe 2 /2" connections. Vail Mountain Lodge has several issues that are not insurmountable,yet need to be addressed. When I tested the alarm system today, I had the tech drop the A/C power in order to evaluate the battery performance. The system did not respond satisfactorily. ln short, the horn strobes in the hallways stopped illuminating. I have advised the tech and Shaw that I will be available tomorrow to conduct a follow up test. There were issues of missing cover plates on tamper annunciators, but these were being addressed while lwas still on the property. Not a big deal, lanticipate completion by tomorrow. Please feel free to pass this info on to whomever might need it. Like I said, I will be back at both locations tomorrow. Mike. CC: John Gulick; Mike Vaughan December 22,2004 Mr. Michael J. McGee Deputy ChieflFiie Marshall 42 West Meadow Drive Vail, CO 81657 Re: Vail Mountain Lodge DearMike: Thank you for meeting with me yesterday. I greatly appreciated your willingness to take the time out of your busy schedule, at an un-appointed time, to discuss matters that are of great importance to us. As I mentioned during our conversation, safety is our first priority; working safely is a condition of employment at Shaw Construction. Prior to my meeting with you, I personally met with Billy Sallee and Gary Starr to discuss the actions that were to be taken in order to secure a safe site, and to re-emphasize safety as a priority above all other things on the project. During our meeting, our personnel worked diligently to correct those things that you identified, and those items that were not immediately corrected are currently being resolved by procuring additional materials or equipment that were not immediately available on site. Following our discussion, where you reviewed your concems of safety, separation of construction and occupancy, I immediately called Billy Sallee, who is working on the project as a Superintendent, to inform him ofour resolve to appoint him as the person in charge of safety. As you know, Billy Sallee has training as a volunteer Fireman, and I believe he is uniquely trained to be aware and sensitive to the most challenging issues facing us at the Vail Mountain Lodge due to the on-going occupancy of the facility. So that we do not experience any miscommunication in the future, please refer all inquiries, inspections or questions to Billy Sallee. He can be reached in person at the jobsite, or at either the job phone 477-1216 or on his cell phone 445-7210. Although we have other Shaw managerial and labor personnel on the site, I ask that you please ensure that all of your communication be directed to Billy so that there is not a misunderstanding and so that you have a consistent contact from Shaw. We also ask that other Town of Vail Staff. specificallv Mr. Sandoval and Mr. Davis. direct all concerns to Billy Salle so that they may be addressed immediately. In the unlikely event that Billy is not available or that ifyou find it necessary to contact me personally, please do not hesitate to do so. I can be reached at work 970-242-9236, on my cell phone at 970-985-3340 or at home 970-245-1693. Thank you for recognizing that Shaw is not in complete control of the site, with numerous other influences that are under the direct control of the Owner and other contractors working on the project. We will diligently control our work, and will' endeavor to influence the actions of the other parties working on the project as well, however, we understand that to the best of your ability, you will distinguish t}te actions of others outside of Shaw. We look forward to completion of this most challenging project, and to continuhg the relationship of trust and confidence that we have worked so hard to establish with you and others at the Town of Vail over the years. Sincerely, Clark Atkinson Vice President cc. Mr. Charlie Davis Mr. Leonard Sandoval Billy Sallee Steve Meyer, President Shaw Constnrction 11August2005 To: Michael Cunent From: Jeremy Thomas Regarding: lnstallation of a Dacor ERBIS Epicure Range an EHIXS Epicure Hood. Mr. Cunent, The installation that is in question is as follorra; The Dacor range and hood are being installed following the'Clearance Reduction Methods," illustrated in Table 308.6 in the Intemational Mechanical Code 2003. Using 24 gauge stainless sbel to sheath Orc face of the cabinets adjacent b he range from the under side of the hood (+30' above range top) to the botbm of the cabinets across their entire depth, with a minimum 2' rctum under the cabineb. The stainless steel sheathing will have a minimum of 1'airspace between the metal and the cabinets in accordance witt tabb 308.6, IMC 2003. This particular installation is made up of 15'deep wooden cabinets. Prwkliq that all of Daco/s otrer minimum installation requirernents have been rne€t, the installation noted above woutd meet our installation requircrn€nb. The final decision is, of course, up b the Authority Having Jurisdiction. Dacor provides installation instructions based on our experbnoe, testing and mandated certification requirements. Dacor exp€cts specilic installation isEues not covered under by our instruc'tions to be ttte responsibility of the builder and the building inspec{or who have detaibd tnorteOge ot, and have inspe@d such installatkrns. I hope thia inbrmation will help in your cunent situation. I can be reached at the telephone numbers below if you have questions. Jeremy Thomas Product Support 800-793-0093 ext.3124 76G792€000 cell Charlie Davis - Shannon 405-0035 f05-0016 Page 1 I From: JR RulapaughTo: Building_DivisionDate: 08112120057:57:14 AM Subject: ShannonA05-0035 m5-0016 Shannon is signed of and ready for TCO per fire. Thanks J.R. F romiBtAtlJ 1N Grt{'llt dJSZ/U3U45 ru/2t/2w4 13:31 #W4 P.UU:yUl5 Project #: 5822.17 Derr Mr- White: Please issue the following information to Shaw Construction for discussions and approval from the Town of Yail Building Inspectors. This letter is in regard to the existing exhaust ducts at Level 177, I E6 and 196. Existing exhaust duct at Level 177- A. The existing hre damper located at the floor/ceiling assembly separating Level 177 from Level 186 will be removed. B. A new firc/smoke damper will be installed in tlre existing duct replacing the s)ci5ting fire n acccss pancl shall be installed for mainterance on (he new fire/smoke &rnper. It is the responsibility of the architect and contractor to consult with the building inspector and determine the propcr access panel construction rcquired for this application. Two existing exhaust ducts at Level I 86. A. Thc cxisting firc dampcrs in tlre two exhaust ducts penetrating the floor/ceiling assembly scparating kvel 186 and Level 196 will be removed. B. Ncw firc/smoke dampers will be installed in the existing ducts, replacing the existing fire dampers. Access panels shall bc installed lbr maintenance on the new firey'smoke dampers. The architcct atrd contmctor shall dcterrnine tlre appropriate constnrction fior the assemtly around the ducts on Level 186. Ul. Two existing cxhaust ducts and onc new exhaust duct on Lcvcl 196. A. From the floor level oflevel 196ancwshaftwill be constuctcd to cnclose thc tlrcc exhaust ducts. This shaft will be continuous through I*vel217 wherc thc ducts terminate. It is the responsibility of the architect and contactor to dctemrine the proper construction of the new shaft. B. A tire/smoke damper Mll be installed at thc shaft wall for any branch duct penetrations ofthe shaft. C. Fire/smoke dampers will be insulled in each exhaust duct upon exiting the shaft on Level 2t7. 1104'€a!.'cr'kErvd'*202'Avqr\corl620;,T^1r"-Slllr?;tr*Srf-i'.?;iii,irt.lil"ir'l?'"*i?i.?13.ilir"#ril:': 11448 D..rf.td Dr., lCl, Truckcc, CA 96re t . pnonETdEffiFr.r: 530.550.7336 I-AJKE TAttOE II" L:\Outlcil Pr\i.cr $Jn:. I t Vril I'ltn Lodg. I.no\.rrion\\C Ehr mCS'Jt{!: | ?AO | 0clt.&.i www.bgoq,€qnr l-rqn:BEAUDIN CTANZE 3ffi783&t3 t0/21/2M 13:31 #004 P.003/005 Sincercly, Cfll,ftfll/ Un"lF Corcy Rhodes, P.E. Project Engrnccr L.\Coldrn h jc!i!rsn:.|7 von N|n Lod8e Rnbr.cbi.\oE Docs\ltllt7Ao|ocR.doc f\ T\f, X r9 O. UJ:(9t,qs za<5 2s. 33 zI(Ltoo Lt-o s J E o- (.) thi .+ +L Fl o- E i:$$ is$ EsEF N1l It cfl +h i lzhl\n NlCIlv3g:urorj900/900'd ?m# rc:tt FMltzlo| LF-AN +x r5 s{{z? u.tJF(9<za'39 z 5o-Eo 9]l. J (Jz -ollt = trE (Ltr{+t t-; 4tr1 ele =to'-t- F2l Ic 5dEEgF o o-3(, x 3Foq gF p5F@ r-E 3aoo atl =IrJz F() lrjz (, rr) +h ,-j hi rd F F C):ta s *iif i:iiE aEAF N cnlt rjFu{ t-i : 1/lz< ;lt co IE xt,/ nNe Nl0lvlg:urorjE 8t8/ZEm9m/f00'd toff zt:tt vwtz/o\ z txzt 'c Po. v-iEx !.sg;hME ESAHC' o\ v) FF t!--r tna)2? UIV LJl,,ill FF fYl I zg€ss3. = s- 59 dE :ttEe f9rEIlS;i in;ea$$oEsBslN 3 g 35,!3 I --' IJT El. \I 'Er J U rI] - l: 9 6 z l:l'5) 5i9.t 6L q.t {b-q 3.9FE E T 9 5 .2 if 391 O= 9-3go)c;.9 i9 'o c r( EI i; bu _LX Ig i.9l> ;9 6 o a: 3) AE Ed ): +r i.$r6'le:lXiroi o.;;{ju! b5 ot :E .E ar 5C a-> 3Ptro Fg. fEt,;:€.,.=lEli&i!. I13: o: !( a.5C'2't (Je !lo €5 EI :3 F" r3 iE IF i3rls{f;je. Sr :s ENbEqz.F tsu go3 oa? E€ g .= F .: t: ttt 'I .r lJrt-5tt3t !ate: F! .-.: rt n.;E .EFE&4E (, (U d) .c :=l 'F t: f-r rrl xtl E *ri"lrJ ftt:> i\l f"t :(J,_trl 5E4 Fz E] F rT'l F rr'l 3z;(^ =k>o (.. !'/ t- o d, cari '5-aui.^. \-r---, v('i>!z i:\?;i:>6,ry frl H F3e], T d oo I €l -l$ I\I I I T:-----------\j a4 .rl i Eli Elrl iitr h].dz t-'t_ -1. ll$ \r ,'9-'L "ivl .... 'r : | "..."..rn+-- -- -)a, ..- _ _ _=.1...---.--.-. lrN ,taj ,l rl.l rr oo F- tl 'Jrr) F v, lr\lr \ri ):itli\l . r'r]\ frHlr\ 2s,Ir \ ;3 I t l -n-Ir 4-lr fl ,; J I A>lr i lrlII LJJlr < rr1| | ar.{ , ait I Frfilt' ffiir/ lL l.l;/ >:ni I ;3 -it.+ s |;-l tTl lr-l la) |l.-ltvllsJ b%r ado'rs uaZ,A ,)Et1orlls? p,. L.I W JFKJ <.o < A: \c^ t:< *7e ElorM9 e?"4 Eu) Be 4r; I!* ts> g t= , a-@ 9rr.l =!*\, a.-t].]l-l F/ vt! FJO 4 AE tf' '74fr< o- -)& tt ,r; lJ Y ',t .^ l t 20 E € l, .l ,to-9 + : I Fl ,l F i! ,:t!J --. h t > "i.i -\ ., < ;--,' : E )2> 6 'l y 5 zeHEB6.s - tr @- E.9 iu1Ei iE I IEfi EFN=$3b83 g rr--- IITIr. \IrL.l =^/. p (Ja a cn OU I il-t \ L--:-Gir;f,----- sl i c''r | |ti Fl E+ i.rz, :.: I o\|.l I I' ( /<\_ _ \f--/ f"t- -\:/ @-- q'i st6 -,. \t/aEr ?gH;*V gEe=,, HO' '-'r O 8a I! rr. tr> f r'l O i zi8 z* R r.r :tr4# !: X /1 s.lxavE)nqzd ,'',) . : ''\ l- ,7QF< o-)& rh z '>,i, UY r,{ .^ AI >o = s * E .t J- 9 ---.', ? s2 HJ 5 r! ,:.;s?iiri,2> E J y 9 z9-Ess3s = E E9 '.'6 ;s!Ei f? :AEun gn -oE,I5i5 N=g95EE g rr- - lr \lr\l ''J,l -rl]<;\tr3 F(4O<AFEAa 3n"H EiX'.> Frtr :. Zii] ip frx Ifi1fr sH UB s#e fi3HH ZEo:d o> l* 7, o z zoFatu |p.9 <r< OFT acn tz rj a rI.],l <U -:^ ^>as h: r:tH 5>9.9 rr;1 <t cn Fl z z r]1trl (.)(n F(.) az E{ z v) gr t-.1 :_) tl s ,'., ?f, r'i ri=zts7zIti -\ IJJ V)EZch< l-'Xi^ lr) Fl Ffrl -l z ;E F(/) tl c.l z F()rrl (n tqU fTl F a II e.l F-l a rrl r.l Fla frl F OPENING ,t \ i"t^, I -"7 ll]l lill I I NN Vam, Nlourwnnmv ll,onon & Sp,t v-#Town of Vail 75 S. Frontage Road West Vail, CO 81657 January 3,2005 To Whom lt May Concern: The Vail Mountain Lodge will be responsible for shoveling the snow on the Town of Vail's steps and path that lead from Vail Valley Drive to the temporary egress from the townhouse that is under construction on the southeast corner of the building. We will also clear the snow along the west easement between the Mountain Haus and The Vail Mountain Lodge. As in the past, we will maintain the Sidewalks from the garage entrance on our northrvest corner to the north edge of the bridge on the southeast corner of the property. lf you nave any questions, please feel free to contact me directly, 476-9530. Sincerely,lL+ Stan Copc Managing Director 352 EastMeadowDrive Vail, CO81657 Hotel (970) 47c07cn. spa (970) !76-7721. Fa:r (970) 476-645r EnururrGTcc)-?eNspEcfl(Wo Inspectlon Reqqest R A/P/D lnlbrm.tlon Requeshd Insp€at Dsb: lnspecdon Arer: Slte Address: TID€: A"MF Occupqncy: ilonday, October 1 1, 20In 352 E TTEAOOW DRVAIL 3Ii2 EAST flEADOW DRIVE ActMty: C,ondTwe: orriier: Appilcrnt: tuchltect: CorflIlctgr: Descrlpdon: con n€ni: E{)+tx)33 VML LLC SHAW CONSTRI.TCTION COfrlPAllY zEfiREN & ASSOCTATES. trc. SFIAW CONSTRIJCTION COMPA}IY FIML REIrcDEL OF MIXED USE LODGE & SPA Strt6: Insp Ar€a: tsst ED CD Phone: 97$242-9236 Phons: 97$94S9257 Phom: 97tts242-936 Commenl: eoflrm€nt Item: Raau6sior: AsslgiFd Itr REVISED DRAWhIGS RECIE\,ED C/21/tX ROUTED TO CHARLIE Alro rout€d to C'oo{ge 6r25fiX ADoroved bv Pbnnlm 7f7l04 Shnatne on r€vlsod oilc€ Dlans - CDAVIS ttro'more Insoectlons lnfll tortslohr me rubmfr€d ard aDorqred. - CDAVLS PT.ANS ROUTED TO }IOUGT.iChID A}ID ASSOC. FOR }T.AhI REVIEW 6696 OF PI.AI.I CHECK FEE W]LL B€ C}|ARGEDFOR REVIEW - CDAVIS Dzsren++f COf,lPAl.lY Requested Tlme: 0E:00 Alf, Phone: 477-(Xt I Entered By: DGOLDEN K Aclbn: PIPARTU\L comm€nis: FERMIETER FOOTlilc AND THICKENED FTG AI{D 1 P D PER REVTSED PIAN MTED o+tF(X AS T.IOTED ON PTANS zuILD APPRO\GD SET. Aclbn: PAPARTIALAPPROVA 06/{ 5/04 fnepoclor: C;C,'VV L', ts Conrmont3: 1 Ffl-ASTER FTG FULL OF WA 06/15/fl lmpector: GCD firm€nts: PERMIETER FO( TX}NE. LEAVE rcCESS.qY1ry04 h3pecto{: Arl 0W04/O'f lmpector: e'CD CoflrmcnE: 1 PAD FOR PILASTER.(820/04 ln$eclor: CCD Actbn: Pl PARTIAI INSPECTIf,N Cotnm.nts: CIP STAF 2E} RFEIRUN ROIJGH APPfiOVED. llam: 20 BlDGFouridrtlofl/Sb€l - ApprovEd * 0Fl24l(X. lnr9oclor: An Ac{on: AP APPROVED Cornm€nts: APPRO\/ED STABAT NORTHEAST CORNER OF zulLDlNG O7t15to1 Inspec{or: GCD Actlon: Pt PARTIAL INSPECTPN Comm€nt3: FOUNmnON WALLS & PILASTERS PER REVISED FLAI{S. O&23/O4 h.!.clor: c'c.D Acllon' Pl P RTIAL INSPECTPN Commenls: PAD AND PII..ASTER S SID€,llem: 30 BLDC'-Framho * Aooroved " 06/ilyo4 -lnsDacto{: cdarili Actlon: NR }'tOT READY FoR INSPECTPN CommenE: LETEL 177 RESTRO|T'MS tlOT READY FOR FRATI tNG INSPECTION ELECTRCAL ROT GH II.ISPECTIOilI REOI,,RED AI.ARAM ROUGH AT{D SPRINKTER ROUGH REOUIREDo?llzlod Insp€cior GCD Actlon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTPII Commsnb: FRAT,NG FOR SI.I.Al,lrS OFFEES AREA 155. O7l15l04 In8pedor: GCD Acflon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTpN Comm€nE: FRAMIT,IG FOR WALL A TREATIENT ROOM AIID OFFICE BY WMS LOCKER ROOM. O8/(M/04 hspeclor: GCD Acton: CR CORRECTION REOUIRED Commsnt3i COtttPLETE FIRESTOPHiG N RESTROOiIS. OEVO6/(X h3p€ctor: eD Aclbn: APSRAPPRoVED/CoRRECTPNREOD CoMM€Nb: RRE STOP PENETRATIONS IN RESTROOilIS AT CORRIDoR WALL. HEAD OF WALL IS Commerrt: A.lclt0on l irilomstlofl ts noeded .eorrdho st oho ol6n. To b€ rclrht €d ofi ADril 6, 2(XX O Pl/V. - COAVIS COTNTN€fit: ROUTED TO CHARLIE DAVIS. GEORGE RUII-IER. FRE DEPARTMENT I}'TD P(JBLICWORKS - LS/A IDOVAL BLDG+ln l ,*11ll1\ rlrneExp: - nfrffi*Ltc hPPzorYr?- qry, W_ l4-/ L REPT131 Acllon: APAPPROVED Run fd: 2443 1G11-2004 Inspgqdm Reqqest Page 9 ATl I'.JIT (WATNNG FOR SFECIAL Tt'B) Glrl6/(X Inspedor GCD Actbn: Pl PARTUL INSPECTION Comrn€nb: CELf.lG DROP lN TERRA EISTRO. @23/04 ln$oclo.: c{hvlr Actron' PI PARTIAL lNsPEcTloN Comrnsd8: th|b3o4, 3o6o.k Untb 306 lpFlovod on condiloo to aomPtslo pon*auon pachru d corklcrvrll[sn: 50 BLDGIrrsutsUon n ADororr€d "(HO,U04 lo!o#br: GCD Acilori: Pl PARTIAL hISPECTIO$,| conmet{r;: I]€ULATPN l.f&S CORRDOR WATLS LEVEL 177. Ogl3r(}]l lnspec'lor: ftt Ac0on: AP APPRO\,ED Commc 3: APFRCwED LE\,EL 17? l.lORTH SID€ EXCEPT END t NlT. CORRECTIC,}I REOIIRED: INSULATE AROIJND Wh[)OT'I'S 09/1dt)4 lnspcctor: GCD Ac{on: l,lOtlOTFlED Cornma'{3: PRO\,I[E PICTURE OF INSUIITION IN RESTARAI,NT Item: 60 BlDc€hdodthbn *fuorowd- 06/2904 lr€D€ctor: GCD ' ' Actbn: Pl PARTI L lllSPECTloil Cornmentc: RESTARAUAI.fT AI.ID CORRIDOR 186 G\tr PATCHhIG. 07/06/(X fspector: GCD Fcdon' Pl PARTIAI- INSPECTIOII Comrnnts: GYilCEil-hlGGYP O7l12l0{ lmDecior: GCD Acton: Pl PARTIAL INSPECT|ON Comrnonls: ABb\rE CElllilc PENETRATIOIIIS AFFROVED CORRIDOR t 56 BOTH SID€S OF WALL. o|( TO tl,At{GAt\DFIMSH Ltr}.(E/t1l04 hcD.6.: @D Arfon: PIPARTIAI-INSPECTKIN COMM.| S: RESTROOil GYP AI.ID ABC'\G CEf,It\G FIRETAPE AIIID CA[,LK. 0ry1UO0 lrcp€ciot: Arl Acilon: APAFPRO\rEDCorurtd3: AFPROVED AaOVE CE[-hlG TE].|ANT SEPARATION At€ CruLXhlG FOR UI{TS AT 177 T{ORTH SDE O9/1s(X InrD.dor: @D Actho: RPARTIALIiISPECTIOII Cmmenb: EHU LEVEI t77 3 t NIfS. ltEcH RC'Olr tEvEL i556EtO4 l|lsD€cloc @D Actbn: PIPARTIALINSPECTION COOlmENb: RESTARAT'I'IT CE]LING @l29lo4 lnsD€clor: GCD Acilon: Pl PARTIqL NSPECTIC,N Comm€nb: UMT il16 ftem: 7O BLD@Mbc. lryo7lo4 |rEpacbr: C€D Aclbn: i,lONoTlFlED Comrnonb: TF{S WAS A COURTESY h}SPECTION FOR TCO OF TERRA BISTRO. PttilB|}lG Al.lD ELECTRICALWORK MAYHA\IE BEEN DOT{E w/OPERrfT. 1 "Pl-AItlNhlG F|}IA,I REOD 2.PROVIDE ACCESS TO T NDER BACK BAR FOR PLtff'BI|G. PROVIE AIR G P FOR ICE BINS. 3.COi#LETE EXTERIOR 4.PROV!DE EXn S|GN O DOOR hrro LOAAYhm: g) BLDG'Flrlal It€m: 21 PLAI$ILC Fortrilmon Ptln lbmr 22 PtJAt{-lLC Sll€ Plrnhilr: '5&' PlJlil.TEtt{QF ,i ^ ltlro7,ro4 llqrslor: .G.o0. E|r: BfGIGD Gonnrantg: ILC Foulrcd At 3xt*br tbrk shdl bo complet d (h, pdn0ng, loof, nall m.brb,, clc.) Item: 5&{ PLqN-FIMLC/O Itom: 539 PW-FIMLC/O Item: !i:lz PW-TEMP.CJO "Apso\d"IUOE(X ll|se*br: b " Acdon: APAPPROIED {(V0&tX lmit€.tof: b Acton: CONDAPPROGryCO}|D|TIOI.ISCornnfitr: Aca6s lilo b{rll.k|g !|rd r.rhficnt canml ba Uam. REPT131 Rurr Id: 2443 i R€quesfed lnspect Date: Inspection Area: Slte .&ddress: Thursdav, December 23, 2004cn 352 E MEADOW DR VAIL 352 EAST ITIEAOOW NRNE A,P,D Inf0rmrtlon Acthrftv: Const T1p,6: OlYner: ADDllca nl: Arttrnra: Conl'rc{or: D€rcdpllon: Itfotka: Comm€nt: Btlit0fft3 Tlpe: A-IIF. Occupaircy: VML LLC SHAW COMITRI CTIOI{ COiTIPANY SubTVpe AMFfAe: llA Phone: 9702tl2-92816 Phone: 970-94S1-t)257 Phone: 97G242-9236 StrhB: ISSUED lnrp fuea: CD i, tNc. COMPANY FINAL REiiIOD€L OF iNXED t,SE LODGE & SPAffiS PLANIS D€NIEDSEE FILEptlASS{G PLAN SLrBtrrlTTED AND ROUTED TO CHARLIE DAVIS. GEORGF FUIHER, FIRE AND RIBLIC $rcRKS.CDAVISVlf,)Ffl\S - (]lJAVlb Plannlnq Comments on TCO PhaslPlannlno Comm€nts on TCO Phaslno Plan1 EH(y's muat b€ completed prior to*TCO of anhre bililding (!our one-bedrooms on€ lwo-b.droom = slx 6mploye6s) 2. Faildno nr2. Faftins n€e& to be provHed lf Darldng sfuclure is lo b€ used for stsglm 3._ 4 nswlorid ls requirbd for ALL ln compl€b worft (b lrndlcaplng, gamg|€ door, otc.) In lh. amourt ot 150% Comrnsnt: 4.. GRUTI.IER REVISED ORAWII.IGS RECIEVED 921/04 ROUTED TO CFIARLIE Alro roui€d lo C'eotgs @&O4 ADprol,3d bv Plannlno 7r7,'O4 Slonatlrs on .eyF.d olfica DLr|s - cDAvlS t*r'nrorc hdpcctionr-uill rev{*ldnc lre submlt€d and opixoyed. - cDAvls PLANS ROT}TED TO }K)IJGLAND AND ASSOC. FOF PLN{ REVIEW 65% OF PLAN CF€CK FEE I'ULI BE CHARGEDFOR REVIEW - cDAVtg Comment Comment Comment Addltonal hbnn fbn b n€eded Boardlno staolno plan. To be teviewed on Aprll6. AXX O Pll\r. - CDAVIS common|: RoUTED To CHARLIE DA\4s, GEORGERUIHER, nRE o€PARruENT AND PUBTIC IrcRKS . GRUTHER _ _^,\€D +" _lY1ftr*t!fttrt{ fl- $qrqrys I tr * Reouests{, hsp€cuordsr _-D€$rr'-- b&zSS F4.-.ovtt B*serrnz*tf n"qul fl^f,frIHh%Ncol-(pANy Lf1 Eaguested#:r g9i98iT Asglgned To: CDAVIS Entered By: DGOLD€N KAc0on: Tlm6 ErD: llsm Comm€nts: RESTI{}MNTTENIED.PtJANM{G APPROVAL REOUIRED .ELECTRICAL PERMITAND I}.JSPECTION REOUIRED FOR ADDITIONAL Y1ICRK PERFORIIEDAT THE T€WBAR AREA Itrm Comrn€nt3: 1ERRA BISTRO AFPROVEO FOR rcO. lcrnrurrxJc AA0ftpvtc lledutLil Pltec ic t-rlc,4rg Aft&urtc- Ptol&El- Scttru.rtxJG - FPE ftq*ilw1 /SngULES@ia- Pra&l,aa$ - Exrercrq, usea-sHf,L B€ &oilttFJ, Comm€ntt: 08/2ty04 In3Declor: GCn 1 FAD FOR PILASTER, Inspeclor: GCD Actlrn: PAPARTIAL APPROVAL Actlon. Pl PARTIAL lt'TSPECTtOt'l -,no*ffi-ffi prlr$tl /Aa.n.e. Pens|Ar FrZ -For,g1r.lG F&t,pf,,iERffo /t4oSt FE Co*lAceta) nx0060 Item:20 BLDGFoundaooruSlocl '- Aoorowd -" B24tO4 lnspector: Art Aclbn: AP APPROVED COMMC'{6: APPROVED SLAB AT NORTHEAST CORNER OF BUILDING O7i15lO4 ln0o€clot: GCD Acllon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTIO}I COMTN€Nb: FOUNOANON WALLS & PILASTERS PER REVISED PLANS.(H231(X lnsD.ciot: CiCD Acfroni Pl PARTIiAL ll{SPECnOll COMMENb: PAb ANDPTLAS1ER S SIDE. 1'l|0zmd Insp€dor: C'cD Actlon: CRCORRECTIONREoUIRED Comrnents: STEEL IIOTPER DETAIL 3 S3.1. 11i03()4 Inspeclor: GCD ' Ac{on: PIPAiTIALINSPECTION Comm€nIs: PCDL FOTJI.TDATION WALLS SOUIH SIDE.1lt11lm Inspectcx: GCD Acflon' Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Comment8: llOT TUB WALLS 30 BLDG-Frgmlno * AoDrovrd " 116/30/04 -ln3DectDr: cdodi Aclion: NR NOT READ'r' FC'F INSPFCTION COMM€NIS: TEVEL 177 RES'IROMMS NOT REANY FOR FRAMI}Ki ITISPECTICN ELECIRICAL ROUGH' lMlPECllOf.l REOIJIRED TARAM ROIJGH AND SPRINKLER ROUGH REOUIRED O7l12to4. lnsoectot: GCD Actlon. Pl PARnAL II'ISPECTIoN Comm€nts: FRAMII.E FOR SHAWS OFFICES AREA 155. 07/15/O'f lnsp€clor: GCD Action: PIFARTIALINSPECT]ON CommeNIS: FRAMIhT FOR WAI.L & TREATME}JT ROOT' AND OFFICE BY W|{S LOCKER ROOM tn,tx/o4 lmD,octor: GCD trcllcn cR CORRECTIoN REoUIRED COMTNONIi: CCh'PIETE RRESTOPPING IN RESTROOMS 0go6/0f trisDactor GCD Acllon: APCRAPPRO/ED/CORRECTIONREOD Commenb: FIRE STOP PENETRAI|ONS lN RESTROOMS AT CORRIDOR WALL. HEAD OF WALL lS DONE, LEAVE ACCESS. OgtOO4 lnsDectGr: Art Ac{on: AP APPRoVED COMM6NIS: APFROVEO FFTAMING FOR UNITS AT 177 ]'TOF'TH SIDE EXCEPT EATHROOM IN I'I/EST END UNIT fliAMNG FOR SPECIAL.TUB} 09'16,04 tnspector. GCE\ Actbn: Pl PARTIAL |i'|SP€CTICN CoMMeNt3: CEILING,DROP IN TERFA BISTRC. C€,,23E4 Inslector: cdavls Aciir.in: Pl PARTIAL |NSPECIOII Commeftb: Unltr 304. 306 o.k Unfis 3{15 roorovod on condltlon to complete ln D€ctor: 'GCD Act6n: ( compl€te p€n€trairbn patchlnq at ionldor wall Actkin: CR CORRECI]ON FEAUIREDlmD€clor: 'GC FRAMING FOR Comments, Slablnspsctlon toi epo orr sorfth slde ;i hrllciinE 11/24!M lnsoector: GCD ACJon: Pl PARTIAL Ii{SPECTION'l1tzqtA tnsp€ctor: 3cu Commet{s: SI-AB FOR SPA DECK. 12lc6to{ lrapoclor: GCD Commonli: HOT TUB CAP SLAE. llem: Action: PA PARTIAL APPROVAL FRAfI,ING FOR 186 SUBMIT UL ASSEMBL|ES FCR FIRE I BEING USED. IIUMERo|JS PENETI?AIIONS REOUIRII'.IG InspQclor: GCD LEVLE 177 UNITS 4O7 Acllon: Pl PARTIAL INSPEC LEI/I-E 177 UNiTS 407.409.411,4t3. tN 407 PRE ROCK A80/E DOOR" 10/1.VBl Cotnments: TOIl€Jo4 Cornnet*s: CAULKIl.IG 10/20lfiX lnsprctor: cCD : Ac$on: FIPARTIALINSPECnON Comm€nts: IN UNIT 302 VrtEST BATH GROUT HOLES IN FLOOR AND FIRE STOP AT CORRIDO,R WALT. 1A22lM Inspoctor: GCD Adion: R PARTTAL INSPECIION Comnr€nts: RRNSPECT OF UMT 3t)2 AND IIJSPECTION OF 4O4 392 lS OiILY FOR THE EXlSnt\G. BUMP o|JT AT A LATER DATE. | 1/09(X Incpecior: GcD Actlon: Pl PARTIAL INSP€CTION CoMm€nt!: FIEE STOP GAS PIFE AT FP, A}.ID PLUMB,AT CORFICOR STFAIGHTEN IJP PLUMBG IN MASIER BAT}I LAV ANT1 VENT I1l11to4. lmpeclor: GCD Acllon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Commenti: V\IOMENS LOCKEF ROOM WALLS 11t24l0d Insr€clor: GCD Acllcn: Pl PART'IAL INSPECIION Commentr: BUMP OIJT FOP 3O2. Ui\,lTS 417.419. 12r03'O4 tnsrrecl,or: cdevlo ADtlon: APCRAPPROVEDTCORRECTIONREOD Commenis: Unfts 503.505,509 & 51,| Atl harn same corrsctlon. -FlreDrootlno ot all slruclurtl columns muet be ma.r€. O.K.lo shaetock excepl ln rreas wiere columns are located. A relnsprec{on of flreprcoflrg required 12tO3tO4 Inoi€ctor: cdrvb Adlon: Pl PARTLAL INSPECIION Commontg. O.K b shserock c.llino at 19€ level l2l0&o4 Insp€cloli COAVIS - Action: NR hPT READY FOR INSPECTION Commardr: contocbt not rc6dv tor lh${ction12l13lH Insoectol: GCD Aclk'n: Pl PAR]]AL INSPECTION Comm€nb: UMTS 38. 4O3 AND SOUTH TERRACE APPR FlFlESToPPlliG REA$ INSPECTIoN. 1211404 lrtspoclol: €davB Ail|on. !.fl NOT READY Fffi lNSpECTiOl.l REPT131 Run Id: 2680 "12-Z:M e.z7 pm _ --vAt|._co-=rotilllirE__:-__Comment$: Contractor Stat8d rc ftomlni readv lor lffipecllon reEuest today (Gary Paul Star) 1?i3)/04 lnsoeclor: cdavts - - Acfion':; Pl PAR1AL lNSPECTldll Comtn€nls: Unttrs 303 and 4O3 aDDrovbd D€ndlno €l€ctkal louoh InsD€ctlon -Add wrrD of sfrrtuidt columh in unii 3&3.lbm: 51|) ELDc-hisubtion " Approved "0€/0404 Intpeclon @D' Aclion: Pl PARIIAL INSPECTION Cammenb: TNSULATION N&S CORRIDOR WAILS LEVET 177. 05f13/04 lnrp€ctor: An Actbn: AP APFROVED Comment!: APPROVED LEVEL 177 NORTH SIDE EXCEPT END UNIT. COFRECTION REOUIRED: f NSt LATE AROUND l,(,tNDO,l/S Cy16/04 Inspoclor: GCD Actlon: No I\PTIFIED Comrrrentg: PRbVIDE PICTI,RE OF INSULATION IN RESTARAUNT llcm: 60 BLDC'-Stogdtoc_ f Nall ," Approvad "06/2flM fnsp.clor: cicD '' Aclton: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Commenis: RESTARAUANTANO CORRIDOR 186 GYP PATCHIIG. OTlo€l0d- lffiDector; cCD Actlon: Pl PART1AL INSPECTION Comm€nts: 'Gll/| CEILING GYP O7l12lO4 Inspeclor: GCD Aclbn: Pl PARTIAL INSPECT|OiI Comrnonts: ABbVE CElLlNc P€NETRAI]ONS APPRO/ED CORRIDOR 155 BOTH SIO€S OF WALL. o|( TC' HAIIG AND RMSH LID.I(J FIAF(' ANLI FIN|SFI LII.J. 1 08/11/04 fnrDoc{or: GCD Actlon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECIIO}I COmfl|€Nb: RESTRooi, GYP AND ABOVE,CETLII'IG RRETAPE AND CAULK. 0910/04 Inspeclor: Art Acilon: APAPPROVED Comme nts: APPROVED ABOVE CEILING TENANT SEPARAT]ON AI.IO CAUT.KING FOR UNITS AT 177 09/'l$M InsDeclor: GCD Actbn: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTIOIJCo rncnb: EHULEVEL 1773UNITS. A9i21lO4 lnlD.clon GCD Actlon: Pl PAR]]AL INSP€CTlOil Comrn€nts: RESTAR UNTCEllltlc€8E04 lnloeclor: GCD Action: Pl P RTIAL I|.TSPECTION Comments: UMT 3o5 1913/04 lnsnetlor: GCD Acllon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTIOII coffincnt3: $tlTs3g.30€ 10ft9,O4 larpeclor: cdwb Actlon: Pl PARIAL INSPECIIO f Comm€ntr: Unn 4{}7 onlv|0EO(X lnsoector: bCD Acllon: Pt PARTIAL tNSPECllOll Commerdr: UMTS /m.411.415 1A2Uo4- lrcpeclor: fiun nl3: APPROVI TENIIVG IN UNIT{3TI2 AcUon: Pl PARTLA 1A2Uo4- Intg€dor: Arl Aclbn: APAPPROVED ConUN.nl3: APPROVEO SHEETROCI( FASTENITVG IN UNIT{3TI2ltDlto4 l63p3clor: c'cDComrnf{$ t NlT 4tX 111{XYO4 loep€cior; @D Comman0r: IML 177 CLOSET 'l1tlfl/o!- hop.clof: cCD Comments: utllT 3OB 11124o4 lrcoeclor: GCD Commentr: RESTOFil2. 1zloB1o,/l jl6Dedor: cdrvls ConmenB: Unfts 4'17.419 12lc6lo{. lmpeclor: GCD Acfon: PI PARIAL INSPECTION Comrn€nb: @LUMN \,\RA,P 5(x!,5O5,5G'.5 1 { 12l0go{ Inepoclot: COAVIS Acdon: Pl PARnAt INSPECITON comm€nl3: uMTs 509.511 1zle€t04 lnsp€clol: ccl.vb Acuon: Pt PARnAL NSPECTION Commantr: Units 5ol .5o3 1Z16104 Insp€itori ocD Acdon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTIoN Comments: SI,{AFT ltt ALL CORE BOARD. 12l2WU lncpector: cdivis Acflon: Fl PARTIAi. INSPECIION _C_omrn€ntr: urffs 233265 & ?86(stairwe[) BLDG-Mltc. 1Cv07/04 Inspector: GCD Acfon: NOI.|C)TIFIED CornrnNtr: ,1"IIS WAS A COURTESY II.ISPECIION FOR TCO OF TERRA EISTRO. PLUMBING AND ,ELECTRICAL WORK MAY HA\IE BEEN DONE W/o PERMIT.ilPLANNltlG RiIAL REOD ii 2.PRO/IDE ACCESS TO UNDER BACK BAR FOR ruLN'B|NG. PROVIDE AIR GAP FOR ICE Bll.tS. 3.COI!iPLETE EXTERIOR : Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Acli,on: Pl PARIAL INSPECIIO,N Actbn: PIPARTIAL INSPECTION Actbn: PI PARNAL NSPECTION Acdon: PI PARTIAL INSPECTON li€m. 70 4.PROVIDE EXITSIGN O DOOR INTO LOEBY 12tRlO4 lftloecbr: c6vb Actlon: tlO NOT|RED Comm€nls: Ano$nr couyrt. wrlk thru tor Occupancy Approv.l. Projecl ls In such sn unnnFhod rftat€ th6t lhet€ arc loo lny lcms requiring compl€Uon to fistfbm: 90 BLDG-Flnat REPT131 Run Id: 2660 .t4 22 533 ' It€m: 534 llem: 539 llenr: 532 Item: l|em: llem: It€m: 53O ragtr 4 l 2-PLAr{$flNG. PUBI_t{t WCRKS, ArJ} FIRE REC ArrFl?Cr./A!_ PLAN-ILc Found€lion Plan PLAN-ILC Sile Plar PLAiI'YEMP. eO - Anorov€d -1o!Q7lA lnsp€ctor: Gecrge ' Actlqn: Dl.! DENIED Commenb: ILC requhed All extdrlot worft shall b'e a,mpleted i!E, palnting. Ioo{, \iall maletial, etc., 10 1;'0i lnspeclor. RF Aciidn. AFTAFFF.OVED Comments: ILC prouided on 1Oi:-Exterior tinishes completsd on Resturant BLDG-Temp. c;O'lOlI/04 lnsoector. CDAVIS Aclic'n: DN fENIED Commenls: RESTAUFIANT DENIED .PLANNIT'TG APPROVAL REQUIRED.ELECTRICAL P€RMIT ANg INSPECT]ON REQUITF I) FOR AN[{ TIONAL iJi/'3RK PERFORMED AT TItE NEWBAR AREA.10/1ffM Inspector GCf) Adion: PA PARTIAL APPROVAL Comm€NIs: 1ERRA BISTRO APTJRI.}VED FOR .TCO. PLAN .FINAL C/O PW.FINAL C/o R V-TEUP CJO - ApprDvod * 10,0&'0.1 lnspector: ls Action AP APPROVED l0'O8/04 lnsi)eclot ls Action: CONDAPPROVEDiCOiIOiIONS Commenh: Acae3s into building s d i€-.{urant canncl b€ blocked. REpT.131 F-un Id: 2680 .:F:r Pagc 2O 08/1304 l$spectofi Art A*lon. APAPFROVE0 COMMiNTT: APPRCII/ED LEVEL 177 hPRTH S1DE EXCEPT END UNIT. COFRECTIO}I REOT'IRED: II,SULATE AROT,ND ITVIiIDOUVS tlg/tgo4 In8picior: GCD Acton: NO|IOTIFIED Comm.ntt: PROVIffi FICTURE OF IHTIULA.IION IhI RESTARAU}JTIt m: 60 BLD&Smdoafrhbll --AWowd" 0e2fl04 lnepccbr: GCD -' Acdon: Pl PARnAL lNSPEcl]ON C{mm3n!5: RESTARAUANT AND CORRIDOR 186 GYP PATCHIN€, 07/09{X lmpador: GCD Acilon: Pt PARnAL NSPECT1ON Com.n ntr: OYM CflL[rtS 6YP O?|1AM lffiDrclsl: GCD Actoo: Pl PARTIALIN$PECTION Commenb: ABbVE CElLlttG PEN€TRAION$ APPROVEO CORRIDCR 155 BOTH SIOES OF WALI. o|( TC, t{AtlG ANDFINISII LlD.(Wl l/M lnsDeclol: GCD Acl'cn: R PARTIAL tNSpECTlOfil CoMNrnb: RESTRooII GYP ANO ABOI'/E CEILIi.I(I FIRETAFf AND C.AULK.(Plg(X lnsD{tctor: Arl ' A(Sn: APAPPROVED COMmant3: APPROVED ABOVE CEILIMI TE}IANT SEPARA1ION AND CAULKING FOR UNITS AT 177 81ry04 Comn nb: wr21l04 Comnan6: m/ff!/04 Comrn€rtr: tcvlSvM Commofltr: 10/{904 Commcnb: 10/20/04 C$mmGnti: to2€I/o* Comrnar{a: t1/m/04 Comfiri a: NORIHSIffi InBDeclot: CaCD EHU LEVEL 177 3 UMTS. TIECH ROOIT' LEVEL 156lBp.r,tlr: GCD RESTARAUNTCEILII.IG lmoector: GCD lJhllT 305 Insfrector: 6CD tr${TS 30,1.306. lngo€clDr: cdcvlt LJnit 407 onlvln$€ciDr: 'Gctr IJI$T6 409,411 .4t $ Acton: Pl PAFnAL lt'l$P€C'notl Aclion: Pl PARnAL NSlt€CTlON Acuon: PI PARNAL NSPEC.TION Actioni Pl PARTTAL 'NSPCCTIOil I'rrFecIoT: Ail ,Actbn: AE APfROVED APPROVED SHEETROCX FASTEltlf(G f,l,tJtlllT t:FAInroector GCD Acrbnl'fr PARtht INSpECTION UMT/104 Action: Pl PARnAt INSPECIION Ac{on: Pl PARTIA- INSPECilON fbm: 70 GcD . Acton; NONOTIFIED I j A COJRIESY IHSF€CllON FOR TCO OF TERRA BISTRO. PLUMBINO AND I'\{,fiK MAY I.IAi/E BEET.I DONE WO PERIIIT. : ; FINAI REOD ACCESE TO.UND€R BACK BAR FOR PLUMBIAIG. PROVIEE AIR GAP Fd |cE lERIOR $rGN @DOOR TryTOLOBBY Cdalrh Acdon: NOI^|OT|FIEDi lbm: 90 BLO6'Rn0I t 1/O9/O4 lnsp€ctor: GCD Co'nrmo o: LEVEI, 17?CI.OSET 11/18yO4 Commeila: 11t21t0{ Commcdtr:rzo304 Comrnanlr: r?/0gt)4 Comnrnb: 12/0S04 Comnrants: l2!Ulto{. Commonbi t?/'t6/04 Commenb: 1A2WA4 Com|mnb: BLOSMI$G. ln s'€dofi GCD LhTT 3OB lrEpactor: cCD Acllon: Pl PARII,AL fNSPECnObt RESTOF 3O2.hEpictQt: cdevb Actlon: Fl PARTIAL INSP€CTION Uftlc 417.{tglrllssctori GCD Airion: Pl PARnAL NSpECTI()N CCIUrttfit 1r1/RAP 503,50t"60S,5t thcpedor: CDAVIS Actlon: pl PARntL ll{SPECnON UMTS 5{F.S1 1 Ineoorlsr: cthvb Aclion: Pl pARnAt INSFECTIOIi unlh 6d1.6ei Incp€ctor: GCD Acdon: Pl PARTIAL lNstPECnOf.t SI,TAFT WALL CORE BOARD- Inrpcctgr: cdavh Ac'tion: Pl PARTIAI" INSPECTIOf'I un|b 233265 & ?66{BraF$nllr couvtt. srlk thru ior Occupency Approval. Protscl b In such an ordlnlsh'€d sttta lhlt thera nanY ibrm reouirlm cornDlrtbn t(i r|f.re loo mny ibrtt| requidng coflpnbh $ f ii'I!j"r' i..i r* f i:.,! .r, ic rr t I 1(y07/04 Comnranb: {li TII;l ,Ht" REpt131 .lt{,* Run Id: 2660 r" fhm: 21 Pttt\,,'lLC Foundd],on Plantt m: 22 FllN-lLC Slur,Phr.Itm. 533 PI,AN"TEMP.CrO. "ADDrowd'" lOlOTlfJ4 ltrsp€ctof: C'eotqo ' Acthon: DN D€f J|ED Conm6nb; {LC rrqul$d All crrrirlor work siull b€ compFred tl€, palntlng. roof, wall m€i€rial. elc.) 1O13/O4 lffiDoctor: RF Acflrtr': AfAPpR0VEC, Comnrant$: ILC provtdec on lot2-Exbrbr ftnkhe* complets.,l on Flisturanlitrm: 530 BLDfr-T.mp. CiO. 1$11lo{. InsDcctof CDAVlg Acll*n: D|\IOENIED CommenB: RESTAURAi.IT DENIED -PLANNING APPROVAL REAUIRED -ELECTRICAT PERM'T AND INSFECNOf.{ REOUIRED FOR ADI{NO}IAL \^JORK PERFORMED ftrm: tlrm: lbm: ATTHE NEWEAR ANEA 10/15/04 Inspoctor: GCO Aclhn; PAF.!,RTIALAPPROVAI Commetb: IERRA BISTRO APPROVED FOR CO. s34 PLAN - FI{AL C/O 539 PVi'.Rh,tALC/o 532 fl,lr-TEMF CiO '- ApDrovod "' lO'0&tX lmoecbr: l$ . Actlrn. AF APPROVEII Ity0&'04 lmbrdor: h Ac[on; CoNBAPPRjS/EDicoNolncNs Comn€nb: Acc€r$ mo buildlng and rs!{urrnl c.nnol bo Usck€d. r' + , t l''.il i t,r'1 t ' ; r '1 t ,\ ;;' ' REPTl31 1t. j: Run fd: 264CI Fage 25 Rcquest€d Insp+:t Oate:' hspectlon A'ee' Slte r.ddress: ArP,D lnformsflon Acttuftv: M04-0t84 Tvoe: FMECH Cottst Typ€: 3ccupah'cy' Own€r. VML LLC AFplicant. mlsco FIREPLACE E sToVE sHOp '3c nlractor FRISCO flREPLACE 8 STOVE SHOP Descrlpllon: tNSTAt L 2 GAS FIREPLACES Ccminent ilrc PLAiI REVIEWPEFFORMEO " CDAVIS Reouested Inspectlon[s]Frruttc ?00 ilECHfrnnsF FRISCO FIREBLACE 8 STOVE SHCIP Thursdav, lle.:efi'ber 23. ?0n.1 CD 352 E MEADOY', DR VAIL 35? E TYIEADOWDR Phone: 97S6@3760 Plr,rne. 970-668-1i760 Item: Requestor. Asslgned To:- Actlon: tt€ft Comments: nom Comfirnts: tt3mComn€ffi: ttBm Comrn€nb: Requested Time: 08:00 Altf' Fhone: 970-664-37€0 Enter€d Bf DGOLOEII KCDAVIST r Iiqle EIP:!bs.:oc; rNsrALL' wAlfT:lREsToP 3sr t N|TS 407,409,41 1 .^r15.505, AND 607. 404 REOg WALL FTRESICP. uNrTs 417319.509,511 unit3 @7,6t)9.61 |.51 3.6 Teo,r'urutrIll'wl lnspcction Historv Item: llem: It€m: ll€m: nem: It€m: teeiolLED l{1?,:}0fib5.306 INSTALL WALL FIRFSTCD 1f?oiXC$ Action: Pl PARTTAL INSPECTIOI'J 407.llC9.41 1 .415.505. ANO 6i)7. ^O4 REOS WALL FIRESTCP.or: GCD Ac8on: Pl PART]AL ll.lSPECTiON 310 MECF$Fleatino 315 PLMFGa$ Pldlnn 32O MECH-ExharfotHoods 33O MECH-Supolv Alr 34o MECI-.{-Mlac ' 39O i,lEcl-l-Fln6l Cor$rnafits: 10i 13/04 Comrn€nt3: 11i24t0l C.omm€nts:mm€nts: UMTS 417,419,501 12118!04 Inspec'tor: cdavle mm€ntB: Unlts 607.609.611. 4t 7.4t9,509,51 | Comm€ntB: Unlts 607.609,61 1,613.615 Action: Pl PARTIAL INSP€CTIOi'J Action: PA PARTIAL APPRO'I,'AL Status: ISSUED Insp Araa: CD REPT131 Run Id: 2680 Correction List for Phased Occupanry of the Vail Mountain Lodge Date: 1211512004 Project: Vail Mountain Lodge Permit # 804-0033 Location: 252E. Meadow Dr. Vail, Co. Contractor: Shaw Construction Listed below are corrections required to be addressed in plan and written format for the submitted phased occupancy plan of the Vail Mountain Lodge. Sheet A2.1 1) Work is proposed to continue on the building exterior. All exterior work shall be complete prior to any occupanry approval. Excluded form this requirement is the east elevation located next to the Terra Bistro restaurant. 2) Show how work being proposed on east elevation is to be accomplished without interfering with the means of egress system for the restaurant' Is propane fuel and heating being used here? If so, show quantities of propane tanks, location of heaters, how propane will secured, delivered and stored. Also show how materials are to be delivered to this area without affecting the Town of Vail's Right-of Way. 3) South elevation. All exterior work shall be complete in this area. Show exit discharge that is free and clear and maintained free of ice and snow to the public way. All scaffolding, construction materials, trash and debris shall be removed and exit discharge established prior to occupancy approval. Provide letter of agreement from the management staff that the exit discharge will be maintained at all times. Some type of exit lighting is also required in this location. Sheet A2.2 1) Work is proposed to continue on the building exterior. Building o<terior shall be complete prior to occupancy approval. It appears that high work is also proposed. This work shall be complete prior to occupancy approval. Sheet L1.1 1) South elevation. Show exit discharge for south elevation to the public way. 2) West elevation. Exit discharge located at west elevation appears to be less than 5' in width. This exit discharge serves separate buildings. (Vail Mountain Lodge & Mountain Haus). Exit discharge shall be a minimum of B'in width to serve occupant loads from both buildings and provide enough clearance for maintenance. Provide agreement from management staff that this exit discharge will be mainbined at all times. 3) East elevation. Exit discharge to the east does not have clear access to the public way. As shown, the exit discharge is interrupted by construction activity and construction fencing. Construction fencing shall be located on the Vail Mountain Lodge property. It appears the proposed construction fence is located beyond the property line. Sheet A0.2 1) Show in clarity, complete path of egress through the building including path of travel and where all areas have access to two means of egress. Include the exit discharge to the public way. 2) Access to exit discharge not shown for two means of egress for level 155. 3) General comment. All exit components shall be shown, Include exit illumination, exit identification and maintained free of construction elements during interior construction. Show this in plan view and written format. Sheet A0.3 1) Show in clarity, complete path of egress through the building including path of travel and where all areas have access to two means of egress. Include the exit discharge to the public way. 2) Access to exit discharge from second exit not shown. Please note that this correction has been noted on previous field inspections. This item shall be addressed immediately or loss occupancy on this level (spa/health club) may occur. 3) Construction access is proposed from west stair tower. What is the plan here? Show how the exit enclosure will be maintained free and clear of construction activity while building is occupied by the general public. The recent past has shown that the control ofthese spaces is beyond the capacity of the General Contractor. Provide in clarity, a written agreement of how this is proposed to be achieved once occupancy has been granted. Sheet A0.4 1) Show in clarity, complete path of egress through the building including path of travel and where all areas have access to two means of egress. 2) Construction access is proposed from west stair tower. What is the plan here? Show how the exit enclosure will be maintained free and clear of construction activity while building is occupied by the general public. The recent past has shown that the control of these spaces is beyond the capacity of the General Contractor. Provide in clarity, a written agreement of how this is proposed to be achieved once occupancy has been granted. 3) General comment. All exit components shall be shown. Include exit illumination, exit identification and maintained free of construction elements during interior construction. Show this in plan view and written format. Sheet AO.5 1) Show in clarity, complete path of egress through the building including path of travel and where all areas have access to two means of egress. 2) General comment. All exit components shall be shown. Include exit illumination, exit identification and maintained free of construction elements during interior construction. Show this in plan view and written format. The plan review for this phased occupancy has been discontinued due to lack of clarity shown on plans or in written format. Please review the listed corrections and apply them to all areas of the revised plan. Provide additional information as to how construction activity will be performed and where materials will be staged. Be aware that the Public Works Department and the Planning Departrnent Temporary Certificate of Occupancy C|CO) approval shall be obtained prior to requesting an inspection approral from the Fire and Building Depaftnents, Prior to requesting a TCO inspection from the Fire Depaftment, all alarm certificationE testing and sprinkler ceftification and testing must be complete. The Fire and Building Departments may coordinate their inspection at the same time. Plan review performed by, Charlie Davis Chief Building Official Town of Vail Requested Inspect Date: lnsoecdon Area: Stte Address: Wednesday, January 19, 2005 CD 352 E MEADOW DR VAIL 35? E iIEADOWDR AIEfD Inlbrmafror ,_ Acwltf lO+O184 Cons!Typ6: Aoolbant: Coirbaclor: Otwier: ApplEqnt: VML LLC FRISCO FRTSCO INSTALI. AMF Sffi.|s: ln:p Area: SFOP Phone: 97$60&37fl) Phone: 970.€6&3760 Descdrdon: Cominerrt: Feo$€bil lnso€ctorilrl T{OPLAN -CDAVI pv.tt * Cofimcnts: units3{X}.4}3o*bT$,If,: cDAvrs Requested Tlme: 08:00 Aif' Phone: 477&11 EnleredBy: DGOTDEN K Tlme ErF 3 (L b Insoecton HlsbrY 310 315 340&rt34)sn ' lbm: lbm: lbm: lbm: tlem: llem: Yl ? lbm: 3t1{F88.![rc-- Eequestor: FRISCO-FIEEPLACE & STOVE SFIOP LwAO lbm: 2o0 t{E*FgWl}lHt'a4w lnapofior: (ni Comrn ntD: LTNITS 302.304 l(}/13/O4 lnroector: G€lO13,O4 lnroector: GCD Actbn: PIPARIAINSPECTION Conrm€ntB; IJMTS 4()7.,{19,41I ,415,506, AND 607. 404 REOS VIALL RRESTOP.'11i?$04 lnsDocbr: @D Actbn: PIPARnALI.|SPECIIONll;ZilllO{ Inspocbr: @D Coflmonc; lJlllTS 41 7.419,5Gr.51 | Actbn: Pl PARIAL I.ISP€CTION Actlon: PA PARTIAL APPROVAL InsD€cior: CDAVIS Acdon: DN DENIED UilTS Ol-l 177 LEVEL€lfiER t{O ACCESS O{JE TO F[TRMTURE lN THE WAY OR TERMII.I TION CAPS t{CrT I}.TSTALLED REINSPECTON REOT.IREDIngpedor GCD Acllon: PA PARNAT APPROVAL LEVELS I 77 AND 186 FIREPI-ACES FINAIED. EXECP/T 3(}3 AND 4O3 IP ROtJGH. ISSUED CD llrce: SIiGCH occupoity: & STOVE SFIOP 59,56 t-lob 1?/''€/n, Commanb: 01/O.lJtl5 Comments: REE4r131 Run Id: 2767 ffi-tnspe*ionnequesin-eporting - - ---Fru;T 4'?9 pm _ ' vAtL. co _ TowN bF - Reguested lnspect Oate: Wednesday, January 19, 2005 Inspectlon Area: CD Site Address: 352 E MEADoW DR VAIL .A/P,D lnformatlon Aclhdv: M04-0O75 TvDe: SMECH Const Typ*: Occupahty: O,vrier: VML LLC ADgIIcant D AGOSNNO MECHANICAL CONIRACTORS Cohlractor: D AGOSTII\F MECHANTCAL CONTRAC TOR S SubTg,fie: AC0M Phone: 913-3845170 Phone: 91$3845170 gtatus: tS9r-rED Insp Area: CD Reguested Tlme: 08:00 AM- Phone: 9491747 Enlered By: DGOTDEN K D€scrir{ion: remodel €rislino f'otrl rooms Cominent Roulecl to Charfie Oavts ?Le++filFA(LL ieouesterrnsoecrion(s) Hf?T|fI-L- fiPp2u,@Item: 390 MEeH-Flnsl Requ€stoi: D AGOSTINO MECHANICAL CONTRACTORS Assioned To: CDAVIS- Astion: Time ExD: Itern Comm€nts: FOFRFITUFI NT o]'JLY BALANCE REPORT CoMPLETE ANO \MLL BE SUBMITTEO 1O12i0.1 InsDecUon Historv Item: 20O MECH-Rouohf,J[X,B]Pn*o"*o, cc;D8.|(X/04 lmpectof GCD Actlon: CR CORRECTTON REOUIRED Commenls: 1.NO EXHAUST I TOTLET CCTIPARTMENT \ rOMEl',S. 2.FINISH JOINT AT SUPPLY MENS, 3.SUPPORT DINT PER EODE 18aa MIN WREInspector GCD -Action: AP APPROVED ITEMS FROII.I O&O+04 APPRCVED. EXMUST TIOT SHOW! OI'I PLANS, Inspectof' GCD Actlon: Pl PARTIAT INSPECnON LEVEL I77 EATH EXHAUST. OSA A}JD DRYER DUCT UNITS 302,3{X.3O5,306.a)7.3O8.3O9,31 I. HAVE ENG REVIEW SHAFT FOR EXHAUST E1LICT AI;D FIRE DAMPERS DUE TO SHFTBElr.fc NON COFfiNOUS BETWEEN nOORs Inspoclor: cdavls Acllon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECIO}I R€hrrn alr duct work at the oflices Musi stlll lnsbll flro damo€rs and oressul€ tesl retrlo€ratlon lines lnsp€ctor: An Acuorr: NO NdftFtED INSPECNON CAIVCELLED BY COT-ITP}CTOR Inspector: GCD Acllon: CR COFRECnON REOIJIRED UMT iA4 REOS EXHAUST qT TJ8. DRYER DUCT HAS 7 9OS R€OS BOOSTER F 1I'! lnspector: GCD Acllon: Pl PART]AL INSPECTION OSA AND BATH EXHAUST d07..OS.4't 1.413..{15.InsDeclor GCD Aclion: Pl PARIAL INSPECI1ON CORRECTIONS FOR LII.JIT 404 APPROVEO- 3O8 BATH EXIdA.USTAND DRYEF DI,ICT APPROVED MASTER BATH NOT EIONE, EXHAUST AND OSA FCR 505,509.41 7.419.lnsp€clor cdovls Aclion. Pl PARTIAL II,ISPECION B€th fan exhaGl un{l 308 ontv Insp€clor; @D Aclion. -, "ApttAL 'IISPECTCI'IUMT 51 I BATH EXHAUSTAND OSA,Insp€ctor: GCD Acllon: Pl PART1AL INSPECTION FIRE/SMOKE OAMPERS AT LEVEL 177 AND BRANCH LII.IES 186 CEILING. F'S DA.MPEP RESTAMUI..IT REruRN AIR FOR EXPANSION, 08/06104 Comments: 09108/04 Commenb: 09123104 Comments: #1.28/M Comnnnls: 10/13/04 Commsnts: 10/13',O4 C omment!: 11t02io4 Comments: t i,otroa Comments: 11'17.tD4 Comrnenls: 11nAtO4 Comm€nB: 12t13i04 REPT131 Inspeclor: GCD AcUon: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Drrrr T/{ - )1 t:1 1?t1 Comtn.ils: 12t16t0/. Commcils: 12!20o/ CommenL:otfld(F conmenb: lbm 3'lo LEVEL 2t7 UNIST 7O1,7M f/ECH-tb.Uno PUIBG.!Pldho MEcfF€xltrfu lloodr MECl.l-SupCyAfs/r/U04'lnrpector: C'CD Actbn: PAPARnALAPPRoVAL CoflUnents: I.IEW SUPPLY AIR EI{JCT FOf, RESTARAUNTIIECH-filhc. - Approued " U*23,O4 lrpocfor: cdavb Aclbn: l.lO i.lOTlFlED comm€nE: Rsvleuaed lack ot thatt encbsufe lor gxhautn ducls. wll app|o\r€ llse ol cbss ll 1r|nol(e'fltE ormpers at every tlhr and root pamllatlicn and comphte itanttoon Ftch thtbugh lbor. Englnaer of record shan revl€s and oDDrolle oroDosal. InsD6cllon f3$df€d 0f'27o4 lneooctor: GcD hcdon: CR DORRECflON REot RED Comm.nB: REFRIGER nON PRESSURE TEST lS RE@ TO BE PER 9? Lrlrc SEC I l?2 AND TABLE 1 1- D BASED ON TYPE OF REFRIGERAT.IT USEO. 1O/Oll04- Inrpeclor: GcD Ac0on: APAPPROVED Commedr: rc'LNE SET PRESSURE TEST 380gc1l(ylso4 trEpcctor: cdrvl3 Acton: l.tOi.lOTlFlED Commentr: t-laid wrtlltEn balancs ropod r€c€fvsd for tho mohcsnkal slFiem Includes adtilons h taltuatanl MECtI-Flnal{O11O'l lmpecto{: CDAVIS Action: PAPARI]ALAPPRoVAL Comm.ntB: RIF RESTAURAIi'T Oln-Y BAIAI.ICE REPORTCOMPLETE ANO WILL BE SUEII|ITTED 1U12I0d 12t22im Ins9.cior: GCD Acton: Pl PARTIAI lNsPEcnQN comrmnB: LE(G1 177302.C!4.308.UMT3{t6FANl.tOTurORKlllG.LEVELlS6tf.llTs4}7,4tr.4fi, Item: 3S) Item 3lOlbm: 315lbm: 320 l!.rn: :!iX) REPT131 Run Id: 2767 Y 01-1&2$5 lmpgq{on Rqqc{ lhru 3lo- - llnr 315^f hil* saot lbn: :KXt 3rO 3gt FCI+ifirc.B:lA0.lcofimann 6,tiITt0/Co|tlt|r6l t(y04/04Coiltr|[: 1|}1 CormdSl-" llECtl-Flnal 1O11O.lCofim.il$ lztluwr1Connrrtr: fi v"tt I C? r\o3 RECID IJSED. A.ilon: APAPPROVED lzliltyo4 InrD.frr: cdryh trlon: F{ PARTIAL h}SpECnONCoilrt|rt: tffi S &(}3 b.$ odnrrt.qrd Erll|b|l rYrbmrOlffiffi lttscloc OCD AEdon: PIPARTI LIISPECnO}ICmmilr: LEt EL A)? (AITS f,,7.qp.6r1.6ts.613. LEVEL 217 1t'l3T 7U1,7{n -Afroridr' Imocclor: cddl Aclon: l,lO NOIIFIED Rairrrurd hct ol ||Efi .nch'src frt .rhrfr dudr. lul aF(lnF.rr |l .nry lfior and rcof prnrtalbn cnd co||p|rb p 0t nip|d rhnlltd.w and epero|| plolrotcl.-l0eqiugll4[ ?\.E$ze") Roa u|. of Cbc Ismft./tlle Fbh |htorlgh [oot. Etrgtutcct SEC ItU AM)TABTE tI. aotlog.4rr.'{., REPT131 Run fd: 2767 TOWNOFVAIL 75 S.FRONTAGEROAD VAIL, CO 81657 970-479-2138 Job Address: Location.....: Parcel No...: Project No : 352 EMEADOW DRVAIL 352 EMEADOWDR 210108255001 "PTi36(-6 t1 DEPARTMENT OF COMMI.]NITY DEVELOPMENT NOTE: THIS PERMIT MUST BE POSTED ON JOBSITE AT ALL TMES MECHANICALPERMIT Permit #:M04-0184 OWNER VAIIJ \-TJ 81,657 License; CONTRACTOR FRISCO FIREPLACE & STOVE P O BOX l_330 FRTSCO, CO 80443 I-,icense: 101-M APPLICANT FRISCO FIREPLACE & STOVE P O BOX 1-330 FRTSCO, CO I0443 I-,icense: l-01--M Desciption: INSTALL 2 GAS FIREPLACES Valuation: $56.157.00 Fireplace Informalion: Resrictod: Y # ofGas Appliances: 0 Status . . Applied. Issued . Expires . 09/15/2004 Phone: SHO09 /L5/2004 Phone: 970-668-3760 SHO09/15/2004 Phone: 970-658-3760 # of Gas tngs: 0 # of Wood Pella: 0 FEE SI'MMARY S0 - 00 Total Calculated Fe€s--> S0. 00 Additional Fees-------> S1,428.00 Total P 't Fee-------> Payments-----------> BAI-ANCE DUE-.-....> .: ISSUED .: 0911512004.: 0912112004.: 03120/2005 Mechmical--> Plan Check--> Investigation-> Will Call----> 51,428.00 s0.00 s1, 428 . 00 s1,428.00 s0. 00 51, 140 . 00 R€stuarant Plan Review-.> S28s.00 DRBFee------------> s0. 00 ToTAL FEES----:--> $3.00 IEem:O5].OO BUILDING DEPARTMM{T 09/2t/2004 cdavis Action: AP SUB'JECT TO FIEI-,D INSPECTION Itsem: 05500 FIRE DEPARTMEXIT CONDITION OF APPROVAL Cond:12 (BI-,DG. ) : FIELD INSPECTIONS ARE REQUIRED TO CHECK FOR CODE COMPLIANCE. Cond:25 (BLDG. ) : GAS APPI,IAI{CES SHALL BE VENTED ACCORD]NG TO CHAPTER 8 AND SHALL TERMINATE AS SPECIFIED IN SEC.8O6 OF THE 1997 UMC, OR C}IAPTER 8 OF THE ]-997 IMC. DECLARATIONS I hereby acknowledge that I have read this application, filled out in fulI tbe information required, completed an accurate plot plan, and state that all the infonnation as required is correct. I agree to comply with the information and plot plan, to comply with all Town ordinanc€s and state laws, and to build this structure according to the towns zoning and subdivision codes, desigr review approved, Uniform Building Code and other ordinanc€s of the Town applicable thereto. REQUESTS FOR INSPECTION SHALL BE MADE TWENTY-FOIJR HOURS IN ADVANCE BY OR AT OUR OFFICE FROM 8:00 AM - 4 PM. *+{'{'********l't**++*'}****tt*t*+f*+t+***t**f,******l**a***ri*+**t*+*********************+++**l* TOWN OF VAIL, COIORADOCopy Reprinted on Ur-21-2O04 rt 11:35:25 09/2r/2004 StateNnent *i****************+*l+****++***t*****t**********+*******+a+******ii*********'t+*+*++********* $1,428.00 09/L5/200402227 PrIInit: JSNotation: +29930/FRISCO StaEenenE Nruriber: R040006653 Amount: PalmenC MeBhod: Check FIREPLACE Permit No: Parcel No: Site Address : Location: This Pa)ment,: MP 00100003111100 PF 00100003112300 wc 00100003112800 I.{04-0184 t!pe: MECHANICAL PERMIT 2101082ss001 352 E MEADOW DR VAII, 352 E MEADOW DR Tota1 Fees: $1,428.00 TOTA1 ALIJ FINIS: Balance : MECHANICAI, PERMIT FEES PIJAN CHECK FEES WILL CALL INSPECTION FEE s1, 428.00 $1, 428.00 $0.00**+ft{'******+*tt**i**+**t*++***ff****+f*t***+t*{'+t*****+++***************i'**********l******* ACCOI,]NT ITEM LIST: Account Code Descripti.on Current Pmts 1, 140.00 285.00 3.00 APPTICATION WILL NOT BE ACCEPTED IF INCOMPTETE OR UNSI Building Permit #: Mechanical Permit #: (-6cv -00 75 S, Frontage Rd. Vail, Colorado 81657 dff!roruUry 151''"0 a Equipment Cut/Spec Sheets _.,V Jror o8= sgoo / ..---- _ -) 97 O- 47 9-2L49 (Inspections) Permit will not be accepted without the following: ConAd Asesrc Office at 97O-328-8640 or visit wvvw.Parcel robName: 5,#;fi:,m|'u Job Address: 3€2 E, /ne*AOd .bEry€ Legal Description ll Lot:- ll etoct: - ll riting:Subdivision: - owners Name: yhl L il?rN ub6€ ll Address: 1sz tr rla4 oa prvglFffi Engineer:Address:Phone: -Detailed description of work: /aawzL 6r'tE fit4t/v/*5 WorkClass: New( ) Addition( ) Atterarion(\J Repair( ) Other( ) Boiler Location: Interior ( ) Exterior ( ) Other( )Does an EHU exist at this location: Yes ( ) No ( ) TypeofB|dg:Sing|e-family()Dup|ex()Mu|ti-fami|yffirant()other() No. of Existing Dwelling Units in this building:No. of Accommodation Units in this buildino: No/Tvpe of Fireplaces Existing: Gas Appliances ( ) Gas Loos ( ) Wood/Pellet ( ) Wood Burninq ( Noffype of Fireplaces Proposed: Gas Appliances (z' ) cas Logs ( ) Wood/Pellet ( ) Wood Eurning (NOT ALLOWED) Is this a conversion from a wood burning fireplace to an EpA phase II device? yes ( ) No ( ) CoMPLETE VALUATION FOR MECHANICAL PERMIT (labor & Materiats) MECHANTGAL: $ 5b , /t7, tr? Mechan ical C-ontractor:Iitt s c ct Town of Vail Reg. No.:Contact and Phone #'s: qrO fu411/ol tttr{Lta€A (e t - S I6a Contractor Signature: Y fut A <-t.[t^ {- * * ***** **** ** *** ***** xxx FOR OFFICE USE ONLy***** *******x**** ************ Aceoted Bv: F:,/ everyone/forms/ mechperm f*D €<y,'a{ 10-11-2004 6:39 am Inspection Request Reportlng vAlL, co -rowN oF Requested InspectDate: Motrday, Octobet 11, 2004 Inspection Area; CD Site Address, 35? E MEADOW DR vAlL Page 15 A/P/D Informatis Acttvity: Mt)4-tD75 Type: BMECH Consl Tyyr. Occupancy.O*ner: VML LLC Applicanl: D AGOSTII{O MECFI,ANCAL CONTRACTORS CoNIrAcloI: D AGOSTINO MECHANICAL CONTRACTORS subTtpe AcoM Phon€: 91338+5170 Phona: 913-384-5170 Stotus; ISSUED Insp Area: CD JHTI. HflsHjlfJs"**-T".^"*ett fseT\rL,l\pWu*'*ffi*";no, { ( D asr-e'4l*r*.P# l,K * Rsquestor.-Q.AOOSTINo tr{ECFlqll|cAL CONTRACTORS Phone: 417-Mr1 Asstgn€d To: cDAtilF Ent€r€d By: DGOLDEN \ Actton: Tirn€ Exp: *Effi MF,,/ / - tu/tc 6E ffiil /o////oq Inspectlon Hlstorv nem: 2m MECH-Rouqh " ADDroved " O8/O4/D{ tnsD€c.tor: GCD' Action' CR CORRECTION REOUIREO COMMENTS: 1 TIO EXHAUST 1 TOILET COMPARTMFNT WOMFNS ?.FINISH JOINT AT SUPPI..Y MENS. 3.SUPPORT DUCT PER CODE 18OE MIN WIRE. lnsDector: GCD lctron: AP APPROVED ITEMS FROM 08,04.04 APPROVEO. EXHAUST NOT SHOWN ON PLAI.JS. Insp€ctor: cCD Action: Pl PARTI,AL IN$PECTION LEVEL 177 BATH EXHAUST. OSA AI{D DRYEF DUCT UNITS 3O2,3Od.3O8,3O6,3O7.3O8.3O9,3T 1 HAVE ENG REVIEW SHAFT FOR EXHAUST DUCT AND FIRE DAMP€FIS DUE TO SHFT BEING NON COI.ITINOIJS B€TWEEN FLOORS, 0€v23/O4 Insp€clor: cdavts Aciton: Pl PARTI,AL INSPECTNSN Comments: REfurn air drrct lrrrk at the o{fices Must still lnstalt Rre damoeIs rnd oressure tesl r€trlqeratlon tlnes Dgl?an4 Inspector: Arl Actlon: No tq6rtFtrD Commenls: IiISPECTION CANCELLED BY CONTRACTOR 31O MECH-H€atina 315 PLM&Gas PlFing 3?O MECH-Exhausl Hoods 330 MECH-Supplv Alt ffil14td4 'lnspeclor: GCD Action. PA PART]AL APPROVAL Comments. NEW SUPPLY AIR OUCT FOR RESTARAUNT ft6m: 34O MECH-Mlsc. " Approved " 09l23i0d Inspec{or: cdavii Action: llO flOTlFlEO Comm€nts: Revi€wed lack o{ sha{l emlosur€ for ertEusl ducls. Witl approv€ us€ o{ class ll smoft€/tire damPefs at every fllo{ and rool p€nelrauon End compl€l€ p€ntratroo patch through noo{. Engine€r of record shall reviow and aDorove proDosal. lnspecllon requlred O9i27t0{ Inspeclor: GCD' ' Aclion. CR CORREC.TIOI'I REOUIRED Comments: REFREERATIONPRESSURETESTISFEODTOBEPEF9TUMCSECll2?ANDTABLEll- D BASED ON TYPE CF REFRIGERANT USED. 08/06Jtx Commsnts: 0e/u&04 Comm€nts: llem: nem: nem: It€m: REPTl31 Run Id: 2443 10-11-2004 6:39 am Inspection History ttem: 210 Inspection Request Reporting- ItAlL, CO.Tolrlfl{ OF Page 19 Ac[on: Tlm€ ExD: IIem Commenls: DIIW-AND.RISE,RS SERVING PRbVATFF*IFENCE ON 3rd FLOOR AT EAST END. WATER COLUMN TEST. ttem Comm€nts: GRID 2 THRU 7 NORTI.I SIDE WATER COLUMN TEST. tt€M COMM€NIS: LEVEL 177 ADA RESTOOIUS VENTING UNDER WATER COLUMN TEST Item Comm€nts;DWV WATER COLUMN TEST.2nd FLOOR 186 NORTH FROM 2 LINE TO 5 LINE. CHECK FO Item: 220 PLMB-RoushrD.v{.v. RegrEsror: D AGOSTINO MECHANTCAL CONTRACTORS Assigned To: JMONDRAGON Requested Time: 08:00 Al$ Phone:949-1747 Entered Bv: DGOLDEN K 'ffazllHz'j+-**'BtsDft U../'.vlL b '/rPPe*oP bt+Wtc)en4ry (/ STUDOR VENTS ON LAVS- nem commentr: GRID LINE ? THRU 7 SOUTH slDE CORRIDOR VETJT t)tJ LEVEL 177. WASTE ON LEVEL 186 }tem Commenls: DISCUSSED TESTING OF VENTS FOR 2nd FLOOR .I€6 OK TO NOT TEST Item Comments: 2 BATH GROUPS ON LEVELS 155,165 WATER COLUMN TEST. BATI.I GROUP 3O8P WATER COLUMN TEST- Nem Comments: WASTE FOR LEVEL 195 AND VENT FOR 186 VVATE€ COLUMN TE$ - pL.-rrrrtAv.IG _ Iwlc-l o6t2ga4 Comm€nls: o7l13/04 Dr/vv 4 RESTA Actio, TH ADA RESTROOMS.GCD Acton: Pl PARTIAI INSPECTIoN N BATHROOMS AND KITCHFN t)WV W'ATER COLl,|MN O8124,O4 Insp€clor: qd/dda Actron Pl PARTIAL INSPEC TfON Comments Leiel 185 gaE maii *rlCed hps & g6splp,e to b€ll vat\re. no g€s Frip€ to untts tesled Used a PLD t€ster and soap, under sncherwater column presstlfe. 7 tap€ t-e6ted 09/30104 lnsp€ctor: Art ArUrn: AP APPROVED COMM€NIS: APPROVED Dl,lrd ON LEVEL 165 GRID 11 :' 'I? UNIT'263 APPROVED EII'IJV ON LE'JEL 177 GRID 10 > I? UNffS {3O8 & 336. APPROVED BAR SINK DWV AT LEVET 196 N,E. CORNER, MENDEK UNIT nem: 220 PLM&Ror.rohtD.W.V. of'/23d[ Inspector: GcD Acfon. Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION CoMMeNts: DV{/V AND RISERS SERVING PROVATE RESIDENCE Ot'I 3Td FLOQR AT EAST END. WATER COLUMN TEST, 06J30/O4 insp€clor: CDAVIS Action: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Comments: LEVEL 177 ADA RESTOfMS VENTII,JG UNDER WATER COLUMN TEST 07/O6rO4 Insp€cto{: GCO Action: Pt PARTTAL INSPEenON Comm€nls GRID 2 THRU 7 NORTH SIDE WATER COLUMN TEST 07i {5/O.l Instr'eclo| GCn Aclion: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTIoN REPTl31 Run Id: 2443 STUDOR VENTS ON I-AVS. O7l29lM Inspactor: ART Acl,on: Pl PAFIAT INSPECTION COMMENTS: GRID LINE 2 THRU 7 SOUTH SIDE CORRIDOR VEN ON LEVEL 177. WASTE ON LEVEL 185 OA/OrryO4 InsD€ctor: GCD Acuon: NO NOTIFIED Co.nm€nts: DISCUSSED TESTING OF VENTS FOR 2ncl FLOOFT 186 OK TO NOT TEST SOME VENTS. o8/0e'O4 Insoector: GCD Actbn: Pl PARTnL INSPECTION ComMenis: WASTE FOR LEVET 196 AND\IENT FOR 186II/ATER COLUMN TEST, 08/j9/04 Inspector: GCD Acticn: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Comm€nb: ? BATH GROUPS ON LEVELS 155.166 WATER COLUMN TEST. BATH GROUP 3O8P WATER COLUMN TEST. nem: 23{) PlM&Rouoh,Water O6/3tvoj[ Insp€clor: CDAMS Actbn: Pl PARTiAL INSPECnON Comments: PARTIAL lNSPECTtOl.f WffH CORRECTIONS LEVEL 177 RESTROOMS 95# AIRTEST .ALL PIP|NC MUST BE SECUREI].INSTALL ISOLATORS.INSTALL NAIL PLATES WHERE REOUIRED 091t19/M Inspeclor: Art Action: DN DENIED Comm€nts, WATER PIPING HAS BEEN INSTALLED PROPERLY, HOWEVER, THE SI-IOWER/TUB INSTALTATIONS ARE NOT PROVIDED WITH FRESSURE-BALANCE VALVES AS REOUIRED BY THE 2()o3 tPC, SECTION 424.3, REI$ESPECTION 1S REOUIRED CF/22IO4 Insrlector: GCD Aclirn: Pl PARTIAI INSPECTK)N Comments: UTATER PIPE lN LEVELS 177 186 APRPOVED, ExEcPT LrNlT 417 LEAK. 58Psi TEST 09122184 InsDaclor: GCD Aciion: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Comm€nts: SF(f,WER VALVES I.{OTED ffFTXFO4 HAVE BEEN INSTALLED. 1O/O404 lnsp€ctor: GCD Actlon: P| PARTTAL INSPECTI3N Comments: UMT 417 LEAK FIXED AND APPROVED STREET PFESSURE PLMSGaS PIDIno CFl22lO4 lnsiactor: GCD Aclion: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Commenb: UMTS 3(X,3>5,3O6,308 lspsi TEST. l0l04/'04 Inspsctor: GCD Action: Pl PARTIAL INSPECTION Commenls: FIREPIT GAS LINE 1sp€i TEST PLMSPooVHot Tub PLMB-Mlsc. PLM&FhaI @l22t}4 lnsp€clor: GCD Action: Pl PARTIqL INSPECTION Comm€nts: PLUMBIAIG APPROVED IN RESTROOMS. ADA REOUIREMENTS NOT MET AT LAVS AND WOMENSWC 1{€m: 240 flem: 2€0 Item: 260 ll€m: 29O REPT131 Run Id: 2443 I I I I l I I I I I I t I t I ttI I Town of Vail I}FFICE COPY VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE VAIL, COLORADO B oV. oo B3 RECEI t/ED tiAR Z tt 200+ Project Manual 20021501.08 Permit Set March 22,2004 SANTABARBARA J,i'Z E H R E N V A I L (805)9636890 Fpv\ (805)96$8102 santaba,ba,a @ zehreo.com a7 AND ASSOCIATES, lNC. t:t"tt:it3t:tJfJtJtli:tlT ARCHITECTURE' PLANNING. INTERIORS ffi ffi9 I I VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE t RENOVATTONS AND ADDTTTONS Project No. 021501.08 Vail. Colorado I 0 T I I I I I I I I I I, I I SPECIFICATION INDEX ORIGINAL ISSUE: March 22,2004 Italic indicates information to be issued at a later dale. Bold indicates information that has changed. )t DIVISION I - GEIVERAL REQITIREMENTS OOTOO GENERALCONDMONS AIA DOCI.JMENT A2OI. GENERAL CONDIDTIONS OF THE CONTRACT FORCONSTRUCTION CODE ANANLYSIS OIIOO STJMMARY OI2IO ALLOWANCES OI23O ALTERNATES OI25O CONTRACTMODIFICATIONPROCEDURES AIA DOC G7IO. ARCHITECTS SI.JPPLEMENTAL INSTRUCTIONS AIA DOC G7O9- WORK CHANGES PROPOSAL REQUEST AIA DOC G701. CHANGE ORDER AIA DOC G7I4. CONSTRUCTION CHANGE DIRECTIVE csl FoRM l3.lA- SUBSTTTUTTON REQUEST 01270 I.JMTPRICES 01290 PAYMENTPROCEDURES O13IO PROJECT MANAGEMENT AND COORDINATION 01320 CONSTRUCTIONPROGRESSDOCUMENTATION 01330 SI.]BMITTALPROCEDI.]RES CSI FORM I2.IA- SUBMITTAL TRANSMITTAL AIA DOC G8IO, TRANSMITTAL LETTER01400 QUALTTYREQUTREMENTS01420 REFERENCES OI5OO TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS01600 PRoDUCTREQUTREMENTS 01700 EXECUTToNREQUTREMENTS OI73I CUTilNGANDPATCHING 01732 SELECTIVE DEMOLITON OI77O CLOSEOUTPROCEDURES CSI FORM 14.IA- PUNCH LIST01781 PROJECTRECORDDOCUMENTS 01782 OPERATIONS AND MAINTENANCE DATA OI82O DEMONSTRATIONANDTRAINING csl FoRM 13.2- REQUEST FOR INTERPERTATION CSI FORM I.5A- SUBCONTRACTORS AND MAJOR MATERIAL SUPPLIERS LIST RELEASE OF ELECTRONIC FILES I Specification Index Issue A - Permit Set (0318104)Page I of4 VA,IL MOUNTIAN LODGE RENOVATIONS AND ADDITIONS DIVISION 2 - SITE CONSTRUCTION 02230 SITE CLEARING 02620 ST]BDRAINAGE 02751 CEMENTCONCRETEPAVEMENT 027il PAVEMENTJONTSEALANTS 02780 UNITPAVERS 02920 LAWNS AND GRASSES 02930 EXTERIORPLANTS DIVISION3 - CONCRETE O33OO CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE O33OO CEMENTBASEDIJNDERLAYMENT DIVISION 4 - MASOIYRY 04860 STONEVENEERASSEMBLIES DTVISION 5 - METALS Project No.02150f.0E Vail. Colorrdo I t I 0 I $ 05120 05310 05500 0551 I 05521 STRUCTURAL STEEL STEEL DECK METAL FABRICATIONS METAIL STAIRS PIPE AND TTJBE RAILINGS I t I I 1 D I IDI\ISION 6 - WOOD AI|ID PLASTICS 06105 MISCELLANEOUSCARPENTRY 0640I EXTERIORARCHITECTI.'RALWOODWORK 06402 INTERIORARCHITECTI.JRALWOODWORK DIVISIONT - THERMAL AI\D MOISTURE PROTECTION 07142 HOTFLUID-APPLIEDWATERPROOFING 07210 BI'ILDING INSULATION I ,l I I tSpecification Index Issue A - Permit Set (03/8/04)Page 2 of4 I I VAILMOUNTT.A,N LODGE t RENOVATTONSANDADDITTONS Project No. 02t501.08 Vail, Colorado Ii I I I t 07241 EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FIMSH SYSTEMS- CLASS PB 07610 SHEET METAL ROOFING 07620 SHEET METAL FLASHING AND TRIM O78I I SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTTVE MATERIALS 07841 THROUGH PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 07842 FIRE RESISTTVE JOINT SYSTEMS 07920 JOINT SEALANTS DIVISION 8 - DOORS AI{D WINDOWS O8I 11 STANDARD STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES O82II FLUSH WOOD DOORS 08212 STILE AND RAIL WOOD DOORS 08263 SLIDING WOODFRAMED GLASS DOORS O83II ACCESSDOORSANDFRAMES 08550 WOODWINDOWS 08711 DOORHARDWARE 08830 MIRRORS DIVISION 9 - FINISHES t 09260 GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES , 09265 GYPST]M BOARD SHAFT-WALL ASSEMBLIES I, 09310 CERAMIC TILE 'l/ 09385 DTMENSTON STONE TrLE 09512 ACOUSTICTILECEILINGS n 09638 STONEPAVTNG AND FLOORTNG t, 09640 wooDFLooRrNG" 0965I RESILIENT FLOOR TILE E 09653 RESILIENT WALL BASE AND ACCESSORIES tl 0e751 INTERIOR STONE FACTNG 09911 PAINTING (CONSUMER LINE PRODUCTS) - 09931 EXTERIOR WOOD STAINSI! -l' DIVISION TO - SPECIALTIES II r0300 FTREPLACES (TO BE TSSUED AT A LATER DATE)r 10801 ToILET AND BATH ACCESSoRIES (To BE ISSUED AT A LATER DATE) 10820 GLASS SHOWER DOORS (TO BE TSSUED AT A LATER DATE) .JI DrvIsIoN r r - EQITTPMENT I1451 RESIDENTIALAPPLIANCES I1460 I.JMTK]TCHENS I Specification Index Issue A - Permit Set (03/8/04) I I Page 3 of 4 VAILMOUNTIAN LODGE Rtr,NOVATIONS AND ADDITIONS Project No.021501.08 Yail, Colorado I t I 0 ,| (DrvrsroN 12 - FTJRNTSHTNGS - NOT USED) (DMSION 13 - SPECTAL CONSTRUCTION - NOT USED) DIVISION 14_ COITVEYING SYSTEMS 14240 HYDRALICELEVATORS DIVISION T5-MECHAMCAL I5OIO MECHANICALGENERAIPROVISIONS I5IOO BASICMATERIALSANDMETI{ODS 15250 INSI.'LATION I54OO PLI.]MBING 15600 HEAT GENERATION, RIFRIGERATION AND LIQTIID HEAT TRANSFERI58OO AIRDISTRIBUTION I59OO CONTROLSANDINSTRT]MENTATION DTVISION T6 - ELECTRICAL I6OIO GENERALPROVISIONS I6IOO BASIC MATERTALS AND METHODS 16500 LIGHTING 16720 FIREALARM AND SMOKE DETECTION SYSTEMS16750 TELECOMMI'NICATIONSYSTEMS END OF SPECIFICATION INDEX I ,t Il I t I I I I I Specification Index Issue A - Permit Set (03/8/04)Page 4 of 4 I t I t tl t I 0 I t T t n i T I I I 1997 Edition - Electronic Format GENERAL PROVISIONS OWNER CONTRACTOR ADMINISTRATION OF THE CONTRACT sUBCONTRACTORS CONSTRUCTION BY OWNER OR BY SEPARATE CONTRACTORS CHANGES IN THE WORK TIME PAYMENTs AND COMPLETION PROTECTION OF PERSONS AND PROPERTY INSURANCE AND BONDS UNCOVERING AND CORRECTION OF WORK MIsCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS TERMINATION OR SUSPENSION OF THE CONTRACT AIA Document A2Ol - 1997 l, General Conditions of the Contract for Construction r TABLE oF ARTTcLEs l. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. lo. It. 12. t3. 14. INDEX Acceptance of Nonconforming Work 9.6.5,9.9.3, t2.3 Acceptance of Work 9.6.6, 9.8.2, 9.9.3,9.to.r, 9.ro.3, 12.3 Access to Work 3.lO e.z.r, n.r Accident Prevention 4.2.3, ro Acts and Omissions 3.2, !3.2, j.r2.8, 3.r8, +2.3, 43.8, 4.4r, 8.3.r, 9.5.r, 1o.2.5, r3.+2, r3.7, 1 4.r Addenda r.r.r, 3.lr Additional Costs, Claims for 4.3.4, 4.3.5, 4.3.6,6.r.r, ro.3 Additional Inspections and Testing 9.83, r2.2,r, r3.s Additional Time, Claims for 4.j.4,4.3.7'8J.2 ADMINISTRATION OF THE CONTRACT t.3,4,9.+,g.s Advertisement or Invitation to Bid l.l.l TI4S DOCUMENT HAS MTR\N,IT 'TGALcoNtEouEl.lcE . coNswf Afto[ wtf H Nl NTONNEY 15 ENCOURAGED W'fH RESPECI fO 'r5 COMWTTON On i'iODIF,CALON. AUT,fiNIICAI ION OF lrXS EITCI RON'C,ILY DNAFTED NA DOCUINENT MAY BE MADE BY USING HA DOCUMENT D/IOI. Ihis docunrrerrt has been approved ard endorcd by Tfu Associatd Gerpral co ntr acto rs of Anet ica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 6ENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnstilute of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20@6-5292 @ copyrighr lerr, 1915, 1918, t925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 196t, 1963, 1966, 1967, 1970, T975;1987, 1997 by The American lnstitule of Architecfs. titteenih Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or substanfial quolalion of ils provisions withoul writlen permission of the AIA violates the copyright laws of the United states and will subject the violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photbcopying violates U.5. :yrighl laws and will subjecl the violator to legal proseculion. Thii documenf was eleclronically produced .,rth permission of fhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license without violation until the date of expiration as noted below. User Documenl: Oi - 3l20n@4. AIA License Number lll5OO7, which expires on YlY2@4. Aeslhetic Effecl 4.2.13, 4.5.r Allowances 3.8 rrll-risk Insurance .4.l.r Applications for Payment 4.2.5, 73.E, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5.r, 9.53, 9.7.r, 9.8.5, 9.1o, ll.r.3, 14.2.4, 14.4.3 Approvals 2.4, 3.r.3, 3.5, 3.ro.2, t.r2, 4.2.7,9.3.2, 13.4.2, 13.5 Arbitration 4.t.3, 4.4, 4.5.1, 4.5.2, 4.6, 8.3.r, 9.7.t, \.4.9, rr.4.1o Architect 4.1 Architect, Definition of 4.r.r Architect, Extent of Aurhority 2.4, 3.12..7, 4.2, 4.3.5, 4.4, 5.t, 5.3,7.r.2,7.3.6, 7.4,9.2,9.3.r, 9.4, 9.5, 9.8J,9.ro.r, 9.ro.3, r2.r, r2.2.t, r3.5.r, r3.5.2, 14.2.2, 14.2.4 Architect, Limitations of Authority and Responsibility 2.r.r,3.j.3, 3.r2.4, j.r2.8, 3.rz.ro, 4.r.2, 4.2.r> 4.2.2, 4.2.3, 4.2.5, 4.2.7, 4.2.ro, 4.2.12, 4.2.13, 4.4, 5.2.r, 7.4, 9.4.2, 9.6.4,9.5.5 Architect's Additional Services and Expenses 2.4, rr.4.r.r, r7.2.r, 13.5.2, 13.5.3, 14.24 Architect's Administration of the Contract :rr.t, 4.2, t.s4, q.4,9.4,9.s 'chitect's Approvals 2.4, 3.1.3, 3.5.r, 3-ro.2,4.2.7 Architect's Authority lo Reiect Work 3.5.r, 4.2.6, rz.r.2, r2.z.r Architecfs Copyright L.6 Architect's Decisions 4.2.6, 4.2.7, 4.2.\r, 4.2.12, 4.2.13, 4.3.4, 4.4.r, 4.4.j, 4.4.6, 4.j, 53, 73.6, 7 J.8, 8.r.3, 8.3.r, 9.2, 9.4, 9.5.1, 9.8.4, 9.9.r, 13.5.2, 14.2.2, 14.2.4 Architect's Inspections 4.2.2, 4.2.9, 4.3.4, 9.4.2, 9.8.J, 9.9.2, 9.ro.r, 13.5 Architect's Instructions 3.2.3,3.3.r, 4.2.6, 4.2.7, 4.2.8,7.4.r, r2.1, rj.5.2 Architect's Interpretations 4.2.rr, 4.2.12, 4.3.6 Architect's Proiect Representative 4.2,rO Architect's Relationship wfth Contractor r.r.2, r.5, 3.r.3,3.2.r, 3.2.2, 3.L3, 3.3.1, 3.4.2, 3.j.r, j.7.3,3.ro, 3.D, 3.r2, 3.16, 3.r8, 4.1.2, 4.1.3, 4.2, 4.3.4, 4.4.r, 4.4.7 , 5.2, 5.2.2, 7 , 8.3.r, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5,9.7, 9.& 9.9, 10.2.6, ro.j, 1r.3, rr.4.7, 12, 13.4.2, r3.5 Archilect's Relationship with Subcontractors r.t.z, 4.2.3, 4.2.4, 4.2.6, 9.6-3,9.6.4, rr.4.7 Architect's Representalions 9.4.2, 9.5.\ 9.to.l Architect's Site Visits 4.2.2, 4.2.5, 4.2.9, 4.3.4,9.4.2, 9. , 9.9.2, 9.ro.l,13.t Asbestos lo.3.r Attomeys' Fees 3.18.1, 9.1o.2, 1o.3.3 Award of Separate Contracls 5-r.r, 6-r.2 Award of Subconlracts and Other Contracts for Portions of the Work 5.2 Basic Definitions Ll Bidding Requirements r.r.r, r.r.7, 5.2.r, rr.5.r Boiler and Machinery Insurance rr.4.2 Bonds, Lien 9.ro.2 Bonds, Performance, and Payment 7 3.6.4,9.5.7,9.ro.3, 11.4.9, ll.5 Building Permit 3.7.r Capitalization' 1.3 Certificale of Subslanrial Completion 9.8J,9.8.4,9.8.5 Certificales for Payment 4.2.5, 4.2.9, 9.3.3, I .4. 9.5, 9.6.r, 9.6.6, 9.7 .r, 9.ro.r, 9.ro.3, r3.7, r4.r.r.3, 14.2.4 Certificates of Inspection, Testing or Approval r3.5.4 Certifi cates of Insurance 9.1o.2, rr.l.3 Change Orders r.r.r, 2.4.r, 3.4.2, 3.8.2.3, 3:r.r, 3.rz.E, 4.2.8, 4.3.4, 4.3.9, 5.2.3, 7 .r, 7 .2, 7 4, 84.r, 9.3.r.r, 9.ro.3, rr.4.r.2, 1r.4.4, rr.4.9, r2.r.2 Change Orders, Definition of 7.2.r CHANGES IN THE WORK 3.1r, 4.2.8, 7, 8.3.r, 9.3.r.r, u.4.9 Claim, Delinition of 4.3.1 Claims and Dispules 3.2.3, 4,3, 4. 4, 4.5, 4.6, 6.1.r, 6J, 7.3.8, 9.3.j, 9.1o.4, 10.3.3 Claims and Timely Assertion of Claims 4.5.5 Claims for Additional Cost ,2.1, q.l.q, 4.3.5,4.3.6, G.r.r, 7.3.8, ro.3.2 Claims for Additional Time fHI' NCUDENI HAS MrcRfNIf LEGAL cottsEQw|l,(:Es. cwuLfAttoN w,tH AN t) Af fonNEY E Et'tcouRACi.D wf H \I/ RESPECT TO IfS COMPUTION ON tvrODtF |CAT tON. AUT,f Nf lCAl ION OF | |rs EUCTNOII'CAUY DR,fI ED NA DOCUtttENT MAY 8E MADE BY USNG NA DOCUT EMMT. fhis docunnnt has fuen approvd atd erfursed by Tln Associatd @rcrd Contractors of Anprica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCTION The American Inslitule of Architecls 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 I T t 0 D I I 0 ! 1 t t il l I I I I @ CopyriSht l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, l93Z 1951, 1958, 1951, 1953, 1965, 1967. 1970, 1976. 1987, 1997 by ThC American Institule of Architects. Fifte€nfh Edition. Reproducfion of the material herein or substantial quotation of its provisions wilhoul wrilten permission of ihe AIA violates the copyright laws of the United'afes and will subject lhe violaie fo legal proseculion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violater U.S. pyrighl laws and will subject lhe violator lo legal prosecution. This documenl was electronically produced wilh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license withoul violalion until the dale of expiration as noted below. User Document: 03 - 3n0l2@4- AIA License Number lll5oo7, which expires on Sll3n0o4. 2 I T t t, I T I I 0 1 I I I l t t, T I I ,2., q.rq,4.3.7, 6.r.r, 8.3.2, ro.j.2 Claims for Concealed or Unknown Conditions 4.3.4 laims for Damages 3.2.3, j.r8, 4.l.lo, 6.1.1, 8. j.3, 9.5.t, 9.6.7, ro.3.3, u.r.rr .4.5, 1r.4.7, r4.r.3, 14.2.4 Claims Subiect to Arbitration 4.4.r, 4.5.r, 4.6.r Cleaning Up 3.15, e.: Commencement of Statutory Lirnitalion Period 13.7 Commencement of the Work, Condilions Relating to 2.2.\ 3.2.r, 3.4.r, 3.7.r,3.ro.r, 3.12.5, 4.3.5, 5.2.r, 5.23, 6.2.2,8.r.2, 8.2.2, 8.j.r, rr.r, u.4.1, rr.4.6, rr.5.r Commencement of the Work, Definition of 8.1.2 Communications Facilitaling Contract Administration s.gt,4.2.4 Completion, Conditions Relating to r.5.r, 3.4.r, 3.u, 3.r5, 4.2.2, 4.2.9,8.2,9.4.2, 9.8, 9.9.r, 9.ro, 12.2, 13.7, r4.r.2 COMPLETION, PAYME NTS AND 9 Completion, Subatantial 4.2.9,8.1.r, 8.8, 8.2.3, 9.4.2, 9.8, 9.9.r, 9.ro.3, 9.ro.4.2, r2.2, t3.7 Cornpliance with laws r.6.r, 3.2.2,3.5, 3.7, 3.12.10, 3.t3, 4.1.1, 4.4.8, 4.6.4, 4.6.6,9.6.4, ro.2.2, rr.r, ll.4, r3.r, t3.4, 13.5.r, r3.5.2, 13.5, r4.r.r, r4.2.r.3 Concealed or Unknown Conditions 4.3.4, 8.3.r, lo.j Conditions of the Contract r.r.r, r.r.Z, 5.r.r, 5.r.4 Consent, Wdtten r.6, 3.4.2, 3.12.8, 3.14.2, 4.r.2, 4.3.4, 4.6.4, 9.3.2, 9.8.5, 9.9.r, 9.ro.2, 9.10.3, [.4.r, r3.2, L3.4.2 CONSTRUCTION BY OWNER OR BY SEPARATE CONTRACTORS r.r.4,6 Construction Change Directive, Definition of 7.3.r Construction Change Directives r.r.r, 3.12.8, 4.2.8, 4.3.9,1.t,7 .3,9.3.r.t Construction Schedules, Conlractor's r.4.r.2, 3.ro, 3.r2.r, 3.12-2, 4.3.7.2, 6.r.3 Contingenl Assignmenl of Subcontracts 5.4, t4.t 2.2 Continuing Contract Performance 4.3.3 Contract, Definilion of 1.t.2 CONTRACT, TERM INATION OR 5USPENsION OF THE t.+.r.r, u.+.9, l4 Conuact Administration 3.r.3, 4, 9.4,9.5 Contract Award and Execution, Conditions Relating to 3.7.r, 3.ro, 5.2, 5.r, u.r.3, u.4.6, u.5.r Contracl Documents, The l.l, r.z Contract Documenls, Copies Furnished and llse of r.6, 2.2.j, 5.3 Contract Documenls, Definition of l.t.l Contract Sum 3.8, 4.3.4, 4.3.5, 4.4.5, 5.2.3,7.2, 7.3' 7.4' 9.1' 9.4.2, 9.5.r.4, 9.6.7, 9.7, to.!.2, rr.4.r, 14.2.4, 14.3.2 Contract Sum, Definition of 9.r Contract Time 4.3.4, 4.3.7, 4.4.5, 5.2.3, 7.Lr.3' 7.3, 7.4, 8.r.t, 8.2, 83.r, 9.j.r, 9.7, ro.3.2, r2.r.r, 14.3.2 Contract Time, Definition of 8.r.1 CONTRACTOR 3 Contractor. Definition of 3.r, 6.r.2 Contractor's Construction Schedules r-+.r.e, 3,lO 3.rz.r, 3.12.2, +3.7.2, 6.r.3 Conlractor's Employees 3.3.2, 3.4.3, 3.8.r,3.9, 3.r8.2, 4.2.3, 4.2.6, ro.2, ro.3, .r.r, Ir,4.7, r4.1, 14,2.1.-, Contractor's Liabilily Insurance I l.l Contractor's Relationship with Separate Contractors and Omer's Forces 3.12.5, 3.14.2, 4.2.4, 6, rL.4.7 , rLr.z, t2.2.4 Contractor's Relationship with Subcontractors r.2.2, j.3.2, 3.r8.r, !r8.2, 5,9.6.2, 9.6.7, 9.ro.2, rr.4.r.2, n.4.7, x.4.8 Codractor's Relationship with the Archilecl r.r.2, r.5, 3.r.3, 3.2.1,3.2.2,3.2.3, 3.3.r, 3.4.2, 3.5.r, 3.7.3, 3.ro, j.u, 3.12, 3.16, 3.r8, 4.r.2, 4.r.3, 4.2, 4.3. 4, 4. 4.r, 4. 4.7, 5.7, 6.7.2, 7, 8.3.r, 9.2, 9.3, 9.+ 9.j,9.7,9.8, 9.9, 10.2.6, ro.3, u.3, rr.4.7, 12, rr4.2, r3.5 Contractor's Representations r.5.2,3.5.r, 3.12.6, 6.L2, E.2.r, 9.3.3, 9.8.2 Contractor's Responsibility for Those Performing the Work 3.3.2, t.rg, 4.2.j, 4.3.E, j.3.1, 5.1.3, 6.2, 5.3,9.5.t, lo ttqs DOCU!{fNT HIS lMrcBrANf LEGAL CONSEQUENCES. COMULTAI'ON WI|H AN AITORNEY IS ENCOURAGED WITH RESPECI TO IT5 CONME|PN OR I@D,f ICATION. AUIHEMrcANON OF TIIS E LECI ROMCAILY DRAF T ED NA DOCUMENr MAY BE MADE 8Y USN,IG NA DOCUMENr D4OI. this document lps been approvd ard et1,orsed by flp Nsociatd @neral Co ntr act ors of America. I ot99t AtAo AIA DOCUMENI A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION American Inslitufe of Archifects. Fifteenth Edition- ReDroduciion of the material herein or substintial The American tnslifule of Architects quolalion of its provisions wilhouf wrilten permission oi the AIA violafes the copyright laws of the United 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. -'ates and will iubject the violate to legal prosecution. WARNTNG: Unlicensed iioi-ocopying violates U.5. Washingfon, D.C.20@6-5292 ,:yright laws and will subject the violafor lo legal prosecution- This document was elecironically produced wilh Permission of the AtA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license withoul violalion unlil the date of expiration as noted below. User Document: 03 -- ?n0l2Co,4. AIA License Number lll50O7, which expires on Sn3ncp4. 3 Contraclor's Review of Conlract Documenls t.5.2,1.2,3.7.3 Contractor's Right to Stop lhe Work 9.7 -ontractor's Righl to Terminate the Contract 4.3.ro, l4.l Contractor's Submiltals 3.ro, 3.u, 3.r2, 4.2.7, 5.2.r, 5.2.3, 7.3.5, 9.2, 9.3, 9.8.2, 9.84, 9.9.t, 9.ro.2, 9.ro.3, u.r.3, 1r.5.2 Contraclor's Superintendent 3.9,ro.2.6 Contractor's Supervision and Conslruction Procedures t.2.2, 3.3,3.4, 3.r2.1o, 4.2.7, 4.2.7, 4.3.3, 6.r.3, 5.2.4, 7.r.3, 7.3.4, 7.3.5, 8.2, ro, 12, 14 Contractual Liability Insurance rl.r.r.8, tr.2, ,3 Coordination and Correlation r.2, r.5.2, 3.3.t, 3.ro, 3.12.6, 6.t.3, 6.2.r Copies Furnished of Drawings and Specifications r.6,2.2.5, 3.rr Copyrights r.6,3.r7 Correction of Work 2.3, 2.4, 3.7.4, 4.2.r, 9.+2, 9.8.2, 9.8.3, 9.9.t, 12.r.2, r2.2, r3.7.r.3 Correlalion and Intent ofthe Conlract Documents 1.2 Cost, Definition of 7.3.6 - lsts 2.4, 3.2.3,3.7.4, 3.8.2,3.15.2, 4.3, r.4.2, 6.r.r, 6.2.3, 7.3.J.3,7 A.5,7.3.7, 7 J.8, 9.ro.2, ro.3.2, ro.5, u.3, u.4, r2.r, D.2.r, 12.2.4,13.5> 14 Cutting and Palching 6.2.5,3.14 Damage to Conslruction of Ovrner or Separate Conlractors 3.14.2, 6.2.4, 9.2.r.5, ro.2.r.2, ro.z5, 10.6, u.r, rr-4, 12.2.4 Damage to the Work 3.14.2, 9.9.L, ro.z.r.2, ro.2.S, ro.6, rr.4, 12.2.4 Damages, Claims for j.2.3, 3.18, 4.3.ro, 6.t.r,8.3.3, 9.5.r, 9.6.7, ro.5.3, rr.r.r, rr,4.5, rr.4.7, r4.r.3, 14.2.4 Darnages for Delay 6 ).r, 8J3, 9.5.r.6, 9.7, ro.3.2 Date of Commencement of the Work, Definition of 8.1.2 Date of Substantial Complerion, Definition of 8.1.3 Day, Definition of 8.r.4 Decisions of the Architect 4.2.6, 4.2.7, 4.2.rr, 4.2.12, 4.2.r3, 4.3. 4, 4. 4.r, 4.4.5, 4.4.6, 4.j, 6 J, 7.3.6, 7 J.8, 8.r.3, 8J.r, 9.2, 9.4, 9.5.r, 9.E.4, 9.9.r, 13.5.2, 14.2.2, 14.2.4 Decisions to Withhold Certification 9. 4.t, 9,5, 9.7, t4.t.t.3 Defective or Nonconforming Work, Acceptance, Reieclion and Correction of 2.3, 2.4, 3.5.r, 4.2.6, 6.2.5, 9.5.r, 9.5.2, 9.6.6, 9.8.2, 9.9.3, 9.ro.4, r2.2.r, r3.7.r.3 Defective Work, Definition of 3.5.r Definitions r.r, 2.1.1, 3.1, 3.5.r, 3.r2.r, 3.12.2, 3.12.3, 4.r.r, 4.3.r, 5.r, 6.r.2, 7.2.r, 7.3.r, 7.3.6, 8.r, g.l, 9.8.1 Delays and Extensions of Time 3.2.3, 4.3.r, 4.3.4, 4.3.7, 4. 4.5, 5.2.3, 7.2.r, 7.3.t, 7.4.r,7.5.r,8,3, 9.j.r, 9.7.r, ro.3.2, 1c-6.r, 14.3.2 Disputes 4.r.4, +3,4.4, 4.5, +6,6-3,73.8 Documents and Samples at the Site 3.tl Drawings, Definition of 1.r.5 Drawings and Specifications, tlse and Ownenhip of l.l.l, r.3, 2.2.5, 3.llr 5.3 Effective Date of Insurance 8.2.2, u.1.2 Emeryencies 4.3.5, 1O.5, r4.r.r.z Employees, Contractor's 3.3.2, 3.43, 18.t, 3.9, 3.18.2, 4.2.3, 4.2.6, ro.2, ro.3, rr.r.r, u.4.7, t4.r, r4.2.r.r Equipment, Labor, Materials and rJ.3, rJ.6, 3.4, 3.5.r, 3.E.2, 3.8.3, 3.t2, 3.r3, 3.15.r, 4.2.6, 4.2.7, 5.2.r, 5.2.r, 7.t.6, 9.3.2, 9.3.3, 9.5.r.3, 9.tO.2, ro.2.r, rO.2.4, r4.2.r.2 Execution and Progress of the Work r.r.3, r.2.r, r.2.2, 2.2.3, 2.2.5, 3.r, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.7, t.ro, 3.r2,3.r4, 4.2.2, 4.2.3, 4.3.3, 6.2.2,7.r.3, 7.3.4, 8.2,9.j, 9.9.r, ro.2, ro.t, r2.2, r4.2, r4.3 Extensions of Time 3.L3, 4.3.r, 4.3.4, 4.3.7, 4.4.5, 5.2.3, 7.2.r, 7.3, 7.4.r, 9.5.r, 9.7.r, ro.3.2, ro.5.r, r4.3.2 Failure of Payment 4.3.5, 9.5.r.3,9,7 , 9.to.z, r4.t.t.3, r4.2.r.2, r3.5 Faulty Work (See Defective or Nonconforming Work) Final Cornpletion and Fina! Payment 4.2.r,4.2.9, 4.3.2,9.8.2, 9.lQ ll.r.2, u.r.3, u.4.r, \.4.5, r2.3.r, r3.7 , 14.2.4, 14.4.3 Financial Arrangements, Owner's L2.r, 13.2.2, r4.r.r.5 Fire and Extended Coverage Insurance u.4 GENERAT PROVISIONS l ttx' NcuttlrEMf H/6 IMPOR| ANf LEGAL coNsEouENcEs. cousuLru,oN wlTH N a AIIORNEY E ENCoiufd|GED W'fH \!, RfJPECI IO tfs COMPtEftON On I I I wDlftcAf,or't. AUTt#},'tcAf|o'/, of f tls ELECIROMCALLY D'l.f f ED NA DoCUtt'ENf MAY 8E MADE 8Y USTNG NA DXU|TEN| D&1. Ttis document tps beelt. apyoved ard enhrsd by tlr- Associatd Gercrd Contr aclors of Ameri ca. I AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONs OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American Institufe of Architects l7l5 New York Avenue, N.W. Warhington, D.C. 20006-5292 I I 0 I t t ,l I ,t I I I I @ copyr.Sht lstl, 1915, 1918. 1925, 1937, l9sl. 1958, 1961, 1963, 1955, 1967, 1970J976-9FtlItgfSt-TF- American Instilule of Archife<ts. Fifte€nlh Edifion. Reproduction of the malerial herein or substantial quolation of ils provisions without writlen permission of the AIA violates the copyright laws of the Unifed<rates and will subject the violaie to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. ryrighr laws and will subjecl the violalor lo legal proseculion. This document was electroniially produced ,vith permission of the AIA and ran be reprodwed in accordance wilh your license without violation until lhe date of expiration as noled below. User Document: 03 - 3/2Ol2@4. AIA License Number'll15007, which exoires on 51131200'4. I I I I t t I c I Governing Law l3.l uarantees (See Warranty) Hazardous Materials 1o.2.4, 1O,3, lo.5 ldentification of Contract Documents 1.5.r Identification of Subcontractors and Suppliers 5.2.r Indemnificalion 3.r2, 3.18, 9.1o.2, 1o.3.3, 1o.5, 11.4.r.2, n.4.2 Information and Services Required of the Owner 2.r.2, 2.2, 3.2.1, J.r2.4, 3.rz.ro, 4.2.7, 4.3.3, 6.r.3, 6.r.4, 5.2.5,9.r2, 9.6.r, 9.6.4, 9.9.2, 9.ro.3, ro.3.3, u.2, D.4, r3.5.r, 13.5.2, 14.1.r.4, r4.1.4 Iniury or Damage to Person or Property 4.3,8, ro.z, ro.o Inspections 3.r.3, 3.3.3, 3.7-r, 4.2.2, 4.2.6, 4.2.9,9.4.2, 9.8.2, 9.EJ, 9.9.2, 9.ro.r, t2.2.r, 13.5 Instructions lo Bidders l.t.l Instructions to the Contraclor 3.2.3, 3.3.r, 3-8.r, 4.2.8, j.2.1, 7, 12, 8.2.2, 13.5.2 Insurance 3.r8.r, 5_.r.r, 2.3.6, 8.2.r, 9.j.2, 9.8.4, 9.9.r, 9.ro.2, 9.ro.5, u Insurance, Boiler and Machinery 1r.4.2 Insurance, Contractor's Liability I l.l .6urance, Effective Dale of E.2.2, rr.r.2 Insurance, Loss of tlse u.4.3 Insurance, Owner's Liability ll.2 Insurance, Proiect Managernent Prolective Liability u.3 Insurance, Properly ro.2.5, ll,4 Insurance, Stored Materials 9.3.7, rt.4.t.4 INSURANCE AND BONDS ll Insurance Companies, Consenl to Partial Occupancy 9.9.1, r.4.r.5 Insurance Companies, Setllemenl with rr,4.ro Intent ofthe Conlract Documents r.2.r, 4.27, 4.2.12, 4.2.13,7.4 Interest t3.6 Interpretalion t.z.l1,4,4.r.r, 4.3.r, 5.r, 6.1.2, 8.r.4 Interprelations, Written 4.2.rr, 4.2.12, 4.3.6 Joinder and Consolidation of Claims Rquired 4.6.4 tudgment on Final Award 4.6.6 Labor and Materials, Equipment r.r.3, r.r.5, 3.4, 3.5.t, 3.8.t, 3.8.3, 3.12, j.13, 1.r5.r, 42.6, 4.2.7, 5.2.r, 5.2.r, 7.3.6, 9.3.2, 9.3.3, 9.5.t.3, 9.tO,2, rO.2.r, rO.2.4, t4.2.r,2 Labor Disputes 8.3.r l,aws and Regulations r-6, 3.2.2,3.6, j.7, 3.r2.ro,3.r3, 4.r.r, 4.4.8, 4.6, 9.6.4,9.9.r,1o.2.2, rr.r, rr.4, 13.1, 13.4, 13.5.1, 13.5.2, 13.6, 14 Liens 2.r.2, 4.4.8, 8.2.2, 9.3.3, 9.Lo Limitation on Consolidation or loinder 4.6.4 Limitations, Slatutes of 4.6.3, 12.2.6, r3.7 Limitations of Liability 2.3, 3.2.t, 3.5.1, 3.7.3, 3.12.8, 3.r2.ro, 3.r2, 3.r8, 4.2.6, 4.2.7, 4.2.12, 5.2.2, 9.4.2, 9.6.4, 9.5.7, 9.ro.4, ro.3.3, ro.2.5, r.1.2, u.2.r, rr.4.7, 12.2.5, 13.4.2 Limilalions of Time 2-r.2, 2.2,2.4, 3.2.r,3.7.J, 3.ro, 3.rr,3.12.5, 3.r5.r, 4.2.7, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 6.2.4,7.3, 7.4, 8.2, 9.2, 9.3.r, 9.3.3, 9.4.r, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.4 9.9, 9.ro, rr.r.3,ll.4.1.5, 11.4.5, ll.4.ro, r2.2, rt 5, r3.7, 14 Loss of Use Insurance 11.4.3 Material Suppliers r.6, 3.r2.r, 4.2.4, 4.2.5, 5.2.r, 9.3, 9.4.2,9.6, 9.ro.5 Materials, Hazardous ro.2.4, ro.3, ro.5 Materials, Labor, Equipment and r.r.J, r.r.5, r.5.r, 3.4, 3.5.r,3.8.2, 3.8.4, 3.12, 3.r3, 3-r5.r, 4.2.6, 4.2.7, 5.2.r, 6.2.r, 7.3.6,9.3.2, 9.3.3, 9.5.r.3, 9.rO.2, r0,2.r, rO.2.4, r4.2.r.2 Means, Methods, Techniques, Sequences and Procedures of Construction 3.3.r, 3.r2.ro, 4.2.2, 4.2.7, 9.4.2 Mechanic's Lien 4.4.8 Mediation 4.4.r, 4-4.5, 4.4.6, 4.4.8,4.5, 4.5.t, 4.6.2,8.3.t, to.5 Minor Changes in the Work L{S DOCUtvENf HtS Mrcnf N{T LE('AL coNsEouENcEs. cot'lsufAfto wf H Nt Af f ONNEY 'S EIICOU&A.GED W'f H RESPECr IO IT5 COAryENON ffi, MODIFICA|ION. AUf HENIICATION OF f TTS EIECTROMCAUY DRNTED NA DOCUMENT MAY BE MADE 8Y USING NA DOCUNENT D&I. f his dxummt lw fuen approvd ard edorsed by Tlr- Assaiatd Gercrd Contr aclors of Arr€jr ica. AIA OOCUMENT A20t - t997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCTION The American lnstitule of Archite(rs 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D-C. 20@6-5292 I t I J t I I t I @coPyri8htl9ll,l9|5,I9l8,l925,l937,l95l'1958,|96I,l963;W American Institufe of Architects. Fifteenth Edifion. ReDroducfion of th€ material herein or substantial quotalion of ils provisions without wrilten permission of the AIA violates the copyright laws of the United <lafes and will subjecr the violate fo legal proseculion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.S. :yright laws and will subject fhe violalor lo legal prosecution. This document was electron'rcally produced ,'rlh permission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until the date of expiration as noted below. User Document: 03 - ff2o/2@4. AIA License Number 11150O7, which expires on YBnoo,4. ( t r.r. r, 3.12.8, 4.2.8, 4.3.6,7r,7.4 MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS l3 rodifications, Defi nition of I.t.l Modifications to the Contract r.r.r, r.r.2, 3.7.3, 3.r\, 4.r.2, 4.2.r, 5.2.3,7,8.3.r, 9.7, rO.3.2, tr.4.r Mutual Responsibility 6.2 Nonconforming Work, Acceptance of g.6.6,9.g.1,12.3 Nonconforming Work, Reiection and Conection of 2.j, 2.4, 3.5.r, 4.2.6, 5.2.r, 9.5.r, 9.8.2, 9.9.3, 9.10.4, r2.2.r, r3.7.r.3 Notice 2.2.r,2.3, 2.4, 3.2.3, 3.3.r, 3.7.2, 3.7.4, 3.12.9, 4.1, 4.4.8, 4.6.5, j.2.r, 8.2.2, 9.7, 9.ro, ro.2.2t rr.r.3, rr.4.5,r2.2.2, rz.z.4, 13.3, r3.5.r, 13.5.2, r4.r, r4.2 Notice, Writlen 2.3,2.4, 3.3.r,3.9, 3.12.9, 3.r2.ro, 4.t 4.+E, 4.6.5, 5.2.r, 8.2.2,9.7,9.ro, ro.2.2, ro.3, u.r.3, n.4.6, 12.2.2, r2.Ll, 13.3, r+ Notice ofTesting and Inspections 13.5.r, 13.5.2 Notice to Proceed 8.t.2 Notices, Permits, Fees and 2.2.2,3.7 , 3.r3, 7.3.6.4, ro.2.2 Observations, Contractor's r.5.2, 3.2, 3.7.3, 4.3.4 .ccuPancy 2.2.2, 9.6.6, 9.8, rr.4.r.s Orden, Writlen r.r.r, 2.t, 3.9, 4.!.6, 7, 8.2.2, rr.4.9, r2.r, r2.2, r15.2, r4.3.r OWNER 2 Owner, Delinition of 2.1 Owner, Infornation and Services Required of lhe 2..t.2,2.2, 3.2.r, 3.12.4, 3.r2.ro, 4.2.7, 4.j.3, 5.r.3, 5.r.4, 6.L5, 9.!2,9.6.r, 9.6.4, 9.9.2, 9.ro.3, ro.3.3, rr.2, u.4, t3.5.r, 13.5.2, r4.r.r.4> r4.r.4 Ovmer's Authority r.5, 2.r.r, 2.j, 2.4, 3.4.2, 3.8.r, 3.r2.ro, 3.14.2, 4.r.2, 4.r.3, 4.2.4, 4.2.9, 4.3.6, 4.4.7, 5.2.r,5.2.4, 5.4.r, 6.r, 6.j, 7.2.r, 7.j.r, 8.2.2, 8.3.r, 9.3.r, 9.1.2, 9.5.r, 9.9.r,9.rO.2, ro.3.2, u.r.3, D.3.1, rr.4.3, rr.4.ro' 12.2.7, r2.3.r, 13.2.2, r4.3, r4.4 Owner's Financial Capability 2.2.r, 13.2.2, r4.t.l.t Owner's Liabilty lnsurance ll.2 Owner's Loss of Lbe Insurance 11.4.3 Owner's Relationship with Subcontractors r.r.2, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4,9.6.4,9.to.2, r4.2.2 Owner's Righl to Carry Out the Work 2.4, na.4. r4.z.z.z Owner's Righl to Clean Up 5.3 Owner's Right to Perform Conslruction and to Award Separate Contracls 6.1 Owner's Right to Slop the Work 2.3 Owner's Right to Suspend the Work 14.3 Owner's Right to Terminate the Contract 14'2 Ormership and Use of Drawings, Specifications and Other Instruments of Service r.r.r, 1.6, 2.2.j, 3.2.r, 3.1.r, 3 .r7.r, 4.2.12,5.3 Partial Occupancy or llse 9.5.6,9.9, 1.4.r.5 Patching, Cutting and 3.14, s.z.s Patents 3.r7 Payment, Applications for 4.2.5, 7.3.E, 9.2, 9.3, g.+, 9.5.r, 9.6.1, g.l.r, 9.8.j, 9.lo.l, 9.ro.3, 9.ro.5, n.r.3, r4.2.4,14.4-3 Payment, Certificates for +.2.5, 4.2.9, 9.3.3, 9,4, 9.5, 9.6.r, 9.6.5, 9.7.r, g.ro.r, g.ro.3, r3.7, r4.1.1.3, 14.2.4 Payment, Failure of 4.3.6, 9.5.r.3, 9,7 , 9.ro.z, r4.r.r.3, r4.2.r.2, 13.6 Payment, Final 4.2.r, 4.2.9, 4.r2,9.8.2, g.ro, tr.r.2, rr.l.3, u.4.r, u.4.5, r2.3.r, r3.7, 14.2.4, r+4.3 Payment Bond, Performance Bond and 7.3.6.4, 9.6.7, 9.ro.3, 11.4.9, I 1.5 Payments, Progress 4.3.1,9.3,9.5, 9.8.5, 9.ro.3, 13.6, 14.2.3 PAYMENTS AND COMPLETION 9 Payments to Sukontractors 5.4.2, 9.5.r.J, 9.6.2, 9.6.3, 9.6.4, 9.6.7, 11.4.8, 14.2.r-2 PCB ro.3.r Performance Bond and Payment Bond 7.3.6.4, 9.6.7, 9.to.3, u.4.9, I 1.5 Permits, Fees and Notices ztt, 3.7, 3.r3, 7.3.6.4, ro.2.2 PERSONS AND PROPERTY, PROTECTION TIIS Do(UMENI HAS [vrcRf//|TT |f,GAL .. coMEouENcEs. cout//-rAnov wtrH Nt It Af foBtfr,Y ts ENC0UR,.GED wfH ,I RESPECI rO 'fS COMPUIiON On MO FTAIPN. AUT'IENIICAIION OF THs EUCT RONIC HIY DRAI TED A'A DOCUMENT MAY 8E MADE 8Y IJSING NA DoC.U|/ENI UOt. Ttis dxwnnl lw fun approved ard edorsd fo flc Assxiatd Gercrd Connadors of Au|,e]'.ica. - AIA DOCUMENT A2O\ - 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCTION The American Inslitute of Architects 1735 New York Avenue. N.W. WashinSton, D.C. 20006-5292 I tl I I t |, t t I i I I t I 3 t @ CopyriSht l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, t951, 1958, 1961, 1963, 1956, '1967, 1970, 1975, 'lgS[lggUEy Th- American Inslilute of Archilects. Fifleenth Edilion. Reproduction of lhe maferial herein or substantial quotation of ils provisions without vrrilien permission of the AIA violates fhe copyrighf laws of the United <tales and will subjecl lhe violale to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. :yrighf laws and will subjecr lhe violalor to legal proseculion. This documenf was electronically produced .,rlh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license wilhoul violafion unlil the date of expiration as noted below. User Document: 03 - 3l20l2@4. AIA License Number lll5oO7, which expires on 5l1Y2Oo4. t I Il I t, I I 0 I I I t I t T I t OF lo Dolychlorinated Biphenyl ro.3.r t'roduct Dala, Definition of 3.r2.2 Product Dala and Samples, Shop Drawings j.il,3.12,4.2.7 Progress and Completion 4.2.2, 4.J.j, 8,2, 9.8, 9.9.r, r4.r.4 Progress Payments +.1.1, g.1,9.6, 9.8.5, 9.ro.3, 8.6, 14.2.3 Proiect, Definition of the 1.r.4 Proiect Management Protective Liability lnsurance ll.3 Project Manual, Definition of the r.r.7 Project Manuals 2.2.5 Proiecl Representatives 4-2.1O Property Insurance ro.z.5, | 1.4 PROTECTION OF PERSONS AND PROPERTY lo Regulations and Laws r.6, j.2.2, 3.6, 3.7, !.r2.ro, !.r3, 4.r.r, 4.4.8, 4.6, 9.6.4,9.9.r, ro.2.2, u.r, rl.4, r3.r, r3.4, 13.5.1, 13.j.2,8.5,14 rteiection of Work 3.5.r, 4.2.6, t2.2.r Releases and Waivers of Liens 9.ro.2 Representations r.j.z, 3.5.r, t.12.6, 6.2.2, 8.2.r, 9.3.3, 9.4.2, 9.5.r, 9.8.2,9.ro.r Representalives 2.r.r, 3.r.r, 3.9, 4.r.r, 4.2.r, 4.2.10' 5.r.r, 5.r.2, 13.2.r Resolution of Claims and Disputes 4.4, +.s, +.6 Responsibility for Tbose Performing the Work 3.3.2, 3.r8, 4.2.3, 4.3.8, 5.3.r, 6.1.j, 6.2, 6.3, 9.5.r, lo Relainage 9.3.r, 9.6.2, 9.8.5, g.g.r, 9.ro.2, 9.ro.3 Review of Contract Documents and lield Review of Shop Drawings, Product Data and Samples by Contractor 3.r2 Rights and Remedies r.r.2, 2.3,2.4, 3.5.t, 3.r5.2, 4.2.6, 4.3.4, 4.5, 4.6, 5.!,5.4, 6.r, 6.3,7.3.r,8.3, f.il,9.7, to.2.5, ro.3, tz.t.z, rz.z.4, 13,4, v Royalties, Patents and Copyrighls 3.17 Rules and Notices for Arbitration 4.6.2 Safely of Persons and Property 1O.2, ro.5 Safety Precautions and Programs 3.3.r,4.2.2, 4.2.7,5.3.r, lO.l, ro.z, ro.e Samples, Dehnition of 3.r2.3 Samples, Shop Drawings, Product Data and 3'u'3,12,4.2.7 Samples at the Site, Documents and 3.ll Schedule of Values 9.2,e.3.r Schedules, Construction r.4.r.2, 3.ro, 3.r2.r, 3.n.a, 4.3.7.2, 5.r.3 Separate Contracts and Contraclors r.r.4, 3.12.5, 3.14.2, 4.L4, 4.2.7, 4.6.4, 6, E.3.1, 1r.4.7, r2.r,Z, 12.2.5 Shop Drawings, Definilion of 3.r2.r Shop Drawings, Product Data and Samples t.\,3.12, q.z.l Sile, tlse of 3.r3, 6.r.r,6.2.r Site Inspections r.2.2, 3.2.r, 3.3.3, 3.7.r, 4.2, 4.3.4, 9.4.2, 9.ro.r, rl.5 Site Visits, fuchitect's 4.2.2, 4.2.9, 4.3.4,9.4.2, 9.5.r, 9.9.2,9.ro.r, r3.5 Special Inspections and Testing 4.2.6, r2.2.r, r3.5 Specifications, Delinition of tbe r.r.6 Specifications, The r.r.r, 1.1.6, r.r.7, r.2.2, r.6, 3.rr, 3.r2.ro, 3.r7 Statule of Limitations 4.6J, 12.2.6, r3.7 Stopping the Work 2.3, 43.6, 9.7, ro.3, r4.r Slored Materials II1S DOCUMENI H?6 'MrcRTNIT LEGAL coMsErji.lEt'lcEs. coNsuf Afto wrH //jl ATTONNEY IS ENCOUF,,.GED WIf H RE PECi TO IT5 COMME|ION OR M@tFtcAf toN. AUIHENT|CAflON Of nlt' ELECI RONICALLY DRr'fIED NA WUMENT MAY BE MADT SY U'ING NA DOCUIyENI D&1. This document ha been approvd atl erfursd by flre '{ssociatd Gercrd Cont t actots of AnEt ica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American Instifute of Archilects '1735 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSton, D.C. 20006-5292 Conditions by Contractor 5'2'r, 9'3'2, ro'2'r'7, ro'2'4,rt'4'r'4 r.s.2,3.i,1.1.1,1.r2.7,6.r.3 Subcontraclor' Definition of Review of Contractor's Submittals by Owner and SUgi|tNfnnCfOnSArchitect 3.ro-r, j.ro.2, 3.u, 3.r2, 4.2, j.2,6.r.3,9.2, 9.8.2 5 American lnslilule of Architects. Fifteenfh Edition. Reproduclion of the material herein or substanlial quolalion of ils provisions wifhouf writlen permission of the AIA violates the copyright laws of the United<lales and will subjecr lhe violale to le8al prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.S. ryright laws and will subject lhe violator lo legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced .,rlh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license wifhoui violation until the dale of expiration as noted below. User Document: 03 -- y20l2@4. AIA License Numb€r lll5oo7, which expires on Yl3l2@4. Subcontractors, Work by r.2.2, 3.3.2, 3.r2.r, 4.2.3, 5.2.3, 5.3, 5.4, 9.3.r.2, 9.5.7 rbcontraclual Relations 5.3, 5.4, 9.3.t.2,9.5, 9.ro lo.2.r, lr.4.7, u.4.8, r4.r, 14.2.1, 14.3.2 Submittals r.6, 3.ro, 3.D, 3.r2, 4.2.7, 5.2.r, 5.2.3,7 A.6,9.2, 9.3, 9.8, 9.9.t, 9.ro.2, 9.1o.3, lrr.3 Subrogation, Waivers of o.r.r, u.4.5, I1.4.7 Substantial Completion 4.2.9, 8.r.r, 8.r.3, 8.2.3, 9.4.7, 9.8, 9.p.r, 9.ro.3, 9.ro.4.2, r2.2, r3.7 Substantial Completion, Definition of 9.8.1 Substitution of Subcontractors 5.2.3,t.2.4 Substilulion of fu chitect 4.1.3 .../ Substitulions of Malerials ,/ 3.4.2, j.s.r, 7 .3.7' Sub-subcontractor, Definition of 5.t-2 Subsurface Condilions 4.3.4 Successors and Assigns\. 13.2' Superintendent 3.9, ro.z.b Supewision and Construction Procedures n.z, 3.3, 3.4,3.r2.ro, 4.2.2, 4.2.7, 4.3.3,6.r.3, 6.2.4, 7.1.3, 7 1.6, 8.2, 8A.r, 9.4.2, ro, 12, 14 Surety 4.4.7, 5.4.r.2, 9.6.5, 9.ro.2, 9.ro.3> 14.2.2 Surety, Consent of 9.ro.2, 9.1o.3 Surveys 2.2.3 Suspension by the Owner for Convenience 14.4 Suspension of the Work 5.4.2'14.3 Suspension or Termination ofthe Contract 4.3-5, 5.4.r.r, u.4.9, 14 Taxes 3,6,3.8.2.r,7.3.6.4 Termination by the Contractor +.l.ro, 14.l Termination by the Owner for Cause 4.3.ro,5.4.r.r, 14.2 Termination of the Architect 4.r.1 Termination of the Conlractor 14.2.7 TERMINATION OR SUSPENSION OF THE CONTRACT t4 Tests and Inspections 3.r.3, 3.3.3, 4.2.2, 4.2.6, 4.2.9, 9.4.2, 9.83, 9.9.2, 9.ro.r, ro.3.2, ll.4.tl, rt.z.r,l3,5 TIME I Time, Delays and Exlensions of 3.2.3, 4.3.r, 4.3.4, 4.3.7, 4.4.5, 5.2.3,7.2.r> 7.3.r, 7.4.r,1.5.r,8.3, 9.5.r, 9.7.r, ro A.2, 10.6.r,14.3.2 Time Limits 2.r.2,2.2,2.4, 3.2.r, 3.7.3, 3.ro, 3.rl, 3.r2.5, 3.15.t, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.5, 5.2, 5.3, 5.+ 6.L4, 7 .3, 7.4,8.2, 9.2, 9.3.r, 9.3.3, 9.+r,9.5, 9-6,9.7,9.8, g.g, g.lo, u.r.3r .4.r.5, 11.4.5, ll.4.ro, 12.2, r3.5, r3.7, 14 Time Limits on Claims 4.3.2, q.t.+, +.t.8, 4.+ 4.j, 4.5 Title to Work 9.3.2,9.3.t UNCOVERING AND CORRECTION OF WORK l2 Uncovering of Work l2.l Unforeseen Conditions +3.4' 8.3.r' lo.3 Unit Prices +3.9,7.3.3.2 tlse of Documents r.r.r, r.6, 2.2.5, 3.12.5, 5.3 llse ofSile 3,13, e.r.r, e.z.r Values, Schedule of 9.2,9.3.r Waiver of Claims by the Archirect 13.4.2 Waiver of Claims by the Contractor 4.3.ro, g.ro.5, rr. 4.7, 13.+2 Waiver of Claims by the Ovrner 4.3.ro, 9.9.3, 9.ro.3, 9.1o.4, r.4.3, u.4.5, rr.4.7, L2.2.2.r, 13.4.2, 14.2,4 Waiver of Consequential Damages 4.3.1O,r+.zt Waiver of Liens 9.ro.2, 9.ro.4 Waivers of Subrogation o.r.r, 1.4.s, 11.4.7 Warranty 3.5, +.2.g, q.3.5.j, 9.3.3, 9.8.4, 9.9.r, 9.ro.4, 12.2.2, r3.7 .r.3 Weather Delays 4.3.7.2 T,1S Do(UTVENT HAS,MTR|NI| IEGAL coilsEotJEvcEs. couwrArtov wTH Nt a AIIORNEY 'S ENCOWA.Jf,DWIIH \! nEstrcf ro tf' cowEfnN oR MOAFrcATrcN. AUIHENIICAIIOI{ Of f I{' - ELECTBOMCALTY OR/trTED NA l DOCUMEMVOT. ' T I I 0 I Itis bcument ls &n apprwd ard erdord by Tlrc Asnciatd Gereral Cottrarlors of Ntr,rica. I AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITION5 OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American Institute of Archilects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 I, I I l t I I l T I I I o copyri8ht l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961, 1953, 1966, 1957, 1970., 1976, 1987-I997Fy TF American Insiifule of Archiiecls. Fifleenlh Edition. Reproducfion of the material herein or substantial quotation of its provisions withoul wriilen permission of lhe AIA violates the copyrighf laws of the United rrates and will subject the violate lo legal prosecution. wARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violaies U.5. ryrighl laws and will subject the violator to leSal prosecution. This documenl was electronically produced *rth permission of lhe AtA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license wilhout violafion until fhe date of expiration as noled below. User Documenf: 03 - 3nol2co4. AIA License Number lll5@7, which exDires on 5n3ir20o,4. 8 I I I l I Work, Definition of t.r.3 Written Consent r.6, 3.4.2, 3.12.8, 3.14.2, 4.t.2, 4.3.4, 4.6.4, 9.3.2, 9.8.5, 9.9.r, 9.ro.2, 9.1o.3, ll.4.r, 13.2, 13.4.2 Wrilten Interpretalions 4.2.rr, 4.2.12, 43.6 Writlen Notice 2.3,2.4, 3.3.r, 3.9, 3.12.9, 3.r2.1o, 4.3, 4.4.8, 4-6-5, 5.2.r,8.2.2, 9.7,9.ro, ro.2.2,lo. j, ll-r-3, rr.4.6, 12.2.2, 12.2.4, 13.3, r4 Wrilten Orders r.t.r,2.3, 3.9, 4.3.6,7,8.2.2, rr.4.9, r2.r, r2.2, 13.5.2, 14.3.r I t t I I ARTICLE I GENERAL PROVISIONS I.I BASIC DEFINITIONSI,I.I THE CONTRACT DOCUMENTS The Contract Documents consist of the Agreement between Orvner and Contractor (hereinafter the Agreement), Conditions of the Contract (General, Supplementary and other Conditions), Drawings, Specifications, Addenda issued prior to execution of the Conuact, other documenls listed in the Agreement and Modifications issued after execution of the Contract. A Modificalion is (r) a written arnendment to lhe Contract signed by both parties, (z) a Change Order, (3) a Construction Change Directive or (4) a written order for a minor change in the Work issued by the fuchitect. Unless specifically enumerated in the Ageement, the Contract Documents do not include other documents such as bidding requirements (advertisement or invitation to bid, Instructions to Bidders, sample forms, the Contractor's bid or portions ofAddenda relating to bidding requirements). I.I.2 THE CONTRACT The Contract Documents form the Conlract for Construction. The Contract represents the entire and integrated agreement'belween the parties hereto and supersedes prior negoliations, representations or agreemenls, either witten or oral. The Conuacl may be amended or modilied only by a Modification. The Contract Documents shall not be construed to create a contractual relationship of any kind (r) baween the Archilect and Contractor, (z) between the Owner and a Subconlractor or Sub-subcontractor, (3) between the Owner and Architect or (4) belween any persons or entilies other than the Ovr'ner and Contractor- The Architect shall, however, be entitled to performance and enforcement of obligalions under the Contract intended to facilitale performance of the Architea's duties. I,I.3 THE WORK The term "Work" means the construction and services required by the Contract Documents, whether completed or partially completed, and includes all other labor, materials, equipment and services provided or to be provided by the Conlractor to fulfill the Contractor's obligations. The Work may constitute the whole or a part of the Project. I.I,4 THE PROJECT The Proiect is the total construction of which the Work performed under the Contract Documents may be the whole or a part and which may include construction by the Owner or by separate contracton. I.I.5 THE DRAWINGS The Drawings are tbe graphic and piclorial portions of the Contract Documents showing the design, localion and dimensions of the Work, generally including plans, elevations, sections, details, scbedules and diagrams- I.I.6 THESPECIFICATIONS rHS DOCUNEN| HA' II|ffiRTN{f LEGAL cot'tsEwEt{cEs. cutsuf AnoN wf H Nt AT|ORNEY 'S ETICo/.,RAGED WTH RE PECT fO IfS COMPLETION 8 IfiOAFrcATrcN. AUI TE Nf'CAf ION OF TI45 ELTCT ROIIICAUY DMf f ED AIA DOCUMENI MAY BE MADE 8Y USNG NA DOCUMENT D&1. Ttis &cunent las fun approvd ard edord by E Asficiared C;rlrrllral Contradors of Arneica. AtA DOCUMET{T A20l - 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsIRUCTION The American lnstilufe of Archilecls 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSton, D.C. 2@06-5292 I I I i I t I ffi -01997 A|AO €, copyrighr t9lr, 1915, 19t8, 1925, 1937, 1951, '1958, 1961, t963, 1966, 1967, 1970, 1975, 1987,T9!17 by The American Insfitule of Architects. Fifleenth Edifion. Reproduction of the material herein or substanfial quotalion of its provisions withouf wrilten permission of lhe AIA violates the copyright laws of the United(tates anq will subjecl the violate lo leSal p.oseculion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. ryrighl laws and will subject the violator to legal prose(ufion. This documenl was electroniially produced ,vtlh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wifh your license without violation until the dafe ol expiralion as nofed below. User Document: 03 - 3f2c,f2@,4. AIA license Number ll'15007, which expires on 5113ncF'4. o The Specifications are that portion of the Conlract Documents consisting of the written requirements for materials, equipment, systems, standards and workmanship for the Work, and performance of relaled services. I.I.7 THE PROJECT MANUAL The Project Manual is a volume assembled for the Work which may include the bidding requirements, sample forms, Conditions of the Contract and Specifications. 1.2 CORRELATION AND INTENT OF THE CONTRACT DOCUMENTS 1,2.1 The intent of the Contract Documents is to include all items necessary for the proper execution and completion of the Work by the Contraclor. The Contract Documents are complementary, and what is required by one shall be as binding as if required by all; perfonnance by the Contractor shall be reguired only to the extent consistenl with the Contract Documents and reasonably inferable from lhem as being necessary to produce the indicated results. 1.2.2 Organizalion of the Specifications inlo divisions, sections and articles, and arangemenl of Drawings shall not control lhe Contmclor in dividing the Work among Subcontractors or in establisbing lhe extent of Work to be performed by any trade. t.2,3 Unless otherwise stated in the Contract Documents, words which have well-known technical or construclion industry meanings are used in lhe Contract Documents in accordance with such recognized meanings. I.3 CAPITALIZATION 1,3.1 Terms capitalized in these General Condilions include those which are (r) specifically defined,' (z) the titles of numbered articles and idenlified references to Paragraphs, Subparagraphs and Clauses in the document or (3) the titles ofother documents published by the American Institute of Archilects. 1.4 II{TERPREIATION 1.4.1 In the inlerest of brevity the Contract Documents frequently omit modiffing words such as 'all' and "any' and articles such as "the" and "an," but the fact that a modilier or an article is absent from one statemenl and appears in another is not inlended to affect the interpretation of either statement. I.5 EXECUTION OF CONTRACT DOCUMENTS 1.5.1 The Contract Documents shall be signed by the Owner and Contractor. If either the Or'r,ner or Contractor or both do not sign all the Contract Documents, lhe fuchitect shall identi$ such unsigned Documents upon request. 1.5.2 Execution of the Contract by the Contractor is a representation that the Contractor has visited the site, become generally familiar with local conditions under which the Work is to be performed and conelated personal obseryations with requirements of the Contract Documenls. I.6 OWNERSHIP AND USE OF DRAWINGS, SPECIFICATIONS AND OTHER INSTRUMENTS OF SERVICE 1.6.1 The Drawings, Specifications and other documents, including those in electronic form, prepared by the fuchitect and the Architect's consultants are Instruments of Service through which the Work to be executed by the Conrractor is described. The Contractor may retain one record set. Neither the Contractor nor any Subcontractor, Sub-subcontractor or malerial or equipment supplier shall own or claim a copyright in the Drawings, Specifications and other documents prepared by the Architect or the fuchitect's consultants, and unless otherwise indicaled the Architect and the Architect's consultants shall be deemed the authors of TTIS WUMENT HN 'MPoRT/'TI TTGA,I, Co,JJEo{JENCES. Cd{swf AITON WfH An ATTORNEY IS EIr.OUP,iIGED WIH RESPECT IO fis COMPITIIOTI OR MOAFrcATION. AUI'IEMrcATDN OF TIf,' EI.E CT RONICAJLY DNAF| ED HA D&UMEN| MAY BE MADT, BY USiNG NA D&UMENT D|'OI. fhis dxumn lw fuen appoved ad etfurcd by flr Asnciatd &rcrd Contracto5 of AnFjrica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRAC] FOR CONSTRUCTION t I I t I I I I t t I t t I t T I t I @ copyrighr t9lt, 19t5, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, t96t, 1963, 1966, 1967,1970, 1976, lpel, l997TtTh- American tnstitule of Archilects. Fifteenth Edifion. Reproduction of the malerial herein or substanfial The American Institule of Architects quotation of ils provisions wilhouf writlen permission of the AIA violates the copyrighf laws of the United 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. -'ales and will subjeci the violale to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violales U.5. Washington, D.C- 20@6-5292 ryright laws and will subject the violator to legal prosecution. This document was ele(tronically produced wtth permission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license wilhoul violation until the date of expiraiion as noted below. User Document: 03 - 3l202oo4. AIA License Number lll5oO7, which expires on 5ll3l2@4. 'lo - I I T i T J 3 I t I l I l I I l I I I lhem and will retain all common law, statutory and other resewed rights, in addition to the coppights. All copies of Instruments of Service, except the Conlractor's record set, shall be returned or suilably accounted for to the Architect, on iequest, upon completion of the Work. The Drawings, Specifications and other documenls prepared by the fuchitect and the Architect's consuhants, and copies thereof furnished to the Contractor, are for use solely wilh resPecl to lhis Proiecl. They are not to b€ used by the Conlractor or any Subcontractor, Sub- subcontractor or material or equipment supplier on other projects or for additions to this Proiect outside the scope of the Work without the specific written consent of the Owner, Architect and the Architecl's consultants. The Contraclor, Sukontractors, Sub-subcontractors and material or equipment suppliers are authorized lo use and reproduce applicable portions of the Drawings, Specifications and other documents prepared by the fuchitect and the fuchitect's consultanls appropriate to and for use in the execution of their Work under the Contract Documents. All copies made under this authorizalion shall bear the statutory copyright notice, ifany, shown on the Drawings, Specifications and other docurnents prepared by the Architect and the fuchitect's consultants- Submittal or distribution to meei oflicial regulatory requirements or for other purposes in connection with this Proiect is not lo be construed as publication in derogation ofthe Architect's or Architect's consuhants' copyrights or other reserved rights. ARTICLE 2 OWNER 2.1 GENERAL 2.1.1 The Owner is the person or entity identified as such in the Agreement and is refened to throughout the Contract Documents as ifsingular in number. The Owner shall designate in writing a representalive who shall have express authority to bind the Owner with respect 1o all matlers requiring lhe Owner's approval or authorization. Except as otherwise provided in Subparagraph 4.r.r, the fuchitect does not have such authority. The term "Owner" means the Owner or the Owner's authorized representalive. 2.1.2 The Owner shall furnish to the Conlractor within fifteen days after receipt of a wdtten request, information necessary and relevant for the Contractor to evaluate, give notice of or enforce mechanic's lien rights. Such infiormation shall include a conect slatement of the record legal litle to the property on which the Project is located, usually referred lo as the site, and the Owner's interest therein. 2.2 INFORMATION AND SERVICES REQUIRED OF THE OWNER 2.2.1 The Owner shall, at the written requesl of lhe Contraclor, prior to commencement of the Work and thereafter, fumish to the Contractor reasonable evidence that financial arrangements have been made to fulfill the Owner's obligations under the Contract. Furnishing of such evidence shall be a condition precedent to commencement or continuation of thi Work. After such evidence has been furnished, the Owner shall not materially vary such financial arrangements wilhout prior notice to the Contmctor. 2.2.2 Excepl for permits and fees, including those required under Subparagraph 3.7.r, which are lhe responsibility ofthe Contractor under the Contract Documents, the Owner shall secure and pay for necessary approvals, €asements, assessments and charges required for construction, use ol occuPancy ofpermanent structures or for permanent changes in existing facilities. 2.2.3 The Owner shall furnish suweys describing physical characteristics, legal limitations and utility locations for the sile of the Proiect, and a legal description of the site. The Contractor shall be entitled lo rely on the accuracy of informCtion furnished by lhe Owner but shall exercise proper precautions relating to the safe performance ofthe Work. 2.2.4 Information or services required of the Owner by the Contracl Documents shall be fumished by the Owner with reasonable promptness. Any other information or services relevant lo the Contractor's performance of the Work under the Owner's control shall be American Instifute of Ar(hile(ts. Fifleenth Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or substintial quotationof iis provisions wifhout written permission oi the AIA violates the copyright laws of lhe United <tafes and will subjecl fhe violate to legal prosecution- WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violafes U.5. :yrighl laws and will subject the violator lo legal prose<ution. This documenl was electi6ni-lly produced ,,tlh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without vioialion until the date of expiration as noled below. User Document: 03 - }lZgtlOO4. AIA License Number I l'l5OO7, which expires on 511Y2@4. l.l fl{s DOCUMTNT H/3 MrcRf N'IT 'TGALCOMEOUEI/GES, CONSULI Af ION WITH AI'I ATTORNEY 15 ENCOURAGED WfH RE PECI lO tt' COMPLEITON On MODIFICATION. AUf HENIICATION OF TIiIS EECI NONCAJIY DMff ED NA NCUMEN| MAY BE MADE BY 'J'ING NA DOCUMENI D&I, This document lw been approved ard edorsd by Ifu Associatd Gereral Contrcclors of ArrF.]rica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITION5 OF THE CONTRACT FOR CON5TRUCTION The American Instilute of Archilectt 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 furnished by the Owner after receipt from the Conlractor of a written request for such inlormation or services. 2.2.5 Unless otherwise provided in lhe Contracl Documents, the Contractor will be furnished, free of charge, such copies of Drawings and Proiecl Manuals as are reasonably necessary for execution of the Work. 2.3 OWNER'S RIGHT TO STOP THE WORK 2.3.1 If the Contractor fails to conect Work which is not in accordance with the requirements of the Conlract Documenls as required by Paragraph tu.2 or persistently fails to carry oul Work in accordance with the Contmct Documents, the Owner may issue a written order to the Contractor to slop the Work, or any portion thereof, until the cause for such order has been eliminated; however, the righl of the Owner to stop the Work shall not give rise to a duty on the part of the Owner to exercise this right for the benefit of the Contrlctor or any other person or entity, except to the extent required by Subparagraph 6.1.3. 2.4 OWNER'S RIGHT TO CARRY OUT THE WORK 2.4.1 If lhe Contractor defaults or neglects to carry out the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents and fails within a seven-day period aff.er receipt of written notice ftom the Owner to commence and continue conection ofsuch default or neglect with diligence and promptness, lhe Owner may after such seven-day period give the Contractor a second written notice to correct such deficiencies within a three-day period. If rhe Contractor within such three-day period after receipt ofsuch second nolice fails to commence and continue to correct any deficiincies, the Ownei may, without preiudice to other remedies lhe Ovrner may have, correct such deficiencies. In sucb case an appropriate Change Order shall be issued deducting {ro1n payments then or thereafter due the Contractor the reasonable cost of conecting sucf, deficiencies, including Owner's expenses and compensation for lhe Architect's additional services made necessary by such default, neglect or failure. Such action by the Owner and amounts charged to the Contractor are both subiect to prior approval of the Architect. If payments then or thereafter due the Contraclor are not suflicient lo cover such amounts, the Contractor shall pay the difference to the Owner. iTICLE 3 COI{TRACTOR 3.I GENERAL 3.1,1 The Contractor is the person or entity identified as such in the Agreement and is refened to throughout the Contract Documents as if singular in number. The term "Contractor" means the Contractor or the Contractor s aulhorized representative. 3.1.2 The Contractor shall petform the Work in accordance with the Conlract Documents. 3.1'3 The Contractor shall not be relieved of obligations to perform the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents either by activitjes or duties of the Architect in the Architect's administration of the Contract, or by tests, inspeclions or approvals required or performed by persons other than the Contractor. 3.2 REVIEW OF CONTRACT DOCUMENTS AND FIETD CONDITIONS BY CONTRACTOR 3,2.1 Since the Contract Documents are complementary, before starting each portion of the Work, the Contractor shall carefully study and compare the various Drawings and other Conttact Documents relative lo that portion of the Work, as well as the information furnished by the Owner pulsuan! to Subparagraph 2.2.3, shall take field measurements of any existing conditions related to that portion of the Work and shall observe any conditions at the site affecring it. These obligations are for lhe purpose of facilitating construction by the Contractor and are not for the purpose ofdiscovering enors, omissions, or inconsislencies in the Contract Documents; however, any enors, inconsislencies or omissions discovered by the Contractor O Copyright l9ll, 1915, l9l8; American Inslilute of Archifecls. Fifteenth Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or substintial quotation of its provisions wilhoui wrillen permission of fhe AIA violates the copyright laws of the United slates and will sublect the violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed phofocopying violates U.5. ryriSht laws and will subjecf the violator to legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced ..rlh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without vioiafion until lhe dafe of exPiraiion as noied below. User Documenl: 03 - 3n0,l2cp,4. AIA License Number lll5OO7, which expires on 5/IY2OO4. l2 T T ) I T']S DOCUMENT HN MMTN'IT LEGAL CONSEQUENCES, CONSULIAI'O'T WI1H AN A AffoRNEY tt ENCOUQAGEDWfiH I MSPECI fO tf' COMPtEftON OR MODIFICA|ION. AUTHENI'CA{ION OF TI.TS ..^ ELECIROMC TY DRA'IED NA t DOcutvENr MAY Bt M DE 8Y ustttc NA IDOCUMENI D$'. fhis documen lw fuen approvd and erdorsd by llte Associatd Gersal Contrcctors of AnBrica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnstitute of Archife€ts 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 T i I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I l I I I I I I shall be reported promptly to the Architect as a request for information in such form as the Architect may require. 3.2.2 Any design errors or omissions noted by the Contractor during this review shall be reported promptly lo the Architect, bul it is recognized that the Conlractor's review is made in the Conlractor's capacity as a contraclor and not as a licensed design professional unless otherwise specifically provided in the Contract Documents. The Conlractor is not re<luired to ascerlain thal the Conlract Documents are in accordance with applicable laws, statutes, ordinances, building codes, and rules and regulations, but any nonconformity discovered by or made known to the Contractor shall be reported promptly to the Architect. 3.2.3 lf the Contractor believes that additional cost or time is involved because of clarifications or instruclions issued by the fuchitect in response to the Conlractor's notices or requests for information pursuanl. to Subparagraphs 3.2.r and 3.2.2, the Contractor shall make Claims as provided in Subparagraphs 4.3.e and 4.3.2. If the Contractor fails to perform the obligalions of Subparagraphs 3.2.r and 3.2.2, the Conlractor shall pay such costs and damages to the Owner as would have been avoided if the Conlractor had performed such obligations. The Contractor shall not be liable to the Owner or Architect for damages resulting from erron, inconsistencies or omissions in the Contract Documents or for differences between lield measurements or conditions and the Contract Documents unless the Contractor recognized such enor, inconsistency, omission or difference and knowingly failed to report it to the Architect. 3,3 SUPERVISION AND CONSTRUCTION PROCEDURES 3,3.1 The Contractor shall supervise and direcl the Work, using the Conlractor's best skill and attention. The Contractor shall be solely responsible for and have control over construction means, methods, techniques, sequences and procedures and for coordinating all portions ofthe Work under the Contract, unless the Conlract Documents give other specific instructions .concerning these matters. If the Contract Documents give specific instructions concerning construction means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures, the Contractor shall evaluate the jobsite safety thereof and, except as stated below, shall be fully and solely responsible for the iobsite safety ofsuch mears, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures. If the Contractor determines that such means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures may not be safe, the Contraclor shall give timely written notice to the Ovmer and fuchitect and shall nor proceed with that portion of the Work withoul further written instructions ftom the fuchitect. If the Contractor is then instructed to proceed with the required means, methods, lechniques, sequences or procedures without acceptance of changes proposed by the Contractor, the Owner shall be solely responsible for any resulting loss or damage. 3.3.2 The Contractor shall be responsible to the Owner for acts and omissions of the Conlractor's employees, Subcontractors and their agents and employees, and other persons or entities performing portions of the Work for or on behalf of the Contractor or any of its Subcontractors. 3,3.3 The Contractor shall be responsible for inspection of portions of Work already performed to determine that such portions are in proper condition to receive subsequent Work. 3.4 LABOR AND MATERIAIS 3.4.1 Unless olherwise provided in the Contract Documents, the Contractor shall provide and pay for labor, materials, equipment, tools, construction equipment and machinery, water, heat, utilities, transportation, and other facilities and services necessary for proper execution and completion of rhe Work, whether temporary or permanent and whether or not incorporated or to be incorporated in the Work. 3.4,2 The Contractor may make substitutions only with the consent of the Owner, after evaluation by the Architecl and in accordance with a Change Order. @ Copyright l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961, 1963, 1956, 1967, 1970, 1976, 1987, 1997 by The Ameri€an Insfitute of Archile(ls. Fifteenth Edition. Reoroduction of the material herein or substanlial quofation of its provisions wilhoul writlen permission oi the AIA violates the copyright laws of the United-'ates and will subject the violale to legal prorecution. WARNTNG: Unlicensed photocopying violales U.S. pyrighf laws and will subjecl the violator to leSal prose(ution. This documenl was eleclronically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license without violalion until fhe date of expiralion as noted below. User Document: 03 - l/2O20O4. AIA License Number ltl5@7, which expires on 5ll3l2@4. l3 f tt' DOCUMEN| Hr'6,MrcRIN,lf lfGAL CONSEOUENCES. COI/dULIAIION W'fH NI AIIORNEY IS ENCo4JPLAGED WfH RESPECT IO IfS COMPLETION OR toDtf ICATION. AUTHENI,CATION OF It*S ELTCI RONICNTY DR/ffED NA DOCUT'IENT MAY U MADE 8Y UStt{G AIA DOCUMENT W)1. Ihis docuncnt lps fuen approved and etdorsed by llrc Asso<iatd General Contractors of AlrE ca. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDI]IONs OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnstilute of Archifects u35 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20m6-5292 - T I3'4.3 The Contractor shall enforce strict discipline and good order among the Contractor's employees and other persons carrying out the Contract. The Contractor shall not permit employment of unfit persons or persons not skilled in tasks assigned to them. 3.5 WARRANry 3.5.1 The Contractor warranls to the Owner and Archilect that rnaterials and equipment furnished under the Contract will be of good quality and new unless otherwise required or permitted by the Contract Documents, lhat the Work will be free from defects not inherent in the quality required or permilted, and that tbe Work will conform to the requirements of the Contract Documents. Work not conforming to these requirements, including substitutions nol ProPe4y approved and authorized, may be considered defective. The Contractor's warranty excludes remedy for damage or defect caused bv abuse, modifications not executed by thl Contractor, improper or insufficient maintenance, improper operation, or normal wear and tear_ and normal usagg. If-required by the Architect, lhe Contractor shall furnish satisfactory evidence as to the kind and quality of materials and equipment. 3.6 TAXES 3.6.1 The Contractor shall pay sales, consumer, use and similar taxes for the Work provided by the Contractor which are legally enacted when bids are received or negotiations concluded, whelher or not yet effective or merely scheduled to go into effect. 3.7 PERMITS, FEES AND NOTICES 3'7.1 Unless otherwise provided in the Contract Documents, the Contractoi shall secure and pay for the building permit and other permits and governmenlal fees, licenses and inspeclions necessary for proper execution and completion of the Work which are customarily secured after execution ofthe Contract and v/hicb are legally required when bids are received or negotiations concluded. 3.7.2 The Contractor shall comply with and give notices required by laws, ordinances, rules, regulations and lawful orden of public authorities applicable to performance of tbe Worlc 3,7'3 It is not the Contractor's responsibility to ascertain that the Contract Documents arein accordance with applicable laws, statutes, ordinances, building codes, and rules and regulations. However, if the Contractor observes that portions oflhe Contract Documents are at variance therewilh, tbe Contractor shall promptly notifr the fuchitect and Owner in writing, and necessary changes shall be accornplished by appropriate Modification. 3.7.4 If the Contractor performs Work knowing it to be contrary to laws, statutes, ordinances, building codes, and rules and regulations without such notice to the Architect and Owner, the Contractor shall assume appropriate responsibility for such Work and shall bear the costs attributable to correction. 3.8 ALLOWANCES 3,8,1 The Contractor shall include in the Contract Sum all allowances staled in the Conlract Documenls. Items covered by allowances shall be supplied for such amounts and by such persons or entities as the Owner may direct, but the Contractor shall not be required to employ persons or entities to whom the Contractor has reasonable obiection. 3.8,2 Unless otherwise provided in the Contract Docurnenls: .l allowances shall cover tbe cosl to tbe Contractor of materials and equipment delivered at tbe site and all required taxes, less applicable trade discounts; @ copyriShr l9I. r9rs, 1918, r92s, 1937, r95r, 1958, 1961, 't963, 1965, 1967, 1970, rt6J98-Tgg7-5y ThF Ameri€an Instifute of Architects. Fiffeenth Edition. Reproduction of lhe material herein or substintial quolation of ils provisions without writlen permission of rhe AIA violates the copyright laws of the United(tates and will subject lhe violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. :yright laws and will subiect rhe violafor to legal prosecution. This document was elecfroniially produced .vith permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until the date o{ expiration as noled below. User Documenl: O} - y2c,l2cn,4. AIA License Number lll5oO7. which expires on 5ll3l20p'4. 14 -1 T f llt' DOCUMEN| HtS MnRTNlf LICrltt co^rSEwENcE . cot'tsuLtATrot! w,TH Alt la ATIORNEY tS ENCOURAaED WfiH IRE'trCt fO tt' COII/P|-EIiOi{ OR tytOAFrcAf ,o/t. AUfHENITAqON OF Tl4S E TCTNOMC/J.LY OffeFTED AIA WUMEN| MAY U MADE Tf USIIIG NA oocuMEll,f wt. flis docunrent lw t*en approvd ard erfursd by llr- lssuiated Geteral Contradors of America. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAL CONOIIIONS Of THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The Amerkan Instituie of Architecfs '1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 2O0o5-5292 I T t I I I I I I I I t I I I I I I l l I I I T I I I I I .2 Contractor's cosls for unloading and handling at the site, labor, installalion costs, overhead, prolit and olher expenses contemplated for stated allowance amounls shall be included in the Contract Sum but not in the allowances; .3 whenever costs are more than or less than allowances, the Contract Sum shall be adjusled accordingly by Change Order. The amount of the Change Order shall reflect (r) the difference between actual costs and the allowances under Clause 3.8.2.r and (z) changes in Contraclor's €osts under Clause 3.8.2.u. 3,8,3 Materials and equipment under an allowance shall be selected by the Owner in suflicienl time to avoid delay in the Work. 3.9 sUPERlNTENDENI 3,9.1 The Contractor shall ernploy a competent superintendenl and necessary assistants who shall be in attendance at the Protect site during performance of the Work. The superintendent shall represent the Contractor, and communications given to the superintendent shall be as binding as if given to the Contractor. Important communications shall be confirmed in wrifing. Other communications shall be similarly confirmed on w tten requesl in each case. 3.IO CONTRACTOR'SCONSTRUCTION SCHEDULES 3.lo.l Tbe Contractor, promptly after being awarded the Contract, shall prepare and submit for the Owner's and fuchitect's information a Contractor's construction schedule for the Work. The schedule shall not exceed lime limits cunenl under the Contract Documents, shall be revised al appropriate intervals as required by the conditions ofthe Work and Proiect, shall be related to the entire Project to the extent required by the Contract Documents, and shall provide for expeditious and praclicable execulion ofthe Work. 3.10.2 The Contractor shall prepare and keep current, for lhe fuchitect's approval, a schedule of submittals which is coordinated with the Contractor's construclion schedule and allows the Architect reasonable time to review submittals. 3,10.3 The Contractor shall perform rhe Work in general accordance wilh rhe mosl recenl schedules submilted to the Owner and Architecl- 3.II DOCUMENT5 AND SAMPLES AT THE 5ITE3.ll.l The Contractor shall maintain at the site for the Owner one record copy of the Drawings, Specifications, Addenda, Change Orders and other Modifications, in good order and marked currently to record field changes and selections made during consuuction, and one record copy of approved Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples and similar required submittals. These shall be available to the Architect and shall be delivered to the Architect for submittal to the Owner upon completion of the Work. 3.I2 SHOP DRAWINGS, PRODUCT DATA AND SAMPIES 3.12.1 Shop Drawings are drawings, diagams, schedules and other data specially prepared for the Work by lhe Contractor or a Subcontractor, Sub.subconlractor, manufacturer, supplier or distributor to illustrate some portion of the Work. 3,12.2 Product Data are illustrations, standard schedules, performance charts, instructions, brochures, diagrams and other information furnished by the Contractor lo illustrale materials or equipment for some portion of the Work. 3,12,3 Samples are physical examples which illustrate materials, equipment or workmanship and establish standards by which the Work will be iudged. tl'tl9 DOCUMEN| HAS tt'trcRr&tr LEGAL CONSEQUENCES, CONSULrAIIOAI WfH NI ATTORNEY I5 ENCo/./RAGED WITH RESP€Cr TO IfS COMPIETION OR MODIFICAIION, AUf IIENTrcAI/oN OF f'{S ELTCI RONICAIIY DMFTED NA DXUMEN| MAY BE MADE, BY USING NA DOCUMENI DEI. fhis document has been approvd ard edorced bv lllr- Asmciated Gened Contr actori of Amer ica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT IOR CONsTRUCTION The American Insiilute of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W- Washington, D.C. 20@6-5292 € copyr8hr le , rers, rer8, 1925, 't937, 19s't, 1958, 1951, 1953, 1965, 1957, 't97O, 't976, 1987, 1997 by The American lnstiiute of Architects. Fifleenrh Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or subsfantial quofafion of its provisions wilhod writien permission of the AIA violafes the (opyright laws of the United stales and will subject the violate to leSal prosecuiion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violafes U.5. :yright laws and will subjecr the violator to legal prosecuiion. This document was electronically produced ,{ilh P€rmission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your licenre without violation unlil lhe dale of erpiration as noted below. User Document: O3 - 312A2cF.4. AIA License Number lll5oO7. which expires on 5/1Y20O4. l5 I 3.12.4 Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples and similar submittals are not Conlract Documenls. The purpose of their submittal is lo demonstrate for lhose portions of the Work for which submittals are required by the Contract Documenls the way by which the Contractor proposes to conform to the information given and the design concept expressed in the Conlract Documenls. Review by the Architect is subject to the limitations of Subparagraph 4.2.2. lnformational submiltals upon which the fuchitect is not expecled to take responsive action may be so identified in the Contract Documents. Submittals which are not required by the Contract Documents may be returned by the Architect without action. 3.12.5 The Contraclor shall review for compliance wilh the Contract Documents, approve and submit to the Architect Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples and similar submittals required by the Contracl Documents with reasonable promptness and in such sequence as to cause no delay in the Work or in the activities of the Owner or of separate contractors. Submittals which are not marked as reyiewed for compliance with the Contract Documents and approved by the Contractor may be returned by the Architect without action. 3.12.6 By approving and submitting Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples and similar submittals, the Contractor represents that the Contraclor has determined and verified materials, {ield measurements and field construction criteria related thereto, or will do so, and has checked and coordinated the information contained within such submittals with the requirements of tbe Work and of the Contract Documents. 3.12.7 The Contractor shall perform no portion of the Work for which the Contract Documents require submittal and review of Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples or similar submitlals unlil the respective submittal has been approved by the Architect. 3.12.8 Tbe Work shall be in accordance with approved submitlals except that the Contractor shall not be relieved of responsibility for deviations from requirements of lhe Contract Documents by the fuchitect's approval of Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples or similar submittals unless the Contractor has specilically informed tbe Architect in writing of such deviation al the time of submittal and (r) the fuchitect has given written approval to the specific deviation as a minor change in the Work, or (z) a Change Order or Construction Change Directive has been issued authorizing the deviation. The Contractor shall not be relieved of responsibility for errors or omissions in Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples or similar submittals by the fuchitect's approval thereof. 3.12.9 The Contractor shall direct specific attention, in writing or on resubmiued Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples or similar submittals, lo r€visions other than those requested by the Architect on previous submittals. In tbe absence of such written notice the fuchilect's approval ofa resubmission shall not apply to such revisions, 3.l2.lO The Contractor shall not be required to provide professional services which constitute the practice of architecture or engineering unless such services are specifically required by fhe Contract Documents for a portion of the Work or unless the Contractor needs to provide such services in order to carry out the Contractor's responsibilities for construclion means, melhods, lechniques, sequences and procedures. The Contractor shall not be required to provide professional services in violation of applicable law. If professional design services or certilications by a design professional related to systems, materials or equipment arc specifically required of the Conlractor by the Contract Documents, lhe Owner and the Architect will specifr all performance and design criteria that such services must satisff. The Contractor shall cause such sewices or certifications to be provided by a properly licensed design professional, whose signature and seal shall appear on all drawings, calculations, specilications, certifications, Shop Drawings and other submittals prepared by such professional. Shop Drawings and other submittals related to the Work designed or certified by such professional, if prepared by others, shall bear such professional's written approval when submitted to the Architect. The Owner and the Architect shall be entitled to rely upon the adequacy, accuracy and completeness ofthe @ copyrighl l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961, 1963, 1966, 1967, 1970, 1975, lgStl9CIEy Tha American Institute of Archileds. Fifteenlh Edifion. Reproduction of the material herein or substantial quolalion of its provisions without wrilten permission of the AIA violater lhe copyright laws of the United(tates and will subiecf the violate lo legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violafes U.5. :yright laws and will sublect the violalor fo legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced ,,/ith permission of the AtA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license withouf violation until the date of expiration as noled below. User Document: 03 - 3!2c,/2cn,4. AIA License Number Ill5OO7, which expires on 511312@4. l6 t I t I I TttS DOCUMEM HA6,tvrcRf NIT IEGAL cot6EauENcE5. cotif,uTAttov wtrH N,r f AffoRNEYtSENCOttP./|GEDyy/,fH tRESPfCI fO tf' COMWflON On MOD'EICAT'ON. AUrHENiICAT'ON OF f '45ELECiRON|CALLY Dfl/'ffED NA I DOCUMENI MAY BE MADE 8Y U''NG NA f DOCUMENI DIDI. |' flis docurnent lps been approvd and I erdorsd bv lfr- Associatd General IContractort of An|F"rica t 01997 A|AO AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAL CONDIIION5 OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCTION The American Institule of Architects 1735 New York Avenue. N.W. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 I I t I t I I I I $ffi I I I services, certifications or approvals performed by such design professionals, provided the Owner and Architect have specified to the Contractor all performance and design criteria that such services must salisff. Pursuant lo this Subparagraph 3.rz..ro, the Architect will review, approve or take other appropriate action on submittals only for the limited purpose ofchecking for conformance with information given and the design concept expressed in the Conlract Documenls. The Contractor shall not be responsible for the adequacy of the performance or design criteria required by the Contract Documents. 3.13 USE OF S|TE 3.13,1 The Contractor shall confine operations at the site to areas permitted by law, ordinances, permits and the Contract Documents and shall not unreasonably encumber the site wilh materials or equipmenl. 3.14 CUTTING AND PATCHING 3.14.1 The Contractor shall be responsible for cutting,, fitting or patchilg required to cornplete the Work or to make its parts fit together properly. 3.14,2 The Contractor sball not damage or endanger a portion of the Work or fully or partially completed conslruction of the Owner or separate contractors by cutting, palching or otherwise altering such construction, or by excavation. The Contractor shall not cut or otherwise alter such construclion by rhe Ovmer or a separate contractor except with wrilten consent of the Owner and of such separate contractor; such consent shall not be unreasonably witbheld. The Contractor shall not unreasonably withhold from the Oryner or a separate contraclor the Conlractor's consent to cutting or oiherwise altering the Work. 3.I5 CLEANING UP 3,15.1 The Contractor shall keep the premises and surrounding area free from accumulation. of wasle materials or rubbish caused by operations under the Contract. At completion of the Work, the Contractor shall remove from and about the Proiect waste materials, rubbish, the Contractor's tools, construction equipment, machinery and surplus materials. 3,15.2 If the Contractor fails to clean up as provided in the Contract Documents, the Owner may do so and the cost thereofshall be charged to Ge Conlractor. 3.16 ACCESS TO WORK 3.16,1 The Contractor shall provide the Owner and Architect access to the Work in preparation and progress wherever located. 3,17 ROYALTIES, PATENTS AND COPYRIGHTS 3.17'l The Contractor shall pay all royalties and license fees. The Contractor shall defend suits or claims for infringement of copyrights and patent rights and shall hold the Owner and Architect harmless from loss on account thereof, but shall not be responsible for such defense or loss when a particular design, process or product of a particular manufacturer or manufacturers is required by the Contract Documents or where the copyright violations are contained in Drawings, Specilications or other documents prepared by the Owner or Archilect. However, if the Contractor has reason to believe that the required design, process or product is an inllingement of a copyrighl or a patenl, the Contractor shall be responsible for such loss unless such information is promptly furnished to the Architect. 3.18 INDEMNIFICATION 3.18.1 To the fullest extent permitted by law and to the extent claims, damages, Iosses or I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I f I4S DOCUMENT HAS IMrcRfN,If ITGAL COI{sEOUENCES. COMULiAI'ON WIf H NI ATfORNEY IS ENCoi'/R,/GED WITH NESPECT TO ITS COMftETION ON WDIFICA|'ON. AJf HENTrcAT'ON OF THS EUC| RONC//.LY DMF| ED NA DOCUMEN| MAY BE MADE BY USING NA DOCUMENI UIO'. TNs docunent has been approved arl edorsed by lttr- Associatd Gerpral Conlrxtors of Anerica. exPenses are not covered by Proiect ManaBement Protective Liability insurance purcbased by the Contractor in accotdance with Paragraph u.3, the Conlractor shall indemnlfr and hold o.Bs7 ArAo harmless the Owner, Archilect, Architect's consultants, and agenls and employees of any of nf,n ooiuf'tf Hf A2ol - 1997 them from and against claims, damages, losses and expenses, including but nor limited to GENERAL coNDtTtoNs oF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION American Institute of Architects. Fifteenth Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or substantial The American Instifute of Archilecls quolation of ils provisions wifhout wrillen permission of lhe AIA violales the copyright laws of the Uniled U35 New York Avenue, N.w. <rates an9 will sublecr. rhe violate lo legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed phofocopying violates U.5. Washington, D.C. 20@6-5292 :yright laws and will subject fhe violalor to legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced .eilh Permission of fhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until the dale of expiralion as noted below. User Documenl: Ol - l/2Ol2OO4. AIA License Number lll5OO7, which expires on 5/lY2OO4. t7 - altorneys' fees, arising out of or resulting from performance of the Work, provided that such claim, damage, loss or expense is attributable to bodily injury, sickness, disease or death, or to injurv to or deslruction oftangible property (other than the Work ilself), bul only to the extent caused by the negligent acts or omissions of the Contractor, a Subcontraclor, anyone directly or indirectly employed by them or anyone for whose acts lhey may be liable, regardless ofwhether or not such claim, damage, loss or expense is caused in part by a party indemnified hereunder. Such obligation shall not be construed to negate, abridge, or reduce olher rights or obligations of indemnity which would otherwise exist as to a party or person described in this Paragraph 3.18. 3.18.2 In claims against any person or enlily indemnified under this Paragraph 3.r8 by an employee of the Conlractor, a Sukontractor, anyone direclly or indirectly employed by them or anyone for whose acts they may be liable, the indemnification obligation under Subparagraph 3.r8.r shall not be linrited by a limitation on amount or type of damages, compensation or benefits payable by or for the Contractor or a Subcontractoi under workers' compensation acts, disability b€nefit acts or other employee benefit acts. ARTICLE 4 ADMINISTRATION OF THE CONTRACT 4.I ARCHITECT 4.1.1 The Architect is the person lawfully licensed to practice architecture or an entity lawfulty practicing architecture identified as such in the Agreement and is referred to throughout the Contract Documents as if singular in number. The term "Architect" means the Architect or the Architect's authorized representative. I I I I I I TI4S DXUMEM HAS 'MNRTNTI LEGAL cottsEOtJENcEs. cottsuljAn?N wrH Anr IArTONIEY,SEI{r.OUF,,.GEDW,IH T RESPfCT TO NS COMPIEIION OR II&AF'CAI Iq{. AUTHEMICAI ION OF T HS EITCI ROT,IICAITY DRAFIEDAIA I DOCUMENr MAY BE MADE 8Y USttJc NA ll DOCUMENI D$)r. v fhis document lw been apgovd ard 4.1,2 Duties, responsibilities and limitations of authority of the Architect as set forth 1n 11. erdorsedby fiE Associatd &rctal Contract Documenti shall not be reslricted, modified or exlended without written consent of contrxtort of Anerica the Owner, Contraclor and Architect. Consent shall not be unreasonably withheld. 4.1.3 If the employment of the Archilect is terminated, the Owner shall employ a new Architect against whom the Contraclor has no reasonable obiection and whose status under the Contract Documents shall be that of the former Architect. 4.2 ARCHITECT'S ADMINISTRATION OF THE CONTRACT 4.2,1 The fuchitect will provide administration of the Contract as described in the Contract Documents, and will be an Owner's representative (r) during construction, (z) until final paymgnt is due and (f) with the Owner's concurrence, from time to tirne during the one-year period for correction of Work described jn Paragraph rz.z. The Architect will have authority to act on behalf of the Owner only lo the exlent provided in the Contract Documents, uniess otherwise modified in writing in accordance with other provisions of the Contract. 4.2.2 The Architect, as a repres€ntative of the Owner, will visit the site at intervals appropriate to the stage of the Contractor's operations (r) to become generally hmiliar wifh and to keep the Owner informed about the progress and quality of the portion of the Work compleled, (z) to endeavor to g,uard the Owner against defects and deficiencies in fhe Work, and (l) to determine in general if lhe Work is being performed in a manner indicating that the Work, when fully compleled, will be in accordance with the Contract Documents. Howwer, the Architect will not be required to make exhaustive or continuous on-site inspections to check the quality or quantity of the Work. The Architect will neither have contiol over or charge of, nor be responsible for, the construclion means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures, or for the safety precautions and programs in connection wirh the Wbrk, since these are solely the Contractor's righls and responsibilities under the Contnct Documents, excepl as provided in Subparagraph 3.3.r. 4.2.3 The Architect will not be responsible for the Contractor's failure to p€rform the Work in accordance with the requirements of the Contract Documents. The Architect will not have conlrol over or charge of and will not be responsible for acts or omissions of the Contractor, I T I I I I I I I I I T AtA DOCUMET{T A20l - 1997 GENERAL CONDITION5 OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION @ copyriSht l9ll, 19t5, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1951, 1963, 1966, 1967, l97O; Ita6: 1962-IB75| Americari Institure of Architects. Fifteenth Edition. Reproduction of the mateiial herein or substlntial The Amerk€n Instifute of Architects quotation of ils provisions without writlen permission oi the ela violate! fhe copyright laws of the g^it.6 'U35,lew York Avenue, N.W. lles and will subject lhe violafe to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed ihoiropying violates U.5. WashinSfon, D.C.20@6-5292 pyright laws and will subjecr lhe violator to legal proseculion. This document was electroniially produced wilh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wifh your license wilhouf violalion until the date of expiration as noted below. User Do€umenf: Oi -- 3l2Df2@4. AIA License Number'lll5@7, which expires on 511312004. 't8 I I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I Subconlractors, or their agents or employees, or any other persons or entities performing portions of lhe Work. 4,2,4 Communicalions FacilitafinS Contract Administration. Excepr as orherwise provided in the Contract Documents or when direct communications have been specially iuthorized, the Owner and Contractor shall endeavor to communicate with each other through the Architect aboul matters arising out of or relating 1o lhe Contract. Communications by and with the Architect's consultants shall be through the Architect. Communications by and with Subcontractors and material supplien shall be through the Contractor. Communications by and with separate contraclors shall be through the Owner. 4.2,5 Based on the Architect's evaluations of the Contractor's Applicalions for Paymenl, the Architect will review and certifr the amounts due the Contractor and will issue Certificates for Payment in such amounts. 4.2.6 The Architect will have authority to reiect Work that does not conform to the Contract Documents. Whenever the Architect considers it necessary or advisable, the Architect will have authority to require inspection or testing of the Work in accordance with Subparagraphs 13.5.2 and 13.5.3, whether or not such Work is fabricated, installed or compl€ted. Howwet, neither this authority of the Architect nor a decision made in good faith either to exercise or not to exercise such authority shall give rise to a duty or responsibility of the Architect to the Contractor, Subcontractors, material and equipment suppliers, their agents or employees, or other percons or entities performing portions of the Work. 4.2.7 The fuchitect will review and approve or take other appropriate action upon the Contractor's submittals such as Shop Drawings, Product Data and Samples, but only for lhe limited purpose of checking for conformance with information given and the design concept expressed in the Contract Documents. The Architect's action will be taken with such reasonable promptness as to caus€ no delay in the Work or in the activities of the Owner, Conlractor or separate conlractors, while allowing sufficient time in the Architect's professional iudgment to permit adequate review. Review of such submittals is not conducted for the purpose of determining the accuracy and cornpleteness of other details such as dimensions and quantities, or for substantiating instructions for installation or performance of equipment or systems, all of which remain the responsibility of the Contraclor as required by the Contract Documents. The Architect's review of the Contraclor's submittals shall not relieve the Contractor of lhe obligations under Paragraphs 3.3, l.j and 3.r2. The Architect's review shall nol constitute approval of safety precautions or, unless otherwise specifically $ated by tbe Architect, of any conslruction means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures. The fuchitect's approval of a specilic item shall not indicate approval ofan assembly of which the item is a component. 4.2.8 The Architect will prepare Change Orders and Construction Change Directives, and may authorize minor changes in the Work as provided in Paragraph 7.4. 4.2.9 The Architect will conduct inspections to determine the date or dates of Substantial Complefon and the date of 6nal completion, will receive and forward to the Owner, for the Owner's review and records, writlen warranties and related documents required by the Contract and assembled by the Contractor, and will issue a final Certificate for Payment upon compliance wilh the requirements of the Contract Documents. 4.2,10 If the Owner and Architect agree, lhe Architect will provide one or rnore project represenlatives to assist in carrying out the Architect's responsibilities at lhe site. The duties, responsibilities and limitalions of authorily ofsuch project representatives shall be as set forth in an exhibit to be incorporated in lhe Contract Docurnents. 4.2.11 The Architect will interpret and decide matters concerning performance under and requiremenls of, the Contract Documents on wdtten requesl of either the Owner or @ copyrlghr re , 1915, t918, l92t t937, 1951, 1958, 1951, 1963, t966, 1967, 1970, 1976, 1987, t997 by The American Insfitule of Architects. Fiffeenth Edition. Reoroduction of the material herein or substantial quoration of ils provisions wilhout writlen permission of the AtA violates the copyright laws of the United 'lates and will sublecl fhe violate io leSal prosecufion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violales U.5. )yright laws and will subject lhe violator to legal prosecufion. This document was electronically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license wilhout violation until the date of expiration as noled below. User Document: 03 - y2A2@4. AIA License Number 'ltl5OO7, which expires on 5lly2@4. l9 Il4S DOCUIIENI HAS D4rcRfAtlf ttcr4l colvjEouEt'tcEs. coNsuLfAf,oN w,fH Nt ATIOR|dEY IS EIICOUFd,GED WIf H RESPECT fO 'TS COMPIEI'ON OR MO FrcAIION. AUTHENTICAIION OT fHS E'TC| RONC NLY DNAF TED NA DOCUMEM MAY 8E MADE 8Y USING NA DOCUMENT DNI. This docunent lps been approvd and etdorsd by ffu Associald Gercrd Contractort of Anwica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT IOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnsfilute of Archifects 1735 New York Avenue, N.w. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 I Contraclor. The Architect's response to such requesls will be made in writing wilhin any time limits agreed upon or otherwise with reasonable promptness. If no agreement is made concerning the time within which interpretations r<luired ofthe Architect shall be furnished in compliance with this Paragraph 4.2, then delay shall not be recognized on account of failure by the Architect to furnish such inlerpretations until r5 days after wrilten request is made for lhem. 4.2.12 Interpretations and decisions of the Architect will be consistenl with the intent of and reasonably inferable from the Contract Documents and will be in writing or in the form of drawings. When making such interpretations and initial decisions, the fuchitect will endeavor to secute faithful performance by botb Owner and Contractor, will not show partiality to either and will not be liable for results of interpretations or decisions so rendered in good faith. 4.2.13 The fuchitect's decisions on matlers relating to aesthetic effect will be final if consistent with the intenl expressed in the Contract Documents. 4.3 CLAIMS AND DISPUTES 4.3.1 Definition, A Claim is a demand or assertion by one of the parties seeking, as a matter of right, adiustment or interprelation of Contract terms, payment of money, extension of time or other relief with respect to the terms of the Contract. The term "Claim" also includes other disputes and matters in question between the Owner and Contractor arising out of or relating to the Contract. Claims must be initiated by written notice. The responsibility to substantiate Claims shall rest with the party making lhe Claim. 4.3.2 Time Limits on Claims. Claims by either party must be initiated wirhin zr days after occurrence of the event giving rise to such Claim or within zr days after the claimant first recognizes the condition giving rise to the Claim,'whichever is later. Claims must be initiated by wdtten notice to the Architect and the other party. 4.3.3 Continuing Contracl Performance, Pending final resolution ofa Claim except as otherwise agreed in writing or as provided in Subparagraph 91t and Article r4, the Contractor shall proceed diligently with performance of lhe Contracl and the Owner shall continue to make payments in accordance wilh the Contract Documents. 4.3.4 Claims for Concealed or Unknown Condilions. If conditions are encountered at the site which are (r) subsurface or otherwise concealed physical conditions which differ materially from those indicated in the Contracl Documents or (z) unknown physical conditions of an unusual nature, which differ materially from those ordinarily found to exist and generally recognized as inherent in construction aclivities oftbe character provided for in the Contract Documents, then notice by the observing party shall be given to tbe other party promptly before conditions are disturbed and in no event later than zr days after first observance of the conditions. The Architect will promptly investigate such conditions and, if they differ materially and cause an increase or deoease in the Contractor's cost of, or time required for, performance of any part of the Work, will recommend an equitable adjustment in the Contract Sum or Contract Time, or both. If the fuchirect determines that the conditions at the site are not materially different from those indicaled in the Contract Documents and that no change in the terms of the Contract is iustified, the fuchitect shall so notiff the Owner and Contractor in writing, stating the reasons. Claims by either party in opposition to such determinalion must be made within zr days after the Architect has given notice of the decision. If the conditions encountered are materially different, the Contract Sum and Contract Time shall be equitably adjusted, but if the Owner and Contractor cannot agree on an adjuslment in the Contract Sum or Contract Time, the adiustment shall be refened lo the Architect for initial determination, subiect to further proceedings pursuant to Paragraph 4.4. 4.3.5 Claims for Additional Cost. If the Contractor wishes to make Claim for an increase in the Contract Sum, written notice as provided herein shall be given before @ CopyriSht 'l9ll, 19]5, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961, 1963, 1965, '1967,1970, 1975, 1987, 1997 bt lht American Instilute of Archilects. Fifteenrh Edition. Reproducfion of the malerial herein or subsfantial quofalion of ifs provisions without writfen permission of fhe AIA violaler the copyright laws of lhe Uniled <rates and will subject the violafe to legal prosecuiion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.S. :yright laws and will subject the violator fo legal prosecution- Thls documenl was electronically produced "vith permission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license wilhoul violation until the date of expiration as noted below. User Documenf : 03 - y20l2Co4. AIA License Number |l l5OO7, which expires on 511312004- 20 I t I I THs NCUMENI HAS 'MNB| NIT TECAL cotif,EouEt€Es- cousuLtAftotJ w,tH Nl I Af IORNEY IS EIICOUP'F.GED W'f H I RESPECI tO tf' COMPLEf'qt OR MODiFICAI'ON. AW tENftCATtON OF fti' ET.E,CIROMC/!'J-Y DR/fTED NA I DOCUII4ENI MAY SE MADE gY USING AIA ] DoCUttENf D&t. ! flis hcwrcn lw ben aprr:ovd and I erdorsd bv llc Asmciard C'ercral IConl rxtors of Arrr]r i ca. I I I I I AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR COI{STRUCTION The American tnsfitute of Ar€hilects 1735 New York Avenu€, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20@6-5292 I I t I t I t t I I I I I ! I I T I I I I I I I I proceeding lo execute the Work. Prior notice is nol required for Claims relating to an emergency endangering life or property arising under Paragraph ro.5. 4.3.5 If the Contraclor believes additional cost is involved for reasons including but not limited to (r) a written interpretation from the fuchitect, (z) an order by the Owner to stop the Work where the Contractor was not at fault, (3) a written order for a minor change in the Work issued by the Architect, (+) failure of payment by the Owner, (5) termination of the Contract by tbe Owner, (6) Owner's suspension or (7) other reasonable grounds, Claim shall be filed in accordance with this Paragraph 4.3. 4.3,7 Claims for Additional Time 4.3.7.1 If the Contractor wishes to make Claim for an increase in the Contract Time, written notice as provided herein shall be given. The Contractor's Claim shall include an estimate of cost and of probable effect ofdelay on progress ofthe Work. ln the case ofa continuing delay only one Claim is necessary. 4.3.7,2 If adverse weather conditions are the basis for a Claim for additional time, such Claim shall be documented by data substantiating that weather condidons were abnormal for the period of tirne, could not have been reasonably anlicipated and had an advene effect on the scheduled construction. 4.3.8 lnjury or Damage lo Person or Property. If either party to the Contract sufferc iniury or damage to person or property because of an act or omission ofthe other party, or of others for whose acts such party is legally responsible, wdtlen notice of such iniury or darnage, whether or not insured, shall be given to the other party within a reasonable time not exceeding zr days after discovery. The notice shall provide sufficient detail to enable lhe other party to investigate the matter. 4.3.9 If unit prices are slated in the Contract Documents or subsequently agreed upon, and if quantities originally contemplated are rnaterially changed in a proposed Change Order or Construction Change Directive so that application of such unit prices to quantities of Work proposed will cause substantial inequity to the Owner or Contractor, the applicable unit prices shall be equitably adiusted. 4.3,10 Claims for Consequential Damaggs, The Contractor and Owner waive Claims against each other for consequential damages arising out of or relating to lhis Contract. This mutual waiver includes: .l damages incurred by the Owner for rental expenses, for losses of use, income, profit, financing, business and reputation, and for loss of managemenl or employee productivily or of the services ofsuch persons; and .2 damages incuned by the Contractor for principal office expenses including the compensation of personnel stationed there, for losses of financing, business and reputation, and for loss of profit except anticipated profit arising directly hom the Work. Tlris mutual waiver is applicable, withoul limitalion, to all consequential damages due to either party's termination in accordance with Article r4. Nothing contained in this Subparagraph 4.3.ro shall be deemed to preclude an award of liquidated direct damages, when applicable, in accordance w h the requiremenb of the Conlracl Documents. 4,4 RESOIUTION OF CLAIM5 AND DISPUTE5 4,4.I Decision of Architect. Claims, including those alleging an enor or omission by the Architect bul excluding those arising under Paragraphs lo.3 througb ro.5, shall be referred initially to the Architect for decision. An initial decision by the Architect shall be required as a condition precedent to mediation, arbilralion or litigation ofall Claims between the Conlractor American lnstitute of Architecls. Fifleenth Edition. Reoroduction of the material herein or subsiantial quotation of ils provisions without written permission of the AIA violates the copyrighl laws of the United <lates and will subject the violafe to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. pyright laws and will subiect the violaior to legal prosecuiion. lhis document was electronically produced nrith Permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license wilhoul violation until the dale of expiraiion as noted below. User Documenl: 03 - 3tZOl2@,4. AIA License Number lll5OO7, which exDires on tl3/2m4. 2l TllS D&UtvENf HAS MnnINlT LEGAL CfiISEol'/ETvcES. CO|/6ULIATION W'fH N'I ATICBNEY 15 ENCOURAGED W'IH RESPECI fO IT5 COMPuIION OR t'lODtFlCAf lON. AUIHEMICATION Of tl{S ELTCT NOMCAUY DF!r'.FrED NA NCUMENT MAY BE ttlADE BY US,NG NA DoCUMENI DQI. lhis document has been approvd ard mdorsd by fle r'ssr,ciatd Gercral Contracto6 of AnFJrica. AIA DOCUMENT A2O1 - 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnstitule of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSlon, D.C. 20006-5292 - and owner arising prior to lhe date final payment is due, unless Jo days have passed after theclaim has been referred ro the fuchiteat with no decision having'been rendered by the fuchitect. The fuchitect will not decide disputes between the Coitractor and persons or entities other than the Owner. 4,4.2 The Architect will review Claims and within ten days of the receipt of the claim take one or more ofthe following actions: (r) request additional supporting dati from the claimant or a response with supporling data from the other party, (z) riiect the claim in whole or inpart, (3) approve the Claim, (4) suggest a compromise, or (5) advise the parties that the Architecl is unable to resolve the Claim if the fuchitect lacks sulficient informaiion to evaluale the nerits of the Claim or if the Architect concludes that, in the Architect's sole discretion, it would be inappropriate for the Architect to resolve the Claim. 4'4.3 In evaluating claims, the fuchitect may, but shall not be obligated to, consult wirh or seek information from either party or from persons with special knowledee or expertise who may assist the Architect in rendering a decision. The Architect may req-uest the owner to authorize retention ofsuch persons at the Owner's expense. 4.1.4 If the fuchitect requests a party to provide a response to a claim or to fumish additional supporting data, such pany shall respond, within ten days after receipt of such request, and shall either provide a response on the requested supporting data, idvise the fuchilect when the response or supponing data will be furnished or aivise thi Architect thar no supporting data will be furnished. upon receipt of the response or supporting data, if any, tbe Architect will either reiect or approve the Claim in whole oi in part. 4.4'5 The Architect will approve or reiect Claims by written decision, which shall state rhe reasons therefor and which shall noti$ the parties of any change in the conlract sum or Contract Time or both. The approval or reiection ofa Claim by the Archirect shall be final and binding on the parties but subject to mediation and arbitralion. 4'4.6 When a written decision of the fuchitect states that 0) the decision is final but subjea to mediation and arbilration and (z) a demand for arbitration of a claim covered by such decision must be made within 3o dap after the date on which the party makine the dimand receives the final written decision, then failure to demand arbitraiion within"said 3o dap, period shall result in the tuchitea's decision becoming final and binding upon the oilirer aird Contractor. If the Architect renders a decision after ar5itration proceedinigp have been iniriated, such decision. may. be enter-ed as evidence, but shdl not sulersede ariitration proceedings unless the decision is acceptable to all parties concerned. 4.4:7 upon receipt of a claim against the contractor or at any time thereafter, the Archilect or.the^owne-r-may,_pu1 is not obligated to, notiff the surety, if any, of the nature and amount of the Claim. If the Claim relates to a possibility of a Contraitor's difault, the fuchitect or lhe Owner may, but is not obligated to, noiiry the surety and request the surity,s assistance in resolving the controversy. 4.4'8 lf a clairn relates to or is tbe subiect of a mechanic's lien, the party asserrinq such claim may proceed in- accordance with applicable law to comply-with the'lien notice or-filing deadlines prior to resolution of the claim by the Architect, by riediation or by arbitration. 4.5 MEDIATION a:I.l Any Claim arising out ofor related to the Contracl, except Claims relaling to aesthetic effecl and -except those waived- as provided for in Subparagraphi 4.3.ro,9.ro.4 "ni 9.ro.5 shall, after initial decision by the Architect or 3o days after submissiin of rhe Ciaim'to rhe erihirect, be rubiect to mediation as a condition precedent to arbitration or the institution of legal or equitable proceedings by either party. t ! I I I rHS DOCU|TTENI ttAS MrcffA&t UG/[ -Co|'ISEQUENCES. CONSWTAqON WTH N,t I AIIORNEY 'S ENCOUNAGEDW'TH T RESPECI fO tf' COMHII//O Of, lroDtFtcAftoN. AUIHENUCATiON OF ftXS _ ELECTRON|'CNTY DRN| ED NA IWUMEN| MAY BE MADE 8Y USI/,IG NA 'DOCUIyiENI D/'01. ,#HffifH;trTEY IContradors of Anerica. r $w- I I I l I I T 01997 A|AO AIA DOCUMENT A2O1 . 1997 GENERAL CONDITION5 OF IHE CONTRACT IOR CONSTRUCTION American Institute of Architerts. Fifleenlh Edirion. Reproduclion of the malerial herein or substintial quotaiion of its provisions wifhout written permission oi the AtA violafes lhe coovriohr law< of rhp r tnira.lquotaiion of its provisions wifhout written permission AIA violafes lhe copyright laws of the United I I I The American Inslitute of Architecfs 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSton, O.C. 20@6-5292-'ates and will subject the violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed pho6copyinn violates U.S. PyriShl laws and will subject the violator lo legal prosecution, This document was electroniiallv produced with.permission of the AIA and can be reproduied in accordance with your license without vioia'tion until the date of erpiration as noted below. User Document: 03 -- Srlm@4. AIA License Number lll5@7, which exDires on 511Y2@4. 22 I J T t I t I ! I I I I t t t I I I I 4.5.2 The parties shall endeavor lo resolve their Claims by mediation which, unless the parties mutually agree otherwise, shall be in accordance wilh the Construction Industry Mediation Rules of the American Arbitration Association currently in effect. Request for medialion shall be filed in writing with the other party to the Contract and with tbe American Arbitration Association. The requesl may be made concurrently with the filing of a demand for arbitralion but, in such event, medialion shall proceed in advance of arbitralion or legal or equitable proceedings, which shall be stayed pending mediation for a period of 5o days from the date of 6ling, unless stayed for a longer period by agreement ofthe parties or court order. 4.5.3 The parties shall share the mediator's fee and any filing fees equally. The mediation shall be held in the place where the Proiect is located, unless another location is mutually agreed upon. Agreements reached in mediation shall be enforceable as settlement agreements in any court having jurisdiction thereof. 4.6 ARBITRATION 4.5,1 Any Claim arising out ofor relaled to the Contract, except Claims relating lo aesthetic effect and except those waived as provided for in Subparagraphs 4.3.ro, 9.ro.4 and 9.ro.5, shall, after decision by the fuchitect or 30 days after submission of the Claim to the Architect, be subiect to arbitration. Prior to arbitration, the parties shall endeavor to resolve disputes by mediation in accordance with the provisions of Paragraph 4.5. 4.6.2 Claims not resolved by mediation shall be decided by arbitration which, unless the parties mulually agree olherwise, shall be in accordance with the Construction Industry Arbitration Rules ofthe American Arbitration Association currenlly in effect. The demand for arbitration shall be filed in writing with the other party to the Contract and with the American Arbitration Association, and a copy shall be filed with the fuchitect. 4.6.3 A demand for arbitration shall be made within the time limits specified in Subparagraphs 4 .4.5 $d 4.6.r as applicable, and in other cases within a reasonable time after the Claim bas arisen, and in no event shall ir be made after the date when institution of legal or equitable proceedings based on such Claim would be barred by the applicable statute of limitations as determined pursuant to Paragraph r3.7. 4.6.4 Limitation on Consolidation or Joinder. No arbitration arising out of or relating to the Contract shall include, by conso[dation or ioinder or in any other manner, the Architect, the Architect's employees or consuhants, except by written consent containing specific reference to the Agreement and signed by the Architect, Owner, Contractor and any other penon or entity soughf to be ioined. No arbitration shall include, by consolidation or joinder or in any other manner, parties other than the Owner, Conlractor, a separate €onlractor as described in Article 6 and other persons substantially involved in a common question offact or law whose presence is required if complete relief is to be accorded in arbitration. No person or entity other than the Owner, Contractot or a separate contractor as described in Anicle 6 shall be included as an original third party or additional lhird party to an arbitration whose interest or responsibilily is insubstantial. Consent to arbitration involving an additional person or entity shall not constitule consent to arbittation of a Claim not described tberein or with a person or entity not named or described therein. The foregoing agreement to arbitrate and other ag,reements to arbilrate with an additional person or entity duly consenled to by parties to the Agreement shall be specifically enforceable under applicable law in any court having jurisdiaion thereof. 4.6,5 Claims and Timely Assertion of Claims. The party Iiling a notice of demand for arbitration must assert in the demand all Claims then known to that party on which arbitration is permitted lo be demanded. o copyrfghr re , rer5. rel8, rgzt 1917, 195t, 1958, t95t, t963, t956, t957, 1970, 't976, 1987, 1997 by The American lnstifute of Architects. Fifteenlh Edition. Reproduction of the maierial herein or substantial quotalionof its provisions wilhout writlen permission of the AIA violales the copyrighf laws of the Uniled(tates and will subject lhe violate fo leSal prosecufion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violafes U.5. pyright laws and will subject lhe violalor to legal prosecution. This document was electroniially produced 'vifh permission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until ihe dafe of expiralion as nofed below. User Document: 03 - 3f20l2@4. AIA License Number'lll5Oo7, which erpires on 5n3n@4. 23 TT{S DOCUMENT TW IMP9NI ANT ITGAL COITSEOUENCES. CONSULI AI'ON WTH AN ATIOBNEY I' ENCWMGED W'fH nEsPECf TO tf' COTWE ON On MOAFrcANON, AUf HENT'CATION OF ITIIS E LTCr RONICAIIY DRAF f ED NA DOCUMEN| MAY 8E MADE BY 'JgNG NA DOCUMENT D4OI. Tfis docvmenl hx been approvd ard etdorsd by fh Asrcciated Gereral Conlr aclors of Aflrsf,ica. 01997 A|AO AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAT CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT TOR CONSIRUCTION The American lnslitule of Architecf s 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSton. D.C. 20006-5292 $ffi- 4.5.6 JudSmenl on Final Award. The award rendered by the arbitrator or arbitrators shall be fiial, and-iudgment ma1 be entered upon it in accordance with applicable law in any court having iurisdiction thereof. ARTICLE 5 SUBCONTRACTORS 5.I DEFINITIONS 5.1.1 A Subcontractor is a person or entity who has a direct contract with the Contractor to perform a portion of the Work at the site. The ternr 'sukontractor' is referred to throughout the Contract Documents as if singular in number and means a Sukontraclor or an auth6rized representative of the Sukonlractor. The term 'Subcontraclor' does not include a separate contractor or subcontractors ofa separate contractor. 5'l'2 A Sub-sukontractor is a person or entity who has a direct or indirecl contract with a Subcontractor to perform a portion of the Work at the site. The term 'Sub-subcontractor" is refened to throughout the Contract Documents as if singular in number and means a Sub- subcontractor or an authorized representative of the Sub-subcontractor. 5,2 AWARD OF 5UBCONTRACTS AND OTHER CONTRACTS FOR PORTIONS OF THE WORK 5.2.1 Unless otherwise stated in the Contract Docurnents or the bidding requirements, the Contracl-or, as-soon as p-racticable after award of the Contract, shall furnish in writing ro the Ovmer through the fuchitea the names of penons or entities (including those who are to fumish m-aterials or eqyipment fabricared to a special design) proposed- for each principal portion of the Work. The Architecr rvill proJnptly reply to the Coniractor in writing stating whether or not the Owner or the Architect, after due investigation, has reasonable obiiction t6 any such proposed-person or entlty. Failure of the Owner or fuchitect to reply promptly shall constitute notice ofno reasonable objection. 5.2.7 The Contractor shall not contract wilh a proposed person or entity to whom the Owner or Architect has made reasonable and timely obiection. The Contractor shall not be required to contract witb anyone to whom the Contractor has made reasonable obiection. 5,2.3 If the Owner or Architect has reasonable obiection lo a person or enlity proposed by the Contraclor, the Contractor shall propose another to whom the Owner or fuchiteit has no reasonable obiection. If rhe proposed but r-eiected Subcontractor was reasonably capable of performing lhe Work, the Contract Sum and Contracl Time shall be increased or decriased by the difference, if any, occasioned by such change, and an appropriate Change Order shall be issued before commencement of the substitute Subcontractoi's Work. However, no increase in the Contract Sum ot Contact Time shall be allowed for such change unless the Contractor has acted promptly and responsively in submitting names as required. 5.2.4 The Contractor shall not change a Subcontractor, person or entity previously selected if the Owner or fuchilect makes reasonable obiection to such substitute. 5.3 SUBCONTRACTUAL REIATIONS 5.3'l By appropriate agreement, witten where legally required for validity, the Contractor shall require each Subcontractor, to the extent of the Work to be performed by $e Subconlractor, to be bound to the Contractor by terms of the Contract Documents, and to assume toward the Contractor all the obligations and responsibililies, including the responsibility for safety of lhe Subcontractor's Work, which the Contractor, by these Documents, assumes toward the Owner and fuchilect, Each subcontract agreement shall preserve and protect the rights of the Owner and fuchitect under the Contracl Documents with resPect to lhe Work to be performgd by the Subcontractor so that subcontracting thereof will not Preiudice such righls, and shall allow to the Subcontraclor, unless specificilly provided otherwise in the subconlract agreement, the beneht of all rights, remedies-and rediess against CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCIION American Instilufe of Architects. Fifteenth Edition. Reproduclion of fhe maferial herein or substintial The American Institule of Architectsquotalion .of its Provisions wif houl wr.itfen permission of lhe AIA violales f he copyright laws of the Unifed U35 New york Avenue, N-W.staies and will subject the violale to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. washinpton, D.C.20006-5292 pyriSht laws and will subject the violator fo legal proseculion. This document was electronically produced 'rith permission of fhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without vioiaiion until lhe dale of expiralion as noted below. User Document: 03 - 3l20n@4. AIA License Number lll5oo7, which expires on 5/ly2oo4. 24 I I I Il1l5 Docuttfi|{r HAS ltt t/nf$tl IIGr'tr CANSEWENCE' CONflJLI AIION WT H AN Af TORNEY 'S EIKOIJNAGED W'fH RESPfCI TO trt COMPUIION On MOAFTAION. AUT'#,NfrcAnON Of fl45 EUCIRONICNLY DN,fIED NA DOCU|TIEN| MAY BE MADE BY U NG AJA NCUWN| D&t, Ttis docurntt Iw fun approvd atd erldorsed by tlc Asncialcd C*twd Conlraclots of Anr€jrica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE W r 01997 A|AO I I I I I I I I I I T I t I I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I the Contractor thal the Contraclor, by the Contract Documents, has against the Owner. Where appropriate, the Contractor shall require each Sukontractor lo enter inlo similar agreements with Sub-subcontractors. The Contractor shall make available to each proposed Subcontractor, prior to lhe execution of the subcontract agreement, copies of the Conlract Documents to which the Sukontractor will be bound, and, upon written request of the Subcontractor, idenlifr to the Subcontractor terms and conditions of the proposed sukonlract agreement which may be at variance with the Conlract Documents. Subcontractors will similarly make copies of applicable portions of such documents available to their respective proposed Sub- subconlractors. 5.4 CONTINGENT ASSIGNMENT OF SUBCONTRACTS 5.4,1 Each sukontract agreement for a portion of the Work is assigned by the Contractor to the Owner provided that: .l assignment is effective only after termination of the Contract by the Owner for cause Pursuant lo Paragraph r4.2 and only for tbose subcontract agreements which the Owner accepts by notifoing the Sukontractor and Conlractor in wdting; and .2 assignment is subject to the prior rights ofthe surety, ifany, obligated under bond relating to the Conlract. 5,4.2 Upon such assignment, if the Work has been suspended for more than 3o days, the Subcontractor's compensation shall be equitably adiusred for increases in cost resulting from the suspension. ARTICTE 6 CONSTRUCTION BY OWNER OR BY 5EPARATE CONTRACTOR5 6.I OWNER's RIGHT TO PERFORM CONSTRUCTION AND TO AWARD SEPARATE CONTRACTS .6.1.1 The Owner reseryes lhe right lo perform construction or operations related. to the Proiect with the Owner's own forces, and to award separate contracts in connection with other portions ofthe Proiect or other construction or operations on the site under Conditions ofthe Contract identical or substantially similar to these including those portions related lo insurance and waiver of subrogation. If the Contractor claims that delay or additional cost is involved because of such action by the Owner, the Contractor sball make such Claim as provided in Paragraph 4.3. 6,1.2 When separate contracls are awarded for different portions of the Prolect or other construction or operations on the site, lhe terrn "Contractor'in the Contract Documents in each case shall mean the Contractor who executes each separate Owner-Contractor Agreement. 6.1.3 The Owner shall provide for coordination ofthe activities ofthe Owner's own forces and of each separate conlractor with the Work of the Contractor, who shall cooperate with them. The Contractor shall participate with other separate contractors and the Owner in reviewing their construction schedules wben djrected to do so. The Contractor shall make any revisions to the construction schedule deemed necessary after a ioint review and mutual agreemenl. The construction schedules shall then constitute the schedules to be used by the Contractor, separate contraclors and the Other until subsequently revised. 5.1.4 Unles otherwise provided in the Contract Documents, when the Owner performs construction or operations related to the Proiect with lhe Owner's own forces, the Owner shall be deemed to be subiect to the same obligations and to have the same rights which apply to the Contractor under the Conditions of lhe Contract, including, wilhout excluding others, those stated in Article 3, $is Article 6 and Articles ro, u and 12. 6,2 MUTUATRESPONSIBIL]TY @ copyriShi l9ll, 1915, 1918, 192s, 1937, 1951, 195€; i95l--I95t l96ql96l 1970, 1976, 1987, 1997 by The American Institute of Archiiects. fiffeenlh Edition. Reprodwlion of the malerial herein or substantial quolalion of ils provisions withoul written permission of lhe AIA violales the copyright laws of the United(lales and will subject the violate lo legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed phofocopylng violates U.5. pyrighl laws and will subjecl the violator lo legal proseculion. This document was electronically produced ,.rith permission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until the date of expiration as noted below. User Document: OJ -- 312A2@,4. AIA License Number lll50o7, which expires on 5ll3l20o4. 25 T|XS DOcUlvENl HN MrcnTANl LEG/I CONSEOUENCE' COMULI AiION Wf H N,I AIfffiNEY IS ENCOURAGED WIf H RESPECI fO ffS COMPITI'ON OB I'PdFrcAfrcN. AUf |ENTTAI,ON OF Il4S EIECI ROMCAUY DBAFTED NA DOCUMEN| MAY 8E MADE 8Y USIIIC NA NCUMENT D$'. fhis document l'us been approvd atd erdorsed by flrc Associatd c*neral Contradots of America. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAT CONOITIONS OT THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American Inslitute of Architecis 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 6.2.1 The Conlractor shall afford lhe Owner and separate contractors reasonable opportunity for introduction and storage oftheir materials and equipment and performance of their activities, and shall connect and coordinate the Contmctor's constru€tion and oDerations with lheirs as required by the Contract Documenls. 6.2,2 If part of the Contractor's Work depends for proper execution or results upon conslruction or operations by the Owner or a separate conlractor, lhe Conlractor shall, prior to proceeding with that portion of the Work, promptry report to the Archilect apparent discrepancies or defecls in such other consiruction lhat would render it unsuitable for such proper execulion and resuhs. Failure of lhe Contractor so to report shall constitute an acknowledgment that the Ov"ner's or separate contractor's completed or partially completed construclion is fit and proper to receive the Conlmctor's Work, except as to defects not then reasonably discoverable. 5.2.3 The Owner shall be reimbursed by the Contractor for costs incurred by the Owner wbich are payable to a separale contractor because of delays, improperly tirned activities or defective construclion ofthe Contractor. The O.nner shall be responsible to the Contractor for costs incurred by the Contractor because of delays, improperly timed actMties, damage to the Work or defective construction ofa separate contractor. 6.2.4 The Contractor shall promptly remedy damage wrongfully caused by lhe Contractor to completed or partially cornpleted construction or to property of the Owner or separate conlractorc as provided in Subparagraph ro.z.5. 6,2,5 The Owner and each separate contraclor shall have the same responsibilities for cutting and palching as are described for the Contractor in Subparagraph 3.r4. 5,3 OWNER's RIGHT TO CLEAN UP 5,3,1 Ifa dispute arises among lhe Contractor, separate conlractors and the Owner as to the responsibility under their respective contracts for maintaining the premises and sunounding area free hom waste materials and rubbish, the Owner may clean up and the Arcbitect will allocale the cost among those responsible. ARTICLE 7 CHANGES IN THE WORK 7.1 GENERAL 7.1,1 Changes in the Work may be accomplished after execution of the Contract, and withoul invalidating the Contract, by Change Order, Construclion Change Directive or order for a minor change in the Work, subiect to the limilations stated in this Article 7 and elsewhere in the Contract Documents. 7.1.2 A Change Order shall be based upon agreemenl among the Owner, Contractor and Architecl; a Construction Change Directive requires agreement by the Owner and Architect and may or may not be agreed to by rhe Contractor; an order for a minor change in lhe Work may be issued by the Architect alone. 7.1.3 Changes in the Work shall be performed under applicable provisions of the Contract Documents, and the Contraclor shall proceed promptly, unless otherwise provided in the Change Order, Construction Change Directive or order for a minor change in the Work. 7.2 CHANGE ORDERS 7.2,1 A Change Order is a written instrument prepared by the Archilect and signed by tbe Owner, Contractor and Architect, stating their agreement upon all offhe following: .l change in the Work; ,2 lhe amount of the adlustment, if any, in the Contract Sum; and t t I I I TI15 DOCUMENI HAS 'MPoRINIT LEGN. coNsEouENcEs. coMULf At to[ WI H N a AfTOflNEY 'S ET,ICOINAGED WITH I RESPECI TO tr' COtnWnON On IvPAFTAIDN. AUTHEMTATiON OF I|XS EUCIROMCr'dTY DRAFIED NA I DOCUMENI MAY BE MADE BY USTNC AtA amCUMENT AP'. ftis fuvnnt lw been approvd ard I erfursed bY ll're Associatd krcral tContractors of AnBrica. I AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAI CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION I I I I T I I I @ copyriSht l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, l9t, l9sl, 1958, 1961, 1953, 1966, 1967,'1970, 1976, 1987t IgEfFy The _. Americari Institute of Architects. Fifteenth Edition. Reproducfion of the material herein or subsrantial The American Inslilute of Architects quotalion of its provisions without wfilten permission oi fhe AIA violales the copyright laws of the unitea .l?5,Tel York Avenue, N.W. -'ates and will iubject the violale to legal prosecution. WARNIN6: Unlicensed ihoi-ocopying violates U.5. WashinSton, D.C.20@6-5292 ,JyriShr laws and will subjecl the violator lo leSal prosecution. This do<ument was eleclronically prodwed wilh permission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wifh your license without violalion until lhe date of expirafion as noied below. User Documenl: 03 -- y2u2Co'4. AIA License Number lll50o7, which expires on 5ll3l20o'4. 26 - I I I T I I I I t ,3 the extent of the adjustmenl, if any, in the Contract Time. 7.2.2 Methods used in determining adjustments to lhe Conlract Sum may include lhose listed in Subparagraph 2.3.3. 7,3 CONSTRUCTIONCHANGEDIRECTIVES 7,3,1 A Construction Change Directive is a wrilten order prepared by the Architect and signed by the Owner and Architect, directing a change in the Work prior to agreement on adiustment, if any, in the Contract Sum or Contract Time, or both. The Owner may by Construction Change Directive, without invalidating the Contract, order changes in the Work within the general scope of the Contract consisting of additions, deletions or other revisions, the Contract Sum and Contract Time being adjusted accordingly. 7 '3.2 A Construction Change Directive shall be used in the absence of total agreemenl on the terms of a Change 0rder. 7.3,3 lFthe Construction Change Directive provides for an adiustment to the Contract Sum, the adiustment shall be based on one of the following methods:,l mutual acceptance ofa lump sum properly itemized and supported by sufficient subdantiating data to permil evaluation; .2 unit prices stated in the Contracl Documents or subsequently agreed upon;.3 cost lo be determined in a manner agreed upon by the parties and a mutually acceptable fixed or percentage fee; or.4 as provided in Subparagraph 7.3.5. 7.3,4 Upon receipt of a Construction Change Directive, the Contractor shall promptly proceed with the change in the Work involved and advise the Architect of the Contractor's agreement or disagreement with the method, if any, provided in the Construction Change Direclive for determining the proposed adiustment in the Contract Sum or Contract Time. 7.3.5 A Construction Change Directive signed by the Contractor indicates the agreement of the Contraclor therewitb, including adiustrnent in Contract Sum and Contract Time or the method for determining them. Such agreement shall be effective immediately and shall be recorded as a Change Order. 7.3,6 If the Contractor does not respond prornptly or disagrees with the method for adiustmenl in the Contract Sum, the method and the adiustment shall be determined by the Architect on the basis of reasonable expenditures and savings of those performing the Work attributable to the change, including, in case of an increase in the Contract Sum, a reasonable allowance for overhead and profit. In such case, and also under Clause 7.3.3.3, lhe Contractor shall keep and present, in such form as the Architect may prescribe, an itemized accounting together with appropriate supporting data. Unless otherwise provided in the Contract Documents, costs for the purposes ofthis Subparagraph 7.3.6 shall be limited to the following:.l costs of labor, including social security, old age and unemployment insurance, fringe benefits required by agreement or custorn, and workers' compensalion lnsurance; ,2 costs of materials, supplies and equipment, including cost of transportalion, whether incorporated or consumed; .3 rental costs of machinery and equipmenl, exclusive of hand tools, whether rented from the Contractor or olhers: costs of premiums for all bonds and insurance, permit fees, and sales, use or similar taxes related to the Work; and additional costs of supervision and field office personnel directly attributable to the change. @ copyr.ghr le . rer5, r9r8, 1925, 1937, 1951, 19s8, 1961, 1953, 1966, tg67; E-7o, I976;T98tlt9-by The American Insfilute of Architects. Fifleenth Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or subsfantial quofalion.of its provisions wilhouf writien permission of the AIA violates fhe copyright laws of fhe United <fates and will subieci lhe violate to leSal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed phofocopying violales U.5. PyriSht laws and will subject lhe violafor to legal prosecution. This do(ument was electroniially produced ,lith permission of fhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without vioiation until the dale of expiralion as nofed below. User Documenl: 03 - 3t2Dl2cr)4. AIA License Number lll5OO7, which expires on 511Y20o4. 27 .4 .5 I I I I T I I I I THS DKUMENT HAS MrcRfANf LT,GAL CONSEOUENCES. COTISULTAI ION WTH NI ATTORNEY 'S ENCOURACf,D WITH RESP€Cr fO IfS COMPLET,ON OR WDIFICATION, AUT 'ENT'CAIION OF ITil' EUC|RONCAUY DMFIED NA DOCUMENT MAY 8E MADE BY USING NA DOCUMENI D&1. TLis document lps been approvd ard edorsd by f he Associatd C*rrr,al Contr actors of AflEri ca. olE T ArA@ AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAL CONOIIIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CON5TRUCTION The American Institute of Architects U35 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSfon, D.C. 20@6-5292 $ffi 7.3.7 The arnount of credit to be allowed by the Contraclor to the Owner for a deletion or change which results in a nel decrease in the Contracl Sum shall be actual net cost as confirmed by tbe Architect. When both additions and credits covering relaled Work or substitutions are involved in a change, the allowance for overhead and profit shall be figured on the basis ofnet increase, iIany, with respect to lhat change. 7.3,8 Pending final deierminalion of the total cost of a Construction Change Directive to the Owner, amounts not in dispute for such changes in the Work shall be included in Applications for ?ayment accompanied by a Change Order indicating the parties' agreement with part or all ofsuch costs. For any portion ofsuch cost lhat remains in dispute, the Architect will make an interim determination for purposes of monthly certification for payment for those costs. That determination ofcost shall adiust the Contract Sum on the same basis as a Change Order, subiect to the right of eilher parly to disagree and asserl a claim in accordance wiih Article 4. 7,3,9 When the Owner and Conlractor agree with the determination made by the Architecr concerning the adiustments in the Contract Sum and Contract Time, or otherwise reach aBreement upon the adjustments, such agteement shall be effective imrnedialely and shall be recorded by preparation and execution ofan appropriate Change Order. 7.4 MINOR CHANGE5 IN THE WORK 7.4.1 The Architect will have authority to order rninor cbanges in the Work not involving adiustment in the Contract Sum or extension of the Contract Time and not inconsistent with the intent of the Contract Documents. Such changes shall be effected by written order and shall be binding on the Owner and Contractor. The Contractor shall carry out such written orders promptly. ARIICLE 8 TIME 8.I DEFINITION5 8.1,1 Llnless otherwise prcvided, Contract Time is the period of time, including authorized adjustments, allotted in the Contract Documents for Substantial Completion of the Work. 8.1.2 The date of commencement of the Work is the dale established in the Agreement. I'l'3 The date of Substantial Complelion is the date certified by the Architect in accordance with Paragraph 9.8. 8.1.4 The term "day" as used in the Contract Documents sball mean calendar day unless otherwise specifically defined. 8.2 PROGRESS AND COMPTETION 8.2.1 Time limits stated in the Contract Documents are of the essence of the Contracl. By executing the Agreement the Contractor confums that tbe Contract Time is a reasonable period for performing the Work. 8,2,2 The Contractor shall not knowingly, except by agreement or inslruction of the Owner in wriring, prematurely commence operations on the site or elsewhere prior to the effective date of insurance required by Article l to be furnished by the Contractor and Ovmer. The date of commencement of the Work shall not be changed by the effective date of such insurance. Unless the date of commencement is established by the Contract Documents or a notice to proceed given by the Owner, the Contractor shall notif lhe Owner in writing not less than five days or other agreed period before commencing the Work to permit the timely filing of mortgages, mechanic's liens and other security interests. I I I I I fIlS DOCUMEN| Hr'6 ,MrcATA/iIT LEGAL COMEOUENCES. CON'UL! Aq'ON WITH N I AIIORItrY IS ETVrOU|,/|GED W'f H I REStrCf rO tfs COMPLETTON OR MODIFICAT IOT!. AUTIT,NTICAIION OF TIXS ELECTROMCNTY Df{/'F!ED NA I DoCUMENI MAY 8E MADE BY UflNG ArA ImCUMENT A'O'. Tlns dcrlnent lw fun apywd and I erdorsd bv lle Asnciattd C*ned tContraclors of Axterica. I @ copyrighl r9lr, lgls, 1918, 192s, 1917, 1951, 1958, 1951, 1953, 1956, 1957, 1970, 196-962-EgrE -Tht American Inslilufe of Architects. Fiffeenth Edifion. Reproduclion of ihe material herein or substintial quotaiion of its provisions withoui wriften permission of lhe AIA violates the copyright laws of the United <tafes and will subject rhe violate fo le8al prosecution. wARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates u.5. ryri8ht laws and will subjecl fhe violalor io legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced ',rfh Permission of lhe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license withoul vioiation until the date of expiration as noled below. User Do€umenl: 03 - 3l2ot2@4. AIA License Number lll5OO7, which expires on 5ll3l2@4. 28 AIA DOCUMENT A2OI .1997 GENERAL CONDITIONs OF THE CONTRACT FOR CON5TRUCTION The American Inslilute of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSlon, D.C. 20006-5292 T I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I 8.2.3 The Contractor shall proceed expeditiously with adequate forces and shall achieve Substantial Completion witbin the Contract Time. 8.3 DELAY5 AND EXTENSIONS OF TIME 8.3.1 If the Contractor is delayed at any time in the commencement or progress of the Work by an act or neglecl of lhe Owner or Architect, or of an employee of either, or of a separate contractor employed by the Owner, or by changes ordered in the Work, or by labor disputes, Iire, unusual delay in deliveries, unavoidable casualties or olher causes beyond the Contractor's control, or by delay authorized by rhe Owner pending medialion and arbitration, or by other causes which the Archilect determines may iustiff delay, then the Contract Time shall be extended by Change Order for such reasonable time as the Architect may determine. 8.3,2 Claims relating to time shall be made in accordance with applicable provisions of Paragraph 4.3. 8,3,3 This Paragraph 8.3 does not preclude recovery of damages for delay by either party under other provisions of the Contracl Documents. ARTICLE 9 PAYTVIENTS AND COMPLETION 9.I CONTRACTSUM 9.1.1 The Contract Sum is stated in the Agreement and, including authorized adiustments, is the tolal amounl payable by the Owner to the Contractor for performance of the Work under the Contract Documenls. 9.2 SCHEDULE OF VALUES 9.2.1 Before the first Application for Payment, the Contractor shall submit to the Architect a schedule of values allocated to various portions of the Work, prepared in such form and supported by such data to substanliate its accuracy as the Architect may require. This schedule, unless obFcted to by the Archilect, shall be used as a basis for reviewing the Contractor's Applications for Payment. 9.3 APPLICATIONS FOR PAYMENT9.31 At least ten days before the date established for each progress payment,lhe Contractor shall submit to the fuchitect an itemized Application for Payment forbperations completed in accordance with the schedule of values. Such application shall be notarized, if required, and supported by such data substanliating the Contlactor's right to payment as the Owner or Archilect may require, such as copies of requisitions ftom Subcontractors and material suppliers, and reflecting retainage if provided for in the Contract Documents. 9,3.1.1 As provided in Subparagraph 7.3.8, such applications may include requests for payment on account of clranges in the Work which have been properly authorized by Construction Change Directives, or by interim determinations of the Architect, but not yet included in Change Orders. 9.3'l'2 Such applications may not include requests for payment for portions of the Work for which the Contractor does not intend to pay to a Subcontractor or malerial supplier, unless such Work has been performed by others wbom the Contractor intends to pay. 9.3.2 Unless otherwise provided in the Contract Documents, payments shall be made on account of malerials and equipment delivered and suitably stored at the site for subsequent incorporation in lhe Work. If approved in advance by the Owner, payment may sirnilarly be made for materials and equipment suilably stored off the site at i location agreed upon in wriring. Payment for materials and equipment stored on or off the site shall be conditioned upon compliance by the Contractor with procedures satisfactory to the Owner to establish the Ov"ner's title to such materials and equipment or otherwise protect the Owner's interest, and TTIIS DOCUMENT HAS ITqTNTNI| IfGAL COMEOUENCES. CONSULT AIION WITH NI ATTORNEY IS ENCO'JMGED W'TH RE PECT fO ITS COMPI.ETION @, MOAFTA|'A!. AU|HENTICATIOT{ tr THS EIEC| RONCNTY DRAFIED NA DOCUIWN| MAY 8E MADE EY U9N6 NA DOCUiTIENI AnOl. fhis docvnent lw been approvd ard etfursd by tle Asnciald Genqal Co rtr actort ol AnEr ica. 01997 A|AO AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION @ copyriSht l9lt. 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, I American lnsiitule of Architecfs. Fifteenth Edition. Reoroduction of the material herein or substantial TheAmerican Insrilule of Archite(ts guotation of its provisions without written permission of the AIA violates the copyright laws of the United 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. "ates and will sublect lhe violate io legal prosecution. WARNIN6: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. Washington, D.c.20@6-5292 pyrighl laws and will subject the violator to legal prosecution. This document was electroniially produced with permission of the AtA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation uniil lhe date of expiralion as noted below. User Documenl: 03 - 3nu2m,4. AIA Licenie Number lll5oo7. which expires on 5llll2@4. 29 I shall include the costs of applicable insurance, storage and transportation to the site for such malerials and equipment stored off the site. 9'3.3 The Contractor warrants that title to all Work covered by an Application for Payrnent will pass to the Owner no later than the time of payment. The Contractor further wanants lhat upon submittal of an Application for Payment all work for which certificates for payment have been previously issued and payments received from the owner shall, to the best of the Conlractor's knowledge, information and belief, be free and clear of liens, claims, security interests or encumbrances in favor of the Contractor, Subconlractors, material suppliers, oi olher persons or entities making a claim by reason of having provided labor, maierials and equipment relating to the Work. 9.4 CERTIFICATES FOR PAYMENT 9.4'l The Architect will, within seven days after receipt ofthe Contractor's Application for Payment, either isJue to the Owner a Certificate for Payment, with a copy to the Contractor, for such arnount as the fuchitect determines is properly due, or noti& thi Contractor and ownerin writing of the fuchitect's reasons for withholding certification in whole or in part as provided in Subparagraph 9.5.r. 9.4,2 The issuance of a Certificate for Payment will constitute a representalion by the Architect lo the Owner, based on the Architect's evaluation of the Work and the data comprising the Application for Paymenl that the work has progressed to the point indicated and that, to the best of the Architect's knowledge, information and belief, tbr! quality of the Work is in accordance with the Contract Documents. The foregoing representations ari subiect to an eYaluation of the Work for conformance wilh the Conlract Documents upon Substantial Complelion, to results of subsequent lests and inspections, to correction of minor deviations from lhe contract Documents prior.to cornplelion and to-specific qualifications expressed by the Architect. The issuance ofa Certificate for Payment will hrrther ionstitute a representation that the contmctor is entitled to payment in lhe amount certified. However, the issuanie of a Certificate for Payment will not be a represenlation rhat the Architecl has (r) made exhaustive or continuous on-site inspections to check the quality or quantity of the Work, (z) reviewed construction means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures, (3) reviewed copies of requisitions received from sukoltractors and material suppliers and other data requeited by the Owner to sub6tantiate the Conlractor's right to payment, or (l) made exarnination to ascertain how or for what purpose the contmctor has used money previously paid on account of the Contract Sum- 9.5 DECI5IONS TO WITHHOID CERTIFICATION 9.5.1 The Architect may witMold a Certificate for Payment in whole or in part, to the exteDt reasonably necessary to protect the Owner, if in the fuchitect's opinion the represenlations lo the Owner required by Subparagraph 9.42 cannot be made. If th; Architecf is unable to certiff payment in the amounl of the Application, the Architect will notifo the Conlractor and Owner as provided in Subparagraph g.+.r. If the Contmctor and Architect cannol agree on-a revised amount, the Architect will promptly issue a certilicate for payment for the amount for which the Architect is able to maki such representations to the Owner. The Architect may also withhold a certificate for Payment or, because of sub,sequently discovered evidence, mayrulliff tbe whole or a part of a Certificate for Payment previously issued, to such extenl as may be necessary in the Architect's opinion to prolect the Owner from loss for which the Contractor is responsible, including loss resulting from acts and omissions described in Subparagraph 3.3.2, because of: .l defective Work nol remedied; .2 third party claims filed or reasonable evidence indicating probable filing ofsuch claims unless security acceptable to the Owner is provided by the Contractori.3 failure of the Contractor to make payments properly to Subconlractors or for labor, materials or equipment; I I I I I T,XS D0CUMENI HAS Mpo.RTN'll UGN- cot{sEout vcts. cowsur |.]/'f,oN wtrH Nt ) Af f oRNEY tS ENCOURAGED WrH I RESPECr tO 'tS COMPtEftON OR I'WErcAfPN. AUT,lENllCAf ION OF THS ETECIROMCALLY DNNED NA I DocUtYENf MAY 8E MADE 8Y atstVc NA aDOCU|WN| A'ot. ftis document lps 6cen apprM atd I erfursd bv llp Associatd GenerJ tCo,tnctors of Ar'€rica- AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE I I I I t I t I t t I CONTRACT FOR CON5TRUCTION American Inslilute of Architects. Fifteenfh Edition. Reproduclion of the material herein or substintial The American Institute of Architectsquotation _of ils provisions wilhout writfen permission of lhe AIA violafes the (opyright laws of the United U35 ttew york Rvenue, lt.W.qales and will subjecl the violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violafes U.S. Washincfon, D.C.269oG-5292 ?yriShf laws and will subjecf the violalor to legal prosecution. This document was elecrronically prodwed 'vilh Permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license without violation until lhe date of expiration as noted below. User Documenf : O3 -- 3l20t2@4. AIA License Number lll5oo7, which expires on 5ll3noo4. 30 I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I t .4 reasonable evidence that the Work cannot be completed for the unpaid balance of the Contract Sum; .5 damage lo the Owner or another contractor; .6 reasonable evidence thal the Work will not be completed wilhin lhe Conlract Time, and that lhe unpaid balance would not be adequale to cover actual or liquidated damages for the anticipaled delay; or .7 persistent failure to car)' out the Work in accordance wilh the Conlract Documents. 9.5.2 When the above reasons for withholding certification are removed, certification will be made for amounts previously withheld. 9.6 PROGRESS PAYMENTS 9.5.1 After the Architect has issued a Certificale for Payment, the Or,r'ner shall make payment in the manner and within the time proyided in the Contract Documents, and shall so notifr the Architect. 9.6.2 The Contractor shall promptly pay each Subcontractor, upon receipt of payment from the Owner, out ofthe amount paid to the Contraclor on accounl ofsuch Sukontractor's portion of the Work, the amount to which said Subcontractor is entitled, reflecting percentages actually retained from payments to the Contractor on account ofsuch Sukontraclor's portion ofthe Work. The Contractor shall, by appropriate agreement with each Subcontractor, require each Subcontractor to make paymenls to Sub-subcontractors in a similar manner. 9,6.3 The fuchitect will, on request, furnish to a Subconlractor, if practicable, information regarding percentages of completion or amounts applied for by the Contractor and action taken thermn by the Architect and Owner on account of portions of the Work done by such Subconlractor. . 9.6,4 Neither the Owner nor fuchitect shall have an obligalion lo pay or to see to the payment of money to a Subcontraclor except as may olherwise be required by law. 9.6.5 Payment 10 material suppliers shall be trealed in a manner similar ro thar provided in Subparagraphs 9 .6.2,9.6.3 and 9.6.4. 9,6.6 A Certificate for Payment, a proBress payment, or partial or entire use or occupancy of the Proiect by the Owner shall not constitute acceptance of Work not in accordance wirh the Contracl Documents. 9,5.7 Unless the Contractor provides the Owner with a payment bond in the full penal sum of the Contract Sum, payments received by the Contractor for Work properly performed by Sukontractors and suppliers shall be held by the Contractor for those Sukontractors or suppliers who performed Work or furnished materials, or botb, under contract with the Contractor for which payment was made by the Ovmer. Nothing coniained herein shall require money to be placed in a separate account and not commingled with money of the Contraclor, shall create any fiduciary liabiliry or tort liabiliry on the pan of the Contractor for breach of trust or shall entitle any person or enlity to an award of punitive damages against the Contractor for breach oftbe requirements of this provision. 9.7 FA]TURE OF PAYMENT 9.7,l If the Architect does not issue a Certificate for Payment, through no fauh of the Contractor, within seven days after receipt of the Contraclor's Application for Payment, or if tbe Owner does not pay the Contractor within seven da;n after the date established in the Contract Documents the amount certilied by the Architect or awarded by arbitration, then the Contractor may, upon seven additional days'written notice to the Ownir and Architect, stop @ copyrighi r9lt, 19t5, 1918, 1925, 1937, 195t, 1958. t961, t963, 1965, 1967, 1970, t976, 1987, t997 by The American Institufe of Architecis. Fifleenth Edilion. Reprodu<fion of lhe material herein or substantial quotation of ils provisions without wrilten permission of the AIA violates the copyright laws of fhe Uniled-'ates and will subject the violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violafes u.S. pyright laws and will subject the violator to leSal prosecution- This document was electronically produced wilh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license wifhout violation unlil lhe date of expiration as noted below. User Documenf: 03 - y7ol2D4. AIA License Number lll50o7, which expires on 5/lY20O4 3l f,45 DOCUIyENi HAS MtrlRTN|T LEGAL CONSEOUEI'KES. CfiISULIAIION Wf H AI{ AIf ORNEY 15 EI,K2UQAGED WrH RESPECI fO ITS COMPITiION OR MOAFrcATrcN, AUrHEMICAIION Of THS EIICIRONCATY DR/fIED NA MCUWNT MAY EE MADE BY ','SII,IG NA WCUMEN| D4OI. fhis docvment lw been approvd ard erdorsd by Tlre Associald Gercrd contrrtors of ArrQrica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONs OF THE CONTRACT FOR CON5TRUCTION The American lnstilute of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washinglon, D.C. 20@6-5292 the Work until payment o[ the amount owing has been received. The Contract Time shall be extended approprialely and the Contracl Sum shall be increased by the amount of the Conlractor's reasonable costs ofshut-down, delay and start-up, plus interest as provided for rn the Contract Documents. 9.8 SUBSTANTIAL COMPLETION 9.8,1 Substantial Completion is the stage in the progress of the Work when the Work or designated portion thereofis sufficiently conrplete in accordance with the Contract D(ruments so that lhe Owner can occupy or utilize the Work for its inlended use. 9.8.2 When the Contractor conside$ that the Work, or a portion thereof which the Owner agre€s to accept separately, is substantially complete, the Contractor shall prepare and submit to the fuchitect a conrprehensive list of items to be completed or corricted pdor to final payment. Failure to include an item on such list does not alter the responsibility of the Contractor to complete all Work in accordance with lhe Conlract Documents. 9.8.3 Upon receipt of the Contractor's list, the fuchitect will make an inspection to determine whether the Work or designated portion thereof is substantially complete. If the Architect's inspection discloses any item, whaher or not included on the Contiactor's list, which is not sufficiently complele in accordance with the Contract Documents so that the Owner can occupy or utilize the Work or designated portion thereof for ils intended use, the Contractor sball, before issuance of the Certificate of Substantial Completion, complete or conect such item upon notification by the fuchitect. In such case, the Contractor shill then submit a request for another inspection by lhe Architect to determine Substandal Completion. 9.8.4 When lhe Work or designated portion thereof is substanlially cornplete, the Architect will prepare a Certilicate ofSubslantial Completion which shall esrablish the date ofSubstantial Cornpletion, shall establish responsibilities of lhe Owner and Conlractor for security, maintenance, heat, utiliries, damage lo the Work and insurance, and shall fix the time within which the Contractor shall finish all items on the list accompanying the Certificate. Warranties required by the Contract Documents shall commence on the date of Substantial Complelion of lhe Work or designated portion thereof unless otherwise provided in the Certificate of Substantial Completion. 9,8,5 The Certificate of Substantial Completion shall be submitted to the Owner and Contractor for their written acceplance of responsibilities assigned to them in such Certificate. Upon such acceplance and consent of surety, if any, the Owner shall make payment of retainage applying to such Work or designated portion thereof. Such payment shall be adjusted for Work that is incomplete or Dot in accordance with the requirements of the Conlraa Documents. 9.9 PARTIAL OCCUPANCY OR USE 9.9.1 The Owner may occupy or use any completed or panially completed portion of the Work at any stage when such portion is designated by separate agreement with the Contractor, provided such occupancy or use is consented to by the insurer as required under Clause rr.4.r.5 and authorized by public authorities having iurisdiction over the Work. Such partial occupancy or use may commence whether or not the portion is substantially complete, provided the Owner and Contractor have accepted in writing the responsibilities assigned to iach of ttrem for payments, retainage, if any, security, maintenance, heat, utilities, damage to lhe Work and insurance, and have agreed in writing concerning the period for correction of the Work and commencemenl of warranties required by the Contract Documents. When the Contractor considers a portion substantially complele, the Conlractor shall prepare and submit a lisl to the Architect as provided under Subparagraph 9.8.2. Consent of the Contractor to partial occupancy or use shall not be unreasonably withheld. The stage of the progress of the Work shall be determined by written agreement between the Ovrner and Contractor or, if no agreemenl is reached, by decision ofthe Architect. I I I I I f IXS DX.UiVENI HAS llqwf$fi |fA4.L coNsErJ4')ENcEs. cot!,5t/tfAflO W'f H N{ ATTOf,NEY IS ENCo{'JP!4,GED WTH RESPECr fO trs COMPtf,TtOtt OR lvnuf ,CALON. AUTIEMTCAITN OF rlfs EITCIROMCATY Df,^Fi ED NA DACUMEN| MAY 8E WDE BY USING AIA WCUMENI D/'OI. fEs dewan |r:ls fuen approvd atd endord by flp Asociatd krsd Conlractors of A'',e ca. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS Of THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American Inslifute of Archite(rs 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20@6-5292 I t I I t I T I I I t I I c' copyrighr r9I, t915, 1918, 1925, l93z t951, 1958, 1951, 1953, 1955, 1967, 1970., 1976,198Z EgTbtThe American Instilule of Archilecls. Fiffeenfh Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or substantial quotation of ils provisions without wrillen permission of lhe AtA violales lhe copyright laws of the Unifedctates and will subjecf the violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. pyright laws and will subject lhe violator to legal prosecution. This dorument was electronically produced wifh Permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license withouf violation until fhe date of expiration as noted below. User Do<ument: 03 - y2ol2@4. AIA License Number lll5@7, which expires on 5ll3l2oo4. 32 I I I I I I I I I I I l I I t I I I t I 9.9.2 Immediately prior to such partial occupan€y or use, the Owner, Contractor and Archilect shall iointly inspect the area to be occupied or portion of the Work to be used in order to determine and record the condition of the Work. 9.9,3 Unless otherwise agreed upon, partial occupancy or use ofa portion or portions of the Work shall not constitute acceptance of Work not complying with the requirements of the Contracl Documents. 9,IO FINAL COMPLETION AND FINAT PAYMENT 9,lO.l Upon receipt of witten notice that the Work is ready for final inspection and accePtance and upon receipt of a final Application for Payment, the Architect will promptly make such inspection and, when the fuchitect hnds the Work acceptable under the Contract Documenls and lhe Contract fully performed, the Architect will promptly issue a final Certificate for Payment stating that to the best of the Architect's knowledge, information and beliel and on the basis of the Architect's on-site visits and inspections, the Work has been completed in accordance with terms and conditions of the Contract Documents and that the entire balance found to be due the Contractor and noted in the final Certificale is due and payable. The Architect's final Certificate for Payment lyill constitute a further representation that conditions listed in Subparagraph 9.ro.z as precedent to the Contractor's being entitled to final payment have been fulfilled. 9.10.2 Neirher final pa)'ment nor any remaining retained percentage shall become due until the Conlractor submits to the Architect (r) an affidavit that payrolls, bills for materials and equipment, and other indebtedness connected with the Work for which the Owner or the Owner's property might be responsible or encumbered (less amounts withheld by Owner) have been paid or otherwise satisfied, (z) a certificate evidencing that insurance required by the Conttacl Documents to remain in force after final payment is cunently in effect and will not be canceled or allowed to expire until at least 3o days' prior written notice has been given to the Owner, (f) a written statement that lhe Contraclor knows of no substantial reason that the insurance will not be renewable to cover the period required by the Contract Documents, (4) consent of surety, if any, to final paymenl and (S), if required by the Owner, other data establishing payment or satisfaction of obligations, such as receipts, releases and waivers of liens, claims, security interests or encumbrances arising out ofthe Contracl, lo the extent and in such forrn as may be designated by the Owner. Ifa Subcontractor refuses to furnish a release or waiver required by the Owner, the Contractor may furnish a bond satisfactory to the Owner to indemnifr the Owner against such lien. If such lien remains unsatislied after paymenls are made, the Contractor shall refund to the Owner all money that the Owner maybe compelled to pay in discharging such lien, including all costs and reasonable attorneys' fees. 9.10,3 lf, after Substantial Completion of the Work, final completion thereof is materially delayed through no fault of the Contraclor or by issuance of Change Orders affecting final completion, and the Architect so confirms, the Owner sball, upon application by the Contractor and certihcation by the Architect, and without terminating the Conlract, make payment of the balance due for that portion of the Work fully completed and accepted. If the rernaining balance for Work not fully completed or corrected is less than relainage stipulated in the Contract Documents, and if bonds have been furnished, the writlen consent of surety to payment of the balance due for that porlion of the Work fully completed and accepted shall be submitted by the Contractor to the Architect prior to certification of such payment. Such payment shall be made under terms and condilions governing final payment, except lhat it shall not conslitute a waiver of claims. 9.10,4 The making of final payment shall constitute a waiver of Claims by the Owner except those arising from: .l liens, Claims, securily interests or encumbrances arising out of the Contract and unseltled; American lnstifute of Architects. Fifteenlh Edition. Reproduciion of the malerial herein or subslantial quofation of its provisions wilhoul wriften permission of f he AtA violales the copyright laws of rhe United 'tates and will subject the violale to legal proseculion. WARNTNG: Unlicensed pholocopying violates U.5. pyright laws and will subjecl lhe violafor io legal prosecution. This documenl was electronically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license without violation until the date of expiration as nofed below. User Document: O3 -- 3,f2ol2@4. AIA License Number lll5oo7, which erpires on 51131200,4. 33 IIIIS DOCUMENT HAS MTNTNI| LEGAL CONSEOUENCES. CONSULT Af 'ON W'T H lf'I ATfOflMY E ET'ICOI.'MGED WIH RESPECf TO If' COMPLEIION OR fv'oryf rcAnON. AUf,fNflCALoN oF r s EITCT ROTII C AUY DRAr T ED N A DOCUMEN| MAY BE MADE 8Y I]SING NA DOCUMENI A'Or. fhis docummt lps ber.n approvd atd erdorsd bv fbe Asnciatd General ConJractori of America. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCTION The American lnstituie of Architecis U35 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20@F5292 I .2 failure of the Work to comply with lhe requirements of the Conlract Documents; OI .3 terms of special warranties required by the Contract Documents. 9.10.5 Acceptance of final Payment by lhe Contractor, a Subcontractor or material supplier sball constitute a waiver of claims by that payee except those previously made in witing and identified by that payee as unsettled at the time of final Application for Payment. ARTICLE IO PROTECTION OF PERSONS AND PROPERry IO.I 5AFETY PRECAUTIONS AND PROGRAM5 lO.l.l The Contractor shall be responsible for initiating, maintaining and supervising all safely precautions and programs in connection with the performance ofthe Contract. IO.2 SAFETY OF PERSONS AND PROPERTY 10.2.1 The Contractor shall take reasonable precautions for safety of, and shall provide reasonable protection to prevent damage, injury or lors to: .l employees on the Work and other persons who may be affected thereby; .2 the Work and materials and equipment to be incorporated therein, whether in storage on or offthe site, under care, custody or control of the Contractor or the Contraclor's SubcontractoF or Sub-subcorrtraclors; and .3 other property at the site or adiacent thereto, such as trees, shrubs, lawns, walks, pavements, roadways, structures and utilities not desiBnated for removal, relocation or replacement in the course ofconstruction. 10.2.2 The Contractor shall give notices and comply wirh applicable laws, ordinances, rules, regulations and lawful orders of public authorities bearing on safety of persons or property or their protection from damage, iniury or loss. 10.2.3 The Contractor shall erecl and maintain, as required by existing conditions and performance of theContract, reasonablesafeguards for safety and protection, including posting danger signs and other wamings against hazar&, promulg,ating safety regulations and n,itiryinf owners and users ofadiacent sites and utilities. 10.2.4 When use or storage of explosives or other hazardous materials or equipment or unusual methods are necessary for execulion ofthe Work, the Contractor shall exercise utmost care and carry on such activities under supervision of proped qualified perconnel. 10,2.5 The Contractor shall promptly remedy damage and loss (othel than damage or loss insured under property insurance required by the Contract Documents) to property referred to in Clauses lo.z.r.z and ro.z.r.3 caused in whole or in part by the Contractor, a Subcontractor, a Sub-subcontractor, or anyone directly or indirectly employed by any of them, or by anyone for whose acts they may be liable and for which the Contractor is responsible under Cliuses ro.z.r.z and ro.u.r.3, except damage or loss attributable to acts or omissions ofthe Ovrner or Architect or anyone directly or indirectly employed by either of them, or by anyone for whose acts either of them may be liable, and not attributable to the fault or negligence of the Contractor. The foregoing obligations of the Contractor are in addition to the Contractor's obligations under Paragrapb 3.r8. 10.2.5 The Contractor shall designate a responsible member of the Contractor's organization at the site whose duty shall be the prevention of accidents. This person shall be the Contractor's suPerintendent unless otberwise designated by the Contractor in writing to the Owner and Archilect. @ copyriShr l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937;lt-1, 1958J96I;19@ American Inslitute of Architects. Fiffeenth Edition. Reproduclion of the material herein or substantial quoialion of its provisions wilhoul writfen permission of lhe AIA violates the copyright laws of the United slates and will subject ihe violate to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violaies U.5. ryright laws and will subject the violator lo legal prosecution. This document was electroniially produced ..rlh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until the date of expiration as noled below. User Document: 03 - y2ol2oo4. AIA License Number lll5oO7, which expf res on 5ll3l2@4. 34 I I t I I I IITS DOCUMENI HAS IMrcf.IAAII EGAL conrsEwENcEs. coNSuLrAttoN wtH AN 3 AfroRtffY ts EN60UP(/|GEDW1TH tRESPECi tO 'fS COMPUi'ON OR MOUFrcANON. AUI'ENIIC/.I|,ON OF I'T5 ELECTROMCNTY DP(/'F!ED NA I DOCUi{ENT I't AY BE MADE BY ll'tttc NA aWUMENTW'. llis cc,cwrent ha been approvd ard Ierdord bv lle Associatd Gercrd ICont r aclors of AnP.jrica. I AIA DOCUMINT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCTION The American lnsfiluie of Architects '1735 New York Avenue, N.W. WashinSton, D.C. 20006-5292 I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I l I T I I I I I I 10,2.7 The Contractor shall not load or permit any part of the construction or site to be loaded so as to endanger its safety. IO.3 HAZARDOU5MATERIALS l0.3.l If reasonable precautions will be inadequale to prevent foreseeable bodily iniury or death to persons resulting from a nraterial or substance, including but not limited lo asbestos or polychlorinated biphenyl (PCB), encountered on the site by the Contractor, the Contractor shall, upon recognizing the condition, immediately stop Work in lhe affected area and report the condition to the Owner and Architect in writing- 10.3.2 The Owner shall obtain the services ofa licensed laboratory to veriS the presence or absence of the rnaterial or substance reported by lhe Contractor and, in the event such material or substance is found to be present, to verifi that it has been rendered hannless. Unless otherwise required by the Contracl Documenls, lbe Owner shall furnish in witing to the Contractor and fuchitect the names and qualificalions of persons or entities who are to perform tests verifting the presence or absence of such material or substance or who are to perform the lask of removal or safe containment ofsuch material or substance. The Conlractor and the Architect will promptly reply to the Owner in writing stating whelher or not either has reasonable obiection to the persons or entities proposed by the Owner. If either the Contractor or Archilect has an obiection to a person or entity proposed by $e Owner, the Owner shall propose another to whom the Contractor and the Architect have no reasonable obiection. When the material or substance has been rendered harmless, Work in rhe affecled area shall resume upon written agreement of the Owner and Contractor. The Conlract Time shall be extended appropriately and the Contract Sum shall be increased in the amount of the Contraclor's reasonable additional costs of shul-down, delay and stail-up, which adiuslrnents shall be accomplished as provided in Article 7. 1O.3.3 To the fullest extent permitted by law, the Owner shall indemnifr and bold harmless the Contractor, Sukontractors, Architect, Architect's consultants and agents and employees of any of them from and against clairns, damages, losses and expenses, including but not limited 10 attomeys' fees, arising out of or resulting from performance of lhe Work in the affected area if in fact the malerial or substance presents the risk of bodily iniury or death as described in Subparagraph lo.3.r and has nol been rendered harmless, provided that such claim, damaBe, loss ot expense is attributable to bodily injury sickness, disease or death, or to injury to or destruction of tangible property (other than the Work itself) and provided that such damage, loss or expense is not due to the sole negligence ofa party seeking indemnity. lO,4 Tlre Owner shall not be responsible under Paragraph to.l for materials and substances brought to the site by the Contractor unless such materials or substances were required by the Conlract Do€uments. lO.5 If, without negligence on the part ofthe Contractor, the Contractor is held liable for the cost of remediation of a hazardous material or subshnce solely by reason of performing Work as required by the Conlract Documents, the Ovrner shall indemni$ the Contractor for all cost and expense there\ incurred. 10.6 EMERGENCIES 10.6.l In an emeryency affecring safety of persons or propeny, the Contraclor shall act, at the Conlractor's discretion, to prevent threatened damage, iniury or loss. Additional compensation or exlension of time claimed by the Contractor on account of an emergency shall be determined as provided in Paragraph 4.3 and Article 7. ARTICLE II ]NSURANCE AND BONDS II.I CONTRACTOR'SLIABILIrylNSURANCE @ copyrfghr re , l9ls, t9t8, t92s, t937, 1951, t958, 196t, 1963, 1966, 1967, 1970,'t976, 1987, 1997 by The American Instilute of Archite<ls. Filteenth Edilion. ReDroduction of the material herein or substantial quofalion of its provisions wilhouf writlen p€rmission of the AIA violates fhe copyrighf laws of the United 'latet and will subled the violate lo legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. rpyright laws and will subject lhe violator to le8al prosecution. This document was electronically produced wilh Permission of ihe AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until the date of expiraf ion as noted below. User Documenl: 03 - 3n0l2@4. AIA License Number ll l5oo7, which expires on YBn@4. 35 TIiIS DOCUMENI HAS 'MrcRfN'If LEGN CONSEWEI'ICE5. COIISULT Af ION WI H N,t Af f ORMY IS ENCOUF,4|GED WIIH RE'PECI fO 'fS COtY'PlfftON OR trtoDlFtcAl,ot'l AUf l#.NTlcAf,ql oF ftts EITCI RONCAUY DRAF f ED N A DXUMENT MAY tr MADE 8Y II''NG NA D&,UMENT D&1. Ihis docwten ht been approvd atd etdorsd by fhe Associatd Generd contracloB of At wka. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONIRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnstifute of Architecls 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washin8lon, D.C. 20@6-5292 I ll.l.l The Contractor shall purchase lrom and maintain in a company or companies lawfully authorized to do business in the jurisdiction in which the Proiect is located such insurance as will protect the Conlractor from claims set forth below which may arise out ofor result from lhe Contractor's operations under the Conlract and for which the Contractor may be legally liable, whether such operations be by the Contractor or by a Subcontractor or by anyone directly or indirectly employed by any of them, or by anyone for whose acts any of them may be liable: ,l claims under workers' compensation, disability benelit and other similar employee benefil acts which are applicable to the Work to be performed; ,2 claims for damages because of bodily iniury, occupational sickness or disease, or death of the Contractor's employees; .3 claims for damages because of bodily inlury, sickness or disease, or death of any person olher than lhe Contractor's employees; .4 claims for damages insured by usual personal iniury liability coverage; .5 claims for damages, other than to ttle Work itself, because of iniury to or destruction oftangible property, including loss ofuse resulting therefrom; ,6 claims for damages because of bodily iniury, death of a person or property damage arising oul of ownership, maintenance or use of a motor vehicle; .7 claims for bodily iniury or property damage arising out of completed operalions; and ,8 claims involving contraclual liability insurance applicable to the Contractor's obligations under Paragraph 3.r8. ll.l.2 The insurance required by Subparagraph u.l.l shall be written for not less than limits of liability specified in the Contract Documents or required by law, whichever coverage is greater. Coverages, whether wrilten on an occunence or claims-made basis, shall be rnaintained without inlemrption from date of commencemenl of the Work until date of final payment and termination of any coverage required lo be maintained after linal payment. ll.l.3 Certificates of insurance acceptable to the Owner shall be filed with the Owner prior to commencement of rhe Work. These certificates and the insurance policies required by this Paragraph u.t shall conlain a provision that coverages afforded under lhe policies will not be canceled or allowed to expire until at least 3o days' prior writlen notice has been given to the Ov"ner. If any of the foregoing insurance coverages are required to remain in force afler final payment and are reasonably available, an additional certificate evidencing continuation ofsuch coverage shall be submitted with the final Application for Payment as requied by Subparagraph 9.ro.2. Information concerning reduction of coverage on account of revised lirnits or claims paid under the General Aggregate, or both, shall be furnished by the Contractor with reasonable promptness in accordance with the Contractor's information and belief. II.2 OWNER'S TIABILIW INSURANCE ll.2.l The Owner shall be responsible for purchasing and maintaining the Ovmer's usual liability insurance. II.3 PROJECT MANAGEMENT PROTECTIVE TIABILITY INSURANCE ll,3.l Opfionally, the Owner may require lhe Contractor to purchase and maintain Proiect Managemenl Protective Liability insurance frorn the Contractor's usual sources as primary coyerage for the Owner's, Conlractor's and Architect's vicarious liability for construction operations under the Contract- Unless otherwise required by the Contract Documents, the Owner shall reimburse the Conlractor by increasing the Contract Sum to pay the cost of purchasing and maintaining such optional insurance coverage, and the Contractor shall not be responsible for purchasing any other liability insurance on behalf of the Owner. The minimum limits of liability purchased with such coverage shall be equal to the aggregate of the limits required for Contractor's Liability Insurance under Clauses u.l.r.2 through u.1.r.5. I I I I I fHS DOCUMENT HN IMNNINII UGN cfi,rsEouEtrcEs. cousuuAnov wfH Nr a AffoRNEYtsENCOtnAcED!/|/fH I RESPECr tO tTs CoftrPt8liott q ITAFrcA|PN. AUT'f,Nf rcAf'ON OF TN' EUCTNONrcATTY DNr'flED NA I DOCUI,rf]NI MAY 8E MADE 8Y Vj,,16 NA .DOCUMENI D&'. fhis docunrn lps bn,en appwd ad I etfursd bv flr r'ulll,ciated Gercral tContr aclors of Arnerica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONsTRUCTION I I T I I I I l I t I @ CopyriSht l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961. 1953, 1956, 1957, 1970, 1975. lgg7;lggzbtTh- American Institute of Architects. Fifteenfh Ediiion. Reproduction of the maferial herein or substanfial The American Instifute of Architects quotation of ils provisions u/ithoul wrillen permission of lhe AIA violaies ihe copyright laws of the United 1735 New York Avenue, N.W.- ates and will subject lhe violale to leSal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed phorocopying violafes U.5. WashinSton, D.C.20@6-5292 pyright laws and will subject the violator lo legal proseculion. This documenf was eleclronically produced wilh permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license without violalion until lhe date of expiration as noted below. User Document: 03 - y2on@4. AIA License Number lll5@7, which expires on 5llV70o4. 35 I I I T I I I I I I I I I T I I I I I I 11.3.2 To the extent damages are covered by Pro ject Management Protective Liability insurance, lhe Owner, Contractor and Architect waive all rights against each other for damages, excepl such rights as they may have to the proceeds ofsuch insurance. The policy shall provide for such waivers ofsubrogation by endorsemenl or otherwise. 11.3.3 The Owner shall not require the Contractor lo include the Owner, Architect or other persons or entities as additional insureds on the Contractor's Liability Insurance coverage under Paragraph u.r. II.4 PROPERTYINSURANCE ll.4.l Unless otherwise provided, the Owner shall purchase and maintain, in a company or companies lawfully authorized lo do business in lhe iurisdiction in which the Proiect is located, property insurance written on a builder's risk "all-risk' or equivalent policy form in the amount of the initial Contract Sum, plus value of subsequent Contmct modifications and cosl of materials supplied or installed \ others, comprising tolal value for the entire Proiect at the sile on a replacenent cost basis without optional deductibles. Such property insurance shall be mainlained, unless otherwise provided in the Contract Documenls or olherwise agreed in writing by all persons and entities who are beneficiaries ofsuch insurance, until linal payment has been made as provided in Paragraph 9.ro or until no person or entity other than the Owner has an insurable interest in the property required by lhis Paragraph u.4 to be covered, whichever is later. This insurance shall include interests of the Owner, the Conlractor, Subcontraclors and Sub-subcontractors in the Project. ll.4.l.l Property insurance shall be on an "all-risk" or equivalent policy form and shall include, without limitation, insurance against the perils of fire (with extended coverage) and physical loss or damage including, without duplication of coverage, theft, vandalism, malicious mischiel collapse, earthquake, Ilood, windstorm, falsework, testing and startup, temporary buildings and debris removal including demolition occasioned by enforcement of any applicable legal requirements, and shall cover reasonable compensation for Architect's and Contractor's services and expenses required as a result ofsuch insured loss. 11.4.1.2 lfrhe Owner does not intend to purchase such property insurance required by the Contract and with all of the coveng,es in the arnount described above, the Owner shall so inform the Contmctor in wrifing prior to commencement of the Work. The Contractor may then effect insurance which will protect the interests of the Contractor, Subcontractors and Sub-subcontractors in the Work, and by appropriate Change Order the cost tbereof shall be charged to the Owner. If the Contractor is damaged by the failure or neglect ofthe Owner to purchase or rnaintain insurance as described above, witbout so notifying the Contractor in w ting, then the Owner shall bear all reasonable costs properly attributable therelo, 11.4.1.3 If rhe property insurance requires deductibles, the Owner shall pay costs not covered because of such deductibles. 11,4.t,4 This property insurance shall cover portions ofthe Work stored offlhe site, and also portions of tbe Work in transit. 11.4.1.5 Partial occupancy or use in accordance with Paragraph 9.9 shall not commence until the insurance company or companies providing property insurance have consented to such partial occupancy or use by endorsement or olherwise. The Owner and the Contractor shall take reasonable steps to obtain consent ofthe insurance company or companies and shall, without mutual written consent, take no action with respect to partial occupancy or use that would cause cancellation, lapse or reduction of insurance, 11,4,2 Boiler and Machinery Insurance. The Owner shall purchase and mainlain boiler and machinery insurance required by the Contract Documents or by lau wbich shall specifically cover such insured objects during installation and unlil final acceptance by the @ copyriSht l9ll, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961, 1963, 1966, 1967, 1970., '1976, 1987,1997 by The American Instilute of Archiiects. Fiffeenlh Edition. Reproduclion of ihe malerial herein or substantial quotation of ils provisions wilhoul wrillen permission of fhe AIA violafes fhe copyright laws of lhe United 'tates and will subject the violate lo legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violafes U.5. -opyrighi laws and will subject the violator to legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license wilhoul violation unlil the dale of expiration as noted below. User Documenf: 03 -- 3n0ncn,4. AIA License Number ll l5OO7, which expires on 'llflzoo,4-f7 f H5 WCUMEN| HAS WrcRf ANT UGAL 6oNSEOUEi'ICES. CO/I/6WI Af ION WIIH Alt ATIORMY 15 ETICOUMGED WTH RESPECT TO IfS COMP'TI'ON OR MOAFTAflON. AUr t#.Nf tCAf tON OF f'll' EITCIRONICAUY DRNTED NA DOCUMENI MAY BE MADE BY USING NA DOCUMEN| D401. fhis document ha been apyovd ad erdorsd by llc Asn<iatd Gercrd Conlradorc of Aftrerica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnsfituie of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20@G5292 - Owner; this insurance shall include interests of the Owner, Contraclor, Sukontractors and Sub-subcontractors in the Work, and the Owner and Contractor shall be named insureds. 11.4.3 Loss of Use lnsurance. The Owner, at the Owner's option, may purchase and maintain such insurance as will insure the Owner against loss of use of lhe Owner's property due to fire or olher hazards, however caused. The Owner waives all rights of action against the Contractor for loss ofuse ofthe Owner's property, including consequential losses due lo fire or other hazards however caused. 11.4.4 Ifthe Conlractor requests in writing tbat insurance for risks other than those described herein or other special causes of loss be included in the property insurance policy, the Ov'rner shall, if possible, include such insurance, and the cost lhereofshall be charged to the Contractor by appropriate Change Order. 11.4.5 If during the Proiect construction pedod the Owner insures properties, real or personal or both, at or adiacent to the site by property insurance under policies separate from those insuring the Proiect, or if after linal payment prope y insurance is to be provided on the completed Proiect lhrough a policy or policies other than those insuring the Proiect during the conslruction period, tbe Owner shall waive all rights in accordance with the terms of Subparagraph u.4.7 for damages caused by fire or other causes of loss covered by this separate property insurance. All separate policies shall provide this waiver of subrogation by endorsement or otherwise. 11,4.5 Before an exposure to loss may occur, the Owner shall file with the Contractor a copy of each policy that includes insurance coverages required by this Paragraph u.4. Each policy shall contain all generally applicable conditions, delinitions, exclusions and endorsements related to this Profect. Each policy shall contain a provision that the policy will not be canceled or allowed to expire, and that ils limits will not be reduced, until at least 3o days' prior written notice has been given to the Contractor. 11.4,7 Waivers of Subrogation. The Owner and Conlractor waive all rights against (r) each other and any of their subcontractors, sub-sukontractors, agents and employees, each of the other, and (2) rhe Architect, Architect's consultants, sepanrte contractors described in Article 5, ifany, and any ofrheir subcontractors, sub-subcontractors, agents and employees, for damages caused by fire or other caus€s of loss to the extent covered by property insurance obtained pursuanl to this Paragraph u.4 or other property insurance applicable to the Work, except such rights as they have to proceeds of such insurance beld by the Owner as fiduciary. The Owner or Contractor, as appropriate, shall require ofthe fuchitect, Architect's consultants, separate contraclors described in Article 6, if any, and the subcontractors, sub-sukontractors, agents and employees of any of fhem, by appropriate agreements, written where legally required for validity, similar waivers each in favor of other parties enumeraled herein. The policies shall provide such waivers of subrogation by endorcement or otherwise. A waiver of subrogation shall be effective as to a person or enlity even though that penon or entity would otherwise have a duty of indemnification, contraclual or otherwise, did not pay the jnsurance premium directly or indirectly, and whelher or not the person or entity had an insurable interest in the property damaged. 11.4.8 A loss insured under Owner's property insurance shall be adiusted by the Owner as fiduciary and made payable to the Owner as fiduciary for the insureds, as their interests may appear, subject 1o requirements ofany applicable mortgagee clause and ofSubparagraph tr.4.ro. Tbe Contractor shall pay Subcontractors their iust shares ofinsurance proceeds received by the Contractor, and by appropriate agreements, written where legally required for validity, shall require Subcontractors to make payments to their Sub-subcontractorc in similar manner. 11.4.9 If required in writing by a party in interest, the Owner as fiduciary shall, upon occurrence of an insured loss, give bond for proper performance of the Owner's duties. The o copyriSht l9ll, 1915, 1918, 192s, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961, 1953, 1965, 1967, 1970, 1975;1987;T9tTTtThe American Instilute of Archite(ts. Fiheenlh Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or substaniial quotation of its provisions withoul wrillen permission of fhe AIA violates lhe copyright laws of the United "ates and will subject the violate lo leSal prosecufion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. ,ryright laws and will subject lhe violator to legal prosecution. This document was elecfronically produced wifh permission of the AtA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without viola?ion until the date of expiration as noted below. User Do<umenl: 03 - 3nU2@4- AIA License Number ll l5OO7, which eroires on 5n3n@4. 38 IIIIS DOCUMENI HN IMPONfNfi ITGAL CoNSEWENCES. COt'ltWfAf tON WTH Nt Af IORMY IS ENCAJNAGED WI|H RESPECI fO 'r5 COMPtIftON OR MODE'CAIION. AU|HEMICA| ION OF TTIIS ELECIROMCNTY DN,4frED NA DOCUINENT MAY BE MADE BY 'ISING NA oocuttENf D40r. fhis dxumen tw tr'en approvd and etfursd by llc Asaciatd c*tr,al Conlracloq of Anwica. I I I T I I t I AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American Insiitute of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20006-5292 T I I I l I I I I I I I I T I I I I I l I I I T I I I t cost of required bonds shall be charged against proceeds received as fiduciary. The Owner shall deposit in a separate account proceeds so received, which the Owner shall distribute in accordance with such agreement as the parties in inlerest may reach, or in accordance with an arbilration award in which case the procedure shall be as provided in Paragraph 4.6. If afler such loss no other special agreement is made and unless the Owner terminates the Contract for convenience, replacement of damaged property shall be performed by the Contraclor afier notification of a Change in lhe Work in accordance with Article 7. ll.4.lo The Owner as fiduciary shall have power to adjusl and settle a loss with insurers unless one of the parties in interest shall obiect in wriling within five days after occurrence of loss to the Owner's exercise of lhis power; if such objection is made, the dispute shall be resolved as provided in Paragraphs 4.5 and 4.5. The Owner as fiduciary shall, in the case of arbitration, make settlement with insurers in accordance with directions ofthe arbitrators. Ifdistribution of insurance proceeds by arbitration is required, the arbitrators will direct such distribution. II.5 PERFORMANCE BOND AND PAYMENT BOND ll,5.l The Owner shall have the right to require the Contractor to furnish bonds covering fairhful performance of the Contract and payment of obligations arising thereunder as stipulated in bidding requirements or specifically required in the Contract Documents on the date of execulion oflhe Conlract. 11.5.2 Upon the request of any person or entity appearing to be a potential beneficiary of bonds covering payment of obligations arising under the Contract, the Contractor shall promptly furnish a copy of the bonds or shall perrnit a copy to be made. ARTICLE 12 UNCOVERING AND CORRECTION OF WORK I2.I UNCOVERING OF WORK l2.l.l If a portion of the Work is covered contrary to the Architect's request or to requirements specifically expressed in the Contract Documents, it must, if required in writing by the Architect, be uncovered for the Architect's examinalion and be replaced at the Contractor's expense without change in the Contract Time. 12.1.2 If a portion of the Work has been covered which the Architect has not specifically requested to examine prior to ils being covered, the Architect may request to see such Work and it shall be uncovered by the Contractor. If such Work is in accordance with tbe Contract Documents, cosls of uncovering and replacement shall, by appropriate Change Order, be at the Owner's expense. If such Work is not in accordance with the Contract Documents, conection shall be at the Contractor's expense unless the condition was caused by the Ovmer or a separate contractor in which event the Owner shall be responsible for payment ofsuch costs. 12.2 CORRECTION OF WORK I2.2.I BEFORE OR AFTER SUBSTANTIAT COMPLETION 12.2.1.1 The Contractor shall promptly correct Work reiected by the Architect or failing to conform to the requirements of lhe Contract Documents, whether discovered before or after Substantial Completion and whether or not fabricated, installed or completed. Costs of correcting such reiecled Work, including additional testing and inspections and compensation for the Architect's services and expenses made necessary thereby, shall be at the Contractor's expense. 12.2.2 AFTER SUBSTANTIAL COMPLETION 12.2,2.1 In addition to the Contractor's obligations under Paragraph :.S, if, within one year after the date of Substantial Completion of the Work or designated portion thereof or after the date for commencement of warranties established under Subparagraph 9.9.t, or by terms of an applicable special warranty required by the Contract Documents, any of the Work is found to be not in accordance with the requiremenls of the Contract Documents, the Contractor shall @ copyri8ht 1911, 'lgls, 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1961, 1963, 1966, 1967, 1970, 1976, 1987, 1997 by The American Inslifute of Architecls. Fifteenth Ediiion. Reoroduction ol the material herein or substantial quolaf ion of its provisions withoul writlen permission of lhe AIA violafes lhe copyright laws of the United ''ates and will subjecl the violate lo legal prosecufion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violales U.5. pyright laws and will subjeci ihe violator to legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced wifh permission of fhe AtA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license without violation unfil the date of expiralion as noted below. User Documenl: 03 -- y2O/20O4. AIA Li."nr" Number lll5OO7, which expires on 511312co4. 39 TTiS DOCUMENT Hr'S 'MrcRTN{T ITGAL coftsEQuENcES. cot'tswTAf toN wrH N't ATIORNEY IS EI,ICOURAGED WTH RESPECI tO tft COMPtrnq{ OR IIIODIFICAIION. Autt#.NftCAT,ON OF I lt| ELECrRONCNIY DMF| ED NA DOCUIviENI MAY 8E MADE BY USING NA DOCUMENT D4OI. This document hu been approvd ar:d e,dorced by flc Associatd cetr-ral Contr act ors of Nnerica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITION5 OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnstitute of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washinglon, D.C. 20006-5292 I correct it promptly after receipt of wdlten notice from the Owner to do so unless the Owner has previously given the Contractor a written acceptance of such condition. The Owner shall give such notice promptly after discovery of the condition. During the one-year period for corection of Work, if the Owner fails to notifr the Contractor and give the Contractor an opportunity lo make lhe correction, the Owner waives the rights to require correction by the Contractor and to make a claim for breach of \.r'arranty. If the Contractor fails to correct nonconforming Work within a reasonable time during that period after receipt of notice fiom the Owner or Architecl, the Owner may correct il in accordance with Paragraph 2.4. 12.2,2,2 The one-year period for correction of Work shall be extended with respect to portions of Work first performed after Subslantial Completion by the period of time between Substantial Complelion and the actual performance of the Work. 12.2.2.3 The one-year period for conection of Work shall not be extended by conective Work performed by the Contractor pursuant to lhis Paragraph u.r. 12.2,3 The Contractor shall remove from tbe site portions of the Work which are not in accordance with the requirements of the Contracl Documents and are neither corrected by the Contractor nor accepted by the Owner. 12.2.4 The Contractor shall bear the cost of conecting destroyed or damaged construction, whether completed or partially completed, ofthe Owner or separate contractors caused by the Contractor's conection or removal of Work which is not in accordance with the requirements of the Contract Documents. 12.2.5 Nothing contained in this Paragraph n.z shall be construed to eslablish a period of limitation wilh respect to other obligalions which rhe Contractor might have under the Contract Documents. Establishment of the one-year period for correction of Work as described in Subparagraph rz.z..z relates only to the specific obligation of the Contraclor to correct the Work, and has no relationship to the time within which the obligation to comply with the Contract Documents may be sought to be enforced, nor to the time within which proceedings may be commenced lo establish the Contractor's liabiliry with respect to the Conlractor's obligations other than specifically to conect the Work. I2.3 ACCEPTANCE OF NONCONFORMING WORK 12.3.1 If the Owner prefers to accept Work wbich is not in accordance with the requirements of the Contract Documents, lhe Owner may do so instead of requiring its removal and conection, in which case the Contract Sum will be reduced as appropriate and equitable. Such adiuslment shall be effected whether or not linal payment has been made. ARTICLE I3 MISCELLANEOUSPROVISIONS I3.I GOVERNING LAW 13.l,l The Contract shall be governed by the law ofthe place where lhe Project is located. 13.2 SUCCESSoRS AND ASSIGNS 13.2.1 The Owner and Contractor respectively bind themselves, lheir partners, successors, assigns and legal representatives to lhe other party hereto and to partners, successorc, assigns and legal representatives of such other party in respecl to covenants, agreements and obligations contained in the Contract Documents. Except as provided in Subparagraph r3.z.z, neither party to the Contract shall assign lhe Contract as a whole without wrilten consent of the other. Ifeither party attempts to make such an assignment wilhout such consenl, thar party shall nevertheless remain legally responsible for all obligations under the Contract. 13,2.2 The Owner may, without consent of the Contractor, assign the Contract 10 an institutional lender providing conslruclion financing for the Project. In such event, the lender O Copyri8ht 'l9l l, 1915, 1918, 1925, 1937, 195I, 1958, 1961, 1953, 1956, 1967, 1970, 1975, 1987, 1997 by The Ameri€an Institute of Architecis. Fifteenth Edition. Reproduction of the material herein or substanlial quotation of iis provisions without written permission of ihe AIA violates the €opyrighl laws of the United rtates and will sub.ject fhe violale to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopyinS violales U.5. rpyright laws and will subjecl fhe violafor to legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license without violation unfil ihe date of expiration as noled below. User Document: 03 -- y2U2Co4. AIA License Number lll5@7, which expires on 5ll3l2Co,4. 40 T I I TI II. ITIIS D&UMEN| IIAS MrcRfNTf I.EGN CONSEOUENCES, CONSULIAT|,ON WIH N f ATIO0MY $ Ei{CO|)MGEDWtfH IMSPECI fO tr' COMPtTftON OR t toDlf tCAT,ql. AUTHENI,CAIiON OF r,lt' EITCTROMCATY DRAIIED NA I DOCUMENT MAY 8E MAU BY US|NG NA aDOCUNENT ANOI. This doatnen ha fun approvd atd Iedorsd bv fl:c Associatd Gerwal tContractus of Anwica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnsiitufe of Architects 1735 New York Avenue, N.w. Washington, D.C. 20005-5292 t I T t T t I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I I I T I I I T I t I shall assume the Owner's rights and obligations under the Contract Documents. The Contractor shall execute all consents reasonably required to facilitate such assignment. I3.3 WRITTEN NOTICE 13.3.1 Written notice shall be deemed to have been duly sewed if delivered in person to the individual or a member of $e firm or entitv or to an officer of the corooration for which it was intended, or if delivered at or sent by regiitered or certified mail ro ihe last business address known to the party giving nolice. I3.4 RIGHTS AND REMEDIES 13.4.1 Duties and obligations imposed by the Contract Documents and rights and remedies available thereunder shall be in addition to and not a limitation of duties, obligations, rights and remedies otherwise imposed or available by law. 13.4.2 No action or failure to act by the Ovmer, Architect or Contractor shall constitute a waiver ofa righr or duty afforded them under the Contract, nor shall such action or failure to act constitute approval ofor acquiescence in a breach thereunder, except as may be specifically agreed in writing. I3.5 TESTS AND IN5PECTIONS 13.5.1 Tests, inspections and approvals of portions of the Work required by the Contract Documents or by laws, ordinances, rules, regulations or orders of public authorities having furisdiction shall be made at an appropriate time. Unless otherwise provided, the Contractor . shall make arangemenls for such lests, inspections and approvals with an independent testing laboratory or entity acceptable lo the Owner, or with the appropriate public authority, and shall bear all related costs of tests, inspections and approvals. The Contractor shall give the fuchitect timely notice of when and where tesls and inspections are to be made so that lhe Architect may be present for such procedures. The Owner shall bear co s of tests, inspections or approvals which do not becorne requirements until after bi& are received or negotiations concluded. 13.5,2 If tbe fuchitect, Owler or public authorities having jurisdiction determine that portions of the Work require additional testing, inspection or approval not included under Subparagraph 13.5.1, the fuchitect will, upon wriuen aulhorization from the Owler, instruct the Contraclor to make arrangements for such addirional testing, inspection or approval by an entity acceptable to the Owner, and the Contractor shall give timely notice to the Archilect of when and where lests and inspections are to be made so that the Architect may be present for such procedures. Such costs, except as provided in Subparagraph 13.5.3, shall be at the Owner's exPense. 13.5.3 Ifsuch procedures for testing, inspection or approval under Subparagraphs r3.5.r and 13.5.2 reveal failure of lhe portions of the Work to comply with requirements established by the Contract Documenls, all cosls made necessary by such failure including those of repeated procedures and compensalion for the Architect's seryices and expenses shall be al the Contractor's expense. 13.5.4 Required certificates of testing, inspection or approval shall, unless otherwise required by the Contract Documents, be secured by the Contractor and promptly delivered to the fuchitect. 13.5,5 If the Architect is to observe tests, inspections or approvals required by the Contracl Documenls, the Architect will do so promptly and, where practicable, at the normal place of testing. 13.5.5 Tests or inspections conducted pursuant to the Contract Documents shall be made promptly to avoid unreasonable delay in the Work. American Insfitute of Archite€ts. fifteenlh Edition- Reproduction of the material herein or 5ubstantial quoiation of iis provisions wilhout written permission of the AIA violafes fhe copyright laws of the United 'rales and will sub,iecl lhe violate lo le8al prosecuiion. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violales U.5. ,PyriSht laws and will subject the violalor lo leSal prose(ution. This document was elecfronically produced wilh P€rmission of the AtA and can be reprodtrced in accordance with your license without violation until the date of erpiralion as noled below. User Document: 03 -- 3ac/ncr.4. AtA License Number lll50o7, which expires on YlY2@4. 4l TI15 DOCUMEN| HIS 'MPC'BINII ITGAL CONSEOUET'ICES. COMUL| ATION WITH AN ATTORNEY IS ET{COURAGED W'f H RESPECr TO lf' COI\4PU||ON OR tttCDlF lCAf t0n. AUT HENTTAI PN Or r,45 EITC| ROMC AIIY DR,f f ED AIA DACUMEN| MAY 8E MADE BY USING A'A DACUMENT D/'OI. ffis document lps ber'n approvd ard edorsd by lhe Assxiatd C*neral Contractors of Anerica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnslitute of Architecis U35 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 2@06-5292 I 13.6 INTERE5T 13.6.1 Payments due and unpaid under the Contract Documents shall bear interest from the date payment is due at such rate as the parties may agree upon in wriling or, in the absence thereof, at lhe legal rate prevailing from lime to time at lhe place where the Proiect is located. 13.7 COMMENCEMENT OF STATUTORY LIMITATION PERIOD ]3.7,1 As between the Owner and Contractor: .l Before Substantial Completion, As to acts or failures to act occurring prior to the relevant date of Substantial Completion, any applicable statuti of limitations shall commence to run and any alleged cause of action shall be deemed to haye accrued in any and all events not later than such date of Substantial Completion; .2 Between Substantial Completion and Final Certificate for payment. As to acts or failures to act occurring subsequent to the relevant date of'substantial Completion and prior to issuance_- of the final Certilicate for payment, any applicable statute of limitalions shall commence to run and any alleqed cause of action shall be deemed to have accrued in any and all evenis not later than the date ofissuance ofthe final Certilicate for Payment; and.3 After Final Certificate for Paymenf. As to acts or failures to act occuning after the relevant date of issuance of the final Certificate for payment, any applicable stalute of limitations shall commence to run and any alleged cause of action shall be deemed lo have accrued in any and all events not kler than the dale .of -any -act or failure to act by the Conlractor puruant to any Warranty provided under Paragraph 3.5, the date ofany conection of the Work or failure to conect the Work by the Contractor under Paragraph rz.z, or the date of actual commission of any other act or failure to perform any duty or obligation by the Contractor or Owner, whichever occurs last. ARTICTE 14 TERMINATION OR SUSPENSION OF THE CONTRACT I4.I TERMINATION BYIHE CONTRACTOR l4.l.l The Contractor may terminate the Contract if the Work is stopped for a period of 3o consecutive days through no act or fault of the contractor or a subcontraclor, sub- subconlractor or their-agents or employees or any other penons or entilies performing portions of the Work under direct or indirect contracl with the Contractor, for any of the fillowing reasons: .l issuance ofan order ofa courl or olher public authority having jurisdiction which requires all Work to be stopped;.2 an act ofgovernmenl, such as a declaration ofnational emergency which requires all Work to be sropped;,3 because the fuchitect has not issued a Certificate for Payment and has not notified the Contractor ofthe reason for withholding certification as provided in Subparagraph 9.4.r, or becaux the Owner has not made payment on a Certificate for Payment within the time stated in the Contract Documents; or.4 the Owner has failed to fumish to the Contractor promptly, upon the Contraclor's request, reasonable evidence as required by Subparagraph z.u,r. 14.1.2 The Contractor may terminate lhe Conlract if, through no act or fault of the Contractor or a Subcontractor, Sub-subcontraclor or their agents or employees or any other Persons or entities performing portions ofthe Work under direct or indirect conlract wifh the Contractor, repealed suspensions, delays or interruptions of the entire Work by the Owner as described -in Paragraph r4.3 constitute in the aggregate more than roo percefl of the total number ofdays scheduled for completion, or reo dalr in any 365-day period-, whichever is less. O Copyrighr l9ll, 1915, 1918, 192 American Institute of Archifecfs. fifieenth Ediiion. Reproduction of the maferial herein or substintial quotalion_ot its provisions without wrilten prermission of lhe AIA violates the copyri8ht laws of the United'tates and will subject the violate lo legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.S. ,pyright laws and will subjecf the violator to leSal prosecution. This documenf was electronically produced wilh permission of fhe AtA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license without vioiaiion until the dale of expiralion as noled below. User Do€ument: 03 -- 3/2ol2oo4. AIA License Number 'l ll5Oo7, which expires on 511Y2@4. 4Z I I I t I f llls NcuMENt '1t6IqrcRf Nfi UGAI coNsEouENcEs. cottsuf ATtoN wfiH Nt I AttoRNEY S ENCOUf(/IGED|y|/1,TH rnEsPfcf to tfs coMntno ofr MODE\CA| tON. AWI#.N CA ON OF Tt S ELECTRONCNIY DRA|IEDNA I 0€/CUMENI MAY BE. MADE BY US|,NG ArA JDOCUMEN| D/N'. '##Ir;TEH:,tr#,";' ICo rxto$ of Annrica. ArA DOCUMEI{T A20l - 1997 GENERAL CONDIIIONS Of THE CONTRACT FOR CONSTRUCIION The American lnititute of Ar(hiie(ts 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, D.C. 20@6-5292 I I T I T t I T I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I t I T I I I I 14.1,3 If one of the reasons described in Subparagraph r4.r.r or 14.r.2 exists, the Contractor may, uPon seven days' written notice to the Owner and Architect, lerminate the Contract and recoyer from lhe Owner payment for Work executed and for proven loss with respect lo materials, equipmenl, lools, and construction equipment and machinery, including reasonable overhead, prolit and damages. 14,1,4 If the Work is stopped for a period of 5o consecutive days through no act or fault of lhe Contractor or a Sukonlractor or their agenls or employees or any other persons performing portions of the Work under conlract with rhe Contractor because the Owner has persistently failed to fulfill the Owner's obligations under the Contract Documents with respect to matters important to the progess of the Work, the Contractor may, upon seven additional days' written notice to the Owner and the Architecl, terminate the Conlract and recover from the Owner as provided in Subparagaph r4.r.3. I4,2 TERMINATION BYTHE OWNER FOR CAUSE 14.2.1 The Owner may terminale the Contract if the Contractor: .l persistently or repeatedly tefuses or fails to supply enough properly skilled workers or proper materials; .2 fails to make payment to Subcontractors for materials or labor in accordance with the respective agreemenls belween the Contraclor and the Subconlractors;.3 persistenrly disregards laws, ordinances, or rules, regulations or orders ofa public authority having iurisdiction; or ,4 otherwise is guilty of substantial breach of a provision of the Contract Documents. 14,2,2 When any of the above reasons exisl, the Owner, upon certification by the Architect that sufficient cause exists to justify such action, may without preiudice to any other rights or rernedies of the. Ov,'ner and ifter giving the Contrictor and ihe-Contractorb surety, If any, seven days' wdtten notice, terminate employment of the Contractor and may, subiect to any prior rights ofthe suret)4 .l take possession oflhe site and ofall materials, equipment, tools, and construction equipment and machinery thereon owned by the Contractor;.2 accept assignment ofsubcontracts pursuant to Paragraph 5.4; and.3 finish the Work by whatever reasonable method the Owner may deem expedient. Upon request of lhe Contractor, the Owner shall furnish to the Contractor a detailed accounting of lhe costs incurred by the Owner in finishing the Work. 14.2.3 When the Owner terminates the Contract for one of the reasons stated in Subparagraph r4.zl, the Contractor shall not be entitled to receive further payment until the Work is finished. 14,2.4 If the unpaid balance of the Contract Sum exceeds costs of finishing the Work, including compensalion for the Architect's services and expenses made necessary thereby, and other damages incurred by the Owner and not expressly waived, such excess shall be paid to rhe Contractor. If such costs and damages exceed the unpaid balance, the Contractor shall pay the difference to the Owner. The amount to be paid to the Contractor or Owner, as the case may be, shall be certified by the Architect, upon application, and this obligation for payment shall survive termination of the Contract. I4.3 SUSPENSION BY THE OWNER FOR CONVENIENCE 14.3,1 The Owner may, without cause, order the Contractor in writing to suspend, delay or intenupt the Work in whole or in part for such period of time as the Owner may determine. 9 Copyrighr 19 , 1915, l9l& 1925, ',t932 t951, ',t958, 1961, 1963, 1965, 1967, 1970, 1976, 1987, 1997 by The American lnstifufe of Archifecfs. Fifteenth Edifion. Reoroduction of lhe material herein or substantial quotation of ils provisions withoui wrillen permission oi the RIA violates the copyright laws of the United <tates and will subject the violafe to legal prosecution. WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.S. >yright laws and will subject the violafor to legal prosecution. This document was electronically produced ..rth permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance with your license withoul violafion unlil lhe date of expiration as noied below. User Documenf: 03 -- 3?U2OO4. AIA License Number l'll5OO7, which expires on 5ll3l20o4. 43 f IXS DOCUMEN| HAS MrcRf r'0|f ITGAL CONSEfl)E|{(,Ei. COi,!SULI AI,ON wlfH Ail ATIORNEY IS EIK.OUMGED WITH RESPECI tO 'tS CONtPttftON Ofr WDIF'CA\'ON, AUIHENTICAIION OF f I4S ELECTRONCNIY DRAF TED NA Do(UMENI MAY BE MADE BY u'/NG NA DOCU|WN| D/pl. t s docvment lns been approvd ard erfursd by lllc Associated Cffieral Cont r actors of America. olgtT AtAo AIA DOCUMENT A2OI . 1997 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT FOR CON5TRUCTION The American lnstitule of Archile€ts 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washinglon, D.C. 20006-5292 $ffi 14,3.2 The Contract Sum and Contract Time shall be adiusted for increases in the cost and tirne caused by suspension, delay or interruption as described in Subparagraph r4.3.r. Adiustment of the Contract Sum shall include profit. No adiustment shall be made to the extenl: .l lhat performance is, was or would have been so suspended, delayed or intemrpted by another cause for which the Contractor is responsible; or .2 that an equilable adiustment is made or denied under another provision ofthe Contract. 14.4 TERMINATION BY THE OWNER FOR CONVENIENCE 14.4.1 The Owner may, at any time, terminate the Contract for the Owner's convenience and without cause. 14.4,2 Upon receipt of writlen notice from the Owner of such termination for the Owner's convenience. the Conlractor shall: .l cease operations as directed by the Owner in the notice; .2 take actions necessary or that the Owner may direct, for the protection and preservation of the Work; and ,3 except for Work directed to be performed prior to the effective date of ternination stated in the notice, terminate all existing subcontracts and purchase orders and enler into no further subcontracts and purchase orders. 14.4.3 In case of such termination for the Owner's convenience, the Contractor shall be entitled to receive payrnent for Work executed, and costs incurred by reason of such termination, along with reasonable overhead and profit on the Work not executed. O Copyrighl t9ll, 1915. 1918, 1925, 1937, 1951, 1958, 1951, 1963, 1965, 1967, r97O, 1976, l98t l99Z5tTh- American Institute of Archite€fs. Fifleenfh Edition. Reproduclion of the material herein or substantial quotation of its provisions withoui writlen permission of lhe AIA violales the copyright laws of the United 'tates and will subject ihe violale to legal prosecution. wARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.5. ,pyright laws and will subject the violator to legal prosecution. This document was eleclronically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced in accordance wilh your license withouf violafion until the date of expiralion as noted below. User Document: 03 - 3/2ol20o4. AIA License Number lll50o7, which expires on 5113120p'4. 44 T I I I ! II TI.,S DOCUIVENr HAS ITI,'rcNTN{T ITGAL coNSEWUrcES. COtf,atLtArtON WfiH Nt f AITCf;jMV'SENCo.JP./IGEDW'TH I Ff,l,PECf TO tTS COtt fl.EftON OR t'n@ff,cAf tou. AUftENltcATloN oF t.ls ELECTRONKAUJ tnAFfED eta I DOCUMEM MAY BE MADE 8Y UStt{6 NA aDoCUttENTD40l. Ttis dor.unrlf lw tcen approvd ard I etdorsd bY f Ie Associard (Erwd tContr;r,tors of /uner.ica. AIA DOCUMENT A2OI - 1997 GENERAT CONDITIONS OF THE CONTRACT TOR CONSTRUCTION The American lnslitute of Ar€hitecfs 1735 New York Avenue, N.W. Washington, O.C. 20005-5292 t I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I I I I 2002r s01.08 VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE Adopted Code: 2003 Intemational Building Code Construction Type: T1,pe II-A Primary Occupancv: R-2 Maximum Heisht: 85 feet, 5 stories (Height Modification 504.2) Maximum Area: 24,000 square feet Section 301 - Use and Occuoancv Classilication Occupancv Classilication Group A-2; Assembly Group A-3; Assembly Group B; Business Group R-l; Residential Group R-2 Residential Group S-l Storage - Moderate Hazard Group S-2 Storage - Low Hazard Group S-2 Storage - Low Hazard Occupancy Senaration - Table 302.3.3* Use Restaurant Health club Office Hotel Apartment/Fractional Fee Miscellaneous Hotel Storage Parking Garage Storage - Food Products 3tzt/2004 * Separation (V Reduction) * Exception 302.3.3 - I hour reduction for fully sprinklered building Adjacency A-UA-3 A-2lR-l AAB..2 A-2lS-l A-2tS-2 A-3/R-l A-3/R-2 A-3lS-l A-3/S-2 R-l/s-l R-l/s-2 R-2lS-1 R-2tS-2 R-1/R-2 A-2/A-2 A-3/A-3 R-1/R-l R-2/R-2 s-l/s-1 s-2is-2 Seoaration 0able 302.3.3) 2 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 3 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 3 How 2 Hour 3 Hour 2 Hour 3 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 2 Hour 3 Hour 2 Hour I Hour I Hour I Hour 2 How l Hour l Hour I Hour 2 Hour I Hour 2 Hour l Hour 2 Hour Hor.rr Hour Hour Hour Hour Hour 2 Hour I Hour BUILDING CODEREVIEW 01000 - I 302.3.2 Separated Uses Floor Level Occupancy Group 2002150r.08 kvel 155 (Basement*) Level 155 (Basement*) Level 155 (Basement*) Sub-Total Level 155 Level 166 (Basenrent*) Level 166 (Basement*) Lwel 166 (Basement*) Level 166 (Basement*) Sub-Total Level 166 l*vel 177 (Level One) l*luel 177 (Level One) Level777 (Level One) Level177 (Level One) I'evel177 (Level One) L.evel 177 (Level One) Level 177 (Level One) Sub-Totel Level177 Level 186 (Level Two) Level 186 (Level Two) Sub-Totrl Level 186 Level 196 (Level Three) Level 196 (Level Three) Sub-Total Level 196 Level2O7 (Level Four) Level 207 (kvel Four) SubTotal Level 207 Lev el 2l'l (Level Five**) Total VAIL MOI-]NTIAN LODGE 3t2l/2004 Calculated Area Ratio 12,53t O.54 1,142 0.03 2.555 0.1I t6,228 0.69 T I I I I I I I I I t I I I I t I t I R-l A-3 R-2 lncidental Uses (A-3) (Not in Tonl) A-3 R-2 92 Incidental Uses (A-3) (Not in Total) A-2 (Restaurant) A-2 (Kitchen) A-2 (Lobby) R-l R-2 B (Accesory Uses) Incidental Uses (R-l) R-l R-2 R-l R-2 R-l R-2 Slories Table 503 J 4 4 Allowable Area Table 503 23,09s 35,760 23.095 3 4 5 4 23,095 35,7ffi 39,000 23.095 23,09s 23,095 23,O95 35,760 35,7ffi 37,500 35,760 35,760 35,7ffi 35,760 3s,760 35,760 35,760 35,760 107,280 12,32r I,153 4,363 1.157 18,994 3,567 r,202 1,586 2,354 7,078 1,030 604 17,421 4,090 10.948 15,038 2,337 r2.710 15,047 3,146 5.905 9,051 876 s7,433 0.53 0.03 0.11 0.05 0.73 0.t5 0.05 0.07 0.07 0.20 0.03 0.02 0.sE 0.1 I 0.31 0.42 0.07 0.36 0.42 0.09 0.t7 0.25 0.02 0.54 {' 503.1.1 Basements need not be included in the total allowable area provided they do not exceed the area permitted for a one-story building. BUILDING CODE REVIEW 01000 - 2 ' 20021501.08 VAIL MOLTNTIAN LODGE 3t2u2004 I ** 504.2 Automatic sprinkler increase. r Section 502 Definitions r B"*.*t - Ttrt po.tt"n of a building that is partly or completelybelow grade plane. A I basement shall be considered as a story above grade plane where the finished surface of! the floor above the basement is: I t:. M::: ffifr3::1H1flJff,111";,""0 rever ror more rhan 50% orthe total building; or - 3. More than 12 feet above the finished ground level at any point. Section 504 Heieht Modifications I 504@ increase - The maximum Height is increased by 20 t feet and the maximum number of stories is increased by one story. (85'-5 stories). - Section 506 Area Modifications I s06@Atxk)/100)+((Arxkyl00) r f-#1ffi3i"f;::liiffi1 z.,oo',sq.ft..A2lA3: 15,500sq.ft. I k - Frontage Increase (506.2) - 47 Is - Sprinkler Increase (506.3) - 200% I Aa:24,000 + ((24,000 x47)/l00) +(24,000 x 2)/100) | fr:3ifHl,1',1:','"?if1l'&,*, A": 15,500 + ((15,500 x 47)/LO0) +((15,500 x21100) I Aa = 15,500 + (7,285) +(310) I A" = 23,095 sq. ft. per floor (A2lA3) I 506.2 Frontage Increase - Ir: 100 x (F/P-0.25) x (W30) t Ir- Increase F- Total Building Perimeter - 660' I P - Perimeter w/ Frontage > 20'- 540'r W - Public Way/Open Space Width:25' I Ir: 100 x (540'1660'-0.25) x (25/30)r k=47 I 506.3 Sprinkler IncreaseI ForMultistoryBuildings -k:200% I 506.4 Area Determinationr For three story or higher buildings, multiply by 3, I I BUILDINGCODEREVIEW 01000 - 3 20021501.08 VAILMOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2U2004 No story shall exceed the allowable area per floor (A"), as determined in section 506.1. Total Area - 35,760 x 3 : 107,280 (Rl/RZ) 602.2 Types I and II construction. Types I and II construction are those types of construction in which the building elements listed in Table 601 are of non-combustible materials. Table 601 Buildine Element Ratine I I I I I I I I t t t I I I I I I I I Exterior non-bearing walls Table 602 lnterior non-bearing walls 0 hour Structural Frame Bearing Walls Floor construction Roof Construction < 5 feet >5" <10' >10" <30' >30' Table 602 Fire Sep. Dist. Ratine I hour I hour I hour I hour I hour I hour I hour 0 hour 603.1 Allowable Materials. Combustible materials shall be permitted in buildings of Tlpe I or II construction in the following applications and in accordance with Sections 603.1. I through 603.1.3. 4. roof coverings that have an A, B, or C, classification. 6. Where not installed over 15 feet above grade, show windows, nailing or furring strips, wooden bulkheads below show windows, their frames, aprons, and showcases. 10. Combustible exterior wall coverings, balconies, or similar appendages in accordance with Chapter 14. 1l. Blocking for handrails, millwork, cabinets, and window and doorframes. 1405.4 Wood veneers. Wood veneers on exterior walls of buildings of Type I, II, II, and fV construction shall not be less than l-inch nominal thickness and shall conform to the following: 1. The veneer does not exceed three stories in height, measured form grade except where fire retardant treated wood is used; the height shall not exceed four stories. 2. The veneer is aftached to or fuired from a non-combustible backing that is fire resistant rated as required by other provisions ofthis code. BUILDING CODE REVIEW 01000 - 4 '- 20021s01.08 vArL MoITNTIAN LoDGE 3/21t2004 I 704.8 Allowable area of openings. The maximum area of unprotected or protected openings permitted in an exterior wall in any story shall not exceed the values set forth in I Table 704.8. ! Table 704.8 I Openins Distance Allowed % Elevation Wall Openine Actualt Unprotected l0'to 15' l5% West r.ffi.f. #t '-W I Unprotected < 30' No Limit N/SiE No Limitr 706.1 Fire Barriers, General. Fire Barriers used for separation of shafts, exits, exit I passageways, horizontal exits or incidental use areas, toseparate different occupancies, tot se,parate a single occupancy into different fire areas, or to separate other areas where a fire barrier is required. 'r 707.2 Shaft enclosures required. Openings through a floor/ceiling assembly shall be - protected by a shaft enclosure. r 707.4Fire resistance rating. 2 hours for four stories or more. I hour connecting less - than four stories. I 707,14 Elevator shafts. Elevator hoist-way enclosures shall be constructed in accordance I with Section 707.4 and Chapter 30. I 707.14.1 Elevator Lobby. Elevators opening directly into a fire resistive rated corridor as required by Section l0l6 shall be provided with an elevator lobby at each I floor containing such a corridor. The lobby shall separate the elevators from the corridor I by fire partitions and the required opening protection. r 708.1 Fire partitions, General. The following wall assemblies shall comply with this I section.r! l. Walls separating sleeping units in occupancies in Group R-l hotel occupancies, - and R-2. I 2. Corridor walls as required by Section 1016.1. 3. Elevator lobby separation as required by section 707.14.1 I 708.3 Fire resistive rating. The fire-resistive rating ofthe walls shall be I hour. I 711.3 Horizontal assemblies. Floor assemblies separating dwelling units in the same t building or sleeping units in occupancies in Group R-l hotel occupancies and R-2 shall be a minimum of I hour fire-resistive-rated construction. I I I I BUILDING CODE REVIEWr 01000 - 5 20021501.08 Section 715 Opening Protectives Table 715.3 Assembly Tqre Fire Barriers o Shaft, exit enclosure, exit passageway o Other Fire Barriers Fire Partitions o Corridor Walls o Other Partitions Exterior Walls VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE I Hour I Hour I Hour I Hour I Hour other exitways B B c c C C 3lzt/2004 Required Rating Min. Fire Door Ratine 2 Hour 90 Minute 60 Minute 45 Minute 20 Minute 45 Minute 45 Minute I t I I I I I I I I t t I I t I I I I Table 803.5 Interior Wall and Ceiling Finish requirements by occupancy Group Vertical exits and exit Exit access corridors and Rooms and enclosed A-2 A-3 R-1 R-2 S B passageways B B B C c B spaces c C c c C C Table 1004.1.2 Maximum floor area allowance per occupant Occupancy Assembly - Unconcentated Business Areas Exercise rooms Kitchen -commercial Locker rooms Parking Garages Residential Pools Pool deck Accessory storage areas, mechanical Floor Area/Occupant 15 net 100 gross 50 gross 200 gross 50 gross 200 gross 200 gross 50 gross 15 gross 300 gross Table 1005.1 Egress width per occupant served Occupancy Stairways OtherComponents M,y'.3, Rl, R2, B, S 0.2 0.15 1009.1 Stairway width. The width of stairways shall be detsrmined by Section 1005.1 but not less than 44 inches. Stairways serving and occupant load ofless than 50 shall have width not less than 36 inches. 1009.2 Headroom. Stairways shall have a minimum headroom of 80 inches. BUILDING CODE REVIEW 01000 - 6 r 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2t/2004 ! f 009.3 Stair Treads and risers. Stair risers heights shall be 7 inches maximum. Stair _ tread depths shall be I I inches minimum. Within dwelling units in R-2 occupancies, the I maximum riser height shall be 7.75 inches and the minimum tread depth shalt be t O! inches. A nosing of 1.25 inches shall be provided on stairways with solid risers where the tread depth is less than 1l inches. - Table 1014.1 r Giffi-oo"-."orof "gr"r,I Occupancy Max. Occ. LoadA.B 50 Rl0ls30r I 1014.2 Exit access arrangement. Where a building is equipped with an automatic I sprinkler system, the separation ofthe exit doors or exit access doorways shall not be less than one-third of the overall diagonal dimension of the area served. I Table l0l5.l Exit access travel distance I Occupancv With Sprinkler Svstem I A, R, S-l 250 feet B 300 feet t Table 1016.1 Corridor Fire Resistance Ratins I Occupancy Occuoant Load Ratine W Sprinkler System I A,B,S >30 0R >10 0.5 t 1017.1 Exits, General. Once a given level of exit protection is achieved, such a level shall not be reduced until arrival at the discharge. I 1019.1 Vertical Exit Enclosures Required. Interior exit stairways shall be enclosed with fire barriers. Exit enclosures shall have a rating of not less than 2 hours when I corurecting four stories or more and not less than I hour when connecting less than fourI stories. I I t I I BIIILDING CODE REVIEW 01000 - 7 I I I t I t I I I t t I I I T I I I I ARCIIITECTURE . PLANN t N G . I N TE RI O RS SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963.41 02 ganlaba,bara@zehrsn-com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP. 1 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501 .00 Issue Date: Available Throueh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269C Kitchen Manufacturer: Sub-Zero Product Refriserator ProductNumber; 642 Descriotion: 42"Side-bv-SideRefriserator/FreEzer Dinrnsion: M" Hx42" W x 24" D Color/Finish: Stainless Steel Cormnents: Suoolier to verifo that all necessarv Darts for inslallation are ordered Enerev Star Com iant Picture is representational Color may vary vaz E H R E N ,r,o,n.n-o'uYAF,e7o)e4e-1oeo - AND ASSOCIATES yair@zehren.'com' 7.,ehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP.2 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Spegificatiqn Location: 269C Kitchen Manufacturer: Vikine Product: Range Product Number: 48" VDSC Description: 48" Professional Dual Fuel Freesanding Range Dinrension: 48"Wx36'Hx28'D Color/Finish: Stainless Steel Conrnents: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)963S890 FAX (805)963-8 1 02 santabarbar@zdren.com E.PLANNING.INTERIORS i-Z E H R E-N ,rro,.o*ruYfll,e7o)e4e-1o8o - AND ASSOCIATES "airgzrnrn.'co.n' I I I I I t I I t I I I I I T I T I I A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G ,,.,s,Sj*TSRiEBiS,.. 7=Z E H R E N sa.iabarbara@zehren.com -- AN D ASSOCIATES INTERIORS VAIL (970)949.02s7 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@zeirsn.corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP-3 Proiect Information Name: Vuil Mo Location: V"tt, C"t""rd" ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269C Kitchen Manufacturer: Viking Product: Ransc Hood ProductNumber: VWH4878 Description: Dimension: 48"Wx 18" Hx27" D Color/Finish: Conrnents: Supplier to veri$ thal all necessary parts for installation are ordered P jcture is representational Color may vary Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP-4 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269C Kitchen(2) Manufactuer: Bosch Product Dishwasher ProductNumber: SHV66A03 Description: Integated 6 Cycle Dishwasher Dinrcnsion: 33718"-35"Hx23518" -24118"W x239116"D ColorlFinish: Stainless Steel Comments: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I N TE RI OR S SANTA BARBARA (80s)9636890 FAX (805)96181 02 santabsbarg@zqhtqn.com VAIL (970)949{2 57 FAX (970)94+.1080 veil@zehrBn.com I T I I I I I I I I I I I I t t I I I akoE,^T,&,[,]: I I t t I I t I t I I I I I T I T I t ARCHITECTURE . PLANNI N G. I N TERI O RS SANTA BARBARA (E05)963€E90 FAX (605)96$8 r 02 saJtab€rbara@zshrsn.co.n Zehren & Associates Specilication Sheet APP.5 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado PrqlectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throueh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilication lncation: 269C Kitchen Manufactuer: Sham Trim Kit: Sharp Product: Microwave ProductNumber: RK-42S24 Product Number: R-430CS Color/Finish Stainless Steel Description: Built-in Dimension: Hl23l8" W 21 1116" D 17 318" -ColorlFinish: Stainless Steel Comrnents: Supplier to veri& that all necessary pads for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary 7aZ E H R E N ,nro,*n-o.uYAltsTo)e4e-108o - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren,'clm' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP-6 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location; Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throupb Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: l49A Laundry Manufacturer: Maytag Product: Wasber ProductNumber: MAV950IE, Atlantic Description: Wasber Dimension: 53 l/8" H x 27" W x 28 l/4" D Colorffinish: White Comments: Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NI NG. I N TE Rl ORS T t I I I I I I I I T I T t SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)9638102 3ar$ab€rbata@z6ht6n-cotn I I I I I zr"5 s, &,F, fj*,0,*,-oJA|1,,^)e4$1oso I I I I I t t T I I I I t I t I I t t ARCHITECTURE . PLANNING. I N TE RI O RS SANTA BARBARA (E05)963€890 FAX (8O5)96'8102 santabarbara@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP-7 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throueh Supplier: Ad&ess: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification location: l49A Lamdrv Manufacturer: Maytag Product: Dryer ProductNumber: MDET400A,Atlantic Description: Electric Dryer ,Dimension: 43 318. Hx27" W x28 l/4" D Colorffinish: White Conrnents: Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary 7AZ E H R E N (e7o)e4e4257vfllL(e7o)e4e-io8o - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP.8 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilication Location: 3028 Kitchen,3088 Kitcheq 404B Kitchen N{anufacturer: Sub'Zcro Product: Refriserator ProductNumber: 561 Description: 36"Side-by-SideRefrigerator/Freezer Dimension: 84'Hx36"Wx24"D ColorlFinish: IntersratedWoodPanel Connnents: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G . I N TE RI OR S t I I I t I I I T I I I I II I t t SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)96Hr 02 sanlabarbare@zeh€n-com T t zr"oE ^frs,irfj,n,o,*..",.y4f,1,,^p4$1o8o I T I I I t I I t T I t I t t I I t I A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (605)96$81 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FA)( (970)949-1 O80 vail@zehren.corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP-9 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 3028 Kitchen,3088 Kitcheq 4048 Kitchen Manufacturer; Dacor Product Wall Oven ProductNrunber: PCSI30,heference Description: 30" Single Electric Oven Dimension: 30" W x 28 3/8" H x 23 718"D Color/Finish: Stainless Sleel Corunents: Supplier to verify that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Pichre is representational Color may vary zks#,*,1,N Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP - IO Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specillcat!!'! Location: 3028 Kilchen,3088 Kitcheq 404B Kitchen Manufacturer: Dacor Product: Cooktop Product Nuniber: CER304, Millenia Description: 3O"Electic Cookrop with 4 Elernents Dimension: 30"Wx2l'D ColorlFinish: Black Graphite Cormnents: Supplier to verify that all necessary parts for irstallation are ordered Picture is represantational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I N T E R I O R S I I I t I II I I t I I II t t I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)96981 02 santaba rbara@zehren-c!fn T I zk$ s, s,i, N,n,0,**_,JAlf,.^)e4$1o80 T U I I J T t il J t I I I t t I I I t ARCIIITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8O5)Sr3€890 FAX (8Os)9618102 saniabarb€ra@zohrrncom INTERIORS VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)949.1 08O vail@zohren.@m Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP. 11 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 3028Kitchen,3088Kitchen,4048Kitchen Manufachrer: Dacor Product: ProductNumber: PMOR3O Description: Over th Cooktop Microwave, Vented Dimension: 29 15116" W x 16 3/8" H x 16 7/8" D ColorlFinish: Stainless Sleel Cornrnents: Suppter to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary ar"s #,s,E^,f: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP. 12 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Pbone: Fax: Specification Location: 3028Kitchen,3088Kitchen,4048Kitchen Manufach.rrer: Bosch Product: Dishwasher ProductNumber: SHV46C03 Description: Intigrated 4 Cycle Dishwasher Dimension: 33718"-35"Hx23518" -24ll8"W x239/16"D Color/Finish: Custom Wood Panel Corrrnenls: Supplier to verify that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is repres€ntational Color mav varv I T I I I I I ,i il I I I t ARCHITECTURE . PLANNIN G . I SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-6890 FAX (8Os)963-81 02 santaba lbara@z€h,€n.com NTERIORS VAIL (970)949-O2s7 FA)( (970)9491 O80 vail@zehrsn.cfi I J I I I I zr"oE 05,s,[,!: INTERIORS VAIL (97 0)9494257 FAX (970p4$. 1 O8O vail@z€ftren.com ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)96$61 02 sa.tab€tbara@zehren.com t I il ! I I t t 0 Il I t I 0 I I I I Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP - 13 Pro.iect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302T WD, 308T W/D, 404T WD Manufachrer: Maytag Product: St""t "bt" W"rh.t & Dty* ProductNumber: LSE7806A Description: Stackable Washer & Dryer Dimension: 73" Hx28" W x27 ll2" D Colo/Finish: Comrnents: Supplier to veri$ that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color nray vary Zf"oEn3rS,t^'!! Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP - 14 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: $pecificafon Location: 303C Bedrooq 305G Living,304A Hall,306A Hall,403CBedroorn,407A Ha[, 409,{ Hall, 4l lA Hall, 4l5C Bedroorq 4l7A Hall, 4l9A Hall, 509A Hall, 5l le Hall, 6074, Hall, 609A Hall, 6l lA Hall, 6134' Hall, & 615A Hall Manufactmer: U-Line Product: ProductNumber: l5R Description: N/A Dirnension: 28 5/32" H x 13 15/16"W Colorffinish: Custom Wood Panel Comrents: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary I I I il I t T t 0 I I I I A RCIIITECTURE . PL AN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963589O FAX (805)963-8102 sanlabaabaaa@zehrgn.cortt INTERIORS VAlL (97O)949O2s7 FAX (970)94$.1 080 vail@zehten. corn I 0 I I I I zr"5J,*,E^,!! I I t T I I t t t, t I I I I I t, t I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (80s)963-8 102 santabarbara@zottren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949. 1 080 vail@zehren.cam Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP - 15 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Localion: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:307E Kitch, 309E Kirch, 3l lE Kitch 70lE Kitch & 702E Kirch Cervitor Kitchens, Inc. Kitchen Unit NMTO Sink, Faucet, 2 Burners & 6.4Cu. Ft. Undercounter Refrigerator 72" W x4O" x24" D Plastic Laminate Cabincts Manufacturer: Product; Product Number: Description: Dimension: Colorffinish: Comments:Supplier to veriry that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNI N G. I N TE RI ORS L7r"oE n3,&,F,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet APP - 16 Project Information Name: Vail Mounfain Lodee Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilication Location: 307E Kitcb, 309E Kitcll 3l lE KitclL 70lE Kitch, & 7028 Kitch Manufacturer: GE Product: Miat"*""" O"* ProductNumber: JE5I0BW Description: N/A Dirnension: 9 l9ll3" x 12 11116" x l8 5132" Colorffinish: Black Cornrnents: Supplier to verifr that all nccessary parts for installation are ordered Provide undercabinet hanging kit Picture is representational Color may vary I I I I I c T t 0 I I I r I t ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N IN G . I SANTABARBARA (805)953-6890 FAX (805)96$8102 santabarbara@zehrsn.com NTERIORS VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)9491 08o vail@zdrrerrcpm I I t I zr"5#,&,F,f! I I I I I I 1 t t I t I t I I t I I I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (80s)963-8102 saDtabarbara@zehJeo.com TNTERIORS VAIL (970)949.O2s7 FAX (970)949-1 O8O va il@zehron. com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 1 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-U5-9926 Specification Location: 269C Kitchen, 3028 Kitchen,3088 Kitchen,404B Kitchen Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Kitchen Sink Product Number: K-3224-3, Ravinia Description: Self- Rimming Dimension: 33"Wx22"Dx8"H Color/Finish: Stainless Steel Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary zr"5#,*,i,i: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.2 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269C Kitchen,3028 Kitchen, 3088 Kitchen,404B Kitchen Manufacturer: In Sink Erator Product: Garbase Disoosal ProductNumber: 777s Description: N/A Dimension: N/A Color/Finish: N/A Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary T I 1 I I I, l t I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-61 02 santabart ara@z€hten.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren.sgm t I I I I t I zr"oE ^[,s,l,N I t I I 3 , I t t t I I I I I t I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8 1 02 sanbbarbara@z€trren.com VAIL (97 Or949-O257 FAX (970)9491 080 vail@zeh.gn.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 3 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 lssue Date : Available Throush Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 269C Kitchen, 3028 Kitchen, 3088 Kitchen,4048 Kitchen Manufacturer: Grohe Product: Kitchen Faucet Product Number: 33 759 KDO, Ladylux Plus Description: Pull-OutSprayFaucet Dimension: 9 5/8" Spout reach Color/Finish: Stainless Steel Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN NI N G . I N TE R I O R S ar"sLs,l,l: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -4 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 2002 I 501 .00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 269CKitchen,3028Kitchen.308BKitchen,4048Kitchen Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Kitchen Hot Water Dispenser PrndrrctNrrrnhcr K-q6n7-R Descriotion: Goose Neck Hot Waler Disoenser. Dinrension: 10" High Spout 3" Reach Color/Finish: Stainless Steel Cornments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corryonents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary I T I I I I I I I I I I ,l I I I I ARCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 sanlabarbara@zehren.com t I E.PLANNING.INTERIORS 7-/Z E H R E-N ,rro,**oruYAlL,eTo)s4e-1080 -- AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren.'com- I I T I t T I T I t I I I I t I I I t ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTABARBAM (805)9634890 FAX (805)9618102 santabarbara@zehren.coln INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1080 vail@zehrcn.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 5 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Localion: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throueh Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Noftingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:1498 Bath, l49E Bath, 302J Bath(2), 302P Bath, 3025 Bath,308J Bath(2), 308P Bath, 3085 Bath, 336D Bath(2), 404J Bath(2),404P Bath, 4043 Bath Lavatorv K-2257,Caxton Tile In, Vitreous China, unglazed 19" x 15" Almond Comrrents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description:. Dimersion: Color/Finish: Picture is representational Color may vary Laf"oE ^3,S E^.1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.6 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Srrnnlier Dahl of Avon Address: 780 Noningham Road Avoq CO 81620 Contact: Ananda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:115 Men's(?) 1l? Worrren'qt'?) Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Lavatorv Product Number: K-2257 , Caxton Description: Tile In, Vitreous China. unglazed Dimension: 19" x 15" Color/Finish: Mexican Sand Cornrnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. INTE RI ORS SANTA BARBARA (80s)963-689O FAX (805)963-8102 santabarbars@zehron. cfi VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)94S.1 08O vail@zehre..com I I I I I t I I T I I T I I I t f, I zr"5s,s,i,!: I I t T t I l I I I I t I fi T I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)9636890 FAX (80s)963-81 02 santabarbEra@zehaen.corn VAIL (97 O)p49-O257 FAX (970)949.1060 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.7 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269E} Powder Manufacturer: Alchernv Glass Product: Glass Bowl Prodrrct Nrmher AR 1? l2R? Description: Above Counter Ground & Polished Edge Sink Dimension: 15" Diameter ColorlFinish: Coral Cienesa Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color rnay vary ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN NI N G. I N TE RIORS zr"oE,5,&,1,f: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 8 Project Information Name: Location: Project No: Issue Date: Vail Mountain Lodee Vail. Colorado 20021501.00 Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon 780 Nottineham Road Avon, CO 81620 Arnanda Bouchard 970-949-9t01 970-845-9926 Specification Location:302L Powder- 308L Powder Manufacturer: Kohler Ptoduct: Pedestal Lavatory Product Number: K-2258-8, Memoirs Description: Classic Desigr\ 8" Center Dimension:27" x22" x35" Color/Finish: Almond Cornrnents:Supplier to provide and order all neccssary corryonents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I N T E R I O R S I t I t I I I SANTA BARBARA (80s)963€890 FAX (805)963-8102 santabarbara@zehr6n.com VAIL (970)9490257 FA( (970)949,1 OB0 vail@zehrGn.com T I I I I l il I I I I I zr"oE 03,&,i,1: T I T I I I I t I T I I t I t l I J I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (E05)9634102 sanlabarbara@zehr€n.(Dm INTERIORS VAIL (97 O)9 49-0257 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zehren.cgm Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 9 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: Fax: Specific4tion Location: 404L Powder Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Pedestal Lavatorv Product Numbe. Description: Classic Design, 8" C.enter Dimension: 24" x 19 3/4" x 34 318" Color/Finish: Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary zr"5 #,&,r^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -IO Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Srrnnlier Dahl of Avon Address: 780 Noftingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 9'70-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:303D Bath,304D Bath, 305D Bath,305H Bath,306D Bath,403D Bath,407D Bath, 409D Bath, 41 1D Bath, 4l5D Bath, 4l7D Bath, 4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 51 lD Bath, 607D Bath, 609D Bath, 6l lD Batb, 6l3D Bath, 615D Bath Kohler K-2885-8, Man's Lav Lavatory Self-Rirnrning, Cast Iron Lavatory, 8" Centers 24" x13" Alnond Manufactuer: Product: Product Numbei: Description: Dimension: Color/Iinish: Comments:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NIN G. I NTE RI OR S SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963-6890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@zehr€n. coatt t I t I I I I l I T T I I I I I I I I zr"5 #, &,[, N (e7o)e4s.o2JAll(e?o)e4s_108o T I t I T I I T I I I I I I I T I I I ARCHITECTURE SANTABARBAM (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@zehren- com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.lI Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avorl CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 307F Bath, 309F Bath, 3l lF Bath, 70lF Bath, 702F Bath Manufachuer: Kohler Product: Lavatory ProductNumber: K-2196-1, Pennington Description: Self-rinrning, Single Hole Drilling, Vitreous China Lavarory Dimension: 20-114" x l7-l/2" Colorffinish: White Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corryonents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS iaz E H R E N (s?o)e4e-o25?v*\e7o)e4e-108o - AND ASSOCIATES vait@zeh.en.'com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB. 12 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avort, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specilication Location: 2698 Powder Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Faucet Product Number: K-T198, Falling Water Description: l0 1/4" Spou! Wall Mounted Lavatory Faucet Dimension: Per Manufacturer Colorffinish: Satin Nickel Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Pichue is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963€890 FAX (8Os)96!8102 santabarbaaa@zohren-com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949O2s7 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zehren.com I T t I I I t T t I I T I I ! I I t t zr"5#,&,i,f: I I t t I I f' I T I I T I I I I I I I ARCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)96181 02 sanlabarbara@zehr€n.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB. 13 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:336D Bath(2) Manufacturer: Product: Newoort Brass Lavatorv Faucet ProductNumber: 1030 Description: Dimension: ColorlFinish: 1030 Series, Widespread 8" Center Lavatory Faucet Per Manufacturer Satin Nickel Comments:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS 7-lz E H R E N (e?o)e4s42sy*!\e7o)e4$1080 - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren-com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB. 14 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 97O-949-9lOl Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:l49B Bath, l49E Baft" 302J Bath(2), 302L Powder, 308J Bath(2), 308L Powder, 404J Bath(2), 4ML Powder Lavatorv Faucet 800 800 Series, Widespread 8" Cehter Lavatory Faucet Per Manufacturer Satin Nickel Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: ColorlFinish: Corunents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary corrponents for installation Picture is representational Color nray vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I N TERIORS I l T I I T I I I l I I I I T I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-8102 sa ntabarbaaa@ehr€n. corn t t Zf-| Sr S,E^ r N (e?o),4e{-4yA!L(,?o)s4slo8o I I I I ) I I I l I T I I I I I I I I A RCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G t SANTA BARBARA (Eo5)963€69O FAX (80s)963€ I 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FA,\ (970)94$1 08O vail@zehren.cfi Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 15 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:302P Batb 3025 Bath, 303D Bath, 304D Bath, 305D Bath,305H Bath, 306D Bath, 308P Bath, 3085 Bath,403D Bath,404P Bath,4045 Bath,407D Bath,409D Bath,4l lD Batb 4l5D Bath, 41?D Bath,4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D Bath,609D Bath, 61lD Bath, 613D Bath, 615D Bath Newport Brass Lavatorv Faucel 1200 1200 Series, Widespread 8" Center Lavatory Faucet Per Manufacturer Satin Nickel Comrnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Mariufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: ColorlFinish: Pichrre is representational Color may vary Zf"oE 03,*,t^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -16 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Fanning & Associates, Inc. 80u745-7313 303-286-9069 Specification Location: 315 Men s(2), 317 Women's(2) Manufachrer: Dela Product: Lavatorv Faucet Product Number: 3555-NNLHP H2I6NN .Description: Victorian Widespread Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Pearl Nickel Connnents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for tstallation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNI N G. I NTE RI ORS t I t I il I I t I I I I I I t I I l I VAIL (97 0)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1080 vail@zehren.com SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (80s)963-8102 sanlabarbara@zehr€ n-com L7r"oE nH,S,l,l: I I I I I I I I l I I I I I I t I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (80s)963-8102 sanlabarbora@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren-cfi Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.IT Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Noftingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-910l Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:307F Bath, 309F Bath, 3l lF Bath, 70lF Bath, 702F Bath Manufacturer: Kohler Product: ProductNumber: K-|5598-F, Coralais Description: Sinsle Con$ol Centerset.Dimension: Per Manufacnuer Color/Finish: Polished Chrome Cornrnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Pichue is representational Color rnay vary zr^5s,&,F,!: Z,ehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.18 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 2002 | 501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Ad&ess: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:1498 Bath. l49E Bath Manufacturer: Eljer Product: Watercloset Pioduct Number: 091-7883, Hylando Description: lT" Toilet, Two-Piece- Back Outlet Dimension: Per Manufachrer ColorlFinish: #96, Biscuit Connnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Match Kohler's Almond color Picture is representational Color nuy vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNING. I N TE RIORS SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963$89O FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@2ehren.clrn VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970p49.1 08O val@zslrcn.com I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I l I I t zr-5Ls,[,11 I I I I I I T I I I I I I I I I I t I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTABARBAM (80s)963-6890 FAX (805)9€3-8102 sant*a lbara@zshr€n.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1 080 vail@zeh,en.clrn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.19 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Arnanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specilication location:2698 Powder, 302K WC, 302P Bath, 3025 Bath, 308K WC, 3O8P Bath, 3085 Bath, 336E WC,404K WC,404P Bath,4045 Bath Manufachrer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: Color/Finish: K-3457 Devonshire Colorffinish: Almond Elonsated. 12" Roush In Per Manufacturer Alrnond Comments:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color mav varv zr"oE o3,s,l,N Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.20 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 302L Powder, 308L Powder,404L Powder Manufachrer: Kohler Product: Watercloset Product Number: K-3429, Memoirs Description: Elongated Two- Piece Toilet with Classic Design, 12" RoughJn Dimension: 303/8" 17 7116" 31 318" Color/Finish: Almond Corffnents: Sup?lier to provide and order all necessary corrponents for irntallation Pictue is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANN I N G . IN TERI ORS I l I I I T I I t t T I I I t SANTA BARBARA (805)963$890 FAX (80s)963-8102 santabarbara@z€hrgn.cfi VAIL (970)949{257 FAX (970)94$1 O8O vail@zehren.com I I I I zr"5#,&,E^,11 I I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (E0s)963€890 FAX (805)963{102 santabarbara@zehran.clm INTERIORS VAIL (970)949,0257 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vail@zehrcn.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -2I Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountaur Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingtham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 4l lD Bath Manufacturer: Kohler Toilet Seat Cover: Kohler Product: Watercloset Product Number: K-4652, Lusta Product Number: K-3427, Highline at ADA Units Color/Finish: White Description: Comfort Height Toilet with 12" Rough In Dimension: Per Manufacturer .Colorffinish: White Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary Zf"oE ^3rS,t^'!: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLNIB.22 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-910l Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 315 Mens,317 Women's(3) Manrfacturer: Kohler Toilet Seat Cover: Kohler Product: Watercloset Product Number: K-4652, Lusta Product Number: K-3427, Highlirre at ADA Units Color/Finish: Almond Description: Comfort Height Toilet with 12" Rough In Dimension: Per Manufacturer _ColorlFinish: Almond Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is represenlational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I NG. I N TE RI ORS I I t I T I l I I I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (80s)963-81 02 sar*ab6rbara@zehren.c-or'| VAIL (970)949-0257 FAx (97op./t9 1O80 va il@zehren. clrn t I l t L7f*oE ^3,S,E^,!: T I I I I t I I T I I I I I I I t I t ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (80s)963€89O FAX (80s)963-81 02 santeb€rbara@zehron.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1080 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -23 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 lssue Uate: Available Throush Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:303E WC, 305E WC, 305H Bath, 306E WC, 307F Bath, 309F Bath, 31lF Bath, 403E WC, 407E WC,409E WC,4t5E wC,415E WC, 4l7E WC,4l9E WC, 503E WC, 505E WC, 509E WC, 51lE WC, 607E WC, 609E WC, 6l lE WC, 613E WC, 6l5E WC, 70lF Bath, 6O?F Rarh Kohler Toilet Seat Cover: Kohler Watercloset Product Number: K-4652, Lustra K Elongated Toilet with 12" Rough In Per Manufacturer White Comments:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: ColorlFinish: Picture is representational Color may vary Lz("oE o3r$,E^'!: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.24 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throlgh Supplier: Address: Contacl: Phone: Fax: Ultra Hardware St r lfut" 303-571-5611 303-394-0200 Spelrfis4lss Location: 336DBath Manufacturer: BainUltra Product: Bath Product Number: Pro.Meridian 55 Description: Air Jet Tub Dimension: 66"Lx34" Wx 20" D Color/Iinish: Almond Corrrnents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NIN G. I N TE RI ORS I t I I I I I I t I I I I I I t I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAx (805)96$8102 santabarbara@zehrgn-c!m Zf-oE ^3, S, E^, I,",0,*,,,JAlt,^)e4e.io8o I t I t T I I I T I I I I I I T T I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963$890 FAX (8O5)963-8102 santabarbara@zehren-com INTERIORS VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)94+ 1 O8O vail@zdr.en.cgm Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 25 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 9'10-949-9101 Fax: 9'70-845-9926 Specification Location: 1498 Battl l49E Bath Manufacturer: TBD Product: Bath Product Numben TE6--- Description; C."t". Sid" D."i" Dimension: 60" x 30" Color/Finish: Alrnond Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color mav varv zkoE,*T,&,[,]: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 26 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 lssue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-910l Fax: 9'10-845-9926 Specilication Location: 302P Batll 3025 Batb 308P Bath, 3085 Batb 4O4P Batb,4045 Bath Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Bath Product Number: K-7 I 5/K-7 I 6 Villager Description: Cast Iron Dimension: 60" x 30" Colorffinish: Almond Conrnents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corryoncnts for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN Nl N G. I NTE RIORS I I I I I I I T I I I I I I I T I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)9@{142 santabalbara@zehrcn.conr VAIL (970)949-@57 FA)( (970p49-'loEO vail@zehr€n.6fi t I zksr,s,E^,!: I I I I I I I I T T I I I I T I T I I A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (EO5)96$E 102 santabarbaaa@z€hten.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)94$.1 O80 va @zehren.cfi T.ehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLM.B - 27 Proiect Information Narne: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Througb Supplier: Address: Dabl ofAvon 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Amanda Bouchard 970-949-9r01 970-845-9926Fax: Specification Location: 305HBath.4llDBath Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Bath Product Numbsr: K-715/K-T 16 Villager Description: Cast lron Dimension: 60" x 30" Colorffinish: Whitc Corrnents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary zlr"oE o3,s,i,fi Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 28 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Ulfra Hardware St.t K.ltt 303-571-s6l l 303-394-0200 Specilication Location: 6l5D Bath Manufachuer: Hy&osystem Product: Bath Product Number: 6634, Solo Description: Agrylic Soaking Tub Dimension: 34" x 66" Color/Finish: White Cornmsnts: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NI N G. I N TERI ORS I I I I I I I I I I t I I T I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santa barbara@z€hren. com t I zr^oE ^[rs [rN ,,,0,no".Jfl.,, )e4e_1080 I l T I I I I l I T I I I l I I T I I ARCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G *,,issT*Pn[Rim,., -72 E H R E N santabarbara@zehron.clm -- AN D AS SOC IATE S INTERIORS VAlL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1 080 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLM.B.29 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Address: UlEa Hardware Stm K.t" 303-571-5611 303-394-0200 Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302J Bath, 308J Bath,404J Bath Manufacturer: Hydrosystem Product: Bath Product Numbert Description: Acrylic Soaking Tub Dimension: 60" x36" x22" Colorffinish: Almond Corrrnenls: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.3O Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Ultra Hardware Str" Kru 303-571-s6t I 303-394-0200 Specification Location:303D Batll 304D Batb, 305D Batb 306D Bath,403D Batll 407D Bath, 409D Bath,4l5D Bath, 4l7D Batll 4l9D Batb 503D Balh, 505D Bath, 509D Batb, 5l lD Bath, 607D Batb" 609D Bath, 6llD Bath, 613D Bath Bath 6036, Deanna Acrylic Soaking Tub 60" x36" x22" White Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: Color/Finish: Conrnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G. IN TE Rl ORS I I I I I T I I I I I T I I I I T SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-Al 02 sgntabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)94+0257 FAX {970)949-1 O80 vail@zehfen.com T I zr"5#,*,E^,f: I I I T I I I I I I I I I I T I I I T ARCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (80s)963€890 FAX (805)96$8102 santabarbara@zehren.c!m INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1 O8O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -31 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proier-t Nn ?OO7 I SO I nO Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 307F Bath. 309F Bath. 3l lF Bath Manufacturer: Larso Bathware Product: Bath ProductNumber: 2603-3CTM Description: Fiberglass Tub/Shower Module Dimension: 60" Lx30" W x 76" H Colorffinish: White Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation .l : .;,. : Picture is representational Color may vary zr"oE 03,&,'^,fl Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -32 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contacl: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 70lF Bath.702F Bath Manufacturer: Lasco Bathware Product: Shower Unit ProductNumber: 1363 Description: Fiberglass Shower Stall Dimension: 36"Wx36"Dx72"H Color/Finish: White Cornrnents: Supplier to Fovide and order all necessary conponents for installation Pichre is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I NG . I N TE RI ORS I T I t I I I J I I I I l I I I I SANTA BARBARA (80s)963€89O FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@zehr€n.com I I J.,:IZ E H R E N - AN D AS S OC lnr L i (e7o)e4e-o257FAx(e70)s4$1080 I I I T I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I A RCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G ('',if.j:ISAiE,tiS,* v=Z E H R E N santabarbarc@zehren.com E AN D ASSOCIATES INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1 08O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.33 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: Project No: 20021501.00 lssue ljate: Available Throush Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon. CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 336D Bath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Roman Tub Faucet Prodrrct Nrrmher I f|16 Description: 1030 Series, Deck Set Bath Faucet Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation -fl Picture is representational Color may vary Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.34 Proiect I4formation Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 302J Bath, 308J Bath,404J Bath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Bath Faucet ProductNumber: 806 Description: 800 Series, Bath Faucet Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Iinish: Satin Nickel Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corryonents for installation "'"€*s' Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I NTE R I ORS I I I I I I I I t I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (80s)9634890 FAX (805)96981 02 santaba rbala@zohlgn.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)9491 O8O val@zeh,en.Gom I I T I zr"5 s,s,E^,!: I t T I I I I I I I I I t I I I I I I A RCIIITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (8Os)96$6890 FAX (805)9698102 santabarbara@zeha€n.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.35 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: ProjectNo: 20021501.00 ISSUe Uate: Available Throuqh Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Noningham Road Avon. CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 9?0%19101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location:303D Bath, 304D Bath, 305D Bath, 306D Bath,403D Bath,407D Bath, 409D Bath,4l5D Bath, 4l7D Bath, 4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D Bath, 609D Bath, 6l lD Bath, 6l3D Bath, 615D Bath Newport Brass Roman Tub Faucet 1206 1?OO Serie< Rath Farrcef Per Manufacturer Satin Nickel Cormnenls:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: Color/Finish: Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS v-Z E H R E-N ,r,o,ror-or.Y$!te7o)s4e'o8o -7 AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehrcn.'com', Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 36 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dal ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingharn Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: l49BBath,l49EBath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product Bath and Shower Faucet ProductNumber: 802BP Description: 800 Series, Balance Pressure Valve Bath and Shower Faucet Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation dtFb Pichre is representational Color mav varv ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N ING. I N TE RI ORS I I I I I I I ! I I I I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)9636890 FAX (80s)963-8102 santabarbara@zehren.com I I Z f"oE ^[, &,E^, N,"0,*""Yflt'^)e4elooo I I I T I t T I t t I I I I t I I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 sanlabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1080 vail@zehren,com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 37 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 lssue uare: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Noftingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 302P Bath, 3025 Bath, 305H Bath, 308P Bath, 3085 Bath, 404P Bath, 4045 Bath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Bath and Shower Faucet ProductNumber: l202BP Description: 1200 Series, Balance Pressure Valve Bath and Shower Faucet Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Cornrnenls: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color mav varv L7(*oE o3,S,i,!1 Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -38 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon" CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-U5-9926 Specification Location: 307F Bath- 309F Bath. 3l lF Bath Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Product Number: K-Tl560l-4, Coralais'Description: Bath and Shower Mixing Valve Faucet Dimension: Per Manufacturer Colorffinish: Polished Chrome Cornrnents: Sup,plier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . PLAN NI N G . I NTE RIORS I t I I I I I I t I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)9638102 santabadlara@z€hren.com VAlL (970)9490257 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vail@zshren.com I I I T I t I zkoEnS,*,[,!: I I I I I t I I I I t I I I T I I I I A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (8O5)963-81 02 santabarbara@zehren.clrn INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970F49.1O8O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 39 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect Nn ?nn?lsnl nO Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 97U845-9926 Specification Location: 336D Bath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Shower Faucet Product Numbe. Description: 1030 Series, Balance Presswe Valve Shower Faucet Dinrension: Per Manufacturer Colorffinish: Satin Nickel Cornnrents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color mav varv zr"oE ^3,s [,[: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB.40 Plgject Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501 .00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dali of Avon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon. CO 81620 Contact: Aman& Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 97O-U5-9926 Specification Location:303D Bath,304D Bath, 305D Bath,306D Batlu 403D Bath,407D Battr,409D Bath,4l5D Bath, 4l7D Bath,4l9D Batlr 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 51lD Bath, 607D Bath, 609D Bath, 6l lD Bath, 6l3D Bath, 615D Bath NewDort Brass Shower Faucet Manufacturer: Product: ProductNumber: l204BP Description: Dirnension: Color/Finish: 1200 Series. Balance Presswe Valve Shower Faucet Per Manufacnrrer Satin Nickel Cornrnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary con{roncnts for installation Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I NG. I N TE RI ORS T I I I I T I I I I t I I I t I I SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963-6890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santaba rltara@z ght€n.com VAIL (97O)949-O2s7 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zehren.com I I zr"oE ^3,&,E^,f: I t t I I I t I T I I t I I t I I I I A RCHITECTURE SANTABARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)96381 02 santaba rbara@zehr€n.com Zehren & Associates Specilication Sheet PLMB.41 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Noftingham Road Avorl CO 81620 Contact: ' Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 302J Bath.308J Bath.404J Bath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Shower Faucet ProductNwnber: 8048P Description: 800 Series, Balance Presswe Valve Sbower Flucet Dimension: Per Manufachrer Colorffinish: Satin Nickel Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color mav vaw E.PLANNING.INTERIORS j-Z E H R E N ,,,o,ro...uYAjf,e7o)e4e.1oso -- AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -42 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Avai!4ble Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon. CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 70lFBath,702FBath Manufachrer: Kohlcr Product: Sho*". F""*t Product Number: K-Tl56l I Description: Shower Faucet with Lever Handle Dimersion: Per Manufactr-rer Color/Finish: P"tirh.d Cht"-" Corrmpnts: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corryonents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary A RCI|ITE,CTURE . PLAN N I N G . I N TE RI O R S I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)96381 02 gantaba lbara@zohren.com VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zehren.com I I zr"oE ^3,&,E^,1: I I I T I I T I I I t I I t I t T I I A RCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)9636890 FAX (805)963-Al 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949{257 FAX (970)94$1O8O vail@zehren.cam Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -43 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Arailable Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: Specification Location: 315 Men's Manufachrer: Kohler Product: Urinal ProductNurnber: K-5016-ET, Dexter Description: NiA Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Almond Cornrrents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corrponents for installation Provide automatic flush valve Picture is representationa I Color mav varv zr-oEo!,&,[,ft Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -44 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Snnnlier l)ehl nf Avon Address: 780 Noningham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 4l lD Bath Manufachrer: Kohler Product: Handshower ProductNurhber: K-8520 Description: '3-Way Handshower & Slide Bar Dimension: Per Manufacturer ColorlFinish: Bnrshed Chrome Conrnents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Pichrre is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I NTE RI ORS I t I I I t I I t I I I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (80s)963€890 FAX (805)963-8102 sanlabarbara@zEhren. com I I ZkS Sr &,E^, N'"0'*'-o'uYAll-o)e4e'1o80 I I I I I I t I t I I I I I I t I T I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (80s)963-6890 FAX (8Os)96981 02 santabaabara@zeh,en.com INTERIORS VAIL 197 0)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1080 vail@zehren-com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- 1 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A."rd" B"r.h*d 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 2698 Powder.336D Bath. 3368 Bath Manufacturer: Newoort Brass Product: Robe Hook ProductNumber:. 13-12 Description: 1030 Series Robe Hook Dimension: Per Manufacturer ColorlFinish: Satin Nickel Comments: All materials and construction rust conply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contact quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locatiors and rnounting heights Provide blockins for weisht requirernents Picture is representational Color may vary zr"5s,s,[,]: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.2 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon At*"d. B"r.trrd 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location:2698 Powder Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: Color/Finish: Newport Brass Towel Ring 13-09 1030 Series Towel Rine Per Manufacturer Satin Nickel Cornrnents:All materials and constuction must comply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contract qualig Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer lo Detail Ma[ual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color mav varv I I I I I t I I t I I I t I t I I A RCIIITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (8O5)963-8102 santabarbara@zehren. coan INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1O8O vail@zehren.crrn t I zr^5s,*,[,]: t I I I I I I I t I I I I I I T I I I A RCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G ,*.;#llT*Ri[F,ffn*, 7=Z E H R E N santabarbara@zehren.com - AN D ASSOCIATES INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-'1080 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- 3 Proiect lnformation Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Localion: Vail, Colorado Prniect Nn ?OO7l SOI OO lssue l)ate: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A*.rd. B"""h"td 9'70-949-9r0r 910-845-9926 Specification Location: 269El Powder, 3368 WC Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Tissue Holder froduct Nrunber , Description: Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Comments: All rnaterials and construction must conply with applicable fue and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and rnounting heights Provide blockins for weisht requirements Picture is representational Color may vary Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.4 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A.""d. B"*h.td 970-949-910r 970-845-9926 Specification Iocation: 336D Bath Manufacturer: Product: Towel Bar ProductNumber: 13-02 Description: 1030 Series- 24" Towel Bar Dimension: Per Manufacturer Colorffinish: Satin Nickel Comments: All materials and construction must conply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Re fer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANN I NG . INTE RI ORS SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963$890 FAX (8Os)9618102 santabarbar'a@zeh ren.com VAIL (970)949{257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zeh.en.com t I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I L2r,oEo3,SF,l: I I t I t t I I I I t I I T I I I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NIN G. I SANTA BARBARA (805)963{890 FAX (EO5)96}8102 santabarbar@zehren.com NTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- 5 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon At*"d" B.".h-d 970-949-9101 9'70-845-9926 Specification Location: l49B Bath. l49E Bath Manufacturer: Newoort Brass Product: Robe Hook Product Number: l0 - l2 Description: 800 Series Robe Hook Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Comments: All rnaterials and construction must co Att rrt"tt"tr -rrt b" ".rtr""t qr.tlty Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Pichre is representational Color mav varv L7(-oE oT,*,E^,f: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.6 Proiect Informaiion Name: Vail Mountain Lodge I ncafinn' Vail Cnloradn ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A-"rd" B.r.h*d 970-949-9101 910-845-9926 Specilication Location:l49B Bath, l49E Bath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Towel Ring ProductNumber: l0- 09 Description: 800 Series Towel Ring Dimension: Per Manufacturer Colorffinish: Satin Nickel Comments:All materials and construction rnrst comply with applicable fue and safety codes All materials rnust be contact quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installatjon are ordered Refer to Detail Marnral for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary I T I I I I I I t I I I I I I I t ARCIIITECTURE SANTABARBAM (80s)963-689O FAX (8Os)963-8102 sar abada.a@zehrcn com I I E.PLANNING.INTERIORS izz E H R E_N ,,,o,*,_o,,ysl.,e7o)e4e-1080 - AND ASSOCIATES vai@zehreniom' I It I I t I t I I! I I I I I t I t t t A RCIIITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-689O FAX (80s)963.a1 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949- t080 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-7 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A-.rd" B"".l"td 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location: l49B Bath, 149E Bath Manufacnrrer: Newport Brass Product: Tissue Holder ProductNumber: l0- 28 Description: 800 Series Tissue Holder Dimension: Per Manufacturer ColorlFinish: Satin Nickel Corrrnents: All materials and construction must comply with applicable fre and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veri9 that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights- Provide blockins for weight requirements Picture is representational Color mav varv zr-oE ^3,*,F,1: Zehren & Associates Specilication Sheet ACC- 8 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021 501 .00 Issue Date: dvailable Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A.""d" B"".h"rd 970-949-9r01 970-845-9926 Specificatiql Location: l49B Bath. l49EBath Manufacturer: Newport Brass Product: Towel Bar Pioduct Number: l0 - 02 Description: 800 Series- 24" Towel Bar Dimension: Per Manufacturer ColorlFinish: Satin Nickel Comments: All rnaterials and construction must conply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials rmrst be contact quality Supplier to veriry that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNIN G . I NTE RIORS t I I t I I I I I I T I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963-6890 FAX (805)963.8102 sariabarbara@zehren.cam t I ar"s ^[ &,i, N,n,o,no*o,uyAlf-,)s4s-108o I I I I t I I t I t t t t T T T t I I A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (eo5)963689o FAX (8Os)963-81 02 santabarbara@zehrsn.com INTERIORS VAIL (97O)94S.O257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- 9 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Dahl ofAvon A"r*d" Bor.b".d 970-949-9t0l 970-845-9926 Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302K WC, 302J Bath, 302L Powder, 302P Bath, 3025 Bath, 303D Bath, 304D Bath, 305D Bath, 305H Bath, 306D Bath, 308K WC,308J Bath, 308L Powder, 308P Bath,3083 Bath,403D Bath, 404K WC, 404J Bath, 404L Powder,404P Battr, 4045 Bath, 407D Bath, 409D Bath, 4l lD Bath (3 415D Bath, 417 Batlr, 4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D Bath, 6l lD Bath, 613D Bath, 6l5D Bath Manufacturer: Franklin Brass Product Double Robe Hook Prndrrr-t Nrrrnhcr' 46O? Kclcie Description: N/A Dimension: 3" Proiection Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Comments: All materials must be contract quality Supplier to verifu that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representationa Color may vary ZkoE olr$,t^rltj Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.lO Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Dahl of Avon A."rd. B"r.h"td 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302J Batb 302L Powder, 302P Bath. 3025 Bath, 303D Bath, 304D Bath, 305D Bath, 305H Bath, 306D Bath, 308J Bath, 308L Powder, 308P Bath, 3085 Bath, 403D Bath, 404J Bath, 404L Powder 404P Bath, 4045 Bath, 407D Bath, 409D Bath, 4l lD Badr, 4l5D Bath, 417 Bath, 419D Bath, . 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D BatlU 6l lD Bath, 6l3D Bath, 6l5D Bath Manufacturer: Franklin Brass Product: Towel Ring Product Number: 9016. Jamestown Description: N/A Dimension: Pcr Manufacturer Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Comments: All materials and construction must conply with applicable fire and safety codes AII -ut .i"ls -*t b" "ootu"t qouliry Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weiqht requirements Picture is representational Color rnav varv ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963$890 FAX (805)96$8102 santabarbara@z€hren.cnm INTERIORS VAIL (97O)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren.comL7(*oE o3,&,E^,f: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- II Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Dahl of Avon At*"d" B.".l"rd 970-949-9t01 970-845-9926 Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302K WC,302L Powder, 302P Bath, 3025 Bath, 303D Battr, 304D Bath,305D Bath,305H Ba 306D Bath, 308K WC, 308L Powder, 308P Bath, 3085 Batb 403D Balh, 404K WC, 404L Por 404P Bath,4045 Bath,407D Bath, 409D Baft,415D Bath,417 Bath,4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Batb, 607D Bath, 6l lD BattL 613D Bath, 6l5D Bath Manufacturer: F "*lir B..* Product: Product Number: 9008. Jamestown Description: N/A Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Conrnents: All materials and construction must conply with applicable fire and safeg codes All materials must be conaact quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary pars for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blockins for weisht reouirements Picture is re Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963.6890 FAX (805)9€3-81 02 sanlabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@zehrEn.comzr"5L&,F,!: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- 12 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge I nr.afinn Vail Cnlnradn Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: DaN ofAvon Att"rd" B"".h.d 970-949-9r01 970-845-9926 Specification Location: Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: ColorlFinish: Cornrnents: 302J Bath, 302P Bath,3025 Bath, 303D Bath, 3MD Bath, 305D Bath,305H Baih, 306D Bath, 308J Bath, 308P Bath, 3085 Bath, 403D Bath, 404J Bath, 404P Bath, 4045 Bath, 407D Bath, 409DBath,4l5DBath,4l7Bath,4l9DBath,503DBat[505DBath,509DBath,5llDBath, 607D Bath, 6l lD Batb 6l3D Bath, 6l5D Bath Franklin Brass 9024, Jamestown Satin Nickel All marerials "rd constructio @ Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heighs Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G. I NTERI OR S I I I T t t t I t I t I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963-6890 FAX (805)963-41 02 santabarbara@zehren com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)9491 08O vail@zehren,com I t Lzr^oE 03,&,i,1: I I I I ! I I I I I t, I I I J J I I t ARCIIITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTABARBARA (8Os)963-6890 FAX (805)96+8 1 02 santabarbara@zehren-com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-108O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- 13 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon Ar*"d. B"*h.d 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 315 Men's,317 Women's(3),4llD Bath Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: Tissue Holder ProductNumber: 8-6857 Description: Dimension: Per Manufacturer ColorlFinish: Satin Nickel Cornrnents: All materials and construction must comply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veri& ihat all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Deeil Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color mav vaw zr"5Ls,u^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- 14 Project Information Name: Vail Mormtain Lodge I ncerinn Vail Cnlnrado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Pbone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon Ar*"d"8"*h.d 970-949-910r 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 315 Mens, 317 Women's, 4l lD Bath Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: Grab Bar ProductNumber: B-5507x36 Description: N/A Dimension: 36" Long Grab Bar Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Conrnents: All rnaterials and constuction nnrst conply with applicable fire and safety codes All rnaterials nnrst be contact quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirernents Picture is representational Color may vary I ! I J T I I I I t I I ! I I I I A RCHITECTURE E.PLANNING.INTERIORS zr_oE rFrS,lrN,n,o,,ono*y*r,,,.)e4e-108o ISANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8102 sant€barbaaa@zehFn com T t I I I I I I T tl f' I I D $ n J I i l SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963{890 FAX (8Os)963-8102 santaba.ba€@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-I5 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A"""d. B"r.hrd 970-949-9t01 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 315 Mens.317 Women's.41lD Bath Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: Grab Bar ProductNumber: B-5507x42 Description: N/A Dimension: 42" Lone Grab Bar Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Comments: All materials and construction must comply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contact quality Supplier to verifu that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual fot lo"ntionr -dffi' Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANN I N G. I NTE RIORS zr-oE 03,&,[,]: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-I6 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021 501 .00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A-""d" B"""}-d 970-949-910r 970-84s-9926 Specification Location: 315 Men's, 317 Women's, 4l lD Bath Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: Grab Bar ProductNumber: B-5507x48 Description: N/A Dimension: 48" Lone Grab Bar Colorffinish: Satin Nickel Comments: All rnaterials and construction must conply wjlh applicable fire and safety codes All rnaterials rnust be contract quality Supplier to verify that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and rnormting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Pichue is representational Color may vary A RCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963.8102 sanlabarbara@zehlen.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)9,19-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 o8o vail@zehaen.com t t I ,J I I t t I I 0 I f, 7i 'II I I zr"5s,s,l,f: I t I t I fr, ! t t, t t, I I li t I I J t SANTA BARBARA (8osp636890 FAX (805)9618102 sanlabarbara@zehren.com VAIL t970)949-0257 FAX (970)949108O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-I7 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A.*d"Bo*h-d 970-949-9r01 9'70-845-9926 Specilication Location:315 Men's, 317 Women's (3) Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: ProductNumber: B-2116 Description: Concealed Mounting Dimension: Projects 3 7/16" from wall Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Cornrnents:All materials and construction must comply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be confract quality Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements ,i: .:..::.' Picture is representational Color rnay vary A RCIIITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I N T E R I O R S L2r"5#,&,[,]: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-I8 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A-""dr B"""h-d 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location:3 l5 Men's(2), 3 | 7 Women's (2) Manufacturer: Bobrick rt-^-t.,^.. C^^- l\:^-rrooucl: soap ulspensor Product Number: B-226 Description: 34oz Soap Dispensor ' Dimcrsion: 6n Spout ColorlFinish: Satin Nickel Cornrnents:All materials and construction must conply with applicable fire and safety codes All rnatefials rnust be contract qualilv Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting hcights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G SANTA BARBARA (805)963S890 FAX (8Os)963-8102 saotaba rbara@zehrgn.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1 08O vail@eh.en,com I I n t I 0 I t ,l I I I r il t I I 0 l zr-5J,&,i,1: t I I T I .l ^t t, I I I T I T t t T I SANTA BARBARA (80s)963€89O FAX (805)963-81 02 sanlabsrbara@zehren-com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1080 vail@zehren.corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-I9 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A--d" B"".ltrd 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification l.ocation' ?17 Wntnpn'c /?'l Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: Toilet Seat Dispenser ProductNumber: B-221 Description: Surface Mounted Toilet Seat Dispenser Dimension: 15 3/4" W x 11" H x 2" D Colorffinish: Conmtents: All rnaterials and construcfion nrust comply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials rrnrst be contract qual8 Supplier to verify that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weisht requtements Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NIN G. I N TE RIORS zr"5Ls,i,ll Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.2O Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A--d. B"*h.rd 9'70-949-9t01 970-845-9926 Specification Location:315 Mens, 317 Women's Manufach.rer: Bobrick Product: Toilet Seat Dispenser ProductNumber: 8-3013 Description: Recessed Toilet Seat Dispenser Dimension: 155/8"Wxll l/4" Hx2 7/8"D Color/Iinish: Satin Nickel Commenls:All materials and construction nnrst comply with ap?licable fire and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picnre is representational Color may vary 9ro' l,l|t|m A RCHITECTURE I I I I I '1 t I ,t I I I t l I I 0SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8102 sarrtabarbara@zehren.com I E.PLANNING.INTERIORS Zf"$ Ir S [rfl,",o,non-o,rY*f,tn,,)e4e-1o80 I I I I I t I J t I I l I I I l, I I I SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963€890 FAX (805)963-8102 santabatbara@zehren.corn VAIL (97O)949-O2s7 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-2I Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A-.rdt B"r.h"td 970-949-910r 970-845-9926 Specification Location:l49B Bath. l49E Bath.4l lD Balh Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: ffi Product Number: B-207x 63 Description: .Concealed Mounting Dimension: 63" Lone Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Cornments:All materials and construction must conply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contact quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Munuul for lo"utiors and *ting hei# Pt*id. bl,""kt"e f"t *"tsht *quirements Picture is representational Color may vary ARCIIITECTURE . PLANNIN G. I N TE R I O RS zr-5#,&,[,i: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-22 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 lssue Date: Available Through Supplier: Ad&ess: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl of Avon A-""dr B"*t"rd 970-949-9r01 970-845-9926 Specification Location:302P Bath, 3025 Bath,305H Bath, 308P Bath, 3085 Bath,404P Bath, 4045 Bath Bobrick Curtain Rod B-207x66 Cnnr-pelpd Mnrrntino 66" Long Satin Nickel Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dirnension: Color/Finish: Connnents:All rnaterials ard constuction rmrst conply with applicable fire and safety codes All rnaterials rmrst be contract quality Supplier to verifr that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary I I l I I I t t f, I I I I ARCIIITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)953€890 FAX (8O5)953-8102 sanlabarbara@zehrBn.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 OaO vail@zehren.com n I t I t I ar"sL&,i,11 I I I I I I t t t I t I I t I t I I l A RCHITECTURE . P LAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€8e0 FAX (805)963.81 02 sanlabarba,a@zeh,en.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)94$1 O80 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-23 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A-"rd" B"".}*d 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location:307H Bath, 309H Bath, 3l lH Bath Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: Prndrrct Nrrrnher R-?O7v 1( Description: Concealed Mounting Dimension: 36" Long Color/Finish: Polished Chrome Connnenls:All materials and consruction nnrst comply with applicable fre and safety codes All materials must be contact quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blockins for weisht requirements Picture is representational Color may vary zr"5 #,s,E^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-24 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon Anr-d" B"".t*d 970-949-9t0r 970-84s-9926 Specification Location:70lH Bath,702H Badr Manufacturer: Bobrick Product: Curtain Rod Product Number: B-207x 60 Description: Concealed Mounting Dimension: 60" Lone Color/Finisb: Polished Chrome Connnenls:All rnaterials and construction must comply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be coptract quality Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picnue is representational Color nray vary I l t I l t I I I I I t t A RCIIITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (8Os)9618102 sariabarbara@zeh.en.coan INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren.com t t I I t I zr-5L*,l,N I I I I n I I I t t I I I I I I I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX {805)96}.81 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vai@zehrBn.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-25 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodpe Location: Project No: 20021501.00 lssue l)ate: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon At*"d. B"r.Lrd 970-949-9101 970-84s-9926 Spmification Location:307H Bath, 309H Bath, 31 lH Bath, 701H Bath, 702H Bath Manufacturer: Franklin Brass Product: Sinele Robe Hook Product Nurnber: 9001. Jamestown f)cc.'rintinn. N/A Dimension: Per Manufacturer ColorlFinish: Polished Chrome Cornrnents:All rraterials and consruction must conply with applicable fre and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for inslallation are ordered Refer to Detait Manual for locations and mormting heights _ Provide blocking for weieht requirements Picture is representational Color may vary ar"s#,s,i,fl Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.26 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl of Avon Ar.rd" B"".Ltd 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 307H Bath, 309H Bath, 3l lH Bath, 70lH Bath, 702H Bath Manufacturer: Franklin Brass Product: Towel Ring ProductNumber: 9016 Description: N/A Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Polished Cbrome Comments: All materials and consruction rmrst comply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials musl be contract quality Supplier to veriry that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary - "-. -"'l ' ARCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)96381 02 santabarbaaa@zehren.@m INTERIORS VAIL (s7o)e49-0257 FAX (970)9491 O80 vail@z6hren.com I I l I n t I I I I I t I I Il i I I zr"oE ^.T,s,[,]: I I I I t I I t t I J u I I I I n I I ARCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)9636E90 FAX (805)96$8102 sanlabaJbara@zeh ren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949J 080 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-27 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Dale: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A.""d" 8"".t".d 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 307H Bath, 309H Bath, 3l lH Bath, 70lH Bath, 702HBath Manufacturer: Franklin Brass Product: Tissue Holder Product Number: 9008, Jamestown Description: N/A Dinension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Polished Chrome Connnents: All materials and constuction rnrst cornply with applicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heigbts Provide blockine for weieht requiem€nts Picture is representanonal Color mav varv Zf"oEo3,S,E^rfl Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.28 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl of Avon Ar*"d. B"".h*d 970-949-9r0r 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 307H Batll 309H Bath, 3l lH Balh, 70lH.Bath, 702H Bath Manufacturer: Franklin Brass Product: Towel Bar ProductNumber: N/A Description: Per Manufacturer Dimansion: Satin Clrome Color/Finish: Polished Chrome Cornments: All materials and construction rnust corryly with ap,plicable fire and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veri8 that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color may vary A RCI{ITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-8 1 02 santabarbara@zehren.qom INTERIORS VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)94$1 O8O vai@zehren.com I t I I I t I l I I I U I l t I It l I zr"5Ls,[,]: I I I I I I T I l I I t I I I I t' I t ARCHITECTURE E.PLANNING.INTERIORS 7aZ E H R E N (e?o)e4+o2syA!\e7o)e4e-1oso -- AND ASSOCIATES vair@z€hron com' SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)96$81 02 sarigba lbat-a@zehren. com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet cT- 1 Proiect Information Name: Vuil Mou Location: V.lt, C"t"t"d" Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 315 Men's, 317 Women's Material: Manufacturer American Olean ProductNumber: CRl1 S36C9T Name/Color: Golden Rod Finish: N/A Dimensions: 12" x 12" Set on diagonal at walls, 12" x 12" Flooring, 6" x 12" Cove base Edge Delail: N/A Grout: TBD Conrnents: Fl"i.h "tt *p.r"d .dg* All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variafion in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufachuer requirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and placernent. Picture is representational Color may vary i.is:::::C"':' :.,,r,', 1.....' ..| , ,:$ ll;...,..1' ..i- tr. i...:.:-i. -?,'; - ': Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT-2 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: Material: Manufacturcr Product Number: Name/Color: Finish: Dirnensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comrnents: 315 Men's, 317 Women's Ceramic Liner/ Decos Crossville MTI53 Bronze Verdigris N/A 2" x 2" (Cut From 2" x 8") Random at walls, sa straight TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All ston€ to be sealed per rnanufacturer requirernents. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and placement. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNI N G. I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-5890 FAX (805)963€1 02 sa. gbsrbara@zehten.com NTERIORS VAIL (97O)949O2s7 Fru( (970)949.1 O8O vail@zellan.com I T I I I I I I I I t I T I t l I t I 27"5#,S,E^,|: I I I I I I I I l I t I I I I I t ) t SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (8Os)963-81 02 sanlabaabara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949.1 O80 vail@zehrsn.c{rn T,ehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 3 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Spccllication Location: 3l5 Men's, 317 Wonren's Material: Manufactiurer Crossville Product Number: MTl54 Name/Color: Bronze Verdigris Finish: N/A Dimersions: I " x 12" Liner at walls, including backsplash and endsplash at vani9 Edge Detail: N/A Grout TBD Comnents: All stone is a nahnal product, Oerefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per rnanufachrer requirernents. Any metal parts must be guaranteed against rust conosion and scratching. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattem and placement- Picture is representational Color may vary ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G . I N TE R I O RS L7r"5S,S,t^,fl Zchren & Associates Specification Sheet CT-4 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodqe Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilicetion Location: Material: Manufacturer Product Nurrber: Name/Color: Finish: Dimensions: Edge Deail: Grout: Comrents: 303D Batlr, 3O4D Bath, 305D Batlu 305H Batb,306D Badr,403D Bath, 407D Bath,409D Bath, 4l lD Bath, 4l5D Bath,4l7D BatlU 4l9D Bath, 503D Badr, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D Bath 609D Bath, 6l lD Bath, 6l3D Bath, 6l5D Batb Porcelain Tile Arnerican Olean cR 10. s36c9T Canyon Ridge, White Thistle Pcr Manufachuer 12" x 12" Flooring,6" x 12" C,ovebasc,6' x 6" Sbower flooring N/A TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural produc! thercfore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirerrnts. Refer to Floor Finish Plao and Detail Manral for tile pattem and placement. Picture is representational Color rnay vary ARCHITECTURE I I I I I I t I l I I t T I t I I l I SANTABARBARA ( 8Os)963€89O FAX (805)9618102 santabarbara@zshBn.corn E.PLANNING.INTERIORS i7Z E H R E_N ,,,o,*r.uY#ltezo)e4elo8o - AND ASSOCIATES ual@ehren.com' I I I I I I I I I I t l I I I I I I I ARCIIITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (8O5)9636890 FAX (8O5)963-8't02 santabsrbara@zeh,en. com Zehren & Associates Specilication Sheet cT- 5 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilication Iocation: Material: Manufactruer Product Number: Name/Color: Finish: Dirnensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Cornrnents: 303D Bath, 304D Batb 305D Bath,305H Bath,306D Bath,403D Batb 407D Bath,409D Batl, 41lD Bath, 4l5D Bath,4l7D Batlu 4l9D Bath, 503D Batb 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D Battu 609D Bath, 6l lD Bath, 6l3D Bath, 6l5D Bath Ceramic Tile American Olean M. Mafte 6" x 6" Set on diagonal at walls above accent band N/A TBD Firtrh "tt e>,""*d "dg"tAll srone is a natural produc! therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed oer manufacturer reouirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile panern and placement. Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS i7z E H R E_N ,,,0,*,_0.,y$!L.e7o)e4elo8o - AND ASSOCIATES vlirgzehren.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.6 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:303D Bath, 304D Bath" 305D Bath, 305H Battu 306D Bath,403D Bath,407O pa!!! aQlp BqtlL 607D Bath, 609D Bath, 61lD Bath, 613D Bath, 615D Bath Sonoma Tilemakers SE44 Sanchez Matte 4" x 4" Set on diagonal at walls below accent band, including backsplash and endsplash at vanity N/A TBD All materials and construction must be contract quality. Any metal parts must be guaranteed against rust corrosion and scratching. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail lr{anual for tile pattern and placement. Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Name/Golor Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G . I N TE RIOR S SANTA BARBARA (80s)963-6890 FAX (80s)963-8 I 02 santabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-108O vail@zehren.com I I I I I I I I t I I T t I l T I I I Lar*oEo3,&,i,!: I I I I I I t t I I I ,! I I I T I l I A RCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (8(}s)9636890 FAX (805)963-81 02 Ba.iabatbara@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 7 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throueh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specificetion Location: Material: Manufacturer Product Nurnber: Name./Color: Finish: Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Connnents: 303D Bath, 304D BatlU 305D Bath, 305H Bath, 306D Bath,403D Bath, 407D Bath,409D Batll 4l lD Bath, 4l5D Bath,417D Ba0r,4l9D Batb 503D Bath, 505D Bath 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D Batl, 609D Baft,6llD Bath, 6l3D Bath, 615D Bath Glass Tiles Sonorna Tilemakers Tamtrum Herm l" :tl\tr\ NiA TBD Fttrlrh "tt *p.r"d .dg* All stone is a natural produc! therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Firirh Pl- "n Picture is representational Color nray vary E.PLANNTNG.INTERIORS fiZ E H R E N rgzorgns-ozsY*Lrezo)e4$io8o = AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.8 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:3025 Bath,3085 Bath,4045 Bath 303D Bath, 304D Batll 305D Bafi 305H Bath,306D Bath,403D Bath, 407D Bath,409D Barh, 4llD Bath,4l5D Batb 4l7D Bath,4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath 51lD Bath, 607D Bath, 609D Batlu 6l lD BaOr, 613D Batll 615D Bath Ceramic Liner Sonoma Tilemakers F(frfe Metrlc Frrrnorirrn Antinrre Rronze N/A l/2" x 8" Liner at walls, including backsplash and endsplash at vanity N/A TBD All stone is a natural product, therefore zubject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per nranufacturer requirements. Any metal parts must be guaranteed against rust corrosion and scratching. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattem and placernent. Material: Manufacturer Product Number: Name/Color: Finish: Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: Picture is representational Color may vary I T I I I I I T t I I N. I I l I I ARCHITECTURE E.PLANNING.INTERIORS LZf*oE o3r S,l, N,.,0,*,.o,,YAlf-o)e4e.,oso ISANTA BARBARA (8O5)963€890 FAX (805)96!81 02 sar{abarbara@zehren.com I t I I I ! I I I T I I I t I I I t l t SANTA BARBARA (805)963€E90 FAX (805)963-8102 santabarbara@z6hren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949- rO8O vail(lzehren.com T,ehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 9 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: Vail. Colorado Proiect No: 20021501 .00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:336D Bath Material: Porcelian Tile Manufacturer: Arm Sacks Product Number, Name/Color: P.rfu P"*y R"*d" Finish: Copper Dimensions: 3/4" x 3/4" (12" x 12' Sheet) Floor border and wall mirror border Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Cormrents: All materials and construction must be confract quality. Any rnetal parts must be guaranteed against rust corrosion and scratching. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and placement. Pichue is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I N T E R I O R S zlr"5L&,:,f: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.lO Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Ad&ess: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: l49B Bath Material: Manufac$rer American Olean ProductNumber: CC-35 Name/Color: Vellum Finish: Polished Dimensions: 6"x 6" Set on diagonal at wall 4:low accent band El-^ ri^.^:l- l.l/ ArfuEg rrgiaur. Grout TBD Corrnents: Ft"trtt "tt r,p.*d "dg*All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per rnanufacturer requirernents. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tilc pattem and placement. ;-=); -). :i' Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANN IN G. INTE RI ORS I t I I I I I I T I I t I I 3 SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbaia@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)9491 O80 vall@zehren.com I I I I zr"5#,&,l,fi I I I l I I I l I I t I I I t I I t I SANTA BARBARA (805)9636890 FAX (8Os)9638102 santabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 OaO vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 1I Proiect Information Name: Vail Motmtain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501 .00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilication Location: l49B Bath Material: Manufacturer Arm Sacks ProductNumber: A57583-6 Name/Color: Dijon Finish: Polished Dimensions: 4"x 4" Set on diagonal at walls above accent band, 3" x 6" Set straight at accent band Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Comrnents: Ft"trh "tt ",p"*d.dg*All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail M Picture is representational Color may vary A RCIIITECTURE . PLAN NI N G . I N T E R I O R S Zf-oE o3,S,E^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ect Information Name: Location: Project No: Issue Date: Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Location: Material: Manufacfurer Product Number: Name./Color: Finish: Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Conrnents: Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTUR SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (8Os)963-8102 sardabarbara@zehren-com Vail Mountain Lodge Vail, Colorado 20021501.00 l49B Bath Ccramic Accent Tile Moore Merkowie Rectangular Leaf Green & Ocbre 2 ll4" x 6" Accent at shower walls Finish all exposed €dges. All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to varir tion in color All stone to be sealed per manufactwer requirenrents. Rcfer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile p ftern and CT.I2 INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-C257 FAX (970)94$.1 oEO vail@zehrqn.€om I T I I I I P Z AN E. -1-7.4 - LANNINGEHRE { D ASSOC IATI S T I t I I I t I I I I I I I I I t I I I I I I t I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@zeh€n com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@zehren com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 13 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: i49E Bath Material: Manufacturer Decorative Materials Inc, Ltd Product Number: Adex Natural Field Narne/Cnlnr Vcllnw Finiqh' Dimensions: 5" x 5" Set on diagonal at shower walls Fdoc Dptail' N/A Grout: TBD \- urru|ls||r5: " -rt-"t, "^p"*" a"gat All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per rnanufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattem and placement. Picfure is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNIN G. I NTE RIORS zr"5L&,i,|: Znhren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.14 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Localion: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: Material: Manufachrer Product Number: Name/Color: Finish: Dimensiors: Edge Detail: Grout: Cornrnents: l49E Bath Ceramic Tile- Shower Walls Onlv Decorative Materials lrc, Ltd Aspen 33 Moss Glazed 2" x 2" Random at shower walls N/A TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a nahual product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per rmnufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Dctail Manual for tile pattem and placerncnt. Picture is representational Color may vary I I I I I I t I I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8O5)e63€890 FAX (805)96381 02 santabarbara@zehren.cofn INTERIORS VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)9491080 val(lzcbr.n. com I T I I I I t I I I zr"5Ls,l,l: I I I I I I l I I I I I t I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (80sp63€890 FAX {805)96}81 @ sariabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vail@eh,en.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.15 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: Material: Manufacturer Product Number: Name/Color: Finish: Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments:Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirernents. Refer to Floor Fioirh Pl- .n 302J Batb, 308J Bath,404J Bath Porcelain Tile Decorative Materials Inc. Ltd Encore, Vccchio Bergamo, Primervera Mulii Per Manufacturer at shower walls N/A TBD Picture is representational Color may vary ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G . I N TE RI O R S zkoEoT,&,i,|: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.16 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Speclfication Location: Material: Manufacturer Product Nurnber: Name/Color: Finish: Dimnsions: Edge Detail: Grout: Cornrrents: 302J Batla 308J Batll 404J Bath Porcelain Tile Decorativc Materials ltrc, Ltd Encore, Vccchio Corsica. Primervera Multi Per Manufacturer 3" x 9" Acccnt band at shorrer walls TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural produc! therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stope to be sealed per rnanufacfurer requirernents. Refer to Floo,r Fhish Plan and Dctail Mamal for tile pattem and placement. Picture is rcpresentational Color rmy vary t I I I I I T t I I I I T I l l I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA {805)963€890 FAX (805)96}810? g€fl tgba rbara(Frren.@m INTERIORS VAIL (97o)9.r9{25t FA)( (97O)949'1O8O val@erhren.com I I zlr"5s,&,i,f: I I I I t I l I I I I I I I I t I I I A RCEITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805p63€E90 FAX (80s)96}81 02 sariabrrbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)9491 O8O vail@z6hren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 17 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mo Location: V"ltJ.t"""d. ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilication Location: Material: Manufacturer Product Number: Name/Color: Finish: Dimensions; Edge Deail: Grout: Connnents: 302P Bath, 308P Bath, 404P Bath Porcelain Tile Dal-tile LC03 La Costa Gold N/A 12" x 12" FlooE& 6" x 12" Base N/A TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stonc is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattem and placernent. Picture is representational Color may vary zr"oEn3,&,lrl: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 18 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mormtain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specificetlon Location: Material: Manufactuer Product Number: Nanre/Color: Finish: Dimcnsions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: 302P Bath, 308P Bath, 404P Bath Ceramic Tile Da!-tile Kl80 Charmis Per Manufacnrer 6" x 6' At shower wells, 3" x 6" Bullnose and beocb seat TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a nanuzl p'roduct, tbcreforc subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be scaled p€r manufacturer requirem€nts. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detril Marnral for tilc patterfl ard placement Pichrc is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G . INTB RI O R S I T I I T I I I t I I I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (8O5)e63-689O FAX (8Os)963€102 santabarbara@u elren.coan t T Zf"oE nlr &,i r N,,,0,*,'-J#l,.)eisroso T I I T I I I I T I I I t I T I t T I ARCHITECTURE . PLANNIN G. I N TE RI OR S SANTA BARBARA (805)9634890 FAX (805)9618102 santabarbara@zehren.com Picture is reoresenta alf*nvf*lssociates Specifi cation Sheet CT- 19 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vajl, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throueh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Spcclfication Location: 302P Bath.308P Bath.404P Bath Material: Porcelain Tile Manufacturer: Decorative Materials Inc, Ltd Product Number: . N/A Nanp/Color Aspe_n Liner, Frosted Jade Finish Glazed Dirnensions: 3" x 6" Liner at shower walls Edee Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Cornrnents: All materials and construction must be contact quality. Any metal parts mrst be guaranteed against rust corrosion and scratching. Refer to Floor Finish Plan und D"tuil M Picture is representational Color may vary 7az E H R E N ,rro,**oruYAf,teTo)s4e.1o8o - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehrcn.con Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.20 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain l,odge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilicedon Location: 3023 Batb, 3085 Bath, 4045 Bath Mnterial: Porcclain Tile Manufactuer: CAPCO Product Number: MAP 872 Name/Color Perla Bone Finish Glaznd Dinrsnsions: 12" x 12" Flooring,6" x 12" Base Edge Detail: N/A Grout TBD CorrrenB: All rmterials and constuction rmrst coqly with applicable fue and life safety codes. All mterials and construction rust be contsact oualitv. Rcfcr to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual fo tile pattern and placerrcnt. Picture is rcpresentational Color may vary t T I I I t I I I I t I T I l I I ARCHITDCTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)953€890 FAX (805)96+8 r&! santabarbar@zeh ren.conl INTERIORS VAIL (970)9.190257 FA)( (970P4$ tO8O vail@zat|€n.cofl! T I zr"5#,s,l,f: T I I I I I I t I I I T I I I t I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (8Os)963-8102 santab6rbara@zehren-com VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@zehlen.€om Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT-2I Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 3025 Battr,3085 Bath,4045 Bath Material: Manufacturer Arrrrican Olean _ ProductNumber: CC-38 Name/Color: Moss Finish: Matte Dimensions: 6" x 6" At shower walls, 3" x 6" Bullnose Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Comments: Ft"lrh rtt r-p.*d "dg*All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufachuer requirErnents. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Dctail Manual for tile pattem and placement. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANN I N G. I NTE RIORS zr"5s,&,[,]: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT.22 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain lodge Location: Vail. Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.0O Issue Date: Available Tbroush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: ipecificetion Location: 3023 Bath,3085 Batb,4MS Bath Material: Manufacturer Lunada Bay Tile, Inc Product Number: Custom Mix Name/Color: Mocha, Honey Pearl, Seafoam Green Silk, Crerm Pearl, Autunm Pearl Finish: Per Manufacturer Dinrnsions: I" x I " (l2" x 12" Sheets, Cut into 3" x 12" Strips) Accent Band , Edge Detail: N/A Grout TBD Corrnents: All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufachrer requirernents. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and ptacenmt. Picture is representational Color may vary I I I I I t I t I I I I T I T I I A RC}IITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I SANTA BARBARA ( 805)963€890 FAX (805)96381s2 ganlabarba ra@zehaen.coan NTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (97o)9rl9l o8o vail@zrlren.com T I zr"5s,&,1,!: t I T I I I t ! I I I I t I I t I t I A RCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-8r02 sgntabarbara@zehJen.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CT- 23 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:303C Bedroonl 304C Bedroorn, 305G Living, 306C Bedroor& 403C Bedroorl 407C Bedroonl 409C Bedroorn,41lC Bedroorq 4l5C Bedroorq 4l7C Bedroor4 4l9C Bedroorq 503C Be&oonl 505C Bedroorn 509C Bedroorn 5l lC Bedroonr. 607C Bedroonr. 609C Bedroorl 6l lC Bedroorn, 613C Bedroorn, 615C Bedroom Porcelain Tile Crossville VS55 Poroeii T ewn Elrnrrrn Acnpn I caf Per Manufacturer 4" x 12" Fireplace surrourd N/A TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plan and Detail Manual for tile paftern and placement. Material: Manufacturer Product Nrunber: Name/Color: Finish: Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Corrrnents: Picture is representational E.PLANNING.INTERIORS i7z E H R E N ,rro,ro*oruY$LteTo)e4$1080 - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zeh'sncom' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.l Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: JeffMikelson 97G92G5927 9704.79:7976 Specification Location: 315 Men's,317 Wonren's Material: Grardte Manufacturer: Dal-stone Product Number: N/A Name/Color Golden Leaf Finish Polished Dimensions: 12" x 12" Cormtertops, 4' x 4" Accent tile at u/alls DJ^^ r\r^:l- tt, At:)Lr5g ugr4tr. Grout: TBD Commnts: Fi"irh "tt "rp.*d "dg""All stone is a nahral product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per rnanufacturer requiremcnts. Refet to Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G. I N TE R I O R S I t I I I 3 I I T I I T T I I I I SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-6890 FAX (8Os)96$81 02 santabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949,O2s7 FAX (970)94+1 O8O vail@zehren.com I I zr"oE#,s,l,li I I I T I I I T ! I I I I I I I t I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTABARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)96981 02 santabarbgrq@zehrsn.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949.02s7 FAX (970)9r+1 080 vail@zshrgn-com Tnhren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.2 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:302H Entry, 302E Close! 302F Hall, 302L Powder, 303A Hall, 304A Hall,305A Hall, 306A Hall, 308A Entry, 308L Powder,403A Hall,404A Entry,404E Close! 404F Hall,4OlL Powder, 407A Hall,409A Hall, 41lA Hall,415D Batll 4l7AHall,4l9A Hall, 503A H4l, 509A Hall,5l1A Hall,607A Hall" 609,4. Hall,6l lA Hall, 613A Hall, 6l5A Hall Slate Santa Fe Collection N/A Wildfire Guased Natural Cleft 12" x 12" Floorins N/A TBD All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed oer manufacfirrer requirernents. Refer to Floor P!- *d D.t"t Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dirnensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Corunents: Picture is representational Color may vary zr"oE ^3,s,i,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 3 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Speciflcation Location:303C Bedroorl 303D Batb 305G Living,305D Batb,305H Bath,304A Hall, 3MD Bath, 306A Hall,306D Bath,403C Bedrooq 403D Batb 407A Hall,407D Bath,409A Hall, 409D Batb,4l lA Hall, 4l lD Batll 4l5A Hall, 4l5D Bath,4l7A Hall, 4l7D Battr,4l9A Hall, 4l9D Batb, 503A Hall, 503D Bath, 505A Hall, 505D Bath, 509A Hall, 509D Ba0l' 5l lA Hall, 51lD Bath, 607A Hall, 607D Batb" 609A llall, 609D Bath, 61lA Hall, 61 lD Bath, 613A Hall, 6l3D Batb 615,{ Hall, 6l5D Bath Granite Alpha Granit€ & Marble N/A Golden Green Polished 12" x 12" Countertops Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a nannal product, thereforc subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per manufacturer requirernents. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattem and placement. Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dinrnsions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE I I t I I I I I ! I I I T I t t I I ISANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-6890 FAX (8Os)963.8102 sar abarbara@zehren.com E.PLANNING.INTERIORS i-22 E H R E-N ,rro,ro*oruYfllteTo)e4e-1o80 - AND ASSOCIATES vai@zehren.'com' T I t I I I T T T I I I I t t I I t I SANTA BARBARA (805)9€36890 FAX (8os)963.81 02 santabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zBh.€n.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN-4 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Desien Materials. Inc. 1048 East 49th Avenue Buildins, C-l Denver, CO 80238 Wendv Utkke 970.260.0985 303446-078r Specification Location:269C Kitchen Material: Granite Manufacturer: D"ri* Mffi Product Number: N/A Name/Color Autumn Harmony Finish Polished Dimensions: Slab at countertoo Edge Detril: Grout: TBD Comments: Finish all exposed edges. l{n tt"t" All stone is to be sealed per manufacnuer reguirernents. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and placement. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNIN G. I N TE RI OR S zr-oEn3,&[,]: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.5 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Mike Quandt Phone: 303-744-1742 Fax: 303-634-6066 Specification Location: Material: Manufachner: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dirnensftrns: Edge Detail: Grout: Cornrnents: 269F Entry,269B Powder Dal-tilc,AHNZU MST4 Colirna Sunset Honed Slab at coutertop, 8" x 8" Flooring, 4" x 8" Ftooring, 6" x I' Base I l/2" Build-Up, Bullnose Edge at countertop l/2" Bevel edge at flooring TBD All stone is a natural product therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per marnrfacturer requirements. Refcr to Floor Plao and Detail Manual for tilc pattem and placenpnt. Picture is represe,ntational Color rnay vary I I I T I I I I T I I I t I T I I A RCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8O5p63-6890 FAX (805)96981 02 gantabarbsrg@z€luen.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (97OF49-1 O8O veil@zchr€n.com I I Zf-oE oH,&,i,N I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t t I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8'102 santabarbara@zehren com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 6 Pro.iect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge I ocalion Vail Colnradn Proiect No: 20021501.00 lssue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: Material: Manufactuier: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Delail: Grout: Comments: '116D Reth Santa Fe Collectinn N/A A lexendrie lfnned l2" x 12" Flooring, shower bench seat, and at shorver walls, 6" x 12" Base, 4" x 4" Shower floorins. 12" x 12" Set on diasonal above and below accent band N/A TRN Finish all evnncc.l pdops AII stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed oer manufacturer reouirements. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual lor tile paftem and placement. Picture is representational Color may vary ; - .: :. L7r*oE o!,S,[,|: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.7 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mounrain Lodge Incation: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Laura Giese 303-574-2990 303-574-t391 Specification Location: Material: Manufacfurer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: 336D Master Bath Marble Santa Fe Collection N/A Santiago Polished 12" x 12" Countert@ and tub dech 4' x 4' Flooing and at shower walls 2" x 12" Accent tile, 4" x 4" Accent tile at tub deck and shower walls N/A TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural produc! therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per rmnufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Plan and Dctail Manual fc tile pattern and placenrent. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G . I N TE RI O R S I I I I I I I I I I t I I I T I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (8Os)963-81 02 santabarbara@zeh,9n. com VAIL (970)949.0257 FAX (970)949-108O vail@zehr€n.com I I Zf-oE 03,&,i,1: I I I I I I I I I t I I t I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)9618 I 02 santabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)94$,0257 FAX (970)949-1 o8O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 8 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: JeffMikelson 970-926-5927 970-479-7976 Specification Location: l49E Bath Material: Limestone Manufacturer: Dal-stone Product Number: N/A Name/Color Jerusalem Antique Gold Finish Honed Dimensions: 12" x 12" Flooring, 6" x 12" Base Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Cornrnents: All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual f Picture is representational Color rnay vary ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I N TE RI O R S anr"oE o3,s,F,f: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 9 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Sup'plier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: JeffMikelson 970-926-5927 97M79-7976 Specification Location: l49B Bath Material: Limestone Manufacturer: Dal-stone ProductNrunber: N/A Name/Color Jerusalem Beige Finish Honed Dimensions: 12" x 12" Countertop and flooring, 6" x 12" Base Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Comnents: All stone is a natual product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per rnanufacturer requirements. Rcfer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattem and placement. .",' Pictue is representational .1 . '-. --' :' Color may vary lx I I I t I t I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-689O FAX (8Os)96181 02 santabarbara@zohr6n.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vail@zehren.com I I I I I I T I I I zr"5L*,l,ff I I T I I I I I I I T I I t I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-5890 FAX (805)963-8 1 02 gantabarbara@zBhren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zghr€n.corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.IO Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Jeff Mikelson 970-926-s927 970-479-7976 Specification Location: l49E Bath Material: Marble Manufacturer: Dal-stone Product Numbert Name/Color Rosa Gerona Finish Polished Dirnensions: 12'x 12" Countertop Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Conrnents: F tt.tr.tt r*"*d .dg* All stone is a nanral product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per manufachuer requirements, Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tilc pattem and placement. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NI N G. I N TE RI O R S ar"s#,s,E^,fl Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.11 Proiect lnformation Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: JeffMikelson 970-92G5927 9704't9-7n6 Specification Location: 3028Kitchen,3088Kitchen,4048Kitchen Material Granite Manufacturer: Dal-stone Product Number: N/A Name/Color Giallo Vensziana Finish Polisbed Dimensions: 12" x 12" Cormtertop EJ-^ h^.^:l- \Y, ALlirEg rJEtatr. l\ril Grout TBD Corrmrents: Ft"t"h "tt "-p"*d "dg*All stone is a ratural produc! therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to bc seated per manufacturer requirenrents. Refcr to Floor Plan and Dstail Mennl for tilc pattcrn and placenenS. Picture is representrtional Color rnay vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-6890 FAX (805)96$8102 sa]{darbara@zcrren.com INTERIORS VAlL (970)94$.0257 FAX (970)94$1 060 vail@zsh.cn.corn t I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I Zf"oE,nT,&'F'11 I I I t I I I I I t I I I I I I I t I ARCHITECTURE . PLANN I N G. I NTE RI ORS SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santaba|bara@zehren.com 7*hren & Associates Specification Sheet sTN- 12 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Dale: Available Through Address: Contact: Phone: 970.260.0985 Fax: 303446-0781 Specification Location: 3O2S Bath, 3O2K WC, 302J Bath, 3085 Batlr, 308K WC, 308J Bath, 4045 Bath,404K WC, 404J Bath Material: Manufacturer: Desi$Materials.Inc. Product Number: N/A Name/Color Jerusalem Bone Finish Honed Dimensions: 12" x 12" Comtenop, tub declc, and flooring,4" X 4" at Shower Floor, 6" x 12" Base Edse Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Comments: All stone is a natual produc! therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is lo be sealed per rnanufacturer requ ernents. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and pla a. i. ,. .I Picture is representational Color may vary fiZ E H R E N ,rro,*r-orrYALteTo)s4elooo = AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren.'com' Zehren & Associates Specilication Sheet sTN- 13 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Narne/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Cornrnenb: 302J Bath, 308J Batlr 4O4J Bath St.," Decorative Materials lnc, Ltd N/A MayGreen Honed, Tumbled 12" x 12" At shower walls above acrcnt band. 8" x E" At walls below acccnt band, 4' x 4' Random at flooring, 4" x 4" Sbower flooring TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a nanual product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining, All stone is to be sealcd per manufacturer rcquirennnts. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pa$ern and placement. Pichue is representational Color may vary T I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN NI N G . I N TE R I ORS SANTABARBARA (805)9634890 FAX (00s)963-81 02 sar*abarbara@zghrgn.cdn I I .72 E H R E_N ,nro,*n*uYAl.,e7o)e,relo8o -- AND ASSOCIATES uirgzeruen.'com' I I I I I I I I I I t t t t I I I I t SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8102 santabs lbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zshren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.14 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throueh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302J Batb 308J Balb 404J Bath Material: Travertine Manufacturer: DesimMaterials.Inc ProductNumber: ChairRail Name/Color Duranqo Finish Honed Dimensions: 2" x 12" At walls Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD Cornxnents: Firirh "tt "-p*"d "dg*All stone is a nahual producl, tberefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNI N G. IN TERIORS Lz(*oE 03,&,F,1: Znhren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 15 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302PBath,308P Batb" 404P Bath Material: Marble Manufacturer: Alpha Granite & Marble Product Number: N/A Name/Color Rojo Alicante Finish Polished Dimensions: Edge Detail: N/A Grout: TBD ConmletrE: All stone is a nanral produc! therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stonc is to be sealed per rnanufacturer requircnrnts. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Mamal for tile pattem and plac"*ot. Picture is representational Color rnay vary t I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I I ARCIIITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)9636890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@eht€n.cotn I t E.PLANNING.INTERIORS .22 E H R E_N ,rro,ro**uyfll,e7o)e.e..'oso*- AND ASSOCIATES vairqzerrreniom' t I I I I I I T t I I I I I T I I T I ARCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)9635890 FAX (8O5)96$81 02 sanlaba,bara@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet WLS-1 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: By Contractor Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:Townhome Unit Material: Description: Finish: Gvpsum Wall Board & Ceilines Contactor to provide sample to Zehren & Associates for approval before installation Prime and Paint Paint Specified Seperately Att ".t".t.All materials and construction must be contract quality. Any metal parts must be guaranteed agairxt rust corrosion and scratching. Comments: Picnue is representational Color mav vaw E.PLANNING.INTERIORS j7Z E H R E N ,rro,ror_orrYAlteTo)e4s,ioso = AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet WLS.2 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021 501 .00 Issue Date: Available Through Sunnlier: Bv Contractor Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:Unit 302, 303, 304, 305, 306, 315,317,403, 404,407, 409,411, 415, 417,419, 503, 505, 509, 5l 1, 607, 609, 6l I, 613, 615 Material: Description: Finish: Comments: Gypsum Wall Board & Ceilings Contractor to provide sample to Zehren & Associates for approval before installation Prime and Paint Paint Specified Seperately Attt-t All materials and construction must be contract quality. Any metal parts must be guaranteed against rust conosion and scratching. Picture is representational Color may vary I I I I I I I I I I T I I I I I I A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963€89O FAX (805)9638102 sar abarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1O8O vail@z6hren.com I I zr-5Ls,i,f: I I t I I t I I I I I I I t I t I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-68e0 FAx (805)9618 1 02 santabarba,a@zehren.com VAIL (970)949O2s7 FAX (970)949-1O8O vail@zehJen.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet WLS-3 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Bv Contractor Specification Location:Unit 307, 309, 3l l, 701,702 Material: Description: Finish: Gvpsurn Wall Board & Ceilinss Oranse Peel Prime and Paint Paint Soecified SeDeratelv Comrnents:All materials and constuction must comply with applicable fire and life safe9 codes. All materials and constuction must be contract quality. Any metal parts nnrst be guaranteed against rust corrosion and scratching. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I N TE RI ORS 4r"5 S,S,t^,fl Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet wD-t Proiect Information Name: Vail Mormtain Lodse Location: Proiect No: 20021502.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Bv Contractor Specification Location: Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: 269A Closet, 269C Kitchen, 269D Closet, 269E DininglLiving, 269G Stair, 3028 Kitchen, 302C Dining Roorn, 302D Family Roorn, 3088 Kitchen, 308C Dining Roorq 308D Family Roonl 4048 Kitchen, 404C Dining Roorq 404D Family Room Wood Floorins Green Mtr Wildwoods TBD Random 4", 5", 6" Widths Random 3'-0" min- 8'-0" max lengths N/A Ft"lrh "lt r,p"*d "dg""All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Finisb Plans for tile pattern. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I NTE RI OR S I I t I I t T I I I T I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8102 santabarbara@zehaen.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FN( (970)949-1 08O vail@zshrefl.coan t I zr"oE o!,*,i,1: t t T t t I I I I I I I I t I I I t t A RCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)9634890 FAX (805)9618102 sariabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (97o)e4s-108o vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CPT-I Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodpe LUUauUII: -"", t-*"at ProjectNo: 2O02I5O2.OO lssue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:Townhome Matedal: Custorr\ Per Interior Designer Yarn Conrent: TBD Manufacturer: TBD Pile Weigbt: TBD Product Number, Name/Color TBD Secondary Backing: TBD Pattern ReDeat: TBDDimensions: TBD - ,Pad: TBD Warranty: TBD Comments:Meets or Exceeds Methenamine Pill Test All nraterials and construction rnust cornply with applicable fire and life safety codes All materials and construction must be contact quality Picture is representational Color may vary zks#,*,r^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CPT-2 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mounlain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021502.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: $peqncaqqn Location:Fractional Material: Pile Weisht: TBDManufacturer: TBD _ Product Number: TBD Primary Backing: TBD Secondarv Backins: TBDName/Color TBD' _ - Patterri Repcat: TBDDimensions: TBD Warrantv: TBDPad: TBD - Corrrnents:Meels or Exceeds Methenamine Pill Test All rnaterials and construction must conply with applicable fue and life safety codes All materials and construction must bc contract quality Picture is representational Color rnay vary ARCHITECTURE . PLANNI N G . I NTE R I O RS I I t I t I I T I I I I t I II I I SANTA BARBARA (805)9636890 FAX (805)963-8102 sanlsbaabara@zeh ren.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)94S1O8O vail@zehr€n.com I I aksLs,l,fi INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-108O vail@zehren.com ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)9635890 FAX (805)96381 02 sanlabarbara@zeh ren.com I T T T t T I t t I t I I I I t I t I Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CPT-3 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021502.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:AU Material: Custon! Per Interior Designer Yarn Conlent: TBD Manufach[er: TBD Pile Weieht: TBD Product Numbe. Name/Color TBD Secondary Backing: TBD Dimensions: TBD Pattern Repeat: TBD Pad: TBD Warranty: TBD Comments:Meets or Exceeds Methenamine Pill Test All materials and construction must be conb-act qualiry Picture is representational Color may vary zr-5#,s,i,l: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet CPT4 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Localion: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021502.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:307A Hall,3079 Closet, 307C Closet,307D Bedroom,309,{ Hall, 3098 Closet, 309C Closer, 309D Bedroom,3l lA Hall,3l lB Closet, 3l lC Closet,3l lD Bedroom, 620 Stair, 621 Stair, 70lA Hall, 70lB Closet, T0lC Closet, 70lD Bedroom,702A Hall,7028 Closet, 702C Closet, 702D Bedroom Solution Dyed Nylot/ Sk i" Dy.d Nylon Y"- C-t Desigrweave Pile Weipht: 20997 Primary Backing: Polypropylene Trieste Secondary Babking: ActionBac l2'Wide Paftern Repeat: 5i 16" W x l" L Warranty: l0 Year Wear Material: Manufachuer: Product Nrunber: Name/Color Dimensions: Pad: Comments:Meets or Exceeds Methenamine Pill Test All rnaterials -d "o*tro"tio. -ust cooply *ith .ppli..bl@ Picrure is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G . I N TE R I ORS T t I I I t I I I I I I I I I t T SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963€890 FAX (805)963€102 sadtabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)9490257 FAX {97o)9rr9.108Oyail@zehren.com I I zr"5#,s,i,fi t, I I t l I I J l I I t I I il / I I T SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963.81 02 santabarbara@zehrer.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet vT-t Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Dale: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Carol Blaha 303-684-92rr Specification Location: 307F Bath, 309F Bath, 3l lF Bath, 70lE Kitchen, 70lF Bath, 7028 Kitchen, 702F Bath Material: Vinvl Tile Manufacturer: Parterre ProductNumber: 77137 Name/Color Pond, Versailles Finish N/A Dimensions: 18" x 18" x 3rnm Fdop f)eteil. N/A Grout N/A Comments: Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I N TE R I O R S -72 E H R E N (s7o)s4s42sy*!(e7o)e4$1o80 = AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehrEn.bom' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet RB-1 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021502.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: Unit 307, 309, 3l l, 7O1, 702 Rubber Cove Base Roppe Pl30 Buckskin TBD Finish all exposed edges. Pichue is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G **i#}gSP,iERiM,* ?7ZE HREN'santabarbara@zehren.com - AN D ASSOCIATES INTERIORS VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zehren.com ,l I t I I I I I I I I I I I I ! t I I I I T t I U I 1 l I I ll J t 1 ,1, I ! I SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963€890 FAX (805)9618102 santabarbara@zehren-com VAIL (970)94+O257 FAX (970)94+1 080 vail@zehren-com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLAM-I Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specilication Location:307E Kitchen, 307H Bath, 309E Kitchen, 309H Bath, 3l lE Kitchen, 3l lH Bath, 701E Kitchen, 701H Bath, 702E Kitchen, 702H Bath Pl., 'WilsonArf 4633-60 Nenrral Nehrrla N/A a""r" "rr ""l"r"t" tuBtt All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Detail Manual for tile pattern. Material: Manufactuer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Corrmrcnts: Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NIN G. I N TE RI OR S zr"5 #,s,r^,i: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLAM.2 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:3078 Kitchen, 307H Batb 3098 Kitchcn, 309H Bath, 3l lE Kitchen, 3l lH Bath, 70lE Kitcberl 70lH Balh,702E Kitchen,702H Bath Material: Manufacturer: Product Numben Narne/Color Finish Dirnensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Cormnents: Plastic Laminate WilsonArt p437-ffi ' Puma N/AN6--- N/A N/A Finish all orposed edges- _ All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per rnanufactuer requirements. Refer to Detail Manual for tile pattern. Picture is representational Color nray vary ARCIIITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)96&81 02 santabarbara@zehren-com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949{257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vail@zehren.com I I I l ! il I 'lI l I il rt I il il I I I zr"5#,s,F,fl I I t ,l I I I I t, I I I l I t, l, I T I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N IN G . I N TE RI O R S SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (8Os)9638102 sar abalbara@zeh ren. com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet MW-l Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Per Contractor Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:D.U. - Townhome Unit Manufacturer: N/A Material: Wood Base Product Number: Per Detail Name/ Color: Alder, #l Commor\ I " tight knots or approved alternate Finish: Per Interior Designer Sample Dimensions: 8" High at Main and Upper Levels Connnelts:Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Provide Sanples for Interior Designer Approval I " Tight Knots; Fill knots as needed; Cull wood missing knots All materials and constuction must comply with applicable fire and life safety codes All materials and conslructioD must be conract qualiry Pichue is representational Color may vary -72 E H R E N .r,o,*r-o,uY$!.,e7o)s4e_1o8o - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehren.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet MW-2 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Dale: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Per Conuactor Specification Location:Unit 302, 303, 304, 3q5,!9q1!5, 3r7,403,404.A07,409,4rr,41s,4r7,419, 503, 505, 509,5l l, 607,ffig,6l r,613,615 N/A Wood Base per Detail Alder, # I Corrrnon, I " tight tnots or approved alternate Per Interior Designer Sanple 6'Hish Manufacturer: Material: Product Number: Name/ Color: Finish: Dimensions: Cornrnents:Suprplicr to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Provide Sarrples for Interior Designer Approval I' Tight Knots; Fill tnots as needed; Cull wood missing knots. All materials and construction must comply wiih applicable fre and life safeg codes All materials and constuction must be contract quality ARCHITECTURE . PLANN IN G. IN TE RI ORS T t I T Il I I ,l I t I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-81 02 sa ntabarbaaa@zehaen.clm I I 'l I I I Zf"oE oSr S,lr N,,,0,**o'uYfl!t,^)s4s-io8o VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 O8O vaal@zehren.com SANTABARBARA (805)9634890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santaba rbara(Dzeh ren.com I I T 7 I t l I t, I t 1 I I t I I t, I Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet MW -3 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Per Contractor Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:l49B Bath, l49E Bath, 2698 Powder, 269C Kitchen, 3028 Kitchen, 302J Bath, 302P Bath, 3025 Battr" 3088 Kitchen, 308J Bath, 308P Bath,3085 Bath, 3368 Dressing Area,336D Bath' 4048 Kitchen,404J Bath,404P Bath,4045 Bath TBD Match Door Stvle or Provide Altemate Alder, #l Common, l " tight knos or approved altemate Per Interior Desiener SarnDle Field Veri& Conrrrnts:Suoolier to verifo that all necessarv Darts for installation are ordered Provide Door Stvle Sarroles for Interior Desigter ADproval l" Tight K-nots max; Fill knots as needed; Cull wood missing knots All rnaterials and construction must cornply with applicable fire and life safe9 codes All rnaterials and construction must be contract quality Manufachrer: Material: Product Number: Narry' Color: Finish: Dimensions: ARCIIITECTURE . PLANN I N G . I N TE R I O R S zr.5 #,s,t^,11 Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet MW-4 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Per Confractor Specification Location:3MA Hall, 305A Hall, 306A Hall,407A Hall, 409A Hall, 4l lA Hall, 415A Hall, 4l7A Hall,419A Hall, 509.A Hall, 5l lA Hall, 607A Hall, 609A Hall, 6l lA Hall, 613,It Hall, 615A Hall TBD Match Door Stvle or Provide Ahernate Alder, #l Conunon, l" tight knots or approved'altemate Per Interior Designer Sanple Field Verify Manufacturer: Material: Product Number: Narne/ Color: Finish: Dimensions: Connnents:Supplier to verify that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Provide Door SVle Sarrples for Inlerior Designer Approval I' Tight Knots rnax; Fill knots as needed; Cull wood missing knorc All materials and consfruction rrmst conply with applicable fire and life safety codes All materials and constuction must be contract quality A RCHITECTURE I I I f, t t I I '! I I I I I I t I fl I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (80s)9698102 santabarbara@aoh.6n.c!m E.PLANNING.INTERIORS Zf"$ It &,Eo, N,"0,'o*o"YA!L-o)e4e-1oso I I t I t t I I t I ti I ; i t I t I A RCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (80s)9634890 FAX (805)963.81 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-108O vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG-1 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proier-t Nn' )nO?lsnl nn Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contacl: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:336D Bath(2) Item Description Vanity Light Manufacturer Brass Light Gallery Product Number: CN-104-81, Reto Sconce Dimensions: l8"Wx5"Hx5 1/2"P ColorlFinish: Chain f enoth' N/A Shade: All8 olr.tuc rrruslr. -"", -r"*Install: Refer to drawings for mormting height Corrrnents: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered I II I isrer Provide blocking for weigbt requirement Picture is representational Color may vary Af"oE 03,&,E^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG.2 Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 2002t501.00 Issue Date: Avaif4ble Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 336D Bath(2) Item Descripion Vanity Light at Make-Up Cormter Manufachrer Minka Lavery ProductNumber: 632-84 Dimensions: 42 112" W x3 3l8" Hx43l4" P Color/Finish: Brusbed Nickel Chain Lenglh: N/A Shade: Opal Glass Shade Finish: N/A Install: To Be Installed Vertically Refer to drawings for mormting height Corrmrcnts: Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirement Picture is represenlational Color may vary I I I T I t I I I I ni I I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (80s)963€e90 FAX (805)9618102 sanlabaJbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1080 vail@zehren.com I I I l Izr"oE#,&,[,]: t I T t I T I .l I l t fl t T I T I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 sanlabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@zehren.com Z.,ehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG-3 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Localion: Vail, Colorado Proiect Nn' ?OO2l5Ol nO Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 1498, 1498 Item Description Manufacturer Kichler Product Numbe' Dimensions: 24" Wx l0 l.r2"Hx8l/2" P Colorffinish: Brushed Nickel Chain Length: Shade: TBD Glass Finish: TBD Install: Refer to drawings for mounting height Comments: Supplier to veri8 that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirement Picture is representational Color mav varv ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NI N G . I N TE RIORS zkoE o3,s,E^,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG .4 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269BPowde(2) Itern Description Wll Sconce Manufachrer Hubbardton Forge ProductNumber: 204526-20 Dimensions: 4'! W x29" H x6l/2" P Colorffinish: Natural Iron Chain Length: N/A Shade: TBD Shade Finish: TBD Install: Refer to drawings for mounting height Comments: S"peti". t. ""rtfy th" UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirement Picture is representational Color mav varv ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NI N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963"81 02 santaba rba,a@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (97O)949-0257 FAX (97OF49-1 08O vail@zeken.com l t t T I I I It I I I /t t I I I I I IZf"oEo3rs.,E^rfi l I t t t I il I I I I t I t I t I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€E90 FAX (805)963-8r 02 sariabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1080 vail@zehren,corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG-5 Proi ect Information Name: Vail Mormtain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 tssue uate: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269C Kitchen(5) ItemDescription Pendant Manufacturer Cosalt ProductNumber: CP52I22 Dimensions: P", M*frch"* . ColorlFinish: TBD Chain Length: Shade' TRD Shade Finich. TRD kstall: Refer to drawings for mounting height Cormnents: Supplier to veriff that all necessary pars for installation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirement Pictrue is representational Color may vary zkoEoS,&,E^,|: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG.6 Project Information Narne: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Conlact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 269E Dining/ Living ItemDescription Pendant Manufacturer Neidhart Product Number: Lucien 6 arm Dimensions: 36" Diameter Color/Iinish: Dark Bronze Chain Length: Shade: Hand Blown Glass Shade Finish: Clear Frosted Install: Refer to drawings for rrounting height Connnents: Supplier to veri0 that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Providc blocking for wcight requirenrnt Picture is representational Color rnay vary T t I I I A RCHITECTURE . PLANN I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)9636890 FAX (805)96381 02 santababara@z€tren.co.n INTERIORS VAIL (970)94$02s7 FAX (s7O)949'1 08O vsil@zehren.com I n I I I I t I I l t I t Izr"5L&,r^,!: I I I I I I t I I I I 1 I l I I I I I ARCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8102 sanlabarbara@zehaen-@m Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG -7 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge I nr"alion' Vail Colnradn Proiecl No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302J Bath(2), 308J Bath(2),404J Bath(2) Item Description Vanity Lig|t Manufacturer Minka Lavery ProductNumber: 5272-77 Dimensions: 20 ll2"W x8l/4"Hx6"P Color/Finish: Chain Length: Shade: TBD Shade Finish: TBD hstall: R.f.. t. dr"*t"gr f* -",-rltu h.lght Connnents: S"pptt"t t *.tfy th"t "tl t"*@ IIT I iqrpd Provide blocking for weight requirement Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS i7z E H R E N ,r,0,*r_oruy*!\s7o)s4s_1o8o - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zeh.en.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG-8 Proiect Information Narne: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 303D Bath,304D Bath,305D Bath, 306D Bath" 308P Bath,403D Bath,407D Bath,409D BatlU 4l lD Batb 4l7D Bath, 4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 609D Bath, 61lD Bath, 613D Bath Item Description Vanity Light Manufacirer Minla Lavery ProductNwnber: 5583-84 Dimensions: 25 ll2" W x7 314" Hx83/8" P ColorlFinish: Brusbed Nickel Chain Lensth: N/A Shade: TBD ShadeFinish: TBD Install: Refer to drawings for mounting height Cornrnents: Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirerrrnt Picture is representational Color may vary I I I t I I il ARCHITECTURE . P LAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA ( 805)9635890 FAX (805)963.8102 sariabarba,a@z€hr€n.co,n INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vail@zehr€n-com I l t t ,T I i t t I l IzkoEoS,&,E^,1: I I I I T I t I I I I I I I T t I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-8102 santabarlraro@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (97O)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 O80 vail@zebren.corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG-9 Pro.iect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge I nr-alion' Vail Cnlnradn Proiect Nn' 7OO7l5Ol On lssue uate: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Locafion: 302P Bath, 3025 Bath, 305H Badr, 3085 Bath,404P Bath,4045 Bath,415D Bath, 607D Bath, 615D Bath Iiem Descripiion \--lty- Ltght Manufachrer Milka Lavery PrndrrcfNrrrnher' 55R?-R4 Dimensions: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Brushed Nickel Chain Length: N/A Shade: TBD Ju.rqc I ullstl. t-- Install: Refer to drawings for mounting height Corrmrnts: Srpptl"t UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirement Pictrue is representational Color may vary Zf-oE^3rS,E^'fi Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG - TO Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Dale: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302L Powde(2l, 308L Powdc(2),4M Powde(2) Item Description Wall Sconce Manufacnrer Corbett Product Number: 38001, Jardins Du Soleil Dimensions: 5" W x 16 1i2" H x 8" P Color/Finish: Dragonlly Greeu Chain I -enoth' N/A Shade: N/A Glass Finish: Install: Refer to drawings for rnounting height Comments: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Providc blocking for weight requirement Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE t t I I I i t I l I t t I l t I I t I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)9698r 02 santabarbara@zehren.com E.PLANNING.INTERIORS zr_5 #, &,1, l*,,,o,*,_o,uyAl.,,^)e4e_1o8o I I I I I t t I I T l t I I I I I I t ARCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)963$690 FAX (805)963-8102 santabarbaaa@zehren.coan Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG-II Proiect Information Name: Vail Mounlain Lodee LULaUUu. -"", \.ar"-"", ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: $pcjfication Location: 3028Kitchen(3),308BKilchen(3),4048Kitchen(3) IternDescription Pendant Manufacturer Candella ProductNumber: C360GFEAL Dimensions: 7" W x34 ll2" H Color/Finish: Ferro Chain Length: Shade: Roman Glass Shade Finish: TBD Install: Cornments: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirennnt Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS =AZEHREN - AN D ASS oc rnr e i (e70)e4e-02:l/FAx(e70)e4e-10E0 Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG.12 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Localion: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302C Dining Roorq 308C Dining Roonl 404C Dining Room ItemDescription Semi-FlushPendant Manufachrer Corbett ProductNumber: 5605 Dirnensions: 18"Wxll"H Colo/Finish: TBD Chain Lensth: N/A Shade: Aruburn Silver Shade Finish: Veneered Stone Install: Refer to drawings for mounting height Comments: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for irstallation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirement Picture is representational Color rnav varv I I I I I I I t I I T I I t t I I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963-6890 FAX (805)96+81 02 sar$abarbara@zehr6n.com INTERIORS VAIL (97O)949-02s7 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@ze}}ren.comL7r"oEo3,S,l,f: I t I I I I I l I I I T I T I t I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963.81 02 sanlabarbara@zehrgn.co'n VAIL (970)949.02s7 FAX (970)94+1 060 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG. 13 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 lssue uate: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 315 M". t Item Description Wall Scones Manufacturer Morrison Lighting ProductNumber: 4099-01 Dimensions: 9"Wx 13"Hx3 l/2"P Color/Finish: Foreed lron Chainkngth: N/A Shade: Sand Etched Peach Shade Finish: Glass Diffuser krstall: R"f* t &"*l"gs f* n-*tl"g hright Conrnents: Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirement Picnre is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G . INTE RI ORS zr"5L&,[,]: Z,ehren & Associates Specification Sheet LTG - 14 Proiect Information Name: Vail Mounlain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 307F Bath, 309F Bath, 3l lF Bath, 701F Bath, 702F Batr Itern Description Vanig Lighting Manufachrer TBD Product Nrmrber: TBD Dimensions: TBD Color/Finish: TBD Chain Length: N/A Shade: TBD ShadeFinish: TBD Install: Refer to drawings for mounting height Corrrnenls: Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered UL Listed Provide blocking for weight requirercnt Picture is representational Color may vary T I il I I 0 I I I I T ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963€8e0 FAX (8Os)96'81 02 santabarbara@zeh.en.co.n INTERIORS VAIL (970)949.02s7 FA( (970)949.1 080 vail@zehr€n.com I I I t I t I Izr"5L&,r^,f: I I 2002150r.08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3/21/2004 t SECTION Ol IOO - SUMMARY T PART I -GENERAL rl -, I.I STJMMARY I A. This Section includes the following:a .,1. l. Work covered by the Contract Documerts. I 2. Work phases. I]fJ 3. Work under other contracts. 4. Use ofpremises. t 5. Owner's occupancy requirements. l] 6. Specification formats and conventions. t B. See Division I Section "Summary of Multiple Conhacts" for division of responsibilities for the f Work.'r- I Lz 'woRK covERED By coNTRACT DoctjMENTs ! A. Project ldentification: Vail Mountian Lodge, Architet's Project Number 20021501.08. t l. Project Location: 352 East Meadow Drive, Vail, Colorado, 81657 I B. Owner: VML, LLC l. Owner's Representative: Stan Cope, American Hospitality, c/o The Lodge Tower 200 I Vail Road, Vail, Colorado 81657 (970) 476-9530 l, C. Architect: Z'efuen and Associates, Inc., PO Box 3401, 43 East Beaver Creek Boulevard, Suite ,r 303, Avon Colorado 81620 f D. The Work consists of the following: I l. The Work includes demolition, renovation, and additions to the current core and shell. I E. Project will be constructed under a single prime contact. -.q, 1.3 WORK PHASES I A. The Work shall be conducted in one phase.I B. Before commencing Work, submit a schedule showing lhe sequence, commencement and I completion dates, and move -in dates of Owner's personnel for all phases of the Work.t I I SI.JMMARY 01100- I t.4 20021501.08 VAIL MOLTNTI-AN LODGE 3/21/2004 WORK UNDER OTHER CONTRACTS General: Cooperate fully with separate contractors so work on those contracts may be carried out smoothly, without interfering with or delaying work under this Contract. Coordinate the Work of thjs Contract with work performed under separate contracts. Concurrent Work: Unit Owner's will award separate contract(s) for the following construction operations at Project site. Thos€ operations will be conducted simultaneously with work under this Contract. l. A separate contract will be awarded for demolition and renovations of the eastem condominium unit on level 196 and 207. Documents describing in detail the extent of those renovations will be made available to the Conhactor tluough the Building Owner. USE OF PREMISES General: Contractor shall have limited use of premises for construction operations, during the constuction period. Contactor's use of premises is limited only by Ownet's right to p€rform work or to retain other contractors on po'rtions of hoject. Use of Site: Limit use of premises to areas within the Contract limits indicated. Do not disturb portions of Project site beyond areas in which the Work is indicated. l. Limits: Confine constructions operations to areas indicated in the constuction staging plan submitted to the Town of Vail by the Contactor. 2. Owner Occupancy: Allow for Owner occupancy of the Healthclub, Restaurant, and existing, occupied units by the owners and general public.3. Driveways and Entrances: Keep driveways parking garage, loading areas, and entrances serving premises clear and available to Owner, Owner's employees, and anergency vehicles at all times. Do not use these areas for parking or storage of materials. a. Schedule deliveries to minimize use of driveways and eatrances.b. Schedule deliveries to minirnize space and time requirements for storage of materials and equipment on-site. Use of Existing Building: Maintain existing building in a weathertight condition throughout construction period. Repair damage caused by construction operations. Protect building and its occupants during construction period. owNER'S OCCUPANCY REQUIREMENTS Partial Owner Occupancy: Building Owner will occupy the premises during entire construction period, with the exception of areas under construction. Cooperate with Owner during construction operations to minimize conflicts and facilitate Owner usage. Perform the Work so as not to interfere with Owner's operations. Maintain existing exits, unless otherwise indicated. I I I I I I T I T I I I I I T I I t I B. 1.5 B. 1.6 SUMMARY 01100 - 2 B. A. B. I I I 't I, T I I I I I I I I J t I I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 l. Maintain access to existing walkways, corridors, and other adjacent occupied or used facilities. Do not close or obstruct walkways, corridors, or olher occupied or used facilities without written permission from Owner and authorities having jurisdiction. Owner Occupancy of Completed Areas of Construction: Owner reserves the right to place and install equipment in completed areas, before Substantial Completion, provided such occupancy does not interfere with cornpletion of the Work. Such placement of equipment and partial occupancy shall not constitute acceptance of the total Work. l. Architect will prepare a Certificate of Substantial Completion for each specific portion of the Work to be occupied before Owner occupancy. 2. Obtain a Certificate of Occupancy from authorities having jurisdiction before Owner occupancy. 3. Before partial Owner occupancy, mechanical and electrical systems shall be fully operational, and required tests and inspections shall be successfully completed. On occupancy, Owner will operate and maintain mechanical and electrical systems serving occupied portions of building. 4. On occupancy, Owner will assume responsibility for maintenance and custodial service for occupied portions of building. SPECIFICATION FORMATS AND CONVENTIONS Specihcation Format: The Specifications are organized inio Divisions and Sections using the l6-division format and CSVCSC'S "MasterFormat" numbering system. l. Division l: Sections in Division I sovem the execution of the Work of all Sections in the Specifications. Specification Content: The Specifications use certain conventions for the style of language and the intended meaning of certain terms, words, and phrases when used in particular situations. These conventions are as follows: l. Abbreviated Language: Language used in the Specifications and other Contract Documents is abbreviated. Words and meanings shall be interpreted as appropriate. Words implied, but not stated, shall be inferred as the sense requires. Singular words shall be interpreted as plural, and plural words shall be interpreted as singular where applicable as the context of the Contact Documents indicates.2. Imperative mood and streamlined language are generally used in the Specifications. Requirements expressed in the imperative mood are to be performed by Contractor. Occasionally, the indicative or subjunctive mood may be used in the Section Text for clarity to describe responsibilities that must be fulfilled indirectly by Contractor or by others when so noted. a. The words "shall," "shall be," or "shall conply with," depending on the context, are irnplied where a colon (:) is used within a sentence or phrase. t.7 SUMMARY 01100 - 3 20021s01.08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART 3 - EXECIITION (Not Used) END OF SECTIONOIIOO VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t2l/2W4 SUMMARY 01100-4 I r' 20021501.08 vArL MoITNTI.AN LoDGE 3l2t/2004 ,l ! SECTION OI2IO - ALLOWANCES a PART I -GENERAL I I.1 SI]MMARY I A. This Section includes administrative and procedural requirernents goveming the following: .\ l. Lurnp-sum allowances. I 2. Unit-cost allowances. - 3. Quantity allowances. 4. Contingencyallowances. I 5. Testing and inspecting allowances.r Li B. See Division I Section "Unit Prices" for procedures for using unit prices. ,! C. See Division I Section "Quality Requirements" for procedures goveming the use of allowances for testing and inspecting. t r.z sELEcTIoNANDpuRcHASE I A. At the earliest practical date after award ofthe Contract, advise Architect of the date when finalil selection and purchase ofeach product or system described by an allowance must be completed to avoid delalng the Work. I B. At Architect's request, obtain proposals for each allowance for use in making final selections. Include reconnnerdations that are relevant to performing the Work. I C. Pr:rchase products and systems selected by Architect from the designated supplier. | 1.3 suBMrrrALSt A. Submit proposals for purchase of products or systems included in allowances, in the form I specified foichange Orders.I B. Subrnit invoices or delivery slips to show actual quantities of materials delivered to the site for I use in fulfillment of each allowance. a C. Coordinate and process submittals for allowance items in same manner as for other portions of r the Work.r,t 1.4 COORDINATION ar A. Coordinate allowance items with other portions of the Work. Fumish templates as required to coordinate installation.I I ALLowANcES 01210 - I I I IA. B. 1.5 Il I t B. 1.6 20021501.08 VAILMOTJNTIAN LODGE 3/2t/2004 LLrMP-SUM, LINIT-COST AND QUANTITY ALLOWANCES Allowance shall include cost to Contractor of specific products and materials ordered by Owner under allowance and shall include taxes, freight, and delivery to Project site. Contractor's costs for receiying and handling at Project site, labor, installation, overhead and profit, and similar costs related to products and materials ordered by Owner under allowance shall be included as part ofthe Contract Sum and not part of the allowance. CONTINGENCY ALLOWANCES Use the contingency allowance only as directed by Architect for Owner's purposes and only by Change Orders that indicate amounts to be charged to the allowance. contractor's overhead, profit, and related costs for products and equipment ordered by owner under the contingency allowance are included in the allowance and are not part of the Contact Sum. These costs include delivery, installation, taxes, insurance, equipment rental, and similar costs. Change Orders authorizing use of funds from the contingency allowance will include Contractods related costs and reasonable overhead and profit margins, At Project closeout, credit unused amounts remaining in the contingency allowance to Owner by Change Order. TESTING AND INSPECTING ALLOWANCES Testing and inspecting allowances include the cost of engaging testing ageacies, actual tests and inspections, and reporting results. The allowance does not include incidental labor required to assist the testing agency or costs for retesting if previous tests and inspections result in failure. The cost for incidental labor to assist the testing agency shall be included in the Contact Sum. Costs of services not required by the Contract Documerts are not included in the allowance. At Projecl closeout, credit unused amounts rernaining in the testing and inspecting allowance to Owner by Change Order. UNUSEDMATERIALS Retum unused materials purchased under an allowance to manufacturer or supplier for credit to Owner, after installation has been cornpleted and accepted. l. If requested by Architect, prepare unused material for storage by Owner when it is not economically practical to retum the material for credit. If directed by Architect, deliver unused material to Owner's storage space. Otherwise, disposal of unused material is Contracto/s responsibi I ity. D. t.7 I I I I T B. C. D. l T T I I 1.8 ALLOWANCES 01210 -2 I I I 2OO2I5O1.O8 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART 3 - EXECUTION 3t2v2004 EXAMINATION Examine products covered by an allowance promptly on delivery for damage or defects. Retum damaged or defective products to manufacturer for replacement. PREPARATION Coordinate materials and their installation for each allowance with related materials and installations to ensure that each allowance item is completely integrated and interfaced with related work. SCHEDULE OF ALLOWANCES Allowance No. I Include testing and inspection as specified in Division 0331 Section "Cast-in- in-Place Concrete Allowance No. 2 Includc testing and inspection as specified in Division 05120 Section "Stuchral Steel". Allowance No. 3 Include a unit cost allowance for roofing system repair and replacement as specified in Division0l73l Section "Cutting and Patching", Division07610 Section "Sheet Metal Roofing" and in Division 07210 Section "Building Insulation". Allowance No. 4 lnclude a lump sum cost allowance for cutting and patching as specified in Division0l73l Section "Cutting and Patching" and in Division0l732 Section "Selective Demolition' and shown on drawings for all conskuction activities located in finished areas below the elevation or adjacent to existing finished areas including corridors and dwelling units. Allowance No. 5 Include a lump sum allowance for a design-build contact for a fully operational fire protection system including but not limited to design, approvals, malerials, labor, testing, and inspections. Include a unit cost allowance for additional sprinkler heads, concealed heads, and piping. Allowance No. 6 Include a lump sum allowance for field modifications to unanticipated, unforeseen, hidden, or covered existing conditions related to structural steel, metal fabrications, steel decl and/or cast in place concrete Work indicated in the Documents. Allowance No. 7 krclude a unit cost allowance for floor leveling as specified in Division 3 "Cement Based Underlayment" indicated in the Documents. Allowance No. 8 Allowance No. 8 Include a unit cost allowance for 24 inch by 24 inch access doors of each type as specified in Division 8 "Access Doors" indicated in the Documents.. 3.1 A. B. c. D. F. G. H. 3.2 3.3 t t I I l I I I I I I I I I I ALLOWANCES 01210 - 3 20021501.08 END OF SECTION OI2IO VAIL MOTJNTTAN LODGE 3/2r/2004 ALLOWANCES 01210 - 4 A. B. c. D. l.l 1.2 1.3 I I l I I I I I I I I T I I I I I I I 20021501.08 SECTION OI23O - ALTERNATES PART 1 - GENERAL VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE SUMMARY This Section includes administrative and procedural requirements for altemates. DEFINITIONS Altemate: An amount proposed by bidders and stated on the Bid Form for certain work defined in the Bidding Requirernorts that may be added to or deducted from the Base Bid amount if Owner decides to accept a corresponding change either in the amount of construction to be completed or in the products, materials, equipment, systems, or installation methods described in the Contract Documents, l. The cost or credit for each alternate is the net addition to or deduction from the Conhact Sum to incorporate alternate into the Work. No other adjustrnents are made to the Contract Sum. PROCEDTIRES Coordination: Modiff or adjust affected adjacent work as necessary to completely integrate work of tbe altemate into Project. l. Include as part of each alternate, miscellaneous devices, accessory objects, and similar items incidental to or required for a complete installation whether or not indicated as part of alternate. Notification: Immediately following award of the Contract, notif each party involved, in writing, of the status of each altemate. lndicate if altemates have been accepted, rejected, or deferred for later consideration. Include a complete description of negotiated modifications to altemates. Execute accepted alternates under the same conditions as other work of the Contract. Schedule: A Schedule of Alternates is included at the end of this Section. Specification Sections referenced in schedule contain requirements for materials necessary to achieve the work described under each altemate. 3/21/2004 ALTERNATES 01230 - I 2OO2I5OI.O8 VAIL MOUNTI"AN LODGE PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART 3 - EXECUTION 3/2v2004 t I I I I T I I t 3.I SCHEDULEOFALTERNATES A. General: Reference Interior Specification sheets for alternates related to Interior Fixed Finishes Fixtures, and Appliances. B. Altemate No. l: Provide a unit price altemate for a 20 minute rated, 3'-0" by 6'-8"painte4 flush wood door as specified in Division 0821I " Flush Wood Doors", with wood glued panels to match existing corridor doors as an alternate to a two panel stile and rail corridor door as specified in Dvision 08212, "Stile and Rail Wood Doors". C. Alternate No.2: Provide a unit price alternate for a standard passage lockset as specified in Division 0871 I ' HARDWARE", for card readers specified in Hardware Group I . D. Alternate No. 3: hovide a deduct or add alternate cost for unit kitchens as specified in Division 11460'Unit Kitchens" for each item listed below: 1. Two cooktop bumers, each rated at 1250 W. 2. No Built -in Electric Oven.3. No recirculating, nonventing hood. 4. No fluorescent light fixtures. 5. No microwave. 6. No wall shields. 7. Stainless Steel sink substituted for porcelain anamel finished steel. END OF SECTION OI23O t I I I I I I I t IALTERNATES01230 -2 A. B. c. l.l I I I I I I B. 1.2 t.3 t l I I I l I I I I t I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE SECTION OI25O - CONTRACT MODIFICATION PROCEDURES PART I -GENERAL 3/21/2004 SI]MMARY This Secfion specifies administative and procedural requirements for handling and processing Contact modifications. See Division 1 Section "Allowances" for procedural requirements for handling and processing allowances. See Dvision I Section "Unit Prices" for administrative requirements for using unit prices. MINOR CHANGES IN THE WORK Architect will issue supplemental instructions authorizing Minor Changes in the Work, not involving adjustment to the Contract Sum or the Contract Time, on AIA Document G710, "Architect's Supplemental lnstructions." PROPOSAL REQUESTS Owner-Initiated Proposal Requests: Architect will issue a detailed description of proposed changes in the Work that may require adjustment to the Contract Sum or the Contract Time. If necessary, the description will include supplemental or revised Drawings and Specifications. l. Proposal Requests issued by Architect are for information only. Do not consider thern insbuctions either to stop work in progress or to execute the proposed change.2. Within 14 days after receipt of Proposal Request, submit a quotation estimating cost adjustnents to the Contract Sum and the Contract Time necessary to execute the change. a. Include a list of quantities of products required or eliminated and unit costs, with total amount of purchases and credits to be made. If requested, fumish survey data to substanti ate quantities. b. krdicate applicable taxes, delivery charges, equipmentrental, and amounts oftrade discounts. c. Include costs of labor and supervision directly attributable to the change.d. Include an updated Contractofs Construction Schedule that indicates the effect of the change, including, but not limited to, changes in activity duration, start and fmish times, and activity relationship. Use available total float before requesting an extension of the Contract Time. Contractor-Initiated Proposals: If latent or unforeseen conditions require modifications to the Contact, Contactor may propose changes by submitting a request for a change to Architect. CONTRACT MODIFICATION PROCEDI"]RES 01250 - l I I I I I ) I I T I I I I t I I I t I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)96$8102 santabarbaaa@zehtgn. com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 5 AIt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 lssue uate: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avnn CO Rl6?O Contact: Amanda Bouchard rnone: , twrlr-,lu rax: , twsl>rrtb Specification Location: 1498 Bath, l49E Bath, 302J Bath(2),302P Bath,3025 Bath, 308J Bath(2), 308P Bath, 3083 Bath, 336D Bath(2), 404J Bath(2), 404P Bath, 4045 Bath Manufachrrer: r ruuuLt. ,-"a "-t-t Product Number: K-221 I Caxton Description: Undercounter,VitreousChina,unglazec Dimension: 19" x 15" Color/Finish: Almond Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary cornponents for installation Picture is repre sentational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G . I NTE RI ORS Af-| #r S,[, I,,,0,*,'o*YAt',,^)e4e-1o'o Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 6 AIt Proiect [nformation Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Suoolier: Dahl of Avon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specilication Location: 315 M.t. Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Lavatory Product Number: K-221 I Caxton Description: Undercounter,VitreousChina,unglazed Dirnension: 19" x 15" -Color/Finish: Mexican Sand Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color mav varv ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I N TE RI ORS I I I I I T I I T I I I I I I t t SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@zehren.com I t -72 E H R E N (e7o)e4e-o2szvAlL(e7o)s4+1080 - AND ASSOCIATES vsir@zeh'encom I l I t I I I I t I I T I I t I I I I A RCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAx (80s)963-E 1 02 santabarbara€!2€hren.corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB -10 AIt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Dahl of Avon Ad&ess: 780 Nottingham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 9'70-845-9926 Specification Location:303D Bath, 304D Bath, 305D Bath, 305H Bath, 306D Bath, 403D Bath, 407D Bath, 409D Bath, 4l lD Bath, 4l5D Battl 417D Bath, 4l9D Bath, 503D Bath, 505D Bath, 509D Bath, 5l lD Bath, 607D Bath, 609D Bath, 61lD Bath, 6l3D Bath, 6l5D Bath Lavatorv- Hotel Roorns . K-2885-8U. Man's Lav Lavatorv Undercounler. Cast lron Lavatorv. 8" Centers ', Att - 1't n Alrnond Connnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: Color/Finish: Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS iaz E H R E N (e7o)e4e-0zs7vAlL(e7o)e4e.io8o - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zeh'cn.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB. 13 AIt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Prniect Nn' 2OO215O| OO Issue Dale: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:336D Bath(2) Manufachrer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: ColorlFinish: Waterworks Lavatory Faucet JULSl9. Julia Lavatorv Faucet with Cross Handles Per Manufacturer Nickel Connnents:Supplier to provide and order all necessary components for installation Picture is representational Color may vary A RCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G. I NTE RI ORS I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-81 02 sanlabarbara@zehren.com VAIL {970)949-0257 FAX (970)94+108O vail@zehr€n.com I I zr^5#,&,[,]'j I T I l I t I I t I I t I t I I I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN NI N G. I N TE RIORS SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (80s)9638 1 02 santabarbara@zqhren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB. 19 AIt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon. CO 81620 Contact: Arnanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-U5-9926 Specification Location: 2698 Powder, 302K WC,308K WC,336E WC, 404K WC Manufacturer: Kohler Product: Watercloset Product Number: K- 3466, San Raphael . Description: Elongated, One Piece Dimension: Per Manufach[er ColorlFinish: Almond Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary i7z E H R E N ,r,o,ro*o.rYAlteTo)s4e-108o -- AND ASSOCIATES vait@zehren.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 33 AIt Proiect Information Narne' Vail Mnrrnrain I ndoe Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Dahl ofAvon Address: 780 Noningham Road Avon, CO 81620 Contact: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 970-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 336D Bath Manufacnrer: Waterworks Product: Roman Tub Faucet Product Number: JUTUOS & JUTU07, Julia Description: Exposed Tub Filler with Handshower and Cross Handles Deck Union Dimension: Per Manufactuer Colorffinish: Nickel Comments: Supplier to provide and order all necessary conponents for installation Picture is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I N T E R I O R S I I I I t l I I T t T I t I I I I SANTA BARBARA (80s)963-689O FAX (80s)963-81 02 sa ntabarba ra@z€hren-c!m VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 08O vail@zehrsn.com I I Z1"oE ^3,&,E^,fl I I I l I I I I t T t I I I I t I I I A RCHITECTURE . P LAN N I N G SANTABARBARA (805)963$890 FAX (8O5)9€$8102 santabarbara@zehr6n-com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949O257 FAX (970)949.1 08O vail@zehren-com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet PLMB - 39 AIt Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: ProjectNo: 20021501.00 tssue lrate: Available Through Supplier: Dahl of Avon Address: 780 Nottingham Road Avon CO Rl67O Contacl: Amanda Bouchard Phone: 910-949-9101 Fax: 970-845-9926 Specification Location: 336D Bath Manufacturer: Waterworks Product: Shower Faucet Product Number, Description: Concealed Shower System . Dirrension: Per Manufacturer Colorffinish: Satin Nickel Connnents: Supplier to provide and order all necessary corrponents for installation ETSH 85 Picture is representational Color may vary ruSV 34 L i I i I zlr"oE ^3,s,1,N Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-g AIt Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Proiect No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A-"rd. B"r.htd 970-949-9101 970-845-9926 Specification Location:302K WC, 302J Bath,302L Powder, 308K WC, 308J Bath, 308L Powder, 404K WC,404J Bath,404L Powder Manufachrer: Newport Brass Product: Robe Hook ProductNumber: 10- 12' Description: 800 Serics Robe Hook Dimension: Per Manufacturer Color/Finish: Satin Nickel Connnents: All materials must be contact quality Supplier to veri0 that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mouting heig'hts Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is representational Color mav varv A RCHITECTURE . PLAN NI NG. I N TE RI ORS I I I I I I I I T I T I I I t I I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (80s)963-8102 santabarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)9490257 FAX (970)949.1O80 vail@zehren.com T I zr"5#,&,E^,N I I I l I I t I T T I I I I I I I I I ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (805)963-81 02 saniabarbafa@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC.IO AIt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado Projecr No: 2002 l50 I ^00 lssue uale: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A."rd" 8"."h-d 970-949-910r 9'10-845-9926 Specification Location:302K WC, 302J Bath, 302L Powder, 308K WC, 308J Bath, 308L Powder, 404K WC,404J Bath.404L Powder ^"*""" *a* Towel Rine to- oq ROO Spriec Tnrwel Rino Per Manufacturer Satin Nickel Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: Color/Finish: Comments:All materials and consuuction must conply with applicable fire and safeg codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veriff that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blockins for weieht reouirements Pichre is representational Color may vary L7r"5#,&,1,1: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC-I1 AIt !4ject Information Name: Location: Project No: Issue Date: Vail Mountain Lodse Vail, Colorado 20021501.00 Available Through Supplier: Address: Conlact: Phone: Fax: Dahl ofAvon A.r"d. B"..h*d 9'70-949-9101 9't0-845-9926 Spegification Location:302K WC, 302J Bath, 302L Powder, 308K WC, 308J Bath, 308L Powder, 404K WC, 404J Batll 404L Powder Newoort Brass Tissue Holder l0- 28 800 Series Tissue Holder Per Manufachuer Satin Nickel Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dinrension: Color/Finish: Conrments:All materials and construction nnrst cornply with applicable fue and safety codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to veri& that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Proui@nts Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G . I N TE RI ORS t I I I I T I I T I I I T I t I I SANTA BARBARA (805)953-6890 FAX (805)963-8102 sanlabarbara@zehren.com I I jjlz EHREN .^_^.. vArL -- AN D Assoc rnr i i (e70)e4e-0257zFAx(e70)e4e-108o I t I l I I I t I T l I I I I I I A RCHITECTUREI I SANTA BARBARA (805)953€890 FAX (805)963.81 02 sar{abarbara@zehren.com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet ACC- I2 AIt Project Information Name: Vail Mor.rntain Lodge Lncalion Vail Cnlnredn Projecl No: 20021501 .00 lssue uate: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Dahl of Avon A-""d" B.".h.d 970-949-9t01 970-845-9926 Specification Location:302K WC, 302J Bath, 302L Powder, 308K WC, 308J Bath, 308L Powder, 404K WC, 404J Bath, 404L Powder Newporl Brass Towel Bar l0-02 800 Series- 24" Towel Bar Per Manufacturer Satin Nickel Manufacturer: Product: Product Number: Description: Dimension: Color/Finish: Comments:All materials and construction must cornply with applicable fue and safeg codes All materials must be contract quality Supplier to verif that all necessary parts for installation are ordered Refer to Detail Manual for locations and mounting heights Provide blocking for weight requirements Picture is repre sentational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS j7Z E H R E N ,n,o,non-oruYfll,e7o)e4e-1080 -- AND ASSOCIATES vair@zehrenrom Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 1 AIt troject Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: Vail, Colorado PrqiectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: JeIf Mikelson 970-9265927 970479-'1976 Specilication Location: 315 Men's. 317 Women's Material: Granite Manufacturer: Dal-stone Product Number: N/A Name/Color Goldan Leaf Finisb Dimensions: Slab at countertops Edge Detail: I l/4", Bullnose Edge Grout TBD Comments: Finish all exposed edges. All stone is to be sealed per rmnufacturer requirernents. Refcr to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattcrn and placerrcnt. Picture is representational Color may vary I I I I I I I t I I T I T I 3 t I ARCHITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (8Os)963689O FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@zeh.en.conl T I E.PLANNING.INTERIORS Zf"oE n!, S,i, N'""*';:'al*:(*)s4slooo I I I I I I I T I I T I I I I t I I I A RCEITECTURE SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (E05)96181 02 sartabarbara@zehran.cofit Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 3 AIt Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodse Location: Vail. Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location:303C Bedroonl 303D Balh 305G Living, 305D Bath, 305H Bath" 304A Hall, 304D Baltu 306A Hall, 306D Bath, 403C Bedrooq 403D Bath,407A Hall,407D Balh,409A Hall, 409D Bath, 4l lA Hall, 4l lD Bath" 4l5A Hall, 4l5D Bath,4l7A Hall,4l7D Bath, 4l9A Hall, 4l9D Batb" 5034' Hall, 503D Bath, 505A Hall, 505D Bath, 509A Hall, 509D Balb 5l lA Hall, 51lD Batlq 607A Hall,607D Badu 609A Hall,609D Bath, 61lA Hall, 6llD Bath,613,4. Hall, 6l3D Batll 615A Hall,6l5D Battr Granite Alpha Granite & Marble N/A Golden Green Slab at countertops and tub deck I l/4", Bullnose Edge TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural product, tlrerefore zubject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per manufactuer requfuements. Refer to Floor Plan and Detar Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Name/C.olor Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Corrrnents: Picture is representational Color may vary E.PLANNING.INTERIORS 7-22 E H R E_N ,rro,*r.oruY$tr,e7o)s4e-1080 - AND ASSOCIATES vair@zeh'en.com' Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.7 AIt Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Laura Giese 303-574-2990 303-574-t391 Specifiqatio4 Location:336D Master Material: Marble Manufacturer: Santa Fc Collection ProductNumber: NiA Name/Color Santiago Finish Polislrcd Dimensions: Slab at countertop and tub deck Edge Detail: I l/4' , Bullnose Edge Grout: TBD Corffnents: Finish all exposed edges. All stone is to be sealed per rnanufacturer requirerpents. Refcr to Floot Plan aod Detail Manual for tile pattern and placernent. Picture is reptesentational Color mav varv I t t I I I I t I I I I I ,l I T I ARCIIITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)9634890 FAX (8Os)96$8 1 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAIL (970)94$o2s7 FAX (970)949.1 08O vail@zehre.r.co.n I I zr"5#,&,F,f: I I I I I I I I T I I I I I I I I t I A RCHITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I SANTA BARBARA (805)963€890 FAX (805)963-81 02 santabarbara@zehren. corn NTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-'1 08O vail@z€h.en.corn Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN.9 AIt Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodee Location: Vail. Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Dale: Arailable Through Supplier: Ad&ess: Contact: Phone: Fax: Jelf Mikelson 970-926-s927 970479-7976 Specilication Location: 1498 Bath Material: Limestone Manufacturer: Dal-stone Product Number: N/A Name/Color Jerusalem Beiee fu!5' Dimensions: SIab at countertop Edge Detail: Grout: TBD Comments: Finish all exposed edges. All stone is to be sealed per manufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile oaftern and olacement. t.7 Picture is representational Color may vary zr"5#,s,i,fl Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet sTN- 10 Alt Project Infqrlnation Name: Location: Prqject No: Issue Date: Vail Mounlain Lodge Vail, Colorado 20021501.00 d,vailable Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Ieff Mikelson 97U92G5927 97U479-7976 Specification Location:l49E Bath Material: Marble Manufacturer: Dal-stone Product Number: N/A NamdColor Rosa Gerona Finish Polished Dimensions: Slab at countertop Edge Derail: I l/4", Bullnose Edge Grout: TBD Cormnents: Finish all exposed edges. All stone is to be sealed per manufacturer requirenrents. Refcr to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and placement. Pichue is representational Color nray vary I T I T I t I I I I I I I I ! t t ARCHITECTURE . PLANN IN G . I SANTA BARBARA (8O5)963-6890 FAX (8O5)96181(}2 santabarbara@zehren.com NTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 080 vall@zehran-clm T I L2r"oE#,&,1,1: I I I I I I I I t T I I l I T I I T T SANTA BARBARA (80s)963489O FAX (805)96+81 02 sanltbarbara@zehren.com VAIL (970)949.0257 FAX (970)9491 O8O vail@zehren-co.n T,ehren & Associates Specification Sheet sTN- 11 Alt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail. Colorado ProjectNo: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throuqh Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: JeffMikelson 970-92G5927 970479-7976 ipecilication Location:3028 Kitchen, 3088 Kitchcn, 4048 Kitchen Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Nanp/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Cornnrents: Granite Dal-stone N/A Giallo VenEziana Polisbed Slab at countertop I l/4'. Bullnose Edee - TBD Finish all exposed edges. All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All slone is to bc sealed per rnanufasftuer requirements. Refer to Floor Plan ard Deteil Matrual for tile pattern and placement. Pichue is representational Color may vary A RCHITECTURE . P L A N N I N G. I N T E R I O R S Af-oEo3,S,F,l: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 12 AIt Project Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: WendvUtkke 970.260.0985 30344G0781 Specification Location: 3023 Bath, 302I Bath, 3085 Bath, 308J Bath, 4045 Batb,404I Bath Malerial: Limestone Manufacturer: DesigrrMaterials,Inc. Product Number: N/A Name/Color Jerusalem Bone Finish Honed Dimensions: Sl"b "t Co*t"ttopr -d tub d*k Edge Detail: t l/tr, Butt"ose Edgt Grout: TBD Comments: All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and All stone is to be sealed pcr rmnufachter requirements. Refer to Floor Plan and Detail Manual for tile pattern and olacement. ..:. .- "- ::^ Picture is representational Color may vary I t t I I I I T I I I T I I I I t ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N I N G SANTA BARBARA (805)963-6890 FAX (8Os)96981 02 santabarbara@zehren.com INTERIORS VAlL (970)94S0257 FA)( (970)949-1 O8O val@zghrBn.com I IL7r"5#,S,l,l: t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I SANTA BARBARA (E05)963-6690 FAX (8os)963-81(r2 santaba Dara@zehr6n.corn VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)9491060 vail@zah.en.cgm Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet STN- 15 AIt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mormtain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021501.00 Issue Date: Available Throush Supplier: Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: 302P Balh.308P Bath 404P Bath Material: Marble ManufacNrer: Product Number: N/A Name/Color Rojo Alicante Finish Polished Dimensions: Slab at countertops Edge Detail: Grout TBD Comments: Fl"tth "lt *p*"d "dg*All stone is a natural product, therefore zubject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone is to be sealed per manufactrucr requirerrcnts. Refer to Floor Ptan and Detail Manual for tile pattem and placement. Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G. IN TE RI O R S zr"oE o3,s,l,l: Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet wD-lAlt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge I nnefinn' Vail Cnlnredn Proiect No: 20021502.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: By Contractor Address: Contact: Phone: Fax: Specification Location: Material: Manufachrrer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Corrnents: 269A Closet, 269C Kitchen, 269D Closet, 269E Dining/Living, 269G Stair, 3028 Kitchen, 302C Dining Roorq 302D Family Rooru 3088 Kitchen, 308C Dining Roonl 308D Family Roorq 4048 Kitchen, 404C Dining Roor& 404D Family Room Wood Flooring Master Crafted Specialty Woods N/A Hickory Knottv Brown Random 4", 5", 6" Widths Random 3'-0" min- 8'-0" max lengths N/A N/A Finish all exposed edges All stone is a nahral product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All stone to be sealed per manufacturer requirements, Refer to Floor Finish Plans for tit. p"tt* Picture is representational Color may vary ARCHITECTURE . PLAN N IN G. I N TE RI O RS SANTA BARBARA (805)9636890 FAX (805)963-8I 02 santabarbara@zehten.com VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1O80 vail@zehlcn.com I I I T I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I L=f*oE o3r$,E^rl! I I I t I t I I I I I I I I I T t I I A RCHITECTURE . PLA N N I N G SANTA BARBARA (E05)963-6890 FAX (E0s)963€1 02 santabarbara@zehran. corn INTERIORS VAIL (970)949-0257 FAX (970)949-1 080 vail@zehren-com Zehren & Associates Specification Sheet wD-lAlt Proiect Information Name: Vail Mountain Lodge Location: Vail, Colorado Project No: 20021502.00 Issue Date: Available Through Supplier: By Contractor Ad&ess: uontact: Phone: litx: Specification Location: Material: Manufacturer: Product Number: Name/Color Finish Dimensions: Edge Detail: Grout: Comments: 269A Closet, 269C Kitchen, 269D Closet, 269E Dining/Living,269G Stair, 3028 Kitchen, 302C Dining Room, 302D Family Roorq 3088 Kitchen, 308C Dining Roorg 308D Family Roorq 4048 Kitchen, 404C Dining Roonl 404D Family Room Wood Floorine Master Crafled Soecialtv Woods N/A FIerd Marnle Knottv Brown Random4",5",6" Widtts - Random 3'-0" min- 8!0" max lengths N/A Finiqh all ernnced pdoec All stone is a natural product, therefore subject to variation in color, shading and veining. All slone to be sealed per rnanufacturer requirements. Refer to Floor Finish Plans for tile oattem. Pichre is representational Color may vary Lar"s#,*,E^,1: 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2U2004 l. lnclude a statement outlining reasons for the change and the effect of the change on the Work. Provide a complete description of the proposed change. hrdicate the effect of the proposed change on the Contract Sum and the Conhact Time. 2. lnclude a list of quantities of products required or eliminated and unit costs, with total amount of purchases and credits to be made. If requested, fumish survey data to substantiate quantities. 3. lndicate applicable taxes, delivery charges, equipment rental, and amounts of trade discounts. 4. Include costs oflabor and supervision directly attributable to the change. 5. Include an updated Confractor's Construction Schedule that indicates the effect of the change, including, but not limited to, changes in activity duration, start and finish times, and activity relationship. Use available total float before requesting an extension of the Contact Time. 6. Comply with requirements in Division I Section nProduct Requirements" if the proposed change requires substitution ofone product or system for product or system specified. Proposal Request Form: Use AIA Document G709 for hoposal Requests. Sample copies are included at end of this Section. ALLOWANCES Allowance Adjushnent: To adjust allowance amouts, base each Change dder proposal on the difference between purchase amolmt and the allowance, multiplied by final measurement of work-in-place. If applicable, include reasonable allowances for cutting losses, tolerances, mixing wastes, normal product imperfections, and similar margins. l. Include installation costs in purchase amount only where indicated as part of the allowance. 2. If requested, prepare explanation and documentation to substantiate disnibution of overhead costs and other margins claimed. 3. Submit substantiation of a change in scope of work, if any, claimed in Change Orders related to unit-cost allowances. 4. Ovi.ner reserves the right to establish the quantity of work-in-place by independent quantity survey, measure, or count. Submit claims for increased costs because of a change in scope or nafure of the allowance describ€d in the Contract Documents, whether for the Purchase Order amount or Contactor's handling, labor, installation, overhead, and profit. Submit claims within 14 days of receipt of the Change Order or Construction Change Directive authorizing work to proceed. Owner will reject claims submitted later than 14 days after such authorization. l. Do not include Contractor's or subcontactot's indirect expense in the Change Order cost amount unless it is clearly shown that the nature or extent of work has changed from what could have been foreseen from information in the Contact Documents.2. No change to Conhactor's indirect expense is permitted for selection of higher- or lower- priced materials or systems of the same scope and nature as originally indicated. I t I t I t I I I I I I I I I t I t I C. 1.4 B. CONTRACT MODIFICATION PROCEDURES 01250 - 2 I 20021501.08 VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE 3/2112004 I 1.5 CHANGE ORDER PROCEDURES I A. On Owner's approval of a Proposal Request, Architect will issue a Change Order for signatures - of Owner and Contractor on AIA Document G70l form included at end of Part 3. 'lI I.6 CONSTRUCTION CHANGE DIRECTIVE I A. Construction Change Directive: Architect may issue a Construction Change Directive on t AIA Document G714. Construction Change Directive instructs Contactor to proceed with a change in the Work, for subsequant inclusion in a Change Order. I I l. Consfuction Change Directive contains a complete description of change in the Work It also designates method to be followed to determine change in the Contact Sum or the Contract Time. - B. Documentation: Maintain detailed records on a time and material basis of work required by the Construction Change Directive.II l. After completion of change, submit an itemized account and supporting data necessa4r to substantiate cost and time adjustments to the Contact. I PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) I' PART 3 - ExEctrTIoN (Not Used) T ENDOFSECTIONOI2sO I r I I I I I I I I coNTRACTM'DTFTcATIoN 'R..EDTJRES 0 t2s0 -3r I I t I I I I I I T I I I I I I I I I OWNER ARCHITECT CONSULTANT CONTRACTOR FIELD OTHER COMPLETION OR MODIFICATION. AUTHENTICATION OF THIS ELECTRONICALLY DMFTED AIA DOCUMENT MAY BE MADE 8Y USING AIA DOCIIMENT D.or. t]EDEEE ARCHITECT'5 PROJECT NO: CONTRACT DATTD: 'Ihe work shall be caried out Docurnents with-out change in Contracl Sum or Contract Timi. Proceeding with the Work in accordance with these inslructions indicates your acknowledgrnent lhat there will be no change in the Contract Su-m or Contracl Time. Description: Atkcbments: (8.r. intqt tisring ol doriy'wnts thot ',rp'pr, .tcsripJiorr.) ARCHITECT'S SUPPLEMENTAL I NSTRUCTIONS AIA DOCUMENT Gzto - ELECTRONIC FORMAT PROJECT: (Nanc, addrcss) OWNER: TO: (C-ontactot) CONTRACT FOR: ARCHITECT's SUPPLEME NTAL INSTRUCTION NO: ARCHITECT: ISSTIED BY: fuchitect IITECT'S SUPPLEMENTAT |NSTRUCI|ONS - 1992 EDITION - AIAO - WARNING: Unlicensed photocopying violates U.S. copyright laws and will,r,ufcl llre violator lo legal prosecution. This documenf was eleclronically produced with permissi6n of the AIA and cin 6-e reproduced in accordance with your license without violation until lhe date of expiration is'noted below. Uier Document: 1557 aii.aia - 3/8/2004. AIA License Number l ll5@7' which expires on 5/lv?(D4' Ebcrronic Format GTro - 1992 Contracl AdministrationS'r\IA G7O9 Work Changes Proposal Request Disfribuiion Iisl: Owner Architect Consuhanl Contraclor Field Other I I I PROJECT (Name and address): OWNER (Name and address): FROM ARCHITECT (Name and address): TO CONTRACTOR (Name and address): PROPOSAL REOUEST NUMBER: DAIE OF ISSUANCE: CONTMCT FOR: CONTRACT DATE: ARCHITECI'S PROJECT NUMBER: I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I DESCRIPTION (lnsert a wriften descrip?ion of the Work): ATIACHMENTS (List attached documents that support descript'ron): (Srgnatw€)(hin .d norE oNI tith) CAUTION: You should sign an original AIA Contracl Document. An original assures changes will not be obscured. Please.eubmil an itemized proporal lor <hanges in thi Conlratr sum and Gbntrxr Time for proposed modilications to fh€ Contract Documents described herein. wilhin ( ) days, the contrxlor must submit fhis proposal or notify the Archifecf, in wriling of the date on which proposal submission is anticipated. Unlicensed pholocopying violates U.5. copyrighf laws and will subject th€ violalor to legal prosecution. To report copyrighr vio6tions of atA Conlracf oocuments, e-mail The American Inslitute of Architects' legal counsel.. copyrightoala.org. This document was eleciroiically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced withouf violation unfil lhe date oflxpirarion-as noted below. User Documenl: 1557 proposal ?st.aia -- y8/2@4. AIA License Number lll5O07, which expires on 5/t3filoo4. Eledroni( Format G7O9 - 2ool I THIS IS NOT A CHANGE ORDTR, A.CONSIRUCTION CHANGE DIRECIIVE OR A DIRECTION IO PROCEED wlTH THE \A,oRK I T I t I t I I I I t I I I I I I I I DATE - ,.' PhotocoPying violales U.5. copyright laws and will subjecl the violafor to legal prosecution. To report copyright violations of AtA Contracl Documenls, e-mail The American Institute of Architects' legal counsel. copyright0aia.org. This documenl was electronically produced with permission of the AIA and can be reproduced withoul violation until the dare of erpiration ai noted below. User Document: 1557 lh;nge order.aia - - :v8l2@4' AIA License Number lll5ooT' which erpires on 5/13/2004' Ereclronic Formar GTor - 2ool ffi{ A T I 'ContractAdministration "g'fllA cTol change order PROJECT (Nane atl address): TO CONTRACTOR (llame and ddress): THE CONTRACT IS CHANGED A5 FOLLOWS: (rcltde, wlnre apy'icfle, any udisptted anau anributda/,e to previotdy executd Cotntruction Cfenge Ditxtives) The original (Contract Sum) (Guaranteed Maximum price) was f Thg net change by previously authorized Change Orders ., $ The (Contract Sum) (Guaranfeed Maximum Price) prior to this Change Order was $ The (Contract Sum) (Guaranteed Maximum price) will be (increased) (decreased) (unchanged) I by this Change Order in the amount of The new (Contracl Sum) (Guaranleed Maximum Price) including this Change Order will be $ 'Le contract Time will be (increased) (decreased) (unchangg)by ( ) dayi. . date of Substantial Completion as of the date of this Changg'Order therefore is IIOTE: Thk Change Order does rct irrclude charya in the Contrrct Sum, Contract linre or Guararted Maximum Price whichlnve been autlprizd by Corstruction Dirs.tive until the cost ad tine have been agred upon by Drlh the ow.Er ad Contrxtot, in which car;e a Change Oder is exrcvtd to supersde tle Corctruction Change Dhetive. NOT VALID UNTIT SIGNED 8Y THE ARCHITECT, CONTRACTOR AND OWNER. ARCHITECT (Frrm rume)CONTRACTOR (Fhm name)OWif ER (Fin mnrc) ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS 8Y ($gnatwe)BY (Signatwe)BY (Signature) (Typd nane)(typd rane) DATE (lyped nne) CAUTION: You should sign an original AIA Coniract Document. An original assures changes will not be obscured. Dislribution List: Owner Archilect Conlraclor Field Other CHANGE ORDER NUMBER: DATE: ARCHITECT'S PROJECI NUMBER: CONTRACT DATE: CONTRACT FOR: Contract Admin istrationS-;\IA G714 Construction Change Directive PROJECT (Alame and ddress): TO CONTRACIOR (llane atd dd r ess): Distribution List: Owner Archite(l Consultant Confractoa Field Other I t I I DIRECIIVE NUMBER: DATE: CONTRACT FOR: COIITRACI DATE: ARCHITECT'S PROJECT NUMBER: You are hereby direcfed to make the following change(s) in fhis Contract: (Desoibe biefly any proposd changes or list my attxirrd inf ornation in tlc alterntive) PROPOSED ADJUSTMENTSl. 'The proposed basis of adjusiment to the Contracl Sum or Guaranteed Maximum prile is:. Lump Sum (increase).(decrease) of $ . tJnil Price of $ per . As provided in Subparagraph 7.3.3 of AIA Document A2Ol-1997 . As follows: l 2. The ContractJime is proposed to (be adjusted) (remain unchanged). The proposed adjustment, if any, is (an increase of days) (a decrease of days). T I T I I I I I I II t I t I When signed by the Owner and Architect and received by the Contractor, this document becomes effective IMMEDIATELY as a Conrfr*tion Ghange Directive (CCD), and the Contractor shall proceed with the change(s) describel aborn. Conlractor signature indicalet agreement wilh the proposcd adjustments in Contracl Sum and Conlract Time set forth in this CCD. ffi ADDRESS BY (Sigmture) - ItyrytlEme) ARCH f TECT (Firm name) ADDRESS BY (ggnatwe) .-( | ype namel OWNER (Fhm rwrc) ADDRESS BY (sigrulwe) (lpdtu,nr,) DATE DATE DATE CAUTlOltl: You should siSn an otiginal AIA Conlract Documenl. An oriSinal assures <hanges will nof be obscured. -^t Unlicensed photocoPying violaies U.5. copyriSht laws and will subject fhe violator to legal prose(ution. To report <opyrirht vio-lations of nlA Confract Documenls, e-mail lh€ American lnstilule of Archite(fs' legal counsel. copyrightoaia.org. This document was eletiro-nically produced withpermission of the AtA and can be reproduced wilhoul violation until the dare oi expkarioi as noted below. User Documenti 1557 change directive.aia - ly8/2OO4. AIA License Numb€r lll5007, which expires on tl3f20O4. Electroni€ Format G7l4 - 20Ol I I I I ql :r"K#il:,, V Technology SUBSTITUTION REQUEST _ (After the Bidding Phase) Project:Substitution Request Number: From: I Re: A,/E Project Number: Contract For: T I Specification Title:Descriplion: Page:Article/Paragraph: Proposed Substitution: I H:l';: Installer: Address:Phone: Model No.: t T History: I Newproduct f] 2-5 yearsold !S-tOysold D More than t0 years otd Differences between proposod substitution and specilied product: I E Point-by-point comparative dara atrached - REQUIRED By A/E Reason for not providing specified item: T I I I Similar Installation: Projecl: Address: Architect: Owner: Date lnstalled; Proposed substitution aflects other parts of Work: fl No f] yes; explain I ":::::.,T::::::::::::::: ($ Proposed substitution changes Contracr Time: E No fl Ves [e00] [Deduct]days. I t Supporting Data Attached: fl Drawings ! Producr Dala I Sanples D Tests f] Reporrs D Copynght 1996, Constuction Sp€cificalion Institut€, Pagc of Seplember 1996 r 60l Madison StIc€1, Alexandria, VA 22314-1191 CSI Form l3.lA I SUBSTITUTION REQUEST (Continued) The Undersigned certifies: ' Proposed subslitution bas been fully investigated and determined to be equal or superior in all respects to specified product.o Same warranty will be fumished for proposed substitution as for specified product.o Same maintenance service and source ofreplacement parts, as applicable, is available.o Proposed substitution will have no adverse effect on other trades and will not affect or delay progress schedule. ' Cosl data as stated above is conplete. Claims for additional costs related to accepted substituiion which may subscquently becorne apparent are lo be waived.. Proposed substitution does not affect dirnensions and firnctional clearances. ' Payment will be made for changes to building design, including A/E design, detailing, and construclion costs caused by tbe substitution. I t I in the Work as substitution will be Submitted by: Signed by: Firm: Address: Telephone: Attachrn€nts: A/Es REVIEW ANDACTION ! Substitution approved - Make submittals in accordancc with Specification Section 01330. Ll Substitulion aPproved as noted - Make submitlals in accordance wilh Specification Section 0t330. Ll Substitution rqiected - Use specified nsrerials. l-l Substitution Request received too late - Use specified materials. Signed by: I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I Additional Corlrnents:I conbactor D Subconu-actor E Supplier I Manufacturer D ,c/B tr Copyighl I 996, Construction Specification lnstitute, 601 Madison Stre€t, Alexandria, VA 22314-1191 Scptcmber I 996 CSI lorm l3.lA Page of t t 20021501.08 VAILMOIJNTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 SECTION OI27O - UNIT PRICES I PART I -GENERAL I I.I SUMMARY I A. This Section includes administrative and procedural requirements for unit prices. I B. See Division I Section "Allowances" for procedures for using unit prices to adjust quantity I allowances. I r.2 DEFINTTIoNS! A. Unit price is an amount proposed by bidders, stated on the Bid ForrrL as a price per unit of I measurement for materials or seryices added to or deducted from the Contract Sum by t appropriate modification, if estimated quantities of Work required by the Contact Documents are increased or decreased. I I.3 PROCEDURES I A. Unit prices include all necessary material, plus cost for delivery, installation, insurance,! applicable taxes, overhead, and profit. I B. Measurement and Payment: Refer to individual Specification Sections for work that requires I establishment of unit prices. Methods of measwement and payment for unit prices are specified in those Sections. I C. Owner resewes the right to reject Contactor's measurernent of work-in-place that involves use of established unit prices and to have this work measured, at Owner's expense, by an I independent surveyor acce,ptable to Conhactor. I D. List ofUnit Prices: A list ofunit prices is included in Part 3. Specification Sections referenced r in the schedule contain requirements for materials described under each unit price. I PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I LIST OF UNIT PRICES I A. Unit Price No. I - Roof System Repair and Replacernent. 1. Description: Replacement and Repair of the Roof System including, but not limited to, I metal panels, sheet metal and flashing, sheathing, insulation, waterproofing membrane, to I t t uNrrPRIcEs 01270 - | 20021501.08 t I I I I I I T t t B. C. D. VAIL MOI.]NTIAN LODGE 3tzr/2004 tie into and match existing roof system according to Division 0 173 1 Section "Cutting and Patching", Division 07610 Section "Sheet Metal Roofing" and in Division 07210 Section "Building lnsulation"- 2. Unit of Measurement: Square Feet. Unit Price No. 2 - Fire Protection Sprinkler Heads: l. Description: hovide additional sprinkler heads as requested by Architect or Owner.2. Unit of Measurement: Each head. Unit Price No. 3 - Fire Protection Sprinkler Heads (concealed): 1. Description: Provide additional concealed sprinkler heads as requested by Architect or Owner. 2. Unit of Measurement: Each head. Unit Price No. 4: l. Description: Provide Unit Pricing on each size and type of siding door according to Division 08263 Section "SLIDING WOOD FRAITED GLASS DOORS.' Unit Price No. 5: l. Description: Provide Unit Pricing on a typical flush painted wood corridor door with trvo adhered wood panels to match existing wood doors to according to Dvision 0821 Section"FLUSH WOOD DOORS" and Division 06402 Section 'INTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK'.2. Unit of Measurement: A typical door. Unit Price No. 6: l. Description: Provide unit Pricing on each size and tlpe of wood door according to Division 08212 Section'STILE AND RAIL WOOD DOORS.'2. Unit of Measurement: Each Door. Unit Price No. 7: l. Description: hovide unit Pricing on each size and type of wood window according to Division 08550 Section "WOOD WINDOWS.' 2. Unit of Measurement: Each Window. Unit Price No. 8: l. Description: Provide unit Pricing on cement based underlayment according to Division 03542 Section "CEMENT BASED LTNDERLAYMENT'2. Unit of Measurement: Square Feet for 1.5 inch (average) thick layer. Unit Price No. 9: I' Description: Provide Unit Pricing on each fully mortised card lockset Division 0871I Section'HARDWARE.' F.I I t I T I I I I H. T]NIT PRICES 01270 -2 20021501.08 VAIL MOITNTIAN LODGE 3/21/2004 ' 2. Unit of Measurement: Eacb Lockset. I J. UnirPriceNo. lo:I l. Description: Provide Unit Pricing for Fill and Conrpaction of southern spa terrace area. l| 2. Unit of Measurement: Cubic Yard.a I ENDOFSECTIONOI2TO I I t I t I I I I I I I t T I I]MTPRICES 01270 -3 a. b. d. e. B. l.l 1.2 I I I I I I I I I t t I T I I It tI T I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3t2v2004 SECTION 01290. PAYMENT PROCEDURES PART I -GENERAL STJMMARY This Section specifies administrative and procedural requirernents necessary lo prepare and process Applications for Payment. SCHEDULE OF VALUES Coordination: Coordinate preparation of the Schedule of Values with preparation of Contractor's Constuction Schedule. l. Correlate line items in the Schedule of Values with other required adminisfative forms and schedules, including Application for Payment forms with Continuation Sheets Submittals Schedule and Contractor's Construction Schedule. 2. Submit the Schedule of Values to Architect at earliest possible date but no later than seven days before the date scheduled for submittal of initial Applications for Payment. Format and Contcnt: Use the Project Manual table of contents as a guide to establish line items for the Schedule of Values. Provide at least one line itern for each Specilication Section. I . Identification: Include the following Project identifrcation on the Schedule ofValues: Project name and location. Name of Architect. Architect's project number. Contactor's name and address. Date of submittal. 2. Submit draft of AIA Document G703 Continuation Sheets or approved equal. 3. Provide a breakdown of the Conbact Sum in enough detail to facilitate continued evaluation of Applications for Payment and progress reports. Coordinate with the Project Manual table of contents. Provide several line items for principal subcontract arnounts, where appropriate. 4. Round amounts to nearest whole dollar; total shall equal the Contract Sum. 5. Provide a separate line item in the Schedule of Values for each part of the Work where Applications for Payment may include materials or equipment purchased or fabricated and stored, but not yet installed. 6. Provide separate line items in the Schedule of Values for initial cost of materials, for each subsequent stage of completion, and for total installed value of that part of the Work. 7 . Allowances: Provide a separate line item in the Schedule of Values for each allowance. Show line-item value of unit-cost allowances, as a product ofthe unit cost, multiplied by measured quantity. Use information indicated in the Contact Documents to determjne quantities. PAYMENT PROCEDURES 01290 - I 2002150r .08 VAIL MOTJNTTAN LODGE 312v2004 Each item in the Schedule of values and Applications for Payment shall be complete. Include total cost and proportionate share ofgeneral overhead and profit for each item. a. Temporary facilities and other major cost items that are not direct cost of actual work-in-place may be shown either as separate line items in the Schedule of Values or distributed as general overhead expense, at Contractor's option. schedule updating: update and resubmit the schedule of Values before the next Applications for Payment when Change Orders or Construction Change Drectives result in a change in the Conkact Sum. APPLICATIONS FOR PAYMENT Each Application for Payment shall be consistent with previous applications and paymelts as certified by Architect and paid for by Owner. l. htitial Application for Payment, Application for Paynent at time of Substantial Completion; and final Application for Payment involve additional requirements. Payment Application Times: The date for each progress pa)rment is indicated in the Agreement between Owner and Contractor. The period of construction Work covered by each Application for Payment is the period indicated in the Ageanent Payment Application Times: hogress payments shall be submitted to Architect by the fifteenth of the month. The period covered by each Application for Payment is one month, ending on the last day of the month. Payment Application Forms: Use AIA Document G702 and AIA Documant G703 Continuation Sheets as form for Applications for Payment. Application Preparation: Complete every entry on form. Notarize and exccute by a person authorized to sigr legal documexts on behalf of Contractor. Architect will return incomplete applications without action. l. Entries shall match data on the Schedule of Values and Contractor's Constuction Schedule. Use updated schedules ifrevisions were made.2. Include amounts of Change Orders and Construction Change Directives issued before last day of construction period covered by application. Transmittal: Submit 3 signed and notarized original copies of each Application for Payment to Architect by a method ensuring receipt within 24 hours. One copy shall include waivers of lien and similar attachments if required. 1. Transmit each copy with a transmittal form listing attachments and recording appropriate information about application. Waivers of Mechanic's Lien: With each Application for Payment, submit waivers of mechanic's lien from every entity who is lawfully entitled to file a mechanic's lien arisins out of the Conhact and related to the Work covered by the payment. I I t I t I I T I t I I I I t t I T I 8. 9. 1.3 B. D. F. G. PAYMENT PROCEDURES 01290 -2 J. I t I t I I t 0 I I I t t t il T I I I 20021501.08 l. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/21/2004 l. Submit partial waivers on each item for amount requested in previous application, after deduction for retainage, on each item. 2. When an application shows completion of an item, submit final or full waivers. 3. Owner reserves the right to desigrate which entities involved in the Work must submit waivers. 4. Waiver Forms: Submit waivers of lien on forms, executed in a manner acceptable to Owner. Initial Application for Payment: Administrative actions and submittals that must precede or coincide with submittal of first Application for Payment include the following: List of subcontractors. Schedule ofValues. Contractor's Construction Schedule (preliminary if not final). Schedule of unit prices. Submittals Schedule (preliminary if not final), List of Contractor's staff assignments. List of Conhactor's principal consultants. Copies of building permits. Copies of authorizations and licenses from authorities having jurisdiction for perfonnance of the Work. Initial progress report. Report of preconstruction conference. Certificates of insurance and insurance policies. Application for Payment at Substantial Completion: After issuing the Certificate of Substantial Completion, submit an Application for Payment showing 100 percent cornpletion for portion of the Work claimed as substantially complete. L lnclude documentation supporting claim that the Work is substantially complete and a statement showing an accounting of changes to the Contract Sum.2. This application shall reflect Certificates of Partial Substantial Completion issued previously for Owner occupancy of designated portions of the Work. Final Payment Application: Submit final Application for Payment with releases and supporting documentation not previously submitted and accepted, including, but not limited, to the following: l. Evidence of completion ofProject closeout requirements.2. Insurance certificates for products and cornpleted operations where required and proof that taxes, fees, and similar obligations were paid. 3. Updated final statement, accounting for final changes to the Confract Sum.4. AIA Documentc706, "Contractor's Affidavit of Payment of Debts and Claims." 5. AIA Document G706A, "Contractor's Affidavit of Release of Liens."6. AIA Documenl G7O7 , "Consent of Surety to Final Payment." 7 . Evidence that claims have been settled.8. Final meter readings for utilities, a measured record of stored fuel, and similar data as of date of Substantial Cornpletion or when Owner took possession of and assumed responsibility for corresponding elements of tbe Work. 9. Final, liquidated damages settlement statement. PAYMENT PROCEDURES 01290 - 3 t t I I I I I Q I l t I I I t I I I I 312v20042002150r.08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART 3 - EXECUTION (Not Uscd) END OF SEC'TION OI29O VAIL MOI.JNTIAN IJODGE 0t2w-4PAYMENTPROCEDT]RES B. c. B. c. l.l 1.2 I I I .T I I I I I I i I 3 I I l I t I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOI.INTIAN LODCE SECTION OI3IO . PROJECT MANAGEMENT AND COORDINATION PART I - GENERAL 3t21/2004 SI]MMARY This Section includes administrative provisions for coordinating construction operations on Project including, but not limited to, the following: l. CoordinationDrawines. 2. Project meetings. See Division I Section "Summary of Multiple Contracts" for a description of the division of Work among separate contracts and responsibility for coordination activities not in this Section. See Division I Section "Execution Requirernents" for procedures for coordinating general installation and field-engineering services, including establishment of benchmarks and control points. COORDINATION Coordination: Coordinate construction operations included in different Sections of the Specifications to ensure efficient and orderly installation of each part of the Work. Coordinate construction operations, included in different Sections, that depend on each other for proper installation, c orurection, and operation. l. Schedule construction operations in sequence required to obtain the best results where installation of one part of the Work depends on installation of other components, before or after its own installation.2. Coordinate installation of different components with other contractors to ensure maximum accessibility for required maintenance, service, and repair. 3. Make adequate provisions to accommodate items scheduled for later installation. 4. Where availability of space is limited, coordinate installation of different components to ensure maximum performance and accessibility for required maintenance, service, and repair of all components, including mechanical and electrical. Prepare memoranda for distribution to each party involved, outlining special procedures required for coordination. Include such items as required notices, reports, and list of attendees at meetings. 1. Prepare similar memoranda for Owner and separate contractors if coordination of their Work is required. Adminishative Procedures: Coordinate scheduling and timing of required administrative procedures with other construction activities and activities of other contactors to avoid conflicts and to ensure orderly progress of the Work. Such administrative activities include, but are not limited to, the following: PROJECT MANAGEMENT AND COORDINATION 01310 - I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE Preparation of Contractor's Constuction Schedule. Preparation of the Schedule of Values. Installation and removal of temporary facilities and controls. Delivery and processing of submittals. Progress meetings. Preinstallation conferences. Project closeout activities. Startup and adjustment of systems. Project closeout activities. 3t21/2004 ST]BMITTALS Coordination Drawings: Prepare Coordination Drawings if limited space availability necessitates maximum utilization of space for efficient installation of different components or if coordination is required for installation ofproducts and materials fabricated by separate entities. l. Content: Project-specific information, drawn accurately to scale. Do not base Coordination Drawings on reproductions of the Contract Documents or standard printed data. Include the following information, as applicable: a. Indicate functional and spatial relationships of componelts of architectural, structural, civil, mechanical, and electrical systems.b. Indicate dimensions shown on the Contact Drawings and make specific note of dimensions that appear to be in conflict with submitted equipment and minimum clearance requirernents. Provide alternate sketches to Architect for resolution of such conflicts. Minor dimension changes and difficult installations will not be considered changes to the Contract. 2. Sheet Size: At least 8-ll2 by 1l inches (215 by 280 mm) but no larger than 30 by 40 inches (750 by 1000 mm). 3. Number of Copies: Submit two opaque cqics of each submittal. Architect will retum one copy. 4. Refer to individual Sections for Coordination Drawing requiremants for Work in those Sections. PROJECT MEETINGS General: Schedule and conduct meetings and conferences at hoject site, unless otherwise indicated. l. Attendees: Inform participants and others involved, and individuals whose presence is required, of date and time of each meeting. Notifu Owner and Architect of scheduled meeting dates and times. 2. Agenda: Prepare the meeting agenda. Distribute the agenda to all invited attendees.3. Minutes: Record significant discussions and agreements achieved. Distribute the meeting minutes to everyone concemed, including Owner and Architect, within three days of the meeting. I T I 0 I I I I T I i 1.3 I I I l I I T I 1.4 PROJECT MANAGEMENT AND COORDINATION 01310-2 a. b. c. d. e. f. o h. i. j. k. l. m. n. a, b. B. I I I I I I t U I t I I I t l J I i I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 Preconstruclion Conference: Schedule a preconstruction conference before starting construction, at a time convenient to Owner and Architect, but no later than 15 days after execution of the Agreement. Hold the conference at Project site or another convenient location. Conduct the meeting to review responsibilities and personnel assignments. l. Attendees: Authorized representatives of Owner, Architect, and their consultants; Contractor and its superintendent; major subconfactors; suppliers; and other concerned parties shall attend the conference. All participants at the conference shall be familiar with Project and authorized to conclude matters relating to the Work. 2. Agenda: Discuss items of significance that could affect progress, including the following: o. p. q. r. S. Tentative construction schedule. Phasing. Critical work sequencing and long-lead items. Designation of key personnel and their duties. Procedures for processing field decisions and Change Orders. Procedures for requests for interpretations (RFIs). Procedures for testing and inspecting. Procedures for processing Applications for Paymant. Dstribution of the Conhact Documents. Submittal procedures. Pieparation of Record Documents. Use of the premises and existing building. Work restrictions. Owner's occupancy requirernents. Responsibility for temporary facilities and controls. Construction waste management and recycling. Parking availability. Office, work, and storage areas. Equipment deliveries and priorities. t. First aid. u. Securify. v. Progress cleaning. w. Working hours. 3. Minutes: Record and distribute meeting minutes. heinstallation Conferences: Conduct a preinstallation conference at Project site before each construction activity that requires coordination with other construction. l. Attendees: Installer and representatives of manufachrers and fabricators involved in or affected by the installation and its coordination or integration with other materials and installations that have preceded or will follow, shall attend the meeting. Advise Architect of scheduled meeting dates. 2. Agenda: Review progress of other constuction activities and preparations for the particular activity under consideration, including requirements for the following: The Contract Documents. Options. Related requests for interpretations (RFIs). PROJECT MANAGEMENT AND COORDINATION 01310 - 3 2002150r.08 VAILMOT]NTI,AN LODGE Related Change Orders. Purchases. Deliveries. Submittals. Review of mockups. Possible conflicts. Compatibility problems. Time schedules. Weather limitations. Manufacturer's written recommendations. Warranty requirements. Compatibility of materials. Acceptability of substates. Temporary facilities and contols. Space and access limitations. Regulations of authorities having jurisdiction. Testing and inspecting requiremants. lnstallation prccedures. Coordination with other work. Required performance results. Protection of adjacent work. Protection of construction and personnel. 3t2y2004 I I T t I d. e. f. 0 h. i. j. k. l. m. n, o. p. q- r. t. u. w. x. v. 3. Record sigrificant conference discussions, agrcements, and disagreements, including required corrective measures and actions. 4. Reporting: Distribute minutes of the meeting to each party present and to parties who should have been present. 5. Do not proceed with installation if the conference cannot be successfully concluded. Initiate whatever actions are necessary lo resolve irnpediments to performance of the Work and reconvene the conference at earliest feasible date. D. Progtess Meetings: Conduct progress meetings at weekly intervals. Coordinate dates of meetings with preparation of payment requests. 1. Attendees: In addition to represantatives of Owner and Architect, each contractor, subcontractor, supplier, and other entity concerned with current progress or involved in planning, coordination, or performance of future activities shall be represented at these meetings. All participants at the conference shall be familiar with Project and authorized to conclude matters relating to the Work. 2. Agenda: Review and correct or approve minutes of previous progress meeting. Review other items of sigrificance that could affect progress. Include topics for discussion as appropriate to status of Project. a. Contractor's Construction Schedule: Review progress since the last meeting. Determine whether each activity is on time, ahead of schedule, or behind schedule, in relation to Conbactor's Construction Schedule. Determine how constuction behind schedule will be expedited; secure commitnents from parties involved to do so. Discuss whether schedule revisions are required to ensure that current and subsequent activities will be completed within the Conhact Time. I I tl I l I I I I f, I I t I 1) Review schedule for next period. PROJECT MANAGEMENT AND COORDINATION 01310 - 4 t 2oo2r5ol.o8 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE t b. Review present and future needs ofeach entity present, including the following: I l) Interface requirements. | 2) Sequence ofoperations.3) Status of submittals. I q Deliveries' tI 5) Off-site fabrication. 6) Access. 7) Site utilization. ,' 8) Temporary facilities and conhols. 9) Work hours. il l0) Hazards and risks. \l I l) Progress cleaning.u n) Quality and work standards. I [i irfr:i::ffi:i:: of dencientiterns a 15) Requests for interpretations (RFIs). 16) Status ofproposal requests. 17) Pending changes. t 18) Status ofChange Orders. 19) Panding claims and disputes. | 20) Documentation of information for payment requests. 3. Minutes: Record and distribute to Conhactor the meeting minutes. d 4. Reporting: Distribute minutes of tlre meeting to each party present and to parties who I shouldhavebeenpresenl. tr a. Schedule Updating: Revise Conhactor's Construction Schedule after each progressI lffi:TJ:ffJ:Hnili,ffi"l"i:hff.'":r#:ffr:'recognized Issue I I PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) I ll PART 3 - EXECUTION (NotUsed) L END OF SECTION O13IOl It -r_t ,t t 3/2r/2004 I I PRoJECT MANAGEMENTAND cooRDINATIoN 01310 - 5 T I I t I t I I I I I I I I l l 2002 1501 .08 VAILMOUNTIAN LODGE 3l2t/2004 SECTION 01320 - CONSTRUCTION PROGRESS DOCUMENTATION PART I -GENERAL I.I SUMMARY A. This Section includes administrative and procedural requirements for documenting the progress of consfuction during performance of the Wor\ including the following: l. Contractor'sConstructionSchedule. 2. SubmittalsSchedule. 3. Daily construction reports.4. Field condition reports. B. See Division I Section "Summary of Multiple Contracts" for preparing a combined Contractor's Constuction Schedule. See Division I Section "Payment hocedwes" for submittine the Schedule of Values. DEFINITIONS Activity: A discrete part of a project that can be identified for plarming, scheduling, monitoring, and controlling the construction project. Activities included in a construction schedule consnme time and resources. l. Critical activities are activities on the critical path. They must start and finish on the planned early start and finish times.2. Predecessor Activity: An activity that precedes another activity in the network.3. Successor Activity: An activity that follows another activity in the network. CPM: Critical path method, which is a method of planning and scheduling a construction project where activities are arranged based on activity relationships. Network calculations determine when activities can be performed and the critical path of Project. Critical Path: The longest connected chain of interdependent activities through the network schedule that establishes the minimum overall hoject duration and contains no float. Float: The measure of leeway in starting and completing an activity. 1. Float time is not for the exclusive use or benefit of either Owner or Conhactor, but is a jointly owned, expiring hoject resource available to both parties as needed to meet schedule milestones and Conhact cornpletion date. Fragnet: A partial or fragmentary network that breaks down activities into smaller acfivities for greater detail. Major Area: A story of construction, a separate building, or a similar sigrificant construction element. t.2 B. D. F.I I CONSTRUCTION PROGRESS DOCUMENTATION 01320 - I 20021501.08 VAIL MOIINTIAN LODGE 3t21t2004 SUBMITTALS Submittals Schedule: Submit three copies of schedule. Arrange the following information in a tabular format: l. Scheduled date for first submittal. 2. Specification Section number and title. 3. Submittal category (action or informational). 4. Name of subcontractor. 5. Description of the Work covered. 6. Scheduled date for Architect's final release or approval. Preliminary Network Diagram: Submit two opaque copies, large enough to show entire network for entire construction period. Show logic ties for activities. Contractor's Construction Schedule: Submit two opaque copies of initial schedule, large enough to show entire schedule for entire constuction perior,i. l. Submit an electonic copy of schedule, using software indicated, on CD-R, and labeled to comply with requirements for submittals. Include type of schedule (kritial or Updated) and date on label. CPM Reports: Concurrent with CPM schedule, submit three copies of each of the following computer-generated reports. Format for each activity in rcports shall contain activity number, activity description, cost and resource loading, original duration, remaining duration, early start date, early finish date, late start date, late finish date, and total float in caleadar days. l, Activity Report: List of all activities sorted by activity number and then early start date, or actual start date if known. 2. Logic Report: List of preceding and succeeding activities for all activities, sorted in ascending order by activity number and then early start date, or actual start date if known. 3. Total Float Report: List of all activities sorted in ascending ordcr oftotal float. Daily Constuction Reports: Submit two copies as requested by Architect or Owner. Field Condition Reports: Submit two copies at time of discovery of differing conditions. COORDINATION Coordinate preparation and processing of schedules and reports with performance of consfuction activities and with scheduling and reporting of separate conhactors. Coordinate Contractor's Construction Schedule with the Schedule of Values, list of subcontracts, Submittals Schedule, progress reports, payment requests, and other required schedules and reports. 1. Secure time commitments for performing critical elements of the Work from parties involved. 2, Coordinate each construction activity in the network with other activities and schedule them in proper sequence. I I1.3 c. D. I U I t I I I I I f I Il I ,l I E. F. 1.4 B. CONSTRUCTION PROGRESS DOCUMENTATION 01320 -2 B. 2.1 2.2 I T t I i t I I I t I I l I I l 20021501.08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOIINTTAN LODGE 3/2V2004 SI.JBMITTALS SCHEDULE Preparation: Submit a schedule of submittals, arranged in chronological order by dates required by construction schedule. lnclude time required for review, resubmittal, ordering, manufacturing, fabrication, and delivery when establishing dates. Coordinate Submittals Schedule with list of subcontracts. the Schedule of Values, and Conhactor's Construction Schedule. Submit concurrently with the first complete submittal of Contractor's Construction Schedule. CONTRACTOR'S CONSTRUCTION SCHEDULE, GENERAL Time Frame: Extend schedule from date established for commencement of the Work to date of Final Completion. l. Contact completion date shall not be changed by submission ofa schedule that shows an early completion date, unless specifically authorized by Change Order. Activities: Treat each story or separate area as a separate numbered activity for each principal element of the Work. Comply with the following: l. Activity Duration: Define activities so no activity is longer than 20 days, unless specifi cally allou'ed by Architect.2. Procurement Activities: Include procurement process activities for the following long lead iterns and major items, requiring a cycle of more than 60 days, as separate aciivities in schedule. hocurement cycle activities include, but are not limited to, submittals, approvals, purchasing, fabrication, and delivery. a. Casework and cabinetry. Submittal Review Time: Include review and resubmittal times indicated in Division I Section "Submittal Procedures" in schedule. Coordinate submittal review times in Contractor's Construction Schedule with Submittals Schedule. Starhrp and Testing Time: Include not less than 7 days for startup and testing. Substantial Cornpletion: Indicate completion in advance of date established for Substantial Completion, and allow time for Architect's administrative procedures necessary for certification of Substantial Completion. Constraints: Include constraints and work restrictions indicated in the Contact Documents and as follows in schedule, and show how the sequence of the Work is affected. Phasing: Arrange list of activities on schedule by phase. Work under More Than One Contract: Include a separate activity for each contract. Work by Owner: Include a separate activity for each portion of the Work performed by Owner. 4. Work Resbictions: Show the effect of the followine items on the schedule: l. 2. 3. 4. 5. 1. 2. J. I I CONSTRUCTION PROGRESS DOCUMENTATION 0r320 - 3 2002150r.08 t t I t N I I I I D. A. B. 2.3 VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE 3t2l/2004 a. Coordination with existing construction. b. Limitations of continued occupancies. c. Unintemrptible services. d. Use of premises restrictions. e. Seasonal variations. f. Environmental conbol. 5. Work Stages: Indicate important stages of consbuction for each major portion of the Work. Milestones: Include milestones indicated in the Contract Documents in schedule, including, but not limited to, the Notice to hoceed, Substantial Completion, and Final Completion. Contract Modifications: For each proposed contact modification and concurrent with its submission, prepare a time-impact analysis using fragrets to demonstrate the effect of the proposed change on the overall project schedule. CoNTRACTOR'S CONSTRUCTION SCI{EDLJLE (CpM SCHEDULE) General: Prepare network diagrams using AON (activity-on-node) format. Preliminary Network Diagram: Submit diagram within 14 dlys of date established for commencement of the Work. Outline sigrificant construction activities for the first 60 days of construction. Include skeleton diagram for the remainder of the Work and a cash requirement prediction based on indicated activities. CPM Schedule: Prepare Contractor's Constuction Schedule using a computerized time-scaled CPM network analysis diagram for the Work. l. Develop network diagram in sullicient time to submit CPM schedule so it can be accepted for use no later than 30 days after date established for commancement of the Work. ^. Failure to include any work item required for performance of this Contract shall not excuse Contractor from completing all work within applicable completion dates, regardless of Architect's approval of the schedule. 2. Establish procedures for monitoring and updating CPM schedule and for reporting progress. Coordinate procedures with progress meeting and payment request dates.3. (Jse "one workday" as the unit of time. Include list of nonworking days and holidays incorporated into the schedule. CPM Schedule Preparation: hepare a list of all activities required to complete the Work. Using the preliminary network diagram, prepare a skeleton network to identift probable critical paths. l. Activities: Indicate the estimated time duration, sequence requirements, and relationship of each activity in relation to other activities. Include estimated time frames for the following activities: C. I I I 'l I I tD. t ICONSTRUCTION PROGRESS DOCUMENTATION 0t320 - 4 a. b. c. d. e. f. o h. i. E.' F. 2.4 I I T I I I I I t I I I I t T I I t t 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOLINTTAN LODGE 3/2II2OO4 Preparation and processing of submittals. Mobilization and demobilization. Purchase of materials. Delivery. Fabrication. Utility interruptions. Installation. Work by Owner that may affect or be affected by Conbactor's activities. Testing. 2. Critical Path Activities: Identifu critical path activities, including those for interim completion dates. Scheduled start and completion dates shall be consistent with Contract milestone dates. 3. Processing: hocess data to produce output data on a computerdrawn, time-scaled network. Revise data, reorganiz,e activity sequences, and reproduce as often as necessary to produce the CPM schedule within the limitations of the Contract Time' 4. Format: Mark the critical path. Locate the critical path near center of network; locate paths with most float near the edges. a. Subnetworks on separate sheets are permissible for activities clearly off the critical path. Initial Issue of Schedule: Prepare initial network diagram from a list of straight "early start-total float" sort. Identiff critical activities. Prepare tabulated reports showing the following: 1. Contractor or subcontractor and the Work or activity' 2. Descripfion of activity. 3. Principal events of activity. 4. Immediate preceding and succeeding activities. 5. Early and late start dates. 6. Early and late finish dates. 7. Activity duration in workdaYs. 8. Total float or slack time. 9. Average size ofworkforce. Schedule Updating: Concurrent with making revisions to schedule, prepare tabulated reports showing the following: l. Identification of activities that have changed' 2. Changes in early and late start dates. 3. Changes in early and late finish dates. 4. Changes in activity durations in workdays. 5. Changes in the critical path. 6. Changes in total float or slack time. 7 . Changes in the Contract Time. REPORTS Daily Construction Reports: Prepare a daily construction report recording the following information concerning events at Project site: CONSTRUCTION PROGRESS DOCUMENTATION 01320 - 5 3.1 2002r 501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3tzt/2004 l. List of subcontractors at Proj ect site. 2. Equipment at Project site. 3. Materialdeliveries. 4. High and low temperatures and general weather conditions. 5. Accidents. 6. Stoppages, delays, shortages, and losses. 7 . Meter readings and similar recordings. 8. Orders andrequests ofauthoritieshavingjurisdiction. 9. Services connected and disconnected. 10. Equipment or system tests and startups. B. Field Condition Reports: Immediately on discovery of a di{ference between field conditions and the Contract Documorts, prepare and submit a detailed report. Submit with a request for interpretation on CSI Form 13.2A. Include a detailed description of the differing conditions, together with recommendations for changing the Contract Documents. PART 3 - EXECUTION CONTRACTOR'S CONSTRUCTION SCHEDULE Contractor's Construction Schedule Updating: At monthly intervals, update schedule to reflect actual construction progrcss and activities. Issue schedule one week before each regularly scheduled progress meeting. L Revise schedule immediately after each meeting or other activity where revisions have been recognized or made. Issue updated schedule concurrently with the report of each such meeting. 2. Include a report with updated schedule that indicates every change, including, but not limited to, changes in logic, durations, actual starts and finishes, and activity durations. 3. As the Work progre$ses, indicate Actual Completion percentage for each activity. Dist'ibution: Distribute copies of approved schedule to Architect Owner, separate contractors, testing and inspecting agencies, and other parties identified by Conhactor with a need-to-know schedule responsibility. l. Post copies in Project meeting rooms and temporary field offices. 2. When revisions are made, distribute updated schedules to the same parties and post in the same locations. Delete parties from disfibution when they have completed their assigned portion of the Work and are no longer involved in performance of construction activities. END OF SECTIONOI32O I I 1 l I I I T T I I I I I I I t t I B. CONSTRUCTION PROGRESS DOCTJMENTATION 01320 - 6 l T t I I I I I I I I' i I I l I 1.2 I I t 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 SECTION OI33O - SUBMITTAI PROCEDURES PART I . GENERAL I.I ST]MMARY A. This Section includes administrative and procedural requirernents for submitting Shop Drawings, Product Data, Samples, and other submittals. B. See Division I Section "Construction Progress Documentation" for submitting schedules and reports, including Contactor's Consfuction Schedule. C. See Division 1 Section "Quality Requirements" for submitting test and inspection reports and for mockup requirements. D. See Division I Section "Closeout Procedtues" for submiuing warranties. E. See Division I Section "Project Record Documents" for submitting Record Drawings, Record Specifications, and Record Product Data. F. See Division I Section "Operation and Maintenance Data" for submitting operation and maintenance manuals. G. See DMsion I Section "Demonstration and Training" for submitting videotapes of demonstration of equipment and training of Owner's personnel. DEFIMTIONS Action Subrnittals: Written and graphic information that requires Architect's responsive action. Informational Submittals: Written information that does not require Architect's responsive action. Submittals may be rejected for not complying with requiremants' SUBMITTAL PROCEDURES Coordination: Coordinate preparation and processing of submittals with performance of construction actMties. L Coordinate each submittal with fabrication, purchasing, testing, delivery, other submittals, and related activities that require sequential activity. 2. Coordinate fansmittal of different types of submittals for related parts of the Work so processing will not be delayed because of need to review submittals concurrently for coordination. a. Architect reserves the right to withhold action on a submittal requiring coordination with other submittals until related submittals are received. A. B. t.3 SUBMITTAL PROCEDURES 01330 - I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 Submittals Schedule: Comply with requirements in Division I Section "Construction hogress Documentation" for list of submittals and time requirements for scheduled performance of related construction activities. Processing Time: Allow enough time for submittal review, including time for resubmittals, as follows. Time for review shall commence on Architect's receipt of submittal. No extension of the Contract Time will be authorized because of failure to transmit submittals enough in advance of the Work to permit processing, including resubmittals. 1. Initial Review: Allow 15 days for initial review of each submittal. Allow additional time if coordination with subsequent submittals is required. Architect will advise Contractor when a submittal being processed must be delayed for coordination.2. Intermediate Review: If intermediate submittal is necessary, process it in same rnanner as initial subrnittal. 3. Resubmittal Review: Allow 15 days for review of each resubmittal. Identification: Place a permanent label or title block on each submittal for identification. l. Indicate name of firm or entity that prepared each submittal on label or title block.2. Provide a spac€ approximately 6 by 8 inches (150 by 200 mm) on label or beside title block to record Contractor's review and approval markings and action taken by Architect.3. Include the following information on label for processing and recording action taken: Project name. Date. Name and address of Architect. Name and address of Conhactor. Name and ad&ess of subcontractor. Name and address of supplier. Name of manufacfurer. Submittal number or other unique identifier, including revision identifier. l) Submittal number shall use Specification Section number followed by a decimal point and then a sequential number (e.g., 06100.01). Resubmittals shall include an alphabetic suffix after another decimal point (e.g., 06100.01.A). i. Number and title of appropriate Specification Section.j. Drawing number and detail references, as appropriate.k. Location(s) where product is to be installed, as appropriate.l. Other necessary identification. Deviations: Highlight, encircle, or othenvise specifically identi$ deviations fiom the Contact Documents on submittals. Additional Copies: Unless additional copies are required for final zubmittal, and tmless Architect observes noncompliance with provisions in the Contract Documents, initial submittal may serYe as final submittal. I . Additional copies submitted for maintanance manuals will not be marked with action taken and will be returned. I I I I il I I ! I 1 t I I B. C. D. a. b. c. d. e. f. o h. I t I I I F. SUBMITTAL PROCEDIJRES 0t330 -2 G. J. A. B. 1.4 2.1 I I I I I t I I I I I I I t T T I T I 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE Transmittal: Package each submittal individually and appropriately for transmittal and handling. Transmit each submittal using a transmittal form. Architect will discard submittals received from sources other than Contractor. l. Transmittal Form: Use AIA Document G810. Resubmittals: Make resubmittals in same form and nurnber of copies as initial submittal. l. Note date and content of previous submittal. 2. Note date and content of revision in label or title block and clearly indicate extent of revision. 3. Resubmit submittals until they are marked "Reviewed" or "Reviewed as Noted." Distribution: Furnish copies of final submittals to manufacturers, subcontractors, suppliers, fabricators, installers, authorities having jurisdiction, and others as necessary for performance of construction activities. Show distribution on hansmittal forms. Use for Construction: Use only final submittals with mark indicating "Reviewed" or "Reviewed as Noted." taken bv Architect. CONTRASTOR'S USE OF ARCHITECT'S CAD FILES General: At Contractor's written request, copies of Architecfs CAD files will be provided to Contractor for Contractor's use in connection with Project, subject to the following conditions: l. Upon sigrratr:re of the enclosed draft agreement and payment of fees indicated. Each consultant may have differing agreement and/or fees and should be negoiaed directly by the Contractor or Subconfact with that consultant. PART 2 - PRODUCTS ACTION SUBMITTALS General: Prepare and submit Action Submittals required by individual Specification Sections. Product Data: Collect information into a single submittal for each element of constructjon and type of product or equipment. l. If information must be specially prepared for submittal because standard printed data are not suitable for use, submit as Shop Drawings, not as hoduct Data. 2. Mark each copy of each submittal to show which products and options are applicable. 3. Include the following information, as applicable: a. Manufactwer'swrittenrecommendations. b. Manufacturer'sproductspecifications. c. Manufacturer'sinstallationinstructions. d. Manufacturer's catalog cuts. e. Wiring diagrams showing factory-installed wiring. f. Printed performance curves. 312V2004 SI.]BMITTAL PROCEDURES 01330 - 3 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.]NTIAN LODGE C. Operational range diagrams. h. Compliance with specified referenced standards. i. Testing by recognized testing agency. 3tzt/2004 4. Number of Copies: Submit four copies of hoduct Data, unless otherwise indicated. Architect will return two copies. Mark up and retain one retumed copy as a Project Record Document. Shop Drawings: hepare Project-specific information, drawn accurately to scale. Do not base Shop Drawings on reproductions of the Contact Documents or standard printed data, unless submittal of Architect's CAD Drawings is otherwise permitted. I . Preparation: Fully illustrate requiranents in the Contact Documents. hrclude the following information, as applicable: a. Dimensions. b. Identificationofproducts. c. Fabrication and installation drawings. d. Roughing-in and setting diagrams. e. Wiring diagrams showing field-installed wiring, including power, signal, and contuol wiring. f. Shopworkmanufacturinginstructions. E. Templates and patterns. h. Schedules. i. Notation of coordination requirements.j. Notation of dimensions esablished by field measurement. k. Relationship to adjoining construction clearly indicated. l. Seal and signature of professional engineer if specified. m. Wiring Dagrams: Differentiate between manufacturer-installed and held-installed wiring. 2. Sheet Size: Exccpt for templates, pattems, and similar full-size drawings, submit Shop Drawings on sheets at least 8-1/2 by I I inches (215 by 280 mm) but no larger than 30 by 40 inches (750 by 1000 mm). 3. Number of Copies: Submit two opaque (bond) copies of each submittal. Architect will retum one cqPy. Sarnples: Submit Samples for reyiew of kind, color, pattern, and texture for a check of tbese characteristics with other elements and for a comparison of these characteristics between submittal and actual component as delivered and installed, I . Transmit Samples that contain multiple, related components such as accessories together in one submittal package. 2. Identification: Attach label on unexposed side of Samples that includes the following: a. Generic description of Sample. b. Product name and name of manufacturer. c. Sample source. d. Number and title ofappropriate Specification Section. I I T D. I I I t I t I 3 I I il I l I I ISI]BMITTAL PROCEDTJRES 01330 - 4 F. G. H. I t I T I I I I I I I t I I I 20021501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3. Disposition: Maintain sets of approved Samples at Project site, available for quality- control comparisons throughout the course of construction activity. Sample sets may be used to determine final acceptance of construction associated with each set. 4. Samples for Initial Selection: Submit manufacturer's color charts consisting of units or sections of units showing the full range of colors, textures, and pattems available. a. Number of Samples: Submit one full set of available choices where color, pattem, texture, or similar characteristics are required to be selected from manufacfurer's product line. Architect will return submittal with options selected. 5. Samples for Verification: Submit full-size units or Samples of size indicated, prepared from same rnaterial to be used for the Work, cured and finished in marmer specified, and physically identical with material or product proposed for use, and that show full range of color and texture variations expected. Samples include, but are not limited to, the following: partial sections of manufactured or fabricated components; small cuts or containers of materials; complete units of repetitively used materials; swatches showing color, texhre, and pattem; color range sets; and components used for independent testing and inspection. a. Number of Samples: Submit three sets of Samples. Architect will retain two . Sample sets; remainder will be retumed. Product' Schedule or List: As required in individual Specification Sections, prepare a written sumrnary indicating types of products required for the Work and their intended location. l. Number of Copies: Submit three copies of product schedule or lis! unless otherwise indicated. Architect will retum two copies. Submittals Schedule: Conrply with requirements specified in Division I Section "Construcfion Progress Documentation." Application for Payment: Comply with requirements specified in Division I Section "Payment hocedures." Schedule of Values: Comply with requirements specified in Division I Section "Payment Procedures. " Subcontract List: Prepare a written surnmary identifying individuals or firms proposed for each portion of the Work, including those who are to fumish products or equipment fabricated to a special desigrr. Use CSI Form 1.5A. Include tlre following information in tabular form: I . Number of Copies: Submit three copies of subcontactor list, unless otherwise indicated. Architect will return two copies. INFORMATIONAL SUBMITIALS General: Prepare and submit Informational Submittals required by other Specification Sections. L Number of Copies: Submit two copies of each submittal, unless otherwise indicated. Architect will not retum copies. 3t21/2004 2.2t I I I SUBMITTAL PROCEDURES 01330 - 5 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE 3/2r/2004 2. Certificates and Certifications: Provide a notarized statement that includes signature of entity responsible for preparing certification. Certificates and certifications shall be signed by an officer or other individual authorized to sigr documents on behalf of that entity. 3. Test and Inspection Reports: Cornply with requirements specified in Division I Section "Quality Requirements." Coordinafion Drawings; Comply with requirements specified in Dvision I Section "Project Management and Coordination. " Contactor's Construction Schedule: Comply with requirements specified in Division I Section "Construction Progress Documentation." Qualification Data: Prepare written information that demonstrates capabilities and experience of firm or person. Include lists of completed projects with project names and addresses, names and addresses of architects and owners, and other information specified. Welding Certificates: Prepare written certification that welding procedures and personnel comply with requirements in the Contract Documents. Submit record of Welding hocedure Specification (WPS) and Procedure Qualification Record (PQR) on AWS forms. Include names of frms and personnel cedified. Installer Certificates: Prepare written statements on manufacturer's lefterhead certiffing that Installer cornplies with requiremarts in the Contract Documents and, where required, is authorized by manufacturer for this specific Project. Manufacturer Certificates: Prepare written statements on manufactwer's letterhead certifoing that manufactwer complies with requirernents in the Contact Documents. Include evidence of manufachrring experience where required. Product Certificates: Prepare written statements on manufacturer's letterhead certiffing that product complies with requiremants in the Contact Documents. Material Certificates: hepare written statements on manufachrer's letterhead certiSing that material complies with requirements in the Contract Documents. Material Test Reports: Prepare reports wriftm by a qualified testing agency, on testing agency's standard form, indicating and interpreting test results of material for compliance with requiremarts in the Conhact Documents. hoduct Test Reports: Prepare written reports indicating current product produced by manufacturer complies with requirements in the Conhact Documents. Base reports on evaluation of tests performed by manufacturer and witnessed by a qualified testing agency, or on comprehensive tests performed by a qualified testing agency. ResearcMEvaluation Reports: Prepare written evidence, from a model code organization acceptable to authorities baving jurisdiction, that product complies with building code in elfect for Project. l t I I I I I I T I I t T t I I I t I B. C. D. F. G. H. J. SUBMITTAL PROCEDURES 01330 - 6 M. N. o. P. a. T. U. I I I T I I I I I I I I I I I I I l I 2002 l 501 .08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE Preconstruction Test Reports: Prepare reports written by a qualified testing agency, on testing agency's standard form, indicating and interpreting results of tests performed before installation of product, for compliance with performance requirements in the Contract Documents. Compatibility Test Reports: Prepare reports written by a qualified testing agency, on testing agency's standard form, indicating and interpreting results of compatibility tests performed before installation of product. krclude written recommendations for primers and subshate preparation needed for adhesion. Field Test Reports: Prepare reports written by a qualified testing agency, on testing agency's standard form, indicating and interpreting results of field tests performed either during installation of product or after product is installed in its final location, for compliance with requirements in the Contact Documents. Maintenance Data: Prepare written and graphic instructions and procedures for operation and normal maintenance of products and equipment. Comply with requirements specified in Division I Section "Operation and Maintenance Data." Design Data: Prepare written and graphic information, including, but not limited to, pei'formance and design criteria, list of applicable codes and regulations, and calculations. lnclude list of assumptions and other performance and design criteria and a summary of loads. Include load diagrams if applicable. Provide name and version of software, if any, used for calculations. Include page numbers. Manufacturer's Instructions: Prepare written or published information that documents manufacturer's recommendations, guidelines, and procedures for installing or operating a product or equipment. Include name of product and name, address, and telephone number of manufacturer. Manufacturer's Field Reports: Prepare written information documenting factory-authorized service representative's tests and inspections. Include the following, as applicable: 1. Statement on condition ofsubshates and their acceptability for installation ofproduct. 2. Summary of installation procedwes being followed, whether they comply with requirements and, ifnot, what corrective action was taken. 3. Results of operational and other tests and a statement of whether observed performance complies with requirements. Insurance Certificates and Bonds: Prepare wdtten information indicating current status of insurance or bonding coverage. Include name of entity covered by insurance or bond, limits of coverage, amounts of deductibles, if any, and term of the coverage. Material Safety Data Sheets (MSDSs): Submit information directly to Owner; do not submit to Architect. l. Architect will not review submittals that include MSDSs and will retum them for resubmittal. 3/2v2004 SUBMITTAL PROCEDTJRES 01330 - 7 2.3 20021501.08 VAIL MOTJNTTAN LODGE 3tzt/2004 DELEGATED DESIGN Performance and Design Criteria: Where professional design services or certifications by a design professional are specifically required ofContactor by the Contract Documents, provide products and systems compllng with specific performance and design criteria indicated. l. If criteria indicated are not sufficient to perform services or certification required, submit a written request for additional information to Architect. Delegated-Design submittal: In addition to shop Drawings, Product Data, and other required submittals, submit three copies of a statement, signed and sealed by the responsible design professional, for each product and system specifically assigned to Contactor to be designed or certified by a design professional. I . Indicate that products and syslems comply with performance and design criteria in the Contract Documents. Include list of codes, loads, and other factors used in performing these services. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I CONTRACTOR'SREVIEW A. Review each submittal and check for coordination with other Work of the Contract and for compliance with the Contract Documents. Note corrections and field dimensions. Mark with approval stamp before submitting to Architect. B. Approval Stamp: Stamp each submittal with a uniform, approval stamp. Include Project name and location, submittal number, Specification Section title and number, name of reviewer, date of Conhactor's approval, and statement certiffing tbat submittal has been reviewed, checked, and approved for compliance with the Contract Documents. ARCHITECT'S ACTION General: Architect will not review submittals that do not bear Contactor's approval stamp and will retum them without action. Action Submittals: Architect will review each submittal. make marks to indicate corrections or modifications required, and retum it. Architect will stamp each submittal with an action stamp and will mark stamp appropriately to indicate action taken, as follows: l. Reviewed. 2. Revise and Resubmit. 3. Furnish as Corrected. 4. Rejected. 5. Not Reviewed.> T I I I I I I I I t I I ! I l I I I I B. 3.2 B. SUBMITTAL PROCEDI.]RES 01330 - 8 I l I T I I I t I I I I I I T I I t I 20021501.08 VAIL MOIINTIAN LODGE 3/2U2004 C. krformational Submittals: Architect will review each submittal and will not retum it, or will retum it if it does not comply with requirements. Architect will forward each submittal to appropriate party. D. Partial submittals are not acceptable, will be considered nomesponsive, and will be retumed without review. E. Submittals not required by the Contract Documents may not be reviewed and may be discarded. END OF SECTION OI33O SI.]BMITTAL PROCEDI]RES 01330 - 9 #.AIA PROJECT Q,tame ard afiress)i TQ (Name a ddress): FROM ttanr"- ad eddress): WE TRANSMIT: vtA: FOR: THE FOLLOWING: Contract Adm i n istration GSlO Transmittal Letter [ ]Attached [ ] Overnight delivery [ ]Courier [ ] Approval/ Action [ ] Comment [ ] Drawings [ ] Under separate cover [ ] Mail []Fax [ ] Informaf ion [ ]Distribufion [ ] Specifications [ ] E-mail [ ]other [ ] Use as requested [ ] other [ ] Digiial Files I l I T I t I I I I t I I I I t I I I REMARKs: BY: COPIES TO: Phofo(oPyinS violates U.5. copyrighl laws and will subject the violator fo legal proseculion. To report copyright vi-irclations of AtA contracl Documents, e'mail The American Inslilute of Archilecfs' legal counsel. copyiightOaia.org. This documenf wai electronically produced withpermission of the AIA and can be reproduced without violatioi until the date oi eipiration ai noted below. User Document: 1557 transmittal.aia -- 'f2OO4. AIA License Number tll5@7, which expires on S^3|ZOO4. Electroni( Format GSIO - 20Ol ql :itr#il:it,, Y Technotory SUBMITTAL TRANSMITTAL P rojecl: A/E Proiect Number: TRANSMITT A AL To (Contractor):Submittal No. From (Subconnactor):! Resubmission Qty. Reference / Title /-Description / Spec. Section Title and Peragreph /Number MNnufacturcr Drewins Detail Referencc By: ! Submitted for review and approval E Resubmitted for review and approval I Complies with contract requirements E Will be available to meel construction schedule E A/E review time included in construction schedute Other rernarks on above submission: E Substitution involved - Substitution reouest attached ! If substirution involved, submission includes point-by-point comparative data or preliminary details ! Iterrc included in submission will be ordered inrnediatel y upon receipt ofapproval ' tr One copy retained by sender TRANSMITTAL B To 1lurg;' From (Conhactor): Attn: By:- Date RecU by Contractor: Date Tmsmtd by Contractor: I I I I I t I t T I I I I I I I I t ! Approved ! Approved as noted Other remarks on above submission: E Revise / Resubmit I Rejected / Resubmit I One copy retained by sendo TRANSMII"TAL C To (Conbactor): From (A/E):E ortto Attn: By:- Date Rec'd by A/E: Date Tmsmt'd by A,iE: Approved Approved as noted Not subject lo revievt No action required Revise / Resubmit Rejected / Resubmit I Approved as noted / Resubmit Other rernarks on above submission: ! Provide file copy with corrections idenrified ! Sepia copies only retumed E Point-by-point comparativc data required to complete approval process I Submission Incomplete / Resubmit I One copy retained by sender TRANSMITT D AL To (Subcontractor): From (Contractor):Byt Date Rec'd bv Contmctor: Date Tmsmt'd bv Contractor: Copies: fl Owner I Consultants tr- D- D_ D One copy retained by sendo Copyrieht I 996, ConsFuction Specilications lnstitute, 106 Madison Street, Alexandria, VA 22314-1791 September 1996 CSI Form l2.lA Pagc of I B. B. c. D. l.l t.2 t l I T t I I l I I I I I t I I I I I 20021 50t .08 VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE 3/2t/2004 SECTION 01400 - QUALTTY REQUIREMENTS PART I - GENERAL QUALITY REQUIREMENTS ST]MMARY This Section includes administafive and procedural requirernents for quality assurance and quality control. Testing and inspecting services are required to verifr compliance with requiremants specified or indicated. These services do not relieve Contractor of responsibility for compliance with the Contract Document requirements. l. Specified tests, inspections, and related actions do not limit Contractor's other quality- assurance and -control procedures that facilitate compliance with tbe Contract Document requirements. 2. Requirements for Contactor to provide quality-assurance and -control services required by Architect, Owner, or authorities having jurisdiction are not limited by provisions of this Section. See Divisions 2 through 16 Sections for specific test and inspection requirements. DEFINITIONS Quality-Assurance Services: Activities, actions, and procedures performed before and during execution of the Work to guard against defects and deficiencies and substantiate that proposed construction will comply witb requirements. Quality-Control Services: Tests, inspections, procedures, and related actions during and after execution of the Work to evaluate that actual products incorporated into the Work and completed construction comply with requirements. Services do not include contract enforcement activities performed by Architect. Mockups: Full-size, physical assemblies that are constructed on-site. Mockups are used to veriff selections made under sample submittals, to demonsfrate aesthetic effects and, where indicated, qualities of materials and execution, and to review constuction, coordination, testing, or operation; they are not Samples. Approved mockups establish the standard by which the Work will be judged. Preconsfuction Testing: Tests and inspections that are performed specifically for the hoject before products and materials are incorporated into the Work to verify performance or compliance with specified crjteria. Product Testing: Tests and inspections that are performed by an NRTL, an NVLAP, or a testing agency qualified lo conduct product testing and acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, to establish product performance and compliance with industry standards. 01400 - I 20021501.08 VA]L MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2t/2004 Source Quality-Conhol Testing: Tests and inspections that are performed at the source, i.e., plant, mill, factory, or shop. Field Quality-Control Testing: Tests and inspections that are performed on-site for installation of the Work and for completed Work. Testing Agency: An entity engaged to perform specific tests, inspections, or both. Testing laboratory shall mean the same as testing agency. Installer/Applicator/Erector: Contractor or another entity engaged by Contractor as an employee, Subconhactor, or Sub-subcontractor, to perform a particular construction operation, including installation, erection, application, and similar operations. l. Using a term such as "carpenty" does not imply that c€rtain constuction activities must be performed by accredited or unionized individuals of a corresponding generic name, such as "carpenter." It also does not imply that requiremerrts specified apply exclusively to hadespeople of the corresponding generic name. Experienced: when used with an entity, "experienced" means having successfully completed a minimum of five previous projects similar in size and scope to this hoject; being familiar with special requirements indicated; and having cornplied with requirernents of authorities having jurisdiction. CONFLICTING REQUIREMENTS General: If compliance with two or more standards is specified and the standards establish different or conflicting requirements for minimum quantities or quality levels, comply with the most stringent requirernent. Refer uncertainties and requirements that are different, but apparently equal, to Architect for a decision before p,roceeding. Minimum Quantity or Quality Levels: The quantity or quality level shown or specified shall be the minimum provided or performed. The actual installation may comply exactly with the minimum quantity or quality specified, or it may exceed the minimum within reasonable limits. To comply with these requirements, indicated numeric values are minimum or maximum, as appropriate, for the context of requirements. Refer uncertainties to Architect for a decision before proceeding. SUBMITTALS Qualification Data: For testing agencies specified in "Quality Assurance" Article to demonstrate their capabilities and experience. Include proof of qualifications in the form of a recent report on the inspection of the testing agency by a recognized authority. Reports: Prepare and submit certified written reports that include the following: I . Date of issue. 2. Project title and number. 3. Name, address, and telephone number oftesting agency.4. Dates and locations of samples and tests or inspections. T I I I l F. I I t I I I N l T t I I I I J. B. 1.3 1.4 QUALITY REQUIREMENTS 01440 - 2 B. C. D. F. G. I I I T T I I I I I I I I I I t I l I 2002150r.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 5. Names of individuals making tests and inspections. 6. Description of the Work and test and inspection method. 7. Identification ofproduct and Specification Section.8. Complete test or inspection data. 9. Test and inspection results and an interpretation oftest results. 10. Record of temperature and weather conditions at time of sample taking and testing and inspecting. 11. Comments or professional opinion on whether tested or inspected Work complies with the Contract Document requirements. 12. Name and signahre of laboratory inspector. 13. Recommendations on retesting and reinspecting. Permits, Licenses, and Certificates: For Owner's records, submit copies of permits, licenses, certifications, inspection reports, releases, jurisdictional settlements, notices, receipts for fee paym€nts, judgments, correspondence, records, and similar documents, established for compliance with standmds and regulations bearing on performance of the Work. QUAIITY ASSI.JRANCE General: Qualifications paragraphs in this Article establish the minimum qualification levels required; individual Specification Sections specif additional requirements. Installer Qualifications: A firm or individual experiorced in installing, erecting, or assembling work similar in material, desigr, and extent to that indicated for this Project, whose work has resulted in construction with a record of successful in-service performance. Manufacturer Qualifications: A firm experienced in manufacturing products or systems similar to those indicated for this Project and with a record of successful in-service performance, as well as sufficient production capacity to produce required units. Fabricator Qualifications: A firm experienced in producing products similar to those indicated for this Project and with a record of successful in-service performance, as well as sufficient production capacity to produce required units. Professional Engineer Qualifications: A professional engineer who is legally qualified to practice in jurisdiction where Project is located and who is experienced in providing engineering services of the kind indicated. Engineering services are defined as those performed for installations of the system, assembly, or product that are similar to those indicated for this Project in material, design, and extent. Specialists: Certain sections of the Specifications require that specific construction activities shall be performed by entities who are recognized experts in those operations. Specialists shall satisff qualification requirements indicated and shall be engaged for the activities indicated. l. Requirement for specialists shall not supersede building codes and regulations governing the Work. Testing Agency Qualifications: An NRTL, an NVLAP, or an independent agency with the experience and capability to conduct testing and inspecting indicated, as documented according 3t21/2004 QUALITYREQUIREMENTS 01400 - 3 2002150r.08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3/21t2004 to ASTM E 548; and with additional qualifications specified in individual Sections; and where required by authorities having jurisdiction, that is acceptable to authorities. l. NRTL: A nationally recognized testing laboratory according to 29 CFR 1910.7.2. NVLAP: A testing agency accredited according to NIST's National Voluntary Laboratory Accreditation Program. Factory-Authorized Service Representative Qualifications: An authorized represantative of manufacturer who is tained and approved by manufacturer to inspect installation of manufacturer's products that are similar in material, design, and extert to those indicated for this Project. Mockups: Before installing portions of the Work requiring mockups, build mockups for each form of construction and finish required to comply with the following requirements, using materials indicated for the cornpleted Work l. Build mockups in location and of size indicated or, if not indicated, as directed by Architect. 2. Notiff Architect seven days in advance of dat€s and times when mockups will be constructed. 3. Demonstrate the proposed range of aesthetic effects and workrnanship.4. Obtain Architect's approval of mockups before starting work, fabrication, or consfuction.5. Maintain mockups during construction in an undisturbed condition as a standard for judging the conpleted Work. 6. Demolish and remove mockups when directed, unless otherwise indicated. QUALITYCONTROL Owner Responsibilities: Where quality<ontrol services are indicated as Owner's responsibiligr, Owner will engage a qualified testing agency to perform these services. l. Owner will furnish Contractor with names, addresses, and telephone numbers of testing agencies engaged and a description oftypes oftesting and inspecting they are engaged to perform. 2. Costs for retesting and reinspecting consfuction that replaces or is necessitated by work that failed to comply with the Contact Documents will be charged to Contractor. Tests and inspections not explicitly assigned to Owner are Conhactor's responsibility. Unless otherwise indicated, provide quality+ontrol services specified and those required by authorities having jurisdiction. Perform quality-control services required of Contractor by authorities having jurisdiction, whether specified or not. l. Where services are indicated as Confactor's responsibility, engage a qualified testing agency to perform these quality-conhol seryices. a. Conhactor shall not employ same entity engaged by Owner, unless agreed to in writing by Owner. 2. Notif testing agencies at least 24 hours in advance of time when Work that requires testing or inspecting will be performed. I t I t l t t t T I I I I I I I I I I H. 1.6 B. QUALTTY REQUIREMENTS 01400 - 4 C. D. F. G. I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 312v2004 3. Where quality-conFol services are indicated as Contractor's responsibility, submit a certified wrinen report, in duplicate, of each quality-control service. 4. Testing and inspecting requested by Conhactor and not required by the Contract Documents are Contractor's responsibility.5. Submit additional copies of each written report directly to authorities having jurisdiction, when they so direct. Manufacturer's Field Services: Wlere indicated, engage a factory-authorized service representative to inspect field-assembled components and equipmant installation, including service connections. Report results in writing as specified in Dvision I Section " Submittal Procedures." Retesting/Reinspecting: Regardless of whether original tests or inspections were Contractor's responsibility, provide quality-conhol seryices, including retesting and reinspecting, for construction that replaced Work that failed to comply with the Contract Documents. Testing Agency Responsibilities: Cooperate with Architect and Contactor in performance of duties. Provide qualified personnel to perform required tests and inspections. 1. Notifi Architect and Contractor promptly of irregulmities or deficiencies observed in the Work during performance of its seryices.2. Determine the location from which test samples will be taken and in which in-situ tests are conducted. 3. Conduct and interpret tests and inspections and state in each report whether tested and inspected work complies with or deviates from requirements.4. Submit a cetified written report, in duplicate, of each test, inspection, and similar qual ity-control service through Contractor.5. Do not release, revoke, alter, or increase the Contract Document requirements or approve or accept any portion of the Work.6. Do not perform any duties of Conhactor. Associated Services: Cooperate with agencies performing required tests, inspectiorrs, and similar quality-control services, and provide reasonable auxiliary seryices as requested. Notiff agancy sufficiently in advance of operations to permit assignment of personnel. Provide the following: Access to the Work. Incidental labor and facilities necessary to facilitate tests and inspections. Adequate quantitie s of representative samples of materials that require testing and inspecting. Assist agency in obtaining samples. Facilities for storage and field curing of test samples. Delivery of samples to testing agencies. Preliminary design mix proposed for use for material mixes that require control by testing agency. Security and protection for samples and for testing and inspecting equipment at Project site. Coordination: Coordinate sequence of activities to accommodate required quality-assurance and -control services with a minimum of delay and to avoid necessity of removing and replacing construction to accommodate testing and inspecting. 1. 2. A 5. 6. QUALITY REQUIREMENTS 01400 - 5 20021501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTI,AN LODGE 3/2II2OO4 Schedule times for tests, inspections, obtaining samples, and similar activities.t. 1.7 SPECIAL TESTS AND INSPECTIONS A. Special Tests and Inspections: Conducted by a qualified testing agercy as required by authorities havingjurisdiction, as indicated in individual Specification Sections, and as follows: I . Verifoing that manufacturer maintains detailed fabrication and qualit5r-control procedures and reviewing the completeness and adequacy of those procedures to perform the Work.2. Notiffing Architect and Contractor promptly of irregularities and deficiencies observed in the Work during performance of its services. 3. Submitting a certified written report of each test, inspection, and similar quality-contol service to Architect with copy to Contractor and to authorities having jurisdiction. 4. Submitting a final report of special tests and inspections at Substantial Completion, which includes a list of unresolved deficiencies. 5. Interpreting tests and inspections and stating in each report whether tested and inspected work complies with or deviates from the Contact Documents. 6. Retesting and reinspecting corrected work. |ART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART3 -EXECUTION 3.I REPAIRANDPROTECTION A. General: On completion of testing, inspecting, sample taking, and similar services, repair damaged construction and restore substrates and finishes.l. Comply with the Contact Document requirements for Dvision I Section "Cutting and Patching." Protect construction exposed by or for quality-control service activities. Repair and protection are Contractor's responsibility, regardless of the assignment of responsibility for quality-conhol services. END OF SECTION OI4OO B. C. T I I T I t I I t I I I T I t I I I IQUALITYREQUIREMENTS01400 - 6 c. D. t.l I T I t t I I I 2002r 501.08 VAIL MOTINTTAN LODGE 3t21/2004 SECTION OI42O - REFERENCES PART I -GENERAL DEFIN]TIONS General: Basic Contract definitions are included in the Conditions of the Contact. "Approved": When used to convey Architect's action on Contractor's submittals, applications, and requests, napproved" is limited to Architect's duties and responsibilities as stated in the Conditions of the Contract. "Directed": A command or instruction by Architect. Other terms including "requested," "authorized," "selected," "approved," "required,n and "permitted" have the same meaning as "directed." "Indicated": Requirements expressed by graphic represantations or in written form on Drawings, in Specifications, and in other Contract Documents. Other terms including "shown," "noted," "scheduled," and "specified" have the same meaning as "indicated." "Regulations": Laws, ordinances, statutes, and lawful orders issued by authorities having jurisdiction, and rules, conventions, and agreements v/'ithin the construction industry that control performance of the Work. "Furnish": Supply and deliver to Project site, ready for unloading, unpacking, assembly, installation, and similar operations. "Install": Operations at Project site including rmloading, temporarily storing, unpacking, assembling, erecting, placing, anchoring, applyng, working to dimension, finishing, curing, protecting, cleaning, and similar operations. "Provide": Fumish and install, cornplete and ready for the intended use. "Project Site": Space available for performing construction activities. The extent of Project site is shown on Drawings and may or may not be identical with the description of the land on which Project is to be built, 1.2 INDUSTRYSTANDARDS A. Applicability of Standards: Unless the Conbact Documents include more stringent requirements, applicable consbuction industry standards have the same force and effect as if bound or copied directly into the Contract Documents to the extent referenced. Such standards are made a part of the Contract Documents by reference. B. Publication Dates: Comply with standards in effect as of date of the Contract Documents, unless otherwise indicated. A. B. T I I I I I I T F. G. H. I.I I I REFERENCES 01420 - | 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE 3121/2004 C. Copies of Standards: Each entity engaged in construction on hoject should be familiar with industry standards applicable to its conskuction activity. Copies ofapplicable standards are not bound with the Contract Documents. l. Where copies of standards are needed to perform a required construction activity, obtain copies directly from publication source. D. Abbreviations and Acronyms for Standards and Regulations: Where abbrreviations and acron)r'ms are used in Specifications or other Contract Documents, they shall mean the recognized name ofthe standards and regulations. I.3 ABBREVIATIONSANDACRONY-T,IS A. Industry Organizations: Wlrere abbreviations and acronyrns are used in Specifications or other Contact Documents, they shall mean the recognized name of the entities indicated in Gale Research's "Encyclopedia of Associations" or in Columbia Books' "National Trade & Frofessional Associations of the U.S." B. Industry Organizations: Where abbreviations and acronyms are used in Specifications or other Contract Documents, they shall mean thb recogrrized name of the entities in the following list. AA Aluminum Association, lnc. (The) AAADM American Association of Automatic Door Manufacturers AABC Associated Air Balance Council A'rqlVfA AmericanArchitecturalManufacturersAssociation AASHTO American Association of State Highway and Transportation Offi cials AATCC American Association ofTextile Chemists and Colorists (The) ABMA AmericanBearingManufacturersAssociation ACI American Concrete Institute/ACl Intemational ACPA American Concrete Pipe Association AEIC Association of Edison llluminating Companies, Inc. (The) AFPA American Forest & Paper Association (See AF&PA) AF&PA American Forest & Paper Association AGA American Gas Association AGC Associated General Contractors of America (The) T I I I I t l I I I I I I I I t I I IREFERENCES01420 -2 I 20021501.08 vArL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2U2004 T AHA American Hardboard Association Ir AHAM Association of Home Appliance Manufacturers I AI Asphalt Institutet ALA American Institute of Architects (The) I} AISC American Institute of Steel Construction I AISI American kon and Steel Institute -I AITC American Institute of Timber Construction I AICA Associated Landscape Contractors of America l, ALSC American Lumber Standard Committee, Incorporated r AMCA Air Movement and Contol Association Intemational. Inc. I ANSI American National Standards InstituteI AOSA Association of Official Seed Analysts f APA APA - The Engineered Wood Association t APA Architectural Precast Association a API American Petroleum Institute f ARI Air-Conditioning & Refrigeration Institute ' ARMA Asphalt Roofing Manufacturers Association t ASCA Architectural Spray Coaters Association I ASCE American Society of Civil Engineers ASHRAE American Society of Heating, Refrigerating and Air-Conditioning Engneers I ASME ASME krtemational I (The American Society of Mechanical Engineers Intemational)r ASSE American Society of Sanitary Engineering I ASrM ffi.-T:Tli"Ttilresting and Mareriars rnternationar) I AwcI AWCI lnternationalt I REFERENCEs ot42o-3I 20021501.08 AWCMA AWI AW?A AWS AW\MA BHMA BIA BIFMA VAIL MOT}NTIAN LODGE (Association of the Wall and Ceiling Indusfries Intemational) American Window Covering Manufacturers Association (See WCSC) Architechral Woodwork Institute American Wood-Preservers' Association American Welding Society American Water Works Association Builders Hardware ManufacturErs Association Brick Industry Association (The) BIFMA International (Business and Institutional Fumiture Manufacturefs Association Intemational) Carpet Cushion Council Center for Cold$ormed Steel Structues Copper Devel o'pment Association lnc. Canadian Elechicity Association Chemical Fabrics & Film Association. Inc. Compressed Gas Association Canadian General Standards Board Cellulose Insulation Manufacturers Association Ceilings & Interior Systems Construction Association Cast hon Soil Pipe Institute Chain Link Fence Manufacturers Institute Comrgated Polyethylene Pipe Association Carpet & Rug krstitute (The) Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute CSA International (Formerly: IAS - International Appro l Services) 3tzl/2004 t I I I I I l T I I I I I I I I I I I CCC CCFSS CDA CEA CFFA CGA CGSB CIMA CISCA CISPI CLFMI CPPA CRI CRSI CSA REFERENCES 0t420 - 4 a 20021s01.08 vArL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/21t2004 I acl Construction Specifications Institute (The)Ir CSSB Cedar Shake & Shingle Bureau I CTI Cooling Technology Institutet (Formerly: Cooling Touier Institute) I DHI Door and Hardware Institute I EIA Electronic Industries Alliance I EIMA EIFS Industry Members Association 1' EJCDC Engineers Joint Contract Documents Committee I EJMA Expansion Joint Manufactwers Association, Inc. I ESD ESD Associationt FCI Fluid Contols InstituteI! FGMA Flat Glass Marketing Association (See GANA) I FM Factory Mutual System (See FMG) I FMG FM GlobalI (Formerly: FM - Factory Mutual System) I _ FRSA lig:Llfftil? Sheet Metal & Air conditioning contractors r FSA Fluid Sealing Association I FSC Forest Stewardship Councilt _ GA Glpsum Association - GANA Glass Association of North America (Formerly: FGMA - Flat Glass Marketing Association)It GRI Geosynthetic Research Institute I GTA Glass Tempering Division of Glass Association of I North America (See GANA) - HI Hydraulic Institute Ir HI Hydronics Institute I HMMA Hollow Metal Manufacturers Association (See NAAMM)I -I REFERENCES OI42O-5I 20021501.08 t I I I I I HPVA HPW IAS VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE Hardwood Plywood & Veneer Association H. P. White Laboratory, Inc. Intemational Approval Services (See CSA) Insulated Cable Engineers Association, lnc. Intemational Conoete Repair Institute, Inc. lntemational Electotecbnical Commission Institute ofElectrical and Electonics Engineers, hrc. (The) Illuminating Engineering Society of North America lnsulating Glass Certi fication Council Insulating Glass Manufacturers Alliance (Ihe) Indiana Limestone Institute of America, Inc. International Solid Srnface Fabricators Association Intertek Testing Services Insect Screening Weavers Association (Now defunct) Kitchen Cabinet Manufacturers Association Laminating Materials Association Lighhing Protection lnstitute Laminated Safety Glass Association (See GANA) Metal Building Manufactwers Association Maple Flooring Manufacturers Association Metal Framing Manufacturers Association Material Handling Industry of America (See MHIA) Material Handling Indusfy of America Marble Institute of America Master Painters Institute 3t2t/2004 ICEA ICRI IEC IEEE IESNA IGCC IGMA ILI ISSFA ITS IWS KCMA LMA LPI LSGA MBMA MFMA MFMA MH MHIA MIA MPI T t I I I I T t I I I IREFERENCES01420 - 6 !20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTLAN LODGE 3t21t2004 - MSS Manufacturers Standardization Society of The Valve and f Fittings Industry krc. r NAAMM National Association of Architectural Metal Manufacturers I NAAMM North Arnerican Association of Mirror Manufacturers (See GANA)f NACE NACE International (National Association of Corrosion Engineers International) I NADCA National Air Duct Cleaners Association I NAIMA North American lnsulation Manufacturers Association (The) I NAMI National Accreditation and Managernent Institute, Inc.r NBGQA National Building Granite Quarries Association, lnc. I NCMA National Concrete Masonry Association NCPI National Clay Pipe Institute II NCTA National Cable & Telecommunications Association I NEBB National Environmental Balancing Bureau I NECA NationalElectricalContractorsAssociation I f NeLMA Northeastem Lumber Manufacturers' Association a NEMA National Eleckical Manufacturers AssociationI NETA InterNationalElectricalTestinsAssociation I NFPA NFPA lnternationalt fNational Fire Protection Association Intemational) I NFRC National Fenestration Rating CouncilI NGA National Glass Association I NHLA National Hardwood Lumber Association I NLGA National Lumber Grades Authority ,NOFMA National Oak Flooring Manufacturers Association I NRCA National Roofing Contractors Association NRMCA National Ready Mixed Concrete Association I I REFERENCES ot42o-..I 20021501 .08 NSF NSSGA NTMA NTRMA }IIVWDA OPL PCI PDCA PDI PGI RCSC P"FCI RIS RTI SAE SDI SDI SEFA SGCC SIA SIGMA SJI SMA SMACNA VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE NSF International (National Sanitation Foundation International) National Stone, Sand & Gravel Association National Tenazzo and Mosaic Association, Inc. National Tile Roofing Manufacturers Association (See RTI) National Wood Window and Door Association (See WDMA) Omega Point Laboratories, Inc. Precast/Prestessed Concrete Institute Painting and Decorating Contractors of America Plumbing & Drainage Institute PVC Geomembrane Institute Research Council on Structural Connections Resilient Floor Covering lnstitute Redwood Inspection Service RoofTile lnstitute (Formerly: NTRMA - National Tile Roofing Manufacturers Association) SAE Intemational Steel Deck hrstitute Steel Door Institute Scientific Equipment and Furniture Association Safety Glazing Certification Council Security hdustry Association Sealed Insulating Glass Manufachrers Association (See IGMA) Steel Joist Institute Screen Manufacturers Association Sheet Metal and Air Conditioning Conhactors' National Association 3t2V2004 T I I I I T I T I I T t l I I I I I IREFERENCES0t420 - 8 I 2oo2rsol.o8 I VAIL MOI.INTIAN LODGE SMITIE Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers I SPFA SprayPolyurethaneFoamAlliance @ormerly: SPUSPFD - The Society ofthe Plastics Industry, lnc.; Spray Polyurethane Foam Dvision) !SPIB Southern Pine lnspection Bureau (The) I SPVSPFD Society of the Plastics Industry, Inc. (The) Spray Polyurethane Foam Dvision (See SPFA) I SPRI SPRI (Single Ply Roofing hstitute) I SSINA Specialty Steel Industy of North Americaa SSPC SSPC: The Society for Protective Coatings ! STI Sleel Tank hrstitute I SWI Steel Window Institute !SWRI Sealant, Waterproofing, & Restoration Institute I TCA Tile Council of America, Inc. I TIA/EIA Telecommunications lndustry Association/Electronic I hdusn-ies Alliance - TMS The Masonry Societyrr TPI Truss Plate Institute, Inc. I TPI Turfgrass Producers InternationalI UL Underwriters Laboratories lnc.II UM Uni-Bell PVC Pipe Association I USITT United States lnstitute for Theate Technology, Inc. I WASTEC WasteEquipmentTechnologyAssociation I WCLIB West Coast Lumber Inspection Bureau I WCMA Window Covering Manufacturers Association (See WCSC) I WCSC Window Covering Safety Council _ (Formerly: WCMA - Window Covering Manufacturers a Association) I REFERENCES I 3t2v2004 01420 - 9 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/21t2004 WDMA Window & Door Manufacturers Association (Formerly: NWWDA - National Wood Window and Door Association) WIC Woodwork lnstitute of Califomia WMMPA Wood Moulding & Millwork Producers Association WSRCA Western States Roofing Contactors Association WWPA Western Wood Products Association C. Code Agencies: Where abbreviations and acroqrms are used in Specifications or other Contract Documents, they shall mean the recognized name of the entities in the following list. BOCA BOCA hrternational. lnc. CABO Council of American Building Officials (See ICC) IAPMO International Association of Plumbing and Mechanical Offrcials (Th6) ICBO International Conference of Building Officials ICBO ICBO Evaluation Service. Inc. ES ICC International Code Council, Inc. (Formerly: CABO - Council of American Building O{ficials) SBCCI Southem Building Code Congress Intemational, Inc. PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART 3 - EXECUTION (Not Used) END OF SECTION OI42O I I I l I I I T T I I I t t I I I T IREFERENCES01420 - l0 A, B. C. 1.1 1.2 I I I t I T I I 2002r 50r.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE SECTION O15OO - TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS PART I - GENERAL 3/2v2004 I t I I 1.3 SI]MMARY This Section includes requirements for temporary utilities, support facilities, and security and protection facilities. See Division I Section "Execution Requirernents" for progress cleaning requirements. See Divisions 2 tlrrough 16 Sections for temporary heat, ventilation, and humidity requirements for products in those Sections. DEFINITIONS Permanent Enclosure: As determined by Architect, pemanent or temporary roofing is complete, insulated, and weathertight; exterior walls are insulated and weathertight; and all openings are closed with permanent consfuction or substantial temporary closures. USE CHARGES General: Cost or use charges for temporary facilities shall be included in the Contract Sum. Allow other entities to use temporary services and facilities without cost, including, but not limited to Architect, testing agencies, and authorities having jurisdiction. Water Service: Water from Owner's existing water system is available for use without metering and without payment of use chmges. Provjde connections and extensions of services as required for c onstructi on operations. Electric Power Service: Electric power from Owner's existing system is available for use without metering and without payment of use charges. hovide connections and extensions of services as required for construction operations. SUBMMTALS Site Plan: Show ternporary facilities, utility hookups, staging areas, and parking areas for construction personnel. QUALITY ASSURANCE Electric Service: Comply with NECA, NEMA, and UL standards and regulations for temporary electric service. Install service to comply with NFPA 70. B. t.4 1.5 I I I t I I I TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS 01500 - I 2002150 r .08 VAIL MOT]NTI,ANLODGE 3t2v2004 B. Tests and Inspections: Arrange for authorities having jurisdiction to test and inspect each temporary utility before use. Obtain required certifications and permits. I.6 PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Temporary Use of Permanent Facilities: Installer of each permanent service shall assume responsibility for operation, maintenance, and protection of each permanent service during its use as a construction facility before Ovme/s acceptance, regardless of previously assigned responsibilities. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERTALS A. Gypsum Board: Minimum l/2 inch (12.7 mm) thick by 48 inches (1219 mm) wide by maximum available lengths; regular-type panels with tapered edges. Comply with ASTMC 36/C36M. B. Insulation: Unfaced mineral-fiber blanket, manufactured from glasS, slag wool, or rock wool;' with maximum flame-spread and smokedeveloped indexes of 25 and 50, respectively. 2.2 TEMPORARYFACILITIES 2.3 EQUTPMENT A. Fire Extinguishers: Portable, UL rated; with class and extinguishing agent as required by locations and classes of fire exposures. B. Heating Equipment: Unless Owner authorizes use of permanent heating system, provide vented, self+ontained, liquid-propane-gas or fuel-oil heaters with individual space thermostatic control. 1. Use of gasoline-buming space heaters, open-flame heaters, or salamander-type heating units is prohibited.2. Heating Units: Listed and labeled for type of fuel being consumed, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I INSTALLATION,GENERAL A. Locate facilities where they will serve Project adequately and result in minimum interference with performance of the Work. Relocate and modify facilities as required by progress of the Work. T I I I I T I I I I t I l I I I I I ITEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS 01500 - 2 B. A. B. C. D. F. G. H, 3.2 I I I I I t I I I I I I I I T I I t I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE 3/21t2004 Provide each facility ready for use when needed to avoid delay. Do not remove until facilities are no longer needed or are replaced by authorized use of completed permanent facilities. TEMPORARY UTILIry INSTALLATION General: Install temporary service or connect to existing service. l. Arrange with utility company, Owner, and existing users for time when service can be intemrpted, if necessary, to make connections for temporary services. Sewers and Drainage: Provide temporary utilities to remove effluent lawfully. l. Connect temporary sewers to private system indicated as directed by authorities having jurisdiction. Water Service: Use of Owner's existing water seryice facilities will be permitted, as long as facilities are cleaned and maintained in a condition acceptable lo Owner. At Substantial Completion, restore these facilities to condition existing before initial use. 1. Where installations below an outlet might be damaged by spillage or leakage, provide a. drip pan of suitable size to minimize water damage. Drain accumulated water promptly from pans. Sanitary Facilities: Provide temporary toilets, wash facilities, and drinking water for use of conskuction personnel. Comply with authorities having jurisdiction for type, number, location, operation, and maintenance of fixtures and facilities. Heating: Provide temporary heating required by construction activities for curing or drying of completed installations or for protecting installed construction from adverse effects of low temperatures or high humidity. Select equipment that will not have a harmful effect on completed installations or elements being installed. Ventilation and Humidity Control: Provide temporary ventilation required by construction activities for curing or drying of completed installations or for protecting installed construction from adverse effects of high humidity. Select equipment that will not have a harmful effect on completed installations or elements being installed. Coordinate ventilation requirements to produce ambient condition required and minimize anergy consumption. Electric Power Service: Use of Owner's existing eleckic power service will be permitted, as long as equipment is maintained in a condition acceptable to Owner. l. Cormect temporary service to Owner's existing power source, as directed by Owner. Lighting: Provide temporary lighting with local switching that provides adequate illumination for construction operations, observations, inspections, and traffic conditions. l. Install and operate temporary lighting that fulfills security and protection requirements without operating entire systern. Telephone Service: Provide temporary telephone service in common-use facilities for use by all construction personnel. Install one telephone line(s) for each field office. TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS 01s00 - 3 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE 3lzt/2004 l. Provide additional telephone lines for the following: a. hovide a dedicated telephone line for each facsimile machine and cornputer in each field office. 2. At each telephone, post a list of important telephone numbers including police and fire departments Contractor's home office Architect's office Owner's office Principal subcontractors' field and home offices. 3. Provide superintendent with cellular telephone or portable two-way radio for use when away from field oflice. J. Elechonic Communication Service: Provide temporary elechonic commrmication service, including electronic mail in field office. 3.3 STJPPORTFACILITIESINSTALLATION A. General: Comply with the following: l. Provide incombustible construction for offices, shops, and sheds located within construction area or within 30 feet (9 m) of building lines. Comply with NFPA 241.2. Maintain support facilities until near Substantial Completion. Remove before Substantial Completion. Personnel remaining after Sirbstantial Completion will be permitted to use permanent facilities, under conditions acceptable to Ovrrner. B. Traffic Contols: Comply with requirements of authorities having jurisdiction. l. Protect existing site improvem€nts to remain including curbs, pavement, and utilities.2. Maintain access for fire-fighting equipment and access to fire hydrants. C. Parking: Parking areas for construction personnel will not be provided on site. D. Dewatering Facilities and Drains: Comply with requirements of authorities having jurisdiction. Maintain hoject site, excavations, and construction free of water. l. Dispose of rainwater in a lawful manner that will not result in flooding Project or adjoining properties nor endanger permanent Work or temporary facilities.2. Remove snow and ice as required to minimize accumulations. E. Project Identification and Temporary Signs: Provide Project identification and other signs. Install signs where indicated to inform public and individuals seeking entrance to Project. Unauthorized signs are not permitted. l. hovide temporary, directional signs for construction personnel and visitors.2. Maintain and touchup signs so they are legible at all times. F. Waste Disposal Facilities: Provide waste<ollection containers in sizes adequate to handle waste from construction operations. Comply with requirements of authorities having jurisdiction. Comply with Division I Section "Execution Requirements" for progress cleaning requirements. G. Lifu and Hoists: hovide facilities necessary for hoisting materials and personnel. t I I t I T I I t I T I l T I I T I ITEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS 01500 - 4 H. J. K. L. B. C. D. E. F. 3.4 I I I t T T I I I I t I t I I t I I I 2002r 50 r.08 VAIL MOTINTTAN LODGE 3/2v2004 l. Truck cranes and similar devices used for hoistins materials are considered "tools and equipment" and not temporary facilities. Temporary Elevator Use: Use of elevators will not be permitted. Existing Elevator Use: Use of Owner's existing elevators will be not be permitted. Temporary Stairs: Until permanent stairs are available, provide temporary stairs where ladders are not adequate. Existing Stair Usage: Use of Building's Owner's existing stair (eastern) will be permitted, as long as stairs are cleaned and maintained in a condition acceptable to Owner. At Substantial Completion, restore stairs to condition existing before initial use. l. Provide protective coverings, barriers, devices, sigrs, or other procedures to protect stairs and to maintain means of egress. If, despite such protection, stairs become damaged, restore damaged areas so no evidence remains of correction work. Ternporary Use of Permanent Stairs: Cover finished, permanent stairs with protective covering of plywood or similar material so fmishes will be undamaged at time of acceptance. SECURITY AND PROTECTION FACILITIES INSTALLATION Environmental Protection: Provide prctection, operate temporary facilities, and conduct construction in ways and by methods that comply with environmental regulations and that minimize possible air, waterway, and subsoil contamination or pollution or other undesirable effects. Tree and Plant hotection: Install temporary fencing located as indicated or outside the drip line of trees to protect vegetation from damage from construction operations. Protect tree root systems from damage, flooding, and erosion. Pest Control: Engage pest-control service to recommend practices to minimize atffaction and harboring of rodents, roaches, and other pests and to perform extermination and control procedures at regular intervals so Project will be free of pests and their residues at Substantial Completion. Perform conhol operations lawfully, using environmentally safe materials. Security Enclosure and Lockup: Install substantial temporary enclosure around partially completed areas of construction. Provide lockable entrances to prevent unauthorized enhance, vandalism, theft, and similar violations of security. Barricades, Warning Signs, and Lights: Cornply with requirements of authorities having jurisdiction for erecting structurally adequate barricades, including warning signs and lighting. Temporary Enclosures: Provide temporary enclosures for protection of construction, in progress and completed, from exposure, foul weather, other construction operations, and similar activities. Provide temporary weathertight enclosure for building exterior. l. Where heating or cooling is needed and permanent enclosure is not complete, insulate temporary enclosures. TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROL S 01500 - 5 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTI,AN LODGE 3/2v2004 Temporary Partitions: Provide floor-to+eiling dustproof partitions to limit dust and dirt migration and to separale areas occupied by Building Owner and tenants from fumes and noise. l. Construct dusproof partitions with gypsum wallboard with joints taped on occupied side, and fire-retardant plywood on construction operations side. 2. Insulate partitions to provide noise protection to occupied areas. 3 . Seal joints and perimeter. Equip partitions with dustproof doors and security locks.4. Protectair-handlingequipment. 5. Weather strip openings. 6. Provide walk-off mats at each enfance through temporary partition. Temporary Fire Protection: Install and maintain temporary fire-protection facilities of tlpes needed to protect against reasonably predictable and contollable fire losses. Comply with NFPA24I. I . Prohibit smoking in construction areas.2. Supervise welding operations, combustion-type temporary heating units, and similar sources of fire igrition according to requirernents of authorities having jurisdiction. 3. Develop and supcrvise an overall fue-prevention and -protection program for personnel at Project site. Review necds with local fire dcparfinent and estrablish procedures to be followed. Instruct personnel in methods and procedures. Post wamings and information.4. Provide temporary standpipes and hoses for fire protection. Hang hoses with a wamihg sign stating that hoses are for fire-protection puposes only and are not to be removed. Match hose size with outlet size and equip with suitable nozzles. OPERATION, TERMINATION, AND REMOVAL Supervision: Enforce strict discipline in use of temporary facilities. To minimize waste and abuse, limit availability of temporary facilities to essential and intended uses. Maintenance: Maintain facilities in good operating condition rnatil removal. 1. Maintain operation of temporary enclosures, heating, cooling, humidity control, ventilation, and similar facilities on a 24-hour basis where required to achieve indicated results and to avoid possibility of damage. Temporary Facility Cbangeover: Do not change over from using temporary security and protection facilities to permanent facilities until Substantial Completion. Termination and Removal: Remove each temporary facility when need for its service has ended, when it has been replaced by authorized use of a p€rmanent facility, or no later than Substantial Completion. Complete or, if necessary, restore permanent construction that may have been delayed because of interference with temporary facility. Repair damaged work, clean exposed surfaces, and replace construction that cannot be satisfactorily repaired. l. Materials and facilities that constitute temporary facilities are property of Contractor. Owner reserves right to take possession ofProject identification signs. t I I I I t I T t I I I T I I I I I I G. 3.5 B. C. D. TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS 01500 - 6 20021501.08 VAIL MOT]NTTAN LODGE 3/21t2004 2. At Substantial Completion, clean and renovate permanent facilities used during construction period. Comply with final cleaning requirements specified in Division I Section "Closeout Procedures." END OF SECTION OI5OO TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS 01500 - 7 B. c. B. c. l.l t.2 1.3 I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I 20021501 .08 SECTION 01600 - PRODUCT REQUIREMENTS PART I -GENERAL VAILMOI.]NTIAN LODGE 3t2v2004 SUMMARY This Section includes administrative and procedural requirements for selection of products for use in Project; product delivery, storage, and handling; manufachrers' standard warranties on products; special wananties; product substitutions; and comparable products. See Division I Section "Closeout Procedures" for submitting warranties for Conhact closeout. See Divisions 2 through 16 Sections for specific requirements for warranties on products and installations specifred to be warranted. DEFIN]TIONS Products: Items purchased for incorporating into the Work, whether purchased for Project or taken from previously purchased stock. The term "product" includes the. terms "material," "equipment," "system," and terms of similar intent. 1. Named Products: Items identified by manufacturer's product name, including make or model number or other desigrration shown or listed in manufacturer's published product literature, that is current as of date of th€ Contract Documents. 2. New Products: Items that have not previously been incorporated into another project or facility, except that products consisting of recycled-content materials are allowed, unless explicitly stated otherwise. hoducts salvaged or recycled from other projects are not considered new products. 3. Cornparable Product: Product that is demonstrated and approved through submittal process, or where indicated as a product substitution, to have the indicated qualities related to type, function, dimension, in-service performance, physical properties, appearance, and other characteristics that equal or exceed those ofspecified product. Substitutions: Changes in products, materials, equipmant, and methods of construction from those required by the Contract Documents and proposed by Contractor. Basis-of-Desigr Product Specification: Where a specific manufacturer's product is named and accompanied by the words "basis of desigt," including make or model number or other desigaation, to establish the significant qualities related to type, function, dimension, in-service performance, physical properties, appeaftmce, and other characteristics for purposes of evaluating cornparable products of other named manufacturers. SUBMITTALS Substitution Requests: Submit three copies of each request for consideration. Identifo product or fabrication or installation method to be replaced. Include Specification Section number and title and Drawins numbers and titles. PRODUCT REQUIREMENTS 01600 - l 20021501 .08 VAIL MOI]NTTAN LODGE 312|2004 I . Substitution Request Form: Use CSI Form 13. I A. 2. Documentation: Show compliance with requirements for substitutions and the following, as applicable: a. Statement indicating why specified material or product cannot be provided. b. Coordination information, including a list of changes or modifications needed to other parts of the Work and to construction performed by Owner and separate contactors, that will be necessary to accommodate proposed substitution.c. Detailed comparison of significant qualities of proposed substitution with those of the Work specified. Significant qualities may include attributes such as performance, weight, size, durability, visual effect, and specific feafures and requirements indicated. d. hoduct Data, including drawings and descriptions of products and fabrication and installafi on procedwes. e. Samples, where applicable or requested. f. List of similar installations for completed projects with project names and addresses and names and addresses of architects and owners. C. Material test reports from a qualified testing agency indicating and interpreting test results for compliance with requirements indicated. h. Researcl/evaluation reports evideacing compliance with building code in effect for Project, from a model code organization acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. i. Detailed comparison of Contactor's Construttion Schedule using proposed substitution with products specified for the Worlg including effect on the overall Contract Time. If specified product or method of construction cannot be provided within the Conkact Time, include letter from manufacturer, on manufacturer's letterhead, stating lack of availability or delays in delivery.j. Cost information, including a proposal of change, if any, in the Contract Sum.k. Contractor's certification that proposed substitution complies with requirements in the Conhact Documents and is appropriate for applications indicated.l. Contractor's waiver of rights to additional payment or time that may subsequently become necessary because of faihne of proposed substitution to produce indicated results. 3. Architecfs Action: If necessary, Architect will request additional information or documentation for evaluation within 7 days of receipt of a request for substitution. Architect will notify Contractor of acceptance or rejection of proposed substitution within 15 days of receipt of request, or 7 days of receipt of additional information or documentation, whichever is later. a. Form ofAcceptance: Change Order. b. Use product specified if Architect cannot make a decision on use of a proposed substitution within time allocated. Comparable Product Requests: Submit three copies of each request for consideration. Identiff product or fabrication or installation method to be replaced. Include Specification Section number and title and Drawing numbers and titles. I . Architect's Action: If necessary, Architect will request additional information or documentation for evaluation within one week of receipt of a comparable product request. Architect will notifr Contractor of approval or rejection ofproposed comparable I I I I I B. I I I I I I I I I I I t t IPRODUCT REQUIREMENTS 01600 - 2 C. B. 1.4 1.5 I I I I I t I I I I I I t t T I I I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE product request within 15 days ofreceipt ofrequest, or 7 days ofreceipt ofadditional information or documentation. whichever is later. a. Form of Approval: As specified in Division I Section "Submittal Procedutes." b. Use product specified if Architect cannot make a decision on use ofa comparable product request within time allocated. Basis-of-Design Product Specification Submittal: Cornply with requirements in Division I Section " Submittal Procedures." Show compliance with requirements. QUALITY ASSIJRANCE Compatibility of Options: If Contractor is given option of selecting between two or more products for use on hojcct, product selected shall be compatible with products previously selected, even ifpreviously selected products were also options. PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Deliver, store, and handle products using means and methods that will prevent damage, deterioration, and loss, including theft. Comply with manufacturer's written instuctions. Delivery and Handling: l. Schedule delivery to minimize long-term storage at hoject site and to prevent overcrowding of constuction spaces.2. Coordinate delivery with installation time to ensure minimum holding time for items that are flammable, hazardous, easily damaged, or sensitive to deterioration, theft, and other losses. 3. Deliver products to Project site in an undamaged condition in manufacturer's original sealed container or other packaging system, complete with labels and instructions for handling, storing, unpacking, protecting, and installing.4. Inspect products on delivery to ensure compliance with the Contract Documents and to ensure that products are undamaged and properly protected. Storage: Store products to allow for inspection and measurement of quantity or counting ofunits. Store materials in a manner that will not endanger hoject structure. Store products that are subject to damage by the elernants, under cover in a weathertight enclosure above grormd, with ventilation adequate to prevent condensation. Store cementitious products and materials on elevated platforms. Store foam plastic from exposure to sunlight, except to extent necessary for period of installation and concealment. Comply with product manufacturer's written instructions for temperahue, humidity, ventilation, and weather-protection requirements for storage. Protect stored products from damage and liquids from freezing. 3/2u2004 l. 2. J. 4. 5. 6. 1 PRODUCT REQUIREMENTS 01600 - 3 1.6 20021501.08 VAIL MOLTNTI-AN LODGE 3/21/2004 PRODUCT WARRANTIES Warranties specified in other Sections shall be in addition to, and run concurrent with, other warranties required by the Contract Documents. Manufacturefs disclaimers and limitations on product warranties do not relieve Conhactor of obligations tmder requirements of the Contract Documents. l. Manufacturer's Warranty: Preprinted written warranty published by individual manufacturer for a particular product and specifically endorsed by manufacturer to Owner. 2. Special Warranty: Written wananty required by or incorporated into the Contact Documents, either to extend time limit provided by manufactwer's warranty or to provide more rights for owner. Special Warranties: Prepare a written documeat that contains appropriate terms and identification, ready for execution. Submit a draft for appro l before final execution. l. Manufacturer's Standard Form: Modified to include Project-specific information and properly executed. 2. Specified Form: When specified forms are included with the Specifications, prepare a written document using appropriate form properly executed. 3. Refer to Divisions 2 tlrough 16 Sections for specific content requirements and particular requirements for su6mitting special warranties. Submittal Time: Comply with requirements in Division I Section "Closeout hocedwes." PART 2 - PRODUCTS PRODUCT SELECTION PROCEDURES General Product Requirements: Provide products that comply with the Contract Documents, that are undamaged and, unless otherwise indicated, that are new at time of installation. l. Provide products complete with accessories, trim, finish, fasteners, and other items needed for a complete installation and indicated use and effect. 2. Standard Products: If available, and unless custom products or nonstandard options are specified, provide standard products of types that have been produced and used successfully in similar situations on other projects. 3. Owner reserves the right to limit selection to products with warranties not in conflict with requiremants of the Contact Documents. 4. Where products are accompanied by the term 'as selected," Architect will make selection. 5. Where products are accompanied by the term "match sample," sample to be matched is Architect's. 6. Descriptive, performance, and reference standard requirements in the Specifications establish "salient characteristics" of products. Product Selection Procedures: t t I T I I t T t I I I T III I I I I I B. C. 2.1 B. PRODUCT REQUIREMENTS 01600 - 4 2. J. 4. 5. 7. 9. I I I I I T I I t I I T T I t t t I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOIINTIAN LODGE 3t2112004 1.Product: Where Specifications name a single product and manufachrer, provide the named product that complies with requirements. Manufacturer/Source: Where Specifications name a single manufactuer or source, provide a product by the named manufacturer or source that complies with requirements. Products: Where Specifications include a list of names of both products and manufacturers, provide one of the products listed that complies with requirements. Manufacfurers: Where Specifications include a list of manufacturers' names, provide a product by one of the manufacturers listed thal complies with requirements. Available Products: Where Specifications include a list of names of both products and manufacturers, provide one of the products listed, or an unnamed prduct, that complies with requirements. Comply with provisions in Part 2 "Comparable Products" Article for consideration of an unnamed product. Available Manufacturers: Where Specifications include a list of manufacturers, provide a product by one of the manufacturers listed, or an turnamed manufacturer, that complies with requirements. Comply with provisions in Part 2 "Cornparable hoducts" Article for consideration of an unnamed product. Product Options: Where Specifications indicate that sizes, profiles, and dimensional requirernents on Drawings are based on a specific product or system, provide the specified product or system. Comply with provisions in Part 2 "Product Substitutions" Article for consideration of an unnamed product or system. Basis-of-Design Product: Where Specifications name a product and include a list of manufactwers, provide the specified product or a comparable product by one of the other named manufacturers. Drawings and Specifications indicate sizes, profiles, dimensions, and other characteristics that are based on the product named. Comply with provisions in Part 2 "Comparable hoducts" Article for consideration of an unnamed product by the other named manufacfu rers. Visual Matching Specification: Where Specifications require matching an established Sample, select a product that complies with requirements and matches Architect's sample. Architect's decision will be final on whether a proposed product matches. a. If no product available within specified category matches and complies with other specified requirements, comply with provisions in Part 2 "Product Substitutions" Article for proposal ofproduct. 10. Visual Selection Specification: Where Specifications include the phrase "as selected from manufacfurer's colors, patterns, textures" or a similar phrase, select a product that complies with other specified requirements. a. Standard Range: Where Specifications include the phrase "standard range of colors, patterns, textures" or similar phrase, Architect will select color, pattem, density, or texture from manufacturer's product line that does not include premium items. b. Full Range: Where Specifications include the phrase "full range of colors, pattems, texfures" or similar phrase, Architect will select color, pattern, density, or texture from manufacturer's product line that includes both standard and premium items. PRODUCT REQUIREMENTS 01600 - 5 2.2 2002150r.08 PART 3 - EXECUTION (Not Used) END OF SECTION 01600 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3t21t2004 PRODUCT S1JBSTITUTIONS Timing: Architect will consider requests for substitution if received within 60 days after the Notice of Award. Requests received after that time may be considered or re.iected at discretion ofArchitect. Conditions: Architect will consider Contactor's request for substitution when the following conditions are satisfied. If the following conditions are not satisfied, Architect will retum requests without action, except to record noncornpliance with these requirements: l. Requested substitution offers Ownet a substantial advantage in cost, time, energy conservation, or other considerations, after deducting additional responsibilities Owner must assume. Owler's additional responsibilities may include compensation to Architect for redesigrr and evaluation services, increased cost of other construction by Ov',ner, and similar considerations. 2. Requested substitution does not require extensive revisions to the Conbact Documents.3. Requested substitution is consistent with the Contract Documents and will produce indicated results. Substitution request is fully documented and properly submitted. Requestcd subsitution will not adversely affcct Contractor's Construction Scheduie. Requested substitution has received necessary approvals of authorities having jurisdiction. 7. Requested substitution is compatible with other podions of the Work. ' 8. Requested substitution has been coordinated with other portions of the Work. 9. Requested substitution provides specified warranty. COMPARABLE PRODUCTS Conditions: Architect will consider Contractor's request for comparable product when the following conditions are satisfied. If the following conditions are not satisfied, Architect will retum requests without action, except to record noncompliance with these requirements: 1. Evidence that the proposed product does not require extensive revisions to the Contract Documents, that it is consistent with the Conhact Documents and will produce the indicated results, and that it is compatible with other portions of the Work.2. Detailed comparison of sigrrificant qualities of proposed product with those named in the Specifications. Significant qualities include atbibutes such as performance, weight, size, durability, visual effect, and specific features and requirements indicated. Evidence that proposed product provides specified warranty. List of similar installations for completed projects with project names and addresses and names and addresses of architects and owners, if requested. Samples, if requested. I IIt It I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I I A. B. 4. 5. 6. 2.3 J. j 5. PRODUST REQUIREMENTS 01600 - 6 20021501.08 vArL MOTJNTTAN LODGE 3/21/2004 ! SECTION 01700 - EXECUTION REQUIREMENTS I PART I -GENERAL T 1.I ST]MMARY I A. This Section includes general procedural requirements goveming execution of the Work rncluding, but not limited to, the following: I l. Constructionlayout.r 2. General installation ofproducts. 3. Progress cleaning. I 4. Starting and adjusting.I 5. Protection ofinstalled construction. 6. Correction of the Work. I B. See Division I Section "Closeout hocedured" for submitting final property survey with Project Record Documents, recording of Owner-accepted deviations from indicated lines and levels, l and final cleaning. t 1.2 SI'BM]TTALS r A. Certificates: Submit certificate signed by land surveyor certifoing that location and elevation of exterior improvements comply with requirements. I B. Landfill Receipts: Submit copy of receipts issued by a landfill facility, licensed to accept hazardous materials, for hazardous waste disposal. I C. Certified Surveys: Submit two copies signed by land surveyor. t 1.3 QUALTTYASSURANCE A. Land Surveyor Qualifications: A professional land surveyor who is legally qualified to practice I in jurisdiction where Project is located and who is experiarced in providing land-survefng - services of the kind indicated. t PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) I PART3 -EXECI,TION I 3.1 ExAMTNATToNI A. Existing Conditions: The existence and location of improvements, utilities, and other I construction indicated as existing are not guaranteed. Before beginning work, investigate andI I ExEcUTIoNREQUIREMENTS 01700 - I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOI.]NTLAN LODGE 3/21/2004 veri0/ tbe existence and location of mechanical and electrical systems and other construction affecting the Work. l. Before construction, veriff the location and points of conneclion of utility services. Existing Utilities: The existence and location of utilities and construction indicated as existing are not guaranteed. l. Before construction, verif the location and invert elevation at points of connection of sanitary sewer, storm sewer, and water-service piping; and electrical services.2. Fumish location data for work related to hoject that must be performed by public utilities serving Project site. Acceptance of Conditions: Examine substrates, areas, and conditions, with Installer or Applicator present where indicated, for compliance with requirements for installation tolerances and other conditions affecting performance. Record observations. I . Veri8/ compatibility with and suitability of substrates, including compatibility with existing hnishes or pnmers. 2. Examine roughing-in for rnechanical and electrical systems to veriff actual locations of connections bfore equipmort and fixture installation. 3. Examine walls, floors, and roofs for suitable conditions where products and systems are to be installed. 4. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. Proceeding with the Work indicates acceptance of surfaces and conditions. PREPARATION Existing Utility lnformation: Fumish information to Owner that is necessary to adjust, move, or relocate existing utility lines, services, or other utility appurtenances located in or affected by construction. Coordinate with authorities having jurisdiction. Field Measurements: Take field measurements as required to fit the Work properly. Recheck measurements before installing each product. Where portions of the Work are indicated to fit to other construction, veri$ dimensions of other construction by field measurements before fabrication. Coordinate fabrication schedule with constuction progress to avoid delaying the Work. Space Requirements: Verifu space requirements and dimensions of items shown diagrammatically on Drawings. Review of Conhact Documents and Field Conditions: Immediately on discovery of the need for clarification of the Conhact Documents, submit a request for information to Architect. Include a detailed description ofproblern encountered, together with recommendations for changing the Conhact Documents. Submit requests on CSI Form 13.2A, "Request for Interpretation." I I I c. I I I I I I I I I I I I I I T I 3.2 B. C. D. EXECUTION REQUIREMENTS 01700 - 2 B. B. c. D. E. F. G. 3.3 3.4 T I I I I I t t I I I I I I I t I I t 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t21/2004 CONSTRUCTION LAYOUT Verification: Before proceeding to lay out the Work, veri$ layout information shown on Drawings, in relation to existing benchmarks. If discrepancies are discovered, notif Architect promptly. General: lay out the Work using accepted surveying practices. 1. Establish benchmarks and conhol points to set lines and levels at each story of construction and elsewhere as needed to locate each element ofProject.2. Establish dimensions within tolerances indicated. Do not scale Drawines to obtain required dimensions. 3. Inform installers of lines and levels to which they must comply.4. Check the location, level and plumb, of every major element as the Work progresses. 5. Notiff Architect when deviations from required lines and levels exceed allowable tolerances. INSTALLATION General: Locate the Work and components of the Work accurately, in correct aligrrment and elevation, as indicated. l. Make vertical work plumb and make horizontal work level.2. Where space is limited, install components to maximize space available for maintenance and ease ofrernoval for replacement. 3. Conceal pipes, ducts, and wiring in finished areas, unless otherwise indicated. Comply with manufacfurer's written instuctions and recommendations for installing products in applications indicated. Install products at the time and under conditions that will ensure the best possible results. Maintain conditions required for product performance until Substantial Completion. Conduct construction operations so no part of the Work is subjected to damaging operations or loading in excess ofthat expected during normal conditions of occupancy. Tools and Equipment: Do not use tools or equipment that produce harmful noise levels. Templates: Obtain and distribute to the parties involved templates for work specified to be factory prepmed and field installed. Check Shop Drawings of other work to confirm that adequate provisions are made for locating and installing products to comply with indicated requirements. Anchors and Fasteners: Provide anchors and fasteners as required to anchor each component securely in place, accurately located and aligned with other portions of the Work. 1. Mounting Heights: Where mounting heights are not indicated, mount components at heights directed by Architect.2. Allow for building movement, including thermal expansion and contraction. EXECUTION REQUIREMENTS 01700 - 3 2002r s0r.08 VAIL MOI]NTTAN LODGE 3t2v2004 3. Coordinate installation of anchorages. Fumish setting drawings, templates, and directions for installing anchorages, including sleeves, concrete inserts, anchor bolts, and items with integral anchors, that are to be embedded in concrete or masonry. Deliver such items to Project site in time for installation. Joints: Make joints of uniform width. Where joint locations in exposed work are not indicated, arrange joints for the best visual effect. Fit exposed connections together to form hairlinejoints. Hazardous Materials: Use products, cleaners, and installation materials that are not considered hazardous. PROGRESS CLEANING General: Clean Project site and work areas daily, including corrmon areas. Coordinate progress cleaning for joint-use areas where more than one installer has worked. Enforce requirements sbictly. Dispose of materials lawfully. l. Comply with requirements in NFPA 241 for removal of combustible waste materials and debris. 2. Do not hold materials more than 7 days during normal weather or 3 days if the temperature is expected to'rise above 80 deg F (27 deg C). 3. Containerize hazardous and unsanitary waste materials separately from other waste. Mark containers appropriately and dispose of legally, according to regulations. Site: Maintain hoject site free of waste materials and debris. Work Areas: Clean areas where work is in progress to the level of cleanliness necessary for proper execution of the Work. l. Remove liquid spills promptly. 2. Where dust would impair proper execution of the Work, broom-clean or vacuum the entire work area, as appropriate. lnstalled Work: Keep installed work clean. Clean installed swfaces according to written instructions of manufacturer or fabricator of product installed, using only cleaning materials specifically recommended. If specific cleaning materials are not recommended, use cleaning materials that are not hazardous to health or property and that will not damage exposed surfaces. Concealed Spaces: Remove debris from concealed spaces before enclosing the space. Exposed Surfaces in Finished Areas: Clean exposed surfaces and protect as necessary to ensnre freedom from damage and deterioration at time of Substantial Completion. Waste Disposal: Burying or burning waste materials on-site will not be permitted. Washing waste materials down sewers or into waterways will not be permitted. Dwing handling and installation, clean and protect construction in progress and adjoining materials already in place. Apply protective covering where required to ensure protection from damage or deterioration at Substantial Completion. I I I II I I I t I I I I I t I I I I t H. 3.5 B. C. E. F. D. G. EXECUTION REQUIREMENTS 01700 - 4 I t I l I I I t I II I II T I T I I T I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t21t2004 I. Clean and provide maintenance on completed construction as frequently as necessary through the rernainder of the construction period. Adjust and lubricate operable components to ensure operability without damaging effects. I. Limiting Exposures: Supervise construction operations to assure that no part of the construction, completed or in progless, is subject to harmful, dangerous, damaging, or otherwise deleterious exposure during the construction period. 3.6 STARTINGANDADruSTING A. Start equipment and operating components to confirm proper operation. Remove malfunctioning units, replace with new units, and retest. B. Adjust operating components for proper operation without binding. Adjust equipment for proper operation. C. Test each piece of equipment to veriff proper operation. Test and adjust controls and safeties. Replace damaged and malfunctioning conftols and equipment. D. Manufacturer's Field Service: If a factory-authorized service representative is required to inspect field-assembled components and equipment installation, comply with qualification requirements in Division I Section "Quality Requirements." 3.7 PROTECTION OF INSTALLED CONSTRUCTION A. Provide final protection and maintain conditions that ensure installed Work is without damage or deterioration at time of Substantial Completion. B. Conply with manufacturer's written instructions for temperature and relative humidity. 3.8 CORRECTION OF THE WORK A. Repair or remove and replace defective construction. Restore damaged subshates and finishes. Comply with requirements in Division I Section "Cutting and Patching." l. Repairing includes replacing defective parts, refinishing damaged surfaces, touching up with matching materials, and properly adjusting operating equipment. B. Restore permanent facilities used during construction to their specified condition. C. Remove and replace damaged surfaces that are exposed to view if surfaces camot be repaired without visible evidence of repair. D. Repair components that do not operate properly. Remove and replace operating components that cannot be repaired. E. Remove and replace chipped, scratched, and broken glass or reflective surfaces. EXECUTION REQUIREMENTS 01700 - 5 2002150t.08 END OF SECTION OITOO VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE 3mn004 DGCUTION REQUIREIVIENTS 01700 - 6 t, t 2002 l 501 .08 SECTION OI73I - CUTTING AND PATCHING PART I - GENERAL VAIL MOLTNTIAN LODGE 312v2004 A. B. c. l.l 1.2 1.3 I T I I t I I I I I T I fi I I I il SUMMARY This Section includes procedural requirements for cutting and patching. See Divisions 2 through 16 Sections for specific requirements and limitations applicable to cutting and patching individual parts of the Work. See Division 7 Section "Through-Penetoation Firestop Systems" for patching fire-rated construction. SUBMITTALS Cutting and Patching Proposal: Submit a proposal describing procedures at least 10 days before the time cutting and patching will be performed, requesting approval to proceed. Include the following information : l. Extent: Describe cutting and patching, show how they will be performed, and indicate why they cannot be avoided. 2. Changes to ln-Place Construction: Describe anticipated results. Include changes to structural elernents and operating components as well as changes in building's appearance and other significant visual elements.3. Products: List products to be used and firms or entities that will perform the Work. 4. Dates: Indicate whan cutting and patching will be performed. 5. Utility Services and Mechanical/Electrical Systems: List serviceVsystems that cutting and patching procedures will disturb or affect. List services/systems tbat will be relocated and those that will be temporarily out of service. Indicate how long servi ceVsystems will be disrupted. 6. Structural Elements: Where cutting and patching involve adding reinforcement to strucfural elements, submit details showing integration of reinforcement with original structure. 7. Architect's Approval: Obtain approval of cutting and patching proposal before cutting and patching. Approval does not waive right to later require removal and replacement of unsatisfactory work. QUALITY ASSI.]RANCE Structural Elernents: Do not cut and patch structural elements in a manner that could change their load-carrying capacity or load-deflection ratio, 1. Operational Elements: Do not cut and patch operating elernents and related components in a manner that results in reducing their capacity to perform as intended or that results in increased maintenance or decreased operational life or safety. CUTTING ANDPATCHING 01731 - I 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2y2004 2. Miscellaneous Elements: Do not cut and patch miscellaneous elements or related components in a manner that could change their load-carrying capacity, that results in reducing their capacity to perform as intended, or that results in increased maintenance or decreased operational life or safety. B. Visual Requirements: Do not cut and patch construction in a manner that results in visual evidence of cutting and patching. Do not cut and patch constuction exposed on the exterior or in occupied spaces in a nnnner that would, in Architect's opinion, reduce the building's aesthetic qualities. Remove and replace construction that has been cut and patched in a visually unsatisfactory manner. 1.4 WARRANTY A. Existing Warranties: Retnove, replace, patch, and repair materials and surfaces cut or damaged during cutting and patching operations, by methods and with materials so as not to void existing warranties. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MATERIALS General: Comply with requirements specified in other Sections. In-Place Materials: Use materials identical to in-place materials. For exposed surfaces, use materials that visually match in-place adjacent surfaces to the fullest extent possible. 1 If identical materials are unavailable or carmot be used, use materials that, when installed, will match the visual and fi:nctional performance of in-place materials. PART 3 -EXECUTION EXAMINATION Examine surfaces to be cut and patched and conditions under which cutting and patching are to be performed. l. Compatibility: Before patching, veriff compatibility with and suitability of substrates, including compatibility with in-place finishes or primers. 2. Proceed with installation only after unsafe or unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION Temporary Support: Provide temporary support of Work to be cut. 'lt I t 2.1 I I I I I I I I I I $ 1 A. B. 3.1 3.2 I I {lCUTTING AND PATCHING ot73t -2 I I t t I 7 I 0 T t Ar V I t I i I t I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2r/2004 Protection: Protect in-place construction during cutting and patching to prevent damage. Provide protection from adverse weather conditions for portions of Project that might be exposed during cutting and patching operations. Adjoining Areas: Avoid interference with use of adjoining areas or intemrption of free passage to adjoining areas. Existing Utility Services and MechanicallElectrical Systems: Where existing services/systems are required to be removed, relocated, or abandoned, bypass such services/systems before cutting to prevent intemrption to occupied areas. PERFORMANCE General: Ernploy skilled workers to perform cutting and patching. Proceed with cutting and patching at the earliest feasible time, and complete without delay. l. Cut in-place construction to provide for installation of other components or performance of other constuction, and subsequently patch as required to restore surfaces to their original condition. Cutting: Cut in-place construction by sawing, drilling, breaking, chipping, grinding, and similm operations, including excavation, using methods least likely to damage elements retained or adjoining construction. If possible, review proposed procedures with original Installer; cornply with original Installer's written recommendations. 1. In general, use hand or small power tools designed for sawing and grinding, not hammering and chopping. Cut holes and slots as small as possible, neatly to size required, and with minimum disturbance of adjacant surfaces. Temporarily cover openings when not in use. 2. Finished Surfaces: Cut or drill from the exposed or finished side into concealed surfaces. 3. Concrete or Masomy: Cut using a cutting machine, such as an abrasive saw or a diamond-core drill.4. Mechanical and Eleckical Services: Cut off pipe or conduit in walls or partitions to be rernoved. Cap, valve, or plug and seal remaining portion of pipe or conduit to prevent entrance of moisture or other foreign matter after cutting. 5. hoceed with patching after construction operations requiring cutting are complete. Patching: Patch construction by frlling, repairing, refinishing, closing up, and similar operations following performance of other Work. Patch with durable seams that are as invisible as possible. hovide materials and comply with installation requirements specified in other Sections. l Inspection: Where feasible, test and inspect patched areas after completion to demonshate integrity of installation. 2. Exposed Finishes: Restore exposed finishes of patched areas and extend finisb restoration into retained adjoining construction in a manner that will eliminate evidence of patching and refi nishing. 3. Floors and Walls: Where walls or partitions that are removed extend one finished area into another, patch and repair floor and wall surfaces in the new space. Provide an even surface of uniform finish, color, texture, and appearance. Remove in-place floor and wall B. D. J.J B. CUTTING AND PATCHING 0173t - 3 20021501.08 VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE 3t2l/2004 coverings and replace with new materials, if necessary, to achieve uniform color and aPpearance. 4. Ceilings: Patch, repair, or rehang in-place ceilings as necessary to provide an even-plane surface of uniform appearance. 5. Exterior Building Enclosure: Patch components in a manner that restores enclosure to a weatherti ght condition. D. Cleaning: Clean areas and spaces where cutting and patching are performed. Completely remove paint, mortar, oils, putty, and similar materials. END OF SECTION OI73I t t I I t t I 0 t I - Ut I I ili I I I ICUTTING AND PATCHING 01731-4 I 2oo2r5or.o8 I VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 t U SECTION 01732 - SELECTIVE DEMOLITION -latll PART I.GENERAL -I.I SI.JMMARY A. This Section includes the following: l. Demolition and removal of selected portions of building or sFucture. 2. Salvage of existing items to be reused or recycled. n rz DEFINTTIoNS f'" A. Remove: Detach items from existing construction and legally dispose of them off-site, unless I indicated to be removed and salvaged or removed and reinstalled. a- B. Remove and Salvage: Detach items from existing construction and deliver them to a Owner ready for reuse. I,F C. Rernove and Reinstall: Detach items hom existing constuction, prepare them for reuse, and 1', reinstall them where indicated. I D. Existing to Remain: Existing items of construction that are not to be removed and that are not otherw'ise indicated to be rernoved, removed and salvaged, or removed and reinstalled. 1.3 SI.]BMITTALS I A. Schedule of Selective Demolition Activities: Indicate detailed sequence of selective demolition and removal work, with starting and ending dates for each activity, intemrption of utility l, services, use of stairs, and locations of temporary partitions and means of egress. I B. Predemolition Photographs: Show existing conditions of adjoining construction and site rr improvements, including finish surfaces, that might be misconstrued as damage caused by I selective demolition operations. Submit before Work begins. ,\ C. Landfill Records: Indicate receipt and acceptance of hazardous wastes by a landfill facility f licensed to accept hazardous wastes.-/rl,1 l, t.4 QUAITTYASSURANCE 'l A. Demolition Firm Qualifications: An experienced firm that has specialized in dernolition work I similar in material and extent to that indicated for this Project. 4 B. Regulatory Requirements: Comply with governing EPA notification regulations before beginning selective demolition. Comply with hauling and disposal regulations of authorities having jurisdiction. U fr I SELECTTvEDEMoLITIoN 0t732 - | 2002 1501 .08 VAIL MOI.JNTIANLODGE 3/2r/2004 C. Standards: Comply with ANSI A10.6 and NFPA 241. 1.5 PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Owner will occupy portions of building immediately adjacent to selective demolition area. Conduct selective demolition so Owner's operalions will not be disrupted. B. Conditions existing at time of inspection for bidding purpose will be maintained by Owner as far as practical. C. Notiff Architect of discrepancies between existing conditions and Drawings before proceeding with selective demolition. D. Hazardous Materials: It is not expected that hazardous materials will be encountered in the Work. l. If materials suspected of containing hazardous materials are encountered, do not disturb; immediately notif Architect and Owner. Owner will remove hazardous materials under a separate contact. E. Storage or sale of removed items or materials on-site is not pemitted. F. Utility Service: Maintain existing utilities indicated to remain in service and protect them against damage during selective demolition operations. l. Maintain fire-protection facilities in service during selective demolition operations. I.6 WARRANTY A. Existing Warranties: Remove, replace, patch, and repair materials and surfaces cut or damaged during selective demolition, by methods and with materials so as not to void existing warranties. PART 2 - PRODUCTS (Not Used) PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I EXAMINATION A. Verify that utilities have been disconnected and capped. B. Inventory and record the condition of items to be removed and reinstalled and items to be removed and salvaged. C. When unanticipated mechanical, electrical, or structural elements that conflict with intended function or design are encountered, investigate and measure the nature and extent of conflict. Promptly submit a written report to Architect. t I il I I I I 'i I tl) I I I I 0 I fi ISELECTTVE DEMOLITION 0t732 -2 I l I t I f, I I I I J I I I J l I 0 I 20021s01.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 312112004 Engage a professional engineer to survey condition of building to determine whether removing any element might result in structural deficiency or unplanned collapse of any portion of strucfure or adjacent structures during selective demolition operations. Survey of Existing Conditions: Record existing conditions by use of preconstruction photographs. UTILITY SERVICES AND MECHANICAL/ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS Existing ServiceVSystems: Maintain services/systans indicated to remain and protect them against damage during selective demolition operalions. Service/System Requiremeats: Locate, ideniiff, disconnect, and seal or cap off indicated utility services and mechanicaUelectrical systems serving areas to be selectively demolished. l. Arrange to shut offindicated utilities with utility companies.2. If serviceVsystems are required to be removed, relocated, or abandoned, before proceeding with selective demolition provide temporary serviceVsystems that bypass area of selective demolition and that maintain continuity of services/systems to other parts ofbuilding. 3. Cut off pipe or conduit in walls or partitions to be removed. Cap, valve, or plug and seal remaining portion ofpipe or conduit after bypassing PREPARATION Site Access and Temporary Conhols: Conduct selective demolition and debris-removal operations to ensure minimum interference with roads, streets, walks, walkways, and other adjacent occupied and used facilities. L Comply with requirements for access and protection specified in Division I Section "Temporary Facilities and Controls." Temporary Facilities: Provide temporary barricades and other protection required to prevent injury to people and damage to adj acent buildings and facilities to remain. SELECTIVE DEMOLITION General: Demolish and remove existing construction only to the extent required by new construction and as indicated. Use methods required to complete the Work within limitations of governing regulations and as follows: 1. Neatly cut openings and holes plumb, square, and true to dimensions required. Use cutting methods least likely to damage construction to remain or adjoining construction. Use hand tools or small power tools designed for sawing or grinding, not hammering and chopping, to minimize disturbance of adjacent surfaces. Temporarily cover openings to rernain. 2. Cut or drill from the exposed or finished side into concealed swfaces to avoid marring existing fi nished surfaces. D, 3.2 B. 3.3 B. 3.4 SELECTIVE DEMOLITION 01732 - 3 20021501.08 I I I I l 0 I I l I 0 I 1 I ,t I I ! I B. B. c. 3.5 3.6 VAIL MOUNTI.AN LODGE 3/21/2004 3. Do not use cutting torches until work area is cleared of flammable materials. At concealed spaces, such as duct and pipe interiors, verifo condition and contents ofhidden space before starting flame-cutting operations. Maintain portable fire-suppression devices during fl ame-cutting operations. 4. Locate selective demolition equipment and remove debris and materials so as not to impose excessive loads on supporting walls, floors, or framing.5. Dispose of demolished items and materials promptly. Existing ltems to Remain: Protect construction indicated to rernain against damage and soiling during selective demolition. When permitted by Architect, iterns may be removed to a suitable, protected storage location during selective demolition and cleaned and reinstalled in their original locations after selective demolition operations are cornplete. DISPOSAL OF DEMOLISHED MATERI,ALS General: Except for items or materials indicated to be reused, salvaged, reinstalled, or otherwise indicated to remain Owner's property, remove demolished materials from Project site and legally dispose of them in an EPA-approved landfill. I . Comply with requirements specified in Division I Section "Consfuction Waste Management." Buming; Do not bum demolished materials. Disposal: Transport donolished materials off Owner's property and legally dispose of them. CLEANING Clean adjacent structures and improvements of dust, dirt, and debris caused by selective demolition operations. Return adjacent areas to condition existing before selective demolition operations began. END OF SECTION 01732 SELECTTVE DEMOLTTION 01732 - 4 I I SECTION OI77O - CLOSEOUT PROCEDURES PART I -GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY I A. This Section includes administrative and procedural requirements for contract closeout,It including, but not limited to, the following: l. Inspectionprocedures. 2. Wananties. 3. Final cleaning. B. See Division I Section "Payment Procedures" for requirements for Applications for Paymant for Substantial and Final Completion. C. See Division I Section "Project Record Documents" for submitting Record Drawings, Record Specifications, and Record Product Data. t L D. See Division I Section "Operation and Maintenance Data" for operation and maintenancea- manu'al requirements. I E. See Divisions 2 through 16 Sections for specific closeout and special cleaning requirernents for t the Work in those Sections. /',,-1II\I,, 1,2 SI]BSTANTIAL COMPLETION I A. Preliminary Procedures: Before requesting inspection for determining date of Substantial t Completion, complete the fotlowing. List items belorv that are incomplete in request. 1. Prepare a list of items to be completed and corrected (punch list), the value of items on the list, and reasons why the Work is not complete. 2. Advise Owner ofpending insurance changeover requirements. 3. Submit specific warranties, workmanship bonds, maintenance service agreements, final certifications, and similar documents. 4. Obtain and submit releases permitting Owner unrestricted use of the Work and access to services and utilities. Include occupancy permits, operating certificates, and similar releases. 5. Prepare and submit Project Record Documents, operation and maintenance manuals, Final Completion construction photographs, damage or settlement surveys, property surveys, and similar final record information. 6. Deliver tools, spare parts, extra materials, and similar items to location designated by Owner. Label with manufacturer's name and model number wh€r€ applicable. 7. Make final changeover of permanent locks and deliver keys to Owner. Advise Owner's personnel of changeover in security provisions. 8. Complete startup testing of systems. 9. Submittest/adjust/balancerecords. 20021 50 r .08 VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE 3t21t2004 I I t I I T r I I I 0 01770 - | I cLosEourPRocEDURES 20021501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/21/2004 with mockups,10. Terminate and remove temporary facilities from Project site, along construction tools, and similar elements. I l. Advise Owner ofchangeover in heat and other utilities.12. Submit changeover information related to Owner's occupancy, use, operation, and maintenance. 13. Complete final cleaning requirements, including touchup painting. 14. Touch up and otherwise repair and restore marred exposed finishes to eliminate visual defects. B. Inspection: Submit a written request for inspection for Substantial Completion. On receipt of request, Architect will either proceed with inspection or notifu Confactor of unfulfilled requirernants. Architect will prepare the Certificate of Substantial Completion after inspection or will notiff Contractor of items, either on Contractor's list or additional items identified by Architect, that must be completed or corrected before certificate will be issued. I . Reinspection: Request reinspection when the Work identified in previous inspections as incornplete is completed or corrected.2. Results of completed inspection will form the basis of requirements for Final Cornpletion. FINALCOMPLETION Preliminary Procedures: Before requesting final inspection for determining date of Final Completion, cornplete the following: I . Submit a final Application for Payment according to Division I Section "Payment hocedures." 2. Submit certified copy of Architect's Substantial Completion inspection list of iterns to be completed or corrected (punch list), endorsed and dated by Architect. The certified copy of the list shall state that each item has been completed or othenvise resolved for acceptance. 3. Submit evidence of final, continuing insurance coverage complying with insurance requirements. 4. Submit pest-control final inspection report and warranty. 5. Instruct Owner's personnel in operation, adjustment, and maintenance of products, equipment, and systems. Inspection: Submit a written request for final inspection for acceptance. On receipt of request, Architect will either proceed with inspection or notif! Contractor of unfulfilled requirenents. Architect will prepare a final Certificate for Payment after inspection or will notifu Contactor of constuction that must be completed or corrected before certificate will be issued. I . Reinspection: Request reinspection when the Work identified in previous inspections as incomplete is completed or corrected. LIST OF INCOMPLETE ITEMS (PUNCH LIST) Preparation: Submit three copies of list. Include name and identification of each space and area affected by construction operations for incomplete items and items needing correction t I I 1 I I I I t I 3 I l.J I I I I it I B. 1.4 CLOSEOUT PROCEDURES 01770 -2 I I I I I t I t I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2r/2004 including, if necessary, areas disturbed by Conhactor that are outside the limits of construction. Use CSI Form 14.1A. l. Organize list of spaces in sequential order, starting with exterior areas first and proceeding from lowest floor to highest floor. 2. Organize items applying to each space by major element, including categories for ceiling, individual walls, floors, equipment, and building systems. WARRANTIES Submittal Time: Submit written warranties on request of Architect for designated portions of the Work where commencement of warranties other than date of Substantial Completion is indicated. Aganize warranty documents into an orderly sequence based on the table of contents of the Project Manual. 1. Bind warranties and bonds in heavyduty, 3-ring, vinyl-covered, looseleaf binders, thickness as necessary to accommodate contents, and sized to receive 8-1/2-by- I l-inch (2 I 5-by-280-mm) paper. 2. hovide heavy paper dividers with plastic-covered tabs for each separate warrantSr. Mark tab to identify the product or installation. Provide a typed description of the product or installation, including the name of the product and the name, address, and telephone number of Installer. 3. Identify each binder on the front and spine with the typed or printed title 'WARRANTIES," Project name, and name of Contractor. Provide additional copies ofeach warranty to include in operation and maintenance manuals. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MATERIALS Cleaning Agents: Use cleaning materials and agents recommended by manufacturer or fabricator of the surface to be cleaned. Do not use cleaning agents that are potentially hazardous to health or property or that might damage finished surfaces. PART 3 . EXECUTION FINALCLEANING General: hovide final cleaning. Conduct cleaning and waste-removal operations to comply with local laws and ordinances and Federal and local eavironmental and antipollution regulations. 1.5 B. 2.1 3.1 0 I I ! I I I CLOSEOTIT PROCEDURES 01770 -3 20021501 .08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3t2v2004 Cleaning: Employ experienced workers or professional cleaners for final cleaning. Clean each surface or unit to condition expected in an average commercial building cleaning and maintenance program. Comply with manufacfurer's written instructions. l. Complete the following cleaning operations before requesting inspection for certification of Substantial Completion for entire hoject or for a portion of Project: a. Clean hoject site, yard, and grounds, in areas disturbed by construction activities, including landscape development areas, of rubbish, waste material, litter, and other foreign substances. b. Sweep paved areas broom clean. Remove peFochemical spills, stains, and other foreign deposits. c. Rake grounds that are neither planted nor paved to a smooth, even-textured surface. d. Remove tools, construction equipment, machinery, and surplus material from Project site. e. Remove snow and ice to provide safe access to building.f. Clean exposed exterior and interior hard-surfaced finishes to a dirt-fiee condition, free of stains, films, and similar foreign substances. Avoid disturbing natural weathering of exterior surfaces. Restore reflective surfaces to their original condition. C. Remove debris and surface dust Aom limited access spaces, including roofs, plenums, shafts, henches, equipment vaults, manholes, attics, and similar spaces.h. Sweep concrete floors broom clean in unoccupied spaces.i. Vacuum carpet and similar soft surfaces, rernoving debris and excess nap; shampoo if visible soil or stains remain.j. Clean transparant materials, including mirrors and glass in doors and windows. Remove glazing compounds and other noticeable, vision-obscuring materials. Replace chipped or broken glass and other damaged hansparent materials. Polish mirrors and glass, taking care not to scratch surfaces.k. Remove labels that are not permanent. l. Touch up and otherwise repair and restore marred, exposed finishes and surfaces. Replace finishes and surfaces that cannot be satisfactorily repaired or restored or that already show evidence of repair or restoration. I ) Do not paint over "UL" and similar labels, including mechanical and electrical nameplates. m. Wipe surfaces of mechanical and electrical equipment and similar equipment. Remove excess lubrication, paint and mortar droppings, and other foreign substances. n. Replace parts subject to unusual operating conditions.o. Clean plumbing fixtures to a sanitary condition, free of stains, including stains resulting from water exposure.p. Replace disposable air filters and clean permanent air filters. Clean exposed surfaces ofdiffusers, registers, and grills.q. Clean light fixtures, lamps, globes, and reflectors to function with full efficiency. Replace bumed-out bulbs, and those noticeably dimmed by hours of use, and defective and noisy starters in fluorescent and mercury vapor fixtures to cornply with requirements for new fixfures. r. Leave Project clean and ready for occupancy. B. CLOSEOUT PROCEDI.]RES 0t770 - 4 t t 2OO2I5OI.O8 VAIL MOT.INTIAN LODGE 3121t2004 C. Comply with safety standards for cleaning. Do not burn waste materials. Do not bury deb'ris or - excess materials on Owner's property. Do not discharge volatile, harmful, or dangerous'f\ materials into drainage systems. Remove waste materials from Project site and dispose of ! lawfullv. l, r ENDOFSECTTON0ITT0 t I I f, 1 T t I t I t I r I I cLosEourPRocEDrJREs 01770 - 5 Ti T l I I i I t t l I I I I P<E{': 9tr ECtgtL Ea<a l) l I E.2ge IF E+ ESE<g>- 2E69 ET -a< =J ; (r)o\s z-e!0E F.>4- I I : Er tr tr El tr D tr D o Ofl q) >o tr u; oo .o c) v) n o D l|) z {) z o Eo !., E () {t a c it) = atl tr FeFE a) .9q =(,Eg FC0otroOo =.=5'ot*9€E'!l oo Eg e.a6r €B b? FS.E C|. 96i6l) ID; .EL .biIaEFFI r-i EC'b€ 5= -^9 r)&trg a,.o E zii6,9,AE d'Eet<().A t! Eo 3r. aF O ,a oa, FfrU9z)D er $€s F) B. B, l.l 1.2 2.1 l t I I I T t I t I $ l I i J I t, 2002150r.08 VAIL MOUNTI-AN LODGE SECTION OI78I - PROJECT RECORD DOCUMENTS PART I - GENERAL 3t21t2004 SIJMMARY This Section includes administrative and procedural requiremeats for hoject Record Documents, including the following: 1. Record Drawings. 2. RecordSpecifications. 3. Rccord Product Data. See Division I Section uOperation and Maintenance Data" for operation and maintenance manual requirernents. See Divisions 2 through l6 Sections for specific requirernents for Project Record Documents of the Work in those Sections. SUBMITTALS Record Drawings: Comply with the following: I . Number of Copies: Submit one set(s) of marked-up Record Prints. Record Specifications: Submit one copy of Project's Specifications, including addenda and contact modifications. Record Product Data: Submit one copy of each Product Data submittal. PART 2. PRODUCTS RECORDDRAWINGS Record Prints: Maintain one set of blue- or blackline white prints of the Contract Drawings and Shop Drawings. I . Preparation: Mark Record Prints to show the actual installation where installation varies from that shown originally. Require individual or entity who obtained record data, whether individual or entity is Installer, subcontractor, or similar entity, to Fepare the marked-up Record Prints. a. Give particular attention to information on concealed elements that would be dilficult to identify or measure and record later. b. Record data as soon as possible after obtaining it. Record and check the markup before enclosing concealed installations. 01781- IPROJECT RECORD DOCUMENTS 2002 r 501 .08 I T I I I l I I I t I ) I I i I I I t a. b. c. d. e. t- B. 2.2 2.3 VAIL MOI.]NTIAN LODGE 3tzr/2004 2. Mark the Contract Drawings or Shop Drawings, whichever is most capable of showing actual physical conditions, completely and accurately. lf Shop Drawings are marked, show cross-reference on the Contract Drawings. 3. Mark record sets with erasable, red+olored pencil. Use other colors to distinguish between changes for different categories of the Work at same location.4. Note Construction Change Directive numbers, altemate numbers, Change Order numbers, and similar identification, where applicable. Format: Identi$ and date each Record Drawing; include the designation "PROJECT RECORD DRAWING' in a prominent location. Record Prints: Organize Record Prints and newly prepared Record Drawings into manageable sets. Bind each set with durable paper cover sheets. lnclude identification on cover sheets. Identification: As follows: Project name. Date. Designation'PROJECT RECORD DRAWINGS." Name of Architect. Name of Contractor. RECORD SPECIFICATIONS Preparation: Mark Specifications to indicate the actual product installation where installation varies from that indicated in Specifications, addenda, and conhact modifications. l. Give particular attention to information on concealed products and installations that cannot be readily identified and recorded later.2. Mark copy with the proprietary name and model number of products, materials, and equipment fi:rnished, including substitutions and product options selected.3. Record the name of manufacturer, supplier, krstaller, and other information necessary to provide a record of selections made. 4. Note related Change Orders, Record Product Data, and Record Drawings where applicable. RECORD PRODUCTDATA Preparation: Mark Product Data to indicate the actual product installation where installation varies substantially from that indicated in hoduct Data submittal. l. Give particular attention to information on concealed products and installations that cannot be readily identified and recorded later. 2. Include sigtificant changes in the product delivered to Project site and changes in manufacturer's written instuctions for installation. 3. Note related Change Orders, Record Specifications, and Record Drawings where applicable. PROJECT RECORD DOCTJMENTS 01781 - 2 a. Ir' 2002150r.08 vAIL MouNTt.AN LoDGE 312l/2004 -, . 2.4 MISCELLANEoUS RECORD SUBMITTALS I A. Assemble miscellaneous records required by other Specihcation Sections for miscellaneousll record keeping and submittal in connection with actual performance of the Work. Bind or file miscellaneous records and identiff each, ready for continued use and reference.If PART 3 - EXECUTION It''' 3.1 REcoRDINc AND MAINTENANCE I A. Recording: Maintain one copy of each submittal during the construction period for ProjectJ Record Document purposes. Post changes and modifications to hoject Record Documents as they occur; do not wait until the end of Project.a f B. Maintenance of Record Documents and Samples: Store Record Documents and Samples in the field office apart from the Contract Documents used for construction. Do not use Project I Record Documents for construction purposes. Maintain Record Documents in good order and t in a clean, dry, legible condition, protected from deterioration and loss. Provide access to- Project Record Documents for Architect's reference during normal working hours. lt.r? ENDoFSECTIoNorT8I -'I II, I I' I i 3 I h rl I I PRoTECTRECoRDDocT.JMENTSI 01781 - 3 - 20021501.08 vAIL MoINTIAN LoDGE 3tzt/2004 rl a SECTION 01782 - OPERATION ANDMAINTENANCE DATA -\I PART I - GENERAL Il, I.I STJMMARY I A. This Section includes adminisfative and procedural requirements for preparing operation and 't maintenance manuals, including the following: fr I l. Emergency manuals.t 2. Operation manuals for systerns, subsystems, and equipment.3. Maintenance manuals for the care and maintenance of Droducts. materials. frnishes .r systems and equipment. -B. See Divisions 2 through 16 Sections for specific operation and maintenance manual t requirements for the Work in those Sections.r! i 1.2 SUBMITTAIS t A. Manual: Submit one copy of each manudl in final form at least 15 days before final inspection. Architect will return copy with cornments within 15 days after final inspection. l. Correct or modiff each manual to comply with Architect's comments. Submit 2 copies of each corrected manual within 15 days of receipt of Architect's comments. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MANUALS. GENERAL I A. Organization: Unless otherwise indicated, organize each manual into a separate section for each|l system and subsystern, and a separate section for each piece of equipment not part ofa system. Each manual shall contain a title page, table ofcontents, and manual contents. I B. Title Page: Enclose title page in transparent plastic sleeve. Include the following information: l. Subject matter included in manual.2. Name and address of Project. 3. Name and ad&ess of Owner.4. Date of submiftal. 5. Name, address, and telephone number of Contractor.6. Name and address of Architect. a, 7 . Cross-reference to related systems in other operation and maintenance manuals. f C. Table of Contents: List each product included in manual, identified by product name, indexed to the content of the volume, and cross-referenced to Specification Section number in Project Manual. I I I I OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE DATA 01782 - 1 2002r50l.08 3/2U2004 Manual Contenls: Organize into sets of manageable size. Arrange contents alphabetically by system, subsystem, and equipment. If possible, assemble instructions for subsystems, equipment, and components of one system into a single binder. l. Binders: Heavy-duty, 3-ring vinyl-covered, looseJeaf binders, in thickness necessary to accommodate contents, sized to hold 8-l/2-by-ll-inch (215-by-280-mm) paper; with clear plastic sleeve on spine to hold label describing contents and with pockets inside covers to hold folded oversize sheets. a. Identiff each binder on front and spine, with printed title "OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE MANUAL," Project title or name, and subject mattef, of contents. Indicate volume number for multiple-volume sets. 2. Dividers: Heavy-paper dividers with plastic-covered tabs for each section. Mark each tab to indicate contents. krclude typed list of products and major components of equipment included in the section on each divider, cross-referenced to Specification Section number and title of hoject Manual. 3. Protective Plastic Sleeves: Transparent plastic sleeves designed to enclose diagrostic software diskettes for computerized elechonic equipmant. 4. Drawings: Attach reinforced, pwched binder tabs on drawings and bind with text. a. If oversize drawings are necessary, fold drawings to same size as text pages and use as foldouts b. If drawings are too large to be used as foldouts, fold and place drawings in labeled anvelopes and bind envelopes in rear of manual. At appropriate locations in manual, insert typewritten pages indicating drawing titles, descriptions of contents, and drawing locations. EMERGENCYMANUALS Content: Organize manual into a separate section for type of emergency, emergency instructions, and emergency procedures. Type of Emergency: Where applicable for each type of emergency indicated below, include instructions and procedures for each system, subsystem, piece of equipment, and component for fire, flood, gas lealg water leak, power failure, water outage, equipment failure, and chemical release or spill. Emergency Insfuctions: Describe and explain warnings, houble indications, error messages, and similar codes and sigrals. Include responsibilities of Owner's operating personnel for notification of Installer, supplier, and manufacturer to maintain warranties. Emergency Procedures: lnclude instructions on stopping, shutdown instructions for each type of emergency, operating instructions for conditions outside normal operating limits, and required sequences for electric or electronic systems. VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE D. 2.2 B. c. D. OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE DATA 01782 -2 VAIL MOI-INTIAN LODGE 3l2t/2004 II . 2.3 OPERATIONMANUALS I A. Content: In addition to requirements in this Section, include operation data required in t individual Specification Sections and equipment descriptions, operating standards, operating procedures, operating logs, wiring and control diagrams, and license requirements.I I B. Descriptions: Include the following: l. Product name and model number. 2. Manufacturer'sname. 3. Equipment identification with serial number of each component.4. Equipment function. 5. Operatingcharacteristics. 6. Limitingconditions.7. Performance curves. 8. Engineering data and tests. 9 . Complete nomenclature and number of replacement parts. C. Operating Procedures: Include stad-up, break-in, and control procedures; stopping and normal shutdown instructions; routine, normal, s'easonal, and weekend operating instructions; and ^ required sequences for electric or electronic systems. t D. Systems and Equipment Controls: Describe the sequence of operation, and diagram contr.ols as installed. I I E. Piped Systems: Diagram piping as installed, and identif color-coding where required for? identification. ' 2.4 PRODUCTMAINTENANCEMANUAL I A. Content: Organize manual into a separate section for each product, material, and finish. I Include source information, product information, maintenance procedures, repair materials and sources, and warranties and bonds, as described below. L I B. Source Information: List each product included in manual, identified by product name and arranged to match manual's table of contents. For each product, list name, address, and r telephone number of lnstaller or supplier and maintenance service agent, and cross-reference I Specification Section number and title in Project Manual. f C. Product Information: Include the following, as applicable: f l. Product name and model number.2. Manufacturer'sname. I 3. Color, pattern, and texture. fJ' 4. Material and chemical composition. 5. Reordering information for specially manufactured products. I D. Maintenance Procedures: Include manufacturer's written recommendations and inspection procedures, types of cleaning agents, methods of cleaning, schedule for cleaning and maintenance, and repair instructions. I 2oo2l5or.o8 I I oPERATIoNANDMAINTENANCEDATA 0t782 - 3 2002150r.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 E. Repair Materials and Sources: Include lists of materials and local sources of materials and related services. F. Warranties and Bonds: Include copies of warranties and bonds and lists of circumstances and conditions that would affect validiW of warranties or bonds. 2.5 SYSTEMS AND EQUIPMENT MAINTENANCEMANUAL C. Content: For each system, subsystem, and piece of equipment not part of a system, include source information, manufacturers' maintenance documentation, maintenance procedures, maintenance and service schedules, spare parts list and source information, maintexance seryice contracts, and warranty and bond information, as described below. Source Information: List each system, subsystem, and piece of equipment included in manual, identified by product name and arranged to match manual's table of contents. For each product, list name, address, and telephone number oflnstaller or supplier and maintenance service agent, and cross-reference Specification Section number and title in Project Manual. Manufachrers' Maintenancc Documentation: Manufacfurers' maintenance documentation including maintenance instructions, drawings and diagrams for maintenance, nomenclature of parts and components, and recommended spare parts for each component part or piece of equlpment: Maintenance Procedures: Include test and inspection insfuctions, houbleshooting guide, disassembly instructions, and adjusting instructions, and demonstration and taining videotape if available, that detail essential maintelance procedures: Maintenance and Service Schedules: Include service and lubrication requirements, list of required lubricants for equipment, and separate schedules for preventive and routine maintenance and service with standard time allotment. Spare Parts List and Source Information: Include lists of replacemcnt and repair parts, with parts identified and cross-referenced to manufacturers' maintenance documentation and local sources of maintenance materials and related services. F, G. Maintenance Service Contacts: Include copies of maintenance agreements with name and telephone number of service agent. Warranties and Bonds: Include copies of warranties and bonds and lists of circumstances and conditions that would affect validitv of warranties or bonds. PART 3 - EXECUTION MANUAL PREPARATION Emergency Manual: Assemble a complete set of emergency information indicating procedures for use by emergency personnel and by Ovmer's operating personnel for types of emergencies indicated. I I I ,l Tl I Il I I I t I T I I g I B. D. E. 3.1 OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE DATA 0t782 - 4 I B. c. D. F. I I t I I I I I I T t I I I I I I I 20021501.08 and maintenance documentation. END OF SECTION 01782 VAIL MOTJNTTAN LODGE Producl Maintenance Manual: Assemble a complete set of maintenance data indicating care and maintenance of each product, material, and finish incorporated into the Work. Operation and Maintenance Manuals: Assemble a complete set of operation and maintenance data indicating operation and maintenance ofeach system, subsystern, and piece of equipment not part of a system. Manufacturers' Data: Where manuals contain manufacturers' standard printed data, include only sheets pertinent to product or component installed. Mark each sheet to identifu each product or component incorporated into the Work. If data include more than one itern in a tabular format, identi$ each item using appropriate references from the Contract Documents. Identiff data applicable to the Work and delete references to information not applicable. Drawings: Prepare drawings supplementing manufacturers' printed data to illustrate the relationship of component parts of equipment and systems and to illusfrate control sequence and flow diagrams. Coordinate these drawings with information contained in Record Drawings to ensute corect illustation of completed installation. l. Do not use original Project Record Documents as part of operation and maintenance manuals. Comply with Division I Section "Closeout Procedures" for schedule for submitting operation 3t2u2004 OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE DATA 01782 - 5 I 2oo2l5or.o8 I SECTION OI 820 - DEMONSTRATION AND TRAINING!ht- v PART l -GENERAL r. I.I SUMMARY I A. This Section includes administrative and procedural requirements for instructing Owner'sIt personnel, including the following: t 1. Demonstration of operation of systerns, subsystems, and equipment.2. Training in operation and maintenance of systems, subsystems, and equipmart. I B. See Divisions 2 through 16 Sections for specific requirements for demonstation and training I for products in those Sections. ,l rJ 1.2 SUBMTTTALS I A. lnstruction Proglam: Submit two copies of outline of instructional progam for demonstration I and haining, including a schedule of proposed dates, times, length of instruction time, and! instructors' names for each training module. Include leaming objective and outline for each haining module. a' J ^. 1.3 QUALITYASSURANCE I A. Facilitator Qualifications: A firm or individual experienced in training or educating maintenance personnel in a training program similar in content and extent to that indicated for this Project, and whose work has resulted in training or education with a record of successful learning performanc e. I B. lnstructor Qualifications: A factory-authorized service representative, complying with I requirernents in Division I Section 'Quality Requirements," experienced in operation andu maintenance procedures and training. I C. Preinstruction Conference: Conduct conference at Project site. Review methods and procedures I related to demonsfiation and training. I D. Coordinate content of training modules with content of approved emergency, operation, and I maintenance manuals. Do not submit instruction program until operation and maintenance data has been reviewed and approved by Architect. VAILMOT]NTIAN LODGE 3tzr/2004 t t t 1 I. DEMoNSTRATIoN AND TRAINING 01820 - l 2002150r -08 PART 2 -PRODUCTS I I I t I I t fi I I I T t I l, I I I I B. B. 2.1 3.1 VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE 3/21/2004 INSTRUCTION PROGRAM Program Structure: Develop an instruction program that includes individual training modules for each systern and equipment not part of a system, as required by individual Specification Sections. Training Modules: Develop a leaming objective and teaching outline for each module. lnclude a description of specific skills and knowledge that participant is expected to master. For each module, include instruction for the following: l. Basis of System Design, Operational Requirernents, and Criteria: Include system and equipment descriptions, operating standards, regulatory requirements, equipment function, operating characteristics, limiting conditions, and performance curv€s.2. Documentation: Review emergency, operations, and maintenance manuals; Project Record Documents; identification systems; warranties and bonds; and maintenance service agreements. 3. Emergencics: lnclude instructions on stopping; shutdown instruc.tions; operating instructions for conditions outside normal operating limits; instructions on meaning of warnings, touble indications, and error messages; and required sequences for electric'or electronic systems. 4. Operations: Include startup, break-in, control, and safety procedures; stopping and normal shutdown instructions; routine, normal, seasonal, and weekend operating instructions; operating procedures for emergencies and equipmenl failure; and required sequences for electric or electronic systems.5. Adjustments: Include aligrments and checking, noise, vib'ration, economy, and effi ciency adjustments. 6. Troubleshooting: lnclude diagnostic instructions and test and inspection procedures.7. Maintenance: Include inspection procedures, types of cleaning agents, methods of cleaning, procedures for preventive and routine maintenance, and instruction on use of special tools. 8. Repairs: Include diagrrosis, repair, and disassembly instructions; instructions for identifuing parts; and review of spare parts needed for operation and maintenance. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTRUCTION Facilitator: Engage a qualified facilitator to prepare instruction program and training modules, to coordinate instructors, and to coordinate between Contractor and Owner for number of pailicipants, instruction times, and location. Engage qualified instructors to instruct Owner's personnel to adjust, operate, and maintain systems, subsystems, and equipment not part of a system. l. Owner will fumish an instructor to describe Owner's operational philosophy. DEMONSTRATION AND TRAINING 01820 -2 I I 2oo2r5or.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2V2004 I C. Scheduling: Provide instruction at mutually agreed on times. For equipment that requires seasonal operation, provide similar instruction at start ofeach season. l. Schedule training with Owner with at least seven days'advance notice. I D. Evaluation: At conclusion of each training module, assess and document each participant's ] mastery of module by use ofa dernonstration performance-based test. I ENDoFsEcrroNols2o I I I t I I I I I I I I I DEMoNSTRATIoNANDTRAINING 01820 - 3 I gl mffi#i;,, I Y =':1"'"'REQUEST FOR INTERPRETATIONt;R.F.l- Number: From:I I Re: To: A"/E Project Number: Contract For: t Specification Section: Paragaph; Dawing Reference: Detail: I Request: I I I Signedby:Date: I I I I I I I t I Response: fl Attachments Response Frorn To:Date Rec'd:Date Ret'd: Signed by: copies: Iowner Dconsultants O- tr- tr- fl- Erit" Copynght 1994, Construction Specifications lnstitute, Page of 601 Madison Stlcet, AlexaDdria, VA 22314-1791 July 1994 CSI Ftrm !3.24 I I Il I t I I T I I t t I I I t T I x<a v-1 >\F v) $ o. Eo\ =F =F*: rE i.i'5N P<,6> 'E -= EF E-6-q< XE96 FE5,;tR>(J-s€ 3ii tr tr tr tr fl tr tr tr 14 E o(J tr - tr iio O (, tn it).c| z () -ae D !),o E z oE tu o c) l|, IJ t/) o o a.E, a I a)g o !, (u (h (, o F a, J o It)v, tlv) ziiE,9'aE ,:. 9€EE6 (l o c(l, .tA j-i. x<5<'F o.F 7u)7- Qa&4arI]3-r) Ft<tr.y i---)-AZ.-tH< AHF-\ r-'t--a- *. f- s E.s FEg-to:rot--\ F tt) T t I t I I I l I I l I I I I t I I T Date \ame ol Purchaser (.'ompanl.' of Purchaser Street Address of Purchaser Cit) , Slate and ZIP oi'Purchaser Re: Elechonic Files Pro.1r"'ct Namc Architect's Project No. \\\x\\ \\ Dear Name: At your request, Znhren and Associates. Inc., will provide Electronic Files for your convenience and use in the preparation ofdesign-build drarvrngs related to lProjecr Nanrel, subject to the following terms and conditions of this Agreement: Zetren and Associates', Inc., Electronic Files were produced and are compatible with AuloCAD Release 2000 software, and 32mb RAM, 256 mhz cpu (minimum) hardware. Zehren and Associates, Inc., makes no repres€ntation as to the compalibility of these frles with your hardware or software. Data contained on these electronic files is part of T,ebren and Associates, lnc., Instruments of Service and shall not be used by you or anyone else receiving this data for any purpose other than as a convenience in the preparation of design-build drawings for [Project Name]. Any other use or reuse by you or others will be at your sole risk and without liability or legal exposure to Zehren and Associates, Inc. You agree to make no claim and hereby waive, to the fullest extent psrmitted by law, any claim or cause of action of any nature against Zehren and Associates, Inc., its officers, directors, employees, agents, or sub- consultants which may arise out of or in connection with your use of these Electronic Files. Furthermore, you shall, to the fullest exteat permitted by law, indemnifi and hold harmless Zehren and Associates, hc., from all claims, damages, losses and expanses-including attomey's fees-arising out of or resulting from your use ofthese Electronic Files. These Electonic Files are not Contract Documeats. Significant differences may exist between these Electonic Files and corresponding "hard-copy" Contract Documents due to Addenda, Change Orders or other Revjsions. Zehren and Associates, Inc., makes no representation regarding the accuracy or completeness of the Electronic Files you receive. In the event that a conflict arises between the Contract Documents prepared by Zelren and Associates, Inc., and the Electronic Files, the Contract Documents shall govern. You are responsible for determining if any conflict exists. By your use of these Elechonic Files, you are not relieved of your duty to fully comply with the Contract Documents, including and without limitation, the need to check, confrm and coordinate all dimensions and details, take field measurements, verifr field conditions and coordinate your work with that of other contractors for the hoject in accordance with the Specifications. Because of the potential that the information presented on the Electronic Files can be modified, unintentionally or otherwise, Zetren and Associates, Inc., reserves the right to remove all indicia of its ownership and/or involvement from each electronic display. Zelven and, Associates, lnc., retains the rights to all intemally developed drawing and documentation standards contained within the Electronic Files exclusive of software. A service fee of $75.00 will be charged for the electronic hansfer ofeach file, regardless ofthe number of sheets, computer disks. cd-r disks; or electronic, intemet, or e-mail transfers. Any re-use of these files for projects other than [Project Name] is expressly prohibited under this Agreement, unless written approval is provided by Zehren & Associates, Inc. Under no circumstances shall delivery of the Electronic Files for use by you be deemed a sale by Zelrren and Associates, Inc., and Zehren and Associates, Inc., makes no warranties, either expressed or implied, of merchantability and fitness for any particular purpose. ln no event shall Zefuen aid Associates, Inc., be liable for any loss or profit or any consequential damages. Sincerely, ISignatorl] lTitlel Zeluen and Associates, Inc. This Agreemant Accepted By (Signature): Title: Date: I I I I t I I I l I I I t I I I I l ,I I 20021501.08 vArL Mor-rNTArN LoDGE i/z0tzo04! I SECTION 02230 - SrTE CLEARTNG I r PART l -GENERAL r I.1 SUMMARY--A. This Section includes the followine:I t l. hotecting existing hees shrubs groundcovers plants and grass to remain. 2. Removing existing trees shrubs groundcovers plants and grass. f| 3. Clearing and grubbing. | 4. Stripping and stockpiling topsoil. 5. Removing above- and below-grade site improvements. ;; 6. Disconnecting and capping or sealing site utilities. fJ 7. Temporary erosion and sedimentation conhol measures. I 1.2 MATERIALOWNERSHIPt A. Except for stipped topsoil or other materials indicated to remain Owner's property, cleared ,l materials shall become Contractor's property and shall be removed from Projecl site.! I 1.3 PROIECTCONDITIONS t- A. Traffrc: Minimize interference with adjoining roads, sbeets, walks, and other adjacent occupied I or used facilities during site-clearing operations. r 1. Do not close or obstruct streets, walks, or other adjacant occupied or used facilities | 2 ;,:1fi:ffi:::".1fi:r.,"#r#1ili:tH*:H,H#*?requiredbyauthoritiesf having jurisdiction. I B. Utility Locator Service: Notifi utility locator service for area where Project is located before ] site clearing. I C. Do not commence site clearing operations until temporary erosion and sedimentation control I measures are in place. I PART2-PRODUCTS I 2.r soILMATERTALSt A. Satisfactory Soil Materials: Requirements for satisfactory soil materials are specified in I Dvision 2 Section "Earthwork."r l I SITE CLEARING 02230 - | 20021501 .08 VAIL MOT]NTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 1. Obtain approved borrow soil materials off-site when satisfactory soil materials are not available on-site. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I PREPARATION A. Protect and maintain benchmarks and survey control points from disturbance during construction. B. Locate and clearly flag bees and vegetation to rernain or to be relocated. c. Protect existing site improvements to remain fiom damage during construction. l. Restore damaged improvements to their original condition, as acceptable to Owner. 3.2 TEMPORARYEROSIONANDSEDIMENTATIONCONTROL A. Provide temporary erosion and sedimentation contol measures to prevent soil erosion and discharge of soil-bearing water runoff or airbome dust to adjacent proper.ties and walkways, according to requirements of authorities having jurisdiction. B. Inspect, repair, and maintain erosion and sedimentation confiol measures during construction until permanent vegetation has been established. C. Rernove erosion and sedinrntation controls and restore and stabilize areas disturbed during removal. 3.3 TREE PROTECTION A' Erect and maintain ternporary fencing around tee protection zones before starting site clearing. Remove fence when construction is complete. B. Do not excavate within hee protection zones, unless otherwise indicated. C' Repair or replace trees and vegetation indicated to remain that are damaged by conskuction operations, in a manner approved by Architect. 3.4 UTILITIES A' Locate, identiff, discormect, and seal or cap off utilities indicated to be removed. I . Arrange with utility companies to shut off indicated utilities. B. Existing Utilities: Do not interrupt utilities serving facilities occupied by Owner or others unless permitted under the following conditions and then only after arranging to provide temporary utility services according to requirements indicated: T I I I I t I I l I t I t I I I I l I SITE CLEARING 02230 -2 I 20021s01.08 vArL MoIJNTATN LoDGE 3/z0t2oo4 | : il::?,;#::J$,[':,llilf,:JffilJi]ffi:ifi.,i.'..,T#iiy,,';ff1,',:l: r c' Removal of underground utilities is included in Division 2 sections covering site utilities.I I 3.5 CLEARINGANDGRUBBINGtr -tI A' Fill depressions caused by cleanng and grubbing operatlons with satisfactory soil material I unless further excavation or earthwoik is iniicated. I l' Place fill material in horizontal layers not exceeding a loose depth of g inches (200 mm), I and compact each rayer to a density equal to adiacent original ground. l 3.6 TOPSOL STRIPPING I A. Remove sod and grass before stripping topsoil. B' strip topsoil to whatever depths are encount€red in a manner to prevent intermingling withI underllng subsoil or other waste materials. c' Stockpile topsoil materials away. from edge of excavations without intermixing with subsoil. I crade ana.sliapeG$br;;rain surface-water. a;r.;i" prevent windblown dust. I 3.7 SITEIMPROVEMENTS Y A' Rernove existing above- and below-grade improvements as indicated and as necessary tol, facilitate new construction. - I 3.8 DrsPosAL I A' Disposal: Remove -surplus soil material, unsuitable topsoil, obstructions, demolished materials,and rraste materials including trash and o"utls, uil-r"gally dispose of them off owner,sI propertv. l' separate recyclable materj,als produced during site crearing from other nomecyclable I i:lifilhJff:e or stockpile without i"t"'.i-r,ie *ith other iraterial" unJ runrpo.t tr,"m I ENDoFSEcrroNo223o t I I SITE CLEARING I 02230_3 I I I I I I I I I I I I I I T I t I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 SECTION O23OO - EARTHWORK PART I -GENERAL 1.I SUMMARY A. This Section includes the following: l. Preparing subgrades for slabs-on-grade walks pavements lawns and grasses and exterior plants. 2. Excavatingandbackfilling forbuildings andstructures. 3. Drainage course for slabs-on-grade. 4. Subbase course for concrete walks and pavements. 5. Excavating and backfilling for utility trenches. 1.2 DEFINTTIONS A. Backfill: Soil material used to fill an excavation. l lnitial Backfill: Backfill placed beside and over pipe in a tench, including haunches to support sides ofpipe. 2. Final Backfill: Backfill placed over initial backfrll to fill a tench. B. Bedding Course: Course placed over the excavated subgrade in a bench before laying pipe. C. Borrow Soil: Satisfactory soil imported from off-site for use as fill or backfill. D. Drainage Course: Course supporting the slab-on-grade that also minimizes upward capillary flow of pore water. E. Excavation: Removal of material encountered above subgrade elevations and to lines and dimensions indicated. l. Authorized Additional Excavation: Excavation below subgrade elevations or beyond indicated lines and dimensions as directed by Architect. Authorized additional excavation and replacement material will be paid for according to Contract provisions changes in the Work. 2. Unauthorized Excavation: Excavation below subgrade elevations or beyond indicated lines and dimensions without direction by Architect. Unauthorized excavation, as well as remedial work directed by Architect, shall be without additional compensation. F. Fill: Soil materials used to raise existing grades. G. Structr:res: Buildings, footings, foundations, retaining walls, slabs, tanks, curbs, mechanical and electrical appurtenances, or other man-made stationary features constructed above or below the ground surface. EARTHWORK 02300 - I 2002 l50 r .08 VAIL MOIJNTTAN LODGE 3/20/2004 Subbase Course: Course placed between the subgrade and base course for hot-mix asphalt pavement, or course placed between the subgrade and a cement concrete pavement or a cement concrete or hot-mix asphalt walk. Subgrade: Surface or elevation remaining after completing excavalion, or top surface of a fill or backfill immediately below subbase, drainage fill, or topsoil materials. Utilities: On-site underground pipes, conduits, ducts, and cables, as well as underground services within buildings. PROJECT CONDITIONS Existing Utilities: Do not interrupt utilities serving facilities occupied by Owner or others unless permitted in writing by Architect and then only after arranging to provide temporary utility services according to requirernents indicated. PART 2 . PRODUCTS F. SOILMATERIALS General: hovide borrow soil materials when suflicient satisfactorv soil materials are not available from excavations. Satisfactory Soils: ASTM D 2487 Soil Classification Groups GW, GP, GM, SW, SP, and SM, or a combination of these groups; free of rock or gravel larger than 3 inches (75 mm) in any dimension, debris, waste, frozen materials, vegetation, and other deleterious matter. Unsatisfactory Soils: Soil Classification Groups GC, SC, CL, ML, OL, CH, MH, OH, and PT according to ASTM D 2487, or a combination ofthese groups. l. Unsatisfactory soils also include satisfactory soils not maintained within 2 percent of optimum moisture content at time of compaction. Subbase Material: Naturally or artificially graded mixtne of natural or crushed gravel, crushed stone, and nahral or crushed sand; ASTM D 2940; with at least 90 percent passing a l-ll2-inch (37.5-mm) sieve and not more than 12 percent passing a No. 200 (0.075-mm) sieve. Base Course: Naturally or artificially graded mixtwe of natural or crushed gravel, crushed stone, and natural or crushed sand; ASTM D 2940; with at least 95 p€rcent passing a I -ll2-inch (37.5-nrm) sieve and not more than 8 percent passing a No. 200 (0.075-mm) sieve. Engineered Fill: Naturally or artificially graded mixture of natural or crushed gravel, crushed stone, and natual or crushed sand; ASTM D 2940; with at least 90 percent passing a 1-l/2-inch (37.5-mm) sieve and not more than l2 percent passing a No. 200 (0.075-mm) sieve. Bedding Course: Nafurally or artificially graded mixture of natural or crushed gravel, crushed stone, and natural or crushed sand; ASTM D 2940; except with 100 percent passing a l-inch (25-mm) sieve and not more than 8 percent passing a No.200 (0.075-nrm) sieve. I tH. I. J. I I I t I I t I I t I l 1.3 I I I 2.1 B. D. G. I EARTHWORK 02300 -2 2.2 3.1 I I I I I I I T 3.2 3.3 I I I I I I I I T 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOLTNThN LODGE 3120/2004 Drainage Course: Narrowly graded mixture of [washed ]crushed stone, or crushed or uncrushed gravel; ASTM D 448; coarse-aggregate grading Size 57; with 100 Percent passing a l -l /2-inch (37.5-mm) sieve and 0 to 5 percent passing a No. 8 (2.36-mm) sieve. ACCESSORIES Waming Tape: Acid- and alkali-resistant polyethylene film warning tape manufachred for marking and identifoing underground utilities, 6 inches (150 mm) wide and 4 mils (0.1 mm) thick, continuously inscribed with a description of the utility. PART 3 - EXECUTION PREPARATION Protect sauctures, utilities, sidewalks, pavements, and other facilities from damage caused by settlement, Iateral movement, undermining, washout, and other hazards created by earthwork operations. Preparation of subgrade for earthwork operations including removal of vegetation, topsoil, debris, obstructions, and deleterious materials from ground surface is specified in Division 2 Section "Site Cle aring." Protect and maintain erosion and sedimentation contols, which are specified in Divisisn 2 Section "Site Clearing," during earthwork operations. EXCAVATION Unclassified Excavation: Excavate to subgrade elevations regardless of the character of surface and subsurface conditions encountered. Unclassified excavated materials may include roclg soil materials, and obstructions. No changes in the Contract Sum or the Contract Time will be authorized for rock excavation or removal of obstructions. l. If excavated materials intended for fill and backfill include unsatisfactory soil materials and rock, replace with satisfactory soil materials. EXCAVATION FOR STRUCTI.JRES Excavate to indicated elevations and dimensions within a tolerance of plus or minus 1 inch (25 mm). If applicable, extend excavations a sufficient distance from stuctures for placing and removing concrete formwork, for installing services and other construction, and for inspections. l. Excavations for Footings and Foundations: Do not disturb bottom of excavation. Excavate by hand to final grade just before placing concrete reinforcement. Trim bottoms to required lines and grades to leave sotid base to receive other work. H. B. I I EART}IWORK 02300 - 3 20021501.08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 3.4 EXCAVATION FOR WALKS AND PAVEMENTS A. Excavate surfaces under walks and pavements to indicated lines, cross sections, elevations, and subgrades. 3.5 EXCAVATION FOR UTILITY TRENCHES A. Excavate trenches to indicated gradients, lines, depths, and elevations. B. Excavate trenches to uniform widths to provide the following clearance on each side of pipe or conduit. Excavate trench walls vertically from trench bottom to 12 inches (300 mm) higho than top ofpipe or conduit, unless otherwise indicated. L Clearance: 12 inches (300 mm) each side of pipe or conduit. C. Trench Bottoms: Excavate and shape trench bottoms to provide uniform bearing and support of pipes and conduit. Shape subgrade to provide continuous support for bells, joints, and barrels of pipes and for joints, fittings, and bodies of conduits. Remove projecting stones and sharp objects along trench subgrade. l. Excavate frenches 6 inches (150 mm) deeper than elevation required in rock or other unyielding bearing material, 4 inches (100 mm) deeper elsewhere, to allow for bedding SUBGRADE INSPECTION Proof-roll subgrade below the building slabs and pavements with heavy pneumatic-tired equipment to identiff soft pockets and areas of excess yielding. Do not proof-roll wet or saturated subgrades. Reconstruct subgrades damaged by freezing temperatures, frost, rain, accumulated water, or construction activities, as directed by Architect, without additional compensation. UNAUTHORIZED EXCAVATION Fill unauthorized excavation under foundations or wall footings by extending bottom elevation of concrete foundation or footing to exca tion bottom, without altering top elevation. Lean concrete fill, witb 28-day compressive strength of 2500 psi (17.2 MPa), may be used when approved by Architect. 1. Fill unauthorized excavations under other constuction or utility plpe as directed by Architect. STORAGE OF SOIL MATERI,ALS Stockpile borrow soil materials and excavated satisfactory soil materials without intermixing. Place, grade, and shape stockpiles to drain surface water. Cover to prevent windblown dust. I I I I I I I j I T I I I I I T I l I B. 3.6 3.7 3.8 EARTHWORK 02300 -4 t I I t I I I I I I I l 20021501.08 3.10 A. B. 3.r 1 A. VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE l. Stockpile soil materials away from edge of excavations. Do not store within drip line of remaining trees. UTILITY TRENCH BACKFILL Place backfill on subgrades free ofmud, frost, snow, or ice. Place and compact bedding course on trench bottoms and where indicated. Shape bedding cours€ to provide continuous support for bells, joints, and barrels of pipes and for joints, fittings, and bodies ofconduits. Bacldll trenches excavated under footings and within 18 inches (450 mm) of bottom of footings with satisfactory soil; fill with concrete to elevation of bottom of footings. Concrete is specified in Division 3 Section "Cast-in-Place Concrete." Provide 4-inch- (100-mm-) thick, concrete-base slab support for piping or conduit less than 30 inches (750 mm) below surface of roadways. After installing and testing, completely encase piping or conduit in a minimum of 4 inches (100 mm) of concrete before bacldilling or placing roadway subbase. Place and compact initial bacldill of satisfactory soil, free of particles larger than I inch (25 mm) in any dimension, to a height of l2 inches (300 mm) over the utility pipe or conduit. l. Carefully compact initial backfill under pipe haunches and compact evenly up on both sides and along the full length of utility piping or conduit to avoid damage or displacement of piping or conduit. Coordinate backfilling with utilities testing. Place and compact final backfill of satisfactory soil to final subgrade elevation. lnstall waming tape directly above utilities, 12 inches (300 mm) below fmished grade, except 6 inches ( 150 mm) below subgrade under pavements and slabs. SOILFILL Plow, scariS, bench, or b,reak up sloped surfaces steeper than I vertical to 4 horizontal so fill material will bond with existing material. Place and compact fill material in layers to required elevations as follows: L Under grass and planted areas, use satisfactory soil material. 2. Under walks and pavements, use satisfactory soil material. 3. Under steps and ramps, use engineered fill. 4. Underbuilding slabs, use angineered fill. 5. Under footings and foundations, use engineered fill. SOIL MOISTURE CONTROL Uniformly moisten or aerate subgrade and each subsequent hll or backfill soil layer before compaction to wjthin 2 percent of optimum moisture content. 3/2012004 3.9 A. B. D. F. G. I I T I T t I EARTHWORK 02300 - 5 2002r 501.08 3.12 A. 3.13 A. B. 3.t4 A. B. B. VAIL MOIJNTI.AN LODGE 3t20t2004 l. Do not place backfill or fill soil material on surfaces that are muddy, frozen, or contain frost or ice. 2. Remove and replace, or scariry and air dry otherwise satisfactory soil material that exceeds optimum moisture content by 2 percent and is too wet to compact to specified dry unit weight. COMPACTIONOF SOIL BACKMLS AND FILLS Place backfill and fill soil materials in layers not more than 8 inches (200 mm) in loose depth for material cornpacted by heavy conpaction equipment, and not more than 4 inches (100 mm) in loose depth for material compacted by hand-operated tampers. Place backfill and fill soil materials evenly on all sides of stuctures to required elevations, and uniformly along the full length of each structwe. Conpact soil materials to not less than the following percentages of maximum dry unit weight according to ASTM D 698: l. Under structtnes, building slabs, steps, and pavements, scariff and recompact top 12 inches (300 mm) of existing subgrade and each layer of bacldill or fill soil material at 95 percent. 2. Under walkways, scarifo and recompact top 6 inches (150 mm) below subgrade and compact each layer ofbackfill or fill soil material at 92 percent. 3. Under lawn or unpaved areas, scariff and recomprt top 6 inches (150 rnm) below subgrade and compact each layer ofbacHill or frll soil material at 85 > percent.4. For utility trenches, compact each layer of initial and final backfill soil material at 85 percent. GRADING General: Uniformly grade areas to a smooth strrface, free of irregular strrface changes. Comply with compaction requirements and grade to cross sections, lines, and elevations indicated. Site Grading: Slope grades to direct water away from buildings and to prevent ponding. Finish subgrades to required elevations within the following tolerances: l. Lawn or Unpaved Areas: Plus or minus 1 inch (25 mm).2. Walks: Plus or minus I inch (25 mm). 3. Pavements: Plus or minus l/2 inch (13 mm). Grading inside Building Lines: Finish subgrade to a tolerance of l/2 inch ( l3 nrm) when tested with a l0-fbot (3-m) straightedge. SI]BBASE AND BASE COI.]RSES Place subbase and base course on subgrades free ofmud, frosl snow, or ice. On prepared subgrade, place subbase and base course under pavements and walks as follows: I I I I I T I T I I I I I I I I tEARTHWORK02300 - 6 I 2. t I I I I 20021 50 I .08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 Shape subbase and base course to required crown elevations and cross-slope grades. Compact subbase and base course at optimum moisture content to required grades, lines, cross sections, and thickness to not less than 95 percent of maximum dry unit weight according to ASTM D 698. 3.I5 DRAINAGE COT]RSE A. Place drainage course on subgrades free ofmud, frost, snow, or ice. B. On prepared subgrade, place and compact drainage course under cast-in-place concrete slabs- on-grade as follows: I . Place drainage course that exceeds 6 inches ( I 50 mm) in compacted thickness in layers of equal thickness, with no compact€d layer more than 6 inches ( 150 mm) thick or less than 3 inches (75 mm) thick. Compact each layer of drainage course to required cross sections and thicknesses to not less than 95 percent of maximum dry unit weight according to ASTM D 698. 3.16 PROTECTION A. Protecting Graded Areas: Protect newly graded areas from traffic, freezing, and erosion. Keep free ofhash and debris. B. Repair and reestablish grades to specified tolerances where completed or partially completed surfaces become eroded, rutted, settled, or where they lose compaction due to subsequent constuction operations or weather conditions. C. Where settling occurs before Project correction period elapses, remove finished surfacing, backfill with additional soil material, compact, and reconstruct surfacing. l. Restore appearance, quality, and condition of finished surfacing to match adjacent work, and eliminate evidence of restoration to greatest extent possible. 3,17 DISPOSAL OF SUPJLUS AND WASTE MATERIALS A. Disposal: Remove surplus satisfactory soil and waste rnaterial, including unsatisfactory soil, trash, and debris, and legally dispose ofit offOwner's property. END OF SECTION O23OO I I I I I I l I I T I I t I EARTHWORK 02300 -7 I 20021501.08 vArL MoLTNTTAN LoDGE 3t20/zoo4I .l I SECTTON 02620 - ST.JBDRAINAGE t PARTr -CENERAL I r.l suMMARY t A. This Section includes subdrainage systems for foundations.TI 1.2 SI.]BMITTALSl t A. Product Data: For drainage conduit, drainage panels, and geotextile fabrics indicated. I PART2-PRODUCTS I 2.r PIPTNGMATERTALS A. Refer to various application articles in Part 3 for applications of pipe, tube, fttting, and joining I materials. I I 2.2 DRAINAGE PIPES ANDFITTINGS I A. Perforated, PVC Sewer Pipe and Fittings: ASTM D 2729,bell-and-spigot ends, for loose joints. I 2.3 SPECIALPIPE COI]PLINGS I A. Description: ASTMC 1173. Rubber or elaslomeric sleeve and band assembly fabricated to I match outside diameters of pipes to be joined. | 2.4 CLEANOUTS I A. PVC Pipe: ASTM D 3034, PVC cleanout threaded plug and threaded pipe hub. I , 2.5 DRAINAGE CONDUIT I A. Pipe and Fittings: Perforated, smooth PVC complying with ASTM D 4216 and ASTM D2729. I 1. Size: 6 inches (152 mm) high by approximately 2-114 inches (57 mm) thick with a a minimumflowrateequaltoNPS4(DN 100)pipe. 2. Fittings: PVC with NPS 4 (DN 100) outlet connection. t 3. Couplings: PVC.r I I SUBDRAINAGE 02620 - | 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.INTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 SOIL MATERIALS Impervious Fill: Clay, gravel, and sand mixture. Drainage Fill: Washed, evenly graded mixture of crushed slone, or crushed or uncrushed gravel, ASTM D 448, coarse aggregate, Size No. 57, with 100 percent passing l-1/2-inch (37.5- mm) sieve and not more than 5 percent passing No. 8 (2.36-mm) sieve. GEOTEXTILE FILTER FABRICS Woven or nonwoven geotextile filter fabric of PP or polyester fibers, or combination of both. Flow rates range from I l0 to 330 gpm per sq. ft. (4480 to 13 440 [-/min. per sq. m) when tested according to ASTM D 4491. Available styles are flat and sock. PART 3 . EXECUTION EARTI{WORK Excavafing, tenching and backfilling are specified in Division 2 Section "Earthwork." SI.JBDRAINAGE SYSTEM APPLICAiIONS NPs 4 (DN 100) Piping: l. Perforated, PVC sewerpipe and fittings forloose, bell-and-spigotjoints. T 2.6 2.7 3.1 3.2 J.J 3.4 A. B.l I I T t I I I IIDENTIFrcATION Materials and their installation are specified in Division 2 Section installation of green waming tapes directly over piping. l. lnstall detectable warning tape over nonferrous piping and structures. "Earthwork. " Arrange for over edges of underground I I t T I I B. FOUNDATION DRAINAGE INSTALLATION Bottom Impervious Fill: Place impervious fill material on subgrade adjacent to bottom of footing after concrete footings have been cured and forms removed. Place and compact impervious fill to dimensions indicated, but not less than 6 inches (150 mm) deep and 12 inches (300 mm) wide. Drainage Fill: Place supporting layer of drainage fill over compacted subgrade to compacted depth of not less than 4 inches (100 mm). After installing drainage piping, add drainage fill to width of at least 6 inches (150 mm) on side away from wall and to top of pipe to perform tests. After satisfactory testing, cover piping to width of at least 6 inches (150 mm) on side away from footing and above top of pipe to within 12 inches (300 mm) of finish grade. Place drainage fill in layers not exceeding 3 inches (75 mm) in loose depth; compact each layer placed. ISUBDRAINAGE02620 -2 C. 3.5 I I I 1 I 2002 r s01.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2012004 l. Encase pipe with sock-style geotextile filter fabric before installing pipe. Connect sock sections with electrical tape. Fill to Grade: Place native fill material over compacted drainage fill. Place material in loose- depth layers not exceeding 6 inches ( I 50 mnr). Thoroughly compact each layer. Fill to finish elevations and slope away from building. PIPING INSTALLATION hstall piping beginning at low points of system, true to grades and alignment indicated, with unbroken continuity of invert. Bed piping with full bearing in filtering material. Install gaskets, seals, sleeves, and couplings according to manufacturer's written instructions and other requirements indicated. l. Foundation Subdrainage: Install piping pitched down in direction of flow, at a minimum slope of 0.5 percent and with a minimum cover of 36 inches (915 mm), unless otherwise indicated. 2. Lay perforated pipe with perforations down.3. Excavate recesses in trench bottom for bell ends ofprpe. Lay pipe udth bells facing upslope and with spigot end entered fully into adjacent bell. Use increasers, reducers, and couplings made for diflerent sizes or materials of pipes and fittings being connected. Reduction of pipe size in direction of flow is prohibited. Install PVC piping according to ASTM D 2321. PIPE JOINT CONSTRUCTION Join PVC pipe and fittings according to ASTM D 3034 with elastomeric seal gaskets according toASTM D2321. Join perforated, PVC pipe and fittings according to ASTM D2729, with loose, bell-and-spigot joints. Special Pipe Couplings: Join piping made of different materials and dimensions with special couplings made for this application. Use couplings that are compatible with and that fit botb pipe materials and dimensions. FIELD QUALITY CONTROL Testing: A{ter installing drainage fill to top of pipe, test drain piping with water to ensure free flow before backfilling. Rernove obstructions, replace damaged components, and repeat test until results are satisfactory. I I I I B. c. B. C. 3.6 3.7 I I I I I T I I I I SUBDRAINAGE 02620 -3 20021501.08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3.8 CLEANING A. Clear interior of installed piping and stnrctures of dirt and other superfluous material as work progresses. Maintain swab or drag in piping and pull past each joint as it is completed. Place plugs in ends ofuncompleted pipe at end ofeach day or when work stops. END OF SECTION 02620 SIJBDRAINAGE 02620 -4 I 20021501.08 vArL MoINTTAN LoDGE ilzorzoolr I -lI SECTTON 027sr - CEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT T PARTI -GENERAL I l.l sIMMARY! _ A. This Section includes exterior cement concrete pavement for the following:l ! l. Driveways and roadways. 2. Curbs and gutters. I 3. Walkways. fJ 4. Exterior Slabs on Grade -I r.2 STJBMTTTALS l A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated. B. Design Mixhres: For each concrete pavement mixture. I 1.3 QUALITYASSURANCE. I A. Manufacturer Qualifications: Manufacturer of ready-mixed concrete products who complies I with ASTM C 94lC 94M requirements for production facilities and equipment I B. ACI Publications: Comply with ACI 301, "Specification for Structural Concrete," unless t modified by requirements in the Contract Documents. I PART2-PRoDUCTSt' I 2.1 STEELREINFORCEMENT I A. Plain-Steel Welded Wire Reinforcernent: ASTM A 185. fabricated from as-drawn steel wire l into flat sheets. B. Deformed-Steel Welded Wire Reinforcement: ASTM A 497, flat sheet. I C. Reinforcing Bars: ASTM A 615/A 615M, Grade 60 (Grade 420); deformed.I D. Plain Steel Wire: ASTM A 82. as drawn. t E. Deformed-Steel Wire: ASTM A 496. I F. Bar Supports: Bolsters, chairs, spacers, and other devices for spacing, supporting, and fastening I reinforcing bars, welded wire reinforcernent, and dowels in place. Manufacture bar supports according to CRSI's "Manual of Standard Practice." I I CEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT 0275r - 1 2002 t 50l .08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3/20t2004 2.2 CONCRETE MATERIALS A. Cementitious Material: Use the following cementitious materials, of the same type, brand, and source throughout the Project: l. PortlandCement: AASHTOM 85,Type trwhite,560lbVcubicyard. 2. Ready Mix Concrete: AASHTO M 157. B. Aggregates: Provide aggregates from a single sourcel. Fine Aggregate: AASHTO M 6, 33-39% total. 2. Coarse aggregate: AASHTO M 80, size 67,357, or 467. C. Water: ASTM C94|C94M. D. Air-Entraining Admixture: ASTM C 2@. E. Chernical Admixtures: ASTM C 4941C 494M, of type suitable for application, certified by manufactruer to be compatible with other admixfures and to contain not more than 0.1 percent water-soluble chloride ions by mass of cemsntitious material. 2.3 FIBERREINFORCEMENT A. Synthetic Fiber: Monofilament or frbrillated polypropylane fibers engineered and designed for use in concrete pavement, complying with ASTM C I I16, Type III, liT to l-ll2 inches ( 13 to 38 mm) long. 2.4 CURINGMATERIALS A. Absorptive Cover: AASIIT0 M 182, Class 2, burlap cloth. B. Moisture-Retaining Cover: ASTMC l7l, polyethylene film or white burlappolyethylene sheet. Water: Potable. Evaporation Retarder: Waterborne, monomolecular film forming; manufactured for application to fresh concrete. Clear Waterbome Membrane-Forming Curing Conrpound: ASTM C 309, Type l, ClassB, dissipating. F. White Waterborne Membrane-Forming Curing Compound: ASTM C 309, Type 2, Class B. 2.5 RELATEDMATERIALS A. Expansion- and Isolation-Joint-Filler Srips: ASTMD 1751, asphalt-saturated cellulosic fiber or ASTM D 1752, cork or self-expanding cork. c. D. T I I I I I I t I I t I t I l t I T ICEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT 027sr -2 I 2002150r.08 vAIL MotrNTrAN LoDGE 3/2012004t I B. Color Pigment: ASTM C 979, synthetic mineral-oxide pigmarts or colored water-reducing I admixtures; color stable, free ofcarbon blaclg nonfading, and resistant to lime and other alkalis. r 2.6 CONCRETEMIXTURES a D-:pare design mixtures, proportioned according to ACI 301, with the following properties: I rr. rr( t I . Compressive Strength (28 Days): 3750 psi {27 .6 MPa). 2- Maximum Water-Cementitious Materials Ratio at Point of Placement: 0.48. | 3. Slump Limit: 4 inches (100 mm) - 4. Air Content: a. 5 percent for aggregates l" and larger. I b. 6percent foraggregates3l4".I c. 7 percent for aggregates l/2", d. 8 percent for aggregates 3/8".II B. Synthetic Fiber: Uniformly disperse in concrete mix at manufacturer's recommended rate, but not less than 1.0 lb/cu. yd. (0.60 kg/cu. nr). -. I C. Color Pigment: Add color pigment to concrete mixture according to manufacturels written rnstructions. If 2.7 CONCRETEMDqNG I A. Ready-Mixed Concrete: Measure, batch, and mix concrete materials and concrete according to f ASTM C 94lC 94M and ASTM C I I 16. Furnish batch certificates for each batch discharged and used in tlre Work. PART3 -EXECUTION ' 3.I EXAMINATIoN I A. Proof-roll prepared subbase surface below concrete pavements with heavy pneumatic-tired I equipment to identi$ soft pockets and areas ofexcess yielding. I 3.2 EDGE FORMSAND SCREED CONSTRUCTION I A. Set, brace, and secure edge forms, bulktreads, and intermediate screed guides for pavemenl to t required lines, grades, and elevations. Install forms to allow continuous progress of work and so forms can remain in place at least 24 hours after concrete placement. I B. Clean forms after each use and coat with form-release agent to ensure separation from concrete - without damaee. I I I CEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT 0275t -3 2002 I 501 .08 I I I I I A. J.J 3.4 B. c. D. VAIL MOLINTI-AN LODGE 3/20t2004 STEEL REINFORCEMENT General: Comply with CRSI's "Manual of Standard Practice" for fabricating, placing, and supporting reinforcement. JOINTS General: Form construction, isolation, and contraction joints and tool edgings true to line with faces perpendicular to surface plane of concrete. Constuct transverse joints at right angles to centerline, unless otherwise indicated. Construction Joints: Set construction joints at side and ead terminations of pavematt and at locations where pavement operations are stopped for more than one-half hour unless pavement terminates at isolation joints. Isolation Joints: Form isolation joints of preformed joint-filler strips abutting concrete curbs, catch basins, manholes, inlets, structures, walks, other fixed objects, and where indicated. Contraction Joints: Form weakened-plane contraction joints, sectioning concrete into areas as indicated. Constuct contraction joints for a depth equal to at least one-fourth of the concrete thickness. Edging: Tool edges of pavement, gutters, curbs, and joints in concrete after initial floating with an edging tool to a l/4-inch (6-mm) radius. Repeat tooling of edges after applying surface finishes. Eliminate tool marks on concrete surfaces. CONCRETE PLACEMENT Moisten subbase to provide a uniform dampened condition at time concrete is placed. Comply with ACI 301 requirements for measuring, mixing, transporting, and placing concrete. Deposit and spread concrete in a continuous operation between transverse joints. Do not push or drag concrete into place or use vibrators to move concrete into place. Screed pavemant surfaces with a straightedge and strike off. Commence initial floating using bull floats or darbies to impart an open textured and uniform surface plane before excess moisture or bleed water appears on the surface. Do not firrther disturb concrete surfaces before beginning hnishing operations or spreading surface treatrnents. FLOATFINISHING General: Do not add water to concrete surfaces during finishing operations. Float Finish: Begin the second floating operation when bleed-water sheen has disappeared and concrete surface has stiffened sufficiently to permit operations. Float surface with power-driven floats, or by hand floating if area is small or inaccessible to power rmits. Finish surfaces to true 3.5 t I t T I I I t I I I I t I 3.6 A. B. c. D. E. A. B, CEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT 0275t - 4 T I I 20021501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE planes. Cut down high spots and fill low spots. Refloat surface immediately to uniform granular texture. l. Burlap Finish: Drag a seamless strip of damp burlap across float-finished concrete, perpendicular to line of traffic, to provide a uniform, gritty texture. Medium-to-Fine-Textured Broom Finish: Draw a soft bristle broom across float-finished concrete surface perp€ndicular to line ofnaffic to provide a uniform, fineJine texture. Medium-to-Coarse-Textured Broom Finish: Provide a coarse finish by striating float- finished concrete surface l/16 to l/8 inch (1.6 to 3 mm) deep with a stiff-bristled broom, perpendicular to line oftraffic. CONCRETE PROTECTION AND CIiRING General: Protect freshly placed concrete from premature drying and excessive cold or hot temperafur€s. Comply with ACI 306.1 for cold-weather protection. Evaporation Retarder: Apply evaporation retarder to concrete surfaces if hot, dry, or windy conditions cause moisture loss approaching 0.2 lb/sq. ft. x h (l kg/sq. m x h) before and during finishing operafions. Apply according to manufacturer's written instructions after placing, screeding, and bull floating or darblng conqete, but before float finishing. Begin curing after finishing concrete but not before free water has disappeared from concrete surface. Curing Methods: Cure concrete by moishne curing, moisture-retaining-cover curing, curing compound or a combination of these methods. PAVEMENT TOLERANCES Comply with tolerances of ACI I l7 and as follows: 1. Elevation: 114 inch (6 mm). 2. Thickness: Plus 3/8 inch (10 mm), minus 1/4 inch (6 mm). 3. Surface: Gap below l0-foot- (3-m-) long, unleveled sfaightedge not to exceed l/4 inch (6 mm). 4. Joint Spacing: 3 inches (75 mm). 5. Contraction Joint Depth: Plus 1/4 inch (6 mm), no minus. 6. Joint Width: Plus l/8 inch (3 mm), no minus. REPAIRS AND PROTECTION Remove and replace concrete pavement that is broken, damaged, or defective or that does not comply with requirements in this Section. Protect concrete from damage. Exclude traffic from pavemenl for at least 14 days after placement. 3t20t2004 2. J. B. c. D. 3.8 3.9 I I I I I T I t I I I I t I I I CEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT 02751 - 5 2OO2I5OI.O8 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t2ot2oo4 I C. Maintain concrete pavement free of stains, discoloration, dirt, and other foreigrr material. I Sweep concrete pavement not more than two days before date scheduled for Substantial I Completion inspections. END OF SECTION 0275I CEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT 0275r -6 I 20021s0r.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDGE 3/20/2004! I t SECTIoN 02264 -IAVEMENTJoTNT SEALANTS I PARTI-GENERAL I r.l suMMARYI - A. This Section includes the following:lI I . Expansion and conhaction joints within cement concrete pavement. 2. Joints between cement concrete and asphalt pavement.II 1,2 SUBMITTALS I A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated. - B. Samples: For each tlpe and color ofjoint sealant required. t- t C. Product certificates. I D. Compatibility and Adhesion Test Reports: From sealant manufacturer. I I PART2-PRoDUCTS I - 2.t MANLJFACTURERS t A. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, products listed in other Part 2 I ardcles.I I 2.2 MATERLALS, GENERAL !A. Compatibility: Provide joint sealants, backing materials, and other related materials that are I compatible with one another and with joint substates under conditions of service and I application, as demonstrated by joint-sealant manufacturer based on testing and field expenence. I 1 m:fi "ru'J*,1T:ff;:l;:.:i.,jfi:l;T,:'fl:.Til*"#r#l'T,":"JJino.,.Tijoint-sealant-substrate tests and field tests. I B. Colors of Exposed Joint Sealants: As selected by Architect from manufacturer's full range. I I! PAVEMENTJOINT SEALANTS 02764 - It I I I I I I t t I I I t B. 2.3 2.4 2002r50I.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 COLD-APPLIED JOINT SEALANTS Type NS Silicone Sealant for Concrete: Single-component, low-modulus, neutral-curing, nonsag silicone sealant complying with ASTM D 5893 for Typr: NS. l. Available Products: a. Crafco lnc.; RoadSaver Silicone. b. Dow Corning Corporation; 888. Type SL Silicone Sealant for Concrete and Asphalt Single-component, low-modulus, neutal- curing, self-leveling silicone sealant complying with ASTM D 5893 for Type SL. L Available Products: a. Crafco Inc.; RoadSaver Silicone SL. b. Dow Coming Corporation; 890-SL. HOT-APPLIED IOINT SEALANTS Elastomeric Sealant for Concrete: Single-component formulation cornpllng with ASTM D 3406. l. Available koducts: a. Crafco Inc.; Superseal 444n77. b. Meadows, \rll. R., Inc.; Poly-Jet 3406. B. Sealant for Concrete and Asphalt Single-componenl formulation complying with ASTM D 3405. l. Available Products: ^. Koch Materials Company; Product No. 9005. b. Koch Materials Company; Product No. 9030. c. Meadows, W. R., Inc.; Sealtight Hi-Spec. C. JOINT-SEALANT BACKER MATERIALS General: Provide joint-sealant backer materials that are nonstaining; are compatible with joint subshates, sealants, primers, and other joint fillers; and are ap'proved for applications indicated byjoint-sealant manufacturer based on field experience and laboratory testing. Round Backer Rods for Cold- and Hot-Applied Sealants: AIITM D 5249, Type l, of diameter and density required to control sealant depth and prevent bottom-side adhesion ofsealant. Backer Sh-ips for Cold- and Hot-Applied Sealants: ASTM D 5249;Type 2; of thickness and width required to control sealant depth, prevent bottom-side adhesion of sealant, and fill remainder ofjoint opening under sealant. 2.5 I I I I I I A. B. PAVEMENT JOINT SEALANTS 02764 -2 B. c. D. E. F. 3.1 t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOI.INTIAN LODGE 3/20t2004 D. Round Backer Rods for Cold-Applied Sealants: ASTM D 5249, Type 3, of diameter and density required to control sealant depth and prevent bottom-side adhesion of sealant. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTALLATION Surface Cleaning of Joints: Clean out joints immediately before installing joint sealants to comply with joint-sealant manufacturer's written instuctions. Joint Priming: Frime joint substrates where indicated or where recommended in writing by joint-sealant manufactwer, based on preconstruction joint-sealant-substate tests or pnor experience. Sealant Installation Standard: Comply with recommendations in ASTM C I193 for use ofjoint sealants as applicable to materials, applications, and conditions indicated. Install backer materials to support sealants during application and at position required to produce optimum sealant movement capability. Do not leave gaps between ends of backer materials. Do not stretch, twist, puncfure, or tear backer materials. Remove absorbent backer materials that have become wet before sealant application and replace them with dry materials. Inbtall sealants at the same time backings are installed to completely fill recesses provided for each joint configuration and to produce uniform, cross-sectional shapes and depths relative to joint widths that allow optimum sealant movement capability. Tooling of Nonsag Sealants: Immediately after sealant application and before skinning or curing begins, tool sealants to form smooth, uniform beads of conliguration indicated; to eliminate air pockets; and to ensure contact and adhesion of sealant with sides ofjoint. Clean off excess sealants or sealant smears adjacent to joints as the Work progresses by methods and with cleaning materials approved by manufacturers of joint sealants and of products in which joints occur. END OF SECTION 02764 PAVEMENT JOINT SEALANTS 027& -3 I 20021501.08 vArL MouNTATN LoDGE 3r20t2004I t sEcTIoN 02780 - r.JNrT PAVERS I PART l -GENERAL I l.r suMMARYt A. This Section includes the followine:II l. Brick pavers set in aggregate setting bed. 2. Edge restraints for unit pavers.It 1.2 SI.JBMITTALS I A. Product Data: For eacb product indicated.'- r B. Samples: Showing the full range of colors, texhres, and pattems available for each type of unit t Paver indicated. l lnclude Samples of material for joints and accessories involving color selection. I 1.3 QUALTTYASSIIRANCE I A. Build mockups for each form and pattern of unit paver. l. Approved mockups may become part of the completed Work if wrdisturbed at time of Substantial Completion. I 1.4 PROJECTCONDITIONS I A. Cold-Weathet Protection: Do not use frozen materials or build on frozen subgrade or setting beds. I B. Weather Limitations for Bituminous Setting Bed: Install bituminous setting bed only when atmospheric temperature is above 40 deg F (4 deg C) and when base is dry. I C. Cold-Weather Requirernants for Mortar and Grout: Heat materials to provide mortar and grout temperatures between 40 and 120 deg F (4 and 49 deg C). Protect unit paver work against freezing for 24 hours after installation. t PART 2 - PRODUCTSl,!2.1 MANUFACTURERS I A. In other Part 2 articles where subparagraph titles below inhoduce lists, the following requirements apply for product selection: t I.JNTT PAVERS 02780 - I I T I I I I I I A. 2.2 2.3 20021s01.08 3t20/2004 1. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance wilh requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the manufactruers speci fi ed. COLORS AND TEXTURES Colors and Textures: Match existine. UNIT PAVERS Brick Pavers: Light-traffic paving brick; ASTM C 902, Clasr SX, Type I, Application PX. Provide brick without frogs or cores in surfaces exposed to view in the completed Work. 1 . Manufacturers: a. Robinson Brick Co, Denver, CO. b. Brick Inc., Denver, CO. c. LPS, Denver, CO. 2. Temporary hotective Coating: Precoat exposed surfaces of brick pavers with a ternporary protective coating that is compatible with briclq mortar, and grout products. ACCESSORIES Steel Edge Res$aints: Painted commercial steel edging 3/16 inch (4.8 mm) thick by 4 inches (100 mm) high, with loops pressed from or welded to face to receive stakes at 36 inches (900 mm) o.c., and steel stakes l5 inches (380 mm) long for each loop. l. AvailableManufacturers: a. BorderConcepts,Inc. b. Ryerson, J. T. & Son, Inc. Cork Joint Filler: Preformed strips complfng with ASTM D ll12,Typell. Cornpressible Foam Filler: Preformed strips cornplying with ASTM D 1056, Grade 2Al. AGGREGATE SETTING-BED MATERIALS Graded Aggregate for Base: Sound crushed stone or gravel complying with ASTM D 448 for Size No. 8. Geotextile: Woven or nonwoven polyester or polypropylene geotextile, with a permeability rating 10 times greater than that of subgrade soil and an apparent opening size small enough to prevent passage of fines from leveling course into base course. Sand for Leveling Course: Sound, sharp, washed sand compllng with gradation requirements ofASTM C 33 for fine aggregate. VAIL MOI.JNTAIN LODGE 2.4 I I I I I I I I I I B. C. 2.5 B. C. I II]NTTPAVERS 02780 -2 D. B. C. D. F. 3.1 3.2 I I I I I T I I I I I I 2002 r s01 .08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 Sand for Joints: Sharp, washed sand with 100 percent passing No. 8 11.l8-mrn) sieve and 95 percent passing No. l6 ( 1 .18-mm) sieve. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTALLATION, GENERAL Mix pavers from several pallets or cubes, as they are placed, to produce uniform blend of colors and texfures. Cut unit pavers with motor-driven masonry saw to provide pattern indicated and to fit adjoining work neatly. Use full tmits without cutting where possible. Joint Pattern: Match existing unit paver joint pattem. Tolerances: Donotexceed 1/16-inch (1.6-mm) unit-to-unit offset fromflushnor 1/8 inch in 24 inches (3 mm in 600 nrm) and 1/4 inch in 10 feet (6 mm in 3 m) fiom level, or indicated slope. Expansion and Control Joints: Provide joint filler as backirig for sealant-filled joints where indicated. hstall joint filler before setting pavers. Provide edge restraints as indicated. Install edge restraints before placing unit pavers. AGGREGATE SETTING-BED PAVER APPLICATIONS A. Compact soil subgrade uniformly to at least 95 percent of ASTM D 1557 laboratory density. B. Proof-roll prepared subgrade and correct deficient areas. C. Place aggregate base in thickness indicated. Compact by tamping with plate vibrator. D. Place geotextile over base course, overlapping ends and edges at least 12 inches (300 mm). E. Place leveling course and screed to a thickness of I to l-1/2 inches (25 to 38 mm), taking care that moisture content remains constant and densitv is loose and constant until oavers are set and compacted. F. Treat leveling base with soil sterilizer to inhibit growth of grass and weeds. G. Set pavers with a minimum joint width of i/I6 inch (1.6 mm) and a maximum of 1/8 inch (3 mm), being careful not to disturb leveling base. If pavers have spacer bars, place pavers hand tight against spacer bars. H. Vib'rate pavers into leveling course with a low-amplitude plate vibrator capable of a 3500- to 5000-lbf (16- to 22-kN) compaction force at 80 to 90 Hz. I. Spread dry sand and fill joints immediately after vibrating pavers into leveling course. Vibrate pavers and add sand until joints are completely filled, then remove excess sand. Leave a slight surplus of sand on the surface forjoint filling. I I I T I I I I.JNITPAVERS 02780 -3 t I I I I I I I T I I I I ! I I I I I 2002150 r .08 ENDOF SECTION 02780 VAIL MOI.JNTAIN LODGE 02780 -4I.]N]TPAVERS I 2002rs0r.08 vArL MouNTAIN LoDGE 3r20tz0o4I r sEcTIoN 02920 - LAWNS AND GRASSES T PART I -GENERAL I r.l sTJMMARYI A. This Section includes seedins. I 1.2 DEFINMONS 'lI A. Finish Grade: Elevation of finished surface of planting soil. I B. Manufactured Soil: Soil produced off-site by homoganeously blending mineral soils or sand I with stabilized organic soil amendments to produce topsoil or planting soil. C. Planting Soil: Native or imported topsoil, manufactured topsoil, or surface soil modified to I becomJtopsoil; mixed with soit amendments.I D. Subgrade: Surface or elevation of subsoil remaining after completing excavation, or top surface I of a fill or backfill immediately beneath planting soil. I r 1.3 SLJBMITTALS I A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated. I B. Productcertificates. C. PlantingSchedule: Indicatinganticipatedplantingdates. I 1.4 QUALITYASS{IRANCE I A. lnstaller's Field Supervision: Require Installer to maintain an experienced full-time supervisor on Prqject site whan planting is in progress. t B. Topsoil Analysis: Furnish soil analysis by a qualified soil-testing laboratory. I r.s LAwNMATNTENANCEI A. Begin maintenance immediately after each area is planted and continue until acceptable lawn is I established, but for not less than the following periods: I . Seeded Lawns: 60 days from date of Substantial Completion. I B. Mow lawn as soon as top growth is tall enough to cut. Remove no more than 40 percent of grass-leaf growth in initial or subsequent mowings. I LAWNS AND GRASSES 02920 -I I 20021501.08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3120t2004 SEED Seed Species: State-certified seed of grass species, as follows: I . Sun and Partial Shade: Proportioned by weight as follou,s: a. Low Grow Mix (supplied by Arkansas Valley Seed) containing 45% Sheep fescue, 35% Ephrain Crested Wheatgrass, and?0Yo Ruebens Canada Bluegrass. PLANTING MATERIALS Topsoil: ASTM D 5268, pH range of 5.5 to 7, a minimurn of 2 percent organic material content; free of stones I inch (25 mm) or larger in any dimension and other extraneous materials harmful to plant growth. l. Topsoil Source: Amend existing in-place surface soil to produce topsoil. Veriry suitability of surface soil to produce topsoil. Swface soil may be supplemented with imported or manufachrred topsoil from off-site sonrces. lnorganic Soil Amendments: l. Lime: ASTM C 602, Class T or O, agricultural limestone containing a minimum 80 percent calcium carbonate equivalent. 2. Sulfur: Granular, biodegradable, containing a minimum of 90 percent sulfur, with a minimum 99 percant passing through No. 6 (3.35-mm) sieve and a maximum l0 percent passing through No. 40 (0.425-mm) sieve.3. hon Sulfate: Granulated ferrous sulfate containing a minimum of 20 percent iron and 10 percent sulfur. 4. Aluminum Sulfate: Commercial grade, unadulterated. Organic Soil Amendments l. Cornpost: Well-composted, stable, and weed-free organic matter, pH range of 5.5 to 8.2. Peat: Sphagnum peat moss, partially decomposed" finely divided or granular texture, with pH range of 3.4 to 4.8. 3. Peat: Finely divided or granular texture, with pH rang;e of 6 to 7.5, containing partially decomposed moss peat, native peat, or reed-sedge peat and having water-absorbing capacity of I100 to 2000 percent. 4, Wood Derivatives: Decomposed, nitrogen-treated sawdust, grotmd bark, or wood waste; of uniform texfure, free ofchips, stones, sticks, soil, or toxic materials. Fertilizer: l. Bonemeal: Commercial, raw or steamed, finely ground; a minimum of I percent nitrogen and l0 percent phosphoric acid.2. Superphosphate: Commercial, phosphate mixture, soluble; a minimum of 20 percent available phosphoric acid. I t I I I T I T I I I I I I I t I T I 2.1 2.2 B. c. D. LAWNS AND GRASSES 02920 -2 E. A. B. 2.3 3.1 I I I I t t I I T I T I I I T I I I I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOI.INTAIN LODGE 3. Commercial Fertilizer: Commercial-grade complete fertilizer of neutral character, consisting of fast- and slow-release nitrogen, 50 percent derived from natural organic sources of urea formaldehyde, phosphorous, and potassium in the following composition: a. Composition: I lb/l000sq.ft.(0.45k8i92.9 sq.m)ofactualnitogen,4percent phosphorous, and 2 percent potassium, by weight. 4. Slow-Release Fertilizer: Granular or pelleted fertilizer consisting of 50 percent water- insoluble nitogen, phosphorus, and potassium in the following composition: a. Composition: 20 percent nitrogen, l0 percent phosphorous, and l0 percent potassium, by weight. Mulches: I . Snaw Mulch: Provide airdry, clean, mildew- and seed-free, salt hay or threshed straw of wheat, rye, oats, or barley. 2. Peat Mulch: Sphagrrum peat moss, partially decomposed, finely divided or granular texture, with pH range of 3.4 to 4.8. 3. Peat Mulch: Finely divided or granular texture, with pH range of 6 to 7.5, containing partially decomposed moss peat, native peat, or reed-sedge peat and having water- absorbing capacity of I100 to 2000 percent. 4. Compost Mulch: Well+ornposted, stable, and weed-free organic matter, pH range of 5.5 to 8. PLANTING SOIL MD( Planting Soil Mix: Mix topsoil with the following soil amendments and fertilizers in the following quantities: I . Ratio of Loose Compost to Topsoil by Volume: 1:2. PART 3 - EXECUTION LAWNPREPARATION Reseed all lawn or ttnf areas disturbed by construction. Newly Graded Subgrades: Loosen subgrade to a minimum depth of 8 inches (200 mm). Remove stones larger than 2 inches (50 mm) in any dimension and sticks, roots, rubbish, and other extaneous matter and legally dispose of them off Owner's property. 1. Apply superphosphate fertilizer directly to subgrade before loosening.2. Thoroughly blend planting soil mix off-site before spreading or spread topsoil, apply soil amendments and fertilizer on surface, and thoroughly blend planting soil mix. 3. Spread planting soil mix to a depth of 8 inches (200 mm) but not less than required to meet finish grades after light rolling and natural settlement. Do not spread if planting soil or subgrade is frozan, muddy, or excessively wet. 3/2012004 LAWNS AND GRASSES 02920 -3 I I I I I I I I I I I D. 3.2 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t20t2004 Finish Grading: Grade planting areas to a smooth, uniform surlace plane with loose, uniformly fine texture. Grade to within plus or minus l/2 inch ( 13 mm) of finish elevation. Roll and rake, remove ridges, and fill depressions to meet finish grades. Limit fine grading to areas that can be planted in the immediate future. Moisten prepared lawn areas before planting if soil is dry. Water thoroughly and allow surface to dry before planting. Do not create muddy soil. Restore areas iferoded or otherwise disturbed after finish gnding and before planting. SEEDING A. Sow seed at the rate of40 lbs. per acre. B. Rake seed lightly into top l/8 inch (3 mm) of topsoil, roll lightly, and watsr with fine spray. C. Protect seeded areas with slopes not exceeding 1:6 by spreading straw mulch. Spread unifornrly at a minimum rate of 2 tonVacre (42k9929 sq. m) to form a continuous blanket 1-1/2 inches (38 mm) in loose depth over seeded areas. Spread by hand, blower, or other suitable equipment. D. Protect seeded areas from hot, dry weather or drying winds by applying compost mulch within 24 horns after completing seeding operations. Soak and scatter uniformly to a depth of 3/16 inch (4.8 mm) and roll to a smooth surface. 3.3 SATISFACTORYLAWNS A. Satisfactory Seeded Lawn: At end of maint€nance period, a healthy, rurifon& close stand of grass has been established, free of weeds and surface irregula:ities, with coverage exceeding 90 percent over any l0 sq. ft. (0.92 sq. m) and bare spots not exc,eeding 5 by 5 inches (l25by 125 mm). B. Reestablish lawns that do not comply with requirements and continue maintenance until lawns are sati sfactory. END OF SECTION 02920 I t I t I I T I LAWNS AND GRASSES 02920 -4 I 20021501.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDGE 3t20/2004I t SECTION02930-EXTERTORPLANTS t PARrI -.ENERAL I l.l suMMARYr A. This Section includes the followins: | 1. rrees. 2. Shrubs. I 3. Ground cover. f| 4. Plants. I 1.2 DEFINITIONSI f A. Finish Grade: Elevation of frnished surface of planting soil. ! B. Manufactured Topsoil: Soil produced off-site by homogeneously blending mineral soils or sand with stabilized organic soil amendments to produce topsoil or planting soil. I C. Planting Soil: Native or imported topsoil, manufactured topsoil, or surface soil modihed to become topsoil; mixed with soil amendments.I I D. Subgrade: Surface or elevation of subsoil rernaining after completing excavation, or top surface ofa fill or backfill, before placing planting soil.r f I.3 SUBMTTTALS I A. Product Data: For each type ofproduct indicated.I B. Samples: Mineral mulch. I C. Product certificates. I D. Planting Schedule: Indicating anticipated planting dates for exterior plants. - E. Maintenance Instructions: Recommended procedures to be established by Owner for I maintenance of exterior plants during a calendar year. I 1.4 QUALITYASSURANCE I A. Installer Qualifications: A qualified landscape installer who maintains an experienced full-time supervisor on Project site when exterior planting is in progress. I B. Topsoil Analysis: Furnish soil analysis by a qualified soil-testing laboratory. I EXTERIORPLANTS 02930.1 I 20021501.08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3120/2004 hovide quality, size, genus, species, and variety of exterior plants indicated, complying with applicable requirements in ANSI 260.1, "American Standard for Nursery Stock." Preinstallation Conference: Conduct conference at Project site. DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Do not prune bees and shrubs before delivery. Protect bark, b'ranches, and root systems from sun scald, drying, sweating, whipping, and other handling and tying damage. Do not bend or bind-tie trees or shrubs in such a manner as to destroy their n.atural shape. hovide protective covering of exterior plants during delivery. Do not drop exterior plants during delivery. Deliver exterior plants afler preparations for planting have been completed and install immediately. If planting is delayed more than six hours after delivery, set exterior plants trees in shade, protect from weather and mechanical damage, and keep roots moist. WARRANTY Special Warranty: Warrant the following exterior plants, fcrr the warrant5r period indicated, against defects including death and unsatisfactory growth, except for defects resulting from lack of adequate maintenance, neglect, or abuse by Owner, or inciclents that are beyond Contractor's contol. l. Warranty Period fm Trees and Shrubs: One year from date of Substantial Completion.2. Warranty Period for Grormd Cover and Plants: Six months from date of Substantial Completion. MAINTENANCE Trees and Shrubs: Maintain during wananty period by pruning, cultivating, watering, weeding, fertilizing, restoring planting saucers, tightening and repairing stakes and guy supports, and resetting to proper grades or vertical position, as required to establish healthy, viable plantings. Spray as required to keep tees and shrubs free ofinsects and disease. Ground Cover and Plants: Maintain during warranty period by watering, weeding, fertilizing, and other operations as required to establish healthy, viable pkmtings. PART 2 - PRODUCTS EXTERIORPLANTS Tree and Shrub Material: Furnish nursery-grown tees and slurubs complying with ANSI 260.1, with healthy root systems developed by hansplanting or root pruning. Provide well-shaped, fully branched, healthy, vigorous stock free of disease, insects, eggs, larvae, and defects such as lnots, sun scald, injwies, abrasions, and disfigurement. l. hovide balled and burlapped hees and shrubs. I I I t I I I t I I T I C. D. 1.5 B. 1.6 1.7 I I T t I I I B. 2.1 EXTERIORPLANTS 02930 -2 B. C. D. B. C. D. 2.2 I t t I I I I I t I I t I I I t I I I 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOI'NTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 Ground Cover: Provide ground cover of species indicated, established and well rooted in pots or similar containers, and complying with ANSI 260.1. Annuals: Provide healthy, disease-free plants of species and variety shown or listed. Provide only plants that are acclimated to outdoor conditions before delivery and that are in bud but not yet in bloom. Perennials: Provide healthy, field-grown plants from a commercial nursery, of species and variety shown or listed. PLANTING MATERIALS Topsoil: ASTMD 5268, pH range of 5.5 to 7, a minimum of 2 percent organic material content; free of stones 1 inch (25 mm) or larger in any dimension and other extraneous materials harmful to plant growth. l. Topsoil Souce: Amend existing in-place surface soil to produce topsoil. Veriry suitability of surface soil to produce topsoil. Surface soil may be supplernented with imported or manufactured topsoil from off-site sources. Inorganic Soil Amendments : L Lime: ASTM C 602, Class T or O, agricultural limestone containing a minimum 80 percent calcium carbonate equivalent. 2. Sulfur: Granular, biodeg radable, containing a minimum of 90 percent sulfur, ivith a minimum 99 percent passing tbrough No.6 (3.35-mm) sieve and a maximum l0 percent passing through No. 40 (0.425-mm) sieve. 3. hon Sulfate: Granulated ferrous sulfate containing a rninimum of20 percent iron and l0 percent sulfir.4. Aluminum Sulfate: Commercial grade, unadulterated. Organic Soil Amendments: l. Compost: Well<omposted, stable, and weed-free organic matter, pH range of 5.5 to 8; moisture content 35 to 55 percent by weight; 100 percant passing tkough l-inch (25- mm) sieve.2. Peat: Sphagnum peat moss, partially decomposed, finely divided or granular texture, with a pH range of 3.4 to 4.8. 3. Peat: Finely divided or granular texture, with a pH range of 6 to 7.5, containing partially decomposed moss peat, native peat, or reed-sedge peat and having a water-absorbing capacity of I100 to 2000 percent. 4:. Wood Derivatives: Decomposed, nihogen-heated sawdust, ground barlg or wood waste; of uniform texfure, free ofchips, stones, sticks, soil, or toxic materials. Fertilizer: 1. Bonemeal: Commercial, raw or steamed, finely ground; nifrogen and l0 percent phosphoric acid.2. Superphosphate: Commercial,phosphatemixture,soluble; available phosphoric acid. a minimum of I percent a minimum of 20 percent EXTERIORPLANTS 02930 -3 2002 l 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 3. Commercial Fertilizer: Commercial-grade complete fertilizer of neutral character, consisting of fast- and slow-release nitrogen, 50 percent derived from natural organic sources ofurea formaldehyde, phosphorous, and potassium in the following composition: a. Composition: I lb/1000 sq. ft. (0.45 k992.9 sq. m) of actual nitogen,4 percent phosphorous, and 2 percent potassium, by weight. 4. Slow-Release Fertilizer: Granular or pelleted fertilizer consisting of 50 percent water- insoluble nihogen, phosphorus, and potassium in the foliowing composition: a. Composition: 20 percant nitrogen, l0 percen,t phosphorous, and 10 percent potassium, by weight. Mulches: l. Organic Mulch: Wood and bark chips. 2. Compost Mulch: Well-composted, stable, and weed-free organic matter, pH range of 5.5 to 8; moisture content 35 to 55 pef,cent by weight; l0t} percent passing thnough I -inch (25-mm) sieve. 3. Mineral Mulch: Rounded riverbed gravel or smooth-faced stone. a. SizeRange: 314 inch(I9 mm) maximum, 1/4 inch (6mm) minimum. b. Color: Readily available natural gravel color range. Weed-Control Barriers: Nonwoven Fabric: Polypropylene or polyester fabric, 3 oz.isq. yd. (l0l g/sq. m) minimum. Composite Fab'ric: Woven, needlc-punched pollpropylane subshate bonded to a nonwoven polypropylane fabric,4.8 oz./sq. yd. (162 g/sq.m). PLANTING SOIL MD( Planting Soil Mix: Mix topsoil with the following soil arnendments and fertilizers in the following quantities: 1. RatioofLooseComposttoTopsoilbyVolume: l:2. PART 3 - EXECUTION EXTERIOR PLANTING Bed Establishmart: l. Loosen subgrade of planting beds to a minimum depth of 8 inches (200 mm).2. Remove stones larger than 1 inch (25 mm) in any dinrension and sticks, roots, rubbisb and other extaneous matter and legally dispose of thefir off Owner's property. 3. Thoroughly blend planting soil mix off-site before spreading or spread topsoil, apply soil amendments and fertilizer on surface, and thoroughly blend planting soil mix. t I I t I F. I I I I t I I I I T T I T I l. 2. 2.3 3.1 EXTERIOR PLANTS 02930 - 4 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 4. 5. B. D. I I t I I I I I t I T I I I t I I I I 4. Spread planting soil mix to a depth of 8 inches (200 mm) but not less than required to meet finish grades after natural settlement. Do not spread if planting soil or subgrade is ftozen, muddy, or excessively wet. 5. Finish Grading: Grade planting beds to a smooth, uniform surface plane with loose, uniformly fine texture. Roll and rake, remove ridges, and fill depressions to meet finish grades. Trees and Shnrbs: l. Pits and Trenches: Excavate circular pits with sides sloped inward. Trim base leaving center area raised slightly to support root ball and assist in drainage. Do not further disturb base. ScariS sides ofplant pit smeared or smoothed during excavation. Excavate approximately three times as wide as ball diameter. 2. Set tees and slnubs plumb and in center of pit or tench with top of root ball I inch (25 mm) above adjacent finish grades. a. Balled and Burlapped: Remove burlap and wire baskets from tops of root balls and partially from sides, but do not remove from rmder root balls. Remove pallets, if any, before setting. Do not use planting stock if root ball is cracked or broken before or during planting operation. b. Place planting soil mix around root ball in layers, tamping to settle mix anil eliminate voids and air pockets. When pit is approximately one-half backfilled water thoroughly before placing remainder of backfill. Repeat watering until no more water is absorbed. Water again after placing and tamping final layer of planting soil mix. 3. Organic Mulching: Apply 3-inch (75-mm) avera5e thickness of organic mulch extending 12 inches (300 mm) beyond edge of planting pit or hench. Do not place mulch within 3 inches (75 nrm) of tnmks or stems. Tree and Shrub Pruning: Prtme, thin, and shape trees and shrubs according to standard horticulfural practice. Prune trees to retain required height and spread. Do not cut fee leaders; remove only injwed or dead branches from flowering trees. Prune shrubs to retain nafural character. Shrub sizes indicated are sizes after pruning. Ground Cover and Plant Planting: 1. Set out and space ground cover and plants as indicated. 2. Dig holes large enough to allow spreading ofroots, and backfill with planting soil. 3. Work soil arormd roots to eliminate air pockets and leave a slight saucer indentation around plants to hold water. Water thoroughly after planting, taking care not to cover plant crowns with wet soil. Protect plants from hot sun and wind; remove protection if plants show evidence of recovery from hanspl anting shock. Planting Bed Mulching: 1. Install weed-control barriers before mulching according to manufacturer's written instructions. Completely cover area to be mulched, overlapping edges a minimum of 6 inches (150 mm). EXTERIOR PLANTS 02930 - 5 2002 r 501.08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 2. Mulch backfilled surfaces of planting beds and other areas indicated. Apply 2-inch (50- mm) average thickness of mulch, and finish level with. adjacent finish grades. Do not place mulch against plant stems. Protect exterior plants from damage due to landscape operations, operations by other contactors and trades, and others. Maintain protection dunng installation and maintenance periods. Treat, repair, or replace damaged exterior planting. Remove surplus soil and waste material, including excess subsoil, unsuitable soil, tash, and debris, and legally dispose of them off Owner's property. END OF SECTION 02930 I I IF. G,I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I I EXTERIORPLANTS 02930 -6 I 20021501.08 vAIL MouNTTAN LoDcE 3t2otz004I I SECTIONO33OO - CAST.IN-PLACE CONCRETE I PART I.GENERAL I 1.1 suMMARYr A. This Section specifies cast-in place concrete, including, reinforcemant, concrete materials, I mixture design, placement procedures, and finishes.I t r.2 sr.rBMrTrALS A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated. I B. Design Mixtures: For each concrete mixture. C. Shop Drawings: For steel reinforcernart. f D. Material test reports and certificates. I I.3 QUALITYASSURANCE I A. Manufacturer Qualifications: A firm experienced in manufacturing ready-mixed concrete I products and that complies with ASTM C 94/C 94M requiranants for production facilities and equipment. t l. Xffi#ffi.:ff|r,:$ according to NRMCA's "Certification of Ready Mixed concrete I B. ACI Publications: Comply with the following unless modified by requirements in the Contract - Documents: I l. ACI 301, "Specification for Struchral Concrete," Sections I through 5. t 2. ACI I17, "Specifications for Tolerances for Concrete Construction and Materials." I PART2-PRODUCTS I 2J STEELREINFoRcEMENTr A. Reinforcing Bars: ASTM A 615/A 615M, Grade 60 (Grade 420), deformed. I B. Plain-Steel Welded Wire Reinforcement: ASTM A 185, plain, fabricated from as-drawn steel wire into flat sheets. t I CAST-IN.PLACE CONCRETE O33OO - 1 I 2.2 20021 50 r .08 C. C. VAIL MOI.]NTLAN LODGE 3120/2004 Bar Supports: Bolslers, chairs, spacers, and other devices for spacing, supporting, and fastening reinforcing bars and welded wire reinforcemert in place. Marrufacture bar supporls from steel wire, plastic, or precast concrete according to CRSI's "Manual of Standard Practice.', CONCRETE MATERIALS Cementitious Material: Use the following cementitious materials, of the same type, brand, and source, throughout Project: l. Portland Cement: As indicated in Structural Documents. a. FlyAsh: ASTMC618,ClassCorF. 2. Blended Hydraulic Cement: As indicated in Stn:ctural I)ocuments. Normal-Weight Aggregates: ASTM C 33, graded, As indicated in Stnrctural Documents. Water: ASTM C94|C94M andpotable. Air-Entraining Admixttne: ASTM C 260. Chemical Admixtures: Provide admixtr.nes certified by marrufacturer to be compatible with other admixtures and that will not contribute water-soluble chloride ions exceeding those permitted in hardened concrete. Do not use calcium chloride or admixtures containing calcium chloride. l. Water-Reducing Admixture: ASTM C 494lC 494M, Tlpe A.2. Water-Reducing and Retarding Admixhre: ASTM C 494/C 494M, Type D.3. High-Range, Water-Reducing Admixture: ASTM C 494lC 494M, Type F. Synthetic Fiber: Fibrillated polypropylene fibers engineered and desigred for use in concrete pavement, complying with ASTM C I I16, Type A\ U2to I -ll2 inches (13 to 38 mm) long. CIJRING MATERTALS Evaporation Retarder: Waterbome, monomolecular film fornLing, manufactured for application to fresh concrete. Absorptive cover: AASHT0 M 182, class 2, burlap cloth made from jute or kenaf, weighing approximately 9 oz./sq. yd. (305 /sq.m) when dry. Moisture-Retaining cover: ASTMC l7l, polyethylene film or white burlappolyethylene sheet. Water: Potable. Clear, Waterborne, Membrane-Forming Curing Cornpound: ASTMC309, Type l, ClassB, dissipating. I I I I I I I I t I I I B. C. D. E. F. 2.3 B. I I t I I D. E. I I CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 03300 - 2 I 2002150r.08 vArL MotrNTrAN LoDGE 3/2012004I I F. Clear, Waterborne, Membrane-Forming Curing Compound: ASTM C 309, Type l, Class B, I nondissipating, certified by curing compound manufacturer to not interfere with bonding of floor covering. I G. Clear, Solvent-Bome, Membrane-Forming Curing and Sealing Compound: ASTMC 1315, Type I, Class A. I H. Clear, Walerborne, Membrane-Forming Curing and Sealing Compound: ASTM C 1315, Type l, Class A. ! 2.4 RELATEDMATERIALS I A. Expansion- and Isolation-Joint-Filler Strips: ASTM D 1752, cork or self-expanding cork. I I 2.5 CONCRETEMD(TI.]RES A. Prepare design mixtures for each type and strength of concrete, proportioned on the basis of r laboratory trial mixture or field test data, or both, according to ACI 301 . r B. Proportion normal-weight concrete mixfure as follows: I '1. Minimum Compressive Strength: As indicated in Siructural Documents.ll 2. 'Maximum Water-Cementitious Materials Ratio: As indicated in Structural Documents. 3. Slump Limig As indicated in Sfuctural Documents I 4. Air Content: As indicated in Structural Documents. I 5. Air Content: Do not allow air content offoweled finished floors to exceed 3 percent. 6. Synthetic Fiber: Uniformly disperse in concrete mixture at manufactwer's recommended I rate. I II 2.6 FABRICATING REINFORCEMENT Ir- A. Fabricate steel reinforcement accordins to CRSI's "Manual of Standard Practice." . 2.7 CONCRETEMDilNG I A. Ready-Mixed Concrete: Measure, batch, mix, and deliver concrete according to I ASTM C 94/C 94M and ASTM C I I16, and turnish batch ticket information. I l. When air temperature is between 85 and 90 deg F (30 and 32 deg C), reduce mixing and I delivery time from l-l/2 hours to 75 minutes; when airtemperahre is above 90 deg F (32 deg C), reduce mixing and delivery time to 60 minutes. I I t I CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 03300 - 3 It I I I I I I t I I I I B. c. 3.1 3.2 J.J 20021 50 r .08 PART 3 - EXECUTION VAIL MOI.INTTAN LODGE 3t20t2004 FORMWORK Design, erect, shore, brace, and maintain formwork according to ACI 301 to suppofi vertical, lateral, static, and dynamic loads, and constuction loads that might be applied, until stucture can support such loads. Construct formwork so concrete members and strucfures are of size, shape, alignment, elevation, and position indicated, within tolerance limits of ACI I 17. Chamfer exterior corners and edges ofpermanently exposed concrete. EMBEDDED ITEMS Place and secure anchorage devices and other embedded itemsr required for adjoining work that is attached to or supported by cast-in-place concrete. Uise setting drawings, templates, diagrams, instructions, and directions fumished with items to be embedded. STEEL REINFORCEMENT General: Comply with CRSI's "Manual of Standard Practice" lior placing reinforcement. l. Do not cut or puncture vapor retarder. Repair damage and reseal vapor retarder before placing concrete. 3.4 JOINTS A. General: Construct joints true to line with faces perpendicular to surface plane of concrete. B. Construction Joints: Install so strength and appearance c'f concrete are not impaired, at locations indicated or as approved by Architect. 3.5 CONCRETE PLACEMENT A. Before placing concrete, veriff that installation of formworlg reinforcement, and embedded items is complete and that required inspections have been performed. B. Deposit concrete continuously in one layer or in horizontal layers ofsuch thickness that no new concrete will be placed on concrete that has hardened enor:gh to cause seams or planes of weakness. If a section cannot be placed continuously, provide construction joints as indicated. Deposit concrete to avoid segregation. l. Consolidate placed concrete with mechanical vibrating equipment according to ACI 301. C. Cold-Weather Placement: Comply with ACI 306.1. I t T t I t I CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 03300 - 4 D. A. B. D. C. 3.6 3.7 t I I I I I t I T I T I T t I I I T I 2002 l50l .08 VAIL MOLTNTIAN LODGE 3/20t2004 HofWeather Placement: Comply with ACI 301. FINISHING FLOORS AND SLABS General: Comply with ACI 302.1R recommendations for screeding, restraightening, and finishing operations for concrete surfaces. Do not wet concrete surfaces. Float Finish: Consolidate surface with power{riven floats or by hand floating if area is small or inaccessible to power driven floats. Restraighten, cut down high spots, and fill low spots. Repeat float passes and restraightening until swface is left with a uniform, smooth, granular texrure . l. Apply float finish to swfaces indicated to receive trowel finish and to be coverrd with fluid-applied or sheet waterproofing or built-up or membrane roofing. Trowel Finish: After applying float finish, apply frst howeling and consolidate concrete by hand or power-driven trowel. Continue troweling passes and reshaighten until surface is free of trowel marks and uniform in texture and appearance. Grind smooth any surface defects that would telegraph through applied coatings or floor coverings. 1. Apply a howel finish to surfaces exposed to view or to be covered with resilient flooring, carpet, paint, or another thin-film-finish coating system. 2. Finish and measure surface so gap at any point betweor concrete surface and an unleveled, freestanding, l0-foot- (3.05-m-) long itraightedge resting on 2 high spots and placed anyrvhcre on the surface does not exceed l /8 inch (3.2 mm). Trowel and Fine-Broom Finish: Apply a first towel finish to surfaces where tile is to be installed by either thickset or thin-set method. While concrete is still plastic, slightly scarif surface with a fine broom. l. Comply with flatness and levelness tolerances for howel finished floor surfaces. CONCRETE PROTECTING AND CTIRING General: Protect freshly placed concrete from premature drying and excessive cold or hot temperahres. Comply with ACI 306.1 for cold-weather protection and ACI 301 for hot- weather protection during curing. Evaporation Retarder: Apply evaporation retarder to unformed concrete surfaces if hot, dry, or windy conditions cause moisture loss approaching 0.2 lb/sq. ft. x h (l klsq. m x h) before and dwing finishing operations. Apply according to manufachuer's written instructions after placing, screeding, and bull floating or darbying concrete, but before float finishing. Crue concrete according to ACI 308.1, by one or a combination of the following methods: I . Moishre Curing: Keep surfaces continuously moist for not less than seven days.2. Moisture-Retaining-Cover Curing: Cover concrete surfaces with moisture-retaining cover for curing concrete, placed in widest practicable width, with sides and ends lapped at least 12 inches (300 mm), and sealed by waterproof tape or adhesive. Cure fornot less CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 03300 - 5 2002 I 501 .08 END OF SECTION O33OO VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE I t I I t I I T t I I I I I I I I I I B. 3.8 3.9 than seven days. Immediately repair any holes or tears during curing period using cover material and waterproof tape.3. curing compound: Apply uniformly in continuous olreration by power spray or roller according to manufacturer's written instuctions. Recoat areas subjected to heavy rainfall within three hours after initial application. Maintain continuit5r of coating and repair damage during curing period. a. After curing period has elapsed, remove curing compound without damaging concrete surfaces by method recomme'ded by curing co-pound manufacturer unless manufactwer certifies in writing curing compound will not interfere with bonding offloor covering used on I,roject. CONCRETE STJRFACE REPAIRS Defective Concrete: Repair and patch defective areas when approved by Architect. Remove and replace concrete that cannot be repaircd and patched to Architect's approval. FIELD QUALITY CONTROL Concrete Tests: Testing of composite samples of fresh concrete obtained according to ASTM C 172 shall be performed according to the following requirernents:l. Testing Frequency: obain at least one conposite sample for each 100 cu. yd. (76 cu. m) or fraction thereofofeach concrete mixhrre placed each day. a. When frequency of testing will provide fewer thm five compressive-strength tests for each concrete mixture, testing shall be conducted fiom at least five randomlv selected batches or from each batch if fewer than five arc used. Testing and Inspecting: Owner will engage a qualified independent testing and inspecting agency to perform field tests and inspections and prepare test r€ports. I. Testing Services: Tests shall be performed according to ACI 301. 3/20/2004 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 03300 - 6 I 20021501.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDcE 3t2o/2004I I SECTION 03542 - CEMENT-BASED TINDERLAYMENT I PART l -GENERAL I I.I RELATEDDOCUMENTSI A. Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementary I Conditions and Division i Specification Sections, apply to this Section.I I 1.2 ST]MMARY I A. This Section includes cement-based, polymer-modified, selfleveling underlayment for interior I finish flooring. I B. Related Sections include the following: I l. Division3 Section "Concrete Top,pings" for cementitious wear toppings applied overI base slabs. 2. Division 9 Sections for patching and leveling compounds applied with finish flooring. I C. Allowances: Furnish cement-ba'sed underlaymant under the allowances specified in Division I Section nAllowances." I D. Unit Prices: Administrative and procedural requirements for rmit prices are specified in Diyision I Section "Unit Prices." !- 1.3 SUBMITTALS I A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated.! B. Shop Drawings: Plans indicating substrates, locations, and average depths of cement-based I underlaynent based on survey of substrate conditions. ! I 1.4 QUALTTYASSURANCE I A. Installer Qualifications: An experienced installer (applicator) who is acceptable to I manufacturer, who has completed cement-based underlayment applications similar in material I and extant to that required for this Project, and whose work has resulted in construction with a record of successful in-service performance. I B. Mockups: Before installing underlayment, apply mockups to demonstrate qualities of materialsr and execution. Comply with the following requirements, using materials indicated for the completed Work: I 1. Architect will select one area or surface to represent surfaces and conditions for application on each substrate required. I I CEMENT-BASED UNDERLAYMENT 03542 - | 20021501.08 VAIL MOT]NTTAN LODGE 3t20t2004 Notify Architecl seven days in advance of dates and times when mockups will be applied. Obtain Architect's approval of mockups before starting underlayment application. Approved mockups may become part of the completed Work if undisturbed when finish floorins is installed. DELTVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Deliver materials in original packages and containers, with seals unbroken, bearing manufacturer's labels indicating brand name and directions for storage, mixing with other components, and application. Store materials to comply with manufacturer's written insfructions to prevent deterioration from moisture or other detrimental effects. PROJECT CONDITIONS Environmental Limitations: Comply with manufacturer'r; written recommendations for substrate temperahtre and moisture contert, ambient temperatrre and humidity, ventilation, and other conditions affecting underlayment performance. Close areas to traffic during underlayment application and for time period after application reconuEnded in writing by manufacturer. 1.7 COORDINATION A. Coordinate cement-based underlayment with requiremorts of hnish flooring products, including adhesives, specified in Division 9 Sections. 1. Before installing surface sealers recommended by underlayment manufacturer, if any, verifr compatibility with finish flooring installation adhBsives. PART2 -PRODUCTS 2.1 MANI.'FACTT]RERS A. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirernents, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: l. K-15 Self-Leveling Underlayment Concrete; Ardex, Inc. 2. Self-Leveling Underlayment; W. R. Bonsal Company. 3. 300 Premium Underlayment; Burke Group, LLC (The). 4. Conflow; Conspec Marketing and Manufacturing Co., Inc. 5. Levelayer I; Dayton Superior Corp. 6. Selby Self-Leveling Underlayment; Harris Specialty Chemicals, Inc. 7. Thoro Underlayment, Self-Leveling; Harris Specialty (hemicals, Inc.8. Levelex Underlayment; L&M Construction Chemicals, Inc. 9. Ulna/?lan MB; Mapei Corporation. 2. 3. t I I I T t t I I I I I I I I I I t I r.5 B. 1.6 B. CEMENT-BASED UNDERLAYMENT 03542 -2 I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 10. Level-Right; Maxxon Corporation. PRODUCTS AND MATERIALS Underlayment: Cement-based, polymer-modified, selfleveling product that can be applied in uniform thicknesses from l/8 inch (3 mm) and that can be feathered at edges to match adjacent floor elevations. 1. Cement Binder: ASTMC 150, podland cement, or hydraulic or blended hydraulic cement as defined by ASTM C 219. 2. Compressive Srengh: Not less than 4100 psi (28 MPa) at 28 days when tested according to ASTM C 109/C 109M. 3. Underlayment Additive: Resilient-emulsion product of underlayment manufachrer formulated for use with underlaymant when applied to substrate and conditions indicated. Aggregate: Well-graded, washed gravel, l/8 to l/4 inch (3 to 6 mm), or coarse sand as recommended by underlayment manufacturer. l. Provide aggregate when recommended in writing by underlayment manufacturer for underlayment thicloress required. Water: Potable and at a ternperature of not more than 70 deg F (21 deg C). Primer: Product of underlayment manufacfurer recommended in writing for subshate, conditions, and application indicated. PART3 -EXECUTION EXAMINATION Examine substates, with Installer present, for conditions affecting performance of underlayment including substate moishrre content. Begin underlayment application only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION General: Prepare and clean substrate according to manufacfurer's written instructions for substrate indicated. Provide clean, dry, neutral-pH subshate for underlayment application. l. Treat nonmoving subsbate cracks to prevent cracks frorn telegraphing (reflecting) through underlayment according to manufacturer's written recommendations. 2. Fill substate voids to prevent underlayment from leaking. Concrete Substrates: Mechanically remove laitance, glaze, efflorescence, curing compounds, form-release agents, dust, dirt, grease, oil, and other contaminants that might impair underlayment bond according to manufacturer's written instructions. t t t t I I I tI I 2.2 B. c. D. 3.1 I I I T I I 3.2 B. I t CEMENT-BASED LINDERLAYMENT 03542 - 3 20021s0r.08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3120t2004 C. Metal Substrates: Mechanically remove rust, foreign matter, and other contaminants that might impair underlayment bond according to manufacturer's written instructions. Apply corrosion- resistant coating compatible with underlayment if recommended in writing by underlayment manufacturer. D. Adhesion Tests: After substrate preparation, test substrate for adhesion with underlayment according to manufacturer's written instructions. 3.3 APPLICATION A. General: Mix and apply underlayment components according to manufacturer's written instructions. l. Coordinate application of components to provide optimum underlayment-to-subsfate and intercoat adhesion. 2. At substate expansion, isolation, and other moving joints, allow joint of same width to continue tlrough underlayment. B. Apply primer over prepared substrate at manufacturer's recommended spreading rate. C. Apply underlayment to produce miform, level sr.rrface. l. Apply a frnal layer without aggregate if required to produce smooth surface.2. Feather edges to match adjacent floorelevations. D. Cure underlayment according to manufactureds uniften instructions. Prevent contamination during application and curing processes. E. Do not install finish flooring over underlayment rmtil after time period recommended by underlayment manufacturer. F. Remove and replace underlayment areas that evidence lack of bond with substrate, including areas that emit a "hollow" sound when tapped. 3.4 FTELDQUATTTYCONTROL A. Slump Test: If slump testing is recommended in writing by nranufacturer, test underlayment for slump as it is placed for compliance with manufacturer's writl.en recommendations. 3.5 PROTECTION A. Protect underlayment from concenhated and rolling loads for remainder of construction period. END OF SECTION 03542 I I t T I I I I T I I I I I I t I I I CEMENT-BASED I.]NDERLAYMENT 03542 - 4 t 20021s0r.08 vAIL MouNTATN LoDGE 3/20/2004I T SECTION 04860 - STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES a PART l -GENERAL I l.l RELATEDDOCUMENTS r A. Drawings and ganeral provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementary I Conditions and Division I Specification Sections, apply to this Section. I 1.2 STJMMARY I A. This Section includes stone veneer in the following applications: I l. On concrete retaining walls.'r 2. Anchored to concrete backup. I 3. Anchoredtounitmasonrybackup. t 4. Anchored to cold-formed metal framing and sheathing. B. Related Sections include the followine:JI l. Division 3 Section "Cast-in-Place Concrete" for dovetail slots in concrete for anchoring stone veneer. I 2. Division 7 Section "Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim" for exposed sheet metal flashing. t 3. Division 9 Section "Stone Paving and Flooring." t C. Products installed, but not furnished, in this Section include the following: - 1. Steel lintels and shelf angles for stone veneer assemblies specified in Division 5 Section r "Metal Fab'rications." I . I.3 STJBMITTALS I A. Product Data: For each tpe of product indicated. I B. Stone Samples for Verification: For each color, grade, finish, and variety of stone required. t-C. Colored Mortar Samples for Verification: For each color required. It D. Qualification Data: For Installer. I 1.4 euALTTYASsTJRANCE.I A. Installer Qualifications: An installer who employs experienced stone masons and stone fitters I who are skilled in installing stone veneer assemblies similar in material, design, and extent to I those indicated for this Project and whose projects have a record of successful in-service - performance. I STONEVENEERASSEMBLIES 04860-1 r 20021501.08 3t20t2004 Source Limitations for Stone: Obtain each variety of stone, regardless of finish, from a single quarry with resources to provide materials of consisteat quality in appearance and physical properties. l. Obtain each variety of stone from a single quarry, whether specified in this Section or in another Section of the Specifications. Source Limitations for Mortar Materials: Obtain ingedients of a uniform qualify for each mortar component from a single manufacturer and each aggreg:rte from one source or producer. DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Store cementitious materials on elevated platforms, under cover, and in a dry location. Do not use cementitious materials that have become damp. Store aggregates where grading and other required characteristics can be maintained and contamination avoided. Deliver preblended, dry mortar mix in moishre-resistant containers designed for lifting and emptying into dispensing silo. Store prebloded, d4r mortar mix in delivery containers on elevated platforms, under cover, and in a dry location or in a metal dispelrsing silo with weatherproofcover. Store masonry accessories, including metal iterns, to prevert corrosion and accumulation of dirt and oil. PROJECT CONDITIONS Protection of Stone Veneer Assemblies: During constuction, cover tops of walls, projections, and sills with waterproof sheeting at end of each day's work. Cover partially completed stone veneer assemblies when construction is not in progress. l. Extend cover a minimum of 24 inches (600 mm) down both sides and hold cover securely in place. Stain Prevention: Immediately remove mortar and soil to prevent tbem from staining the face of stone veneer assemblies. l. Protect base of walls from rain-splashed mud and morlar splatter by coverings spread on the ground and over the wall surface. Z. Protect sills, ledges, and projections from mortar droppings. 3. Protect surfaces of window and door frames, as well asi similar products with painted and integral finishes, from mortar droppings. 4. Turn scaffold boards near the wall on edge at end of each day to prevent rain from splashing mortar and dirt on completed stone veneer assemblies. Cold-Weather Requirements: Do not use frozen materials or materials mixed or coated with ice or frost. Do not build on frozen subgrade or seffing beds. Remove and replace stone veneer I I I I I I I I ! I I t I I I ! T I I B. C. B. D. B. t.5 1.6 VAIL MOI.'NTAN LODGE STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 2 I 20021501.08 'AIL Mo'NTAIN LoDGE it2ot2004I I assemblies damaged by frost or freezing conditions. Comply with cold-weather construction f requirements contained in ACI 530.1/ASCE 6iTMS 602. f I . Cold-Weather Cleaning: Use liquid cleaning methods only when air temperature is 40 I deg F (4 deg C) and above and will remain so until masonry has dried, but not less than 7 days after completing cleaning. I D. Hot-Weather Requirements: Comply with hot-weather construction requirements contained in ACI 530.I/ASCE 6/TMS 602.tI PART2-PRoDUCTS II 2.1 STONE SOI]RCES I A. Varieties and Sources: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the following I stone varielies from one of the following sources: ,i'i 1. StoneTlpel: Granite MossRocktomatchexisting. rr 2. Stone Type II: Sandstone sills and coursing to match existing. I 2.2 MANIFACTTJRERS I A. In other Part 2 articles where zubparagraph titles below introduce lists, the following I requirements apply for product selection: l, l. Available hoducts: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be il incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the products specified.- 2. Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the products specified. N 2.3 STONEI U A. Match Architect's samples for variety, color range, finish, and other stone characteristics relating to aesthetic effects. I B. Granite Building Stone Standard: ASTM C 615. I C. Other Stone: Provide stone that complies with the following physical characteristics: tlr l. Maximum Absorption, by Weight 3 percent according to ASTM C 97. r 2. Minimum Compressive Snength: 7500 psi (52 MPa) according to ASTM C 170. -trI 1lI I J STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 3 I 2.4 20021 501 .08 2.5 VENEERANCHORS A. Materials: VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 MORTAR MATERIALS Portland Cement: ASTM C 150, Type I or II, except Type III may be used for cold-weather consfuctjon. Provide natural color or white cement as required to produce mortar color indicated. l. Low-Alkali Cement: Not more than 0.60 percent total alkali when tested according to ASTM C I14. Hydrated Lime: ASTM C 207, Type S. Portland Cement-Lime Mix: Packaged blend of portland cement complying with ASTM C 150, Type I or III, and hydrated lime complying with ASTM C 207. Aggregate: ASTM C 144 and. as follows: 1. For pointing mortar, use aggregate graded with 100 percent passing No. 16 (1.18-mm) sieve. Mortar Pigmants: Natural or synthetic iron oxides, compounded for use in mortar mixes and with a record of satisfactory performance in stone masonry mortars. Latex additive (water emulsion) described below, serving as replacement for part of or all gaging water, of type specifically recommended by latex-additive manufacturer for use with job-mixed portland cement mortar and not containing a retarder. l. Latex Additive: Styrene-butadiene rubber or acrylic resin. Cold-rrly'eather Admixture: Nonchloride, noncorrosive, accelerating admixture complying with ASTM C 494, Type C, and recommended by manufacturer for use in masonry mortar of composition indicated. Water: Potable. Available hoducts: l. Cold-WeatherAdmixture: a. Euclid Chemical Co.; Accelguard 80. b. Grace, W. R. & Co., Construction Products Division; Morset.c. Sonnebom, Div. of ChemRex, Inc.; Trimix-NCA. l I ;l I I I I n I I c , I I I I I i I B. C. D. E. F. G. H. I, I . Hot-Dip Galvanized Steel Wire: ASTM A 82, urith ASTM A I 53/A 153M, Class B-2.2. Hot-Dip Galvanized Steel Sheet: ASTM A 366/A366M, cold-rolled, carbon-steel sheet hot-dip galvanized after fabrication to comply with ASTM A 153/A 153M, Class B-2. STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 4 J t t t 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3/2012004 B. Comrgated-Metal Veneer Anchors: Not less than 0.030-inch- (0.76-mm-) thick by 7/S-inch- (22-mm-) wide hot-dip galvanized steel sheet with comrgalions having a wavelength of 0.3 to 0.5 inch (7.6 to l3 mm) and an amplitude of 0.06 to 0.10 inch (1.5 to 2.5 nm). C. Wire Veneer Anchors: Formed from Wl.7 or 0.148-inch- (3.E-mrn-) diameter, hot-dip galvanized steel wire. D. Adjustable, Screw-Attached Veneer Anchors: Units consisting of a wire tie section and a metal anchor section that allow vertical adjustment but resist tension and compression forces perpendicular to plane of wall, for attachment over sheathing to wood or metal studs, and as follows: L Sffuctrual Performance Characteristics: Capable of withstanding a 100-lbf (445-N) load in both tension and compression without deforming or developing play in excess of 0.05 inch (1.3 mm). E. Screw-Attached Veneer Anchors: Units consisting of a wire tie section and a metal anchor section for attachment over sheathing to wood or metal studs, and as follows: l. Structural Performance Characteristics: Capable of withstanding a 100-lbf (445-N) load in both tension and compression without deforming or developing play in excess of 0.05 inch ( l.3 mm). F. Steel Drill Screws for Steel Studs: ASTM C 954 except manufactured with hex washer head and neoprene washer, No. l0 (4.8-mm diameter), in length required to penetrate steel stud flange by not less than 3 exposed threads, and with the following corrosion-protective coating: l. Organic polymer coating with salt-spray resistance to red rust of more than 500 hours per ASTM B II7. G. Available Products: l Adjustable, Screw-Attached Veneer Anchors: a. Dur-O-Wal, a Dayton Superior Company;D/A213. b. Duro-Wal, a Dayton Superior Company; D/A 210 with D/A 700-708. c. Heckmann Building Products, Inc.; 3 l5-D with 3 I 6. d. Hohmann & Bamard, krc.; DW-10. e. Hohmann & Bamard, hc.; DW-I0HS. f. Hohmann & Barnard, Inc.; DW-10-X. g. Masonry Reinforcing Corporation of America; 1004, Type III. h. Masonry Reinforcing Corporation of America; RI-71l. 2. Screw-Attached Veneer Anchors: a. Heclcnarur Building Products, Inc.; Pos-I-Tie. 3. Organic-Polymer-Coated,SteelDrillScrews: a. Elco Industries, Inc.; Dril-Flex. b. Hilti Corp.; Kwik-Flex. T I I I l, T T I I I t ; I I I STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 5 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE ITW-Buildex; Traxx. Rawlplug Co., lnc. (The); Perma-Seal Coated Twin-Fast. 3/20t2004 EMBEDDED FLASHING MATERTALS Metal Flashing: Fabricate from the following metal complying with requirements specified in Division 7 Section "Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim" and below:l. Copper: l0-oz./sq. ft. (3-kgisq. m) weight or 0.0135 inch (0.34 mm) thick for tully concealed flashing; l6-oz.lsq. ft. (s-kgsq. m) weight or 0.0216 inch (0.55 mm) thick elsewhere. 2. Fabricate through-wall metal flashing embedded in masonry with sawtooth or dovetail ribs at 3-inch (75-mm) intervals along langth of flashing to provide an integral mortar bond. 3. Fabricate metal expansion-joiut st'ips to shape indicated.4. Fabricate metal drip edges to extend at least 3 inches (75 mm) into wall and. 1/2 inch (13 mm) out from wall, with a hemmed outer edge bent down 30 degrees. Contractor's Option for Concealed Flashing: For flashing partly exposed to the exterior, use metal flashing specified above. For flashing not exposed to the exterior, use one of the following, unless othenvise indicated: l. Copper-Laminated Flashing: Manufacturer's standard laminated flashing consisting of 7- oz./sq. ft. (2-kg/sq. m) sheet copper bonded with asphalt between 2 layers of glass-fiber cloth. Use only where flashing is firlly concealed in masonry.2. Asphalt-Coated Copper Flashing: Manufachuer's standard product consisting of 7-oz./sq. ft. (2-kgisq. m) sheet copper coated with flexible asphalt. Use only where flashing is fully concealed in masonry.3. Rubberized-Asphalt Flashing: Manufacturer's standard composite flashing product consisting of a pliable and highly adhesive rubberized-asphalt compound, bonded to a high-density, cross-laminated polyethylane film to produce an overall thickness of0.040 inch (1.0 mm). 4. Elastomeric Thermoplastic Flashing: Manufacturer's standard composite flashing product consisting ofa polyester-reinforced ethylene interpolymer alloy 0.025 inch (0.6 mm) thick with a 0.015-inch- (0.4-mm) thick layer of rubberized-asphalt adhesive. a. hovide flashing as a complete system with preformed corners, end dams, other special shapes, and seaming maierials all produced by flashing sheet manufacturer. 5. EPDM Flashing: Manufacturer's standard flashing product formed from a terpolymer of ethylene-propylene-diene, complying with ASTM D 4637,0.040 inch (1.0 mm) thick. Solder and Sealants for Sheet Metal Flashings: As specified in Division 7 Section "Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim." Adhesives, Primers, and Seam Tapes for Flashings: Flashing manufacturer's standard products or products recommended by flashing manufacturer for bonding flashing sheets to each other and to substrates. Available Products: I I I t t I I I I I t I I I 3 t I d. 2.6 B. D. I I STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 6 I 20021501.08 VAILMOUNTATN LODGE 3t20/2004a I l. Metat Ftashing: I a. Cheney Flashing Company; Cheney Flashing (Dovetail). I b. Cheney Flashing Company; Cheney Flashing (Sawtooth). I c. Keystone Flashing Co.; Keystone 3-Way lnterlocking Thruwall Flashing. - 2. Copper-Laminated Flashing:tt I ^. Advanced Building Products, Inc.; CopperFabric Flashing. I i flff"*"lTh*:;".H';tt-rrF,ashing d. Phoenix Building Products; Type FCC-Fabric Covered Copper.I I UlT:1iffiff#ff3iT;.i13ffiiilHi#Til'lr;,I g. York Manufacturing, Inc.; York Copper Fabric Flashing. n 3. Asphalt-Coated Copper Flashing: I a. Advanced Building Products, lnc.; Cop-R-Cote. - b. AFCO Products, Inc.; Cop-A€ote. I c. Hohmann & Bamard, krc.; H & B C-Coat Flashing.d. Phoenix Building Products; Type ACC-Asphalt Bituminous Coated. I e. Polyite Manufacturing Corp.; Coated Copper Flashing. I f. Sandell Manufacturing Co., Inc.; Coated Copper Flashing. g. York Manufacnring, Inc.; Copperseal. I 4. Rubberized-Asphalt Flashing:I i I f;[d_l i:f'J.:,"ff"Xf:ll#"il"H'3-fiTff;", perm-A-Barrier wa' c. Hohmann & Barnard, Inc.; Textroflash. I d. Polyguard Products, Inc.; Polyguard 300. I e. Polyite Manufachring Corp.; Poly-Barrier Self-Adhering Wall Flashing. f. Williams Products, Inc.; Everlastic MF40. .-\ I 5. Elastomeric Thermoplastic Flashing: a. Hyload Cloaked Flashing System; Hyload Flashing Membrane. J 6. EpDM Flashing: I a. Firestone Building Products; FlashGuard. I 2.7 MISCELLANEOUSMASONRYACCESSORIES I A. Compressible Filler: Premolded filler strips complying with ASTMD 1056, Grade2Al; A compressible up to 35 percent; of width and thickness indicated; formulated from neoprene, I urethane, or PVC. t I STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 -7 20021501.08 VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 Asphalt Dampproofing for Concrete Backup: Cut-back asphalt complying with ASTM D 4479, Type I, or asphalt emulsion complying with ASTM D 1227,Type III or IV. MASONRY CLEANERS Job-Mixed Detergent Solution: Solution of ll2-cup (0.14-L) dry-measure tetrasodium polyphosphate and l/2-cup (0.14-L) dry-measure laundry detergent dissolved in I gal. (4 L) of water. Proprietary Acidic Cleaner: Manufacturer's standard-strength cleaner designed for removing mortar/grout stains, efflorescence, and other new constuction stains from stone masonry surfaces without discoloring or damaging masonry surfaces; expressly approved for intended use by stone producer. l. Available Products: a. Diedrich Technologies, Inc.; l0lG Granite, Terra Cotta, and Brick Cleaner. b. Diedrich Technologies, lnc;202 New Masonry Detergent.c. Dominion Restoration, hc.; DR-60 Stone and. Masonry Cleaner.d. Hydrochernical Tectmiques, Inc.; Hydroclean Brick, Granite, Sandstone and Teira Cotta Cleaner (HT -626). e. ProSoCo, lnc.; Sure Klean No. 600 Detergent. f. ProSoCo, Inc.; Sure Klean Restoration Cleaner. 2.9 STONEFABRICATION A. General; Fabnicate stone in sizes and shapes necessary to comply with requirements indicated, including details on Drawings. l. For granite, comply with recommendations in NBGQA's "Specifications for Architectural Granite.u B. Select stone to produce pieces of thickness, size, and shape indicated and to comply with fabrication and construction tolerances recommended by applicable stone association or, if none, by stone source, for faces, edges, beds, and backs. l. Clean sawed backs ofstone to remove rust stains and iron particles. C. Thickness of Stone Veneer: Provide thickness indicated, but not less than the following: l. Thickness: 4 inches ( 1 00 mm) plus or minus 1/2 inch (13 mm). D. Dress joints (bed and vertical) straigbt and at right angle io face, unless otherwise indicated. E. Shape stone for type of masonry (pattem) as follows: l. To match existing. F. Finish exposed faces and edges of stone to comply with requirements indicated for finish and to match approved samples and mockups- B. I I t I I I I t I I I t I I I I I I 2.8 B. STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 8 G. B. c. 3.1 I I I T I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I 2002 r 501 .08 2.10 A. VAIL MOI'NTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 |. Finish: To match existing. 2. Finish for Sills: To match existing. 3. Finish for Lintels: To match existing.4. Finish for Copings: To match existing. a. Finish exposed ends ofcopings same as front and back faces. Carefully inspect stone at quarry or fabrication plant for compliance with reguirements for appearance, material, and fabrication. Replace defective rmits before shipment. MORTARMD(ES General: Do not use admixtures, including pigments, air-entaining agents, accelerators, retarders, water-repellent agents, antifreeze compounds, or other admixhres, unless otherwise indicated. 1. Do not use calcium chloride. 2. Add cold-weather admixture (if used) at same rate for all mortar, regardless of weather conditions, to ensure that mortar color is consistent. 3. Mixing Pointing Mortar: Thoroughly mix cementitious and aggregate materials together before adding water. Then mix again, adding only anough water to produce a darnp, unworkable mix that will retain its form when pressed into a ball. Maintain mortar in this dampeaed condition for one to two hours. Add remaining water in small portions until mortar reaches desired consistency. Use mortar within 30 minutes of final mixing; do not retemper or use partially hardened material. Preblanded, Dry Mortar Mix: Furnish &y mortar ingredients in the form of a preblended rnix. Measure quantities by weight to ensure accurate proportions, and thoroughly blend ingredients before delivering to hoject site. Mortar for Stone Masonry: Comply with ASTM C 270,Property Specification. 1. Extended-Life Mortar: Mortar complying with ASTMC ll42 may be used instead of mortar specified above, at Contractor's option. Limit cementitious materials in mortar to portland cement, mortar cement, and lime. Mortar for Setting Stone: Type S. Mortar for Pointing Stone: Type N. PART 3 - EXECTJTION EXAMINATION Examine surfaces indicated to receive stone veneer assemblies, with Installer present, for compliance with requirements for installation tolerances and other conditions affecting performance. 2. 5. 4. STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 9 20021501 .08 T I l I I I 2. J- B. 3.2 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t20/2004 l.Examine substrate to verif, that dovetail slots, inserts, reinforcement, veneer anchors, flashing, and other items installed in unit masonry or concrete and required for or extending into stone veneer assemblies are correctly installed. Examine wall framing, sheathing, and building paper or building wrap to verify that stud locations are suitable for spacing of veneer anchors and that installation will result in a weatherproof covering. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION Advise installers of other work about specific requirements for placement of reinforcement, veneer anchors, flashing, and similar items to be built into stone vene€r assemblies. Accurately mark stud centerlines on face of building paper or building wrap before beginning stone installation. Coat concrete backup with asphalt dampproofing. Clean dirty or stained stone surfaces by removing soil, stains, and foreign materials before setting. Clean stone by thoroughly scrubbing with fiber brushes and then drenching with clear water. Use only mild cleaning compounds that contain no caustic or harsh materials or abrasives. SETTING OF STONEVENEER, GENERAL Sort stone before it is placed in wall to remove stone that does not comply with requirements relating to aesthetic effeAs, physical properties, or fab'rication, or that is otherwise unsuitable for intended use, Arrange stones for good fit in uncoursed rubble pattern with joint widths within tolerances indicated. Insert small stones into spaces between larger stones as needed to produce joints as uniform in width as practical. Alrange stones with color and size variations wiformly dispersed for an evenly blended appearance. Set stone to comply with requirements indicated on Drawings. Install veneer anchors, supports, fasteners, and other attaclments indicated or necessirD/ to secure stone veneer assemblies in place. Set stone accurately in locations indicated with edges and faces aligned according to established relationships and indicated tolerances. Maintain uniform joint widths except for variations due to different stone sizes and where minor variations are required to maintain bond alignment, if any. Lay walls with joints not less than 114 inch (6 mnr) at narrowest points nor more than I inch (25 mm) at widest points. Provide expansion, conhol, and pressure-relieving joints ofwidths and at locations indicated. l. Keep expansion and pressure-relieving joints free of mortar and other rigid materials. c. D.t-, J.J I t I D t i T I T I I B. c. D. F. STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - l0 G. A. B. D. E. F. 3.4 I I I t I I I T I T I I I r I I I I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 2. Sealing expansion, control, and pressure-relieving joints is specified in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants." Install embedded flashing and weep holes at shelf angles, lintels, ledges, other obstructions to downward flow of water in wall, and where indicated. l. At cold-formed metal-framed walls, extend flashing from exterior face of veneer, through the veneer, up the face ofsheathing at least 8 inches (200 mm), and behind building paper or building wrap. 2. At lintels and shelfangles, extend flashing full length ofangles but not less than 4 inches ( 100 mm) into masonry at each end. 3. At heads and sills, extend flashing 4 inches ( 100 mm) at ends and turn up not less than 2 inches (50 mm) to form a pan. 4. Interlock endjoints ofribbed sheet metal flashing by overlapping ribs not less than l-l/2 inches (38 mm) or as recommended by flashing manufacturer, and seal lap with elastomeric sealant complying with requirements in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants" for application indicated. 5. Extend sheet metal flashing 1/2 inch (13 mm) beyond face of masonry at exterior and tum flashing down to form a drip. 6. Install metal drip edges beneath flashing at exterior face of wall. Stop flashing l/2 inch (13 mm) back from outside face of wall and adhere flashing to top of metal drip edge. 7. Install metal flashing termination beneath flashing at exterior face of wall. Stop flashing 1/2 inch (13 mm) back from outside face of wall and adhere flashing to top of metal flashing termination. 8. Cut flashing flush with face of wall after masonry wall consfuction is completed. CONSTRUCTION TOLERANCES Variation from Plumb: For vertical lines and surfaces. do not exceed ll4 inch in 10 feet (6 mm in 3 m), 3/8 inch in 20 feet (10 mm in 6 m), or l/2 inch in 40 feet (13 mm in 12 m) or more. For extemal comers, expansion joints, control joints, and other conspicuous lines, do not exceed l/4 inch in 20 feet (6 mm in 6 m) or ll2 inch in 40 feet (13 mm in 12 m) or more. Variation from Level: For lines of exposed lintels, sills, parapets, horizontal grooves, and other conspicuous lines, do not exceed l/4 inch in 20 feet (6 mm in 6 m) or l/2 inch in 40 feet (13 mm in 12 m) or more. Variation of Linear Building Line: For position shown in plan, do not exceed 1/2 inch in 20 feet (13 mm in 6 m) or 3/4 inch in 40 feet (19 mm in 12 m) or more. Measure variation from level, plumb, and position shown in plan as variation of the average plane ofthe face ofeach stone from level, plumb, or dimensioned plane. Variation in Mortar-Joint Thickness: Do not vary from joint size range indicated. Variation in Plane between Adj acent Stones: Do not exceed one-half of tolerance specified for thicloess of stone. 3/20t2004 STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - ll 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t20t2004 3.5 INSTALLATION OF ANCHORED STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES A. Anchor stone veneer to concrete with com.rgated-metal veneer anchors as follows: l. Secure veneer anchors by inserting dovetailed ends into dovetail slots in concrete.2. Embed veneer anchors in mortar joints to within I inch (25 mm) of face. B. Anchor stone veneer to cold-formed metal framing with screw-attached veneer anchors as follows: l. Fasten each anchor section by screwing through sheathing into framing. 2. Embed wire tie section in mortar joints to within 1-l/2 inches (38 mm) of face. C. Space veneer anchors not more than 18 inches (450 mm) o.c. vertically and 32 inches (800 mm) o.c. horizontally, with not less than I veneer anchor per 2.67 sq. ft. (0.25 sq. m) of wall area. Install additional veneer anchors within 12 inches (300 mm) of openings, sealant joints, and perimeter at intervals not exceeding 12 inches (300 mm). D. Set stone in full bed of mortar with full head joints, unless otherwise indicated. Build veneer anchors into mortar joints as stone is set. E. Fill space between back of veneer and building paper or building wrap with mortar as stone is set. F. Rake out joints for pointing with mortar to depth of not less than 3/4 inch (19 mm) before setting mortar has hardened. Rake joints to uniform depths with square httoms and clean sides. 3.6 POINTING A. Prepare stone-joint surfaces for pointing with mortar by rernoving dust and mortar particles. Where setting mortar was rernoved to depths greater than surrounding areas, apply pointing mortar in layers not more than 3/8 inch (10 mm) deep until a uniform depth is formed, B. Point stone joints by placing and compacting pointing mortar in layers not more than 3i8 inch (10 mm) deep. Compact each layer thoroughly and allow to become thumbprint hard before applying next layer. C. Tool joints, when pointing mortar is thumbprint hard, with a smooth jointing tool to produce the following joint profi le: L Joint Profile: To match existine. ADruSTING AND CLEANING Remove and replace stone veneer assemblies of the following description: l. Brokan, chipped stained, or otherw'ise damaged stone. Stone may be repaired if methods and results are approved by Architect. 2. Defective joints. I I I I I I I l I I I I I T t I t I 3.7 STONE VENEER ASSEMBLIES 04860 - 12 D. A. B. 3.8 : I I I I T I t, I I t I T t I I I t I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 3. Stone veneer assemblies not matching approved samples and mockups. 4. Stone veneer assemblies not complying with other requirements indicated. Replace in a manner that results in stone veneer assemblies' matching approved sarnples and mockups, compllng with other requirernents, and showing no evidence of replacement. In-Progress Cleaning: Clean stone veneer assemblies as work progresses. Remove mortar fins and smears before tooling joints. Final Cleaning: After mortar is thoroughly set and cured, clean stone veneer assemblies as follows: l. Remove large mortar particles by hand with wooden paddles and nonmetallic scrape hoes or chisels. 2. Test cleaning methods on mockup; leave one-half of panel uncleaned for comparison purposes. Obtain Architect's approval of sample cleaning before cleaning stone veneer assemblies. 3- Protect adjacent stone and nonmasonry surfaces from contact with cleaner by covering them with liquid strippable masking agent, polyethylene film, or waterproof masking tape. 4- Wet wall surfaces with water before applying cleaner; remove cleaner promptly by rinsing thoroughly with clear water. 5. Clean stone veneer assemblies by bucket and brush hand+leaning method described in BLA Technical Note No. 20 Revised II, using job-mixed detergent solution. EXCESS MATERIALS AND WASTE Excess Stone: Stack excess stone where directed by Owner for Owner's use. Disposal as Fill Material: Dispose of clean masoffy waste, including mortar and excess or soil- contaminated sand, by crushing and mixing with fill material as fill is placed. 1. Crush masonry waste to less than 4 inches (100 mm) in greatest dimension. 2. Mix masonry waste with at least two parts of specified fill material for each part of tnasonry waste. Fill material is specified in Division 2 Section "Earthwork.'3. Do not dispose of masonry waste as fill within l8 inches (450 mm) of finished grade. Excess Masonry Waste: Remove excess clean masonry waste that cannot be used as fill, as described above, and other waste, and legally dispose of off Owner's property. END OF SECTION 04860 C. STONE VENEER AS SEMBLTES 04860 - 13 t 20021s01.08 VAIL MOIjNTIAN LODGE 3t2O/2004 I sEcrIoN05120 - srRUcruRAL srEEL I PARr r -GENERAL t l.l SI'MMARY - A. This Section includes structural steel and grout. I 1.2 PERFORMANCEREQUIREMENTS t A. Cormections: Provide details of simple shear connections required by the Contact Documents to be selected or completed by structural-steel fabricator to withstand [ASD-service] [LRFD] a loads indicated and comply with other information and restrictions indicated. I l. Select and complete connections using scbematic details indicated and AISC's "Manual f of Steel Construction, Load and Resistance Factor Design," Volume 2, Part9 andlm I AISC's "Manual of Steel Construction, Allowable Stress Desigr," Part 4. I 1.3 sr.JBMrrrALSI .- A. ProductData: Fqeachtypeofproductindicated. I B. Shop Drawings: Show fabrication ofstuctural-steel components. t C. Welding certificates. D. Mill test reports. 7 E. Source quality-control test reporrs.t I IA QUAIITYASSTJRANCE -A. Fabricator Qualifications: A qualified fabricator who participates in the AISC Quality t Certification Program and is designated an AlSC-Certified Plant, Category Sbd. I- B. Welding: Qualifu procedures and personnel according to AWSDl.l, "Structural Welding r Code--Steel." - C. Comply with applicable provisions of AISC's "Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings _, and Bridges." t al I I I STRUCTTJRAL STEEL 05120 - l 2002 l 501 .08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOIINTIAN LODGE 3/2012004 I I t I I T t I t t I T T I T t I t I )1 STRUCTURAL-STEEL MATERIALS W-Shapes: As indicated in Stn:ctural Documents. Channels, Angles, M or S-Shapes: As indicated in Structwal Documents. Plate and Bar: As indicated in Structural Documents. Cold-Formed Hollow Sructural Sections: ASTM A 500. Grade as indicated in Structural Documents, structural tubing. Steel Pipe: ASTM A 53/A 53M, Type E or S, Grade B. Welding Elecfodes: Comply with AWS requiremants. BOLTS, CONNECTORS, AND ANCHORS High-Strength Bolts, Nuts, and Washers: ASTM A 325 (ASTM A 325M), T1rye l, heavy hex steel structural bolts; ASTM A 563 (ASTM A 563M) heavy hex carbon-steel nuts; and ASTM F 436 (ASTM F 436M) hardened carbon-steel washers.. l. Finish: Plain. 2. Direct-Tension Indicators: ASTM F 959, Type325 (ASTM F 959M, Type 8.8,) compressible-washer type. a. Finish: Plain. High-Strength Bolts, Nuts, and Washers: ASTM A 490 (ASTM A 490M), Type 1, heavy hex steel structural bolts; ASTM A 563 (ASTM A 563M) heavy hex carbon-steel nuts; and ASTM F 436 (AS'IM F 436M) hardened carbon-steel washers, plain. l. Direct-Tension Indicators: ASTMF959, Type490 (ASTMF959M,) Type 10.9, compressible-washer type, plain. Tension-Control, High-Strength Bolt-Nut-Washer Assemblies: ASTMF 1852, Type 1, head steel stuctural bolts with splined ends; ASTM A 563 (ASTM A 563M) heavy hex carbon-steel nuts; and ASTM F 436 (ASTM F 436M) hardened carbon-steel washers. 1. Finish: Plain. D. Shear Connectors: ASTMA 108, Grades l0l5 through 1020, headed-stud tpe, cold-finished carbon steel; AWS Dl.l, Type B. Unheaded Anchor Rods: As indicated in Sfuchrral Documenls. L Configuration: As indicated in Structwal Documents. 2. Finish: Plain. A. B. C. D, E. F. 2.2 B. c. STRUCTTIRAL STEEL 05120 - 2 I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 I F. Headed Anchor Rods: As indicated in Structural Documents, shaight.I l. Finish: Plain. I G. Tlueaded Rods: As indicated in Structural Documents. I l. Finish: Plain. t - 2.3 PRMER II A. Primer: SSPC-Paint ZS,TyqII, iron oxide, zinc oxide, raw linseed oil, and allcyd. I B. Primer: Fabricator's standard lead- and chromate-free, nonasphaltic, rust-inhibiting primer. I I 2.4 GROUT I A. Nonmetallic, Shrinkage-Resistant Grout: ASTM C 1107, factory-packaged, nonmetallic I aggregate grout, noncorrosive, nonstaining, mixed with water to consistency suitable for t application and a 30-minute working time. II 2,5 FABRICATIONI A. Structural Steel: Fabricate and assemble in shop to greatest extent possible. Fabricate I according to AISC's "Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings and Bridges" and AISC's I "specification for Structural Steel Buildings-Allowable Stress Design and Plastic Desigt." ;; B. Shear Connectors: Prepare steel surfaces as recommended by manufacfttrer of shear I connectors. Use automatic end welding of headed-stud shear connectors according to AWS Dl .I and manufacturer's written instructions. : 2.6 SHoP coNNEcTIoNS f A. High-Shength Bolts: Shop install high-stuength bolts according to RCSC's "specification for t Structural Joints Using ASTMA325 or A490 Bolts" for type of bolt and type of joint specified. - I l. Ioint Type: As indicated in stuctural documents. I B. Weld Connections: Comply with AWS D1.1 for welding procedure specifications, tolerances, I appearance, and quality of welds and for methods used in correcting welding work. I 2.7 sHoPPRMTNcI ._ A. Shop prime steel surfaces except the following: a l. surfaces embedded in concrete or mortar. Extend priming of partially embedded members to a deoth of 2 inches (50 nrm). I I STRUCTURAL STEEL 05120 - 3 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3/20/2004 2. Surfaces to be field welded. 3. Surfaces to be high-shength bolted with slip-critical connections. 4. Surfaces to receive sprayed fire-resistive materials. 5. Galvanizedsurfaces. Surface Preparation: Clean surfaces to be painted. Rernove loose rust and mill scale and spatter, slag, or flux deposits. hepare surfaces according to the following specifications and standards: L SSPC-SP 2, "Hand Tool Cleaning." 2. SSPC-SP 3, "Power Tool Cleaning." Priming: Immediately after strrface preparation, apply primer according to manufachrer's written instructions and at rate recommended by SSPC to provide a &y film thickness of not less than 1.5 mils (0.038 mm). Use priming methods that result in full coverage of joints, comers, edges, and exposed surfaces. SOURCE QUALITY CONTROL Owner will engage an independent testing and inspecting agency to perform shop tests and inspections and prepare test reports. Comply with testing and inspection requirernents of Part 3, Article "Field Quality Control." Correct deficiencies in Work that test repo'rts and inspections indicate does not comply with the Contract Documents. In addition to visual inspection, shop-welded shear connectcrs will be tested and inspected according to requirernents in AWS Dl.l for stud welding. PART 3 -EXECUTION c. ERECTION Examination: Verifr elevations of concrete- and masonry-bearing surfaces and locations of anchor rods, bearing plates, and other embedments, with steel erector pr€sent, for compliance with requirements. l. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. Set struchral steel accurately in locations and to elevations indicated and according to AISC's "Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings and Bridges' and "Specification for Stuchrral Steel Buildings-Allowable Stress Design and Plastic Desigrr." Base and Bearing Plates: Clean concrete- and masonry-bearing surfaces of bond-reducing materials, and roughen surfaces prior to setting base and bearrng plates. Clean bottom surface ofbase and bearing plates. l. Set base and bearing plates for structural members on wedges, shims, or setting nuts as required. B. C. I I t I I T I l T I I I I I 2.8 B. c. I I3.1 B. I I I STRUCTURAL STEEL 0s120 - 4 ! I I I I t 20021501.08 VA]L MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 2. Weld plate washers to top of base plate. 3. Snug-tighten anchor rods after supported members have been positioned and plumbed. Do not remove wedges or shims but, if protruding, cut off flush with edge of base or bearing plate before packing with grout. 4. Promptly pack grout solidly between bearing surfaces and base and bearing plates so no voids remain. Neatly finish exposed surfaces; protect grout and allow to cure. Comply with manufacturer's written installation instructions for shrinkage-resistant grouts. D. Maintain erection tolerances of structural steel within AISC's "Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings and Bridges." 3.2 FIELDCONNECTIONS A. High-Strenglh Bolts: Shop install high-shength bolts according to RCSC's "Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A 325 or A490 Bolts" for type of bolt and t)?e of joint specified. B. Weld Connections: Comply with AWS Dl.l for welding procedure specifications, tolerances, appearance, and quality of welds and for methods used in correcting welding work. l. Courply with AISC's "Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings and Bridges" and "Specification for Stuctural Steel Buildings-Allowable Stress Desigr and Plastic Design" for bearing, adequacy of temporary connections, alignmant, and removal of paint on surfaces adjacant to field welds. FIELD QUALITY CONTROL Testing Agency: Owner will engage a qualified independent testing and inspecting agency to inspect held welds and high-strangth bolted connections. Bolted Cormections: Shop-bolted connections will be tested and inspected according to RCSC's "Specification for Structural loints Using ASTM A 325 or A 490 Bolts." Welded Cormections: Field welds will be visually inspected according to AWS D1.1. l. h addition to visual inspection, field welds will be tested according to AWS Dl .1 and the following inspection procedures, at testing agency's option: a. Liquid Penetrant Inspection: ASTM E 165. b. Magnetic Particle lnspection: ASTM E 709; performed on root pass and on finished weld. Cracks or zones of incomplete fusion or penetration will not be accepted. c. Ultrasonic lnspection: ASTM E 164. d. Radiographic Inspection: ASTM E 94. Correct deficiencies in Work that test reports and inspections indicate does not comply with the Contract Documents. END OF SECTION O5I2O STRUCTTJRAL STEEL B. D. 3.3 I I I t I t I I t I I I l 05120 - s T T I T I I I I I 20021 50 r .08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3t20t2004 I T I I I I t.2 SECTION 05310 - STEEL DECK PART I.GENERAL I.I SUMMARY A. This Section includes the following: l. Roofdeck. 2. Composite floor deck. 3. Noncomposite form deck. SIJBMITTALS Product Data: For each type of declq accessory, and product indicated. Shop Drawings: Include layout and types of deck panels, anchorage details, reinforcing channels, pans, deck opanings, special jointing, accessories, and attachments to other construction. Product certificates. Welding certificates. Research/evaluation reports. QUALITY ASSI'RANCE Welding: Quali$/ procedr:res and persormel according to AWS Dl.l, "Structural Welding Code--Steel," and AWS D1.3, 'Structrnal Welding Code--Sheet Steel." Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: Where indicated, provide steel deck units identical to those steel deck units tested for fire resistance per ASTM E I 19 by a testing and inspection agancy acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. l. Fire-Resistance Ratings: Indicated by desigrr desigrations from UL's "Fire Resistance Directory" or from the listings of another testing and inspecting agency. 2. Ste€l deck units shall be identified with appropriate markings ofapplicable testing and inspecting agency. AISI Specifications: Calculate structural characteristics of steel deck according to AISI's "Specification for the Design of Cold-Formed Steel Stuctural Members." A. B. c. D. E. 1.3 B. c.t I t I STEEL DECK 05310 - r T t I I I I I I B. 2.1 2002 r s01 .08 PART 2 . PRODUCTS VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 MANUFACTURERS Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: BHP Steel Building Products USA Inc. Consolidated Systems, Inc. Epic Metals Corp. Marilyn Steel Products, Inc. Nucor Corp.; Vulcraft Div. RoofDeck, Inc. United Steel Deck, Inc. Verco Manufacturing Co. Wheeling Comrgating Co.; Dv. of Wheeling-Pittsburgh Steel Corp. ROOF DECK Steel Roof Deck: Fabricate panels, without topflange stiffening grooves, to comply with'SDI Specifications and Commentary for Steel Roof Declg" in SDI Publication No. 29. 1. Prime-Painted Steel Sheet: ASTM A 611, Grade C minimum, shop primed with gray or white baked-on, lead- and chromate-free rust-inhibitive primer. Deck Profile: As indicated in Structural Documents.. Profile Depth: As indicated in Structural Documents. Design Uncoated-Steel Thickness: As indicated in Structural Documents.. COMPOSITE FLOOR DECK Composite Steel Floor Deck Fabricate panels, with integralll' ernbossed or raised pattem ribs and interlocking side laps, to comply with "SDI Specifications and Commentary for Composite Steel Floor Deck," in SDI Publication No. 29, the minimum section properties indicated, and the following: l. Prime-Painted Steel Sheet: ASTMA6II, Grade (l minimum, with top surface phosphatized and unpainted and bottom surface shop primed with gray or white baked- on, lead- and chromate-free rust-inhibitive primer. 2. Profile Depth: As indicated in Stuctural Documents. 3. Design Uncoated-Steel Thickness: As indicated in Structtnal Documents. ACCESSORIES Accessories: Steel deck manufacturer's standard accessory materials, including mechanical fasteners, closure strips, pour stops, and closures for deck. 2.2 2. ). 4. I I T I I t t I I t t 2.3 aA STEEL DECK 05310 - 2 J. 3.1 I l I T t T I I t T I I T I I J I I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE 3/20t2004 C. Shear Connectors: ASTMA 108, Grades 1010 tlnough 1020 headed stud type, cold-finished carbon steel, AWS D I . I, Type B, with arc shields. Repair Paint: Lead- and cbromate-free rust-inhibitive primer. PART 3 . EXECUTION INSTALLATION krstall deck panels and accessories according to applicable specifications and commentary in SDI Publication No. 29, manufacturer's written instructions, and requirements in this Section. Place deck panels on supporting frame and adjust to final position with ends accurately aligned and bearing on supporting frame before being permanently fastored. Do not stetch or contract sideJap interlocks. Place deck panels flat and square and fasten to supporting frame without warp or deflection. Cut and neatly fit deck panels and accessories around openings and other work projecting through or adjacent to decking. Provide additional reinforcemert and closure pieces at openings as required for strength, contintrity of decking, and support of other work. Comply with AWS requirernents and procedures for manual shielded metal arc welding, appearance and quality of welds, and methods used for correcting welding work. Roof Deck Accessories: Install ridge and valley plates, finish srips, cover plates, end closures, and reinforcing channels according to deck manufachrer's written instructions. Weld to substrate to provide a complete deck installation. Shear Connectors: Weld shear connectors through deck to supporting frame according to AWS Dl.l and manufacturer's written instuctions. Butt end joints of deck panels; do not overlap. Remove and discard arc shields after welding shear connectors. Pour Stops and Girder Fillers: Weld steel sheet pour stops and girder fillers to supporting structure according to SDI recommendations, unless otherwise indicated. Floor Deck Closures: Weld steel sheet column closures, cell closures, and Z-closures to deck, according to SDI recommendations, to provide tight-fitting closures at open ends of ribs and sides of decking. Weld cover plates at changes in direction of floor deck panels, unless otherrvise indicated. Repairs and Protection: l. Repair Painting: Wire brush and clean rust spots, welds, and abraded areas on both surfaces of prime-painted deck immediately after installation, and apply repair paint. B. B. c. D. F. G. STEEL DECK 0s310 - 3 2002150r.08 VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 3.2 FrELD QUALITY CONTROL A. Testing: Owner will engage a qualified independant testing agency to perform field quality- control testing. B. Field welds will be subject to inspection. C. Shear connector stud welds will be tested and inspected according to AWS Dl .l . D. Remove and replace work that does not comply with specified requirements. E. Additional testing and inspecting, at Contrastor's expense, will be performed to determine compliance of corrccted work with specified requirements. END OF SECTION O53IO I I I l I I I l I I I I I I t I I t ISTEELDECK053r0-4 I 20021501.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDcE 3/20/2004I I SECTION O55OO - METAL FABRICATIONS I PARTI-GENERAL l, I 1.1 STJMMARY A. This Section includes the following: r 1. Miscellaneous steel framing and supports. 2. Shelfangles. I 3. Loose bearing and leveling plates. t 4. Steel weld plates and angles. 5. Miscellaneous steel trim. J 6. Metal ladders. || 7. Loose steel lintels. I B. See Division 5 Section "Metal Stairs" for metal-framed stairs. t C. See Division 5 Section "Pipe and Tube Railings" for metal pipe and tube railings. I D. See Division 5 Section "Omamental Railings" for omamental metal railings.! T 1.2 SI.JBMITTALS a A. Product Data: For the followine: I L Grout. I' B. Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, and details of metal fabrications and their I connections. Show anchorage and accessory items. I C. Ternplates: For anchors and bolts. t,J PART2-PRoDUCTS -t 2.1 MANUFACTURERS I A. In other Part 2 articles where titles below introduce lists, the following requirements apply to I Product selection: - l. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be a incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, products specified.l! 2. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, a manufacturers specified. t t METALFABRICATIONS O55OO - I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 METALS Metal Surfaces, General: hovide materials with smooth, flat surfaces without blemishes. Ferrous Metals: 1. Steel Plates, Shapes, and Bars: ASTM A 36/..{ 36M. 2. Steel Tubing: ASTM A 500, cold-formed steel tubing. 3. Steel Pipe: ASTM A 53/A 53M, standard weight (Schedule 40), unless another weight is indicated or required by strucnral loads. 4. Slotted Channel Framing: Cold-formed metal channels cornpllng with MFMA-3, 1-5/8 by l-5/8 inches (41 by 4l mm). Channels made from galvanized steel compllng with ASTM A 6531A653M, structural steel, Grade 33 (Grade 230), with G90 (2275) coating; 0.079-inch (2-mm) nominal thickness. 5. Cast kon: ASTM A 48/A 48M, Class 30, unless another class is indicated or required by structural loads. Nonferrous Metals: l. AluminumExtrusions: ASTMB22I (ASTMB22l$,alloy6063-T6. 2. Aluminum-Alloy Rolled Tread Plate: ASTM B 63218 632M, alloy 6061 -T6. 3. Aluminum Castings: ASTM B 261826M, Alloy443.0-F. FASTENERS General: Type 304 stainless-steel fasteners for exterior use and zinc-plated fasteners with coating complying with ASTM B 633, Class FelZn 5, at exterior walls. Provide stainless-steel fasteners for fastening aluminum. Select fasteners for type, grade, and class required. Cast-in-Place Anchors in Concrete: Threaded or wedge type; galvanized ferrous castings, either ASTM A 47/A47M malleable iron or ASTM A27/A27M cast steel. Provide bolts, washers, and shims as needed, hotdip galvanized per ASTM A 153/A 153M. MISCELLANEOUS MATERI,ALS Universal Shop Primer: Fast-curing, lead- and chromate-free, universal modified-allcyd primer cornpllng with MPI #79. Nonshrink, Nonmetallic Grout: Factory-packaged, nonstaining, noncorrosive, nongaseous grout complying with ASTM C I107. Concrete Materials and hoperties: Comply with requirements in Division 3 Section "Cast-in- Place Concrete" for normal-weight, air+ntrained, ready-mix concrete with a minimum 28day compressive strength of 3000 psi (20 MPa), unless otherwise indicated. I I t l I I I t l I I I I I l T I I I 2.2 A. B. 2.3 B. 2.4 B. C. METAL FABRICATIONS 05500 - 2 A. B. D. F. G. 2.5 I t I I I I I I I T I I I I I ! I I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE FABRICATION General: heassemble items in the shop to greatest extent possible. Use connections that maintain structural value ofjoined pieces. 1. Cut, drill, and punch metals cleanly and accurately. Remove burrs and ease edges. Remove sharp or rough areas on exposed surfaces. 2. Weld corners and seams continuously. Use materials and methods that minimize distortion and develop sfength and corrosion resistance of base metals. Obtain fusion without undercut or overlap. Remove welding flux immediately. Finish exposed welds smooth and blended. 3. Form exposed connections with hairline joints, flush and smooth, using concealed fasteners where possible. Locate joints where least conspicuous. 4. Fabricate seams and other connections that will be exposed to weather in a manner to exclude water. Provide weep holes where water may accumulate. 5. Where units are indicated to be cast into concrete or built into masonry, equip with integrally welded steel strap anchors, not less frloir' 24 inches (600 mm) o.c. Miscellaneous Framing and Supports: Provide steel framing and supports not specified in other Sections as needed to complete the Work. Fabricate units from steel shapes, plates, and bars of welded construction. Cut, drill, and tap units to receive hardware, hangers, and similar items. Loose Steel Lintels: Fabricate loose steel lintels from steel angles and shapes of size indicated for opanings and recesses in masonry walls and partitions at locations indicated. l. Lintels in Exterior Walls: Prime with zinc-rich primer. Shelf Angles: Fabricate shelf angles of sizes indicated and for attachment to frarning. Fabricate with horizontally slotted holes to receive 3/4-inch (19-mm) bolts, spaced not more than 6 inches (150 mm) from ends and 24 inches (600 mm) o.c. I . Shelf Angles in Exterior Walls: Prime with zinc-rich primer. 2. Furnjsh wedge-type concrete inserts, complete with fasteners, to attach shelf angles to cast-in-place concrete. Loose Bearing and Leveling Plates: Provide loose bearing and leveling plates for steel iterns bearing on masonry or concrete construction. Drill plates to receive anchor bolts. Miscellaneous Steel Trim: Fabricate units from steel shapes, plates, and bars of profiles shown with continuously welded joints and smooth exposed edges. Miter corners and use concealed field splices where possible. Provide cutouts, fittings, and anchorages as needed to coordinate assembly and installation with other work. I . Exterior Miscellaneous Sreel Trim: Prime with zinc-rich primer. Metal Ladders: Comply with ANSI A14.3, unless otherwise indicated. l. Space siderails l8 inches (457 mnr)apart, unless otherwise indicated. 2. Steel Ladder Construction: Flat bar siderails, with 3/4-inch- ( I 9-mm-) diameter steel bar rungs fitted in centerline of siderails, plug-welded, and ground smooth on outer rail faces. Provide nonslip surfaces on top of each rung. 3/2012004 METAL FABRICATIONS 05500 - 3 2.6 20021501.08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 FINISHES Comply with NAAMM's "Metal Finishes Manual for Architectural and Metal Products" for recommendations for applying and designating finishes. Finish metal fabrications after assembly. Steel and hon Finishes: l. Hotdip galvanizn items as indicated to comply with ASTM Al23/Al23M or ASTM A 153/4 l53M as applicable. 2. Preparation for Shop Priming: Prepare uncoated ferrous-metal surfaces to comply with requirements indicated below for environmental exposure conditions of installed metal fabrications: ^. Exteriors (SSPC Zone lB): SSPC-SP 6NACE No. 3, "Commercial Blast Cleaning." b. Interiors (SSPC Zone 1A): SSPC-SP 3, "Power Tool Cleaning." 3. Shop Priming: Apply shop primer to uncoated surfaces of metal fabrications, except those with galvanized finishes and those to be embedded in concrete, sprayed-on fireproofing, or masonry, to comply with SSPC-PA 1, 'Paint Application Specification No. l: Shop, Field, and Maintenance Painting," for shop painting. PART3 -EXECUTION INSTALLATION General: Perform cutting, drilling, and fining required for installing metal fabrications. Set metal fabrications accr:rately in location, with edges and surfaces level, plumb, and true. l. Fit exposed connections accurately together. Weld connections that are not to be left as exposed joints but cannot be shop welded. Do not weld, cut, or abrade surfaces of exterior units that have been hot{ip galvanized after fabrication.2. Provide anchorage devices and fasteners where metal fabrications are required to be fastened to in-place construction. 3. Provide temporary bracing or anchors in formwork for items that are to be built into concrete, rnasonry, or similar constuction. Set bearing and leveling plates on cleaned surfaces using wedges, shims, or leveling nuts. After bearing members have been positioned and plumbed, tighten anchor bolts and pack solidly with nonshrink, nonmetallic grout. Touch up surfaces and finishes after erection. 1. Painted Surfaces: Clean field welds, bolted connections, and abraded areas and touch up paint with the same material as used for shop painting. 2. Galvanized Surfaces: Clean field welds, bolted connections, and abraded areas and repair galvanizing to comply with ASTM A 780. I I I t I I I t I I I I I I I ! I T I B. 3.1 B. c. METAL FABRICATIONS 05500 - 4 I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDGE 3/20/2004 I ENDoFSECrroNossoo METALFABRICATIONS 05s00 - 5 I 2002150r.08 vAIL MoTJNTTAN LoDGE 3t20t2004I I SECTION()55II -METALSTAIRS t PARTI -GENERAL fr I.I SI]MMARYI A. This Section includes the following: It l. Preassembled steel stairs with concrete-filled treads. T 1.2 PERFORMANCEREQUIREMENTS I A. Structural Performance of Stairs: Provide metal stairs capable of withstanding the effects of I gravity loads and the following loads and stresses within limits and under conditions indicated: t l. Uniformload: 100 lbflsq. ft.t4.79 kNisq. m). I 2. Concenhated Load: 300 lbf (1.33 kN) applied on an area of4 sq. in. (2580 sq. mm).t 3. Uniform and concentrated loads need notbe assumed to act concurrently. 4. Stair Framing: Capable of withstanding shesses resulting from railing loads in addition I to loads specified above.I 5. Limit deflection of teads, platforms, and framing members to U360 or 714 inch (6.4 mm), whichever is less. t B. Sfuchral Performance of Railings: Provide railings capable of withstanding the effects of gravity loads and the following loads and stresses within limits and under conditions indicated: - t l. Handrails: - a. Uniform load of 50 lbf/ ft. (0.73 kN/m) applied in any direction.! i 3tff"H::Ti:::"ffi?3Jiji3;';"S*tri::##J,TiTl,Xi".."*" I 2. Top Rails of Guards:a a. Uniform load of 50 lbf/ ft. (0.73 kNlm) applied in any direction. I b. Concentrated load of 200 lbf (0.89 kN) applied in any direction. t c. Uniform and concenbated loads need not be assumed to act concurrently. 11 3. krfill of Guards: l' a. Concentrated load of 50 lbf (0.22 kN) applied horizontally on an area of 1 sq. ft. (0.093 sq. m).r i Ht?,Ti?1:1i:,','"1'f *"$"',iili:1,9:liH.n:;x"#:1,1,, I t I METAL STAIRS 05511- I 1.3 1.4 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.JNTTAN LODCE 3/20/20M SUBMITTALS Product Data: For metal stairs. Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments to other work. COORDINATION Furnish setting drawings, templates, and directions for installing anchorages, including sleeves, concrete inserts, anchor bolts, and items with integral anchors, that are to be embedded in concrete or masonry. Deliver such items to Project site in time for installation. Coordinate locations of hanger rods and struts with other work so that they will not encroach on required stair width and will be within the fire-resistance-rated stair enclosure. PART2 -PRODUCTS 2.1 MANT]FACTI.]RERS A. In other Part 2 adicles where titles below inhoduce lists, the following requiremants apply to product selection: l. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirernents, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, manufacturers specifi ed. A. B. I I I I I I I t I I I I T I T I I T I A. B. 2.2 METALS Metal Surfaces, General: Provide materials with smooth, flat surfaces without blemishes. Steel Plates, Shapes, and Bars: ASTM A 36/A 36M. Steel Tubing: ASTM A 500 (cold formed) or ASTM A 513, Tlpe 5 (mandrel draln). Rolled-Steel Floor Plate: ASTM A 786/A786M, rolled from plate complying with ASTM A 36/A36M or ASTM A283lA 283M, Grade C or D. Wire Rod for Grating Crossbars: ASTM A 510 (ASTM A 5l0M). hon Castings: Either gray iron, ASTMA48lA48M, Class30, or malleable iron, ASTM A 47lA 47M, unless otherwise indicated. Uncoated, Cold-Rolled Steel Sheet: ASTM A 1008/A 1008M, either commercial steel, Type B, or struchral steel, Grade 25 (Grade 170). Uncoated, Hot-Rolled Steel Sheet: ASTM A l01l/A l01lM, either commercial steel, Type B, or struchral steel, Grade 30 (Grade 205). A. B. c. D. E. F. G. METAL STAIRS 05511-2 I 2.4 FABRrcArroN I 20021s0r.08 vArL MouNTIAN LoDGE 3/20/2004 ! I I. Expanded Metal, Carbon Steel: ASTM F 1267, Class l (uncoated).r J. Woven-Wire Mesh: Intermediate-crimp, 2-inch (50-mrn) woven-wire mesh, made from 0.135- I inch (1.5-mm) nominal diameter wire complying with ASTM A 510 (AS'IM A 5l0M). I K. Aluminum Extrusions: ASTM B 221 (ASTM B 22lM), Alloy 6063-T6. a. T 23 MISCELLANEoUS MATERIALS t A. Concrete Materials and Properties: Comply with requirements in Division 3 Section "Cast-in-t Place Concrete" for normal-weight, air-entrained, ready-mix concrete with a minimum 28-day compressive shength of 3000 psi (20 MPa), unless othenvise indicated. t B. Welded Wire Fabric: ASTM A 185, 6 by 6 inches (152 by 152 mm)-W1.4 by W1.4, unless otherwise indicated. I A. Available Manufacturers:a l. Alfab, Inc. I 2. American Stair, Inc.! 3. Sharon Companies Ltd. (The). I B. Provide complete stair assemblies, including metal framing, hangers, struts, clips, brackets, ! bearing plates, and other components necessary to support and anchor stairs and platforms on supporting structure.I I lr*trffi'ir*li;1i1?,#'a'J$rffi:H",ffi';",Y*T"fi:ffiT,:"i#::i3tliil fusion without undercut or overlap. Remove welding flux immediately. At exposed I connections, finish exposed welds smooth and blended.r 2. Use connections that maintain structural value ofjoined pieces. - 3. Cut drill, and punch metals cleanly and accurately. Remove burrs and ease edges, unless I otherwise indicated. Remove sharp or rough areas on exposed surfaces.a 4. Form bent-metal comers to smallest radius possible without impairing work. 5. Form exposed connections with hairline joints, flush and smooth, using concealed t fasteners where possible. Locate joints where least conspicuous. I C. Stair Framing: Fabricate stringers of steel plates or channels. Construct platforms of steel plate I or channel headers and miscellaneous framing members. t l. Ifusing bolts, fabricate andjoin so bolts are not exposed on finished surfaces. ). I D. Metal-Pan Stairs: Form risers, subkead pans, and subplatforms to configr.nations shown from'- steel she€t of thickness needed to comply with performance requirements but not less than o 0677 inch (1.7 mm).II l. At Conbactor's option, provide siair assemblies with metal-pan subtreads frlled with reinforced concrete durine fabrication.I I METAL STAIRS 0551I - 3 I I I I I B. 2.5 20021501.08 VAIL MOIINTI,AN LODGE 3/20/2004 FINISHES Comply with NAAMM's "Metal Finishes Manual for Architectural and Metal Products" for recornmendations for applying and designating finishes. Finish metal stairs after assembly. Preparation for Shop Priming: Prepare uncoated ferrous-metal surfaces to comply with requirements indicated below for environmental exposure conditions of installed producs: 1. Interior Stairs (SSPC Zone lA): SSPC-SP 3, "Power Tool Cleaning." Apply shop primer to uncoated surfaces of metal stair components. Comply with SSPC-PA l, 'Paint Application Specification No. l: Shop, Field, and Maintenance Painting of Steel," for shop painting. PART3 -EXECUTION 3.I INSTALLATION A. Perform cutting, drilling, and fitting required for installing metal stairs. Set units accurately in location, alignment, and elevation, measured from established lines and levels and free of rack. Install metal stairs by welding stair framing to steel stucture or to weld plates cast into concrete, unless otherwise indicated. Fit exposed connections accurately together to form hairline joints. Weld connections that are not to be left as exposed joints. Do not weld, cut, or abrade surfaces of exterior rmits that have been hotdip galvanized after fabrication and are for bolted or screwed field connections. Place and finish concrete fill for teads and platforms to comply with Division 3 Section "Cast- in-Place Concrete." Adjusting and Cleaning: l. Immediately after erection, clean field welds, bolted connections, and abraded areas of shop paint, and paint exposed areas with the same material as used for shop painting. END OF SECTION O55I I B. C. D. t t T I I I l t I I t I ! IMETAL STAIRS 0551I - 4 I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDGE 3t20/2004r - ll SECTIONO552I -PIPEANDTUBERAILINGS I PART I -GENERAL .] 1.I ST]MMARY! A. This Section includes the following: I l. Steel pipe and tube railings.r _ B. See Division 5 Section "Metal Stairs" for steel tube railings associated with metal stairs. t 1.2 PERFORMANCEREQUIREMENTS I A. Structurat Performance: Provide railings capable of withstanding the effects of gravity loads and the following loads and stresses within limits and mder conditions indicated: II l. Handrails:a a. Uniform load of 50 lbf/ ft. (0.73 kN/m) applied in any direction. I b. Concentated load of 200 lbf (0.89 kXl apptiea in any direction. a c. ' Uniform and concentrated loads need not be assumed to act concurrently. I 2. Top Rails of Guards: I a. Uniform load of 50 lbf/ ft. (0.73 kN/m) applied in any direction. I b. Concentrated load of200 lbf (0.89 kN) applied in any direction. I c. Uniform and concentrated loads need not be assumed to act concurrently. i. Infill of Guards:Ia a. Concentated load of 50 lbf (0.22 kN) applied horizontally on an area of I sq. ft. (0.093 sq. m). I b. Uniform load of 25 lbf/sq. ft. (l.2 kN/sq. m) applied horizontally. t c. Infill load and other loads need nol be assumed to act concurrently. I B. Control of Corosion: Prevent galvanic action and other forms of corrosion by insulating metals t and other materials from direct contact with incompatible materials. ,l t 1.3 SUBMTTTALS A. Product Data: For mechanically connected railings, grout, anchoring cement, and paint I products.! B. Shop Drawings: lnclude plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments to other work. I t PIPE AND TIJBE RAILINGS 0552I - 1 I I t I I I I I I I C. D. 2.1 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOLTNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 l. For installed products indicated to comply with design loads, include structural analysis data signed and sealed by the qualified professional engineer responsible for their preparation. Samples: For each exposed finish required. Product Test Reports: Based on evaluation of comprehensive tests performed by a qualified testing agency, according to ASTM E 894 and ASTM E 935. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MANUFACTTJRERS Available Manufacfurers: Subject to compliance with requirernents, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: 1. Steel Pipe and Tube Railings: a. Pisor Industries, [nc. b. SharpeProducts. c. Wagrer, R & B, Inc.; a division of the Wagner Companies. METALS Brackets, Flanges, and Anchors: Cast or formed metal of same fpe of material and finish as supported rails, unless othenvise indicated. Steel and hon: l. Tubing: ASTM A 500 (cold formed) or ASTM A 513, Type 5 (mandrel drawn). 2. Pipe: ASTM A 53iA 53M, Type F or Type S, Grade A, Standard Weight (Schedulc 40), unless another grade and weight are required by structural loads. 3. Plates,Shapes,andBars: ASTMA 361A36M. 4. Castings: Either gray or malleable iron, unless otherwise indicated. a. Gray hon: ASTM A 48/A 48M, Class 30, rmless another class is indicated or required by struchral loads.b. Malleablekon: ASTM A47/A47M. 5. Expanded Metal: ASTMF 1267, Type I (expanded) or II (expanded and flattened)1, Class 1 (uncoated). 2.3 MISCELLANEOUS MATERTALS A. Fasteners: Provide concealed fasteners, unless unavoidable or standard for railings indicated.l. Steel Railings: Plated steel fasteners complying with ASTM B 633, Class FelZn 25 for electrodeposited zinc coating. 2.2 I I I I I I I t B. I I T PIPE AND TT]BE RAILINGS 05521-2 T I I I I t I I 20021s0r.08 E. F. G. VAIL MOTINTIAN LODCE 3/20t2004 Anchors: Provide cast-in-place, chemical or torque-controlled expansion anchors, fabricated from corrosion-resistant materials with capability to sustain, without failure, a load equal to six times the load imposed when installed in unit masonry and equal to four times the load imposed when installed in concrete, as determined by testing per ASTM E 488. Welding Rods and Bare Electrodes: Select according to AWS specifications for metal alloy welded. Shop Primers: Provide primers that comply with Division 9 painting Sections. Universal Shop Primer: Fast-curing, lead- and chromate-free, universal modified-alkyd primer complying with MPI#79. Zinc-Rich Primer: Complying with SSPC-Paint 20 or SSPC-Paint 29 and compatible with topcoat. Shop Primer for Galvanized Steel: Zincdust, zinc-oxide primer compatible with finish paint systems indicated, and cornplying with SSPC-Paint 5. Grout and Anchoring Cement: Factory-packaged, nonshrink, nonmetallic grout complying with ASTM C I107; or water-resistanl, nonshrink anchoring cement; recornmended by rnanufacfurer for exterior use. FABRICATION General: Fabricate railings to comply with desigr, dimensions, and details indicated, but not less than that required to support structural loads. Welded Connections: Cope components at connections to provide close fit, or use fittings designed for this purpose. Weld all around at connections, including at fittings. Nonwelded Connections: Connect members with concealed mechanical fasteners and fittings. Form curves by bending in jigs to produce uniform curvature; maintain cross section of member throughout bend without cracking or otherwise deforming exposed surfaces. Close exposed ends of railing members with prefab'ricated end fittings. Provide wall returns at ends of wall-mounted handrails. unless otherwise indicated. Brackets, Flanges, Fittings, and Anchors: Provide wall brackets, flanges, miscellaneous fittings, and anchors to interconnect railing members to other work, unless othenvise indicated. FINISHES Steel and hon: I . Galvanized Railings: Hotdip galvanize exterior railings, after fabrication, to comply with ASTM Al23lAl23M. Provide hot-dip galvanized fittings, brackets, fastaners, sleeves, and other ferrous components. B. C. D. E. F. G. T I I I 2.4 B. c. D. 2.5 I I I I I I I PIPE AND TUBE RAILINGS 05521 - 3 3.1 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 Shop-Primed Galvanized Railings: After galvanizing, clean railings, treat with metallic- phosphate process, and apply primer to comply with SSPC-PA 1. Shop-Primed Steel Finish: Prepare to comply with SSPC-SP 6NACE No. 3, "Commercial Blast Cleaning" and apply primer to comply with SSPC-PA l. PART 3 . EXECUTION INSTALLATION General: Perform cutting drilling, and fitting required for installing railings. Set railings accurately in location, alignment, and elevation. l. Set posts plumb within a tolerance of l/16 inch in 3 feet (2 mm in 1 m).2. Align rails so variations from level for horizontal mernbers and variations from parallel with rake of steps and ramps for sloping members do not exceed ll4 inch in 12 feet (5 mm in 3 m). Coat concealed surfaces of aluminum that will be in contact with grout, concrete, masonry, wood, or dissirnilar metals, with a heavy coat of bifuminous paint. Anchor posts in concrete by inserting into preset steel pipe sleeves, formed or core-drilled holes and grouting annular space. Anchor posts to metal surfaces with oval flanges. Anchor railing ends to concrete and masonry with round flanges connected to railing ends and anchored to wall construction with anchors and bolts. Attach handrails to wall with wall brackets. l. Use type of bracket with flange tapped for concealed anchorage to threaded hanger bolt.2. For steel-framed partitions, fasten to steel framing or concealed steel reinforcements using self-tapping screws of size and type required to support structural loads. Adjusting and Cleaning: l. Immediately after erection, clean field welds, bolted cormections, and abraded areas of shop paint, and paint exposed areas with the same material as used for shop painting.2. Galvanized Surfaces: Clean field welds, bolted connections, and abraded areas and repair galvanizing to comply with ASTM A 780. END OF SECTION 05521 I I I t I t I T I I I I I t T T I t I J. B. C. D, E. F. G. PIPE AND TUBE RAILINGS 0552r - 4 I 2002150r.08 vAIL MotrNTrAN LoDGE 3t21t2004I Ii SECTION 06105 . MISCELLANEOUS CARPENTRY r PART1 -GENERAL I l.l suMMARY! A. This Section includes the following: I l. Miscellaneous lumber.a 2. Shelving and clothes rods. 3. Panel products.t I 1.2 STJBMITTALS I A. Product Data: For each type of process and factory-fabricated product indicated. I l. lnclude data for wood-preservative and fire-retardant treatment from chemical treatment I manufacturer and certification by heating plant that materials comply with requirements. _ B. ResearcMEvaluation Reports: For the following: a l. heservative-heated wood. 2. Fire-retardant-treatedwood. I 3. Powerdriven fasteners. t I PART2-PRODUCTS I 2.1 WOOD PRODUCTS, GENERAL r A. Lumber: DOC PS 20 and applicable rules of lumber grading agencies certified by the American Lumber Standards Committee Board of Review. I l Factory mark each piece of lumber with grade stamp of grading agency. 2. For exposed lumber indicated to receive stained or natural finish, mark grade stamp on I end orback ofeachpiece. a 3. Provide dressed lumber, S4S, unless otherwise indicated. 4. Provide dry lumber with 15 percent maximum moisture content at time of dressing for 2- inch nominal (38-mm actual) thickness or less, unless otherwise indicated. - B. Wood Struchral Panels: I 1. Plywood: DOC PS I or DOC PS 2, unless otherwise indicated.I I I I MISCELLANEOUS CARPENTRY 06105 - I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t21t2004 WOOD-PRESERVATTVE-TREATED MATERI,ALS Preservative Treatment by Pressure hocess: AWPA C2 (lumber) and AWPA C9 (plywood), except that lumber that is not in contact with the ground and is continuously protected from liquid water may be treated according to AWPA C3l with inorganic boron (SBX). Kiln-dry material after teatment to a maximum moisture content of 19 percent for lumber and l5 percent for plywood. Mark each healed item with the treatment quality mark of an inspection agency approved by the American Lumber Standards Committee Board of Review. Application: Treat items indicated on Drawings, and the following: l. Wood cants, nailers, curbs, equipment support bases, blocking, stripping, and similar members in connection with roofing, flashing, vapor barriers, and waterproofing.2. Wood sills, sleepers, blocking, furring, stripping, and similar concealed members in contact with masonrv or concrete. FIRE-RETARDANT.TREATED MATERIALS Where fire-retardant-treated materials are indicated, provide materials that comply with performance requirements in AWPA C20 (lumber) and AWPA C27 (plywood). Identiff.fire- retardant-treated wood with appropriate classification marking of UL, U.S. Testing, Timber Products Inspection, or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. l. Use Exterior type for exterior locations and where indicated. 2. Use Interior Type A High Ternperature (HT), unless othenvise indicated. DMENSIONLT]MBER General: Of grades indicated according to the American Lumber Standards Committee National Grading Rule provisions of the grading agency indicated. MISCELLANEOUS LUMBER Provide miscellaneous lumber for support or attachment of other construction, including the following: l' Rooftop equipment bases and support curbs. 2. Blocking. 3. Cants. 4. Nailers. 5. Furring. 6. Grounds. For items of dimension lumber size, provide Construction, Stud, or No. 2 grade lumber with 15 percent maximum moisture content of any species. T I I I I T I T 2.2 B. c. D. 2..) A.I I I I I I I I I I I 2.4 2.5 MISCELLANEOUS CARPENTRY 06105 - 2 I 20021s01.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDGE itzv2o04I I C. For exposed boards, provide lumber, with 15 percent maximum moisture content, of eastem S white pine, Idaho white, lodgepole, ponderosa, or sugar pine; D Select (Quality) grade; NELMA, NLGA, WCLIB, or WWPA. t D. For concealed boards, provide lumber with 15 percent maximum moisture content and any of the following species and grades: I l. Mixed southem pine, No. 2 grade; SPIB. 2. Eastem softwoods, No.2 Common grade; NELMA. I 3. Northern species, No.2 Common grade; NLGA. I 4. Western woods, Constuction or No. 2 Common grade; WCLIB or WWPA. I 2.6 sHELVTNGAND cLorHES RoDS ! A. Shelving: 3/4-inch ( l9-mrn) medium-density fiberboard shelving with radiused front edge. I B. Clothes Rods: 1-1/2-inch- (-18-mm-) diarneter, clear, kiln-dried hardwood rods. t 2.7 PANEL PRODUCTS - A. Miscellaneous Concealed Plywood: Exterior sheathing, span rating to suit framing in each I location, and thickness as.indicated but not less than 112 inch (13 rnnr). B. Miscellaneous Exposed Plywood: DOC PS l, A-D Interior, thickness as indicated but not less I than l/2 inch (13 mm).a C. Telephone and Electrical Equipment Backing Panels: DOC PS 1, Exposure 1, C-D Plugged, I fire-retardanl treated, in thickness indicated or, if not indicated, not less than 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) I thick. t 2.8 FASTENERS A. General: Where carpentry is exposed to weather, in ground contact, or in area of high relative I humidity, provide fasteneis with hot-dip zinc coating complying with ASTM A 153/,4. 153M.t B. Power-Driven Fasteners: CABO NER-272. a C. Screws for Fastening to Cold-Formed Metal Framing: ASTM C 954, except with wafer heads and reamer wings. I! PART3-EXECUTION I! 3.I INSTALLATION I A. Set carpentry to required levels and lines, with members plumb, kue to line, cut, and fitted. Fit f carpentry to other construction; scribe and cope as needed for accurate fit. Locate [furring,] r MISCELLANEOUS CARPENTRY 06105 - 3 r 2002 I 501 .08 VAILMOI]NTIAN LODGE 3/2r/2004 nailers, blocking, grounds, and similar supports to comply with requirements for attaching other constuction. B. Securely attach carpentry work as indicated and according to applicable codes and recognized standards. C. Countersink fastener heads on exposed carpentry work and fill holes with wood filler. D. Wood Stntctural Panels: Comply with applicable recommendations contained in APA Form No. E30K, "APA Design/Constructbn Guide: Residential & Commercial," for types of structural-use panels and applications indicated. END OF SECTION 06105 I ! I I I t I t T I I t I I T I I T I MISCELLANEOUS CARPENTRY 06105 - 4 I 2002rs0r.08 vArL MouNTr.AN LoDGE 3/2r/2004 I sEcrroN 06150 - wooD DEcKrNc I PARr 1-.ENERAL I 1.1 suMMARy A. This Section includes the following: r l. Solid-sawn roof(solfit and ceiling) decking. I 1.2 suBMrrrALS - A. Product Data r B. Samples: I t tJ*fl ili #:".,rr_::aucts for hansparent finish, for each species and cut, finished on I I.3 QUALITYASSTJRANCE I A. Decking Standard: Comply with AITC I12, "Standard for Tongue-and-Groove Heavy Timber t Roof Decking." I 1.4 DELIVERY, SToRAGE, ANDHANDLING A. Schedule delivery ofwood decking to avoid extended on-site storage and to avoid delaying theI Work.t I PARr2-PRODUcrs I 2.1 LT.JMBER.GENERAL t A. Gerreral: Comply with DOCPS20, "American Softwood Lumber Standard,u and with I applicable grading rules of inspection agencies certified by ALSC's Board of Review. I B. Grade Stamps: Factory mark with grade stamp of inspection agency on surfaces that will not be exposed to view. t C. *oir,*" Content: Provide wood decking with 15 percent maximum moisture content at time of dressine. I I wooD DECKING 06150 _ 1I t I I I I t I t C. D. 2.2 20021501 .08 VAILMOUNTTAN LODGE 3t2v2004 SOLID-SAWN WOOD DECKING Wood Species: L lnterior: Reference lnterior Speci{ication Sheets.2. Exterior: Rough Sawn, Westem Red Cedar, plain sawn. Decking Nominal Size: 1. lnterior: Reference Interior Specification Sheets.2. Exterior: I x6. Decking Grade: l Interior: Reference Interior Specification Sheets-2. Exterior: Select(ed) Decking or Select Dex. Surface and Edge Pattem: l Interior: Reference Interior Specification Sheets.2. Exterior: Smooth strrface, Vee grooved. 2.3 FASTENERS AND ACCESSORY MATERIALS A. Exterior Fastener Material: Hofdip galvanized steel. B. Sealant: Latex sealant compatible with substates. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I INSTALLATION A. solid-Sawn wood Decking: Install to comply with referenced decking standard. B. Apply joint sealant to seal roof decking at exterior walls at thc following locations: l. Between decking and supports located at exterior walls.2. Between decking and exterior walls that butt against underside ofdecking.3. Between tongues and grooves of decking over exterior walls and supports at exterior walls. Repair damaged surfaces and finishes after completing erection. Replace damaged decking if repairs are not approved by Architect. END OF SECTION 06150 I! I I I I I T I I t I WOODDECKING 06150 - 2 I I I t I I I t t I t I I t T t I T I 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 SECTION 06401 - EXTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK PART I -GENERAL 1.I SI.IMMARY A. This Section includes the following: l. Exterior standing and running trim. 2. Exterior omamental work. 3. Exterior frames and jambs. 4. Exterior siding. 5. Shop priming of exterior arcbitectural woodwork. 6. Shop finishing of exterior architectural woodwork. 1.2 SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: For wood-pre servative materials and finishes indicated. B. Shop Drawings: Include location of each itenr, dimensioned plans and elevations, large-scale details, attachment devices, and other components. C. Samples: For lumber for exterior wood stain Iinish, for each finish systern and color, with one- half of exposed surface fi nished. 1.3 QUATTTYASSURANCE A. Quality Standard: Unless otherwise indicated, comply with AWI's "Architectural Woodwork Quality Standards." PART 2 - PRODUCTS MATERI.ALS Fire-Retardant Treatment: For all exterior siding, use materials impregnated with fire-retardant chemicals per AWPA C20; exterior type or interior Type A as required. Wood-Preservative-Treated Materials, Nonpressure Process: Treat woodwork items indicated to receive water-repellent preservative teatrnent to comply with AWPA Nl using the following preservative: I . Water-Repellent Preservative: Formulation containing 3-iodo-2-propynyl butyl carbamate (IPBC) complying with AWPA P8 as its active ingredieat. 2.1 B. EXTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK 06401 - l 20021501.08 VAIL MOI,JNTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 2. Water-Repellent Preservative/Insecticide: Formulation containing 3-iodo-2-propynyl bufyl carbamate (IPBC) as its active ingredient, combined with an insecticide containing chlorpyrifos as its active ingredient, both cornpllng with AWPA P8. Nails: Hot-dip galvanized. Screws: Hotdip galvanized. FIRE-RETARDANT-TREATED MATERIALS Where fire-retardant-treated materials are indicated, provide materials that comply with performance requirements in AWPA C20 (umber) and AWPA C27 (plywood). Identiff fire- retardant-treated wood with appropriate classification marking of UL, U.S. Testing, Timber Products Inspection, or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. l. Use Exterior type for exterior locations and where indicated. a. Exterior standing and running h'im. b. Exterior omamental work. c. Exterior frames and jambs. d. Exterior siding. FABRICATION Wood Moisture Content: 9 to 15 percent. Complete fabrication, including assembly, frnishing, and hardware ap'plication, to maximum extent possible, before shipment to Project site. Disassemble components only as necessary for shipment and installation. Where necessary for fitting at site, provide arnple allowance for scribing, t'imming, and fitting. Woodwork for Transparent Finish: l. Grade: Custom. 2. Wood Species: Western red cedar. Backout or groove backs of flat trim members and kerf backs of other wide, flat members, except for mernbers with ends exposed in finished worlc Shop Priming: Shop prime woodwork for paint finish with one coat of wood primer specified in Dvision 9 Section "Painting." l. Backpriming: Apply one coat of sealer or primer, compatible with finish coats, to concealed surfaces of woodwork. Apply two coats to surfaces installed in contact with concrete or masonry and to end-grain surfaces. Shop Finishing: Comply with AWI Section 1500 To greatest extent possible, finish architectural woodwork at fabrication shop. Defer only final touchup and cleaning until after installation. t I I I I t I I I I I I I I T I I t I C. D. 2.2 2.3 A. B. D. F. EXTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK 06401-2 3.1 B. C. D. F. G. t I I I I I I I I I t I I t I I I I I 2002r501.08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 Grade: Custom. Backpriming: Apply one coat of sealer or primer, compatibre with finish coats, to concealed surfaces of woodwork. Apply two coats lo surfaces installed in contact with concrete or masonry and to end-grain surfaces. Finish System: To match existing. Sheen: To match existing. PART3 -EXECUTION INSTALLATION Condition woodwork to average prevailing humidity conditions in installation areas before installation. Before installing architectural woodworlg examine shop-fabricated work for completion and complete work as required, including backpriming and removal of packing. Quality standard: Install woodwork to comply with AWI Section 1700 for the same grade specified for type of woodwork involved. Install woodwork true and straight with no distortions. Shim as required with concealed shims. Install level and plumb to a tolerance of l/8 inch in 96 inches (3 mm in 2400 mm). Scribe and cut woodwork to fit adjoining work, and refinish cut surfaces or repair damaged finish at cuts. Anchor woodwork to anchors or blocking built in or directly attached to subsFates. Secure to 4o*dt' stripping and blocking with countersunk, concealed fasteners and blind nailing. Use fine finishing nails for exposed nailing, countersunk and fired flush with woodwork. Cornplete the finishing work specified to extent not completed at shop or before jnstallation of woodwork. Fill nail and screw holes with matching filler where exposed. Clean woodwork on exposed and semiexposed strrfaces. Touch up shop-applied finishes to restore damaged or soiled areas. END OF SECTION 0640I t. 2. J. 4. EXTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK 06401 - 3 I 2002150r.08 vAIL MoINTIAN LoDGE it20t2oo4r I SECTION 06105 -MISCELLAMOUS CARPENTRY I PART l -GENERAL I r.r suMMARY! A. This Section includes the following: I 1. Miscellaneous lumber.t 2. Shelving and clothes rods. 3. Panel products. I I 1.2 ST]BMITTALS I A. Product Data: For each type of process and factory-fabricated product indicated. r I . krclude data for wood-preservative and fire-retardant treatment from chemical freatment t manufacturer and certification by treating plant that materials comply with requirements. B. Research/Evaluation Reports: For the following: I l. ' Preservative-treated wood. 2. Fire-retardant-treatedwood. I 3. Powerdriven fasteners. I - PART2-PRODUCTS I 2.1 WOOD PRODUCTS, GENERAL ! A. Lumber: DOC PS 20 and applicable rules of lumber grading agencies certified by the American Lumber Standards Committee Board of Review. I I . Factory mark each piece of lumber with grade stamp of grading agency. 2. For exposed lumber indicated to receive stained or natural finish, mark grade stamp on I end or back ofeach piece. I 3. Provide dressed lumber, S4S, unless otherwise indicated. 4. Provide dry lumber with l5 percent maximum moisture content at time of dressing for 2- inch nominal (38-mm actual) thickness or less, unless othenvise indicated. t B. Wood Structural Panels: I l. Plywood: DOC PS 1 or DOC PS 2, unless otherwise indicated.I r t I MISCELLANEOUS CARPENTRY 06105 - I I 20021501.08 vArL MouNTATN LoDcE 3t2ttz004r I SECTION 06402 .INTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK t PART1 -GENERAL I I.I SI]MMARYI A. This Section includes interior woodwork including for the following applications: I 1. Standing and running trim. 2. Wood cabinets. I 3. Plasticlaminate cabinets. f 4. Plasticlaminate countertops. 5. Frames and jambs. I 6. Shopfinishingofwoodwork. I B. Interior architectural woodwork includes wood furring, blocking, shims, and hanging strips, - unless concealed within other construction before woodwork installation. I 1.2 SUBMITIALS I A. Product Data: For the following: I L Cabinet hardware and accessories. || 2. Handrailbrackets.3. Finishing materials and processes. t B. Shop Drawings: Include location of each item, plans and elevations, large-scale details, attachment devices, and other components. I C. Samples:r l. Lumber and panel products for transparent finish, for each species and cut, finished on I one side and one edge.! 2. Lumber and panel products with shop-applied opaque finish, for each finish system and color, with exposed surface finished. I 3. Plasticlaminate-clad panel products, for each type, color, pattem, and surface finish. I 4. Thermoset decorative-overlay surfaced panel products, for each type, color, pattern, and surface finish. I.3 QUALITYASSURANCE I A. Installer Qualifications: Fabricator of woodwork.t B. Quality Standard: Unless otherwise indicated, comply with AWI's "Architectural Woodwork I Quality Standards" for grades of interior architechral woodwork, constuction, finishes, and! other reouirements. I INTERIOR ARCHITECTTIRAL WOOD\MORK 06402 - I t 1.4 2002l501 .08 VAIL MOLINTAIN LODGE 3/2U2004 l. Provide AWI certification labels or compliance certificate indicating that woodwork complies with requirements of grades specified. PROJECT CONDITIONS Environmental Limitations: Do not deliver or install woodwork until building is enclosed, wet work is complete, and HVAC system is operating and maintaining temperatwe and relative humidity at levels planned for building occupants during the remainder of the consfuction period. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MATERIALS Wood for Transparent Finish: l. Species and Cut: Alder, quarter sawn or cut. Wood for Opaque Finish: l. Species: Any closed-grain hardwood. Wood Products: l. Hardboard: AHAAI35.4. 2. Medium-DensityFiberboard: ANSI4208.2,Grade MD. 3. Particleboard: ANSIA208.l.Grade M-2. 4. SoftwoodPlywood: DOCPS I,MediumDensityOverlay. 5. HardwoodPlywoodandFaceVeneers: HPVAHP-I. Thermoset Decorative Overlay: Particleboard or medium-deasity fiberboard with surface of thermally fused, melamine-impregrated decorative paper complying with LMA SAT-1. High-Pressure Decorative Laminate: NEMA LD 3. 1. Available Manufachtrers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: 2. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: a. FormicaCorporation. b. International Paper; Decorative hoducts Div. c. Laminart. d. Pioneer Plastics Corp. e. Westinghouse Elecfic Corp.; Specialty Products Div. f. Wilsonart lnternational: Div. of hemark International. Inc. I I I t I I I T I III II I I I t I I I I 2.1 B. C. D. INTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK 06402 -2 A. B. 2.2 I I I I I I I t I I t I I t I t T I t 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOLTNTAIN LODGE 3t2v2004 C. FIRE-RETARDANT-TREATED MATERIALS Fire-Retardant-Treated Lumber and Plywood: Materials impregnated with fire-retardant chemical formulations to comply with AWPA C20 (lumber) and AWPA C27 (plywood), Exterior Type or Interior Type A. Use fire-retardant-treatment formulations that do not bleed through or otherwise adversely affect finishes. Kiln-dry material after treatment. Fire-Retardant Particleboard: Panels made from softwood particles and fire-retardant chemicals mixed together at time of panel manufacture with flame-spread index of 25 or less and smoke- developed index of25 or less per ASTM E 84. Fire-Retardant Fiberboard: ANSI A208.2 medium{ensity fiberboard panels made from softwood fibers, synthetic resins, and fire-retardant chemicals mixed together at time of panel rnanufacture with flame-spread index of 25 or less and smoke-developed index of 200 or less perASTM E 84. 2.3 CABINETHARDWAREANDACCESSORIES A. General: Provide cabinet hardware and accessory materials for a complete installation of architectural woodwork, except for items specified in Division 8 Section "Door Hardware." B. Hardware Standard: Comply with BHMA A156.9 for items indicated by referencing BHMA numbers or items referenced to this standard. C. Butt Hinges: 2-314-inch (70-mm), S-knuckle steel hinges made from 0.095-inch- (2.4-mm-) thick metal. l. SemiconcealedHinges forFlushDoors: BHMAA156.9, 801361- 2. Semiconcealed Hinges for Overlay Doors: BHMA A156.9, B0l52l. D. Frameless Concealed Hinges (European Type): BHMA A156.9, 801602, self-closing. E. Wire Pulls: Back mounted, 4 inches (100 mm) long 5/16 inches (8 mm) in diameter. F. Catches: Magnetic, BHMA A156.9, B03 141. G. Adjustable Shelf Standards and Supports: BHMA 4156.9, 804071; with shelf rests, 804081. H. Drawer Slides: Side-mounted, full-extension, zinc-plated steel drawer slides with steel ball bearings, BHMA 4'156.9,805091, and rated for the following loads: l. Box Drawer Slides: 100 lbf (440 N).2. File Drawer Slides: 200 lbf (890 N). 3. Pencil Drawer Slides: 45 lbf (200 N). I. Door Locks: BHMA Al56.l l, E07121 J. Drawer Locks: BHMA 4156.1l. E07041 K. Exposed Hardware Finishes: Complying with BHMAAI56.I8 for BHMA finish number indicated. TNTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK 0@02 -3 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t21t2004 Reference interior designer specifi cation sheets. Satin Chromium Plated: BHMA 626 for hrrass or bronze base: BHMA 652 for steel base. INSTALLATION MATERIALS Furring, Blocking, Shims, and Hanging Strips: Softwood or hardwood lumber, fire-retardant- heated, kiln-dried to less than 15 percent moisture content. Handrail Brackets: Cast from malleable iron with wall flange drilled and tapped for concealed hanger bolt and with support arm for screwing to underside ofrail. Sized to provide I -ll2-inch (38-mnr) clearance between handrail and wall. FABRICATION General: Complete fabrication to maximum extent possible before shipment to Project site. Where necessary for fitting at site, provide allowance for scribing, trimming, and fitting. l. lnterior Woodwork Grade: Premium. @welling Unit), Custom, and Economy (at employee housing units) complying with the referenced quality standard. 2. Shop cut openings to maximum extent possible. Sand edges of cutouts to remove splinters and burrs. Seal edges of openings in countertops with a coat of varnish. For bim items wider than available lumber, use veneered construction. Do not glue for width. 5. Backout or groove backs of flat trim members and kerf bacla of other wide, flat members, except for mernbers with ands exposed in finished work. 6. Assemble casings in plant except wtrcrc limitations of access to place of installation require field assembly. Premium Grade Wood Cabinets for Transparent Finish: l. AWI Type of Cabinet Construction: Flush overlay. 2. Grain Matching: Rrm and match grain vertically for drawer fronts, doors, and fixed panels. 3. Matching of Veneer Leaves: Book match. 4. Veneer Matching within Panel Face: Balance match. 5. Semiexposed Surfaces Other Than Drawer Bodies: Match species and cut indicated for exposed surfaces. a. Drawer Sides and Backs: Solid-hardwood lumber, same species indicated for exposed surfaces. b. Drawer Bottoms: Hardwood p-lywood, same species indicated for exposed surfaces. 6. Provide dust panels of l/4-inch (6.4-mm) plywood or tempered hardboard above compartments and drawers, unless located directly under tops. Custom Wood Cabinets for Transoarent Finish: I I I l. 2. 2.4 B. I I I I I I T t I I I t I I I I 2.5 J. A B. C. INTERIOR ARCHITECTURAI WOODWORK 0@02-4 I 2oo2rsol.o8 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE 312112004 I l. AWI Type of Cabinet Construction: Flush overlay. I 2. Matching of Veneer Leaves: Book match. 3. Semiexposed Surfaces Other Than Drawer Bodies: Compatible species to that indicated for exposed surfaces, stained to match. I a. Drawer Sides and Backs: Solid-hardwood lumber, stained to match species I indicated for exposed surfaces. t b. Drawer Bottoms: Hardwood plywood, same species indicated for exposed surfaces. I 4. Provide dust panels of l/4-inch (6.4-mm) ptywood or tempered hardboard abovet compartments and drawers, unless located Oirecily under tops. I D. Plastic-Laminate Cabinets:I 1. AWI Type of Cabinet Construction: Flush overlay. | 2. Laminate Cladding for Exposed Surfaces: High-pressure decorative of grade indicated. I a. Horizontal Surfaces Other Than Tops: HGS. b. Postformed Surfaces: HGP. t i. ;;ltj:l;ffi;:,X8lr-,""n (0460-mm) minimum thickness, matching raminate . in color, pattern, and finish. r' 3. Materials'for Semiexposed Surfaces Other Than Drawer Bodies: Thermoset decorative overlay. I a. Drawer Sides and Backs: Thermoset decorative overlay. b. Drawer Bottoms: Thermoset decorative overlav. I 4. Colors, Pattems, and Finishes: As selected from manufacturer's full range. I E. Plastic-Laminate Countertops: I I . High-Pressure Decorative Laminate Grade: HGS. r 2. Colors, Patterns, and Finishes: As selected from manufacturer's full range. I 3. Edge Treatrnent: Same as laminate cladding on horizontal surfaces.! 4. Core Material at Sinks: Particleboard made with exterior elue. I F. Rails: t l. Handrails: Transparent finish. I G. Fire-Rated Interior Frames and Jambs: Products fabricated from fire-retardant particleboard or I fire-retardant medium-density fiberboard with veneered, exposed surfaces and listed and labeled by a testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, for fire ratings I indicated, based on testing according to NFPA 252. - 1. Test Pressure: Test at atmospheric pressure. - 2. Fire Rating: 20 minutes. I I I INTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK 06402 - 5 2002 r s01 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3tzt/2404 SHOP FINISHING Finish architectural woodwork at fabrication shop. Defer only final touchup, cleaning, and polishing until after installation. Backpriming: Apply one coat of sealer or primer, cornpatible with finish coats, to concealed surfaces of woodwork. Apply fwo coats to back of paneling. Transparent Finish: Comply with requirements indicated below for grade, finish system, staining, and sheen, with sheen measured on 60deg ree gloss meter per ASTM D 523: 1. Grade: Prernium (Dwelling Unit), Custom elsewhere.2. AWI Finish Systern: TR4, conversion varnish. 3. Staining: Match sample. 4. Wash Coat for Stained Finish: Apply a vinyl wash coat to woodwork made from closed- grain wood before staining and finishing. 5. Open-Grain Woods: Do not apply filler to open-grain woods. After staining (if any), apply paste wood filler to open-grain woods and wipe off excess. Tint filler to match stained wood. 6. Sheen: Flat, 10-25 gloss units. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTALLATION Condition woodwork to average prevailing humidity conditions in installation areas and examine and complete work as required, including removal of packing and backpriming before installation. Quality Standard: lnstall woodwork to comply with AWI Section 1700 for the same grade specified in this Section for type of woodwork involved. Install woodwork level, plumb, true, and shaight to a tolerance of 1/8 inch in 96 inches (3 mm in 2440 mm). Shim as required with concealed shims. Scribe and cut woodwork to fit adjoining worlg and refinish cut surfaces and repair damaged finish at cuts. Anchor woodwork to anchors or blocking built in or directly attached to substrates. Secure with countersunk, concealed fasteners and blind nailing as required for complete installation. Use fine finishing nails or finishing screws for exposed fastening, countersunk and filled flush with woodwork and matching final finish if transparent finish is indicated. Standing and Running Trim: tnstall with minimum number ofjoints possible, using full-length pieces (from maximum length of lumber available) to greatest extent possible. Fill gaps, if any, between top of base and wall with plastic wood filler, sand smooth, and finish same as wood base, if finished. I I I 2.6 A. B. c. I T J- l A. B. I I t I t t I t I T D. F.I t I I INTERIOR ARCHITECTT.]RAL WOODWORK 06402 - 6 G. T I t I I I I I t t t t T t I I I I t 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t2r/2004 Cabinets: lnstall without distortion so doors and drawers fit openings properly and are accurately aligned. Adjust hardware to center doors and drawers in openings and to provide unencumbered operati on. l. Fasten wall cabinets through back, near top and bottom, at ends and not more than 16 inches (400 nrm) o.c. with No. l0 wafer-head sheet metal screws through metal backing or metal framing behind wall finish. Countertops: Anchor securely by screwing through comer blocks of base cabinets or other supports into underside of countertop. Calk space between backsplash and wall with sealant specified in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants." Rails: Cut carriages to accurately fit heads and risers and securely anchor lo supporting substrates. Glue teads to risers, and glue and nail treads and risers to carriages. Glue and dowel or pin balusters to treads and railings, and railings to newel posts and support wall railings on indicated metal brackets securely fastened to wall framing. END OF SECTION 06402 INTERIOR ARCHITECTURAL WOODWORK 06402 -7 f, 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 I SECTION 07 I 42 . HOT FLUID.APPLIED WATERPROOFING lt't PART I -GENERAL I) "' 1.1 RELATEDDOCUMENTS I A. Drawings and general provisions of the Contract including General and Supplemantary I Conditions and Division I Specification Sections, aprply to this Section. I r.z suMMARY I A. This Section includes the following: ! l. Reinforced waterproofing membrane. ^ B. Related Sections include the following: f t P,i,Hl:lnt Section "Foundation Drainage Systerns" for drainage panels and geotextile fl 2. Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants" for joint-sealant materials and installation. I 3. Division 9 Section "Stone Paving and Flooring" for stone paving. t 1.3 PERFORMANCEREQUTREMENTS - A. Provide waterproofing that prevents the passage of water and complies with physical I requirements in CAN/CGSB-37.50, "Hot Applied, Rubberized Asphalt for Roofing andr Waterproofing." .tr1 1.4 SUBMITTALS I A. Product Data: Include manufachner's written instructions for evaluating, preparing, and freating I substrate, technical data, and tested physical and performance properties. - B. Shop Drawings: Show locations and extent of waterproofing. Include details for substrate I joints and cracks, sheet flasbings, penetrations, inside and outside comers, tie-ins to adjoining - waterproofing, and other termination conditions. I C. Samples: For the following products:U l. l2-by-12-inch(300-by-300-mm)squareofflashingsheet. I 2. l2-by-12-inch (300-by-300-mm) square of insulation. I 3. 4-by4-inch (100-by-100-mm) square of drainage panel. I D. Installer Certificates: Signed by manufacturers certiflng that installers comply with f requirements. tI HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - I I 20021501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 Sample Warranty: Copy of special waterproofing manufacturer's and Installer's warranty stating obligations, remedies, limitations, and exclusions before starting waterproofing. QUALITY ASSURANCE lnstaller Qualifications: A qualified installer who is authorized, approved, or licensed to install waterproofing manufacturer's products; and who is eligible to receive waterproofing warranty specified. Source Limitations: Obtain waterproofing materials, sheet flashings, protection course, and drainage panels through one source from a single manufacfurer. L Mockups: Apply waterproofing to 100 sq. ft. (9.3 sq. m) of deck and wall to demonstate surface prepa.ration, crack and joint treatment, comer treatment, thickness, texture, and execution quality 2. Approved mockups may become part of the completed Work if rmdistrnbed at time of Substanfi al Completion. DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Dbliver liquid materials to Project site in original containers with seals rmbroken, labeled with manufactr:rer's name, product brand name and 1pe, date of manufacture, and directions for storing and mixing with other conrponents. Store liquid materials in their original rmdamaged containers in a clean, dry, protected location and within the temperature range required by waterproofing manufacturer. Rernove and replace liquid materials that cannot be applied within their stated shelflife. Protect stored materials from direct sunlight. PROJECT CONDITIONS Environmental Limitations: Apply waterproofing within the range of ambient and substate temperatures recommended by waterproofing manufacturer. Do not apply waterproofing to a damp or wet substate, or when temperahre is below 0 deg F (minus l8 deg C). l. Do not apply waterproofing in snow, rain, fog, or mist. Maintain adequate vertilation during application and curing of waterproofing materials. I.8 WARRANTY A. Special Manufacturer's Warranty: Written warranty, signed by waterproofing manufacturer agreeing to repair or replace waterproofing and sheet flashings that do not comply with requirements or that do not remain watertight within specified warranty period. I I 1.5 I t I I B. I I 1.6 C. D. I I il I I J I 1.7 B. I I IHOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07t42 - 2 B. 2.1 2.2 I I I I l t I t I t t, 3 t I t l $ I l 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t20t2004 l. Warranty does not include failure of waterproofing due to failure of substrate prepared and teated according to requirements or formation ofnew joints and cracks in substrate that exceed 1/8 inch (3 mm) in width. 2. Warranty Period: l0 years after date of Substantial Completion. B. Special Installer's Warranty: Written waterproofing Installer's warranty, on warranty form at end of this Section, sigrred by Installer, covering Work of this Section, for warranty period of two years. l. Warranty includes removing and reinstalling protection board, drainage panels, and insulation. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MANUFACTI.]RERS Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the following products: American Hydrotech, Inc.; Monolithic Membrane 6125. American Perrnaquik Inc.; Permaquik 6100. Barreft Company; Ram-Tough 250. Carlisle Corporation, Carlisle Coatings & Waterproofing Div.; CCW-500. T. C. Miadri; Miraseal 9100. Monsey Bakor; Elasto-Seal 790-ll. Protecto Wrap Co.; HM625B. Tremco; Tremproof 150. MEMBRANE Single-component; 100 perc€nt solids; hot fluid-applied, rubberized asphalt with the following properties measured per applicable test methods in CAN/CGSB-37.50: 1. Flash Point: Not less than 260 degC or not less tlnn25 degC above manufacturer's maximum recommended application temperature. 2. Cone Penetration: I l0 maximum at25 degC, and 200 maximum at 50 deg C. 3. Flow: 3mmmaximumat60degC. 4. Toughness: Not less than 5.5 J 5. Ratio ofToughness to Peak Load: Not less than 0.040. 6. Adhesion Rating: Pass. 7. Water-Vapor Perneance: 1.7 ngtPa x s x sq. m. 8. Water Absorption: 0.35-9 maximum mass gain, or 0.18-g maximum mass loss. 9. Pinholing: Not more than one pinhole. 10. Low-TemperatureFlexibility: Nocracking. 11. Crack Bridging Capability: No cracking, splitting, or loss of adhesion. HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - 3 2002r50l.08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3120t2004 12. Heat Stability: Comply with requirements for penebation, flow, Iow-temperature flexibility, and viscosity when heated for five hours at manufacturer's recommended application temperature. 13. Viscositv Test: 2 to 15 seconds. 2.3 AUXILIARYMATERIALS A. Primer: ASTM D 41, aspbaltic primer. B. Elastomeric Flashing Sheet 50-mil- (1.3-mm-) minimum, nonstaining, uncured sheet neoprene with manufacturer's recommended contact adhesives and predrilled metal termination bars and anchors, with the following physical properties as measured per standard test methods refereaced: l. Tensile Strength: 1400 psi (9.6 MPa) minimurn; ASTM D412, Die C. 2. Elongation: 300 percent minimum; ASTM D 412. 3. Tear Resistance: 125 psi (860 kPa) minimum; ASTM D 624,Ae C. 4. Brittleness: Does not break at minus 30 deg F (34 deg C); ASTM D 2137. C. Modified-Bituminous Flashing Sheel SBS-modified bituminous sheet, 160-mii- (4-mm-) thiclq woven or nonwoven polyester or glass-fiber reinforced; suitable for application method specifi ed; granular surfaced. D. Sealants and Accessories: Waterproofing manufachugr's reconnnended sealants and accessories. E. Reinforcing Fabric: Manufactwer's recommended spum-bonded polyester fabric. F. Separator Sheel ASTM D 4397, polyethylene sheet, minimum 4 mils (0.l0 mm) thick. G. Protection Course: Semirigid sheets of fiberglass or mineral-reinforced-asphaltic core, pressure laminated between two asphalt-saturated fibrous liners and as follows: l. Thickness: l/4 inch (6 mm), nominal. 2. Adhesive: Rubber-based solvent t5pe recommended by waterproofing manufacturer for type of protection course. 2.4 MOLDED.SHEETDRAINAGEPANELS A. Molded-Sheet Drainage Panel: Comply with Dvision 2 Section "Foundation Drainage Systems." 2,5 INSULATION A. Board Insulation: Extruded-polystyrene board insulation complying with ASTM C 578, square edged of type, density, and compressive sbength indicated below: 1. TypeV,3lb/cu. ft. (48-kg/cu. m) minimum density and 100-psi (690-kPa) minimum compressive strength. I l I I t 0 I I ! I c f, a I I I fl I I HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - 4 B. c. B. 2.6 I I I ) I I I I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOT,INTAIN LODGE 3/2012004 lnsulation Drainage Panels: Extruded-polystyrene board insulation complying with ASTM C 578; fabricated with shiplap or tongue-and-groove edges and with one side having grooved drainage channels, unfaced or faced with manufacturer's standard, nonwoven geotextile filter fabric. 1. TypeVI, 1.8-lb/cu. ft. (2g-kg/cu. m) minimum density and 40-psi (276-kPa) minimum compressive strengtb. Available Manufacfurers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into tbe Work include, but are not limited to, the following: l. DiversifoamProducts. 2. Dow Chemical Company (The). 3. Owens Coming. 4. T. Clear Corporation. 5. Tenneco Building Products. PLAZADECKPAVERS Plaza Deck Pavers: Slate pavers specified in Dvision 9 Section "Stone Paving and Flooring." I . Colors and Textures: To match existing. Setting Bed: Provide mortar setting-bed materials specified in Division 2 Section "Unit Pav€rs." l. Concrete Fill: ACI 301, compressive shength of 5000 psi (34 MPa) at 28 days and air content of 6 percent. PART 3 - EXECUTION EXAMINATION Examine substrates, areas, and conditions, with Installer present, for compliance with requirements and other conditions affecting performance. I . Veri8, that concrete has cured and aged for minimum time period reconrnended by waterproofi n g manufacturer. 2. Verify that substrate is visibly dry and free of moisture. Test for capillary moisture by plastic sheet method according to ASTM D 4263. 3. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION Clean and prepare substate according to manufacturer's written insfuctions. Provide clean, dust-free, and dry substrate for waterproofing application. Mask off adjoining surfaces not receiving waterproofing to Prevent spillage and overspray affecting other construction. 3.1 3.2 B. HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - 5 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOI.JNTAIN LODGE 3/2012004 Close off deck drains and other deck penetrations to prevent spillage and migration of waterproofing fluids. Remove grease, oil, form-release agenls, paints, curing compounds, and other penetrating contaminants or film-forming coatings from concrete. l. Abrasive blast clean concrete surfaces uniformly to €xpose top surface of fine aggregate according to ASTM D 4259 with a self-contained, recirculating, blast-cleaning apparatus. Remove material to provide a sound surface free of laitance, glaze, efflorescence, curing cornpoundg concaete hardeners, or form-release ageats. Remove remaining loose material and clean surfaces according to ASTM D 4258. Remove fins, ridges, and other projections and fill honeycomb, aggregate pockets, and other voids. JOINTS. CRACKS, AND TERMINATIONS Prepare and treat substrates to receive waterproofing membnane, including joints and cracks, deck drains, corners, and penetations according to CAN/CGSB-37.51, 'Application of Rubberized Asphalt, Hot-Applied, for Roofing and Waterproofing," and waterproofing systern manufactrner's written instuctions. l. Rout and frll joints and cracks in substrate. Before filling, remove dust and dirt according to ASTM D 4258. 2. Adhere elastomeric flashing sheet to substrate in a layer of hot, rubberized asphalt. Extend elastomeric flashing sheet a minimum of 6 inches (150 mm) on each side ofjoints and craclc and beyond deck drains, comers, and penetrations. 3. Embed reinforcing fabric into a layer of hot, rubberized asphalt. Exteird reinforcing fabric a minimum of 6 inches (150 mm) on each side of joints and cracks and beyond deck drains, comers, and penehations. At expansion joints and discontinuous deck-to-wall or deck-to-deck joints, bridge joints with elastomeric flashing sheet exterded a minimum of 6 inches (150 mm) on each side ofjoints and adhere to subsrates in a layer ofhot, rubberized asphalt. FLASHING INSTALLATION Install flashing sheets at terminations of waterproofmg memb'rane according to CAN/CGSB- 37.51, "Application of Rubberized Asphalt, Hot-Applied, for Roofing and Waterproofing," and waterproofing system manufacfurer's written instructions. Prime substrate with asphalt primer. Install elastomeric flashing sheet and adhere to deck and wall substrates in a layer of hot, rubberized asphalt. Install modified-bituminous flashing sheet and adhere to substrate in a layer of bot, rubberized asDhalt. t I I I C. D. I T E. T I 't I Ii il I 'l I 1 I B. B, C. D. 3.3 3.4 HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - 6 F. B. c. D. F. B. C. 3.5 3.6 3.7 I I I i I I I I I I 0 t T ] I i I r J 2002150r .08 VAIL MOIINTAIN LODGE Extend flashing sheet up walls or parapets a minimum of 8 inches (200 mm) above plaza deck pavers and 6 inches ( 150 mm) onto deck to be waterproofed. lnstall termination bars and mechanically fasten to top of flashing sheet at terminations and perimeter of roofing. MEMBRANE APPLICATION Apply rubberized asphalt according to CAN/CGSB-37.51, "Application of Rubberized Asphal! Hot-Applied, for Roofing and Waterproofing," and manufacturer's written instructions. Heat rubberized asphalt in an oil- or air-jacketed melter with mechanical agitator specifically designed for heating rubberized-asphalt waterproofing. Apply primer, at manufacturer's recommended rate, over prepared substrate and allow to dry. Reinforced Membrane: Apply waterproofing to substrates and adjoining surfaces indicated. Spread hot fluid-applied, rubberized asphalt to a thickness of 90 mils (2.3 mm); embed reinforcing fabric, overlapping sheets 2 inches (50 mm); and spread another 125-mil- (3.2-mm-) thick layer to provide a uniform, reinforced, seamless membrane 2 I 5 mils (5.5 mm) thick. Apply waterproofing over prepared joints and up wall terminations and vertical surfaces to heights indicated or required by manqfacturer. Cover waterproofing with separator sheet with overlapped joints while rubberized asphalt is still hot and before membrane is subject to taflic. l. Install protection course with overlapped joints over separator sheet.. MOLDED-SHEET DRAINAGE PANEL INSTALLATION Place and secure molded-sheet drainage panels to subshate according to manufacturer's written instructions. Use adhesives that do not penetrate waterproofing. Lap edges and ends of geotextile to maintain continuity. hotect installed molded-sheet drainage panels during subsequent construction. 1. For vertical applications, install board insulation used as a protection course before installing drainage panels. INSTJLATION INSTALLATION Install insulation drainage panels over waterproofed surfaces. Cut and fit to within 3/4 inch ( 19 mm) of projections and penetrations. On vertical surfaces, set insulation units into hot fluid-applied, rubberized asphalt according to manufacturer's written instructions. On horizontal surfaces, loosely lay insulation rmits according to manufacturer's instructions. Stagger end joints and tightly abut insulation units- 3t20t2004 HOT FLUID.APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 -7 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODCE 3t20t2004 3S PLAZA DECK PAVER INSTALLATION A. Setting Bed: Install setting bed in locations and of thickness indicated to comply with requirements in Division 9 Section "Stone Paving and Flooring." B. Install pavers to not vary more than l/16 inch (1.6 mm) in elevation between adjacent pavers or more than l/ 16 inch ( 1.6 mm) from surface plane elevation of individual paver. C. Maintain tolerances of paving installation within l/4 inch in 10 feet (l:48) of surface plane in any direction. T I I I I I I I 3.9 FIELD QUAIITY CONTROL Flood Testing: Flood test each deck area for leaks, according to recommendations in ASTMD 5957, afler completing waterproofing but before overllng construction is placed. Install temporary containment assemblies, plug or dam drains, and flood with potable u/ater. l. Flood to an average depth of 2-ll2 inches (65 mm) with a minimum depth of 1 inch (25 mm) and not exceeding a depth of 4 inches (100 mm). Maintain 2 inches (50 mm) of clearance from top ofsheet flashings. 2. Flood each area for 72 hours. 3. After flood testing, repair leaks, repeat flood tests, and make further repairs until waterproofmg installation is watertight. Notiff Architect to obs€rve flood testing and examine underside of decla and terminations for evidence of leaks during flood testing. CURING, PROTECTING, AND CLEANING Cure waterproofing according to manufacturer's written recommendations, taking care to prev€nt contamination and damage during application stages and cwing. l. Do not permit foot or vehicular taffic on unprotected membrane. Protect wat€rproofing from damage and wear during remainder of construction period. Protect installed insulation drainage panels from damage due to ulhaviolet light, harmful weather exposures, physical abuse, and other causes. Provide tenporary coverings where insulation will be subject to abuse and carmot be concealed and protected by permanent construction immediately after installation. Clean spillage and soiling from adjacent construction using cleaning agents and procedures recommended by manufacturer of affected construction END OF SECTION 07142 3.10 A. l 0 I T I t I I h J I B. C. D. HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - 8 A. B. C. l.l 1.2 I I t ! t iI I l t 20021 501 .08 SECTION O72IO - BUILDING INSULATION PART I -GENERAL SUMMARY This Section includes the following: VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 l. 2. J. ^ 5. Insulation wrder slabs-on-grade. Foundation wall insulation (supporting bacldll). Concealed building insulation. Loose-fill building insulation. Vaoor retarders. 1.3 SIJBMITTALS hoduct Data: For each product indicated. Product test reports. Research/eviluation reports. QUALITY ASSIJRANCE Fire-TesGResponse Characteristics: Provide insulation and related materials with the fire-test- response characteristics indicated, as determined by testing identical products per ASTM E 84 for surface-burning characteristics and other methods indicated with product, by UL or anothsr testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. Identiff materials with appropriate markings of applicable testing and inspecting agency. PART 2 - PRODUCTS INST]LATING MATERI.ALS General: Provide insulating materials that comply with requirements and with referenced standards and, for preformed units, in sizes to frt applications indicated, selected from manufacturer's standard thicknesses, widths, and lengths. Extruded-Polystyrene Board lnsulation: ASTM C 578, Type V, 3.00 lb/cu. ft. (48 kg/cu. m), with maximum flame-spread and smokedeveloped indices of 75 and 450, respectively. Fabric-Faced, Extruded-Polystyrene Drainage Panels: ASTM C 578, Type VI, with a density of 1.8 lbicu. ft. (29 kg/cu. m), faced with insulation manufacturer's standard nonwoven filtation fabric and fabricated with one side having a matrix of drainage and edge channels. A. 2.1 B. C. t I I I t t BUILDING INSULATION 07210 - | 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOTNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 Mineral-fiber blanket insulation consisting of fibers manufactured frorn glass: l. Unfaced Mineral-Fiber Blanket lnsulation: ASTM C 665, Type I; with maximum flame- spread and smoke-developed indices of 25 and 50, respectively; passing ASTM E 136 for combustion characteristics. Glass-Fiber Loose-Fill Insulation: ASTM C 764 for type (method of application) indicated below; maximum flame-spread and smoke-developed indices of 5, and as follows: l. Type I for pneurnatic application. 2. Type 2 forpoured application. VAPORRETARDERS Polyethylene Vapor Retarder: ASTMD4397,6 mils (0.15 mm) thick, with maximum permeance rating of 0.13 perm (7.5 ng/Pa x s x sq. m). Reinforced-Polyethylene Vapor Retarders: 2 outer layers of polyethylene film laminated to an inner reinforcing layer consisting of either nylon cord or polyester scrim and weighing not less than 25 lb/1000 sq. ft. (12 kg/100 sq. m), with maximum permeance rating of 0.0507 perm (2.9 nglPaxsxsq.m). Fire-Retardant, Reinforced-Polyethylene Vapor Retarders: 2 outer layers ofpolyethylene film laminaied to an inner reinforcing layer consisting of either a nonwoven grid of nylon cord c polyester scrim and weighing not less than2T lb/1000 sq. ft. (10 kg/100 sq. m), with marimum penneance rating of 0.1317 perm (7.53 nglPa x s x sq. m), and flame-spread and smoke- developed indices ofnot more than 5 and 60, respcctively. Foil-Polyester Film Vapor Retarder: 2 layers of 0.5-mil- (0.013-mm-) thick polyester film laminated to an inner layer of l-mil- (0.025-mm-) thick aluminum foil, with maximum water- vapor transmission rate in flat condition of 0.0 g/h x sq. m and with maximum flame-spread and smoke-developed indices of 5. Vapor-Retarder Tape: Pre ssure-sensitive tape of type recommended by vapor-retarder manufachrer for sealing joints and penefrations in vapor retarder. AIXILIARY INSULATING MATERI,ALS Adhesive for Bonding Insulation: Product with demonstrated capability to bond insulation securely to substrates indicated without damaging insulation and substrates. Protection Board: Premolded, sernirigid asphalt/fiber composition board, 1/4 inch (6 nrm) thiclg formed under heat and pressure, of standard sizes. INSULATION FASTENERS Anchor Adhesive: Product with demonstrated capability to bond insulation anchors secwely to subshates indicated without damaging insulation, fasteners, and substrates. I ID. 2.2 J I )o I I I I t I B. 'c. D. 2.3 I I I U I B. 2.4 BUILDING INSULATION 07210 -2 I T t I I I I i t t l t l I I J 3 I I 20021501.08 PART 3 - EXECUTION VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 3.1 INSTALLATION General: Install insulation to comply with insulation manufacturer's written insfuctions applicable to products and application indicated. Extend insulation in thickness indicated to envelop entire area to be insulated. Cut and fit tightly around obstructions and fill voids with insulation. Remove projections that interfere with placement' lnstall perimeter insulation on vertical surfaces by setting units in adhesive' l. Ifnot othenvise indicated, extend insulation to footing. 2. Protect below-grade insulation on vertical surfaces from damage during bacldlling by applying protection board set in adhesive. Protecl top surface of perimeter underlab insulation from damage during concrete work by applying protection board. Installation of General Building tnsulation: Apply insulation units to substrates by method indicated, complying with manufacturer's written instructions. If no specific method is indicated, bond units to zubstrate with adhesive or use mechanical anchorage to provide permanent placement and support of units. l. Seal joints between closed+ell (nonbreathing) insulation units by applyng adhesive, mastic, or sealant to edges ofeach unit to form a tight seal as units are shoved into place. Fill voids in completed installation with adhesive, mastic, or sealant. 2. Set vapor-retarder-faced units with vapor retarder to warm side of construction, unless otherwise indicated. Do not obstnrct ventilation spaces, except for firestopping. a- Tape joints and ruptures in vapor retarder, and seal each continuous area of insulation to surounding construction to ensure airtight installation' 3. Install mineral-fiber blankets in cavities formed by framing members according to the following requirements: a. Use blanket widths and lenglhs that fill the cavities formed by frarning members. If more than one length is required to fill cavity, provide lengths that will produce a snug fit between ends. b. Place blankets in cavities formed by framing members to produce a friction fit between edges of insulation and adjoining framing members' 4. For metal-framed wall cavities where cavity heights exceed 96 inches (2438 mm) support unfaced blankets mechanically and support faced blankets by taping stapling flanges to flanges of metal studs. 5. Stuff glass-Iiber, loose-filt insulation into miscellaneous voids and cavity spaces where shown. Compact to approximately 40 percent of normal maximum volume equaling a density of approximately 2.5 lb/cu. tl. (40 kgibu. m). lnstallation of Vapor Retarders: Extand vapor retarder to extremities of areas to be protected from vapor transmission. Secure in place with adhesives or other anchorage system as B. C. D. BUILDING INSULATION o72lo - 3 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 indicated. Extend vapor retarder to cover miscellaneous voids in insulated subshates, including those filled with loose-fiber insulation. l. Seal vertical joints in vapor retarders over framing by lapping not less than two wall studs. Fasten vapor retarders to framing at top, end, and bottom edges; at perimeter of wall openings; and at lap joints. Space fasteners l6 inches (406 mm) o.c.2. Seal overlapping joints in vapor retarders with adhesives or vapor-retarder tape according to vapor-retarder manufacfurer's instructions. Seal butt joints and fastener penetrations with vapor-retarder tape. Locate all joints over framing members or other solid substrates. 3. Firnrly attach vapor retarders to substrates with mechanical fasteners or adhesives as recommended by vapor-retarder manufacfurer. Seal joints caused by pipes, conduits, electrical boxes, and similar items penetrating vapor retarders with vapor-retard€f, tape to create an airtight seal between penetrating objects and vapor retarder. Repair any tears or puncturcs in vapor retarders immediately before concealment by other work. Cover with vapor-retarder tape or another layer of vapor retarder. END OF SECTION O72IO T t I I t T il I I t t I I I I 1- 5. BUILDING INSULATION 07210 - 4 t 2oo215or.o8 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 . sEcrIoN 07142 - Hor FLUID-APPLIED wATERPRooFINc - || PARTI-GENERAL h u 1.1 SUMMARY t A. This Section includes reinforced, hot fluid-applied waterproofing memb'rane. t - 1.2 SI.]BMITTALS t A. Product Data: Include manufacturer's written instructions for evaluating, preparing, and treating subshate, technical data, and tested physical and performance properties. t B. Shop Drawings: Show locations and extent of waterproofing. Include details for substrate lornts and cracks, sheet flashings, penefrations, inside and outside corners, tie-ins to adjoining ) waterproofing, and other termination conditions. I C. Product test reports. . I.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. hrstaller Qualifications: A qualified installer, approved by manufacturer to install manufacturefs products; and who is eligible to receive waterproofing warranty specified. f, 1.4 PROJECTCONDTTTONS - A. Environmental Limitations: Apply waterproohng within the range of ambient and subshate I temperatues recommended by waterproofing manufacturer. Do not apply waterproofing to ar damp or wet subsfrate, or when ternperature is below 0 deg F (minus 18 deg C). I I.5 WARRANTY I A. Special Warr"anty: Manufacturer's standard form, sigred by manufacturer, in which manufacturer agrees to repair or replace waterproofing and sheet flashings that do not cornply with requirements or that do not remain watertight for a period of 10 years after date of Substantial Completion. - PART2-PRODUCTS a ... 2.I MANT]FACTURERSIIf' A. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be lncorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following:l T HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07t42 - | 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3120/2004 Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the following: l. American Hydrotech, Inc.; Monolithic Membrane 6125. MATERIALS Membrane: Single-cornponent; 100 percent solids; hot fluid-applied, rubberized asphalt compllng with CAN/CGSB-37.50. American Hydrotech, lnc.; Monolithic Memb'rane 6125 Primer: American Hydrotech, Inc, Surface Conditioner. Elastomeric Flashing Sheet: 60-mi1- (1.3-mm-) minimum, nonstaining, uncured sheet neoprene. American Hydrotech, Inc, Flex Flash UN. Reinforcing Fabric: Manufactuer's recommended sprm-bonded polyester fabric. Separation Sheet/?rotection Course: Semirigid sheets of fiberglass-reinforced-rubberized asphaltic sheet, pressure laminated between 2 asphalt-satrnated fibrous liners and nominal thickness l/4 inch (6 mm). MOLDED-SHEET DRAINAGE PANELS Woven-Geotextile-Faced, Molded-Sheet Drainage Panel: Manufachred cornposite subsurface drainage panels consisting of a woven-geotextile facing with an apparent opening size not exceeding No.40 (0.43-mm) sieve laminated to I side of a 3dimensional, nonbiodeg radable, molded-plastic-sheet drainage core, with a horizontal flow rate not less than 2.8 gpm per ft. (35 Lr'min. per m). American Hydrotech, krc, Hydrodrain. PART 3 -EXECUTION PREPARATION Clean and prepare substate according to manufachrer's written instructions. Provide clean, dust-free, and dry substate for waterproofing application. Mask off adjoining surfaces not receiving waterproofing to prevent spillage and overspray affecting other construction. Close off deck drains and other deck pelrebations to prevent spillage and migration of waterproofing fluids. Remove grease, oil, form-release agants, paints, ctrring compounds, and other penetrating contaminants or film-forming coatings from concrete. Remove fins, ridges, and other projections and fill honeycomb, aggregate pockets, and other voids. T I I I I I I i I I l I I I ! I t I I B. B. c. D. E. B. D. 2.2 2.3 3.1 HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - 2 I I f l I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE JOINT AND CRACK TREATMENT Prepare, treat, rout, and fill joints and cracks in subshate according to CAN/CGSB-37.51, "Application of Rubberized Asphalt, Hot-Applied, for Roofing and Waterproofing," and waterproofing manufacfurer's written insh'uctions. Install elastomeric sheet reinforcement and bond to deck and wall subsht€s where indicated or required. Extend elastomeric sheet reinforcement a minimum of 18 inches (150 rnm) onto perpandicular surfaces and other work penetrating substrate. hepare vertical and horizontal surfaces at terminations and penebations through waterproofing and at drains and sleeves. l. At expansion joints and discontinuous deck-to-wall or deck-todeck joints, bridge joint with sheet flashing extended along each side ofjoint and securely bond to substate. 2. Install elastomeric flashing sheet at terminations and adhere to deck and wall substrates in a layer of hot, rubberized asphalt. MEMBRANE APPLICATION Apply rubberized asphalt according to CAN/CGSB-37.51 and manufacturer's written instructions. Heat rubberized asphalt in an oil- or air-jacketed melter with mechanical agitator specifically designed for heating rubberized-asphalt waterproofing. Apply primer, at manufacfurer's recommended rate, over prepared substrate and allow to dry. Reinforced Membrane: Apply waterproofing to substrates and adjoining surfaces indicated. Spread hot fluid-applied, rubberized asphalt to a thickness of 90 mils (2.3 mm); embed reinforcing fabric, overlapping sheets 2 inches (50 mnr); and spread another 125-mil- (3.2-mm-) thick layer to provide a uniform, reinforced, seamless membrane 215 mils (5.5 mm) thick. Apply waterproofing over prepared joints and up wall terminations and vertical surfaces to heights indicated or required by manufacturer. Install protection cou6e with overlapped joints while rubberized asphalt is still hot. MOLDED-SHEET DRAINAGE PANEL INSTALLATION Place and secure molded-sheet drainage panels to strbstrate according to manufacturer's written instructions. Use adhesives that do not penetate waterproofing. Lap edges and ends of geotextile to maintain continuity. Protect installed molded-sheet drainage panels during subsequent construction. PROTECTING AND CLEANING Do not permit foot or vehicular haffic on unprotected horizontal membrane. 312012004 3.2 A. B. c. 3.3 B. c. D. F. 3.4 3.5 t I HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 -3 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE B. Protect waterproofing from damage and wear during remainder of construction period. C. Clean spillage and soiling from adjacant construction using cleaning agents and procedures recommanded by manufacturer of affected consfruction END OF SECTION 07142 T I HOT FLUID-APPLIED WATERPROOFING 07142 - 4 t t I 2002150r.08 'AIL M.'NTIAN L.DGE 3t2ot2oo4 t. SECTION 07241 - EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB PART I - GENERAL l, \I r.l RELATEDDOCUMENTS a A. Drawings and general provisions of the Confracl including General and Supplementary I Conditions and Division 1 Specification Sections, ap'ply to this Section. I 1.2 ''MMARYI A. This Section includes the following: 1. Exterior insulation and finish system (EIFS) applied over the following: a. Gypsumsheathing. .' I B. Related Sections include the following: - l. Division 5 Section "Cold-Formed Metal Framing" for gypsum sheathing and water- I lweather-resistive-barrier metal fiaming. - 2. Division 7 Section 'Joint Sealants" for sealing joints in EIFS with elastomeric joint sealants. - I.3 DEFINITIONS !, A. EIFS: Exterior insulation and finish system(s). - B. Class PB EIFS: A "nonload bearing, exterior wall cladding system that consists of an insulation I board attached either adhesively, mechanically, or both to the substate; an integrally reinforced base coat; and a textured protective finish coat," as defined by ASTM C 1397. I 1.4 PERFoRMANCEREQUIREMENTS I A. EIFS Performance: Comply with the following:t 1. Bond htegrity: Free from bond failure within EIFS components or between system and supporting wall construction, resulting from exposure to fire, wind loads, weather, or other in-service conditions. 2. Weathertightness: Resistant to water penehation from exterior into EIFS and assemblies behind it or through them into interior of building that results in deterioration of thermal- insulating effectiveness or other degradation of EIFS and assemblies behind it, including substrates, supporting wall construction, and interior finish. I B. Class PB EIFS: Provide EIFS having physical properties and structural performance that(! comply with the following when tested per methods referenced: I f, I EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 07241 - | 2002150t.08 VAIL MOLTNTIAN LODGE 3/20t2004 T I T l I I I ,l I I I I I I l, I D 'It Abrasion Resistance: Sample consisting of l-inch- (25.4-mm-) thick EIFS mounted on 112-inch- (12.7.n'm-\ thick gypsum board; cured for a minimum of 28 days; and showing no cracking, checking, or loss of film integrity after exposure to 528 quarts (500 L) of sand when tested per ASTM D 968, Method A. Accelerated Weathering Characteristics: Sample of size suitable for test equipment and consisting of l-inch- {25.4-mm-) thick EIFS mounted on l/2-inch- (12.7-nm-) thick gypsum board; cured for 28 days; and showing no cracking, checking, crazing, erosion, rusting, blistering, peeling, or delamination afler testing for 2000 hours when viewed under 5 times magrrification per ASTM G 23, Method 1, or ASTM G . Absorption-Freeze Resistance: No visible deleterious e{fects and negligible weight loss after 60 cycles per EIMA l0l.0l. Mildew Resistance of Finish Coar Sarnple applied to 2-by-2-inch (50.8-by-50.8-mm) clean glass substrate, cured for 28 days, and showing no growth when tested per ASTM D 3273. 5. Salt-Spray Resistance: Sarnple consisting of I -inch- (25.4-mm-) thick EIFS mormted on l/2-inch- ( l2.7-mm-) thick gypsum board; cured for 28 days; and showing no cracking checking, crazing, erosion, rusting, blistering, peeling, or delamination after testing for 300 hoursperASTMB l17. 6. Tensile Adhesion: No failure in the adhesive, base coat, or fmish coat. Minimum 5-psi (34.5-kPa) tensile strength before and after freeze-thaw and accelerated weathering tests perEIMA 101.03. 7. Water Penetation: Sample consisting of l-inch- (25.4-mm-) thick EIFS mounted onll2- inch- (12.7-mm-)thick gypsum board, cured for 28 days, and showing no wat€r penetration into the plane of the base coat to expanded polystyrene board interface of the test specimen after 15 minutes at 6.24 lbflsq. fr". {299 Pa) of air prcssure difference or 20 percent of positive design wind pressure, whichever is greater, across tlte speciman during a test period when tested per EIMA 101.02. 8. Water Resistance: Sample consisting of 1-inch- (25.4-mm-) thick EIFS mounted on ll2- inch- (12.7-mm-) thick gJpsum board; cured for 28 days; and showing no cracking, checking, uazing, erosion, rusting, blistering, peeling, or delamination after testing for 14 days per ASTM D 2247. 9. Impact Resistance: Sample consisting of l-inch- (25.4-mm-) thick EIFS when constucted, conditioned, and tested per EMA 101.86; and mecting o'r exceeding the following impact classification and range: a. Standard Irnpact Resistance: 25 to 49 inchlb (2.8 to 5.6 J). 10. Positive and Negative Wind-Load Performance: Sample assembly, 48 by 48 inches (1220 by 1220 mmi) in size, consisting of studs, sheathing, and l-inch- (25.4-mm-) thick EIFS; and showing capability to withstand wind loads indicated when tested per ASTM E 330. 11. Drainage: 3 samples capable of draining water, and having an average minimum true drainage efficiency of 90 percent when tested per EIMA 200.2. Water-AMeather-Resistive-Barrier Coating: With physical properties that comply with the following when tested on substrate pet methods referenced: L Tensile Adhesion: No failure in bond when 5 samples of water-/weatber-resistive coating are applied to substrate and tested at a minimum I 5-psi ( 105-kPa) flatwise tensile strength p€r ASTM C 29'7 . t. 2. .'. 4. c. EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 07241 -2 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3t20/2004 Absorption-Freeze Resistance: No visible deleterious effects and negligible weight loss after 60 cycles per EIMA l0l.0l. Water Penetration: 3 samples each sized not less than 4 by 8 feet ( l2l9 by 2438 nrm); consisting of coating applied to substrate including a minimum of 2 vertical joints and I horizontal joint within sheathing subshate, each joint not less than 0.125 inch (3.2 mm) wide; and tested sequentially as follows: a. Passing l0 cycles at 80 percent positive design load (design load is defined as ultimate load with a safety factor of 3.0 imposed) as the maximum test load when tested in accordance vrith ASTM E 1233, Procedure A. b. No water penetation on the plane of the exterior-facing side of substate after 75 minutes at 6.24 lbflsq. tt. (299 Pa) of air-presswe difference or 20 percent of positive design wind pressure, whichever is greater, across the specimen during a test period when tested per ASTM E 331. Water Resistance: 3 samples, each sized not less than 4 by 6 inches (102 by 152 mm) and consisting of coating applied to substrate, showing no cracking, checking, crazing, erosion, blistering, peeling, or delamination after testing for 14 days per ASTMD 2247. Water Vapor Transmission: Three samples prepared by applying the coating, at recommended thickness, to a nonadhesive surface and removipg cured coating film. Average thicloress is determined from material density, area, and weight and samples are tested per ASTM E 96 after conditioning at 75 plus or minus 5 deg F (24 plus or minus 3 deg C) and 50 percent relative humidity for 40 hours before testing, with results meeting or exceeding grade requirements in Table l4-l-A ofUBC Standard 14-1. SUBMITTALS Product Data: For each fype and component ofEIFS indicated. Samples for lnitial Selection: For each type offinish-coat color and texture indicated. 1. Include similar Samples ofjoint sealants involving color selection. Samples for Verification: 24-inch- (600-mm-) square panels for each type of finish+oat color and texture indicated, prepared using same tools and techniques intanded for actual work including a typical control joint frlled with sealant ofcolor selected. l. Include sealants Samples to verify color selected. Qualification Data: For Installer. Compatibility and Adhesion Test Reports: For joint sealants from sealant manufacturer indicating the following : l. Materials forming joint subshates and joint-sealant backings have been tested for compatibility and adhesion with joint sealants. 2. Interpretation of test results and written recommendations for primers and substrate preparation needed for adhesion. Maintenance Data: For EIFS to include in maintenance manuals. 2. 3. 4. 5. 1.5 B. D. E. C. F. EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS . CLASS PB 07241 -3 2002r 501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 QUALITY ASSURANCE hstaller Qualifications: An installer who is certified in writing by EIFS manufacturer as qualified to install manufacfurer's system using trained workers. Source Limitations: Obtain EIFS through one source from a single EIFS manufacturer and from sources approved by EIFS manufacturer as compatible with syJtem components. Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: hovide EIFS and system components with the following fire-test-response characteristics as determined by iesting identical EIFS and systeri components Per test method indicated below by UL or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. Identiff produ€ts with ippropriai" -"ttitgr of applicable testing and inspecting agency. l - Fire-Resistance Characteristics: hovide materials and construction tested for fire resistance per ASTM E I 19. DELTVERY, STORAGE. AND HANDLING Deliver materials in original, unopened packages with manufactwers' Iabels intact and clearlv identifying products. store materials inside dnd under cover; keep them dry and protected from weather, direct sunlight, surface contamination, aging, corrosion, damaging temperahres, construction traffic, and other caus€s. Stack insulation board flat and off the ground. hotect plastic insulation against igrition at all times. Do not deliver plastic insulating materials to Project site before installation time.3' Complete installation and concealment of plastic materials as rapidly as possible in each area of consFuction. PROJECT CONDITIONS weather Limitations: Maintain ambient temperatures above 40 deg F (4.4 deg c) for a minimum of 24 hours before, during, and after adhesives or coatings "re apptiea. Do not apply EIFS adhesives or coatings during rainfall. Proceed with installaiion oniy *hen existing-and forecasted weather conditions and ambient outdoor air and subshate temperafures perm;t -nms to be applied, dried, and cured according to manufactwers' written instructions and warranfu requirements. Field Measurements: Verifu actual dimensions required for prefabricated panets by field measurements before fabrication and indicate measurements on shop Drawings. l. Established Dimensions: Where field measurements cannot be made without delaying the Work, establish dimensions and proceed with fabricating prefabricated panels witiroui field measurements. Coordinate construction to ensure that acfual dimensions correspond to established dimensions. 1.6 A. B. c. 1.7 l. 2. 1.8 B, EXTERIOR INSTILATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 07241 - 4 I t I I I I t ] I t I I t I t l I t t 20021s01.08 VAIL MOTINTTAN LODGE 3/20t2004 PART 2 . PRODUCTS MANUFACTURERS Available Manufacturers' subjgct to compliance wilh requirements, manufacturers offeringproducts that may be incorporated into the lvork include, uuirr" noitinircJi;,;; folowing: Manufacturers: subject to compriance with requirements, provide products by one of thefollowing: l. Class PB EIFS: Acrocrete. Inc. Bonsal, W. R. Co. Corev America, Inc. Dryvit Systems, Inc. El Rey Stucco Company, Inc. Finestone - Simplex products Division. Master Wall, Inc. Omega Products International. Inc. Parex, Inc. Pleko Systems lntemational, Inc. Retro TeVExcel LLC. Senergy hrc.; SKW-MBT ConsEuction Chemicals. Shurcoat Wall Systems; VenTex, Inc. Sonnebom, Div. of chemRex, Inc.; SKW-MBT consbuction chemicals.Sto Corp. Stuc-O-Flex International, Inc. TEC Inc.; An H. B. Fuller Company. COORDINATION coordinate installation of EIFS with related work specified in other Sections to ensure that wallassemblies, including sheathing, water-/weather-resistive,banier, fr"rh;;;; ;;:joint searants,windows, and do-ors, are protected against damage from the effects of weath er, age,corrosron,moisture, and other causes. Do noi allow wati to penehate behind flashing and protectivecoating of barrier EIFS. coordinate panel fabrication schedule with constuction progress to avoid delaying the work. 1.9 2.1 B. 2.2 MATERTALS compatibility: Provide substrates, water-/weather-resistive barriers, adhesive, fasteners, boardinsulatiorr, reinforcing meshes, base- and finish-coat systems, searants, and accessories that arecompatible with one another and approved for use by fIFS .*ut""trro rl, t;;". Colors, Textures, and pattems of Finish Coat: Match Existing.B. EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS. CLASS PB 0724t - 5 2002r 501.08 I I 1 t t I i I I I I l t I I I I I D. F. G. VAIL MOLINTTAN LODGE 3t20/2QQ4 l. Fasteners: Wafer-head or hard-roc steel drill screws complying with ASTM C 954, with an organic-polymer coating or other corrosion-protective coating having a salt-spray resistance of more than 500 hours per ASTM B I 17. a. Size and Length: As recommended by sheathing manufacturer for type and thickness of sheathing board to be attached. Water-Aileather-Resistive Barrier: hovide one of the following: l. Water-Meather-Resistive-Barrier Coating: EIFS manufachrer's standard formulation and accessories dcsigned for indicated use, compatiblc with substrate, and complying with performance requirements indicated. a. Sheathing Joint Compormd and Tape: Type recommended by EIFS manufacturer for sealingjoints between and penetations tlrough sheathing. 2. Polymer-Based Building Wrap: ASTM E 1677, Tlpe I air retarder; with flame-spread and smoke-developed indexes of less than 25 and 450, respectively, when tested according to ASTM E 84; and W stabilized; with presstne-sensitive plastic tape recommended by building wrap manufacturer for sealing joints between and penetrations through building wrap. ^. Product: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide "Tyvek StuccoWrap" by DuPont Tyvek Weatherization Systems (E. I. duPont de Nemours and Company). Primer/Sealer: EIFS manufacturer's standard substrate conditioner desigrred to seal substates from moisture penetration and to improve the bond between substrate of type indicated and adhesive used for application of insulation. Flexible-Membrane Flashing: Cold-applied, fully self-adhering, self-healing, rubberized- asphalt and polyethylene-film composite sheet or tape and primer; EIFS manufacturer's standard or product recommended in writing by EIFS manufacturer. Adhesive for Application of Insulation: EIFS manufacturer's standard formulation desigrred for indicated use, compatible with substrate, and cornplying with one of the following requirements: l. Job-mixed formulation of portland cement complying with ASTM C 150, Type I, and polymer-based adhesive specified for base coat. 2. Factory-blended dry formulation of portland cement, dry polymer admixture, and fillers specified for base coat. 3. Factory-mixed noncementitious formulation desigrred for adhesive attachment of insulation to substrates of type indicated, as recommended by EIFS manufacturer. Molded, Rigid Cellular Polystyrene Board Insulation: Comply with EIFS manufacturer's requirements, ASTM C 578 for Type I, and EMA's "EMA Guideline Specification for Expanded Polystyrene (EPS) Insulation Board" for more st-ingent requirements for material performance and qualities of insulation, including dimensions and permissible variations, and the following: I EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FIMSH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 07241-6 I I I t I I I I I I t I t t T I I I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOLTNThN LODGE 3t20/2004 1. Aging: Before cutting and shipping, age insulation in block form by air drying for not less than six weeks or by another method approved by EMA that produces equivalent results. 2. Flame-Spread and Smoke-Developed Indexes: 25 and 450 or less, respectively, per ASTM E 84- 3. Dimensions: Provide insulation boards not more than 21by 48 inches (610 by l2l9 mm) and in thickness indicated but not more than 4 inches ( l02 mm) thick or less than thickness allowed by ASTM C 1397. Reinforcing Mesh: Balanced, alkali-resistant, open-weave glass-frber mesh treated for compatibility with other EIFS materials, made from continuous multiend stands with retained mesh tensile strength of not less than 120 lbf/in. (21 dNrcm) per EIMA 105.01, complying with ASTM D 578 and the following requirements for minimum weight: l. Standard-Impact Reinforcing Mesh: Not less than 4.0 oz.lsq. yd. ( I 36 g/sq. m). 2. Strip Reinforcing Mesh: Not less than 3.75 oz.lsq.yd. (127 dsq.m)3. Detail Reinforcing Mesh: Not less than 4.0 oz./sg.yd. (136 g/sq. m). 4. Corner Reinforcing Mesh: Not less than 7 .2 oz./sq. yd. (244 gsq. m)1. Base-Coat Materials: EIFS manufachrer's standard mixtwe complfng with one of the following requirements for material composition and method of combining materials: I .' Job-mixed formulation of portland cement complying with ASTM C 150, Type I, white or natural color; and manufacturer's standard polymer-emulsion adhesive designed for use indicated. 2. Job-combined formulation of manufacturer's standard polymer-emulsion adhesive and manufacturer's standard dry mix containing portland cement. 3. Factory-blended dry formulation of portland cement, dry polymer admixture, and inert fillers to which only water is added at Project site. 4. Factory-mixed noncementitious formulation of polymer-emulsion adhesive and inert fillers that is ready to use without adding other materials. Waterproof AdhesivelBase-Coat Materials: EIFS manufacturer's standard waterproof mixhre complying with one of the following requiremarts for material composition and method of combining materials: I . Job-mixed formulation of portland cement complying with ASTM C 150, Type I, white or natural color; and manufacturer's standard polymer-emulsion adhesive designed for use indicated. 2. Job+ombined formulation of manufacturer's standard polymer-emulsion adhesive and manufacturer's standard dry mix containing portland cement. Primer: EIFS manufacturer's standard factory-mixed elastomeric-polymer primer for preparing base-coat surface for application of finish coat. Finish-Coat Materials: EIFS manufacturer's standard acrylic-based coating complying with the following requirements for material composition and method of combining malerials: l. Factory-mixed formulation of polymer-emulsion binder, colorfast mineral pigments, sound stone particles, and fillers. I. EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 07241-7 2002 I 501 .08 T I I T I t t M. N. 2.3 VAIL MOLINTTAN LODGE 312012004 Water: Potable. Trim Accessories: Type as designated or required to suit conditions indicated and to comply with EIFS manufacturer's written requirements; manufactured from UV-stabilized PVC; and complying with ASTM D 1784, manufacturer's standard Cell Class for use intended, and ASTM C 1063. l. Casing Bead: hefabricated one-piece type for attachment behind insulation, of depth required to suit thiclcress of coating and insulation, with face leg perforated for bonding to coating and back leg.2. Drip Screed/Track Prefabricated one-piece tlpe for attachment behind insulation with face leg extended to form a drip, of depth required to suit thickness of coating and insulation, with face leg perforated for bonding to coating and back leg.3. Window Sill Flashing: hefabricated type for both flashing and sloping sill over framing beneath windows; with end and back dams; designed to direct water to exterior. MDCNG General: Comply with EIFS manufacturer's requirements for combining and mixing materials. Do not inhoduce admixtures, water, or other materials except as recommended by EIFS manufachrer. Mix materials in clean containers. Use materials within time period specified by EIFS manufacturer or discard. PANELFABRICATION PART 3 - EXECUTION c. EXAMINATION Examine substrates, areas, and conditions, with Installer present, for compliance with requirements for installation tolerances and other conditions affecting performance ofEIFS. Examine roof edges, wall framing, flashings, openings, substates, and juncfures at other conskuction for suitable conditions where EIFS will be installed. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION Protect contiguous work from moisture deterioration and soiling caused by application of EIFS. Provide temporary covering and other protection needed to prevent spattering of exterior finish coats on other work. Protect EIFS, substrates, and wall construction behind them from inclement weather during installation. Prevent penetration of moisture behind EIFS and deterioration of substrates. I I 2.4 3.1 I I I l t I I I I I B. B. 3.2 EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 07241 - 8 D. F. G. B. c. 3.3 I T I l I I I T I I I Ii I t I I I 20021501.08 C. VAIL MOUNTL{N LODGE 3/20t2004 Prepare and clean substrates to comply with EIFS manufacturer's written requirements to obtain optimum bond between substrate and adhesive for insulation. Primer/Sealer: Apply over gypsum sheathing substrates to protect substrates fi'om degradation and where required by EIFS manufacturer for improving adhesion of insulation to substrate. Water-AVeather-Resistive-Barrier Coating: Apply over substrates to protect substates from degradation and to provide water-/weather-resistive bamer. l. Tape and seal joints, exposed edges, terminations, and inside and outside comers of sheathing, unless otherwise indicated by EIFS manufacturer's written instructions. Waterproof Adhesive/Base Coat: Apply over substrates to protect substrates from degradation. Flexible-Membrane Flashing: Install over weather-resistive barrier, applied and lapped to shed water; seal at opanings, panetrations, terminations, and where indicated by EIFS manufacturer's written instructions to protect wall assembly from degradation. Prime substrates, if required, and install flashing to comply with EIFS manufacturer's written instructions and details. EIFS INSTALLATION General: Comply with ASTM C 1397 and. EIFS manufacturer's written instructions for installation of EIFS as applicable to each type of substate indicated. Trim: Apply trim accessories at perimeter of EIFS, at expansion joints, and elsewhere as indicated, according to EIFS manufacturer's written instructions. Coordinate with installation of insulation. l. Drip Screed/Track: Use at bottom edges of EIFS, unless otherwise indicated. 2. Window Sill Flashing: Use at windows, unless otherwise indicated. 3. Expansion Joint: Use where indicated. 4. Casing Bead: Use at other locations. Board Insulation: Adhesively attach insulation to substrate in compliance with ASTM C1397, EIFS manufacturer's written requirements, and the following: l. Apply adhesive to insulation by notched-trowel method in a manner that results in coating the entire surface of gypsum sheathing with adhesive once insulation is adhered to sheathing unless EIFS manufacturer's written instructions specifu using primer/sealer with ribbon-and-dab method. Apply adhesive to a thickness of not less than 1/4 inch (6.4 mm) for factory mixed and not less than 3/8 inch (9.6 mm) for freld mixed, measured from surface of insulation before placement. 2. Press and slide insulation into place. Apply pressure over the entire surface of insulation to accomplish uniform contact, high initial grab, and overall level surface. 3. Allow adhered insulation to remain undisturbed for period recommended by EIFS manufachrer, but not less than 24 hours, before beginning rasping and sanding insulation, or applying base coat and reinforcing mesh. 4. Apply insulation over dry substrates in courses with long edges of boards oriented horizontallv. EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 07241-9 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t20Q4 Begin first course of insulation fiom screed/hack and work upward. Work from perimeter casing beads toward interior of panels if possible. Stagger vertical joints of insulation boards in successive courses to produce running bond pattern. Locate joints so no piece of insulation is less than l2 inches (300 mnr) wide or 6 inches (150 mm) high. Offset joints not less than 6 inches (150 mm) from comers of window and door openings. a. Adhesive Attachment: Offset joints of insulation not less than 6 inches (150 mm) from horizontal and 4 inches (100 mm) from vertical joints in sheathing. Interlock ends at internal and external corners. Abut insulation tightly at joints within and between each course to produce flush, continuouly even swhces without gaps or raised edges between boards. If gaps greater than 1116 inch ( 1.6 mm) occur, fill with insulation cut to fit gaps exactly; insert insulation without using adhesive or other material. Cut insulation to ht openings, corners, and projections precisely and to produce edges and shapes compllng with details indicated. Rasp or sand flush entire surface of insulation to remove irregularities projecting more than ll32 inch (0.8 mm) from surface of insulation and to remove yellowed areas due to sun exposure; do not create depressions deeper than 1/16 inch (1.6 mm). Cut aesthetic reveals in outside face of insulation with high-speed router and bit configured to produce grooves, rabbets, and other features that comply with profiles and locations indicated. Do not reduce inzulation thickness at aesthetic reveals to less than 3/4 inch ( l9 mm). Interrupt insulation for expansion joints where indicated. Form joints for sealant application by leaving gaps between adjoining insulation edges and between insulation edges and dissimilar adjoining surfaces. Make gaps wide enough to produce joint widths indicated after encapsulating joint substrates with base coat and reinforcing mesh. After installing insulation and before applylng field-applied reinforcing mesh, fully wrap board edges. Cover edges of board and extend encapsulating mesh not less than 2-ll2 inches (64 mm) over front and back face, unless otherwise indicated on Drawings. Treat exposed edges of insulation as follows: a. Except for edges forming substrates of sealant joints, encapsulate with base coat, reinforcing mesh, and finish coat. b. Encapsulate edges forming substrates of sealant joints within EIFS or between EIFS and other work with base coat and reinforcing mesh. c. At edges timmed by accessories, extend base coat, reinforcing mesh, and finish coat over face leg of accessories. 16. Coordinate installation of flashing and insulation to produce wall assembly that does not allow water to penebate behind flashing and EIFS protective coating lamina. D. Expansion Joints: Install at locations indicated, where required by EIFS manufachrer, and as follows: 1 . Where expansion joints are indicated in substrates behind EIFS. 2. Where EIFS adjoin dissimilar substates, materials, and construction. E. Base Coat: Apply to exposed surfaces of insulation in minimum thickness recommended in writing by EIFS manufacturer, but not less than l/16-inch (1.6-mnr) dry-coat thickness. 5. 6. 7. 8. 12. 13. 9. 10. ll. T T I t I l I I I I t tl I I t I 14. 15. I IEXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS. CLASS PB 0724r - r0 F. G. B. 3.4 3.5 I T I I I I I l I I I I a I I ; J I 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE Reinforcing Mesh: Embed type indicated below in wet base coat to produce wrinkle-free installation with mesh continuous at comers and overlapped not less than 2-112 inches (64 mm) or otherwise treated at joints to comply with ASTM C 1397 and EIFS manufacturer's written requirements. Do not lap reinforcing mesh within 8 inches (204 mm) of comers. Completely embed mesh, applying additional base-coat material if necessary, so reinforcing-mesh color and pattem are not visible. 1. Standard-impact reinforcing mesh, unless otherwise indicated. Additional Reinforcing Mesh: Apply strip reinforcing mesh around openings extending 4 inches (100 mm) beyond perimeter. Apply additional 9-by-I2-inch (230-by-300-mm) strip reinforcing mesh diagonally at comers of o'penings (re-entant comers). Apply 8-inch- (200- mm-) wide strip reinforcing mesh at both inside and outside comers unless base layer of mesh is lapped not less than 4 inches (100 mm) on each side of corners. l. Embed strip reinforcing mesh in base coat before applyng first layer of reinforcing mesh. Finish Coat: Apply over dry base coat, maintaining a wet edge at all times for uniform appearance, in thickness required by EIFS manufactxer to produce a uniform finish of color and texture matching approved sample and free of cold joints, shadow lines, and texture variations. INSTALLATION OF JOINT SEALANTS Prepare joints and apply sealants, of type and at locations indicated, to comply with applicable requirements in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants" and in EMA's 'EMA Guide for Use of Sealants with Exterior Insulation and Finish Systems, Class PB." I . Clean surfaces to receive sealants to comply with indicated requirements and EIFS manufacturer's written instructions. 2. Apply primer recommended in writing by sealant manufacturer for surfaces to be sealed. 3. Install sealant backing to control depth and configuration of sealant joint and to prevent sealant from adhering to back ofjoint. 4. Apply masking tape to protect areas adjacent to sealant joints. Remove tape immediately after tooling joints, without disturbing joint seal. 5. Recess sealant sufficiently from surface of EIFS so an additional sealant ap'plication, including cylindrical sealant backing, can be installed without protruding beyond EIFS surface. 6- Apply joint sealants after base coat has cured but before applying finish coat. CLEANING AND PROTECTION Remove temporary covering and protection of other work. Promptly remove coating materials from window and door frames and other surfaces outside areas indicated to receive EIFS coatlngs. Provide final protection and maintain conditions, in a manner acceptable to Installer and EIFS manufactrner, that ensure that EIFS are without damage or deterioration at time of Substantial Completion. 3t20/2004 EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS . CLASS PB 07241 - tr 20021501.08 END OF SECTION 0724I VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS - CLASS PB 0724t - t2 B. B. 1.2 t.3 I I I t I t I I j I I I t I ) t I I I 2002 r 501.08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 SECTION 07610 . SHEET METAL ROOFING PART I -GENERAL I.1 RELATED DOCI]MENTS Drawings and general provisions of the Contact, including General and Supplementary Conditions and Division I Specification Sections, apply to this Section. SUMMARY This Section includes the following on-site, roll-formed sheet metal roofing:l. Standing-seam metal roofing. Related Sections include the following: 1. Division 5 Section "Steel Deck" for steel roof deck supporting sheet metal roofing.2. Division 5 Section "Cold-Formed Metal Framing" for secondary support framing supporting sheet metal roofing. 3. Division 7 Section "Building Insulation" for roof insulation.4. Division 7 Section "Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim" for flashings and other sheet metal work not part of sheet metal roofing.5. Division 7 Section "Roof Accessories" for accessories on roof.6. Dvision 7 Section "Joint Sealants" for field-applied sheet metal roofing sealants. PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS General: Provide complete sheet metal roofing system, including, but not limited to, on-site, roll-formed metal roof panels, cleats, clips, anchors and fasteners, sheet metal flashing and drainage components related to sheet metal roofing, fascia panels, trim, underlayment, and accessories as indicated and as required for a weathertight installation. Wind-Uplift Resistance: hovide portable roll-forming equipment capable of producing sheet metal roofing assernblies that comply with LJL 580 for Class 90 wind-uplift resistance. I . Maintain IIL certification of portable roll-forming equipment for duration of sheet metal roofing work. Thermal Movements: Provide sheet metal roofing that allows for thermal movements resulting from the following maximum change (range) in ambient and surface temperatures by preventing buckling, opening of joints, hole elongation, overshessing of components, failure of joint sealants, failure of connections, and other detrimental effects. Provide clips that resist rotation and avoid shear shess as a result of sheet metal roofing thermal movements. Base engineering calculation on surface temperatures of materials due to both solar heat gain and nighttime-sky heat loss. SHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - I 2002 1501 .08 I T I I T D. r.4 VAIL MOLINTI-AN LODGE 1. Temperature Change (Range): 120 degF (67 degC), ambient; 180 degF (100 degC), material surfaces. Water lnfiltration: Provide sheet metal roofing that does not allow water infiltration to building interior, with metal flashing and connections of sheet metal roofing lapped to allow moisture to mn over and offthe material. SI.]BMITTALS Product Data: For each product indicated. Include details of construction relative to materials, dimensions of individual cornponents and profiles, and finishes. Shop Drawings: Show fabrication and installation layouts of sheet metal roofing, including plans, elevations, and keyed refercnces to termination points. Distinguish between shop and field-assembled work. Include the following: 3/2012004 Details for forming sheet metal roofing, including seams and dimensions. Details for joining and securing sheet metal roofing, including layout of fasteners, clips, and other attachments. lnclude pattem of seams. Details of termination points and assemblies, including fixed points. Details of expansion joints, including showing direction of expansion and contraction. Details of roof penetations. Details of edge conditions, including eaves, ridges, valleys, rakes, crickets, and counterflashings. Details of special conditions. Details of connections to adjoining work. Details of the following accessory iterns, at a scale of not less than l-l/2 inches per 12 inches (1:10): a. Flashing and trim. b. Roofcurbs. c. Snow guards. B. I 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 7. 8. 9. Coordination Drawings: Roof plans drawn to scale and coordinating penetrations and roof- motmted items. Show the following: I . Sheet metal roofing and attachments. 2. Pwlins and rafters. 3. Roof-mounted items including roof hatches, equipment supports, pipe supports and penetrations, lighting fixfures, snow guards, and items mounted on roof curbs. Samples for Verification: For each type of exposed finish required, prepared on Samples of size indicated below: l. Sheet Metal Roofing: I 2 inches (300 mm) long by actual [pan] [panel] width, including finished seam. lnclude fasteners, [cleats,] [clipsr] [battens,] closures, and other attachments . 2. Trim and Closures: 12 inches (300 mm) long. Include fasteners and other exposed accessories. 3. Accessories: l2-inch- (300-mm-) long Samples for each type of accessory. c. I I t T l I l I T I D. ISHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 -2 E. A. B. 1.5 I I I I I T I I I I I I I I I I I 20021 50 t .08 C. VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 4. Snow Guards: Full-size Sample. Roll-Forming Equipment Certificate: Issued by UL for manufacturer's portable roll-forming equipment designed for producing sheet metal roofing. Show expiration date no earlier than two months after scheduled end of sheet metal roofing. Qualification Data: For lnstaller. Product Test Reports: Based on evaluation of comprehensive tests performed by a qualified testing agency, for sheet metal roofing portable roll-forming equipment. Include reports for structural performance. Wananties: Special warranties specified in this Section. QUALITY ASSURANCE Installer Qualifications: Fabricator of sheet metal roofing. Roll-Formed Sheet Metal Roofing Fabricator Qualifications: An authorized representative of roll-formed sheet metal roofing manufacturer for fabrication and installation of units required for this Project. Preinstallation Conference: Conduct conference at Project site. Comply with requiremants in Division I Section "Project Management and Coordination." Review methods and procedures related to sheet metal roofing including, but not limited to, the following: t . Meet with Owner, Architect, Owner's insurer if applicable, sheet metal roofing Installer, manufacturer's representative for sheet metal roofing portable roll-forming equipment, metal deck, sheathing Installer, and installers whose work interfaces with or affects sheet metal rooling including installers of roof accessories and roof-mounted equipment. 2. Review and finalize construction schedule and veriff availability of materials, Installer's personnel, equipment, and facilities needed to make progess and avoid delays. 3. Review methods and procedures related to sheet metal roo{ing installation, including portable roll-forming equipment manufacturer's written instructions. 4. Examine metal deck sheathing purlin and rafter conditions for compliance wittr requirements, including flatness and attachment to structural members. 5. Review structural loading limitations of metal deck and sheathing during and after roofing. 6. Review flashings, special roofing details, roof drainage, roof penetrations, equipment curbs, and condition of other construction that will affect sheet metal roofing including transition to and patching of existing roofing areas. 7. Review goveming regulations and requirements for insurance, certificates, and testing and inspecting if applicable. 8. Review temporary protection requirements for sheet metal roofing during and after installation. 9. Review roof observation and repair procedures after sheet metal rooling installation. 10. Document proceedings, including corrective measures and actions required, and fumish copy of record to each participant. F. G. H. I I SHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - 3 2002 r s01 .08 T t il I I B. c. 1.6 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 DELTVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Deliver metal coils, sheet metal roofing pans, components, and other sheet metal roofing materials so as not to be damaged or deformed. Package sheet metal roofing materials for protection during transportation and handling. Unload, store, and erect sheet metal roofing materials in a manner to prevent bending, warping, twisfing, and surface damage. Stack materials on platforms or pallets, covered with suitable weathertight and ventilated covering. Store metal coils and sheet metal roofing materials to ensure dryness. Do not store metal coils or sheet metal roofing materials in contact with other materials that miglrt cause staining, denting, or other surface damage. l. Store copper away from rmcured concrete and masonry. Protect strippable protective covering on sheet metal roofing from exposure to smlight and high humidity, except to extent necessary for period of sheet metal roofing installation. COORDINATION Coordinate installation of roof curbs, equipment supports, and roof penetrations, which are specified in Division 7 Section "Roof Accessories." Coordinate sheet metal roofing with rain drainage work, flashing, trim, and construction of metal decks, sheathing, parapets, walls, and other adjoining work to provide a leakproof, secure, and noncorrosive installation. WARRANTY Special Installer's Warranty: Roofing Installer's warranty, on warranty form at end of this Section, sigrred by Roofing lnstaller, in which Roofing Installer agrees to repair or replace cornponents of custom-fabricated sheet metal roofing that fail in materials or workmanship within specified warranty period. 1. Failures include, but are not limited to, the following: a. Structural failures. b. Loose parts. c. Wrinkling or buckling. d. Failwe to remain weathertight, including rurcontolled water leakage.e. Deterioration of metals, metal finishes, and other materials beyond normal weathering, including nonuiformity of color or finish.f. Galvanic action between sheet metal roofing and dissimilar materials. 2. Warranty Period: Two years Aom date of Substantial Completion. D.I T I I I I I I I T I I I 1.7 B. 1.8 SHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - 4 I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 I PART2-PRoDUCr' - I z.r MANUFACTURERsr A. ln other Part 2 articles where titles below introduce lists, the following requirements apply for I product selection: I l. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be a incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the products specified. I 2. Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the products specified. - 3. Available Manufachrrers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers I offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the manufacturers specifi ed. - 4. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by the I manufachrers specified. I 2.2 ROOFINGSHEETMETALS -A. Copper Sheet: ASTM B 370, cold-rolled copper sheet, H00 temper, unless otherwise indicated. I f 1. Available Manufacturers: - a. Hussey Copper Ltd. I b. Outokumpu American Brass. c. Revere Copper Products, Inc. I 2. Weight ('llrickness): 16 oz.lsq. ft. (0.55 mm) unless otherwise indicated.a I 2.3 TJNDERLAYMENTMATERIALS !A. Polyethylene Sheet: 6-mil- (0.15-mm-) thick polyethylane sheet complying with I ASrMD43e7. I B. Felts: ASTM D 226,TypeIl (No. 30), asphalt-saturated organic felts. I C. Self-Adhering, Granular-Faced Sheet: ASTMD 1970, 55 mils (1.4 mm) thick minimum,r minimum, consisting of slip-resisting polyethylene-film top surface laminated to layer of butyl or SBS-modified asphalt adhesive, with release-paper backing; cold applied. Provide primer I when recommended by underlayment manufacturer. I l. Thermal Stability: Stable after testing at 240 deg F ( I 16 deg C); ASTM D 1970. t 2. Low Temperature Flexibility: Passes after testing at minus 20 deg F (29 deg C); I ASTMD 1970. 3. Available Products: a. Carlisle Coatings & Waterproofing, Div. of Carlisle Companies hc.; Dri- Start'HR" High Performance Roofing Underlayment. b. Grace, W. R. & Co.; Vycor Ultra. I I I SHEET METAL ROOFINC 07610 - 5 2OO2I5OI.08 VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE c. Henry Company; Perma-Seal PE. d. Metal-Fab Manufacturing, LLC; MetShield. e. TC MiraDRL WIP 300HT. t I I I I D. 2.4 3t20/2004 Slip Sheet: Building paper, minimum 5 lb/100 sq. ft. (0.24 kflsq. m), rosin sized. MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS General: hovide materials and types of fastoters, solder, welding rods, protective coatings, separators, sealants, and other miscellaneous items as required for a complete roofing system and as recommended by fabricator for sheet metal roofing. Fasteners: Self-tapping screws, self-locking rivets and bolts, and other suitable fasteners designed to withstand design loads. l Nails for Copper Roofing: Copper or hardware bronze, 0.109 inch (2.8 mm) minimum and not less than 7/8 inch (22mm) long, barbed with large head. 2. Fasteners for Flashing and Trim: Blind fasteners or selldrilling screws with hex washer head. Solder for Copper: ASTM B 32, Grade Sn50, 50 percent tin and 50 percent lead. Sealing Tape: Pressure-sensitive, 100 percent solids, pollsobutylene compound sealing tape with release-paper backing. Provide permanently elastic, nonsag, nontoxic, nonstaining tape. Elastomeric Joint Sealant: ASTM C 920, of base polymer, t1pe, grade, class, and use classifications required to produce joints in sheet metal roofing that wiU remain weathertight and as recommended by roll-formed sheet metal roofing manufactrner for installation indicated. Expansion-Joint Sealant: For hooked-type expansion joints, which must be free to move, provide nonsetting, nonhardening, nonmigrating, heavy-bodied polyisobutylene sealant. Bituminous Coating: Cold-applied asphalt mastic, SSPC-Paint 12, compounded for 15-mil (0.4-mm) dry film thickness per coat. Provide inert-type noncorrosive compound free of asbestos fibers, sulfi.r components, and other deleterious impurities. ACCESSORIES Sheet Metal Roofing Accessories: hovide components required for a complete sheet metal roofing assembly including trim, copings, fasciae, corner rmits, ridge closures, clips, flashings, sealants, gaskets, fillers, closwe strips, and similar iterns. Match material and finish of sheet metal roofing, unless othenvise indicated. l. Closures: Provide closures at eaves and ridges, fabricated of same metal as sheet metal roofing. 2. Clips: Minimum 0.0625-inch- (1.6-mm) thick, stainless-steel panel clips designed to withstand negative-load requiremarts. 3. Cleats: Mechanically seamed cleats formed from the following material: a. Copper Roofing: l6-oz./sq. ft. (0.55-mm-) thick copper sheet. B.l I t I I I I I I T t c. D. F. G. 2.5 I l ISHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - 6 t 2oo2lsor.o8 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/20t2004 I 4. Closures: Closed-cell, expanded, cellular, rubber or crosslinked, polyolefin-foam ort closed-cell laminated polyethylene; minimum l-inch- (25-mm-) thick, flexible closure , strips; cut or premolded to match sheet metal roofing profile. Provide closure strips where indicated or necessary to ensure weathertight construction.I 5. Insulate roof curb with l-inch- (25-mm) thick, rigid insulation.II B. Snow Guards: Prefabricated, noncorrosive units designed to be installed without penetating sheet metal roofing, and complete with predrilled holes, clamps, or hooks for anchoring. aI I :f"-ffi:Y,t"#,i?:H:r:Hrffffil:#Ti,t,Bronze-a'oy stops designed ror t ^. Available Prducts:I I tl i'"Jfiil":";1f:;il#:'i::X'3l:"ii" 2ooMI 3) Zaleski Snow-Guards & Roofing Specialties; Model No. 7 Regular Copper. I 2. Seam-Mounted, Stop-Type Snow Guards: Cast-bronze stops designed for attachment to I vertical ribs of standing-seam sheet metal roofing with stainless-steel set screws. ' a. Available Products: II l) Alpine Snow Guards, Div. of Vermont Slate & Copper Services, Inc; Model No.30. f 2) BergerBros. Co.; RT SnowGuards. 3) Polar Blox; Standing Seam Snowguard. I C. Pipe Flashing: Premolded, EPDM pipe collar with flexible aluminum ring bonded to base.a l 2.6 EQUIPMENT !A. Portable Roll-Forming Equipment: Manufacturer's standard Ul-certified equipment capable of r forming sheet metal roofing in profiles indicated. q l. Available Manufacturers: - a. Berridge Manufacturing Cornpany. IL! b. Fabral. Inc. c. Flexospan Steel Buildings, Inc. I d. Metal-Fab Manufacturing, LLC. I e. Morin Corporation; a Metecno Group Company. I 2.7 FABRICATTON - A. General: Custom fabricate sheet metal roofing to comply with details shown and t recommendations in SMACNA's "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual" that apply to the design, dimensions (pan width and seam height), geometry, metal thickness, and other characteristics of I I SHEET METAL ROOFING o76to - 7 2002I50r.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 I I I I I I I T I I l I l I I I I installation indicated. Fabricate sheet metal roofrng and accessories at the shop to greatest extent possible. l. Standing-Seam Roofing: Form standing-seam pans with finished seam height to match existing. General: Fabricate roll-formed sheet metal roofing panels to comply with details shown and roll-formed sheet metal roofing manufacfurer's wriften instructions. Fabricate sheet metal roofing to allow for expansion in rururing work sufficient to prevent leakage, damage, and deterioration of the Work. Form exposed sheet metal work to lit subshates without excessive oil canning, buckling, and tool marks, true to line and levels indicated, and with exposed edges folded back to form hems. 1. Lay out sheet metal roofing so cross seams, when required, are made in direction of flow with higher pans ovedapping lower pans. Stagger cross seams. 2. Fold and cleat eaves and transverse seams in the shop. 3. Form and fab'ricate sheets, seams, sbips, cleats, valleys, ridges, edge treatments, integral flashings, and other components of metal roofing to profiles, patterns, and drainage arrangements shown and as required for leakproof construction. Expansion Provisions: Where lapped or bayonet-type expansion provisions in the Work cannot be used, form expansion joints of intermeshing hooked flanges, not less than I inch (25 mm) deep, filled with sealant (concealed within joints). Sealant Joints: Where movable, nonexpansion-typc joints are indicated or required to produce weathertight seams, form metal to provide for proper installation of elastomeric sealant, in compliance with SMACNA standards. Metal Protection: Where dissimilar metals will contact each other, protect against glvanic action by painting contact surfaces with bituminous coating, by applying rubberized-asphalt underlayment to each contact swface, or by other permanent separation as recommended by manufacturers of dissimilar metals or by fabricator. Sheet Metal Accessories: Custom fabricate flashings and trim to comply with recommendations in SMACNA's "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual" that apply to design, dimansions, metal, and other characteristics of itern indicated. Obtain field measurements for accurate fit before shop fabrication. l. Form exposed sheet metal accessories that are without excessive oil canning, buckling, and tool marks and that are true to line and levels indicated, with exposed edges folded back to form hems. 2. Seams for Other Than Aluminum: Fabricate nonmoving seams in accessories with flat- lock seams. 3. Sealed Joints: Form nonexpansion but movable joints in metal to accommodate elastomeric sealant to comply with SMACNA standards. 4. Conceal fasteners and expansion provisions where possible. Exposed fasteners are not allowed on faces of accessories exposed to view. 5. Fabricate cleats and attachment devices from same material as accessory being anchored or from compatible, noncorrosive metal. B. C. D. E. F. G. I ISHEETMETAL ROOFING 07610 - 8 c. B. c. B. 2.8 3.1 3.2 t I I I I I I T I I I I I I I I I T I 20021 501 .08 VAILMOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 a. Size: As recommended by SMACNA's "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual" for application but not less than thickness of metal being secured. FINISHES. GENERAL Appearance of Finished Work: Variations in appearance of abutting or adjacent pieces are acceptable if they are within one-half of the range of approved Samples. Noticeable variations in the same piece are not acceptable. Variations in appearance of other components are acceptable if they are within the range of approved Samples and are assembled or installed to minimize contrast. Copper Sheet Finishes: 1. Exposed Finish: Mill. Stainless-Steel Sheet Finishes: Remove tool and die marks and stretch lines or blend into finish. PART3 -EXECUTION EXAMINATION Examine substrates, areas, and conditions, with Installer present, for compliance with requirements for installation tolerances, sheet metal roofing supports, and other conditions affecting performance of work. l. Examine primary and secondary roof framing to verify that rafters, purlins, angles, channels, and other sfiuctural panel support members and anchorages have been installed. 2. Examine solid roof sheathing to verifr that sheathing joints are supported by framing or blocking and that installation is within flatness tolerances. 3. Verify that substate is sound, dry, smooth, clean, sloped for drainage, and completely anchored, and that provision has been made for flashings, and penetations tbrough sheet metal roofing. 4. For the record, prepare \pritten report, endorsed by Installer, listing conditions detrimental to performance of work. Examine roughing-in for components and systems penetrating sheet metal roofing to veriff acfual locations of penetrations relative to seam locations of sheet metal roofing before sheet metal roofing installation, Proceed with installation onlv after unsatisfactorv conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION Install flashings and other sheet metal to comply with requirements specified in Division 7 Section "Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim." Install fasciae and copings to comply with requirements specified in Division 7 Section "Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim." SHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - 9 2002 I 501 .08 T l I J.J I iB. c. l. 2. J. 4. VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 312012004 IINDERLAYMENT INSTALLATION Self-Adhering Sheet Underlayment: Install self-adhering sheet underlayment, wrinkle free, on roof sheathing under sheet metal roofing. Apply primer if required by underlayment manufacturer. Comply with temperature restrictions of underlayment manufacfurer for installation; use primer rather than nails for installing underlayment at low temperatures. Apply over entire roof, in shingle fashion to shed water, with end laps ofnot less than 6 inches (150 mm) staggered 24 inches (600 mm) between courses. Overlap side edges not less than 3-112 inches (90 mm). Extend underlayment into gutter trough. Roll laps with roller. Cover underlayment within 14 days. Install flashings to cover underlayment to comply with requirenrnts specified in Divisiqn 7 Section "Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim." Apply slip sheet over underlayment before installing sheet metal roofing. INSTALLATION, GENERAL General: Anchor sheet metal roofing and other components of the Work securely in place, with provisions for thermal and structural movement. Install fasteners, solder, welding rods, protective coatings, separators, sealants, and other miscellaneous items as required for a complete roofing system and ai recommended by fabricator for sheet metal roohng. Field cutting of sheet metal roofing by torch is not permitted. Rigidly fasten eave end of sheet metal roofing and allow ridge end free movement due to thermal expansion and contaction. Predrill roofing. kovide metal closures at peaks rake edges rake walls and each side of ridge and hip caps. Flash and seal sheet metal roofing with weather closures at eaves, rakes, and at perimeter of all openings. Fasten with self-tapping screws. 5. Locate and space fastenings in uniform vertical and horizontal alignment. 6- Install ridge and hip caps as sheet metal roofing work proceeds. 7. Stagger roofrng splices and errd laps to avoid a four-panel lap splice condition. 8. Lap metal flashing over sheet metal roofing to allow moisture to run over and off the material. Fasteners: Use fasteners of sizes that will not penetrate completely through subsaate. l. Copper Roofmg: Use copper or stainless-steel fasteners. Metal Protection: Where dissimilar metals will contact each other or corrosive substrates, protect against galvanic action by painting contact surfaces with bituminous coating, by applying rubberized-asphalt underlayment to each contact surface, or by other permanent separation as recommended by fabricator of sheet metal roofing or manufachrers of dissimilar metals. Conceal fasteners and expansion provisions where possible in exposed work and locate to minimize possibilify of leakage. Cover and seal fasteners and anchors as required for a tight installation. 3.4 I I I I I T l I T I I I I B. c. D. SHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - 10 I 2002l 50r -08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 3.6I I E. B. 3.5 I I I I l I T B. C. I I I t I I I I I Fascia: Align bottom of sheet metal roofing and fasten with blind rivets, bolts, or self+apping screws. Flash and seal sheet metal roofing with weather closures where fasciae meet soffits, along lower panel edges, and at perimeter of all openings. ON-SITE, ROLL-FORMED SHEET METAL ROOFING INSTALLATION General: Install on-site, roll-formed sheet metal roofing to comply with sheet metal roofing manufacturer's written instructions for UL wind-uplift class indicated. Provide sheet metal roofing of full length from eave to ridge unless othenvise restricted by shipping limitations. Standing-Seam Sheet Metal Roofing: Fasten sheet metal roofing to supports with concealed clips at each standing-seam joint at location, spacing, and with fasteners recommended by manufacfurer. l. Install clips to supports with self-tapping fasteners.2. Install pressure plates at locations indicated in manufach.uer's written installation instructions. 3. Before panels are joined, apply continuous bead of sealant to top flange of lower panel. 4. Seamed Joint: Crimp standing seams with manufacturer-approved motorized seamer tool so cleat, sheet metal roofing, and field-applied sealant are completely engaged. ACCESSORY INSTALLATION General: Install accessories with positive anchorage to building and weathertight mounting and provide for thermal expansion. Coordinate installation with flashings and other components. l. Install components required for a complete sheet metal roo{ing assembly including trim, copings, ridge closures, s€am covers, flashings, sealants, gaskets, fillers, closure strips, and similar items. Flashing and Trim: Comply with performance requirements, manufacturer's written installation instructions, and SMACNA's "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual." hovide concealed fasteners where possible, and set units true to line and level as indicated. Install work with laps, joints, and seams that will be permanently watertight and weather resistant. l. Install exposed flashing and trim that is without excessive oil canning, buckling, and tool marks and that is true to line and levels indicated, with exposed edges folded back to form hems. Install sheet metal flashing and trim to fit substrates and to result in waterproof and weather-resistant performance. 2. Expansion Provisions: Provide for thermal expansion of exposed flashing and trim. Space movement joints at a maximum of 10 feet (3 m) with no joints allowed within 24 inches (600 mm) of comer or intersection. Where lapped or bayonet-type expansion provisions cannot be used or would not be sufficiently weather resistant and waterproof, form expansion joints of intermeshing hooked flanges, not less than I inch (25 mm) deep, filled with mastic sealant (concealed within joints). Gutters: Join sections with riveted and soldered or lapped and sealed joints. Attach gutters to eave with gutter hangers spaced not more than 4 feet (l .2 m) o.c. using manufacfurer's standard SHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - l1 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 fasteners. Provide end closures and seal watertieht with sealant. Provide for thermal expansion. D. Downspouts: Join sections with l-l/2-inch (38-mm) telescoping joints. Provide fasteners desigred to hold downspouts securely I inch (25 mm) away from walls; locate fasteners at top and bottom and at approximately 60 inches ( 1500 mm) o.c. in between. I . Provide elbows at base of downspout to direct water away from building. E. Roof Curbs: Install curbs at locations indicated on Drawings. Install flashing around bases where they meet sheet metal roofing. F. Stop-Type Snow Guards: Attach snow guards to sheet metal roofmg with solder, as recommended by manufacturer. Do not use fastenen that will penehate sheet metal roofing. l. Provide rows of snow guards, at locations indicated on Drawings, spaced in accordance with manu factures written instructions. G. Vertical Rib Type Snow Guards: Attach bar supports to vertical ribs of standing-seam sheet metal roofing with clarnps or set screws. Do not use fasteners that will penetrate sheet metal roofing. l. Provide of snow guards, at locations indicated on Drawings, spaced accordinag to manufacfurer' s written instuctions, H. Pipe Flashing: Form flashing around pipe penetation and sheet metal roofing. Fasten and seal to sheet metal roofing as recommended by manufacturer. 3.7 ERECTION TOLERANCES A. Installation Tolerances: Shim and aligt sheet metal roofing within installed tolerance of l/4 inch in 20 feet (6 mm in 6 m) on slope and location lines as indicated and within l/8-inch (3- mm) offset of adjoining faces and of alignment of matching profiles. 3.8 CLEANING AND PROTECTION A. Clean exposed metal surfaces of substances that interfere with uniform oxidation and weathering. B. Clean and neutalize flux materials. Clean offexcess solder and sealants. C. Remove temporary protective coverings and strippable frlms, if any, as sheet metal roofing is installed. On completion of sheet metal roofing installation, clean finished surfaces, including removing unused fasteners, metal filings, pop rivet stems, and pieces of flashing. Maintain in a clean condition during con struction. D. Replace panels that have been damaged or have deteriorated beyond successful repair by finish touchup or similar minor repair procedures. t t 1 t I I I T I I I I I I I t I I ISHEET METAL ROOFING 07610 - t2 t. c. B. c. D. 3.9 T I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I 20021501.08 VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 ROOFING INSTALLER'S WARRANTY WHEREAS <Insert name> of <Insert address>, herein called the "Roofing Installer," has performed roofing and associated work ("work") on the following project: L Owner: <Insert name of Owner,>2. Address: <Insert address.>3. Building NameiType: <Insert information.>4. Address: <lnsert address.>5. Area of Work: <Insert information.>6. Acceptance Date: <Insert date.>7. Warranty Period: <Insert time.>8. Expiration Date: <Insert date.> AND WHEREAS Roofing Installer has contracted (either directly with Owner or indirectly as a subcontractor) to warrant said work against leaks and faulty or defective materials and worknanship for designated Warranty Period, NOW THEREFORE Roofing Installer hereby warrants, subject to t€Tms and conditions herein set forth, that during Warranty Period he will, at his own cost and expense, make or cause to be made such repairs to or replacements of said work as are necessary to correct faulty and defective work and as are necessary to maintain said work in a watertight condition. This Warranty is made su$ect to the following terms and conditions: l. Specifically excluded from this Warranty are damages to work and other parts of the building, and to building contents, caused by: lighnring; peak gust wind speed exceeding <Insert wind speed> mph (mtsec); fire; failure of roofing system substrate, including cracking, settlement, excessive deflection, deterioration, and decomposition; faulty construction of parapet walls, copings, chimneys, slcylights, vents, equipment supports, and other edge conditions and penetrations ofthe work; vapor condelsation on bottom ofroofing; and activity on roofing by others, including construction conhactors, maintenance personnel, other persons, and animals, whether authorized or unauthorized by Owner. 2. when work has been damaged by any of foregoing causes, warranty shall be null and void until such damage has been repaired by Roofing Installer and until cost and expense thereof have been paid by Owner or by another responsible party so desigrrated.3. Roofing hrstaller is responsible for damage to work covered by this Warranty but is not liable for consequential damages to building or building contents resulting from leaks or faults or defects of work.4. During warranty Period, if owner allows alteration of work by anyone other than Roofing Installer, including cutting, patching, and maintenance in connection with penetrations, attachment of other work, and positioning of anything on roof, this Warranty shall become null and void on date of said alterations, but only to the extent said alterations affect work covered by this warranty. If owner engages Roofing a. b. c. d. SHEETMETAL ROOFING 07610 - l3 2002 I 501 .08 END OF SECTION 07610 VAIL MOI.]NTI,AN LODGE Authorized Signatwe: <Insert signature) Name: <Insert name> Title: <Inserttitle.> Installer to perform said alterations, Warranty shall not become null and void unlessRoofing Installer, before starting said work, shall have notified Owner in writing, showing reasonable cause for claim, that said alterations would likely damage Ji deteriorate work, thereby reasonably justifing a limitation or termination of this Warranty. 5. During Warranty Period, if original use of roof is changed and it becomes used for, but was not originally specified for, a promenade, work deck, spray-cooled surface, flooded basin, or other use or service more severe than originally rp""ifi"d, this Warranty shall become null and void on date of said change, but only to tliLe exteni said change Lffects work covered by this Wan-anty.6. owner sball promptly notiS Roofing Instalrer of observed, known, or suspected leaks, defects, or deterioration and shall afford reasonabte opportunity for Roofing Installer to inspect work and to examine evidence ofsuch leaks, defects, or deterioration.7. This Wan"anty is recognized to be the only warranty of Roofing Installer on said work and shall not operate to restict or cut off Owner from other iemedies and resources lawfully available to Owner in cases of roofing failure. Specifically, this Warranty shall not operate to relieve Roofing- Installer ofresponsibility for performance of originai work according to requirements of the Conbact Documents, regardless of whether Contract was a contract directly with Owner or a subcontract with Owner's General Contactor. IN wITNEss THEREOF, this instrument has been duly executed this <rnsert day> day of<Insert month>, <fnsert year>. 3/20t2004 I I I I I I I T I I T t I I I I I I I l. 2. J. SHEETMETAL ROOFING 07610 - 14 t I 20021501.08 vAIL MoUNTI.AN LoDcE 3/20t2004 I -l]T SECTION 07620 - SHEET METAL FLASHING AND TRIM r PART I -GENERAL I l.l SUMMARY ) A. This Section includes the following: t l. Formed roof drainage system. 2. Formed steep-slope roof flashing and trim. 3. Formed wall flashing and tim. I 1.2 ST]BMITTALS t A. ProductData: Foreachproductindicated. I B. Shop Drawings: Show layouts, profiles, shapes, seams, dimensions, and details for fastening, t joining, supporting, and anchoring sheet metal flashing and trim. - C. Samples: For each type of sheet metal flashing and trim. I I.3 OUALITYASSIJRANCEI t A. Sheet Metal Flashing and Trim Standard: Comply with SMACNA's "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual." Conforrn to dimensions and profiles shown unless more stringent requirements are l, indicated. I B. Preinstallation Conference: Conduct conference at hoject site.tI PART2-PRoDUcrs I - 2.1 MANUFACTI.]RERS I A. In other Part 2 articles where titles below introduce lists, the following requirements apply to f product selection: ,l l. Available Manufachrers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers I offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, manufacturers specifi ed. fJ 2.2 SHEET METALS I A. Copper Sheet: ASTM B 370, Temper H00 or H0l, cold-rolled copper sheet.I t SHEET METAL FLASHING AND TRIM 07620 - I ! 2.3 20021501.08 VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE 3/20t20Q4 MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS General: Provide materials and types of fasteners, solder, welding rods, protective coatings, separators, sealants, and other miscellaneous items as required for complete sheet metal flashing and trim installation. Felt Underlayment: ASTM D 226, Type II (No. 30), asphalt-saturated organic felt, nonperfbrated. I . Slip Sheet Rosin-sized paper, minimum 3 lb/l 00 sq. ft. (0. 16 kg/sq. m). Fasteners: Wood screws, annular tlreaded nails, self-tapping screwg self-locking rivets and bolts, and other suitable fasteners desigrred to withstand desigr loads. 1. Nails for Copper Sheet: Copper or hardware b'ronze, 0.109 inch (2.8 mm) minimum and not less than 718 inc1r'(22 mm) long, barbed with large head. 2. Exposed Fasteners: Heads matching color of sheet metal by means of plastic caps or factory-applied coating. 3. Fasteaers for Flashing and Trim: Blind fasteners or selfdrilling scr€ws, gasketed, with hex washer head. 4. BlindFasteners: High-sfrengthstainless-steelrivets. Sealing Tape: Pressure-sansitive, 100 percent solids, polyisobutylene compound sealing tape with release-paper backing. hovide permanantly elastic, nonsag, nontoxic, nonstaining tape. Elastomeric Sealant: ASTM C 920, elastomeric silicone polymer sealant; of type, grade, class, and use classifications required to seal joints in sheet metal flashing and trim and remain watertight. F. Butyl Sealant: ASTMCl3ll, single+omponert, solvent-release butyl rubber sealant, polyisobutylene plasticized, heavy bodied for hooked-type expansion joints with limited movemert. Epoxy Seam Sealer: Two'part, noncorrosive, aluminum seam-cementing compotmd. Bituminous Coating: Cold-applied asphalt mastic, SSPC-Paint 12, compounded for lS-mil (0.4-mm) dry film thickness per coat. FABRICATION. GENERAL General: Custom fabricate sheet metal flashing and trim to comply with recommendations in SMACNA's "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual" that apply to desigrr, dimensions, metal, and other characteristics of item indicated. Shop fab'ricate items where practicable. Obtain field measurements for accurate fit before shop fabrication. Fabricate sheet metal flashing and trim without excessive oil canning, buckling, and tool marks and tue to line and levels indicated, with exposed edges folded back to form hems. l. Seams for Other Than Aluminum: Fabricate nonmoving seams in accessories with flat- lock seams. Tin edges to be seamed, form seams, and solder. T I t I I I T t t I I I t I I I I I I B. c. D. G. H. 2.4 B. SHEET METAL FLASHING ANDTRM 07620 -2 I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/20t2004 I C. Sealed Joints: Form nonexpansion but movable joints in metal to accommodate elastomeric - sealant to comply with SMACNA recommendations. I D. Expansion hovisions: Where lapped or bayonet-type expansion provisions in the Work cannot I be used, form expansion joints of intermeshing hooked flanges, not less than I inch (2-5 mnr) deep, filled with elastomeric sealant concealed within joints. I E. Conceal fasteners and expansion provisions where possible on exposed-to-view sheet metal flashing and trim, unless othenvise indicated. I F. Fabricate cleats and attachment devices from same material as accessory being anchored or from compatible, noncorosive metal, and in thiclness not less than that of metal being secured. rl I 2.5 ROOF DRAINAGE SHEET METALFABRICATIoNS I A. Hanging Gutters: Fabricate to half round cross section indicated, complete with end pieces, I outlet tubes, and other accessories as required. Fabricate in minimum 96-inch- (2400-mm-) long sections. Furnish flat-stock gutter spacers and gutter brackets fabricated from same metal I as gutters, of size recommended by SMACNA but not less than twice the gutter thickness. t Fabricate expansion jointg expansion-joint covers, gutter bead reinforcing bars, and gutt€r accessories from same metal as gutters. t l. Fabricate from the following material: I a. Copper: 20 oz.bq.ft. (o.z mm itrict) I B. Downspouts: Fabricate round downspouts complete wrth mitered elbows. Fumish with metal! hangers, from same material as downspouts, and anchors. I l. Manufactured Hanger Style: Copper Strap.>t 2. Fabricate downspouts from the following material: I a. Copper: 16 oz.lsq. ft. (0.55 mm thick). I I 2.6 STEEP-SLOPE ROOF SHEET METAL FABRICATIONStA. Apron, Step, Cricket, and Backer Flashing: Fabricate from the following material: I l. Copper: 16 oz./sq. ft. (0.55 mm thick).! B. Valley Flashing: Fabricate &om the following material: I 1. Copper: 16 oz./sq. ft. (0.55 mm thick). 1; C. Drip Edges: Fabricate from the following material: - l. Copper: 16 oz./sq. ft. (0.55 mm thick). I D. Eave, Rake, Ridge, and Hip Flashing: Fabricate from the following material:t 1. Copper: 16 oz./sq. ft. (0.55 mm thick). I I SHEET METAL FLASHING AND TRIM 07620 - 3 3.1 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 2.7 WALL SHEETMETAL FABRICATIONS A. Openings Flashing in Frame Construction: Fabricate head, sill, and similar flashings to extend 4 inches ( 100 mm) beyond wall openings. Form head and sill flashing with 2-inch- (50-mm-) high end dams. Fabricate from the following material: 1. Copper: 16 oz.isq. ft. (0.55 mm thick). PART3 -EXECUTION INSTAILATION, GENERAL General: Anchor sheet metal flashing and trim and other components of the Work secwely in place, with provisions for thermal and structural movement. Use fastaners, solder, welding rods, protective coatings, separators, sealants, and other miscellaneous items as required to complete sheet metal flashing and trim system. l. Torch cutting of sheet metal flashing and trim is not permitted. Metal Protection: Where dissimilar metals will contact each other or corrosive zubstrates, protect against galvanic action by painting contact surfaces with bituminous coating or by other permanent separation as recornmended by fabricator or manufachners of dissimilar metals. Install exposed sheet metal flashing and tim without excessive oil canning, buckling and tool marks. lnstall sheet metal flashing and trim true to line and levels indicated. Provide unifornL neat seams with minimum exposure of solder, welds, and elastomeric sealant. Install sheet metal flashing and trim to fit substrates and to result in watertight performance. Veriff shapes and dimensions of surfaces to be covered before fabricating sheet metal. 1. Space cleats not more than 12 inches (300 mm) apart. Anchor each cleat with two fasteners. Bend tabs over fasteners. Expansion hovisions: Provide for thermal expansion of exposed flashing and trim. Space movement joints at a maximum of l0 feet (3 m) with no joints allowed within 24 inches (600 mm) of corner or intersection. Where lapped or bayonet-type expansion provisions cannot be used or would not be sufficiently watertight, form expansion joints of intermeshing hooked flanges, not less than I inch (25 mrn) deep, filled with elastomeric sealant concealed within joints. Fasteners: Use fasteners of sizes that will penetrate substrate not less than l-1/4 inches (32 mm) for nails and not less than 314 inch ( l9 mm) for wood scr€ws. L Copper: Use copper or stainless-steel fasteners. Seal joints with elastomeric sealant as required for watertight construction. T T I I I t I I I I I t I I I T I I I D. F. G. H. SHEETMETAL FLASHING AND TRIM 07620 - 4 A. B. C. D. 3.2 J.J I I I I I l I T I I I I I I I I I I I 20021501 .08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3/20/2004 Soldered Joints: Clean surfaces to be soldered, removing oils and foreign matter. Pretin edges of sheets to be soldered to a width of l-112 inches (38 mm) except where pretinned surface would show in finished Work. ROOF DRAINAGE SYSTEM INSTALLATION General: Install sheet metal roof drainage items to produce complete roof drainage system according to SMACNA recommendations and as indicated. Coordinate installation of roof perimeter flashing with installation of roof drainage system. Hanging Gutters: Join sections with riveted and soldered joints or with lapped joints sealed with elastomeric sealant. Provide for thermal expansion. Attach gutters at eave or fascia to firmly anchored gutter brackets spaced not more than 18 inches (900 mm) apart. Provide end closures and seal watertight with sealant. Slope to downspouts. l. Install gutter with expansion joints at locations indicated but not exceeding 50 feet (15.24 m) apart. Install expansion joint caps. Downspouts: Join sections with l-ll2-inch (38-mm) telescoping joints. Provide fasteners desigrred to hold downspouts securely I inch (25 mm) away from walls; locate fasteners at top and bottom and at approximately 60 inches (1500 mm) o.c. in between. ROOF FLASHING INSTALLATION General: Install sheet metal roof flashing and trim to comply with performance requirements and SMACNA's "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual." Provide concealed fasteners where possible, set units true to line, and level as indicated. Install work with laps, joints, and seams that will be permanently watertight. Roof Edge Flashing: Anchor to resist uplift and outward forces according to recommendations in FMG Loss Prevention Data Sheet l-49. 1. Interlock bottom edge ofroof edge flashing with continuous cleats anchored to substate at l6-inch (400-mm) centers. Counterflashing: Coordinate installation of counterflashing with installation of base flashing. Insert cotmterllashing in reglets or receivers and fit tightly to base flashing. Secure in a waterproof marmer. Extend counterflashing 4 inches ( 100 mm) over base flashing. Lap counterflashing joints a minimum of 4 inches ( 100 mm) and bed with elastomeric sealant. Roof-Penetration Flashing: Coordinate installation of roof-penetration flashing with installation of roofing and other items penetrating roof. Install flashing as follows: I . Turn lead flashing down inside vent piping, being careful not to block vent piping with flashing. 2. Seal with elastomeric sealant and clamp flashing to pipes penetrating roof except for lead flashing on vent piping. SHEET METAL FLASHING AND TRIM 07620 - 5 20021 50 r .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 3.4 WALL FLASHING INSTALLATION A. General: Install sheet metal wall flashing to intercept and exclude penetrating moisture according to SMACNA reconrmendations and as indicated. Coordinate installation of wall flashing with installation of wall-opening components such as windows, doors, and louvers. B. Openings Flashing in Frame Constuction: Install continuous head, sill, and similar flashings to extend 4 inches (100 mm) beyond wall openings. END OF SECTION 07620 I t I t I I I t I I I I t I I T I I tSHEET METAL FLASHING AND TRIM 07620 - 6 B. c. 1.1 1.2 1.3 t I I I I I t I I I t I I I I t I t I 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTI-AN LODGE SECTION O78I I - SPRAYED FIRE.RESISTTVE MATERIALS PART I -GENERAL 3t20/2004 SUMMARY This Section includes sprayed fire-resistive materials applied to surfaces that are concealed from view behind other construction when the Work is completed. SUBMITTALS Product Data: For each product indicated. Shop Drawings: Show extent of sprayed fire-resistive material for each construction and fire- resistance rating, applicable fire-resistive desigrr designations of a qualified testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities havingjurisdiction, and minimum thicknesses. Compatibility and adhesion test reports. Product test reports. Research/evaluation reports. QUALITY ASST'RANCE Installer Qualifications: A qualified installer, approved by manufactwer to install manufactrner's products. A manufacturer's willingne ss to sell its sprayed fire-resistive materials to Contactor or to an installer engaged by Contactor does not in itself confer qualification on the buyer. Sprayed Fire-Resistive Materials Testing: By a qualified testing and inspecting agency engaged by Contractor or manufacturer to test for cornpliance with specified requirements for performance and test methods. l. Sprayed fire-resistive materials are randomly selected for testing from bags bearing the applicable classification marking of UL or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. 2. Testing is performed on specimens of sprayed fire-resistive materials that comply with laboratory testing requirements specified in Part 2 and are otherwise identical to installed fire-resistive materials, including application of accelerant, sealers, topcoats, tamping, troweling, rolling, and water overspray, if any ofthese are used in final application. 3. Testing is performed on specimens whose application the independent testing and inspecting agency witnessed during preparation and conditioning. Include in test reports a full description of preparation and conditioning of laboratory test specimens. Compatibility and Adhesion Testing: Engage a qualified testing and inspecting agency to prepare compatibility and adhesion test reports. A. B. c. D. E. SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTTVE MATERI,ALS 07811- l 20021 50 | .08 VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE 3t20/2004 1. Test for bond per ASTM E 736 and requirements in UL's "Fire Resistance Directory" for coating materials. Provide bond strength indicated in referenced fire-resistance design, but not less than minirnum specified in Part 2. 2. Veri0/ that manufacturer, through its own laboratory testing or field experience, has not found primers or coatings to be incompatible with sprayed fire-resistive material. Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: Where indicated, provide products identical to those tested for fire resistance per ASTME 119 by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. l. One Hour Fire-Resistance Ratings: Indicated by design desigrations from UL's "Fire Resistance Directory" or from the listings of another testing and inspecting agency. 2. Identi$ products with appropriate markings of applicable testing and inspecting agency. Provide products containing no deteciable asb€stos as determined according to the method specified in 40 CFR 763, Subpart E, Appendix E, Section l, "Polarized Light Microscopy." PROJEST CONDITIONS Environmental Limitations: Do not apply sprayed fire-resistive material when ambient or substrate temperature is 40 deg F (4 deg C) or lower rmless temporary protection and heat is provided to maintain temperature at or above this level for 24 horns before, during, and for 24 hours after product application Ventilate building spaces during and after application of sprayed fire-resistive material. Use natural means or, if they are inadequate, forced-air circulation until fire-resistive material dries thoroughly. Sequance and coordinate ap'plication of sprayed fire-resistive materials with related work. l. Provide terporary enclosure as required to confine sprayng operations and protect the environment. 2. Provide temporary enclosures for applications to prevent deterioration of fire-resistive material due to exposure to weather and to unfavorable ambient conditions for humidity, temperature, and ventilation. 3. Avoid unnecessary exposure of fire-resistive material to ab'rasion and other damage likely to occw during construction operations subsequent to its application. 4. Do not apply fire-resistive material to metal roof deck substates until concrete topping, if any, has been completed. For metal roof decks without concrete topping, do not apply fire-resistive material to metal roof deck substrates until roofing has been completed; prohibit roof traffic during application and drying of Iire-resistive material. 5. Do not apply fire-resistive material to metal floor deck substrates until concrete topping has been completed. 6. Do not begin applying fire-resistive material unfil clips, hangers, supports, sleeves, and other items penetrating fire protection are in place. 7. Defer installing ducts, piping, and other items that would interfere with applying fire- resistive material until application offire protection is cornpleted. 8. Do not install enclosing or concealing construction until after fire-resistive material has been applied, inspected, tested and corrections have been made to defective applications. I I I I I I I I I I I I l I I t I I t D. 1.4 B. C. SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTTVE MATERTALS 07811-2 I I 20021s0t.08 vAIL MoUNTIAN LoDGE 3t2o/2oo4 I 1.5 wARRANTYI A. Special Warranty: Manufacturer's standard form, signed by Contractor and by Installer, in I which manufacfurer agrees to repair or replace sprayed fire-resistive materials that fail in f materials or worknanship within two years from date of Substantial Completion. f l. Failures include, but are not limited to, cracking, flaking, spalling, eroding in excess of I specified requirements; peeling; or delaminating of sprayed fire-resistive materials from subshates. I 2. Not covered under the warranty are failures due to damage by occupants and Owner's I maintenance personnel and other causes not reasonably foreseeable under conditions of normal use. .l . PART2-PRODUCTS I 2.1 CONCEALED SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTTVEMATERIALS I A. General: For concealed applications of sprayed fire-resistive materials, provide manufacture/s I standard products complying with requirements indicated for material composition and physical properties representative of installed products. I I B. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be- rncorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: I C. Products: Subject to compliance with requirernents, provide one of the following: T l. Cernentitious Sprayed Fire-Resistive Material: I a. Carboline Co., Fireproofing hoducts Dv.; Pyrolite 15. b. Carboline Co., Fireproofing Products Dv.; Pyrolite 15 High Yield. I c. Grace, W. R. & Co.-Conn., Construction Products Div.; Monokote Type MK-6s. I d. Grace, W. R. & Co.-Conn., Construction hoducts Div.; Monokote Type MK- 6IHY. I e. Isolatek Intemational Corp., Cafco Products; Cafco 300. I f. Southwest Vermiculite Co., Inc.;5EF.g. Southwest Vermiculite Co., Inc.; 5GP. I 2. Sprayed-Fiber Fire-Resistive Material:! a. Isolatek Intemational Corp., Cafco Products; Cafco Blaze-Shield II. I b. Isolatek Intemational Corp., Cafco Products; Type JN-HD. I D. Material Composition: Either of the following: t I . Cementitious sprayed fire-resistive material consisting of factory-mixed, dry formulation of gypsum or portland cement binders and lightweight mineral or synthetic aggrcgates I mixed with water at Project site to form a slurry or mortar for conveyance and I application. I I SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTIVE MATERI-ALS 078il - 3 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3t20t2004 2. Sprayed-fiber fire-resistive material consisting of factory-mixed, dry formulation of inorganic binders, mineral fibers, fillers, and additives conveyed in a dry state by pneumatic equipment and mixed with water at spray nozzle to form a damp, as-applied product. Physical Properties: Minimum values, unless othenvise indicated, or higher values required to attain desigrated fire-resistance ratings, measured per standard test methods referenced with each property as follows: l. Ilry Density: 15 lb/cu. ft. (240 kg/cu. m) for average and individual densities regardless of density indicated in referenced fire-resistance desigr, or greater if required to attain fire-resistance ratings indicate{ per ASTME605 or AWCI Technical Manual l2-A, Section 5.4.5, "Dsplacement Method." 2. Thiclness: Provide minimum average thiclness required for one how fire-resistance design indicated according to the following criteria, but not less than 0.375 inch (9 mm), perASTM E 605: a. Where the referenced fire-resistance design lists a thickness of I inch (25 mm) or greater, the minimum allowable individual thickness of sprayed fire-resistive material is the design thickness minus 0.25 inch (6 mm). b. Where the referenced fire-resistance desigr lists a thickness of less than I inch (25 mm) but more than 0.375 inch (9 mm), the minimum allowable individual thiclness of sprayed fire-resistive material is the greater of 0.375 inch (9 mm) or 75 percent ofthe desigr thickness. c. No reduction in avaage thicloess is permittcd for those fire-resistance designs wbose fire-resistance ratings were established at densities of less than 15 lb/cu. ft. (240kglcu.m). 3. Bond Strengh: 150 lbflsq. ft. (7.2 kPa) minimum per ASTM E 736 under the following conditions: a. Field test sprayed fire-resistive material that is applied to flanges ofwide-flange, strucfural-steel members on surfaces matching those that witl exist for remainder of steel receiving fire-resistive material. b. If surfaces of structural steel receiving sprayd fire-resistive material are primed or othenvise painted for coating materials, perform series of bond tests specified in LIL's "Fire Resistance Directory." Provide bond strength indicated in referenced UL fire-resistance criteria, but not less than 150 lbflsq. ft. (7 .2 YAa) minimum per ASTM E 736. c. Minimum thickness of sp'ra.yed fire-resistive material tested in laboratory shall be 0.75 inch ( l9 mm). 4. Compressive Shength: 5.21 lbflsq. in. (35.9 kPa) as determined in the laboratory per ASTM E 761. Minimum thickness of sprayed fire-resistive material tested shall be 0.75 inch (19 mm) and minimum dry density shall be as specified, but not less than 15 lb/cu. ft. (240 kg/cu. m). 5. Corrosion Resistance: No evidence of corrosion per ASTM E 937. 6. Deflection: No cracking, spalling, or delamination per ASTM E 759. 7. Effect of Impact on Bonding: No cracking, spalling, or delamination per ASTM E 760. 8. Air Erosion: Maximum weight loss of 0.025 g/sq. ft. (0.270 glsq. m) in 24 hours per ASTM E 859. For laboratory tests, minimum thickness of sprayed fire-resistive material T I I I I I I t 1 I I I I t I I I I ISPRAYED FIRE-RESISTIVE MATERIALS 07811-4 c. D. 2.2 3.1 I I I T I I I I I I I I I I t t I I I 2002r 501.08 VAIL MOTJNTLAN LODGE 3/20/2004 is 0.75 inch (19 mm), maximum dry density is l5 lb/cu. ft. (240 kgicu. m), test specimens are not prepurged by mechanically induced air velocities, and tests are terminated after 24 hours. 9. Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: Provide sprayed fire-resistive materials with the following surface-burning characteristics as determined by testing identical products per ASTM E 84 by UL or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction: a. Flame-Spread Index: l0 or less. b. Smoke-Developed lndex: 0. AUXILIARY FIRE-RESISTTVE MATERIALS General: Provide auxiliary fire-resistive materials that are compatible with sprayed fire- resistive materials and substrates and are approved by UL or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction for use in fire-resistance desigrrs indicated. Subsfate Primers: For use on each subst'ate and with each sprayed fire-resistive product, provide primer that complies with one or rnore of the following requirements: I . Primer's bond stength complies with requirements specified in UL's "Fire Resistance Directory," for coating materials based on a series of bond tests per ASTM E 736. 2. Primer is identical to those used in assemblies tested for fue-test-response characteristics of sprayed fire-resistive material per ASTM E I 19 by UL or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jrnisdiction. Adhesive for Bonding Fire-Resistive Material: hoduct approved by manufacturer of sprayed fire-resi stive material. Metal Lath: Expanded metal lath fabricated from material of weight, configuration, and finish required to comply with fire-resistance desigrs indicated and fire-resistive material manufacturer's written recommendations. Include clips, lathing accessories, comer beads, and other anchorage devices required to attach lath to substrates and to receive sprayed fire-resistive material. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTALLATION Examine subsbates, areas, and conditions, with Installer present, to determine whether they are in satisfactory condition to receive sprayed fire-resistive material and to verifo the following: l. Substrates are free of oil, grease, rolling compounds, incompatible primers, loose mill scale, dirt, or other foreign substances capable of impairing bond of fire-resistive materials with substrates under conditions of normal use or fire exposure. 2. Objects penehating fire-resistive material, including clips, hangers, support sleeves, and similar items, are securely attached to substrates. SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTIVE MATERIALS 0781I - 5 20021 50 t .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t20t2004 3. Substrates are not obstructed by ducts, piping, equipment, and other suspended construction that will interfere with applying fire-resistive material. Clean substrates of substances that could irnpair bond of fire-resistive material, including dirt, oil, grease, release agents, rolling cornpounds, loose mill scale, and incompatible primers, paints, and encapsul ants. Conduct tests according to fire-resistive material manufacturer's written recommendations to verify that substrates are free of oil, rolling compounds, and other substances capable of interfering with bond. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corected. Cover other work subject to damage from fallout or overspray of fire-resistive materials during application. Install metal lath, as required, to comply with fire-resistance ratings and fire-resistive material manufachlrer's written recommendations for conditions of exposure and intended use. Securely attach lath to subsfrate in position required for support and reinforcement of fire-resistive material. Use anchorage devices of type recommended in writing by sprayed fire-resistive material manufacturer. Attach lathing accessories where indicated or required for secwe attachment to substrate. Coat subsfrates with adhesive before applying fire-resistive material where required to achieve fire-resistance rating or as reconunended in writing by sprayed fire-resistive material manufachner for material and application indicated. Extend fire-resistive material in full thickness over entire area ofeach subsfate to be protected. Unless otherwise recommended in writing by sprayed fire-resistive material manufacttrer, install body of fire-resistive covering in a single course. Spray apply fire-resistive materials to maximum extent possible. Following the spraying operation in each area, complete the coverage by trowel application or other placement method recommended in writing by sprayed fire-resistive material rnanufacturer. Apply concealed sprayed fire-resistive material in thicknesses and densities not less than those required to achieve fire-resistance ratings designated for each condition, but apply in greater thicknesses and densities if specified in Part2 nConcealed Sprayed Fire-Resistive Materials" Article. Immediately after completing spraying operations in each containable area of Project, remove material overspray and fallout from surfaces of other construction and clean exposed surfaces to remove evidence of soiling. Repair or replace work that has not been successfully protected. FIELD QUALITY CONTROL Testing Agency: Owner will engage a qualified independent testing and inspecting agency to perform field tests and inspections and to prepare test reports. I T IB. c.T I I I I J I I I I t I t I I I D. E. F. G. J. 3.2 SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTTVE MATERIALS 07811-6 B. D. t I I t I I I I I l I I I I I I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOTNTIAN LODGE Testing Services: Testing and inspecting of completed applications of sprayed fire-resistive material shall take place in successive stages, in areas of extent and using methods as follows. Do not proceed with application of sprayed fire-resistive material for the next area until test results for previously cornpleted applications of sprayed fire-resistive material show compliance with requirements. Tested values must equal or exceed values indicated and required for approved fire-resi stance desi gn. l. Thickness forFloor, Roof, and Wall Assemblies: Foreach 1000-sq. ft. (93-sq. m) area, or partial area, on each floor, from the average of 4 measurements from a 144-sq. in. (0.093-sq. m) sample area, with sample width of not less than 6 inches (152 mm) per ASTM E 605. 2. Thickness for Structural Frame Members: From a sample of 25 percent of struchnal members per floor, taking 9 measurements at a single cross section for structural frame beams or girders, T measurements ofa single cross section for joists and fusses, and 12 measurements of a single cross section for columns per ASTM E 605. 3. Dorsity for Floors, Roofs, Walls, and Structural Frame Members: At frequency and from sample size indicated for determining thickness of each type of construction and structural framing member, per ASTME605 or AWCI Technical Manual 12-A, Section 5.4.5, "Displacement Method." 4. Bond Stength for Floors, Roofs, Walls, and Structural Framing Members: For each 10,000-sq. ft. (929 sq. m) area, or partial area, on each floor, cohesion and adhesion from one sample of size indicated for determining thickness of each typ€ of construction and structural framing member, per ASTM E 736.5. If testing frnds applications of sprayed fre-resistive material are not in compliance with requirernents, testing and inspecting agency will perform additional random testing to determine extent of noncompliance. Remove and replace applications of sprayed fire-resistive material where test results indicate that it does not comply with specified requirements for cohesion and adhesion, for density, or for both. Apply additional sprayed fire-resistive material per manufachrer's written instructions where test results indicate that thickness does not cornply with specified requirements. Additional testing and inspecting, at Contractor's expense, will be performed to determine compliance of replaced or additional work with specified requirements. END OF SECTION 07811 3t20t2004 I I I SPRAYED FIRE-RES ISTTVE MATERIALS 07811 - 7 A, B. l.l t.2 1.3 I I I I I I I I I I I t I t I I I I l 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 312012004 SECTION 07841 - THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS PART 1-GENERAL RELATED DOCI.JMENTS Drawings and general provisions of the Contact, including General and Supplemantary Conditions and Division I Specification Sections, apply to this Section. SUMMARY This Section includes tlrrough-peneh"ation firestop systems for penetrations through fire- resistance-rated constructions, including both ernpty openings and openings containing penetrating items. Related Sections include the following: l. Dvision 7 Section "Fire-Resistive Joint Systems." 2. Division 15 Sections speciffing duct and piping penetrations. 3. Division 16 Sections speciffing cable and conduit panetrations. PERI'ORMANCE REQUIREMENTS General: For penetrations through fire-resistance-rated constructions, including both ernpty openings and openings containing penetrating iterns, provide through-penetration firestop systems that are produced and installed to resist spread of fire according to requirements indicated, resist passage of smoke and other gases, and maintain original fire-resistance rating of conskuction penehated. l. Fire-resistance-rated walls including fire walls, fire partitions, fire barriers, and smoke barriers. 2. Fire-resistance-rated horizontal assemblies including floors, floor/ceiling assemblies, and ceiling membranes of rooflceiling assernblies. B. Rated Systems: Provide through-penehation firestop systems with the following ratings determined per ASTM E 814 or UL 1479: 1. F-Rated Systems: Provide through-penetration firestop systems with F-ratings indicated, but not less than that equaling or exceeding fire-resistance rating of constuctions penetated. 2. T-Rated Systems: For the following conditions, provide through-penehation firestop systems with T-ratings indicated, as well as F-ratings, where systems protect penehating items exposed to potential contact with adjacent materials in occupiable floor areas: a. Penetations located outside wall cavities. b. Penetrations located outside fire-resistance-rated shaftenclosures. THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 07841 - I 20021 501 .08 VAILMOUNTAIN LODGE 3/2012004 For through-penetration firestop systems exposed to view, traffic, moisture, and physical damage, provide products that, after curing, do not deteriorate when exposed to these conditions both during and after construction. l. For piping penehations for plumbing and wet-pipe sprinkler systems, provide moisture- resistant through-penehation firestop systems. 2. For floor penerations with annular spaces exceeding 4 inches (100 mm) in width and exposed to possible loading and traffic, provide firestop systems capable of supporting floor loads involved, either by installing floor plates or by other means.3. For penebations involving insulated piping, provide through-penetration firestop systems not requiring removal of insulation. For through-panetation firestop systems exposed to view, provide products with flame-spread and smokedeveloped indexes of less than 25 and 450, respectively, as determined per ASTM E 84. SUBMITTALS Product Data: For each type ofproduct indicated. Shop Drawings: For each through-penetration fnestop system, show each type of construction condition penetrated, relationships to adjoining construction, and type of penetrating item. Include firestop desigr desigratibn of qualified testing and inspecting agency that evidences compliance with requirements for each condition indicated. I . Submit documentation, including illushations, from a qualified testing and inspecting agency that is applicable to each through-penetration firestop system configuration for constuction and penehating items. Through-Penetration Firestop System Schedule: Indicate locations of each through-penetration firestop system, along with the following information: I . Types of penetating items. 2. Tlpes of constructions penetrated, including fire-resistance ratings and, where applicable, thicknesses of con struction penetated. 3. Through-penetation firestop systems for each location identified by firestop desigrr designation ofqualified testing and inspecting agency. Qualification Data: For Installer. Product Test Reports: From a qualified testing agency indicating through-penehation firestop system cornplies with requirements, based on comprehensive testing of cunant products. QUALITY ASSURANCE lnstaller Qualifications: A firm experienced in installing through-panehation frestop systems similar in material, desigr, and extent to that indicated for this hoject, whose work has resulted in construction with a record of successful performance. Qualifications include having the necessary experience, staff, and training to install manufacturer's products per specified I I I I I I I I I I I I T I I t t I I c. D. t.4 A, B. c. D. E. 1.5 THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 0784t -2 B. C. D. B. B. 1.6 |.,L.t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOIINTAIN LODGE requirements. Manufacturer's willingness to sell its through-penehation firestop system products to Contactor or to lnstaller engaged by Contractor does not in itself confer qualification on buyer. lnstallation Responsibility: Assign installation of through-penetration firestop systems and fire- resistive joint systems in hoject to a single qualified installer. Source Limitations: Obtain through-penetration firestop systems, for each kind of penehation and construction condition indicated, through one source from a single manufacfurer. Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: Provide through-penetation firestop systems that comply with the following requirements and those specified in Part 1 "Performance Requirements" Article: l. Firestopping tests are performed by a qualified testing and inspecting agency. A qualified testing and inspecting agency is UL or another agency performing testing and follow-up inspection services for firestop systems acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. 2. Ttrough-penetration firestop systems are identical to those tested per testing standard referenced in "Part 1 Performance Requirements" Article. Provide rated systems complying with the following requirements: n. Through-penetration firestop systems correspond to those indicated by reference to tbrough-penetration firestop systern designations listed by the following: 1) UL in its "Fire Resistance Directory." DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Deliver through-penetration firestop system products to Project site in original, unopened containers or packages with intact and legible manufacturers' labels identifring product and manufacturer, date of rnanufacture, lot number, shelf life if applicable, qualified testing and inspecting agency's classification marking applicable to Project, curing time, and mixing instructions for mul tic omponent materials. Store and handle materials for through-penetration firestop systerns to prevent their deterioration or damage due to moisfure, ternperature changes, contaminants, or other causes. PROJECT CONDITIONS Environmental Limitations: Do not install through-penetration firestop systems when ambient or substrate temperatures are outside limits permitted by through-penetration firestop systern manufacturers or when substrates are wet due to rain, frost, condensation, or other causes. Ventilate through-panetration firestop systems per manufacturer's written instructions by natural means or, where this is inadequate, forced-air circulation. 3/20t2004 THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 07841-3 1.8 20021501.08 VAIL MOLTNTAIN LODGE 3t20t2004 c. COORDINATION Coordjnate construction of openings and penetrating items to ensure that through-penetation firestop systems are installed according to specified requirements. Coordinate sizing of sleeves, openings, core-drilled holes, or cut openings to accommodate through-penetration fi restop systems. Noti$ Owner's inspecting agency at least seven days in advance of through-penetration firestop system installations; confirm dates and times on days preceding each series of installations. Do not cover up through-penetation firestop system installations that rvill become concealed behind other constnrction until each installation has been examined by building inspector, if required by authorities having jurisdiction. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2,1 MANI.]FACTIJRERS A. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, through-penehtion firestop systems that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, those systems indicated that are produced by one ofthe following manufachrers: l. A/D Fire Protection Systerns Inc. 2. Grace, W. R. & Co. - Conn. 3. Hilti, Inc. 4. Johns Manyille. 5. Nelson Firestop hoducts. 6. NUCOhc. 7. RectorSeal Corporation (Ihe). 8. Specified Technologies Inc. 9. 3M: Fire hotection hoducts Dvision. 10. Tremco; Sealant/WeatherproofingDivision. I l. USG Corporation. FIRESTOPPING, GENERAL Compatibility: Provide through-penetation firestop systems that are compatible with one another; with the substrates forming openings; and with the items, if any, penetrating through- penetation firestop systems, under conditions of service and application, as demonstrated by through-penehation firestop system manufactr.ner based on testing and field experience. Accessories: hovide components for each tlnough-penetration fir€stop system that are needed to install fill materials and to comply with Part 1 "Performance Requiremants" Article. Use only components specified by through-penetration firestop system manufacfurer and approved by qualified testing and inspecting agency for firestop systems indicated. Accessories include, but me not limited to, the following items: I I I I I I I t I I I t T I t I I I I B. D. 2.2 B. TTIROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 07841 - 4 C. D. F. G. J. 2.3 I I t t I I I I t I I I I I t I I I I 20021 501 .08 l. VAIL MOI.TNTAIN LODGE 3t20t2004 Permanent forming/damming,backing malerials, including the following: a. Slag-/rock-wool-fiberinsulation. b. Sealants used in combination with other forming/damming/backing materials to prevent leakage of fill materials in liquid state. c. Fire-rated form board. d. Fillers for sealants. Temporary forming materials. Substrate primers. Collars. Steel sleeves- 2. 3. 4. 5. FILLMATERIALS General: Provide through-penetration firestop systems containing the types of fill materials indicated in the Through-Penetation Firestop System Schedule at the end of Part 3 by referarcing the types of materials described in this Article. Fill materials are those referred to in directories ofreferenced testing and inspecting agencies as "fill,u "void,n or "cavity" materials. Cast-in-Place Firestop Devices: Factory-assembled devices for use in casGin-place concrete floors and consisting of an outer metallic sleeve lined with an intumescent strip, a radial extended.flange attached to one end of the sleeve for fastening to concrete formwork, and a neoprene gasket. Latex Sealants: Single-component latex formulations that after cure do not re-emulsiff during exposure to moisture. Firestop Devices: Factory-assanbled collars formed from galvanized steel and lined with intumescent material sized to fit specific diameter of panetant. Intumescent Composite Sheets: Rigid panels consisting of aluminum-foil-faced elastomeric sheet bonded to galvanized steel sheet. Intumescent Putties: Nonhardening dielectric, water-resistant putties containing no solvants, inorganic fibers, or silicone compounds. Infumescent Wrap Strips: Single-cornponent intumescent elastomeric sheets with aluminum foil on one side. Mortars: Prepackaged dry mixes consisting of a blend of inorganic binders, hydraulic cement, fillers, and lightweight a9gegate formulated for mixing with water at Project site to form a nonshrinking, homogeneous mortar. PillowsiBags: Reusable heat-expanding pillows/bags consisting of glass-fiber cloth cases filled with a combination of mineral-fiber, water-insoluble expansion agants, and fire-retardant additives. Silicone Foams: Multicomponent, silicone-based liquid elastomers tJrat, when mixed, expand and ctne in place to produce a flexible, nonshrinking foam. THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 07841 - 5 20021501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t20t2004 K. Silicone Sealants: Single-component, silicone-based, neutral+uring elastomeric sealants of grade indicated below: l. Grade: Pourable (selfJeveling) formulation for openings in floors and other horizontal surfaces, and nonsag formulation for openings in vertical and other surfaces requiring a nonslumping, gunnable sealant, unless indicated firestop system limits use to nonsag grade for both opening conditions. 2. Grade for Horizontal Surfaces: Pourable (selfJeveling) formulation for openings in floors and other horizontal surfaces. 3. Grade for Vertical Surfaces: Nonsag formulation for openings in vertical and other surfaces. 2.4 MXING A. For those products requiring mixing before application, comply with tbrough-penefration firestop system manufacturer's writter instructions for accurate proportioning of materials, water (if required), type of mixing equipment, selection of mixer speeds, mixing containers, mixing time, and other items or procedures needed to produce products of uniform quality with optimum performance characteristics for application indicated. PART 3 -EXECUTION 3.I EXAMINATION A. Examine substrates and conditions, with Installer present, for compliance with requircmeirts for opening configurations, penetrating iterns, substrates, and other conditions affecting performance of work. l. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactorv conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION Surface Cleaning: Clean out openings immediately before installing tlrough-penetation firestop systems to comply with firestop system manufachrer's written instructions and with the following requirements: l. Remove from surfaces of opening substrates and from penetrating iterns foreigrr. materials that could interfere with adhesion of tlnough-penetration firestop systems. 2. Clean opaning substrates and penehating items to produce clean, sound surfaces capable of developing optimum bond with tlnough-poretration firestop systems. Remove loose particles remaining from cleaning operation. 3. Remove laitance and form-releas€ agents from concrete. Priming: Prime substrates where recommended in writing by through-penetration firestop system manufacturer using that manufacturer's recommended products and rnethods. Confine primers to areas ofbond; do not allow spillage and migration onto exposed surfaces. 3.2 I I I T I I I I I t I I T I I I I t I B. THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 07841 - 6 C. B. B. J.J 3.4 I t I I I I I I I I I t I I I I t I I 2002150r.08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Masking Tape: Use masking tape to prevent through-penehation firestop systems from contacling adjoining surfaces that will remain exposed on completion of Work and that would otherwise be permanently stained or damaged by such contact or by cleaning methods used to remove smears from firestop system materials. Remove tape as soon as possible without disturbing firestop system's seal with subshates. THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEM INSTALLATION General: Install through-penetation firestop systems to cornply with Part 1 "Performance Requirements" Article and with firestop system manufacturer's written installation instructions and published drawings for products and applications indicated. Install forming/damming/backing materials and other accessories of types required to support fill materials during their ap'plication and in the position needed to produce cross-sectional shapes and depths required to achieve fire ratings indicated. 1. After installing fill materials and allowing them to fully cure, remove combustible forming materials and other accessories not indicated as permanent components of firestop systems. Install fill materials for firestop systems by proven techniques to produce the following results: l. Fill voids and cavities formed by openings, formlng materials, accessories, and penetating items as required to achieve fire-resistance ratings indicated. 2. Apply materials so they contact and adhere to substrates formed by openings and penefiating items. 3. For fill materials that will remain exposed after completing Worlq finish to produce smootlt, uniform surfaces that are flush with adjoining finishes. CLEANING AND PROTECTING Clean off excess fill materials adjacent to openings as Work progresses by methods and with cleaning materials that are approved in writing by ttrough-penetration firestop system manufacturers and that do not damage materials in which openings occur. hovide final protection and maintain conditions during and after installation that ensure that through-penetation firestop systems are without damage or deterioration at time of Substantial Completion. If, despite such protection, damage or deterioration occurs, cut out and remove damaged or deteriorated through-penefation firestop systems immediately and install new materials to produce systems complying with specified requirements. END OF SECTION 0784I 3t20t2004 THROUGH-PENETRATION FIRESTOP SYSTEMS 0784t -7 I 20021501.08 vArL M.T.JNTATN L.DGE 3/20t2004T I SECTION 07842 - FIRE-RESISTTVE JOINT SYSTEMS r PARTI -GENERAL I 1.1 RELATEDDOCUMENTS - A. Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplemartary t Conditions and Dvision I Specification Sections, apply to this Section. ll r.2 SUMMARYtA. This Section includes fire-resistive joint systems for the following: I l. Floor-to-floorjoints. 2. Floor-to-walljoints. I 3. Head-of-wall joints. I 4. Wall-to-wall joints. 5. Perimeter fre-resistive joint systems consisting of floor-to-wall joints between perimeter I B. ."".::::::;ff";#assembriesandexteriorcurtainwa's' l. Division 7 Section "Building Insulation" for floor-to-wall joints indicated as perimeter I fire-containment systems between perimeter edge of fire-resistance-rated floor assembliesI and back of non-fire-resistance-rated exterior curtain walls.2. Division 7 Section "Through-Penetration Firestop Systerns" for systerns installed in I openings in walls and floors with and without penetrating iterns. || 3. Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants" for non-fre-resistive joint sealants. I r.3 PERFORMANCEREQUTREMENTS r A. General: Provide fire-resistive joint systems that are produced and installed to resist spread of I fire according to requirements indicated, resist passage of smoke and other gases, and maintainr original fire-resistance rating of assembly in which fire-resistive joint systems are installed. I B. Joint Systems in and between Fire-Resistance-Rated Consfiuctions: Provide systems with I assembly ratings equaling or exceeding the fire-resistance ratings of construction that they join, and with movement capabilities and L-ratings indicated as determined by UL 2079. f C. For fire-resistive systems exposed to view, provide products wit} flame-spread and smoke- developed indexes ofless than 25 and 450, respectively, as determined per ASTM E 84. r 1.4 SUBMITTALS I A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated.I t I FIRE-RESISTIVE JOINT SYSTEMS 07842 - | 2002 r 501.08 VAIL MOIINTAIN LODGE 3t20/2004 Shop Drawings: For each fire-resistive joint system, show each kind of construction condition in which joints are installed; also show relationships to adjoining construction. Include fire- resistive joint system design designation of testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction that demonstrates compliance with requirements for each condition indicated. l. Submit documentation, including illustrations, from a qualified testing and inspecting agency that is applicable to each fire-resistive joint system configuration for construction and penetrating items. C. Product Certificates: For each type of fire-resistive joint system, signed by product manufactwer. Qualification Data: For lnstaller. Evaluation Reports: Evidence of fire-resistive joint systerns' compliance with ICBO ES AC30, from the ICBO Evaluation Service. QUALITY ASSI.]RANCE Installer Qualifications: A firm that has been approved by FMG according to FMG499I, "Approval of Firestop Contractors. n Installation Responsibility: Assign installation of thnough-penetration firestop systems and fire- resistive joint systems in Project to a single qualified installer. Source Limitations: Obtain fire-resistive joint systems, for each kind of joint and construction condition indicated, tbrough one source from a single manufactuer. Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: Provide fue-resistive joint systons that comply with the following requirements and those specified in Part I "Performance Requiremants" Article: 1. Fire-resistance tests are performed by a qualified testing and inspecting agency. A qualified testing and inspecting agency is IJL or another agency performing testing and follow-up inspection services for fire-resistive joint systerns acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. 2. Fire-resistive joint systems are identical to those tested per methods indicated in Part I "Performance Requiremernts" Article and comply with the following: a. Fire-resistive joint system products bear classification marking of qualified testing and inspecting agency. b. Fire-resistive joint systems correspond to those indicated by referencing system desigrations of the qualified testing and inspecting agency. DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Deliver fire-resistive joint system products to hoject site in original, unopened containers or packages with qualified testing and inspecting agency's classification marking applicable to Project and with intact and legible manufacturers' labels identifoing product and manufacturer, B. T I I I I I I I t I I I I I I t I I I D. E. 1.5 B. D. 't.6 FIRE-RESISTIVE JOINT SYSTEMS 07842 -2 I T T I t I 2002 1501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3I2OI2OO4 number, shelf life, curing time, and mixing instructions fordate of manufacture. lot multicomponent materials. B. Store and handle materials for fire-resistive joint systems to prevent their deterioration or damage due to moisture, temperature changes, contaminants, or other causes. 1.7 PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Environmental Limitations: Do not install fire-resistive joint systems when ambient or substrate temperatures are outside limits permitted by fire-resistive joint system manufacturers or when substrates are wet due to rain, frost, condensation, or other causes. B. Ventilate fire-resistive joint systems per manufacturer's written instructions by natural means or, if this is inadequate, forced-air circulation. I.8 COORDINATION A. Coordinate construction of joints to ensure that fire-resistive joint systems are installed according to specifi ed requirements. B. Coordinate sizing ofjoints to accommodate fire-resistive joint systems. PART 2.PRODUCTS 2.1 MANTJFACTURERS A. Available Products: Subject to cornpliance with requirements, fire-resistive joint systerns that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, those systems indicated in the Fire-Resistive loint Svstem Schedule at the end ofPart 3. 2.2 FIRE-RESISTTVEJOINTSYSTEMS A. Compatibility: Provide fire-resistive joint systems that are compatible udth joint substrates, rmder conditions of service and application, as dernonstrated by fire-resistive joint system manufacturer based on testing and field experience. B. Accessories: Provide components of fire-resistive joint systems, including primers and forming materials, that are needed to install fill materials and to comply with Part I "Performance Requirements" Article. Use only components specified by fire-resistive joint system manufactuer and approved by the qualified testing and inspecting agency for systems indicated. T I I I t I t I I I t I I FIRE-RESISTIVE JOINT SYSTEMS 07842 - 3 2002 I 501 .08 PART 3 - EXECUTION VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t20/2004 3.I EXAMINATION A. Examine substrates and conditions, with krstaller present, for compliance with requirements for joint configurations, subshates, and other conditions affecting performance of work. 1. Proceed with installation onlv after unsatisfactorv conditions have been corrected. PREPARATION Surface Cleaning: Clean joints immediately before installing fire-resistive joint systems to comply with fire-resistive joint systern manufacturer's written instructions and the following requirements: l. Remove from surfaces of joint subshates foreign materials that could interfere with adhesion of fill materials. 2. Clean joint substrates to produce clean, sound surfaces capable of developing optimum bond with fill materials. Rernove loose particles remaining from cleaning operation.3. Remove laitance and form-release agents from concrete. Priming: Prime substrates where recomrnended in writing by fire-resistive joint system manufacfurcr using that manufacturer's recommended products and methods. Confine p'rimers to areas of bond; do not allow spillage and migration onto exposed surfaces. Masking Tape: Use mashng tape to prevent fill materials of fire-resistive joint system from contacting adjoining surfaces that will remain exposed on completion of Work and that would otherwise be permanently stained or damaged by such contact or by cleaning methods used to remove smears from fire-resistive joint systern materials. Remove tape as soon as possible without disturbing fue-resistive joint system's seal with substrates or damaging adjoining surfaces. INSTALLATION General: Install fire-resistive joint systems to comply with Part I "Performance Requirernarts" Article and fire-resistive joint system manufacturer's written installation instuctions for products and applications indicated. Install forming/packing/backing materials and other accessories oftypes required to sup'port lill materials during their application and in position needed to produce cross-sectional shapes and depths required to achieve fire ratings indicated. Install fill materials for fire-resistive joint systems by proven techniques to produce the following results: l. Fill voids and cavities formed by openings and forming/packing/backing materials as required to achieve fire-resistance ratings indicated. 2. Apply fill materials so they contact and adhere to substrates formed by joints. t t I 3.2 t I I I t I I I I I I t I I t I B. J.J c. FIRE.RESISTTVE JOINT SYSTEMS 07842 - 4 B. 3.4 T I t I t I I I I I T I I I t T T I I 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 3. For fill materials that will remain exposed after completing work, finish to produce smootb, uniform surfaces that are flush with adjoining finishes. CLEANING AND PROTECTING Clean off excess fill materials adjacent to joints as Work progresses by methods and wirh cleaning materials that are approved in writing by fire-resistive joint syslem manufacturers and that do not damage materials in which openings occur. hovide final protection and maintain conditions during and after installation that ensure fire- resistive joint systems are without damage or deterioration at time of Substantial Cornpletion. If damage or deterioration occurs despite such protection, cut oul and remove damaged or deteriorated fre-resistive joint systems immediately and install new materials to produce fire- resistive joint systems complying with specified requirements. END OF SECTION 07842 FIRE-RESISTIVE JOINT SYSTEMS 07842 - 5 I Vail Morrrrt;rin Lorlge I sECrroNoTe2o-JorNrsEArANTs I PARr r -.ENERAL n022Dn0 I r.r RELATEDDocttMEMsI A. Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementary Conditions and I Division I Specification Sections, apply to this Section. I 1.2 STIMMA.R,Y ! A. This Section includes sealants for the following applications, including those specified by reference to this Section: t B. This Section includes sealants for the following applications: l. Exterior joints in the following vertical surfaces and nontraffic horizontal surfaces: I a. Control and erpansion joints in cast-in-place concrete above interior spaces only. b. Joints in exterior insulation and finish systems. I c. Joinls between different materials listed in a. & b. above. I d. Perimetcr joints between materials listed above and frames of doors and windows. e. Other joints as indicated. I 2. Erlerior joinls in thc following horizontal trafhc surfaces:I a. Control, expansion, and isolationjoinls in casl-in-place concrete slabs. I b. Tile control and cxpansion joinrs. t c. Joints betwcen differenl matcrials listed in a. & b. above.d. Other joints as indicated. I 3. Interior joints inthe following vertical surfaces and horizonral nontraffic surfaces:t a. Perimeter joints of exterior openings where indicated. I b. Tile control ard erpansion joints. t c. Joints betwecn plurnbing fixtures and adoining walls, floors, and counters. d. Other joints as indicated. I 4. Interior joints in tbe foltowing horizonlal lraffic surfaces:r a. Control and expansion joints in stone flooring. I b. Control and exparsion joints in tile flooring. I c. Other joints as indicated. I C. Related Sections include the following: I l. Division 2 Section "Pavement Joint Sealants" for sealing joinls in pavements, walkuays, and curDrng, I 2. Division 4 Section "Unit Masonry" for masoruy control and expansion joint filhrs and gaskets. I 3. Division 8 Section "Glazing" for glazing sealanrs. I I JOI]VT SEALANTS 07920 - | Vnil Monntain Lodge 0022n00 t.3 4. Division 9 Section "Gypsum Board Assemblies" for sealing perimeter joints of gypsum bard partitions to reduce sound transmission. PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS Provide elastomeric joint sealanls that establish and maintain walertight and airtight continuous joint seals wilhout staining or deteriorating joint substrates. Provide joint sealants for interior applications that establish and maintain airtight and water-resistant conlinuous joi seals without staining or deteriorating joint substrates. SIJBMITTALS Product Data: For each joint-scalant product indicated. Samples for Initial Selection: Manufaclurer's color cha s consisting of strips of cured sealants showing the full range of colors available for each producl exposed to view. Product Ce ificales: Signcd by manufacturers ofjoint sealants certifying that producb furnished comply with requirements and are suitable for the use indicatcd. Qualification Data: For firms and pcrsons specified in "Quality Assurance" Articlc to demonstrale their capabilitics and experience. Include lists of completed projects with project names and addresses, names and addresses of architects and owners, and other informalion specified. Compatibility and Adhesion Tcst Reports: Iiom sealanl manufacturer indicating the following: l. Materials forming joint substrates and joint-scalant backings have becn tested for compatibility ard adhesion with joint sealants.2. Inerprctation of tcst results and written recommendatjons for primers and subslrate preparalion necded for adhesion. Product Test Reports: From a qualified tasting agency indicating sealants comply with requirements, based on comprehensive lesting of current product formulations. Wananties: Special warranties specified in this Section. QUALITY ASSIJRANCE Installer Qualifications: An experienced installcr wbo has specialized in installing joint sealants similar in material, design, and extenl to those indicatcd for this Project and whose work has resultcd in joint- sealant installations with a record of successful in-service performance. Source Limitations: Obtain each type ofjoint sealant through one source from a single manufacturer. Mockups: Before installing joint sealanls, apply elastomeric sealanls as follows to verify selections made under sample Submittals and to demonstrale aesthetic effects and qualities of materials and execution: l. Joinls in mockups of assemblies specified in other Sections that are indicated to receive elastomeric joint sealanls, which are specified by reference to this Section. I I I I I t I I t I t I I I I I B. 1.4 I I I A. B. : D. F- G. 1.5 -A. B. c. JOINTSEALANTS vI92$-2 B. B. B. c. 1.6 t.? 1.8 I I I I I t t I t I t I T I I t t I t Vail Mountnin Lorlge 0022000 C. DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDL]NG Deliver materials to Project site in original unopened containers or bundles with labels indicating manufacturer, product name and designation, color, expiration date, pot life, curing lime, and mixing instructions for multicomponent materials. Store and handle materials in compliarrce wilh manufacturer's written instructions to prevent their deterioration or damage due to moisture, high or low temperatures, conlaminants, or olher causes. PROJECT CONDITIONS Environmental Limitations: Do not proceed with installalion of joint sealants under the following conditions: l. When ambient and substrate temperature conditions are outside limits permitted by joint sealant manufaclurer. 2. When ambient and substrate lemperature conditions are outside limits permitted by joint sealant manufaclurer or are below 40 deg F(4.4 deg C). 3. When joint substrates are wet. Joinl-Width Conditions: Do not proceed with installation of joinl sealants where joint widths are less than those allowed by joint sealant manufaclurer for applications indicated. JoinrSubslrate Conditions: Do not proceed with installation ofjoint sealants until contaminants capable of interfering with adbesion are removed from joint subslrales. WARRANTY General Warranty: Special warrantics specified in this Articlc shall not deprive Owner of other rights Owner may havc rmdcr otber provisions of the Contract Documents and shall be in addition to, and run concurenl with, other waranties made by Contractor under requiremenls of the Conlracl Docum€nts. Special Installer's Warranty: Writlen warranty, signed by Installer agreeing to repair or replace elastomeric joint sealants that do not comply with performancc and o$er requirenrcnts specified in this Section within specified warranty period. L Warranty Period: Two ycars from date of Substantial Completion. Special Manufacturerb Warranty: Written wruranty, signed by elastomeric sealant manufaclurer agreeing lo furnish elaslomeric joint sealants to repair or replace those that do nol comply with performance and other requiremenls specified in this Section within specified wananty period. l. Warranty Period: 20 years from date of Substantial Conpletion. Special warranlies specified in this Article exclude delerioration or failure of elastomeric joint sealants from the following: l. Movemenl of the structure resulting in stresses on the sealant exceeding sealant manufacturerb written specifications for sealant elongation and compression caused by structural setllemenl or errors attdbulable to design or construction. Disintegration ofjoint substrates from natural causes exceeding design specifications. Mechanical damage caused by individuals, tools, or olher outside agents. Changes in sealanl appearance caused by accumulation ofdirt or other atmospheric contaminants. 2. 3. 4. JOINTSEALANTS 07929 - 3 I I I I I I I t t I I I I B. B. 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 Vai I Mountain Lodge PART 2 - PRODUCTS JOINT SEALAFI1TS 0022000 PRODUCTS AND MANIJFACTI'RERS Available Products: Subject to compliance with requiremenls, products that may be incorporated into thc Work include, but are not limited to, the products specified in the sealant schedules at the end of Part 3- MATERIALS. GENERAL Compalibility: Provide joint sealanls, backings, and other related materials thal are compatible with one another and with joint substrales under conditions of service and application, as demonslraled by sealant manufacturer based on testing and ficld experience. Colors of Exposed Joint Sealanls: As selected by Architect from manufacturer3 full range for this characterislic. ELASTOMERIC JOINT SEALANTS Elastomeric Sealant Standard: Comply with ASTM C 920 and other requirenrents indicated for cach liquid-applied chemically curing sealant in the Elastomeric Joint-Scalant Schedule al the end of Part 3, including those referencing ASTM C 920 classifications for type, grade, class, and uses. Additional Movement Capability: Where additional movement capability is specified in the Elaslomeric Joint-Sealant Schedule, provide products with the capability, when tcstcd for adhesion and cohcsion under maximum cyclic movement per ASTM C 719, to withsrand thc specified percentage change in thc joint width existing at thc time of installation and remain in compliance with other requircnrnts of ASTM C 920 for uses indicated. Suitability for Contact with Food: Where elastomeric sealants are indicated for joints that will come in repeated contact with food, provide producls that comply wi0r 2l CFR 177.26W. LATEXJOINT SEALANTS Latex Sealant Slandard: Comply with ASTM C 834 for each product of this description indicated in the Latex Joint-Sealant Schedule at the end of Part 3. ACOUSTICAL JOINT SEALANTS Acoustical Sealant for Exposed and Concealed Joints: For each product of this description indicated in th€ Acoustical Joint-Sealant Schedule'at the end of Part 3, provide manufacturerb standard nonsag, paintable, nonstaining latex sealant complying with ASTM C 834 and the following: l Product effectively reduces airborne sound transmission through perimeler joints and openings in building construction as dernonstrated by tqsting representative assemblies according lo ASTM E9O. JOINT-SEALANT BACKING 2.5 t I I I t I 2.6 07920.4 B. c. B. 2.7 3.1 3.2 I I I I I t I I l I r I I I I t I, t Vnil )lnunlnin Lorlge 0022000 General: Provide sealanl backings of material and type that are nonslaining; are compatible with joint substrates, sealants, pnmers, and olherjoint fillers; and,ue approved for applications indicated by sealant manufacturer based on field experience and laboratory testing. Cylindrical Sealant Backings: ASTM C I 330, of type indicated below and of size and density to control sealant depth and otherwise contribute to producing optimum sealant petformance: l. Type C: Closed-cell material with a surface skin. 2. Type O: Open-cell male al on vertical sudaces only 3. Type: Any material indicated above. Bond-Breaker Tape: Polyethylene tape or olher plastic tape recommended by sealant manufaclurer for preventing sealant from adhering to rigid, inflexible joint-filler materials or joint surfaces at back ofjoinl wbere sucb adhesion would result in scalant failure. Provide self-adhesive tape where applicable. MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS Primer: Malerial recommended by joint sealant manufacturer where required for adhesion of sealanl to joint substrates indicated, as determined from preconstruction joinl-sealant-substrate tests and field lests. Cleaners for Nonporous Surfaces: Chemical cleaners acceptable to manufacturets of sealants and scalant backing materials, free of oily residues or other substances capable of staining or harrning joint substrates and adjacent nonporous surfaces in any way, and formulated to promote optimum adbesion of sealants with jgint substrates. Masking Taft: Nonstaining, nonabsorbent material compatible with joint sealants and surfaces adjaccnt lo irints. PART 3 - EXECUTION EXAMINATION Er.amine joints indicated to receive joint sealants, with Installer present, fot compliance with requirernents for joint configuration, installation tolcrances, and olher conditions affecting joint-sealant performance. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfaclory conditions have been corected. PREPARATION Surface Cleaning of Joints: Clean out joints immediately before installingjoint sealants to cornply widt joint sealant manufacturer's written instructions and lhe following requirements: l. Remove all foreign material from joint substrates that could interfere with adbesion of joint sealant, including dust, paints (except for permanenl! prolective coatings tested and approved for sealant adhesion and compatibility by sealant manufacturer), old joint sealants, oil, grease, waterproofing, water repellents, waler, surface dirt, and frost. 2. Clean porous joint substrate surfaces by brushing, grinding, blast cleaning, mechanical abrading, or a combination of these methods to produce a clean, sound substrale capable of developing optimum bond with joinl sealants. Remove loose particles rernaining from above cleaning t JOINT SEALANTS fr920 - 5 I t I I I ! I I I I t I ) I t, I tl I B. B. D. F. 3.3 Vail Morrnlain Lorlge 0022000 operations by vacuuming or blowing outjoints with oil-free compressed air. Porous joint surfaces include lhe following: a. Concrete. b. Masonry. c- Unglazed surfaces of ceramic tile. 3. Remove laitance and form-release agents from concrete, 4. Clean nonporous surfaces with chemical cleaners or olher means that do not slain, harm substrates, or leave residues capable of interfering with adhesion ofjoint sealants. a. Metal. b. Glass. c. Porcelain enamel. d. Glazcd surfaces of ceramic tile. Joint Priming: Prime joint substrates where recommended in writing by joint sealant manufacturer, based on preconstruclion joint-s€alanl-subslrate tesB or prior experience. Apply primer to comply with joint sealant manufacturerb wilten inslructions. Confine primers to areas ofjoinl-sealant bond; do not allow spillage or migration onto adjoining surfaces. Masking Tapc: Usc masking tapc where rcquired lo prcvent contact of sealant with adjoining surfaccs that otherwise would be pernanently stained or damaged by srrch contact or by clcaning methods required to remove sealant sm€ars Rcmovc tape immediatcly afler tooling without disturbing joint scal. INSTAII-ATION OF JOINT SEALANTS General: Comply with joint sealanl manufacturert written installation instructions for products and applications indicatcd, unless morc stringenl requiremcnts apply. Scalant Installation Slandard: Comply with recomrnendatiors of ASTM C 1193 for use of joint s€alants as applicablc to natcrials, applications, ard conditions indicated. Acoustical Sealant Application Standard: Comply with recommendations of ASTM C 919 for use of joint sealants in acoustical applications as applicable to materialB, applications, and conditions indicated. Install sealant backings of type indicated to support scalants during application and at position required to produce cross-seclional shapes and depths of installed sealants relative to joint widths that allow optimum sealant movement capability. l. Do not leave gaps between ends of sealant backings. 2. Do not stretch, twist, punclure, ot lear sealant backings. 3. Remove absorbent sealant backings that have become wet before sealant application and replace them with dry materials. Install bond-brcaker tapc behind sealants where sealant backings are not used between sealants and back ofjoints. Inslall sealants by proven techniques to comply with rhe following and at the same time backings are installed: l. Place sealants so they directly contact and fully wel joint substrates. 2. Completely fill recesses provided foreachjoint configuration. I JOINTSEALANTS 0792n - 6 I YailMorrnlnin Lorlge 00220t10 ] I 3. Produce uniform, cross-sectional shapes and depths relative to joint widths that allow oplimum I sealant rnovement capability. .. G. Tooling of Nonsag Sealants: Immediately after sealanl application and before skinning or curing begins, I tool sealanls according to requirements specified below to form smoolh, uniform beads of configurationrl indicated; to eliminate air pockets; and to ensure contacl and adhesion of sealant with sides ofjoint. l, l. Remove excess sealanrs from surfaces adjacent tojoinr. |l 2. Use tooling agents lhat are approved in writing by sealant manufacturer and that do nol discolor sealadts or adjacent surfaces. I 3. Provide concavejoint configuration per Figure 5A in ASTM C I193, unless olherwise indicated- l[ 4. Provide flush joint configuralion, per Figure 58 in ASTM C I 193, where indicated.f 5. Provide recessed joint configuration, per Figure 5C in ASTM C 1193, of recess deplh and at 1. locations indicated. lr.\lJ a. Use masking tape to protect adjacent surfaces ofrecessed tooled joints. I 3.4 CLEANINGF 2t A. Clean off excess sealants or sealant smears adjacent to joinls as the Work progresses by methds and with I cleaning malerials approved in writing by manufactwers ofjoint scalants and of products in which joints I occur I f 1.5 PROTECTION -. A. Prctcct joint sealants during and after curing pcriod from contacl with conhminating substances and from I damagc resulting from construction opcrations or other caus€s so scalants are without deterioration or ll damagc at time of Substantial Complction. If, despite such proteclion, damage or delerioration occurs, cut out and remove damaged or detcrioraled joinl s€alants immediately so installalions with repaired li areas are indistinguishable from the original work. v 3,6 ELASTOMERICJOINT.SEALANTSCHEDIJLE A. Mcdium-Modulus Neutral-Curing Silicone Sealant: Where joint sealants of this type are indicated, provide products complying with the following: 1. Producs: Available products include $e following: a. 791; Dow Corning. b- 795; Dow Corning. c. HiFlex 393; NUCO Industries, Inc. d. PSI-631; Polymeric Systems, Inc.e. SM5731 Poly-Glaze; Schnee-Morehead, Inc. f. SM5733 Poly-Glaze; Schnee-Motehead, Inc.g. Spectrem 2; Tremco. h. Tremsil 6010; Tremco. 2. Type and Grade: S (single component) and NS (nonsag). 3. Class: 25. 4. Use Related to Exposure: NT (nontraffic) 5. Uses Related to Joint Substrates: M, G, A, and, as applicable lo joint substrales indicated, O. I 0 f' I ! I I t JOINTSEALANTS 07920-7 Voil IVlou nlnin Lnrlge 0n22nn0 Stain-Test-Response Characterisrics: Nonstaining to porous substrales per ASTM C 1248. Applications: Glazing, metal (without high performance coatings) and other non-porous surfaces including galvanized sleel and previously painted or varnished wood. Medium-Modulus Neutral-Curing Silicone Sealant: Where joint sealants of this type are indicated, provide products complying with the following: l. Products: Available products include the following: a. 756 H.P.; Dow Corning. b. Silglaze II; GE Silicones. c. 895; Pecora Corporalion. Type and Grade: S (single component) and NS (nonsag). Class:25. Additional Movemenl Capability: 50 pcrcenl movement in extension and 50 percent nnvement in compression for a total of 100 percent rnovemenl. Use[s] Related to Exposure: NT (nontraffic). Uses Related to Joinl Substrates: G, A, and, as applicable to joint substrates indicated, O. Applications: Color anodic aluminum and aluminum coatcd with a high-performance coating where color olher than black is selected by Arcbitcct. High-Modulus Neutral-Curing Siliconc Scalant: Where joint sealants of this type are indicated, provide products complying with the following: l. Products: Availablc products includc thc following: a. 799; Dow Corning. b. NuFlex 319, NUCO Indusuies, Inc. c. SM5734 Controllcd Flow Poly-Glazc; Schnce-Morehcad, Inc. 2. Type and Gradc: S (single componenr) and NS (nonsag). 3. Class: 25. 4. Use Related to Exposurc: NT (nontraffic). 5. Uses Related to Joint Substrates: G, A, and, as applicable ro joint substrates indicated, O. 6. Applications: Glazing and where glazing abuts color anodic aluminum and aluminum coated with a high-performance coating. High-Modulus Neutral-Curing Silicone Sealant: Wherc joint sealants of this type are indicared, provide products complying with the following: 1. Products: Available products includc the following: ^. 995; Dow Corning. b. Ultraglaze 4(XD; GE Silicorrcs. c. Ultraglaze 400OAC; GE Silicones. Type and Grade: S (singlc component) and NS (nonsag). Class: 25. Additional Movement Capability: 50 percenl rnovemenl in extcnsion and 50 pcrcent movemcnt in compression for a lotal of 100 percent movement. Use Related to Exposure: NT (nontraffic). Uses Related to Joint Substrates: G, A, and, as applicable to joint substrates indicated, O. B. I I I I I 0 I l' I I I I 0 I I I l I I 6. '1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. D. JOINTSEALANTS 07920 -8 F. 3.7 t I I I t t tl l, Il I t I 0 I t I I Vail iVIountain Lotlge 0022000 '1 . Applications: Color anodic aluminum and aluminum coated with a high-performance coating where black color is selected by Architect. Mildew-Resistant Silicone Sealanl: Where joint sealants of this type are indicated, provide products formulated with fungicide that are intended for sealing interior ceramic lile joints and other nonporous substrates that are subject to in-service exposures of high humidity and temperature extremes, and that comply with the following: l. Products: Available products include the following: a. 786 Mildew Resistant; Dow Corning. b. Sanitary 1700; GE Silicones. c. NuFlex 302; NUCO Induslries, Inc. d. 898 Silicone Sanitary Sealant; Pecora Corporalion. e. PSI-61 I ; Polymeric Systems, Inc. f. Tremsil 600 Whitel Trernco. 2. Type and Grade: S (single component) and NS (nonsag). 3. Class: 25. 4. Use Related to Exposure: NT (nontraffic). 5. Uses Related to Joint Substrates: G, A, and, as applicable to joint subsirates indicated, O. 6- Applications: Between bilet room and orher plumbing fixtures and walls, counterlops and other non-porous surfaces including ceramic tile, porcelain, stainless steel, plastic laminate, solid surfacing materials and the like. Multicomponent Norsag Urethane Sealant: Where joint sealants of this type are indicated, provide products complying with the following: l. Products: Available products include the following: a. Vulkem922;Mame*olnternalional. b. Dynatrol II; Pecora Corporation. c. Fleriprene 2000; Polymeric Syslems, Inc.d. Sikaflex - 2c NS; Sika Corporation. e. DYmeric 5 I l; Trernco. Type and &ade: M (multicomponent) and NS (nonsag). Class:25. Additional Movement capability: 50 percent movement in extension and 50 percent in compression for a total of l@ percent movemenl. Use Related to Exposure: NT (nontraffic). uses Related to Joint Substrates: M, A, and, as applicable to joint substrates indicated, o. Applications: Brick, stone, concrete, concrele masonry units and exterior insulation and finish systems' Also where joints of these materials abut color anodic aluminum and aluminum coated with a high-performance coating, galvanized and other rnetats. Verify manufacturer requiremenls for primer for use with anodic aluminum surfaces. LATEX JOINT.SEALANT SCIIEDULE I alex Sealant: Where joint sealants of this type are indicated, provide products complying with the following: 2. 3. 4. f. 6. 7- JOINT SEALANTS 07920 -9 Vnil .Vlountain Lor'lge 0022000 l Producls: Available products include the following: a. Chem-Calk 600: Bostik lnc. b. NuFlex 330; NUCO Industries, Inc. c. LC 160 All Purpose Acrylic Caulk Ohio Sealants, Inc. d. AC-20; Pecora Corporation. e. PSI-701; Polymeric Systems, lnc. f. Sonolac; Sonneborn Building Ptoducts Div., ChemRex, Inc. E. Tremflex 834; Tremco. 2. Applications: Inlerior caulk joints hollow metal frames, walls and similar surfaces to bc painted where little or no joint movcment is anticipated. ACOUSTICAI JOINT-SEALANT SC}IEDULE Acoustical Sealant for Exposed and Conccaled Joints: Where joinl sealants of this type are indicated, provide products complying with rhe following: l. Products: Available products include the following: a. AC-20 FTR Acoustical and Insulation Scalant; Pccora Corporation. b. SHEETROCK Acoustical Scalant; USG Corp., United States Gypsum Co. 2. Applications: At locations other than gypsum board type assemblies. (See Division 9 Sections for acoustical joint-sgalanl at gypsum board assemblies.) END OF SEeflON 07920 I ,t I I I I I I t t 0 I 3.8 I I t t I I t JOINT SEALANTS 0?920 - r0 B. B. B. l.l t.2 1.3 t.4 I t t I I T I I I t l I t I I l t 3 I 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE SECTION O8I I I - STANDARD STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES PART I - GENERAL 3t20/2004 STJMMARY This Section includes standard hollow-metal steel doors and frames. SIJBMITTALS hoduct Data: Include construction details, material descriptions, core de scriptions, label compliance, fire-resistance rating, and finishes for each type of steel door and frame specified. Shop Drawings: Provide a schedule of standard steel doors and frames using same reference numbers for details and openings as those on Drawings. Product test reports. QUALITY ASSURANCE Fire-Rated Door Frame Assemblies: Assernblies complying v/ith NFPA 80 that are listed and labeled by a testing and inspecting agancy acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, for fire- protection ratings indicated. l. Test Pressure: Test at atrnospheric (neuhal) pressure according to NFPA 252 or UL l0B. 2. Test hessure: Test according to NFPA 252 or UL 10C After 5 minutes into the test, the neutral pressure level in furnace shall be established at 40 inches (1000 mm) or less above the sill. 3. Temperature-Rise Rating: At exit enclosures, provide doors that have a temperature-rise rating of 450 deg F (250 deg C) maximum in 30 minutes of fire exposure. Smoke-Control Door Assemblies: Comply with NFPA 105 or UL 1784. DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING Deliver doors and frames palletized, wrapped, or crated to provide protection during ransit and Project-site storage. Do not use nonvented plastic. Deliver welded frames with two removable spreader bars across bottom of frames, tack welded to jambs and mullions. STANDARD STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 08lll - I 2002 I 501 .08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS I I t 0 I l A. 2.1 VAIL MOIINTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 MANUFACTURERS Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: l. Amweld Building Products, LLC. 2. Benchmark Doors; a division of General Products Co., Inc. 3. CecoDoorProducts; anASSA ABLOYGroupCompany. 4. CLJRRIES Cornpany; an ASSA ABLOY Group Company. 5. Deansteel Manufacturing, Inc. 6. Fleming Door Products Ltd.; an ASSA ABLOY Group Company. 7. Kewanee Corporation (The). 8. Mesker Door Inc. 9. Pioneer lndustries, Inc. 10. Republic Builders Products Company. I I . Steelcraft; an lngersoll-Rand Company. MATERI.ALS Cold-Rolled Steel Sheet: ASTM A 1008/A 1008M, Commercial Steel (CS), TypeB; suitable for exposed applications. Hot-Rolled Steel Sheet: ASTMA l0ll/A l0l1M, Commercial Steel (CS), TypeB; free of scale, pitting, or surface defects; pickled and oiled. Supports and Anchors: After fabricating, galvanize units to be built into exterior walls according to ASTM A 153/A 153M, Class B. lnserts, Bolts, and Fasteners: Provide items to be built into exterior walls, hotdip galvanized according to ASTM A 153/.{ 153M. Powder-Actuated Fasteners in Concrete: Fastener systern of tne suitable for application indicated, fabricated from corrosion-resistant materials, with clips or other accessory devices for attaching standard steel door frames of type indicated. Grout: Comply with ASTM C 476, with a slump of 4 inches (102 mm) for standard steel door frames built into concrete or masonry, as measured according to ASTM C l43lc 143M. Mineral-Fiber Insulation: ASTM C 665, Type I (blankets without membrane facing); consisting of fibers manufacttned from slag or rock wool with 6- to l2-lb/cu. ft. (96- to 192-klcu. m) density; with maximum flame-spread and smokedeveloped indexes of 25 and 50 respectively; passing ASTM E 136 for combustion characteristics. Bituminous Coating: Cold-applied asphalt mastic, SSPC-Paint 12, compounded for lS-mil (0.4-mm) dry film thickness per coat. Provide inert-t]?e noncorrosive compormd free of asbestos fibers, sulfur components, and other deleterious impurities. 2.2 I I I I fl I I I B. C. D. F. G. H.I I ISTANDARD STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 08111-2 r t I I I 1 U I I t i l I t I c I I I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOTNTAIN LODGE 3/20t2004 2.3 STANDARD STEEL DOORS A. General: Provide doors of design indicated, not less than thickness indicated; fabricated with smooth surfaces, without visible joints or seams on exposed faces. Comply with ANSI 4250.8. 1. Core Constuction: Manufacturer's standard kaft-paper honeycomb, polystyrene, polyurethane, mineral-board, or vertical steel-stiffener core that produces doors cornpllng with ANSI 4250.8.2. Vertical Edges for Single-Acting Doors: Beveled edge unless square edge is indicated. a. Beveled Edge: 1/8 inch in 2 inches (3 mm in 50 mm). 3. Top and Bottom Edges: Closed with flush or inverted 0.042-inch- (1.0-rnm-) thick end closures or channels of same material as face sheets. B. Interior Doors: Face sheets fabricated from cold-rolled steel sheet. unless othenvise indicated to comply with exterior door requirements. Provide doors complying with requirements indicated below by referencing ANSIA250.8 for level and model and ANSI A2504 for physical- endurance level: l. Level I and Physical Performance Level C, (Standard Duty), Model 2 (Seamless). 2.4 STANDARD STEEL FRAMES A. General: Comply with ANSI 4250.8 and with details indicated for type and profrle. B. Exterior Frames: Fabricated from metallic-coated steel sheet. l. Fabricate frames with mitered or coped and welded face corners and seamless face joints. 2. Frames for Level I Steel Doors: 0.042-inch- (1.0-mm-) thick steel sheet unless otherwise indicated. C. Interior Frames: Fabricated from cold-rolled steel sheet, unless otherwise indicated to comply with exterior frame requirements. 1. Fabricate frames with mitered or coped and welded face comers and seamless face joints. 2. Frames for Level I Steel Doors: 0.042-inch- (1.0-mm-), unless otherwise indicated. D. Supports and Anchors: Fabricated from electrolytic zinc-coated or metallic+oated steel sheet. E. Jamb Anchors: Masonry, stud-wall, compression, or postinstalled expansion t)rye; not less than 0.042 inch ( 1.0 mm) thick. F. Floor Anchors: Formed from same material as frames, not less than 0.042 inch ( 1.0 mm) thick. 2.5 FABRICATION A. General: Fabricate standard steel doors and frames to be rigid and free of defects, warp, or buckle. Accurately form metal to required sizes and profiles, with minimum radius for thickness of metal. Where practical, fit and assemble units in manufacturer's plant. To ensure STANDARD STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 08111 - 3 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/20t2004 proper assembly at hoject site, clearly identify work that cannot be permanently factory assembled before shipment. Standard Steel Doors: l. Exterior Doors: Provide weep-hole openings in bottom of exterior doors to permit moisture to escape. Seal joints in top edges of doors against water penetation. Standard Steel Frames: Where frames are fabricated in sections due to shipping or handling limitations, provide alignment plates or angles at each joint, fabricated of same thickness metal as frames. l. Welded Frames: Weld flush face joints continuously; grind, fill, dress, and make smooth, flush, and invisible. 2. Provide countersunk, flat- or oval-head exposed screws and bolts for exposed fasteners, unless otherwise indicated. 3. Floor Anchors: Weld anchors to bottom of jambs and mullions with at least four spot welds per anchor. 4. Jamb Anchors: Locate anchors not more than l8 inches (457 mm) from top and bottom of frame. Space anchors not more than 32 inches (813 mm) o.c. 5. Door Silencers: Except on weather-stripped doors, drill stops to receive door silencers as follows. Provide plastic plugs to keep holes clear during construction. Hardware Preparation: Factory prepare standard steel doors and frames to receive tenrplated mortised hardware; includc cutouts, reinforcemort, mortising, drilling, and tapping, according to the Door Hardware Schedule and templates fumished as specified in Dvision 8 Section "Door Hardware." l. Comply with applicable requiremants in ANSIA250.6 and ANSllDHIAll5Series specifications for door and frame prcparation for hardware. Locate hardware as indicated on Shop Drawings or, if not indicated, according to ANSI 4250.8. Stops and Moldings: Provide stops and moldings around glazed lites where indicated. Form corners of stops and moldings with butted or mitered hairline joints. I . Provide fixed stops and moldings welded on secure side of door or frame.2. Provide loose stops and moldings on inside of doors and frames. 2.6 FINISHES A. Steel Finish: Factory pnming for field-painted finish. l. Shop Primer: Manufach:re/s standard, fast-curing, lead- and chromate-free primer complying with ANSI A250.10 acceptance criteria. T t B. c. I I I t I I I I f, tl I I t I I I D. STANDARD STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 08111-4 t I 20021501.08 PART 3 - EXECUTION VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 3.I INSTALLATION A. Remove welded-in shipping spreaders installed at factory. B. Provide doors and frames of sizes, thicknesses, and desigrrs indicated. Install standard steel doors and frames plumb, rigid, properly aligned, and securely fastened in place; comply with Drawings and manufachrer's written instructions. C' Standmd Steel Frames: lnstall standard steel frames for doors and other openings, of size and profile indicated. Cornplywith SDI 105. l. Set frames accwately in position; plumbed, aligned, and braced securely until permanent anchors are set. After wall construction is complete, remove temporary braces, leaving surfaces smooth and undamaged. a. At fire-protection-rated openings, install frames according to NFPA 80.b. Apply bituminous coating to backs of frames that are filled with mortar, grout, and plaster containing antifreezing agents. 2. Metal-Stud Partitions: Solidly pack mineral-fiber insulation behind frames.3. Masonry Walls: Coordinate installation of frames to allow for solidly hlling space between frames and masonry with mortar as specified in Division 4 Section "Unit Masonry Assemblies."4. Concrete Walls: Solidly fill space between frames and concrete with grout. Install grout in lifts and take precautions, including bracing frames, to ensure that frames are not deformed or damaged by grout forces. D. Standard Steel Doors: Fit hollow-metal doors accurately in frames. Shim as necessary. l. Fire-Rated Doors: Install doors with clearances according to NFPA 80.2. Smoke-Control Doors: Install doors according to NFPA 105. E. Glazing: Comply with installation requirements in Division 8 Section "Glazing" and with standard steel door and frame manufacturer's written instructions. F. Final Adjustments: Check and readjust operating hardware items immediately before final inspection. Leave work in complete and proper operating condition. Remove and replace defective work, including standard steel doors or frames that are warped, bowed, or otherwise uracceptable. G. Prime{oat Touchup: Immediately after erection, sand smooth rusted or damaged areas of prime coat and apply touchup of compatible air-drying primer. END OF SECTION O81I I I I I I I i I t t I I I t I ; I I STANDARD STEELDOORS AND FRAMES 08lll-5 I 20021501.08 vArL M.r-INTAIN L'DGE 3/2r/2004I I SECTION 08211 - FLUSH WOOD DOORS ,f' PART I -cENERAI I r.r ''MMARYA. This Section includes solid-core doors as follows: I l. Doors with hardboard faces.fJ 2. Factory fitting wood doors to frames and factory machining for hardware. I B. See Division 6 Section " lnterior Architectural Woodwork" for wood door frames and custom f panels appliedto flushwood doors. I t.z sr.rBMrrrALS I A. hoduct Data: For each type of door. Include factory-finishing specifications. I B. Shop Drawings: Indicate location, size, and hand of each door; elevation of each kind of door; z:-, construction details; location and extent of hardware blocking mortises, holes, and cutouts; I factory finishing; fire ratings; and other pertinent data.t C. Samples: For each face material and fmish.I I 1.3 QUALTTYASSTJRANCE !1 A. Quality Standard: Comply with AWI's "Architectural Woodwork Qualrty Standards'- Illustrated." I B. Fire-Rated Wood Doors: Doors that are listed and labeled by a testing and inspecting agancyir acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, for fire ratings indicated. } PART2-PRoDUcTs I 2.r MANUFACTTJRERS e A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering I products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: L Algoma Hardwoods lnc. I 2. Ampco hoducts, krc.! 3. Buell DoorCompany. , 4. Chappell Door Co. J 5. Eagie Plywood & Door Manufachring, Inc. , 6. Eggers Industries; Architectural Door Division. 7. GRAHAM Manufacturing Corp. tlII FLUSH WOOD DOORS O82I I - III 2002 I 501 .08 I I f, I I I I l, I I I t l B. 2.2 VAIL MOIINTAIN LODGE 8. Haley Brothers, Inc. 9. Ideal Wood Products, Inc. 10. IPIK Door Company. 11. Lambton Doors. 12. Marlite. 13. Mohawk Flush Doors, Inc. 14. Oshkosh Architectural Door Co. 15. Poncraft Door Co. 16. SouthwoodDoorCo. 17. Vancouver Door Company, Inc. 18. VT lndustries Inc. 19. WeyerhaeuserCompany. DOOR CONSTRUCTION Doors for Opaque Finish: l. Grade: Economy. 2. Faces for Interior Doors: Hardboard. 3. Construction: Seven plies, either bonded or nonbonded construction. Interior Hardboard-Faced Solid-Core Doors: l. Core: Either glued or stsuchnal corupositLe lumber. 2. Constuction: Three plies with stiles and rails bonded to core, then sntire unit abrasive planed before faces are applied. Fire-Rated Doors: l. Consfuction: Construction and core specified above for type of face indicated or manufacturefs standard mineral-core construction as needed to provide fire rating indicated. 2. Edge Construction: Manufacturer's standard laminated-edge corstruction with improved screw-holding capability and split resistance. 3. Pairs: hovide fire-rated pairs with fire-retardant stiles matching face veneer that are labeled and listed for kinds of applications indicated without formed-steel edges and astagals. hovide stiles with concealed intumescent seals. Blocking: For mineral- core doors, provide blocking as needed to eliminate through-bolting hardware. For mineral-core doors use composite blocking with improved screw-holding capability. FABRICATION Factory fit doors to suit frame-oparing sizes indicated. Comply with clearance requirements of referenced quality standard for fitting. Comply with requirements in NFPA 80 for fire-rated doors. Factory machine doors for hardware that is not surface applied. 3t21t2004 D.t I t t 2.3 B, n IFLUSHWOODDOORS082rr - 2 ,l 20021501.08 vArL MoUNTATN LODGE 3/2u2004rl 3 t lf?Lfitragals: Premachine astragals and formed-steel edges for hardware for pairs of I C. Openings: Cut and trim openings tbrough doors to comply with applicable requirements of I referenced standards for kind(s) of door(s) required. t 2.4 sHoppR,'rNG j A. Doors for Opaque Finish: Shop prime faces and edges of doors, including cutouts, with one I coat of wood primer specified in Division 9 Section "Painting." I 2.5 FACToRYFTMSHTNcI A. General: Field finish doors indicated to receive opaque frnish.rii 'r PART3 -ExECUTIoN IIt 3.1 INSTALLATIoN I A. hstall doors to comply with manufacturer's written instructions, referenced quality standard, t and as indicated. I l. Install fire-rated doors in corresponding fire-rated frames according to NFPA 80. I B. Job-Fitted Doors: Align and fit doors in frames with rmiform clearances and bevels; do not trim I stiles and rails in excess of limits set by manufacturer or permitted for fire-rated doors. I Machine doors for hardware. Seal cut surfaces after fitting and machining. t l. Comply with NFPA 80 for fire-rated doors. I C. Factory-Fitted Doors: Align in frames for uniform clearance at each edge. I D. ffi,:l-rff*ted Doors: Restore finish before installation if fitting or machining is required at u ENDOFSECTTONOS2T1 I tr I J FLUSH WOOD DOORS O82I I - 3I I t 2002rs0r.08 vArL MoLTNTATN LoDGE 3tzrt2004 . SECTION 08212 - STILE AND RAIL WOOD DOORS I PARTr -GENERAL I I.I SUMMARYt A. This Section includes exterior and interior stile and rail wood doors.I N B. See Division 6 Section "Interior Architectural Woodwork" for wood door frames. I r.2 suBMrrrALS I A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofdoor. I B. Shop Drawrngs: Indicate location, size, and hand of each door; elevation of each kind of door; I construction details not covered in Product Data; and other pertinent data. I C. Samples: For each species and finish required. III I.3 QUALITYASSURANCE a A. Quality Standard for Doors of Stock Desigr and Constuction: Comply with WDMA I.S.6, | "Industry Standard for Wood Stile and Rail Doors." a B. Qualrty Standard for Doors of Special Desigrr and Construction: Comply with AWI's I "Architectural Woodwork Quality Standards." ,. C. Fire-Rated Wood Doors: Doors that are listed and labeled by a testing and inspecting agency t acceptableto authoriiieshavingjurisdiction. D. Safet5r Glass: Provide products complying with testing requirernents in 16 CFR 1201, for I Category II materials, unless those ofCategory I are expressly indicated and permitted.a - PART2.PRODUCTS l 7I MANUFACTURERSIJ A, In other Part 2 articles where titles below introduce lists, the following requirements apply to - product selection: U l. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers ffering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to,.,. manufacturers specified. I l STILE AND RAIL WOOD DOORS 08212 - I IIt 20021s01 .08 I I I I )^ I t J t I I I t I I I I \t T B. c. D. F. G. 2.2 2.3 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE 3t2t/2004 MATERIALS Assemble exterior doors, including components, with wet-use adhesives. STILE AND RAIL DOORS OF SPECIAL DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION Available Manufacturers : 1. Algoma Hardwoods, Inc. 2. Eggers Industries; Architectural Door Division. 3. ENJO Architectural Millwork. 4. Karona, Inc. 5. Maiman Company (The). 6. Oakwood Woodworks. 7. Pinecrest, lnc. 8. Select Interior Door, Ltd. 9. SUN-DOR-CO. 10. Woodtech Trading Company. Construction, General : l. Grade of Doors for Transparent Finish: Custom. 2. Grade of Doors for Opaque Finish: Custom. 3. Wood Species and Cut for Transparent Finish: Alder, quarter sawedsliced. Door Construction for Transparent Finish: l. Stile and Rail Consfruction: Veneered, stuctural composite lumber or veneered, edge- glued, frn ger-j ointed clear lumber. 2. Raised-Panel Conskuction: Vaneered, shaped, wood-based panel product with veneer conforming to raised-panel shape. Exterior Doors: l. Raised-Panel Thiclness: Manufacturer's standard, but not less than l-l/8 inches (29 mm). 2. Glass for Openings: Uncoated, clear, fully tempered float glass, 5.0 mm thick. lnterior Doors: l. Basis-of-Desigrr Product: Maiman or a comparable product. 2. Raised-Panel Thickness: Manufacturer's standard, but not less than 1-ll8 inches (29 mm) thick. Interior Fire-Rated Doors (20-Minute Rating): Fire-rated doors with I -3l4-inch- (,14-mm-) thick stiles and rails and veneered raised panels not less than l-ll8 inches (29 mm) thich complying with requirements indicated for interior doors. lnterior Fire-Rated Doors (45, 60, and 9O-Minute Rating): Fire-rated doors with l-3/4-inch (2- ll2 inch for 60 or 90 minute rating) thick, edged and veneered mineral-core stiles and rails and STILE ANDRAIL WOOD DOORS 08212 -2 I 2002150r.08 'AIL MouNTAIN LoDcE 3t2t/2004a I I - I /8-inch- (or 'l -3i4 inch for 60 or 90 minute rating) thick, veneered mineral-core raised panels, t complying with requirements indicated for interior doors. I l. Basis-of-Desigrr Product: Maiman or a comparable product. i) 2.4 FABRICATIONs-' A. Fabricate stile and rail wood doors in sizes indicated for Project-site fitting. I B. Factory fit doors to suit frame-opening sizes indicated. Comply with clearance requiremants oft referenced quality standard for fitting. Comply with requirements in NFPA 80 for fire-rated doors.a. I C. Factory machine doors for hardware that is not sr:rface applied. I D. ,:ttrJ*3::rtgs: Trim openings indicated for glazing with solid wood moldings, with one side I E. Exterior Doors: Factory treat exterior doors after fabrication with water-repellent preservative I to comply with WDMA I.S.4. Flash top of outswinging doors with manufacturer's standard metal flashing. I ' 2.5 SHOP PRMING I A. Doors for Opaque Finish: Shop apply one coat of wood primer specified in Division 9 Section ll "Painting" to faces and edges of doors. t B. Doors for Transparant Finish: Shop apply stain (ifrequired), other required preteatments, and I first coat of finish specified in Division 9 Section "Painting" to faces and edges ofdoors. - t' 2.6 FACTORYFTMSHTNG A. Finish wood doors at factory that are indicated to receive tansparent finish. t B. Grade: Custom. I C. Finish: Manufacturer's standard finish with performance requirements comparable to AWI t System TR4 conversion vamish. t D. Staining: As selected by Architect from manufachner's full range. l,j E. Effect Open-grain finish. I F. Sheen: Satin. - I STILE AND RAIL WOOD DOORS 08212 -3 20021501.08 PART 3. EXECUTION VAIL MOIINTAIN LODGE 3t21t2004 3.I INSTALLATION A. lnstall wood doors to comply with manufacturer's written instructions and with referenced quality standard, and as indicated. l. Install fire-rated doors in corresponding fire-rated frames according to NFPA 80. Job-Fitted Doors: Aligrr and fit doors in frames with rmiform clearances and bevels as indicated below; do not bim stiles and rails in excess of limits set by rnanufacturer or permitted with firo- rated doors. Machine doors for hardware. Seal cut surfaces after fitting and machining. l. Clearances: Provide l/8 inch (3.2 mm) at heads, jambs, and between pairs of doors. hovide 1/8 inch (3.2 mm) from bottom of door to top of decorative floor finish or covering. Where threshold is shown or scheduled, provide l/4 inch (6.4 mm) from bottom ofdoor to top ofthreshold. a. Comply \rith NFPA 80 for fire-rated doors. 2. Bevel non-fire-rated doors l/8 inch in 2 inches (3-ll2 degrees) at lock and hinge edges. 3. Bevel fire-rated doors l/8 inch in 2 inches (3-ll2 degrebs) on lock edge; trim stiles and rails only to exteflt permitted by labeling agency. Factory-Fitted Doors: Align in frames for uniform clearance at each edge. END OF SECTION 08212 I t I I I I I I I I I t T t I t t 't B. STILE AND RAIL WOOD DOORS 08212 -4 l.l I T t l t 20021501.08 VAILMOUNTAIN LODGE 3t21/2004 SECTION 08263 - SLIDING WOOD-FRAMED GLASS DOORS PART I - GENERAL SUMMARY This Section includes sliding wood-framed glass doors for exterior locations with aluminum- clad exterior exposed surfaces. 1.2 PERFORMANCEREQUIR.EMENTS A. General: hovide sliding wood-framed glass doors capable of complying with performance requirements indicated based on testing manufacfurers' doors that are represantative of those specified. B. AAMAn\IW\rDA Performance Requirements: hovide sliding wood-framed glass doors of the performance class and grade indicated that comply with AAMA/NWWDA l0l/I.S'2. l. Performance Class: R.' 2. Performance Grade: Minimum for performance class indicated.' 3. Exception to AAMAA.IWWDA l0l/LS.2: kr addition to requirements for performance class and performance grade, desigrr glass framing system to limil lateral deflections of glass edges to less than l/175 of glass+dge length or 3/4 inch (19 mm), whichever is less, at design presswe based on testing performed according to AAMA/NWWDA l0l/I.S.2, Uniforrn Load Deflection Test. C. Thermal Transmittance: Whole-door U-factor maximum indicated below at 15-mph (24-knlh) €xterior wind velocity and winter condition temperatures when tested according to AAMA 1503. l. U-Factor: 0.57 Btu/sq. ft. x h x deg F (-1.23 Wsq. m x K) for double-glazed, aluminum- clad sliding wood-frarned glass doors. D. Solar Heat Gain Coefficient: hovide sliding wood-framed glass doors with a wholedoor SHGC maximum of 0.63, determined according to NFRC 200 procedures for nomesidential size. I.3 SUBMITTAIS A. Product Data: For each tlpe of product indicated. B. Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments lo other work. C. Samples: Foreach exposed finish. D. Productcertificates. t l ! I t I I l I I I t T I SLIDING WOOD-FRAMED GLASS DOORS 08263 - 1 2002 | 501 -08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE QUALITY ASSURANCE Feneshation Standard: Comply with AAMA,TNWWDA l0l/I.S.2, "Voluntary Specifications for Aluminum, Vinyl (PVC) and Wood Windows and Glass Doors," for minimum standards of performance, materials, components, accessories, and fabrication unless more stringent requirements are indicated. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MANI'FACTI-IRERS Available Manufacturers: Subject to conrpliance with requirements, manufacfurers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: l. Aluminum-Clad Slidine Wood-Framed Glass Doors: 312u2004 1.4 2.1 a. b. c. d. e. f. c. h. i. j. Caradco. Crestline; a division of SNE Enterprises, Inc.; a Nortek Company. Hurd Millwork Conrpany, lnc. Kolbe & Kolbe MillworkCo., lnc. Marvin Windows and Doors. Noico Windows & Patio Dbors; Jeld-Wen, Inc. Peachtree Doors and Windows; a Nortek Company. Pella Corporation. Vetter; a division of SNE Enterprises, lnc.; a Nortek Company. Weather Shield Mfg., Inc. 2.2 MATERIALS AND FIMSHES General: Comply with AAMA /NWWDA l0l/I.S.2 requirements. Wood Parts: Wood or wood cornposites, water-rep€llent preservative treated except inside stops and inside trim. Aluminum Cladding; Provide the following manufacturer's standard finish: 1. High-performance organic finish consisting of a fluoropolymer 2-coat system complying with AAMA 2604. a. Color and Gloss: To match existing as selected by Architect from manufacturer's full range. Glazing System and Glass: Manufacturer's standard factory-glazing system that produces a weathertight seal and is glazed with clear insulating-glass units with low-E coating or film. Hardware: Manufacturer's standard. Insect Screens: Locate screens in operable panels on outside of door. Comply with SMA 2006. T I I I I I I I I A. B. D. E. F. t t I T I I I T I SLIDING WOOD-FRAMED GLASS DOORS 08263 -2 I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3/21/2004 l. Insect Screen Frames: Manufacturer's standard extruded-aluminum or formed-tubular- aluminum members, with mitered or coped joints, concealed fasteners, adjustable rollers, and removable PVC or PE spline/anchor concealing edge of frame. a. Finish: Baked-on organic coating. b. Color: Manufachrer's standard. 2. Glass-Fiber Mesh Fabric: ASTM D 3656, l8-by-14 (1.4-by-1.8-rnm) or l8-by-16 (1.'1- by-I.6-mm) mesh of PVC-coated, glass-fiber threads. a. Mesh Color: Charcoal gray. 3. AluminumWireFabric: l8-by-16(l.l-by-I.3-mmopenings)meshof0.01l-inch-(0.28- mm-) diameter, coated aluminum wire. a. Wire-Fabric Finish: Charcoal gray. 4- Lock: Manufacturer's standard pull and keyless locking device on each movable panel, lockable from inside onlv. 2.3 FABRICATION A. General: Fabricate sliding wood-framed glass doors in sizes indicated that conply with AAMAATWWDA l0l/I.S.2 for performance class and grade indicated. B. Fabricate sliding wood-framed glass doors tbat are reglazable without dismantling panel framing. C. Factory-Glazed Fabrication: Glaze sliding wood-framed glass doors in the factory where practical and possible for applications indicated. PART 3 . EXECUTION 3.I INSTALLATION A. Install sliding wood-framed glass doors level, plumb, square, true to line, without distortion or impeding thermal movement, anchored securely in place to structural support, and in proper relation to wall flashing, vapor retarders, air retarders, water/weather barriers, and othEr adjacent construction. B. Set sill members in bed of sealant or with gaskets, as indicated, for weathertight consauction. C. Adjust operating panels, screens, and hardware to provide a tight fit at contact points and weather shipping for smooth operation and weathertight closure. Lubricate hardware and moving parts. D. Clean exposed surfaces immediately after installing sliding glass doors. Avoid damaging protective coatings and finishes. Remove excess glazing sealants, dirt, and other substances. I I t T I I I f' I I T I I I I I SLIDING WOOD-FRAMED GLASS DOORS 08263 -3 20021501.08 END OF SECTION 08263 VAIL MOI.JNTAIN LODGE 3t2v2w4 SLIDING WOOD-FRAMED GLASS DOORS 08263 - 4 | 2oo2r5ol.o8 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t21t2004 I sEcrroN0s3' -AccESsDooRSANDFRAMES I PARr r -.ENERAL I l.l s'MMARY A. This Section includes the following: 1. Access doors and frames. 2. Fire-rated access doors and frames. --1!1.2 SUBMITTALS t A. Product Data: For each type ofaccess door indicated. J B. Coordination Drawings: Drawn to scate and coordinating access door and frame installation I with ceiling support, ceiling-mounted itans, and concealed Work above ceiling. C. Samples: For each exposed finish. l D. Schedule: Door aird frame schedule, including types, general locations, sizes, construction details, latching or locking provisions, and other data pertinent to installation.a I 1.3 QUALTTYASSURANCE I A. Fire-Rated Access Doors and Frames: Units complying with NFPA 80 and that are labeled and'- listed by UL, ITS, or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having I jurisdictionpertest method indicated. I |. Vertical Access Doors; NFPA 252 or UL l0B. 2. Horizontal Access Doors and Frames: ASTM E ll9, UBC Standard 7.1, orUL263.l, t B. Size and Location Verification: Determine specific locations and sizes for access doors needed to gain access to concealed equipment, and indicate on schedule. I -r PART2-PRODUCTS S 2.1 MATERTALS I A. Steel Plates, Shapes, and Bars: ASTM A 36/A36M.il products and ASTM A 153/A l53M for steel and iron hardware. ! B. Steel Sheet: fII/ ACCESSDOORSANDFRAMES 08311- ItI 2002 l50l .08 VAIL MOTNTAIN LODGE 3t21/2004 l. Hot-Rolled: ASTMA569/A569M, Commercial Steel (CS), TypeB; free of scale, pitting, and surface defects; pickled and oiled. 2. Cold-Rolled: ASTM A 3661A366M, Commercial Steel (CS), or ASTM A6201A620M, Drawing Steel (DS), Type B; stretcher-leveled standard of flatness. a. Electrolytic zinc-coated steel sheet, complying with ASTM A 591/A 591M, Class C coating, may be substituted at fabricator's option. 3. Electrolytic Zinc Coated: ASTM A 591/A 591M, Commercial Steel (CS), with Class C coating and phosphate treatment to prepare surface for painting. 4. Metallic Coated: ASTM A 653/A 653M, Commercial Steel (CS), Tlpe B, with A60 (ZFl80) zinc-iron-alloy (galvannealed) coating or G60 (2180) mill-phosphatized zinc coating; stretcher-leveled standard of fl atness. Drywall Beads: Edge trim formed from 0.0299-inch (0.76-mm) zinc-coated steel sheet formed to receive joint compound and in size to suit thickness of gypsum panels indicated. Paint: l. Shop Primer for Ferrous Metal: Fast+uring, lead- and cluomate-free, universal modified-alkyd primer complying with performance requiremants in FS fi-P-664; selected for good resistance to normal atmospheric corrosion, compatibility with finish paint systerns indicated, and capability to provide sotmd foundation for field-applied' topcoats despite prolonged exposure. 2. Shop Primer for Metallic-Coated Steel: Organic zinc-rich primer complying with SSPC- Paint 20 and compafible with topcoat. 3. Galvanizing Repair Paint: High-zincdust-content paint for regalvanizing welds in steel, compllng with SSPC-Paint 20. ACCESS DOORS AND FRAMES Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: 1. Acudor Products, Inc. 2. Bar-Co, Inc. Div.; Alfab, Inc. 3. Cendrex. lnc. 4. Cesco hoducts. 5. Elmdor/Stoneman; Div. of Acom Engineering Co.6. Jensen Industries. 7. J. L. Industries, Inc. 8. Karp Associates, Inc. 9. Larsan'sManufacturingCompany. 10. MIFAB Manufacturing, Inc. I l. Milcor Limited Partnership. 12. Nystom Building Products Co. 13. Precision Plumbing hoducts, Inc. 14. Williams Bros. Corporation of America (The). Flush, Uninsulated, Fire-Rated Access Doors and Trimless Frames: I I t I t C. D. I I I I I I I I I 2.2 I I I t t B. ACCESS DOORS AND FRAMES 08311-2 I I I | 2oo2r5or.o8 VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE 3t2t/2004 l. Material: Prime-painted steel sheet. 2. Surface Type: Gypsumboard. 3. Locations: Walls and ceilings. 4. Fire-Resistance Rating: Minimum as indicated in project code review for opening in rated assembly. 5. Temperature-Rise Rating: 250 deg F ( 139 deg C) at the end of 30 minutes. 6. Door: Flush panel with core of mineral-fiber insulation enclosed in sheet metal with a minimum thickness of 0.036 inch (0.9 nm). 7. Frame: Minimum 0.060-inch- (1.5-mm-) thick sheet metal with drywall bead. I 8. Hinges: Concealedpintype. f| 9. Automatic Closer: Spring type.! 10. Latch: Selflatchingboltoperatedbykeywithinteriorrelease. .- I l. Lock: Key-operated cylinder lock with interior release. T,q C. Flush, Uninsulated, Fire-Rated Access Doors and Frames with Exposed Trim: l. Material: Prime-painted steel sheet.2. Locations: Ceramic-tile wall surfaces. 3. Fire-Resistance Rating: Minimum as indicated in project code rerriew for opening in rated assembly. 4. Door: Minimum 0.060-inch- (1.5-mm-l thick sheet metal. flush construction. 5. Frame: Minimum 0.060-inch- (1.5-mm-) thick sheet metal with l-inch- (25-mm-) wide, surface-rnounted trim. fJ 6. Hinges: Concealed pin type.! 7 . Autornatic Closer: Spring type.R Latch: Self-latching bolt operated by flush key with interior release.Ir D. Flush Access Doors and Trimless Frames: 1. Material: Prime-painted steel sheet. 2. Surface Type: Gypsumboard. 3. Locations: Walls and ceilings of back of house employee areas not generally exposed to public view.4. Door: Minimum 0.060-inch- (1.5-mm-) thick sheet metal, set flush with surrounding finish surfaces. I 5. Frame: Minimum 0.060-inch- (1.5-mm-) thick sheet metal with bead for type of surface indicated.r 6. Hinges: Continuous piano hinge. t 7. Lock: Key-operated cylinder lock a-r E. Recessed Access Doors and Trimless Frames: l. Material: Prime-painted steel sheet. 2. Surface Type: Gypsumboard 3. Locations: Non-rated walls and ceilings of all areas exposed to public view. 4. Door: Minimum 0.060-inch- (1.5-mm-) thick sheet metal in the form of a pan recessed 518 inch ( l6 mm) for infill of finish matching surface type indicated. a. Reinforce panel as required to prevent buckling. I I I I I I t I ACCESS DOORS AND FRAMES 083u - 3 2002rs0r.08 VAIL MOLTNTAIN LODGE 3/2v2004 5. Frame; Minimum 0.060-inch- ( 1.5-mm-) thick sheet metal with bead or edge for surface type indicated. 6. Hinges: Concealed pivoting rod hinge. 7. Lock: Key-operated cylinder lock. Exterior, Flush Access Doors and Frames: Weatherproof with extruded door gasket. Surface Type: EIFS, Wood Siding, Masonry. Locations: Walls and ceilings. Door: Minimum 0.036-inch- (0.9-mm-) thick, metallic-coated steel sheet; flush panel construction with 2-inch- (50-mm) thick fiberglass insulation. Frame: Minimum 0.060-inch (1.5-mm) extruded aluminum wi0r mill finish. Hinges: Continuous piano hinge, zinc plated. Lock: Lockable dual-action handles. 2.3 FABRICATION A. Latching Mechanisms: Frrnish number required to hold doors in flush, smooth plane when closed. 1. For cylinder loclq firnish two keys per lock and key all locks alike. 2. For recessed panel doors, provide access sleeves for each locking device. Furnish plastic grommets and install in holes cut through finish. PART3 -EXECUTION INSTALLATION Advise installers of other work about specific requirements relating to access door and floor door installation, including sizes of openings to receive access door and frame, as well as locations of supports, inserts, and anchoring devices. Set frames accurately in position and attach securely to supports with plane of face panels aligned with adjacent finish surfaces. Install access doors with trimless frames flush with adjacent finish surfaces or recessed to receive fmish material. Adjust doors and hardware after installation for proper operation. END OF SECTION O83I I l t I t I t I t l I T t I I I I I I I L 2. J. 4. 5. 6. F. B. C. D. 3.1 ACCESS DOORS AND FRAMES 08311-4 T t 20021501 .08 VA]L MOLINTAIN LODGE 3/2t/2004 SECTION 08550 -WOOD WINDOWS PART I - GENERAL I.I SUMMARY A. This Section includes the following aluminum-clad wood-framed window product types: L Casement windows. 2. Fixed windows. 1,2 PERFORMANCEREQUIREMENTS A. General: Provide wood windows capable of complying with performance requirements indicated, based on testing manufacturer's windows that are representative of those specified and that are of minimum test size required by AAMA/I.IWWDA 101/I.S.2. B. AAMA/NWWDA Performance Requirements: Provide wood windows of the performance class and grade indicated that comply with AAMA/NWWDA l0l/I.S.2. l. Performance Class: R. 2. Performance Grade: Minimum for performance class indicated. 3. Exception to AAMA/NWWDA l0l/I.S.2: kr addition to requirernents for performance class and performance grade, desigrr glass framing system to limit lateral deflections of glass edges to less than 1/175 of glass-edge length or 3/4 inch (19 mm), whichever is less, at design pressure based on testing performed according to AAMAA.IWWDA l0l/I.S.2, Uniform Load Deflection Test or structural computations. C. Thermal Transmittance: Whole-window U-factor maximum indicated below at 15-mph (24- km,tr) exterior wind velocity and winter condition temperatures when tested according to AAMA 1503. l. U-Factor: 0.57 Btur/sq. ft. x h x deg F (3.23 Wsq. m x K) for double-glazed, aluminum- clad wood windows. D. Solar Heat Gain Coeffrcient: Provide wood windows with a whole-door SHGC maximum of 0.63, determined according to NFRC 200 procedures for nonresidential size. E. Specifrc Product Performance Requirements: Comply with Section 2.2 of AAMA/NW'WDA l0l/I.S.2 as applicable to types ofwood windows indicated. I.3 SUBMITTALS A. Product Data: For each type of wood window indicated. B. Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, details, hardware, attachments to other Work, and operational clearances. I I I I I I I I I I t I I ! t I I WOODWINDOWS 08550 - r 2002r s0r.08 I T I I I I I l i c. 1.5 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t2t/2004 1. Include structural analysis data indicating deflection limitations of glass framing systems, signed and sealed by the qualihed professional engineer responsible for their preparation. Samples: For each exposed finish. Product test reports. Maintenance data. QUALITY ASSI]RANCE lnstaller: A qualified installer, approved by manufacfurer to install manufachner's products. Fenesfation Standard: Comply with AAMAA.IWWDA l0l/I.S.2, "Voluntary Specifications for Aluminum, Vinyl (PVC) and Wood Windows and Glass Doors," for minimum standards of performance, materials, components, accessories, and fabrication unless more stringent requirements are indicated. Glazing Publications: Comply with published recommendations of glass manufacturers and GANA's "Glazing Manual' unless more stringent requirernents are indicated. WARRANTY Special Wananty: Manufacturer's standard form in which manufacturer agrees to repair or replace wood windows that fail in materials and worlsnanship within two years from date of Substantial Cornpletion. Warranty Period for Metal Finishes: Five years from date of Substantial Completion. Warranty Period for Glass: Five years from date of Substantial Conrpletion. PART 2 -PRODUCTS MANTJFACTT]RERS Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requiremants, manufactureas offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: 1. Andersen Commercial Group; Andersen Corp. 2. BiltBest Windows and Patio Doors. 3. Caradco Window Corp.; Jeld-Wen, Inc. 4. Crestline; a division of SNE Enterprises, Inc.; a Nortek Company. 5. Eagle Window & Door, Inc.; an American Architectural Products Corporation Company. 6. Hurd Millwork Co. 7. Kolbe & Kolbe Millwork Co., Inc. 8. Marvin Windows and Doors. 9. Norco Windows and Patio Doors; Jeld-Wen, Inc. 10. Peachtree Doors and Windows: Nortek. Inc. C. D. E. 1.4 A. B. B. c. tl T I I I t I I I 2.1 WOODWINDOWS 085s0 - 2 B. A. B. B. c. D. 2.2 2.3 2.4 T I I I I t t t I I I I l I I I T I I 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE I 1. Pella Corporation. 12. Pozzi Wood Windows; Jeld-Wen, Inc. 13. Vetter; a division of SNE Enterprises, Inc.; a Nortek Company. 14. Weather Shield Mfg., Inc. MATERIALS, GENERAL High Altitude System: Provide a window and glazing system intended for installation at altitudes above 8,000 feet above sea level. Aluminum Extrusions and Rolled Aluminum for Cladding, High-Performance Organic Finish: Two-coat thermocured system with fluoropolymer coats containing not less than 70 percent poll'vinylidene fluoride resin by weight; complying with AAMA 2604. l. Color and Gloss: Match Existing Windows CLAZING Glass: Clear, insulating-glass with low-e coating or film. Glazing Systern: Manufacturer's standard high altitude, factory-glazing systan that produces weathertight seal. INSECT SCREENS General: Design windows and hardware to accommodate screens in a tight-fitting, removable arrangemeart, with a minimum of exposed fasteners and latches. Locate screens on inside of window and provide for each operable exterior sash or ventilator. L Aluminum Tubular Frame Screens: Comply with SMA 1004, "Specifrcations for Aluminum Tubular Frame Screens for Windows." Residential R-20 class. Aluminum Insect Screen Frames: Manufacturer's standard aluminum alloy complying with SMA 1004. Fabricate frames with mitered or coped joints, concealed fasteners, and removable PVC spline/anchor concealing edge of frame. l. Aluminum Tubular Framing Sections and Cross Braces: Roll formed from aluminum sheet with minimum wall thickness as required for class indicated. 2. Finish: Manufacturer'sstandard. Glass-Fiber Mesh Fabric: 18-by-14 (l.l-by-l.4-nrm) or 18-by-16 (1.O-by-l.l-mm) mesh of PVC-coated, glass-fiber threads; woven and fused to form a fabric mesh resistant to corrosion, shrinkage, stretch, impact damage, and weather deterioration in the following color. Comply with ASTM D 3656. l. Mesh Color: Charcoal gay. Aluminum Wire Fabric: l8-by-16 (1.1-by-1.3-mm) mesh of 0.01l-inch- (0.28-mm-) diameter, coated aluminum wire. 3t2t/2004 WOODWINDOWS 08s50 - 3 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t21t2004 without distortion or impeding thermal support, and in proper relation to wall I I I 2.5 l. Wire-Fabnc Finish: Charcoal gray. Wickets: Provide sliding or hinged wickets, framed and himmed for a tight fit and durability during handling. FABRICATION General: Fabricate wood windows, in sizes indicated, that comply with AAMA/l{lmyDA 101n.S.2 for performance class and performance grade indicated. lnclude a complete system for assembling components and anchoring windows. Fabricate wood windows that are reglazable without dismantling sash or ventilator framing. Weather Stripping: Provide full-perimeter weather stipping for each operable sash and vertilatoq unless otherwise indicated. Factory machine windows for openings and hardware that is not surface applied. Mullions: hovide mullions and cover plates as shown, matching window units, complete with anchors for support to stucture and installation of window units. Allow for erection tolerances and provide for movement of window units due to thermal expansion and building deflections, as indicated. Provide mullions and cover plates capable of withstanding design loads of window units. Glazing Sto'ps: Provide nailed or snapon glazing stops coordinated udth glazing systern indicated. Provide glazing stops to match sash and ventilator frames. PART3 -EXECUTION I I t I t I I F. B. C. D. E. B. c. I I I U I t I 3.1 INSTALLATION Install windows level, plurnb, square, true to line, movement, anchored securely in place to structural flashing and other adjacant construction. Set sill members in bed of sealant or with gaskets, as indicated, for weathertight construction. Metal Protection: Separate aluminum and other corrodible surfaces from sources of corrosion or electolytic action at points of contact with other materials by complying with requirements specified in "Dissimilar Materials" Paragraph in Appendix B in AAMAA.IWWDA l0l/I.S.2. Adjust operating sashes and ventilators, screens, hardware, and accessories for a tight fit at contact points and weather stripping for smooth operation and weathertight clostne. Lubricate hardware and moving parts- Protect window surfaces from contact with contaminating substances resulting from consfuction operations. kr addition, monitor window surfaces adjacent to and below exterior concrete and masonry surfaces during construction for presence of dirt, scum, alkaline deposits, D. E. I IWOODWINDOWS08550 - 4 I t T stalns, or other contaminants. If contaminating substances do contacl window surfaces, remove contaminants immediately according to manufacturer's written recommendations. F. Clean exposed surfaces immediately after installing windows. Avoid damaging protective coatings and finishes. Remove excess sealants, glazing materials, dirt, and other substances. G' Clean factory-glazed glass immediately after installing windows. Comply with manufacturer's written recommendations for final cleaning and maintenance. Remove nonpermanent labels and clean surfaces. H' Remove and replace glass that has been broken, chipped, cracked, abraded, or damaged during construction period. END OF SECTION 08550 20021501.08 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE 3t2t/2004 I I t I I I I I I I I I I l I I wooDWINDOWS 08550 - 5 I 20021501.08 vAIL MouNTAIN LoDGE 3t21t2004! I SECTION 08830 - MIRRORS a I PARTI -GENERAL I l.l sLMMARY! A. This Section includes the following: ? 1. Annealed monolithic glass mirrors. a 1.2 SUBMTTTALS - A. Product Data: For mirror hardware and mastic.I B. Shop Drawings: Include mirror elevations, edge details, mirror hardware, and attachments to other work. I C. Samples: For cach type of mirror product required, in the form indicated below: I 1. Mirrors, 12 inches (300 mm) square, including edge treatment on 2 adjoining edges. a 2. Mirror clips. 3. Mirror trim, 12 inches (300 rnrn) long. !' D. Product Certificates: For each type of mirror and mirror mastic, sigrred by product manufacturer. t E. Mirror Mastic Compatibility Test Reports: From mirror manufacturer.JI'e I 1.3 euALTTYASSTJRANCEI A. Glazing Publications: Comply with GANA's "Glazing Manual" and GANA Mirror Division's I "Mirrors, Handle with Exteme Care: Tips for the hofessional on the Care and Handling of I Mirrors" unless more stringent requirements are indicated I B. heconstuction Mirror Mastic Compatibility Test: Submit mirror mastic products to mirror I manufacturer for testing to determine compatibility of mastic with mirror backing paint and substrates on which mirrors are installed. ' 1.4 DELIVERY, SToRAGE,ANDHANDLING t A. Comply with miror manufacturer's written instructions for shipping, storing, and handling I minors as needed to prevent deterioration of silvering, damage to edges, and abrasion of glass surfaces and applied coatings. Store indoors, protected from moisture including condensation. I! t MIRRORS 08830 - 1 I a 20021 501 .08 t I I I I t I 1.5 2.1 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE 3t2t/2004 WARRANTY Special Warranty: Manufacturer's standard form, made out to Owner and signed by mirror manufactruer agreeing to replace mirrors that deteriorate, f.o.b. the nearest shipping point to Project site, within specified warranty period indicated in second subparagraph below. l. Deterioration of Mirrors: Defects developed from normal use that are attributable to the manufacturing process and not to causes other than glass breakage and practices for maintaining and cleaning mirrors conhary to mirror manufachrer's wdtten instructions. Defects include discoloration, black spots, and clouding of the silver film. 2. Wananty Period: Five years from date of manufacture. PART 2 -PRODUCTS SILVERED FLAT GLASS MIRROR MATERTALS Clear Glass Mirrors: ASTM C 1503, Minor Glazing Quality. 1. Nominal Thickness: 3.0 mm. MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS . Setting Blocks: Elastomeric material with a Type A Shore durometer hardness of 85, plus or minus 5. Edge Scaler: Coating compatible with glass coating and approved by minor manufacturer for use in protecting against silver deterioration at mirrored glass edges. Mirror Mastic: An adhesive setting compound, produced specifically for setting mirrors and certified by both mirror manufacturer and mastic manufacturer as compatible with glass coating and substates on which mirrors will be installed. l. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: a. Gunther Minor Mastics. b. Palmer Products Corporation. MIRRORHARDWARE Top and Bottom Aluminum J-Channels: Aluminum extrusions with a retum deep enough to produce a glazing channel to accommodate mirrors of thickness indicated and in lengths required to cover bottom and top edges ofeach mirror in a single piece. 1. Bottom Trim: J-channels formed with front leg and back leg not less than 5i 16 and 314 inch (7.9 and l9 mm) in height, respectively. A. 2.2 I I I I I I I T I I I t C. 2.3 MIRRORS 08830 - 2 B. C. A. B. c. A. B. c. 2.4 3.1 I I I I I T I I I I I I I I I t I J I 20021501 .08 VAIL MOL]NTAIN LODGE 2. Top Trim: Formed with front leg with a height of 5/16 inch (.7.9 nrm) and back leg designed to fit into the pocket created by wall-mounted aluminum cleat. 3. Product: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide the following: a. Bottom Trim: C. R. Laurence Co., lnc.; D638 FHA Type "J" Channel. b. Top Trim: C. R. Laurence Co., Inc.; D 1638 Top Channel. c. Cleat: C. R. Laurence Co., Inc.; D 1637M Mirror Motl:t System Cleat. Fasteners: Fabricated of same basic metal and alloy as fastened metal and matching it in finished color and texhre where fasteners are exposed. Anchors and Inserts: Provide devices as required for mirror hardware installation. Provide toothed or lead-shield expansion-bolt denices for drilled-in-place anchors. Provide galvanized anchors and inserts for applications on inside face of exterior walls and where indicated. FABRICATION Mirror Sizes: To suit Project conditions, cut mirrors to final sizes and shapes. Cutouts: Fabricate cutouts for notches and holes in mirrors without marring visible surfaces. Locate and size cutouts so they fit closely around penetations in mirrors. Mirror Edge Treatrnent: Flat polished edge. I . Seal edges of mirrors after edge treatnent to prevent chernical or atmospheric penetration of glass coating. PART3 -EXECUTION INSTALLATION Gereral: Install mirrors to comply with mirror referenced GANA publications. Mount mirrors distorting refl ected images. 3tzt/2004 manufacturer's written instructions and with accurately in place in a manner that avoids Provide a minimum air space of 1/8 inch (3 mm) between back of mirrors and mounting surface for air circulation between back ofmirrors and face ofmounting surface. For wall-mounted mirrors, install with mastic and minor hardware. 1. Attach mirror hardware securely to mounting surfaces with mechanical fasteners installed with anchors or inserts as applicable. lnstall fasteners so heads do not impose point loads on backs of mirrors. 2. For mirror hardware in the form of continuous J-channels at bottom, provide setting blocks l/8 inch (3 mm) thick by 4 inches (100 mnr) long at quarter points. To prevent trap'ping water, provide, between setting blocks, 2 slotted weeps not less than 1/4 inch (6.4 mm) wide by 3/8 inch (9.5 mm) long. 3. For metal or plastic clips, place a felt or plastic pad between mirror and each clip to prevent spalling of mirror edges. MIRRORS 08830 - 3 2002 l50l .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t2u2004 4. Where indicated, install bottom trim and top clips. Fabricate bottom trim in single lengths to fit and cover bottom edges of mirrors. Locate top clips so they are symmetrically placed and evenly spaced. 5. Install mastic as follows: ' a. Apply barrier coat to mirror backing where approved in writing by manufacturers of mirrors and backing material. b. Apply mastic to comply with mastic manufacturer's writtea instructions for covenrge and to allow air circulation between back of mirrors and face of mounting surface. c. After mastic is applied, align mirrors and press into place while maintaining a minimum air space of l/8 inch (3 rnm) between back of mirrors and mounting surface. D. Protect mirrors from breakage and contaminating substance s rezulting from construction operations. E. Do not permit edges of mirrors to be exposed to standing water. F. Maintain environmental conditions that will prevent mirrors from being exposed to moisture from condelsation or other sources for continuous periods of time. END OF SECTION OE83O I I t T I I I I l I t I I I I I I I IMIRRORS08830 - 4 I 20021501.08 vAIL MoLJNTAIN LoDGE 3/zr/2004 ! I I SECTION087il -DOORHARDWARE -I PART I -GENERALt I r.l suMMARY -rt A. This Section includes the followine: - l. Commercial door hardware. 2. Cylinders for doors specified in other Sections. t 3. Electrified door hardware.r t- 1.2 SLJBMITTALS I A. Product Data: For each product indicated. I B. Shop Drawings: Include details of electrified door hardware and wiring diagrams. rt C. Samples: For each exposed finish.I t D. Door Hardware Schedule: Organized into door hardware sets indicating type, sfyle, function, size, label, hand, manufacturer, fasteners, location, and finish of each door hardware itern. I Include description ofeach electrified door hardware function, including sequance of operation. I- E. Keying Schedule: Detail Owner's final keying instructions for locks. I F. hoduct certificates.I I 1.3 eUALTTYASST.JRANCEt A. Supplier Qualifications: Person who is or employs a qualified DHI Architectural Hardware I Consultant. I B. Source Limitations: Obtain electrified door hardware from same manufacturer as mechanical I door hardware, unless otherwise indicated. Manufacturers lhat are listed to perform electrical I modifications, by a testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, are acceptable. I I C. Keying Conference: Conduct conference at hoject site. lncorporate keying conference " decisions into final keying schedule. I D. Preinstallation Conference: Conduct conference at Project site.r ,_ E. Keys: Deliver keys to Owner by registered mail. t F. Templates: Obtain and dishibute templates for doors, frames, and other work specified to be factory prepared for installing door hardware. I I DOORHARDWARE 08711 - I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOT]NTAIN LODGE 3/2U2004 G. Standards: Comply with BHMA 4.156 series standards, Grade l. H. Certifred Products: Provide door hardware that is listed in BHMA directory of certified Products. 1.4 WARRANTY A. Special Warranty: Manufacture/s standard form in which manufacturer agrees to repair or replace components of door hardwarc that fail in materials or workrnanship within warranty period. l. Warranty Period for Electromagretic Locks: Five years from date of Substantial Completion. 2. Wananty Period for Manual Closers: l0 years from date of Substantial Completion.3. Warranty Period for Concealed Floor Closers: Five years from date of Substantial Completion. I.5 EXTRAMATERIALS A. Fumish full-size units described below that match products installed and that are packaged with protective covering and identified with labels describing.contents. l. Door Hardware: <Insert detailed descriptions and specific numbers of units)2. Eleckical Parts: <Insert detailed descriptions and specific numbers of units.> PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MANUFACTI"JRERS A. Product: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide the product named for each door hardware item indicated in Door Hardware Sets. B. Basis-of-Design hoduct: Product named for each door hardware item indicated in Door Hardware Sets establishes the basis of design. Provide either the named product or a comparable product by one ofthe manufacturers specified for each type ofhardware item. 2.2 DOORHARDWARE A. Scheduled Door Hardware: Provide door hardware according to Door Hardware Sets at the end of Part 3. Manufacturers'names are abbreviated. 2.3 PIVOTS AND HINGES A. Manufacturers: I . Hinges: I I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I IDOORHARDWAREo87rr -2 I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTATN LoDGE 3t2t/2004l f| a. Baldwin Hardware Corporation (BH). I b. Bommer Indushies, Inc. (BI). c. Cal-Royal Products, Inc. (CRP). I d. Hager Cornpanies (HAG). I e. Lawrence Brothers, Inc. (LB). f. McKinney Products Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (MCK).' g. Mont-Hard Corporation; Div. of Fanal, SA (MH). I i 3l'"#il"qJ"t:'.tnnr.ornouny; Div. oIESSEX Industries, hrc. (sGr). j. Stanley Commercial Hardware; Div. of The Stanley Works (STH). ! 2. Pivots and Pivot Hinges: I a. DORMA Door Contols Inc.; Member of The DORMA Group (DC). I b. Hager Companies (HAG). c. Lawrence Brothers, Inc. (LB). I d. LCN Closerq an Ingersoll-Rand Company (LCN). I e. Markar Products, Inc. (MP). f. McKinney Products Company; Div. of ESSEX Indushies, Inc. (MCK). 1; g. NT Dor-O-Matic Hardware Div.; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTD). I h. Rixson-Firemark, Inc.; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (RIX). i. Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). I j. Stanley Commercial Hardware; Div. of The Stanley Works (STH). I! 3. Continuous Geared Hinges: I a. Hager Companies (HAG).I b. Markar Products, Inc. (Mp). c. McKinney Products Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc- (MCK). I d. Pemko Manufacturing Co., krc. (PEM). t e. Select Products Limited (SPL). f. Z.ero Intemational, hrc. (ZRO). I B. General: Except for hinges and pivots to be installed cntirely (both leaves) into wood doors and frames, provide only ternplate-produced units. I C. Hinge Base Metal: Unless otherwise indicated, provide the following: t- 1. Exterior Hinges: Brass, with stainless-steel pin body and brass protruding heads. f 2. Interior Hinges: Steel, with steel pin.I 3. Hinges for Fire-Rated Assemblies: Steel, with steel pin. I D. Nonremovable Pins: Provide set screw in hinge barrel that prevents removal of pin while door t is closed; for oulswinging exterior doors and outswinging corridor doors with locks. 11 E. Screws: Phillips flat-head screws; screw heads finished to match surface ofhinges. rr 1. Metal Doors and Frames: Machine screws (drilled and tapped holes). .. 2. Wood Doors and Frames: Wood screws. I 3. Fire-Rated Wood Doors: Threaded-to-the-head wood screws. I I DOORHARDWARE 08711-3 2002 I 501 .08 I t I I I I I T I I I I I I I l I I I B. C. D. E. 2.4 2.5 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE MECHANICAL LOCKS AND LATCHES Manufacfurers: l. 2. .). 3/21/2004 Accurate Lock and Hardware Co. (ALH). Adams Rite Manufacturing Co. (ARM). Architectural Builders Hardware Mfg., Inc. (ABH). Arrow Architectural Hardware; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (AAH). Best Lock Corporation (BLC). Brink, R. R. Locking Systems, Inc. (RRB). Cal-Royal Products, Inc. (CRP). Corbin Russwin Architectural Hardware; Div. of Yale Security krc. (CR). Door Controls International (DCI). Folger Adam Security Inc. (FAS). Glynn-Johnson; an lngersoll-Rand Company (GJ). Hager Companies (HAG). Ives, H. B. (fVS). Lockwood Architectural Hardware; Dv. of Lloyd Matheson Inc. (LAH). Marks USA (MKS). McKinney Products Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (MCK). Medeco High Security Locks, lnc. (MED). NT Falcon Lock Co.; an lngersoll-Rand Company (NTF). PDQ Manufacturing Co. (PDQ). Rockwood Manufacturing Company (RM). Sargent Manufacturing Company; Dv. of ESSEX Industries, krc. (SGT). Schlage Lock Company; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (SCH). Security Door Controls (SDC). Simplex; Div. of UNICAN (SM). Southern Steel Co.; Div. of Phelps-Tointon Inc. (SS). Triangle Brass Manufacturing Company, hrc. (TBM). Weiser Lock; Div. of Masco Building Products Corporation (WEI). Yale Security krc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAI). Bored Lockset Design: As scheduled. Dummy Trim: Match lever lock trim and escutcheons. Lock Throw: Comply with labeled fire door requirements. Backset: 2-314 inches (70 mm), unless othenvise indicated. ELECTRIFIED LOCKS AND LATCHES Electomagnetic Locks: Tested according to BHMA A156.23. 1. Manufacturers: a. American Device Manufacturing Cornpany; Member of The DORMA Group (ADM). b. Door Controls International (DC[). DOORHARDWARE 08711-4 d. e. f. o h. i. j. k. l. m. b. c. d. e. B. D. I I I t l I I I I I I I T I I I I I I 20021501.08 C. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/21/2004 Doorguard Systerns, Inc. (DGS). Dortronics Systems Inc. (DS). Dynalock Corp. (DLC). Locknetics Security Engineering; a Harrow Company (LSE). Rixson-Firemark, Inc.; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (RIX). Rutherford Controls Inc.; Div. of Fritz Fuss (RC). Sargent Manufacturing Company Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). Securitron Magralock Corp. (SMC). Security Door Controls (SDC). Von Duprin, lnc.; an hgersoll-Rand Company (VD). Yale Security lnc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). 2. Strength Ranking: 500 lbf (2224 N). 3. Inductive Kickback: Not more than 53V peak voltage. 4. Residual Magnetism: Not more than 0Jbf (0-N) force to separate door from magnet. Self-Contained Electronic Locks and Latches: Internal, battery-powered locks; consisting of complete lockset, motor-driven lock mechanism, and actuating device. Provide key override, low-battery detection and warning, LED status indicators, and ability to program at the lock. l. Manufacfurers: Best Lock Corporation (BLC). Cypress Computer Systems, Inc. (CYP). Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX lndustries, hc. (SGT). Simplex; Div. of UMCAN (SM). Yale Security Inc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). Electromechanical Locks and Latches: l. Manufacturers: a. b. c. d. e. f. g h. j. k. L Arrow Architectural Hardware; Div. of ESSEX lndustries, hrc. (AAH). Baldwin Hardware Corporation (BH). Best Lock Corporation (BLC). Brinlq R. R. Locking Systems, krc. (RRB). Corbin Russwin Architectural Hardware; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (CR). Folger Adam Security Inc. (FAS). Locknetics Security Engineering; a Harrow Company (LSE). Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). Schlage Lock Company; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (SCH). Security Door Connols (SDC). Southern Steel Co.; Div. of Phelps-Tointon Inc. (SS). Yale Security Inc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). Exit Locks: Surface-mounted deadbolts or latchbolts; with battery-powered alarm that sounds when unauthorized use of door occurs. Provide red and white pressure-sensitive letterins reading'PUSH TO OPEN--ALARM WILL SOI-IND." DOORHARDWARE 08711-5 2.6 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/21/2004 BOLTS Fire-Rated Doors: Comply with labeled fire door requirements. Surface Bolts: Flush bolt heads of minimum \/2-inch- (12.7-mm-) diameter rods of brass, bronze, or stainless steel with minimum l2-inch- (305-mm-) long rod, l. Manufacturers: Bums Manufacturing Incorporated (BM). Door Controls International (DCI). Glynn-Johnson; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (GJ). Hager Companies (HAG). Ives, H. B. (IVS). NT Quality Hardware; an Ingersoll-Rand Company G.na). Rockwood Manufacturing Company (RM). Triangle Brass Manufacturing Company, hrc. (TBM). Flush Bolts: BHMA Grade l, designed for mortising into door edge. l. Manufacfurers: Adrims Rite Manufacturing Co. (ARM). Burns M anufacturing Incorporated (BM). Cal-Royal Products, Inc. (CRP). Door Conhols International (DCI). Glynn-Johnson; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (GI). Hager Companies (HAG). Hiawatha, Inc. (HIA). Ives, H. B. (IVS). NT Quality Hardware; an lngersoll-Rand Company (NTQ). Rixson-Firemarlg hc.; Div. of Yale Security hrc. @D<). Rockwood Manufacturing Company (RM). Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). Triangle Brass Manufacturing Company, Inc. (TBM). 2.7 EXIT DEVICES A. Manufacturers: 1. Adams Rite Manufacturing Co. (ARM). 2. American Device Manufacturing Company; Member of The DORMA Group (ADM). 3. Arrow Architectural Hardware; Div. of ESSEX lndustries, Inc. (AAH). 4. Corbin Russwin Architectural Hardware; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (CR). 5. Door Conhols International (DCI). 6. Dynalock Corp. (DLC). 7. Locknetics Security Engineering; a Harrow Company (LSE). 8. NT Dor-O-Matic Hardware Div.; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTD). 9. NT Monarch Hardware; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (I{-IM). 10. Precision Hardware, Inc. (PH). I I I I I I t T I I I I I I t t I I I A. B. C. a. b. c. d. e. f. c. h. a. b. d. e. f. o h. i j. k. l. m. DOOR HARDWARE 08711 - 6 I 2002150r.08 vArL MoTJNTATN LoDGE 3/2v2004 ! I I l. Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX lndustries, krc. (SGT). t 12. Securiron Magnalock Corp. (SMC). 13. Von Duprin; an lngersoll-Rand Company (VD). t 14. Yale Security Inc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). t B. Panic Exit Devices: Listed and labeled for panic protection, based on testing according to - uL 305. - C. Fire Exit Devices: Complying with NFPA 80 that are listed and labeled for fire and panic I protection, based on testing according to UL 305 and NFPA 252. I l. Dummy Push Bar: Nonfunctioning push bar matching functional push bar. 2. Outside Trim: Pull with cylinder; material, finish, and desigr to match loclaets and I latchsets, unless otherwise indicated. fl 3. Through Bolts: For exit devices and trim on metal doors, non-fire-rated wood doors and fire-rated wood doors. r 2.8 OPERATINGTRM I A. Push-Pull Desigrr: As scheduled. 1 . Manufacturers: ll a. Baldwin Hardware Corporation (BH). b. Bums Manufacturing Incorporated (BM). I c. Don-Jo Mfg., Inc. (DJO). t d. Forms * Surfaces (FS). e. Hager Companies (HAG). I f. HEWI, hrc. (HEW). lJ C. Hiawatha, hc. (HIA). h. Ives,I{. B. (fVS). I i. NT Quality Hardware; an Ingersoll-Rand Cornpany Q'ma). ! j. Rockwood ManufacturingCompany (RM). k. Stanley Commercial Hardware; Div. of The Stanley Works (STH). I l. Triangle Brass Manufacturing Cornpany, Inc. (TBM). I 2.9 ACCESSORIES FOR PAIRS OF DOORS a A. Coordinators: BHMA A156.3- f l. Manufacturers: !a. Adams Rite Manufacturing Co. (ARM). b. Archirectural Builders Hardware Mfg., krc. (ABH). t c. Arrow Architectural Hardware; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (AAH). d. Door Controls hrternational (DCI). I i ffl#::H:l;#,HE;:"'.andcompanv(GJ)I s. Ives, H. B. (rvs). I I DOORHARDWARE 08711 - 7 2OO2I5OI.O8 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE h. NT Monarch Hardware; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTM). i. Precision Hardware, Inc. (PH). j. Rockwood Manufacturing Company (RM). k. Triangle Brass Manufacturing Company, Inc. (TBM). 2,10 A. B. Removable Mullions: BHMA A156.3. l. Manufacturers: a. Adams Rite Manufacturing Co. (ARM). b. American Device Manufacturing Company; Member of The DORMA Group (ADM). Arrow Architectural Hardware; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (AAH). Corbin Russwin Architectural Hardware; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (CR). NT Dor-O-Matic Hardware Div.; an Ingersoll-Rand Company Nm). NT Monarch Hardware; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTM). C. g. Precision Hardware, Inc. (PH). h. Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). i. Von Duprin; an lngersoll-Rand Company (VD).j. Yale Security Inc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). 2, Fire-Exit Removable Mullions: Complying with NFPA 80 that are listed and labeled for fire and panic protection, based on testing according to UL 305 and NFPA 252. Mullions shall be used only with exit devices for which they have been tested. Carry-Open Bars: Provide carry-open bars for inactive leaves of pairs of doors, unless automatic or self-latching bolts are used. CLOSERS Surface-Mounted Closers: l. Manufacturers: c. d. e. f. 3/2v2004 t I I I I t I I I I T t T I I T I t I Arrow Architectural Hardware; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (AAH). Cal-Royal Products, hc. (CRP). Corbin Russwin Architechral Hardware; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (CR). DORMA Door Contols Inc.; Member of The DORMA Group (DC). LCN Closers; an lngersoll-Rand Company (LCN). Norton Door Controls; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (NDC). Rixson-Firemark, Inc.; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (RIX). Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX lndustries, Inc. (SGT). Yale Security lnc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). Concealed Closers: 1 . Manufacturers: a. DORMA Door Controls Inc.; Member of Ttre DORMA Group (DC). b. LCN Closers; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (LCN). B. DOORHARDWARE 08711 - 8 I 20021501.08 vArL MoINTATN LoDGE 3t2r/2004r I c. Norton Door Controls; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (NDC). t d. NT Dor-O-Matic Hardware Div.; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTD). e. Rixson-Firemarb Inc.; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (RX). I f. Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). I g. Yale Security krc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). - C. Electromechanical Closers: ' l. Manufacturers: t a. Corbin Russwin Architectural Hardware; Div. of Yale Securify Inc. (CR).I b. Norton Door Controls; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (NDC). c. Rixson-Firemark, Inc.; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (RD(). I d. Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Indusfiies, krc. (SGT). I e. Yale Security lnc.; Div. ofWilliams Holdings (YAL). I D. Closer HolderRelease Devices: BHMA A156.15.I ll l. Manufacturers: t a. Corbin Russwin Architectural Hardware; Div. of Yale Security hc. (CR). b. DORMA Door Conhols tnc.; Member of The DORMA Group (DC).I :. k:ffi:'.l:'d;fff;B1l;l;l+;:Hll#T)'i*o., - e. Rixson-Firemark, Inc.; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (RX). I : i:1:1ffi*:lfri:?Ttiilh?';;ii,lilii^fiustries'hrc (sGr) r E. Flush Floor Plates: Finish cover olates for floor closers. unless thresholds are indicated. Match |, door hardware finish. I F. Recessed Floor Plates: Provide insert of floor finish material for floor closers. unless thresholds - are indicated. hovide extended closer spindle to accommodate thickness of floor finish. Ir G. Size of Units: Factory-sized, adjustable to meet field conditions and requirements for opening I force. t - 2.11 PROTECTryETRMUNITS I A. ProtectiveTrimUnits: Sizedl-ll2inches(38mrr)lessthandoorwidthonpushsideandll2 inch (13 mm) less than door width on pull side, by height scheduled or indicated. Fasten with I exposed machine or self{apping screws. !1. Material: Metal. ., a. Manufacfurers: I ll ffi1'tril1r"'#",t1l,i,kli;jtk,r 3) Baldwin Hardware Corporation (BH). I t DOORHARDWARE 08711 - 9 20021 501 .08 2.12 A. B. 2.t3 A. I T I I I t I I I I T I I I I T I I T 4) s) 6) 7) 8) e) l0) l1) r2) l3) l4) VAIL MOLINTAIN LODGE Bums Manufacturing lncorporated (BM). Don-Jo Mfg., Inc. (DJO). Hager Companies (HAG). Hiawatha, Inc. (HIA). IPC Door and Wall Protection Systems, Inc. (IPC). Ives, H. B. (rvS). NT Quality Hardware; an Ingersoll-Rand Company CI.{Ta). Pawling Corporation (PAW). Rockwood Manufacturing Company (RM). Triangle Brass Manufacturing Company, Inc. (TBM). Wilkinson Company, Inc. (W[). 3l2l/2004 STOPS ANDHOLDERS Stops and Holders: Provide floor stops for doors, unless wall or other type stops are scheduled or indicated. Do not mount floor stops where they will impede taffic. Where floor or wall stops ar€ not appropriate, provide overhead holders. 1. Manufacturers: Architectural Builders Hardware Mfg., Inc. (ABH). Baldwin Hardware Corporation (BH). Burns Manufacturing Incorporated (BM). Door Contols Intemational (DCI). DORMA Door Contols Inc.; Member of The DORMA Group (DC). Glynn-Johnson; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (GJ). Hager Companies (HAG). Hanchett Entry Systems, Inc. (HES). Hiawatha, Inc. (HIA). Ives, H. B. (IVS). LCN Closers; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (LCN). Norton Door Controls; Div. of Yale Security hrc. (NDC). NT Dor-O-Matic Hardware Div.; an lngersoll-Rand Company (NID). NT Quality Hardware; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTQ). Rixson-Firemark, lnc.; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (RIX). Rockwood Manufacturing Company (RM). Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). Triangle Brass Manufacturing Company, Inc. (TBM). Yale Security Inc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). Silencers for Door Frames: Neoprene or rubber; fabricated for drilled-in application to frame. DOOR GASKETING AND THRESHOLDS Door Gasketing: Provide continuous weather-strip gasketing on exterior doors and provide smoke, light, or sound gasketing on interior doors where indicated or scheduled. Provide noncorrosive fasteners for exterior applications and elsewhere as indicated. 1. Manufacfurers: DOORHARDWARE 08711- l0 I 20021501.08 vAIL MoLJNTAIN LoDGE 3t2tt2oo4I a. Gasketing:t l) Hager Conrpanies (HAG). |; 2) National Guard Products, Inc. (NGP). I 3) Pemko Manufacturing Co., Inc. (PEM). 4) Reese Enterprises, Inc. (RE). I 5) Sealeze Corporation (SEL). t 6) Ulha Industries; a Macklanburg-Duncan Company (ULT). 7) Zero International, Inc. (ZRO). t b. Door Bottoms:r I )\ fi:f;"1":iffi1lHil*[]'"" ^o,,t 3) Pemko Manufachrring Co., Inc. (PEM). 4) Reese Enterprises, Inc. @E). I 5) Sealeze Corporation (SEL). fJ 6) Ultra Industries; a Macklanburg-Duncan Company (ULT). 7) Zero Intemational, Inc. (ZRO). I 2. 'Air Leakage: Not to exceed 0.50 cfm per foot (0.000774 cu. m/s pL'r m) of crack length for gasketing other than for smoke control, as tested according to ASTM E 283- I 3. Smoke-Labeled Gasketing: Assemblies complying with NFPA 105 that are listed and I labeled, based on testing according to UL 1784.r 4. Fire-Labeled Gasketing: Assemblies complying with NFPA 80 that are listed and I 5 fj.ill'-il:#:'s:ffXffi,*.i:'JTJi.Y';",",?lH$'i^'i ,u0","0, based on restingf accordingtoAsTM E 1408. 6. Gasketing Materials: Comply with ASTM D 2000 and AAMA 7Ol/702.I I B. Thresholds: Oftype scheduled orindicated. I l. Manufacturers:r a. Hager Companies (HAG). b. National Guard Products, Inc. (NGP). ! c. NT Dor-O-Matic Hardware Div.; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTD). d. Pemko Manufacturing Co., Inc. (PEM). I I fiffT-Tf#:i:,*l;ff];"aresecurityrnc (RrX)I g. Ulha Indusfties; a Macklanburg-Duncan Company (ULT). h. Zero Intemational, Inc. (ZRO). r 2.14 MISCELLANEOUSDOORHARDWARE I I A. Boxed Power Supplies: Modular unit in NEMA ICS 6, Type 4 enclosure; filtered and regulated; and listed and labeled for use with fire alarrn systems. I I I DOORHARDWARE 08711 - l l 2002 I 501 .08 2.15 A. VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 312112004 T I I I t I I T T t I I I I I I I I I CYLINDERS, KEYING, AND STRIKES Cylinders: Tumbler type, constructed from brass or bronze, stainless steel, or nickel silver. l. Manufacturers: Same manufacturer as for locks and latches. ABLOY High Security Locks; Div. of ASSA ABLOY, Inc. (ABL). Arrow Architectural Hardware; Div. of ESSEX Industries, krc. (AAH). ASSA High Security Locks; Div. of ASSA ABLOY, hrc. (ASA). Best Lock Corporation (BLC). Corbin Russwin Architectural Hardware; Div. of Yale Security Inc. (CR). Lockwood Architectural Hardware; Div. of Lloyd Matheson Inc. (LAII). Marks USA (lvfl$). Medeco High Security Locks, hc. (MED). NT Falcon Lock Co.; an Ingersoll-Rand Company (NTF). Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX lndustries, Inc. (SGT). Schlage Lock Company; an lngersoll-Rand Company (SCH). Weiser Lock; a Masco Building Products Corporation (WEI). Yale Security lnc.; Div. of Williams Holdings (YAL). 2. Number of Pins: Six 3. High-Security Grade: BHMA Grade 1A, listed and labeled as complying withUL437 (Suffix A). 4. Permanent Cores: Manufacturer's standard; finish face to match lockset; interchangeable cores. 5. Construction Master Keys: Provide cylinders with feature that permits voiding of consruction keys without cylinder removal. Provide l0 construction master keys. 6. Constuction Cores: Provide construction cores that are replaceable by permanent cores. Provide 10 construction master keys. a. Replace construction cores with permanent cores, as directed by Owner. b. Fumish permanent cores to Owner for installation. Keying System: Factory-registered keying system; [no master] [master] [grand master] Igreat-grand master] key system. l. Keys: Provide nickel-silver keys permanently inscribed with a visual key control number and "DO NOT DUPLICATE" notation. In addition to one extra blank key for each lock, provide three change keys and five [master] [grand master] [great-grand master] keys. Key Control System: Include key-holding hooks, labels, key tags with self-locking key holders, envelopes, and markers. Contain system in [multiple-drawer] [wall-mounted] [portable] type metal cabinet with baked-enamel finish. Include cross-index system set up by key control manufacturer, with [card index] [computer software]. 1 . Manufacturers: a. Key Control Systems, Inc. (KCS). b. Major Metalfab Co. (MM). B. C, DOORHARDWARE 0871l - 12 I I t t I I I I I I I I T I I I 2.t6 A. 2OO2I5OI.O8 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3I21I2OO4 c. Sargent Manufacturing Company; Div. of ESSEX Industries, Inc. (SGT). d. Sumoc Corporation (SUN). e. <Insertmanufacturer.> Strikes: Manufacturer's standard strike with strike box for each latch or lock bolt, with curved lip extended to protect frame, finished to match door hardware set. FABRICATION Base Metals: Furnish metals of a quality equal to or greater than that of specified door hardware units and BHMAAI56.I8 for finishes. Do not fumish manufachner's standard materials if different from specified standard. Fasteners: Phillips flat-head screws with finished heads to match surface of door hardware, unless othenvise indicated. Provide steel machine or wood screws or steel through bolts for fire-rated applications. Spacers or Sex Bolts: For through bolting of hollow metal doors. Fasteners for Wood Doors: Comply with requirements of DHI WDHS.2, "Recommended Fasteners for Wood Doors." E. Finishes: Comply with BHMA A156.18. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTALLATION Examine doors and frames for compliance with requirements for installation tolerances, labeled fire door assembly construction, wall and floor construction, and other conditions affecting performance. Examine roughing-in for eleckical power systems to verify actual locations of wiring connections before electrified door hardware installation. Steel Door and Frame Preparation: Comply with DHI Al15 series. Drill and tap doors and frames for surface-applied hardware according to SDI 107. Wood Door Preparation: Comply with DHI A115-W series. Mounting Heights: Comply with the following requirements, unless otherwise indicated: 1. Standard Steel Doors and Frames: DHI's "Recommended Locations for Architecfural Hardware for Standard Steel Doors and Frames." 2. Custom Steel Doors and Frames: DHI's "Recommended Locations for Builders' Hardware for Custom Steel Doors and Frames." 3. Wood Doors: DHI WDHS.3. "Recommended Locations for Architectural Hardware for Wood Flush Doors." D. B. c. D. 3.1 B. C. D. I I I DOORHARDWARE 0871t - 13 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3t21/2004 Adjust and reinforce attachment subsfrates as necessary for proper installation and operation. Drill and countersink units that are not factory prepared for anchorage fasterers. Space fasteners and anchors according to industry standards. 1. Boxed Power Supplies: Locate power supplies as indicated or, if not indicated, in equipment room. Verifu location with Architect. a. Configuration: Provide the least number of power supplies required to adequately serve doors with elect-ified door hardware. 2. Thresholds: Set thresholds for exterior and acoustical doors in full bed of sealant complying with requirements specified in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants." Adjust door control devices to compensate for final operation of heating and ventilating equipment and to comply with accessibility requirements. L Door Closers: Adjust sweep period so that from an open position of 70 deg rees, the door will take at least three seconds to move to a point 3 inches (75 mm) from the latch, measured to the leading edge of the door. FIELD QUALITY CONTROL lnspections: Owner will engage a qualified independent Architectural Hardware Consultant to perform inspections and to prepare inspection reports. DOORHARDWARE SETS (See HW desigrrations on Door Schedules - do not confuse with lnterior Designer's Hardware sheets) GROUP l: Guestroom Entrv - Card Reader ( I ) Fully-mortised card-reader lockset. (1) Conducting hinge (finish to match lockset). (2) Heavy-duty hinges - one or more hinges to be adjustable self-closing spring tlpe; number of spring hinges to be determined by manufacturer's rating for weight of door I I I I I I I T t l I I I I I I I t I E. F. A. 3-Z J.J and exposure; finish to match lnterior Designer's lockset finish, typical all (l) Stop (as required by location). (l) Viewer (see Door Type drawings for mounting heights). (l) Smoke Seal. (l) Automatic Door Bottom. (l) Interior Door Latch. GROUP 2: Residence Entry - Lockset (l) Fully-mortised lockset, key/ thumb-turn. (3) Heavy-duty hinges - one or more hinges to be adjustable self-closing spring type; number of spring hinges to be determined by manufacturer's rating for weight of door hardware. hardware.and exposure; finish to match lnterior Desigrer's lockset finish, typical all (l) Stop (as required by location). (l) Viewer (see Door Type drawings for mounting heights). (1) Smoke Seal. DOORHARDWARE 0871I - 14 I 2oo2r5or.o8 VAIL MOUNTAINLODGE 3t2v2004 I (l) Automatic Door Bottom. t (l) Interior Door Latch. I GROUP 3: Interior Privacv - Bedrooms. Bathrooms. Water Closets I tfl p.ivacy Lockset (reference ID specification sheet for style and finish). (3) Hinges (match finish on lockset). (l) Stop (as required by location). - GROUP4: lnteriorDoubleClosetDoors I (a D".@cification sheet forstyle and finish). I (6) Hinges (match finish on lockset).I (2 sets) Heavy-duty ball-catch hardware mounted to top of leaves. (2) Stops (as required by location).I f GROUP 5: lnterior Passage - Residential -<r["ssage tocksei 6"r.."nce n specification sheet for style and finish). I (3) Hinges (match finish on lockset). t (l) Stop (as required by location). I GROUP 6: Storeroom. Closet. Mechanical I -11; storooom Lockset (reference ID specification sheet for style and finish). (3) Hinges (match finish on lockset). I (l) Stop (as required by location). I (l) Smoke Seal. (l) Door Bottom. ,r (l) KickPlate. I (l) closer' GROUP 7: Storeroom - Paired I (1) Dr--y L"""r(r.f.rence ID specification sheet for style and finish). - ( 1) Bolt Lockset (reference ID specification sheet for style and finish). (6) Hinges (match finish on lockset). I (2) Stops (as required by location). I (1) Smoke Seal. (2) Door Bottoms. I (2) Closers. ! GROUP 8: Office I ( I ) Privacy Lockset - Key/ Button (reference ID specification sheet for style and t finish)..^. -(3) Hinges (match finish on lockset). - (l) Stop (as required by location). I (l) Automatic Door Bottom.rF (1) Smoke Seal. ( I ) Closer. ! GROUP 9: Interior Passage - Restroom. Spa, Elevator @tion sheet for style and finish). I ( I ) Pull (reference ID specification sheet for style and finish). I (3) Hinges (match finish on lockset). (l) Stop (as required by location). I I DOORHARDWARE 08711- 15 20021501.08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE ( I ) Closer. (3) Silencers. (l) Kick Plate. (l) Smoke Seal (fire rated conditions only). (l) Door Bottom (fire rated conditions only). ( I ) Reuse existing coordinating hardware at all elevator locations. GROUP l0: Resfroom Stall (l) Privacy Loclaet (reference ID specification sheet forstyle (3) Hinges (match finish on lockset). (l) CoatHook. GROUP l1: Exit (l) Panic Device. (l) Passage Lever (3) Hinges (match finish on lockset). (t) Closer. (1) KickPlate. (1) Smoke Seal.(1) Door Bottom (fire rated conditions only). GROUP 12: Corridor Passage - Paired (2) Panic Device (reuse existing when possible). (2) Passage Levers or pulls (6) Hinges (match finish on lockset). (2) Elecfronic Hold Open devices (as required by location, wire to existing fre alarm system, reuse existing when possible). (2) Closer. (2) Kick Plate. (l) Smoke Seal. (2) Automatic Door Bottom (fire rated conditions only). GROUP 13: Garaee Door(1) Over-Head Rolling Door with electric drive. GROUP 14: Exterior Elecbical Closet (2) Flush Bolts (reference ID specification sheet forstyle and finish) (2) Pulls (finish to match lockset). (6) Heavy-duty exterior-grade hinges (match finish on lockset). (l) Weather stripping. END OF SECTION O87I I 3/21t2004 and finish). I I I t I I I t T I t I I I I I I I I DOORHARDWARE 08711- 16 I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTATN LoDGE 3tz2/2004I II SECTTON 08830 - MTRRORS I PART1 -GENERAL I r.r suMMARYI A. This Section includes the following:It l. Annealed monolithic glass minors. I 1.2 SUBMTTTALS I A. Product Data: For mirror hardware and mastic. t B. Shop Drawings: Include mirror elevations, edge details, mirror hardware, and attachments to other work. I C. Samples: For each type of mirror product required, in the form indicated below: I 1. Mirrors, 12 inches (300 mm) square, including edge featrnent on 2 adjoining edges. I 2. Mirror clips. 3. Mirror rinl l2 inches (300 mm) long. I D. Product Certificates: For each t)?e of mirror and mirror mastic, signed by product manufacturer. t, I E. Mirror Mastic Compatibility Test Reports: From mirror manufacturer. I 1.3 euALTTYASSURANcEI A. Glazing Publications: Comply with GANA's "Glazing Manual" and GANA Mirror Division's I "Mirrors, Handle with Extreme Care: Tips for the hofessional on the Care and Handling of I Mirrorsn unless more stringent requirements are indicated I B. Preconstruction Mirror Mastic Compatibility Test: Submit mirror mastic products to mirror t manufacturer for testing to determine compatibility of mastic with mirror backing paint and subshates on which mirrors are installed. Ir 1.4 DELryERY, STORAGE.ANDHANDLING I A. Comply with mirror manufacturer's written instructions for shipping, storing, and handling I mirrors as needed to prevent deterioration of silvering, damage to edges, bnd abrasion of glass surfaces and applied coatings. Store indoors, protected from moisture including condensation.I I I MIRRORS 08830 - IIr 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3t22t2004 I.5 WARRANTY A. Special Warranty: Manufacturer's standard form, made out to Ovi'ner and signed by mirror manufacturer agreeing to replace mirrors that deteriorate, f.o.b. lhe nearest shipping point to Project site, within specified warranty period indicated in second subparagraph below. l. Deterioration of Mirrors: Defects developed from normal use that are attributable to the manufacturing process and not to causes other than glass breakage and practices for maintaining and cleaning mirrors confrary to mirror manufacturer's written instructions. Defects include discoloration, black spots, and clouding of the silver film.2. Warranty Period: Five years from date of manufacture. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2,1 SILVERED FLAT GLASS MIRROR MATERI,ALS A. Clear Glass Mirrors: ASTM C 1503, Mirror Glazing Quality. l. Nominal Thiclness: 3.0 mm. MISCELLANEOUS MATERI,ALS Setting Blocks: Elastomeric material with a Type A Shore durometer hardness of 85, plus or minus 5. Edge Sealer: Coating compatible with glass coating and ap,proved by mirror manufachrer for use in protecting against silver deterioration at mirrored glass edges. Mirror Mastic: An adhesive setting compound, produced specifically for setting mirron and certified by both mirror manufacturer and mastic manufacturer as compatible with glass coating and substates on which minors will be installed. l. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: a. Gunther Mirror Mastics. b. Palmer Products Corporation. MIRRORHARDWARE Top and Bottom Aluminum J-Channels: Aluminum extrusions with a retum deep enough to produce a glazing channel to accommodate mirrors of thickness indicated and in lengths required to cover bottom and top edges ofeach mirror in a single piece. 1. Bottom Trim: J-channels formed with front leg and back leg not less than 5/16 and 3/4 inch (7.9 and l9 mm) in height, respectively. I I I I I 2.2 I I T I I T I I I I t I I I B. 2.3 MIRRORS 08830 - 2 B. c. A. B. C. B. c. 2.4 3.1 T I I I I t I I I I t I t t I t I I I 2002 l50l .08 VAIL MOIINTAIN LODGE 3/22t2004 2. Top Trim: Formed with front leg with a height of 5il6 inch (7.9 mm) and back leg desigred to fit into the pocket created by wall-mounted aluminum cleat.3. Product: Subject to cornpliance with requirements, provide the following: a. Bottom Trim: C. R. Laurence Co., Inc.; D638 FHA Type "J" Channel.b. Top Trim: C. R. Laurence Co., Inc.; D 1638 Top Channel.c. Cleat: C. R. Laurence Co., Inc.; D 1637M Mirror Mount System Cleat. Fasteners: Fabricated of same basic metal and alloy as fastened metal and matching it in hnished color and texture where fasteners are exposed. Anchors and Inserts: hovide devices as required for mirror hardware installation. Provide toothed or lead-shield expansion-bolt devices for drilled-in-place anchors. Provide galvanized anchors and inserts for applications on inside face of exterior walls and where indicated. FABRICATION Mirror Sizes: To suit hoject conditions, cut mirrors to final sizes and shapes. Cutouts: Fabricate cutouts for notches and holes in mirrors without marring visible swfaces. Locate and size cutouts so they fit closely around penetrations in mirrors. Minor Edge Treatment: Flat polished edge. l. Seal edges of mirrors after edge teatmealt to prevent chemical or atrnospheric penetration ofglass coating. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTALLATION General: lnstall mirrors to comply with mirror manufacturer's written instructions and with referenced GANA publications. Mount mirrors accurately in place in a manner that avoids distorting reflected images. hovide a minimum air space of 1/8 inch (3 mm) between back of mirrors and mounting surface for air circulation between back of mirrors and face of mounting surface. For wall-mounted mirrors, install with mastic and mirror hardware. l. Attach mirror hardware securely to mounting surfaces with mechanical fasteners installed with anchors or inserts as applicable. Install fasteners so heads do not impose point loads on backs of mirrors.2, For mirror hardware in the form of continuous J-channels at bottom, provide setting blocks l/8 inch (3 mm) thick by 4 inches (100 nrm) long at quartef, points. To prevent trapping water, provide, between setting blocks, 2 slotted weeps not less than 1/4 inch (6.4 mm) wide by 3/8 inch (9.5 mm) long.3. For metal or plastic clips, place a felt or plastic pad between mirror and each clip to prevent spalling of minor edges. MIRRORS 08830 - 3 2002 150 I .08 VAIL MOI.JNTAIN LODGE 3t22/2004 4. Wlere indicated, install bottom trim and top clips. Fabricate bottom trim in single lengths to fit and cover bottom edges of mirrors. Locate top clips so they are symmetrically placed and evenly spaced.5. Inslall mastic as follows: a. Apply barrier coat to mirror backing where approved in writing by manufacturers of mirrors and backing material. b. Apply mastic to comply with mastic manufacfiner's written instructions for coverage and to allow air circulation between back of mirrors and face of mounfing surface. c. After mastic is applied, aligr mirrors and press into place while maintaining a minimum air space of 1/8 inch (3 mm) between back of mirrors and mounting surface. D. hotect mirrors tom b,reakage and contaminating substances resulting from constuction operations. E. Do not permit edges of mirrors to be exposed to standing water. F. Maintain ervironmental conditions that urill prevent mirrors from being exposed to moisture from condensation or other sources for continuous periods of time. END OF SECTION 08830 T I I I I I I T I I t I I I t I I I I MIRRORS 08830 - 4 ! 20021501.08 vArL MotrNTtAN LoDcE 3/2r/2004I I SECTION 09260 - cypsuM BOARD ASSEMBLIES I PART I -GENERAL I 1.1 suMMARYI A. This Section includes the following: I l. Interiorgypsumwallboard.2. Tilebackingpanels. I 3. Non-load-bearing steel framing. I T 1.2 SUBMITTALSrA. Product Data: For each product indicated. I B. Samples: For each textured finish indicated and on same backing indicated for Work.! I 1.3 QUALTTY ASSI'RANCErA. Fire-TesfResponse Characteristics: For g)?sum board assemblies with fire-resistance ratings, I provide materials and construction identical to those tested in assembly indicated according to I ISTM E l19 by an independent testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. I B. Sound Transmission Characteristics: For gypsum board assemblies with STC ratings, providet materials and construction identical to iirbse tested in assembly indicated according to ASTM E 90 and classified according to ASTM E 4l3by a qualified independent testing agency. a C. Mockups: Beforefinishinggypsumboardassemblies,installmockupsofatleastl00sq.ft.(9 sq. m) in surface area to dernonstrate aesthetic effects and qualities of materials and execution.- I l. Install mockups for the following applications: I a. Surfaces with texture finishes. I b. Surfaces indicated to receive nontextured paint finishes.c. Surfaces indicated to receive textured paint finishes. I 2. Simulate finished lighting conditions for review ofrnockups.I I I I I GYPSI]M BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 - I 20021501.08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOI'NTIAN LODGE 3/21/2004 2,1 MANUFACTURERS A. In other Part 2 articles where subparagraph titles below inhoduce lists, the following requirements apply for product selection: l. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the products specified. 2.2 STEELFRAMING A. Steel Framing, General: Comply with ASTM C 754 fq conditions indicated. l. Steel Sheet Components: Metal complying with ASTM C 645 requirements. I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I a. Protective Coating: l) lnterior Applications: manufacturer's standard coating. 2) Exterior Applications: ASTM A 653/A 653M,' galvanized zinc coating. B. Suspended Ceiling and Soffit Framing: corrosion-resistant zinc G60 (2180), hofdip 1. Tie Wire: ASTM A&llA64.lM, Class I zinc coating, soft temper, 0.0625-inch- (1.59- mm-) diameter wire, or double strand of 0.0475-inch- ( I .21 -mm-) diameter wire. 2. Hanger Attachments to Concrete: a. Anchors: Fabricated from corrosion-resistanl materials with holes or loops for attaching hanger wires and capable of sustaining, without failure, a load equal to 5 times that imposed by construction as determined by testing according to ASTM E 488 by a qualified independent testing agency. I ) Type: Cast-in-place anchor, designed for attachment to concrete forms. b. Powder-Actuated Fasteners: Suitable for application indicated, fabricated from corrosion-resistant materials, with clips or otler devices for attaching hangers of type indicated, and capable of sustaining, without failure, a load equal to l0 times that imposed by construction as determined by testing according to ASTM E 1190 by a qualified independent testing agency. 3. Wire Hangers: ASTMA 641/A6/-Illl, Class I zinc coating, soft temper, 0.162-inch (4.12-mm) diameter. 4. Carrying Channels: Cold-rolled, commercial-steel sheet with a base metal thickness of 0.0538 inch (1.37 mm), a minimum l/2-inch- (12J-mm-7 wide flange, and in depth indicated. 5. Furring Channels (Furring Members): GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 -2 D. I T I t I I I I I I I T I I t I I t I 2002 r 50r .08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3/21/2004 a. Cold Rolled Channels: 0.0538-inch (1.37-mm) bare steel thickness, with minimum 1 12 -inch- ( I 2.7-mm-) wide fl ange, 3 / 4 inch ( I 9. I mm ) deep. b. Steel Studs: ASTM C 645, in depth indicated. l) Minimum Base Metal Thickness: 0.0312 inch (0.79 mm) unless otherwise indicated. c. Hat-Shaped, Rigid Furring Channels: ASTM C U5,718 inch (.22.2 mm) deep. l) Minimum Base Metal Thiclrress: 0,0312 inch (0.79 mnt) unless otherwise indicated. d. Resilient Furring Channels: 112-inch- (12.7-rrm-) deep members designed to reduce sound fransmission, and asymmetrical with single leg or hat shaped with two legs. Grid Suspension System for Interior Ceilings: ASTM C 645, direct-hung system composed of main beams and cross-furrins members that interlock. I . Available Products: a. Armstrong World Industries, Inc.; Furring SystemVDrywall. b. . Chicago Metallic Corporation; Drywall Furring 660 System. c. USG Interiors, Inc.; Drywall Suspension System. Partition and Soffit Framing: 1. Steel Studs and Runners: ASTM C 645, in depth indicated. a. Minimum Base Metal Thickness: 0.0312 inch (0.79 mm). 2. Proprietary Deflection Track: Steel sheet top runner manufactured to prevent cracking of gypsum board applied to interior partitions resulting from deflection of skucture above; in thickness indicated for studs and in width to accommodate depth of studs. a. Available Products: l) Delta Star, lnc., Superior Metal Trim; Superior Flex Track System (SFI). 2) Metal-Lite, lnc.; Slotted Track. 3. Proprietary Firestop Track: Top runner manufactured to allow partition heads to expand and contact with movement of the structure while maintaining continuity of fire- resistance-rated assembly indicated; in thickness not less than indicated for studs and in width to accommodate depth of studs. a. Available Products: l) Fire Trak Corp.; Fire Trak attached to studs with Fire Trak Slip Clip.2) Metal-Lite, Inc.; The Systern. 4. Flat Strap and Backing Plate: Steel sheet for blocking and bracing in length and width indicated. GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 -3 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t2v2004 a. Minimum Base Metal Thickness: 0.0179 inch 10.45 mn). Cold-Rolled Channel Bridging: 0.0538-inch (I.-i7-mnr) bare steel thickness, with minimum | /2-inch- ( 12.7-mm-) wide flange, and in depth indicated. a. Clip Angle: 1-112by 1-l/2 inch (38.1 b.v- 38.1 mnr),0.068-inch- (1.73-mm-) thick, galvanized steel. Hat-Shaped, Rigid Funing Channels: ASTM C 645, in depth indicated. a. Minimum Base Metal Thickness: 0.0179 inch (0.45 mm). Resilient Furring Channels: ll2-inch- (12.7-mm-) deep, steel sheet members designed to reduce sound transmission. Asymmetrical or hat shaped, with face attached to single flange by a slotted leg (web) or attached to tu'o flanges by slotted or expanded metal legs. Cold-Rolled Furring Channels: 0.0538-inch (1.37-mm) bare steel thickness, with minimum l/2-inch- (12.7-mm) wide flange, and in depth indicated. a. Furring Brackets: Adjustable, cornrgated-edge type of steel sheet with minimum bare steel thickness of 0.0312 inch (0.79 nrm). b. Tie Wire: ASTM A 64ll[64lM, Class I zinc coating, soft temper, 0.0625-inch- (1.59-mm-) diameter wire, or double strand of 0.0475-inch- (1.21-mm-) diameter wrre- Z-Shaped Furring: With slotted or nonslotted web, face flange of l-l/4 inches (31.3 mm), wall attachment flange of 7/8 inch (22.2 mm), minimum bare metal thickness of 0.0179 inch (0.a5 mm), and depth required to fit insulation tbickness indicated. Fasteners for Metal Framing: Of type, material, size, corrosion resistance, holding power, and other properties required to fasten steel members to substrates. PANELPRODUCTS Panel Size, General: Provide in maximum lengths and widths available that will minimize joints in each area and correspond with support system indicated. Gypsum Wallboard: ASTM C 36. l. Regular Type: In thickness indicated and with long edges tapered. 2. Type X: ln thickness indicated and with long edges tapered. Flexible Gypsum Wallboard: ASTM C 36, manufactured to bend to fit tight radii and to be more flexible than standard regular-type panels of the same thickness, l/4 inch (6.4 mm) thick, and with long edges tapered. Apply in double layer at curved assemblies. Sag-Resistant Gypsum Wallboard: ASTM C 36, manufactured to have more sag resistance than regular-type gypsum board, 1 2 inch \12.7 n.un) thick, and with long edges tapered. Apply on ceiling surfaces. t I I I I I I t I I t I I II I I I I I 5. 6. 8. 9. 10. A. B. C. D. 2.3 GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 - 4 I 2002150r.08 vAILMoLJNTIAN LoDGE 3l2rt20o4 I I E. Proprietary, Special Fire-Resistive Type: ASTM C 36, having improved fire resistance over I standard Type X, complying with requirements of fire-resistance-rated assemblies indicated, in thickness indicated, and with long edges tapered. I F. Paper-Surfaced Gypsum Wall Sheathing: ASTMC 791C79M, with water-resistant material incorporated into core and with water-repellent paper bonded to core's face, back" and long - edges. r 1. Available Manufacturers: r I *"8ifr,ff"":#"1";", c. National Gypsum Company. d. United States Gypsum Co. I 2. Type and Thickness: Type X, 5/8 inch (15.9 mm) thick. ft 3. Edge and End Configuration: Square. I G. Glass-Mat Gypsum Wall Sheathing: ASTM C ll77lc ll77M. I l. Prodtrct: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide "Dens-Glass Gold" by G-P Gypsum Corp. 2. Type and Thickness: Type X, 5/8 inch (15.9 mm) thick. r H. Exterior Gypsum Panels for Ceilings and Soffits: I l. Exterior Gypsum Soffit Board: ASTM C 93llc 931M, with core type and in thickness t indicated and with manufacturer's standard edges. 2. Glass-Mat G1rysum Sheathing Board: ASTM C ll77lc 117TM, with core type and in thickness indicated. I a. Product: G-P Gypsum Corp; Dens-Glass Gold. I I. Tile Backing Panels:t l. Water-Resistant Glpsum Backing Board: ASTM C 630/C 630M, with core type and in I thickness indicated.! 2. Glass-Mat, Water-Resistant Backing Board: ASTM C ll73lc 1178M, with core type and in thickness indicated. t a. Product: G-P Gypsum Corp.; Dens-Shield Tile Backer. t 3. Cementitious Backer Units: ANSI Al18.9, in thickness indicated. t 2.4 TRIM ACCESSORIES I- A. lnteriorTrim: ASTMC 1047. I l. Comerbead: Use at outside comers, unless otherwise indicated. l| 2. Bullnose Bead: Use where indicated. 3. LC-Bead: Useatexposedpaneledges. ! GYPST]M BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 - 5 I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOLJNTIAN LODCE 3t21/2004 I I I I I I I I I I I I t II I 4. L-Bead: Use where indicated. 5. U-Bead: Use where indicated. 6. Expansion (Control) Joint: Use where indicated. 7. Curved-Edge Comerbead: With nolched or flexible flanges; use at curved openings. B. Exterior Trim: ASTM C 1047, hot-dip galvanized steel sheet or rolled zinc. Cornerbead: Use at outside corners. LC-Bead: Use at exposed panel edges. Expansion (Connol) Joint: One-piece, rolled zinc with V-shaped slot and removable strip covering slot opening. Use where indicated. JOINT TREATMENT MATERIALS General: Comply with ASTM C 475. Joint Tape: 1. lnterior Gypsum Wallboard: Paper. 2. Exterior Gypsum Soffit Board: Paper. 3. Glass-Mat Gypsum Sheathing Board: l0-by-10 glass mesh. 4. Tile Backing Panels: As recommended by panel manufacturer. Joint Compound for lnterior Gypsum Wallboard: For each coat use formulation that is compatible with other compounds applied on previous or for successive coats. 1. Prefilling: At open joints and damaged surface areas, use setting-type taping compound. 2. Embedding and First Coat: For embedding tape and first coat onjoints, flanges oftrim accessories, and fasteners, use setting-type taping compound. a. Use setting-type conrpound for installing paper-faced metal trim accessories. 3. Fill Coat: For second coat, use setting-type, sandable topping compound. 4. Finish Coat: For third coat, use setting-type, sandable topping compound. 5. Skim Coat: For final coat of Level 5 finish, use setting-type, sandable topping compound. Joint Compound for Exterior Applications: l. Exterior Gypsum Soffit Board: Use setting-type taping and setting-type, sandable topping compounds. 2. Glass-Mat Gypsum Sheathing Board: As recommended by manufacturer. Joint Compound for Tile Backing Panels: l. Water-Resistant Gypsum Backing Board: Use setting-type taping and setting-type, sandable topping compounds. 2. Glass-Mat, Water-Resistant Backing Panel: As recommended by manufacturer. 3. Cementitious Backer Units: As recommended bv manufacturer. l. 2. 3. 2.5 A. B. C. D. I I I I GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 - 6 I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTtAN LoDGE 3lzvzoo4I I 2,6 AUXILIARYMATERIALS I A. General: hovide auxiliary materials that comply with referenced installation standards and I manufacfurer's written recommendations. B. Acoustical Sealant for Exposed and Concealed Joints: Nonsag, paintable, nonstaining, latex I sealant complying with ASTM C 834 that effectively reduces airborne sound transmission I through perimeter joints and openings in building construction as demonstrated by testing representative assemblies according to ASTM E 90. I l. AvailableProducts:I a. Pecora Corp.; AC-20 FTR Acoustical and Insulation Sealant.b. United States Gypsum Co.; SHEETROCK Acoustical Sealant.r C. Acoustical Sealant for Concealed Joints: Nondrying, nonhardening, nonskinning, nonstaining, I gunnable, synthetic-rubber sealant recorrmended for sealing interior concealed joints to reduce I airbome sound transmission. 1. Available Products: I a. Ohio Sealants, lnc.; Pro-Series SC-170 Rubber Base Sound Sealant.b. Pecora Corp.; BA-98. f c. Tremco, Inc.; Trernpo Acoustical Sealant. D. Steel Drill Screws: ASTM C 1002. unless otherwise indicated. t 1. Use screws cornplfng with ASTM C 954 for fastening panels to steel members from 0.033 to 0.112 inch (0.84 to 2.84 mm) thick. || 2. For fastening cementitious backer units, use screws of type and size recommended by I panel manufacturer. r E. Isolation Strip at Exterior Walls: It l. Asphalt-Saturated Organic Felt: ASTM D 226, Type I (No. 15 asphalt felt), I 2. i::fftH:f"l Adhesive-backed, closed-cetl vinyt foam strips that allow fastenerf penetration without foam displacement, l/8 inch (3.2 mm) thici, in width to suit steel stud size. I F. Sound Barrier: Un-reinforced, mass loaded, flexible, vinyl based polymer barrier with no lead fillers. I . Available Manufacturers: a. MidwestFiber-GlassCorporation. b. Acoustic Surfaces, Inc.c. Acoustical Solutions, Inc. d. Raven lndustries. lnc. 2. Thickness: l/8" or 0.105 inches minimum. GYPSIJM BOARD ASSEMBLIES t t I I I 09260 -7 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/21t2004 PART 3 - EXECUTION NON.LOAD-BEARING STEEL FRAMING INSTALLATION General: comply with ASTM c754, and ASTM c g40 requirements that apply to framing installation. Suspended Ceiling and Soffit Framing: l. Suspend ceiling hangers plumb and free from contact with insulation or other objectswithin ceiling plenum that- are not part of supporting stuctural or ceiling suspensionsystem. Splay hangers only where required to miss obsfuctions and ofiset resulting horizontal forces by bracing, countersplaying, or other equally effective means. T t I t I I I t I II I I I I t t I I II G. J. B. J.l 3. STC: 27 Minimum. 4. Density: I pound per square foot.5. Stiffness: 26Mpa 6. Tensile: 450 psi, Min 7 . Color: Black or clear- Building wrap: Air-retarder sheeting made from polyolefins; cross-laminated films, woven strands, or spun-bonded fibers; coated or uncoated; with or without perforations; and complying with ASTM E 1677,Typel. l AvailableManufacturers: a. Celotex Corporation (Ihe); Building products Dvision.b. DuPont (8. I. du Pont de Nemours and Company).c. Parsec, Inc.d. Raven lndustries, Inc.e. Reemay, Inc.f. Simplex Products. C. Sto-Cote Products, lnc.h- Tenneco Building Products. 2. Thickness: Not less than 3 mils (0.08 mm).3. Permeance: Not less than l0 perms (-i75 ng/pa x s x sq. nr.).4. Flame-Spread Index: 25 or less per ASTM E g4. 5. Allowable Exposure Time: Not less than three months. Building wrap Tape: Pressure-sensitive plastic tape recommended by building wrap manufacturer for sealingjoints and penetrations in building wrap. Sheathing Tape: Pressure-sensitive plastic tape for sealing joints and penetrations in sheathing and recommended by sheathing manufacturer for use with type of sheathing required. Sill-Sealer Gaskets: Glass-fiber-resilient insulation, fabricated in strip form, for use as a sillsealer; I -inch (25-rnnr) nominal thickness, compressible to l/32 inch l0.g min); selected from manufacturer's standard widths to suit width of sill members indicated. GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 - 8 D. 3.2 I t I T I I I I t t I t T I T t t I I 2002r 501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t21/2004 2. Where width of ducts and other construction within ceiling plenum produces hanger spacings that interfere with the location of hangers required to support standard suspension system members, install supplemental suspension members and hangers in form of trapezes or equivalent devices. Size supplernental suspension members and hangers to support ceiling loads within performance limits established by referenced standards.3. Attach hangers to structural members. Do not support ceilings from or attach hangers to permanent metal forms, steel deck tabs, steel roof decks, ducts, pipes, or conduit.4' Wire-tie furring channels to supports, as required to comply with requirements for assemblies indicated.5. Grid Suspension System: Attach perimeter wall track or angle where grid suspension system meets vertical surfaces. Mechanically join main beam and cross-furring members to each other and butt-cut to fit into wall hack. C. Partition and Soffit Framing: l. Where studs are installed directly against exterior walls, install isolation strip between studs and wall.2. Extend partition framing full height to structural supports or substrates above suspended ceilings, except where partitions are indicated to terminate at suspended ceilings. Continue framing over frames for doors and openings and frame around ducts penetrating partitions above ceiling to provide support for glpsum board.3. Frame door openings to cornply with GA-600 and with gypsum board manufacturer's applicable written recommeadations, unless othenvise indicated. Screw vertical'studs at jambs to jamb anchor clips on door frames; install runner back section (for cripple studs) at head and secure to jamb studs. a. Install two studs at each jamb, unless otherwise indicated.b' Extend jamb studs though suspended ceilings and attach to underside of floor or roof strucfure above. 4. Frame openings other tian door openings the same as required for door openings, unless otherwise indicated. Install framing below sills of openings to match framing required abol-e door heads. Z-Furring Members: Erect insulation vertically and hold in place with Z-furring members. 1. Until gypsum board is installed, hold insulation in place with l0-inch (250-rrrnr) staples fabricated from 0.0625-inch- (1.59-mm-) diameter, tie wire and inserted through slot in web of member. Polyethylene Vapor Retarder: Install to comply with requirements specified in Division 7 Section "Building Insulation." PANEL PRODUCT INSTALLATION Gypsum Board: Comply with ASTM C 840 and GA-216. Space screws a maximum of 12 inches (304.8 mm) o.c. for vertical applications. space fasteners in panels that are tile substrates a maximum of 8 inches (203.2 .um) o.c. l. 2. GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 -9 20021501.08 VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE 312U2004 3. On ceilings, apply glpsum panels before walVpartition board application to the greatest extent possible and at right angles to framing, unless otherwise indicated. 4. On partitions/walls, apply gypsum panels vertically (parallel to framing), unless otherwise indicated or required by fire-resistance-rated assemblv. and minimize end joints. a. Stagger abutting end joints not less than one framing member in alternate courses ofboard. b. At stairwells and other high walls, install panels horizontally, unless otherwise indicated or required by fire-resistance-rated assembly. 5. On Z-furring members, apply glpsum panels vertically (parallel to framing) with no end joints. Locate edge joints over furring members. 6. Single-Layer Fastening Methods: Apply g1rysum panels to supports with steel drill screws. 7. Multilayer Fastening Methods: Fasten base layers and face layers separately to supports with screws. 8. Laminating to Substrate: Comply with gypsum board manufacturer's written recommendations and temporarily brace or fasten g)?sum panels until fastening adhesive has set. B. Exterior Ceilings and So{fits: Apply exterior gypsum panels perpendicular to supports, with end joints staggered and located over supports. 1. Fasten with corrosion-resistant screws. C. Building Wrap Application: Cover exterior wall sheathing with building wrap as indicated. Cover upstanding flashing with 4-inch (102-mm) overlap. Seal seams, edges, and penehations with tape. D. Apply sheathing tape to joints between sheathing panels and at items penehating sheathing. Apply at upstanding flashing to overlap both flashing and sheathing. E. Tile Backing Panels: l. Water-Resistant Gypsum Backing Board: Install with l/4-inch (6.4-mm) gap where panels abut other consbuction or penetrations. 2. Glass-Mat, Water-Resistant Backing Panel: lnstall with ll4-inch (6.4-mm) gap where panels abut other construction or penetrations. 3. Cementitious Backer Unit Application: ANSI Al08.l l. 3.3 FINISHING A. Installing Trim Accessories: For trim with back flanges intended for fasteners, attach to framing with same fasteners used for panels. Otherwise, attach him according to manufacturer's written insffuctions. B. Finishing Gypsum Board Panels: Treat gypsum board joints, interior angles, edge trim, control joints, penetrations, fastener heads, surface defects, and elsewhere as required to prepare gypsum board surfaces for decoration. I t I t I t I t I t II I I II I t I t I GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 - 10 2. J. 4. l. 2. J. 4. 5. C. D. I I I t I I I I I I t I I T I I t I t 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2r/2004 Prefill openjoints and damaged surface areas. Apply joint lape over gypsum board joints, except those with trim having flanges not inlended for tape. Glass-Mat Gypsum Sheathing Board: Finish according to manufacturer's written instructions for use as exposed soffit board. Glass-Mat, Water-Resistant Backing Panels: Finish according to manufacturer's written instructions. Cementitious Backer Units: Finish according to manufacturer's written instructions. Gypsum Board Finish Levels: Finish panels to levels indicated below, according to ASTM C 840, for locations indicated: Level l: Embed tape at joints in ceiling plenum areas, concealed areas, and where indicated, unless a higher level of finish is required for fire-resistance-rated assemblies and sound-ra1ed assemblies. Level2 Embed tape and apply separate first coat ofjoint compound to tape, fasteners, and trim flanges where panels are substrate for tile and where indicated. Level 3: Embed tape and apply separate hrst and filI coats ofjoint compound to tape, fasteners, and trim flanges where indicated. Level 4: Embed tape and apply separate first, fill, and finish coats ofjoint cornpound to tape, fasteners, and trim flanges at panel surfaces that will be exposed to view, unless otherwise indicated. Level 5: Embed tape and apply separate first, fill, and finish coats ofjoint compound to tape, fasteners, and trim flanges, and apply skim coat of joint compound over entire surface at panel surfaces where indicated. END OF SECTION 09260 GYPSUM BOARD ASSEMBLIES 09260 - l l I t I I I t 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE SECTION 09265 . GYPSUM BOARD SHAFT.WALL ASSEMBLIES PART I - GENERAL I.1 SUMMARY A. This Section includes the following: 1. Shaft enclosures. 2. Chase enclosures. 3. Stair enclosures. 3t2v2004 1.2 SUBMITTALS Product Data: For each gypsum board shaft-wall assembly indicated. Fire-Test-Response Reports : L lnclude data substantiating that elevator entrances and other items that penetrate each glpsum board shaft-wall assembly do not.negate fire-resistance rating. Research/evaluation reports. Acoustical-test-response reports. QUALITY ASSURANCE Fire-Resistance-Rated Assemblies: Provide materials and construction identical to those tested in assembly indicated according to ASTME ll9 by an independent testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. STC-Rated Assemblies: For gypsum board shaft-wall assemblies indicated to have STC ratings, provide assembly materials and construction complying with requirements of assemblies whose STC ratings were determined according to ASTM E 90 and classified according to ASTM E 413 by a qualified independent testing agency. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MANTJFACTT]RERS Basis-of-Design Product: The desigr for gypsum board shaft-wall assemblies is based on products named on Drawings by design desigrration of a qualified testing and inspecting agency. Subject to compliance with requirements, provide the named product or a comparable product by one of the following: 1.3 2.1 t t I t t I I I I I I t I A. B. C. D. B. GYPSUM BOARD SHAFT-WALL ASSEMBLIES 09265 - | 20021 50 r .08 VAIL MOI.JNTAINLODGE 3/2U2004 l. American Gypsum Co. 2. G-P Gypsum Corp. 3. National Gypsum Cornpany. 4. United States Gypsum Co. 2.2 MATERIALSANDCOMPONENTS A. General: Comply with requirements of fire-resistance-rated assemblies indicated. l. Provide panels in maximum lengths available to eliminate or minimize end-to-end butt joints. 2. Provide auxiliary materials compllng with gpsum board shaft-wall assembly manufacturerrs written recommendations. B. Steel Sheet Components: Metal complying with ASTM C 645 requirements. 1. Protective Coating: Manufacturer's standard corrosion-resistant zinc coating. C. Studs: Manufacfurer's standard profile for repetitive members and comer and end members and for fi re-resistance-rated assembly indicated. 1. Depth: As indicated. 2. Minimum Base Metal Thickness: As indicated. D. Track @unner): Manufacturer's standard J-profile track with longJeg length as standard with manufacturer, but at least 2 inches (51 mm), in depth matching studs. 1. Minimum Base Metal Thiclness: As indicated. E. Jamb Skuts: Manufacturer's standard J-profrle strut with long-leg length of 3 inches (76.2 mm), in depth matching studs, and not less than 0.0329 (0.84 mm) thick. F. Gypsum Liner Panels: Manufacturer's proprietary liner panels in l-inch (25.4-rnm) thickness and with moisture-resistant paper faces. G. Gypsum Wallboard: ASTM C 36, core type as required by fire-resistance-rated assembly indicated. 1. Edges: Tapered. H. Gypsum Base for Gypsum Veneer Plaster: ASTM C 588, core brye as required by fire- resistance-rated assembly indicated, with edges as standard with manufacturer. I. Water-Resistant, Gypsum Backing Board: ASTM C 630/C 630M, core type as required by fire- resistance-rated assemblv indicated. J. Cementitious Backer Units: ANSI Al l8.9, in manufacturer's standard thickness. but at least ll2 inch (12.7 mm) thick. I I I t I t I I I I I t I I I I t I I GYPSUM BOARD SHAFT-WALL ASSEMBLIES 09265 -2 M. N. o. P. B. C. J.l I I I I I il I il/ t, I t I I I t I I il l 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/21t2004 Accessories: Comerbead, edge trim, and control joints of material and shapes specified in Division 9 Section "Gypsurn Board Assemblies" that comply with glpsum board shaft-wall assembly manufacfurer's written recommendations for application indicated. Gypsum Wallboard Joint-Treatment Materials: ASTM C 475 and as specified in Division 9 Section "Gypsum Board Assemblies." Steel Drill Screws: ASTM C 1002, unless otherwise indicated. l. Use screws complying with ASTMC954 for fastening panels to steel members from 0.033 1o 0.1l2 inch (0.84 to 2.84 mm) thick. 2. For fastening cementitious backer units, use screws of type and size recommended by panel manufacfurer. Track (Runner) Fasteners: Power-driven fasteners of size and material required to withstand loading conditions imposed on shaft-wall assemblies without exceeding allowable design stress of frack. fasteners. or structural substrates in which anchors are embedded. l. Powder-Actuated Fasteners: Provide powder-actuated fasteners with capability to sustain, without failure, a load equal to 10 times that imposed by shaft-wall assemblies, as determined by testing conducted by a qualified independent testing agency according toASTME 1190. 2. Postinstalled Expansion Anchors: Where indicated, provide expansion anchors with capability to sustain, without failure, a load equal to 5 times that imposed by shaft-wall assemblies, as determined by testing conducted by a qualified independent testing agency according to ASTM E 488. Acoustical Sealant: As specified in Division 9 Section "Gypsum Board Assemblies." Sound Attenuation Blankets: ASTM C 665 for Type I, unfaced mineral-fiber-blanket insulation produced by combining thermosetting resins with mineral fibers manufactured from slag or rock wool. PART 3 - EXECUTION INSTALLATION Sprayed Fire-Resistive Materials: Coordinate with glpsum shaft-wall assemblies so both elements of Work remain complete and undamaged. Install gypsum board shaft-wall assemblies to comply with requirements of fire-resistance-rated assemblies indicated, manufacturer's written installation instructions, and the following: l. ASTM C 754 for installing steel framing.2. Division 9 Section "Gypsum Board Assemblies" for applying and finishing panels. Do not bridge building expansion joints with shaft-wall assemblies; aame both sides of joints with furring and other support. GYPSI]M BOARD SHAFT-WALL ASSEMBLIES 09265 -3 20021501.08 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODCE 3tzl/2004 Install supplementary framing in gypsum board shaft-wall assemblies around openings and as required for blocking, bracing, and support of gravity and pullout loads of fixtures, equipment, services, heavy trim, fumishings, and similar items that cannot be supported directly by shaft- wall assembly framing. l. where handrails directly attach to gypsum board shaft-wall assemblies, provide galvanized steel reinforcing strip with 0.0312-inch (0.79-mm) minimum thickness of base (uncoated) metal, accurately positioned and secured behind at least I faceJayer panel. At penetrations in shaft wall, maintain fire-resistance rating of shaft-wall assembly by installing supplementary steel framing around perimeter of penetration and fire protection behind boxes containing wiring devices and similar items. Isolate glpsum finish panels from building structure to prevent cracking of finish panels while maintaining continuity of fire-rated construction. Install control joints to maintain fire-resistance rating of assemblies. Seal gypsum board shaft walls with acoustical sealant at perimeter of each assembly where it abuts other work and atjoints and penetations within each assembly. lnstall acoustical sealant to withstand dislocation by air-pressure differential between shaft and external spaces; maintain an airtight and smoke-tight seal; and comply with manufacturer's written instructions or ASTM C 919, whichever is more stringent. END OF SECTION 09265 t I l ! t 3 I il I I I l I I l I I J I D. F. G. H. GYPSI]M BOARD SHAFT-WALL ASSEMBLIES 09265 - 4 t 2oo2l5or.o8 VAIL MOI,INTIAN LODGE 312il2004 I SECTION O93IO - CERAMIC TILE |n T PART I -GENERAL t I 1.1 SUMMARY n A. This Section includes the following:ll!| l. Ceramic mosaic tile. t I ll 2. Paver tile. 3. Glazed wall tile. 4. Special-purposetile. 5. Stone thresholds installed as part of tile installations. 6. Waterproof membrane for tile installations. 7. Crack-suppression membrane for thin-set tile installations. 8. Metal edge strips installed as part of tile installations. 1.2 SI.JBMITTALS J A. Product Data: For each product indicated. .n B. Shop Drawings: Show locations of each type of tile and tile pattern. Show widths, details, and I locations of expansion, contraction, control, and isolation joints. . C. Samples: \Ll i! l. Each type, composition, color, and finish oftile. 2. Assembled samples with grouted joints for each type, composition, color, and finish of I . tile. ll 3. Stone thresholds in 6-inch (150-mm) lengths. t r.3 oUALTTYASSURANCE '! A. Mockups: Build mockups to veri$ selections made under sample Submittals and to I demonstrate aesthetic effecis and qualities of materials and execution.t '' I . Build mockup of each type of floor tile installation. 0 2. Build mockup of each type of wall tile installation. I 3. Approved mockups may become part of the completed Work if undisturbed at time of Substantial Completion. l,I! r.4 EXTRA MATERIALS tl A. Fumish exta materials described below that match products installed and that are packagedr| with protective covering for storage and identified with labels describing contents. I CERAMIC TILE O93IO - I ,r 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t2v2004 l. Tile and Trim Units: Fumish quantity of full-size units equal to 3 percent of amount installed, for each type, composition, color, pattem, and size indicated. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MANI.JFACTURERS A. In other Part 2 articles where titles below inhoduce lists, the following requirements apply for product selection: l. Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the products specified. 2. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the manufacturers soecifi ed. 2.2 TILE PRODUCTS A. Tile Manufacturers and Products: L As indicated by lnterior designer in finish schedule and specification sheets. B. ANSI Ceramic Tile Standard: Provide Standard grade tile that complies with ANSI A137.1, "Specifications for Ceramic Tile," for types, compositions, and other characteristics indicated.1. Mounting: Factory back-mounted. C- Ceramic Mosaic Trim Units: Matching characteristics of adjoining flat tile and coordinated with sizes and coursing where applicable. 2.3 ACCESSORYMATERIALS A. Thresholds: Fabricate to provide transition between adjacent floor finishes. Bevel edges at l:2 slope, limit height of bevel to 1/2 inch {12.7 mm) or less, and finish bevel to match face of threshold. l. Marble Thresholds: ASTM C 503 with a minimum abrasion resistance of 10 oer ASTM C 1353 or ASTM C 241 and with honed finish. a. Description: As indicated by lnterior designer in finish schedule and specification sheets. T t I I I i I B.Waterproofing and Crack-Suppression Membranes Manufacfurer's standard product that complies with following. l. Fabric-Reinforced, Fluid-Applied hoduct: reinforcement. a. Available Products: for Thin-Set Tile Installations: ANSI Al18.10, selected from the LiquidJatex rubber with fabric I I l I I u I c I I r ICERAMIC TILE 09310 -2 J 2oo2l5or.o8 VAIL MOI.]NTIAN LODGE 3t2v2004 1) Custom Building Products; Trowel & Seal Waterproofing and Anti-Fracture Membrane. 2) LATICRETE Intemational lnc.; Laticrete 9235 Waterproof Membrane. 3) MAPEI Corporation; PRP Ml9. 4) Summitville Tiles, lnc.; 3-9000. 2. Latex-Portland Cement Product: Flexible mortar witb acrylic-latex additive. a. Available Products: l) Boiardi hoducts Corporation; Elastiment 323. 2) MAPEI Corporation; PRP 315. 3) Southern Grouts & Mortars, Inc.; Southcrete I100. 4) TEC Specialty Products lnc;TA-324, Triple Flex. 3. Urethane Waterproofing and Tile-Setting Adhesive: One-part liquid-applied urethane. a. Available Products: l) Bostik; Hydroment Ultra-Set. 2) Southem Grouts &Mortars, Inc.; Deck-Seal 1000. I I I I I I r 2.4 SETTING AND GROUTING MATERIALSJ. - A. Available Manufacturers: I 1. Atlas Minerals & Chemicals, Inc. 2. Boiardi hoducts Corporation. 1 3. Bonsal, W. R., Company. J 4. Bostik. 5- C-Cure. t 6. Custom Building Products. l-,fl t. DAP, Inc. 8. Jamo Inc. y', 9. LATICRETE Intemational Inc. lj 10. MAPEI Corporation.JI 1 l. Southern Grouts & Mortars. Inc. r\ 12. Summitville Tiles, Inc. I 13. TEC SpecialtyProducts lnc. f ^ B. Latex-Portland Cement Mortar (Thin Set): ANSI Al 18.4. I' l. For wall applications, provide nonsagging mortar. J C. Water-Cleanable, Tile-Setting Epoxy Adhesive: ANSI Al l8.3.I U D. Polymer-Modified Tile Grout: ANSI A118.7, color as seleted from manufacturers full range. I I CERAMICTILE 09310 - 3 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2U2004 2.5 MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS A. Elastomeric Sealants: Elastomeric sealants of base polymer and characteristics indicated that cornply with applicable requirements in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants." l. One-Part, Mildew-Resistant Silicone: ASTMC920; TypeS; GradeNS; Class25; Uses NT, G, A, and, as applicable to nonporous joint subshates indicated, O; formulated with ftngicide, intended for in-service exposures of high humidity and extreme temperatures. a. Available Products: l) Dow Corning Corporation; Dow Coming 786.2) GE Silicones; Sanitary 1700. 3) Pecora Corporation; Pecora 898 Sanitary Silicone Sealant.4) Tremco, Inc.; Tremsil 600 White. 2. Multipart, Pourable Urethane Sealant for Use T: ASTM C 920; Type M; Grade p; Class 25; Uses T, M, A, and, as applicable to joint substrates indicated, O. a. Available Products: l) Bostik; Chem-Calk 550. 2) Mameco Intemational, Inc.; Vulkem 245.3) Pecora Corporation; NR-200 Urexpan.4) Tremco, Inc.; THC-900. B. Trowelable Underlayments and Patching Compounds: Latex-modified, portland cement-based formulation provided or approved by manufacturer of tile-setting materials. C. Metal Edge Strips: Angle or L-shape, nickel silver exposed-edge material. D. Grout Sealer: Manufacturer's standard silicone product for sealing grout joints that does not change color or appearance of grout. PART 3 - EXECUTION PREPARATION Remove coatings, including curing compounds and other substances that contain soap, wax, oil, or silicone, that are incompatible with tile-setting materials. Fill cracks, holes, and depressions with trowelable leveling and patching compound according to tile-setting material manufacturer's written instructions. Remove protrusions, bumps, and ridges by sanding or grinding. Blending: For tile exhibiting color variations, use factory blended tile or blend tiles at Project site before installing. T I I t I 0 I 3.1 ,t l I I I I I il I I 7 I B. c. D. CERAMICTILE 09310 -4 E. B. D. E. F. G. H. 3.2 1 I l I t t t I I t 3 I I I J t t l I 20021501.08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t212004 Field-Applied Temporary Protective Coating: Where indicated under tile type or needed to prevent gout from staining or adhering to exposed tile surfaces, precoat them with continuous film of temporary protective coating, taking care not to coat unexposed tile surfaces. INSTALLATION. GENERAL ANSITilelnstallationStandards: ComplywithpartsofANSIAl08Series"Specificationsfor Installation of Ceramic Tile" that apply to types of setting and grouting rnaterials and to methods indicated in ceramic tile installation schedules. TCA hrstallation Guidelines: TCA's "Handbook for Ceramic Tile Installation." Comply with TCA installation methods indicaled in ceramic tile installation schedules. Extend tile work into recesses and under or behind equipment and fixtures to form complete covering without intem.rptions, urless othenvise indicated. Terminate work neatly at obstructions, edges, and corners without disrupting pattem orjoint alignments. Accurately form intersections and retums. Perform cutting and drilling of tile without marring visible surfaces. Grind cut edges of tile abutting trim, finish, or built-in items. Fit tile closely to electrical outlets, piping, fixtures, and other penetrations so plates, collars, or covers overlap tile. Jointing Pattem: Lay tile in grid pattem, unless otherwise indicated. Align joints when adjoining tiles on floor, base, walli, and trim are same size. Lay out tile work and center tile fields in both directions in each space or on each wall area. Adjust to minimize tile cutting. Provide uniform joint widths, unless otherwise indicated. Lay out tile wainscots to next full tile beyond dimensions indicated. Expansion Joints: Locate expansion joints and other sealant-filled joints during installation of setting materials, mortar beds, and tile. Do not saw-cut joints after installing tiles. 1. Locate joints in tile surfaces directly above joints in concrete substrates. 2. Prepare joints and apply sealants to comply with requirements in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants-" Grout tile to comply with requirements of ANSI A108.10, unless otherwise indicated. 1. For chemical-resistant epoxy grouts, comply with ANSI ,{108.6. Install waterproofing to comply with ANSI A I 08. I 3 and rvaterproofing manufacturer's rvritten instructions to produce waterproof membrane of uniform thickness bonded securely to substrate. 1. Do not install tile over waterproofing until waterproofing has cured and been tested to determine that it is watertisht. J. For installations indicated below, follow procedures in ANSI Al08 Series tile installation standards for providing 95 percent mortar coverage. l. Exterior tile floors. CERAMIC TILE 09310 - 5 2002 1501 .08 L. K. VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t2v2004 2. Tile floors in wet areas. 3. Tile floors composed of tiles 8 by 8 inches (200 by 200 nm) or larger. 4. Tile floors composed of rib-backed tiles. Install tile on floors with the following joint widths: l. Ceramic Mosaic Tile: 1/16 inch ( 1.6 mm). 2. Paver Tile: 1/4 inch (6.35 mm). Stone Thresholds: Install stone thresholds at locations indicated; set in same type of setting bed as abutting field tile, unless otherwise indicated. L Set thresholds in latex-portland cement mortar for locations where mortar bed would otherwise be exposed above adjacent nontile floor finish. Metal Edge Strips: lnstall at locations indicated or where exposed edge of tile flooring meets carpet, wood, or other flooring that finishes flush with top of tile. Install tile on walls with the following joint widths: 1. Ceramic Mosaic Tile: 1/16 inch (1.6mm). 2. Glazed Wall Tile: l/16 inch (l .6 rnnr). Apply grout sealer to cementitious grout joints in tile floors according to grout-sealer manufacfurer's written instructions. As soon as grout sealer has penetrated grout joints, remove excess sealer and sealer that has gotten on tile faces by rviping rvith soft cloth. FLOOR TILE INSTALLATION SCHEDULE Exterior floor installation on concrete: thin-set mortar: TCA FI02. I . Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified sanded grout. lnterior floor installation on concrete: thin-set mortar: TCA Fl13. 1 . Thin-Set Mortar: I-atex- portland cement mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. Interior floor installation on waterproof and crack-suppression membrane over concrete; cement mortar bed (thickset); TCA F12l . I . Bond CoaVThin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. Interior floor installation on waterproofand crack-suppression membrane over concrete; thin-set mortar; TCAFl22. I . Thin-Set Mortar: Latex-portland cement mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded prout. I I I t I t I I I I 0 t I I I t I I I N. o. A- B. c. D. 3.3 CERAMIC TILE 09310 - 6 t 2oo2rso1.o8 VAIL MOUNTI,AN LODGE 3t21t2004 I 3.4 wALL TILE TNSTALLATToN scHEDULEI . lnterior wall installation over masonry or concrete; cement mortar bed (thickset); TCA W201. !-I 1. Bond CoaVThin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar.t 2- Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. J B. lnterior wall installation over masonry or concrete; thin-set mortar; TCA W202. a l. Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. 'l 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. ! /_ C. Interior wall installation over masonry or concrete; cement mortar bed (thickset) bonded to f substrate; TCA W2l l. I, I . Bond Coat/Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. f 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. II- D. Interior wall installation; thin-set mortar; over gypsum board; TCA W243. 1 . Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. f E. . Interior wall installation over glass-mat, water-resistant backer board; thin-set mortarJ TCA W245. f I . Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. f| 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. t F. Interior bathtub wall installation; thin-set mortar; over water-resistant gypsum board; t TCA B4l3 and TCA W243. I . Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. G. lnterior bathtub wall installation over glass-mat, water-resistant backer board; thin-set mortar; TCA B4l9 and TCA W245. l. Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cemenl mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. H. Interior wall and shower-receptor installation; thin-set mortar; over glass-mat, watcr-resistant backer board; TCA 8420 and TCA W245. I . Thin-Set Mortar: Latex- portland cement mortar. 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout. END OF SECTION O93IO CERAMIC TILE 09310 - 7 | 2oo2rsor.o8 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t21/2004 ! sECTIoN 09385 - DMENSIoN sroNE TILE t a t PART1 -GENERAL ll l.l SUMMARY A. This Section includes dimension stone tile and relaled setting materials applied to floors andI walls.I I r.z suBMrrrALS I A. hoduct Data: For each type of product indicated. I B. Shop Drawings: Show locations of each type of stone tile and tile pattern. Show widths,It details, and locations ofexpansion, contraction, control, and isolation joints. I C. Samples: Full-size units of each type of stone tile in each finish required.a I r.3 euALrrYAssuRANCEI A. Source Limitations for Stone Tile: Obtain each type of stone product through one source from a single producer. B. Mockups: Build mockups to verify selections made under sample submittals and to dernonstate aesthetic effects and set quality standards for materials and execution. l Build mockup of each type of floor tile installation. 2. Build mockup of each type of rvall tile installation.3. Approved mockups may become part of the completed Work if undisturbed at time of Substantial Completion. I t 1.4 EXTRAMATERLALS n A. Fumish extra materials described below that rnatch products installed and that are packaged I with protective covering for storage and identified with labels describing contents. l. Dimension Stone Tile: Fumish quantity of full-size units equal to I percent of amount installed, for each type, composition, color, pattem, and size indicated. t) I I t, t t, I DMENSION STONETILE 09385 - I 2002 I 501 .08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOUNTLAN LODGE 3/21/2004 C. STONE PRODUCTS Varieties and Sources: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide stone varieties from sources indicated. Abrasion Resistance: Provide stone with a value of not less than 10, as determined per ASTMC 1353orASTMC24l. Stone Tile Type: As listed in Specification sheets and finish schedule. 2.2 SETTING AND GROUTING MATERTALS A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, rnanufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the follorving: 1. Atlas Minerals & Chemicals, Inc.2. Boiardi Products Corporation. 3. Bonsal, W. R., Company.4. Bostik Findley 5. C-Cure. 6. Custom Building Products. 7. DAP Inc. 8. Jamo Inc. 9. Laticrete International. lnc. 10. MAPEI Corp. II. SGM. 12. Summitville Tiles, Inc. 13. TEC Incorporated; H. B. Fuller Company. B. Portland Cement Mortar (Thickset) Installation Materials: ANSI Al08.lA. C. Latex-Portland Cement Mortar (Thin Set): ANSI Al18.4.l. For wall applications, provide nonsagging mortar. D. Water-Cleanable Epoxy Adhesive: ANSI Al18.3. E. Organic Adhesive: ANSI Al36.l, Tlpe I. F. Standard Sanded Cement Grout: ANSI A118.6. G. Standard Unsanded Cement Grout: ANSI Al l8.6 ( for stoen with polished or honed finish). H. Polymer-ModifiedTileGrout: ANSIAll8.7. L Water-Cleanable Epoxy Grout: ANSI Al18.3. J. Grout Colors: As selected bv Architect. t I l t I I tl I I ,l I i t I I I 't t B. 2.1 DMENSION STONE TILE 09385 - 2 A. B. c. D. c. D. E. 2.4 I I I i t I I I i I J I t I I t T f; I 20021501 .08 2.3 DMENSION STONETILE B. VAIL MOTJNTI,AN LODGE 3/21/2004 MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS Sealants: Elastomeric sealants of base polymer and characteristics indicated that comply with applicable requirements in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants." Trowelable Underlayments and Patching Compounds: Latex-modified, portland cement-based formulation provided or approved by manufacturer of tile-setting materials. Metal Edge Strips: Angle or L-shape, nickel silver exposed-edge material with satin finish. Floor Sealer: Colorless, slip- and stain-resistant sealer, not affecting color or physical properties of stone surfaces as recommended by stone tile producers for application indicated. 1. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: a. Bostik Findley. b. Custom Building Products.c. Hillyard, hrc. d. HMK Stone Care System. e. Summitville Tiles. Inc. FABRICATION Facial Dimensions of Stone Tiles with Polished or Honed Faces: Do not vary facial dimensions from specified dimensions by more than plus or minus l/64 inch (0.4 nrm). Facial Dimensions of Stone Tiles with Sand-Rubbed NatLrral-Cleft or Therrnal-Finishcd Faces: Do not vary facial dimensions from specified dimensions by ntore- thrn plus or minus 1/32 ::tc';i (0.8 mm). Thickness of Stone Tiles with Polished Honed or Sand-Rubbed Finish: Do not vary fi-om specified thickness by more than plus or minus l/32 inch (0.8 mm). Thickness of Stone Tiles with Natural-Cleft or Thermal Finish: Do not vary average thickncss of each tile from specified thickness by more than plus or minus 1/16 inch (l .6 nln). Backs ofPieces: Gage units by dressing backs ofpieces smooth and flat. l. Natural-cleft stone need not be gaged if gap does not exceed 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) when tested with a24-inch (600-nrnr) straightedge on backs of units. 09385 - 3 20021 501 .08 PART 3 - EXECUTION VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2V2004 3.1 INSTALLATION, GENERAL A. Preparation: For concrete substrates for tile floors installed with adhesives or thin-set mortar, correct conditions that do not comply with flatness tolerances specified in referenced ANSI Al08 Series of tile installation standards. 1. Fill cracks, holes, and depressions with trowelable leveling and patching compound. 2. Remove protrusions, bumps, and ridges by sanding or grinding. B. ANSI Tile lnstallation Standards: Comply with requirements of ANSI Al08 that apply to types of setting and grouting materials and to methods indicated. l. For tile floors, follow procedures in ANSI A108 for providing 95 percent mortar coverage. C. TCA Installation Guidelines: Comply with TCA's "Handbook for Ceramic Tile Installation." D. Extend tile work into recesses and under or behind equipment and fixtures to form complete covering without intemrptions, unless otherwise indicated. Terminate work neatly at obsfuctions, edges, and comers without disrupting pattern or joint alignments. E. Accurately form intersections and retums. Perform cutting and drilling of tilc rvithout marring visible surfaces. Fit tile closely to elechical outlets, piping, fixtures, and other penetrations so plates, collars, or covers overlap tile. F. Finish cut tile edges that will not be concealed by other construction to match factory-fabricatcd edges, unless otherwise indicrted. G. Jointing Pattem: Lay tile in grid pattern, unless otherrvise indicated. Align joints s'hen adjoining tiles on floor, base, rvalls, and trim are same size. Lay out tile rvork and centcr til,-' fields in both directions in eaclr space or on each wall arca. Adjust to minimize tile cutting. H. Match tiles within each space by selecting tiles to achieve uniformity of color and pattern. Reject or relocrte tiles that do not nratclt colot and pattern of r.ljnr--'rrt t,l,. s. I. Pattern Orientation: For stone varieties with directional pattem, orient pattern as indicatcd, or if not indicated, as directed by Architect. J. Expansion Joints: Locate scalant-filled joints rvhere indicated dLrring installation of setting materials, mortar beds, and tilc. Do not sarv-cut joints alicr instrlling tilcs. l. Locate joints in tile surfaces directly above joints in concrete substrates. 2. Prepare joints and apply elastomeric sealants to comply with requirements in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants." 3. Use single-component, mildew-re sistant, neutral-curing silicone sealant for joints in walls. 4. Use single<omponent, nonsag urethane sealant for joints in floors. T T l I I I l I I I il I I tl t I t IDMENSION STONE TILE 09385 - 4 I 2oo2r5or.o8 t I VAIL MOIiNTI.AN LODGE 3t21t2004 t 3.2 TNSTALLATToN ToLERANcES t T , I t A. Variation from Plumb: For vertical joints, extemal comers, and other conspicuous lines, do not exceed l/8 inch in 8 feet (3 mm in 2400 mm). B. Variation in Level: For horizontal joints and other conspicuous lines, do not exceed li4 inch in 20 feet (6 n.rm in 6 m), or l12 inch (12 mm) maxrmum. C. Variation in Surface Plane of Flooring: Do not exceed l/8 inch in 10 feet (3 mm in 3 m) from level or slope indicated when tested with a l0-foot (3-m) straightedge. D. Variation in Plane between Adjacent Units (Lipping): Do not exceed the following differences between faces ofadjacent units as measured from a sttaightedge parallel to tiled surface: l. Units with Polished Faces: I i64 inch (i).4 mnr). 2. Units with Honed Faces: li64 inch (0.-l mn). 3. Units with Sand-Rubbed Faces: l/32 inch (0.8 mm). 4. Units with Thermal-Finished Faces: Depth of thermal finish or 3/16 inch (5 mm), whichever is less. 5. Units with Natural-Cleft Faces: Depth of natural-cleft finish or 3/16 inch (5 mm), whichever is less. E. Variation in Joint Width: Do not vary joint thickness more than li 16 inch (1.6 ntm) or one- fourth of nominal joint width, whichever is less. t 13 ADruSTINGAND CLEANING I I I I A. Remove and replace material that is stained or othenvisc damaged or that cloes not rnatch adjoining tile. Provide new matching units, installed as spccified and in r nranner to clirninrte evidence of replacement. B. Cleon stone tiles aftcr seti.ing arrd grouting is complet"-; r:sc proccllr;ics recommenclctl l-'y stonc producer and manui'acturer for typcs of applicatiol indicatcrl. C. Apply sealer to cleaned stone tile flooring, according to serler mlnulacturer's s'rittct.r insh'uctions. ; 3.4 sroNE FLooR TILE TNSTALLATToN scHEDULE I A. Exterior floor installation on concrcte: thin-sct mortrr: TC.\ F102. I 1. Thin-Set Mortar: Latex-portland cement mortar.v 2. Grout: Polymer-modified sanded grout. I B. Interior floor installation on concrete; thin-set mortar; TCA Fl13. z^ I . Thin-Set Mortar: Latex-portland cement mortar.j 2. Grout: Polymer-modified unsanded grout.t C. Interior floor installation on concrete; thin-set mortar; watercleanable epoxy grout; TCA F115.Ir DMENSION STONE TILE 09385 - 5I I t I I I I I t t I I t t I I I I I I 2002r50r.08 VAIL MOUNTLAN LODGE SECTION 09512 - ACOUSTICAL TILE CEILINGS PART I -GENERAL I.I ST]MMARY A. This Section includes acoustical tiles and concealed suspansion systems for ceilings. 3t22t2004 1.2 SI.]BMITTALS Product Data: For each product indicated. Coordination Drawings: Drawn to scale and coordinating penehations and ceiling-mounted items. Show the following: 1 . Ceiling suspension assembly members. 2. Method of attaching hangers to building struchne.3. Size and location of initial access modules for acoustical tile. 4. Ceiling-mounted items including lighting fixtures, diffusers, grilles, speakers, sprinklers, access panels, and special moldings. Samples: For each acoustical tile, for each concealed suspension systern member, for each exposed molding and trinl and for each color and texture required. Muct test repods. Researctr/evaluation reports. Maintenance data. QUALITY ASSLIRANCE Acoustical Testing Agency Qualifications: An independent testing laboratory or an NVLAP- accredited laboratory. Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: I . Fire-Resistance Ratings: Where indicated, provide acoustical tile ceilings identical to those of assemblies tested for fire resistance per ASTM E I 19 by UL or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction. Ratings are indicated by design designations from UL's "Fire Resistance Directory" or from the listings of another testing and inspecting agency. a. Identifu materials with appropriate markings of applicable lesting and inspecting agency. A. B. c. D. E. F. 1.3 B. ACOUSTICAL TILE CEILINGS 09512 - I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOIJNTI,AN LODGE 3t22/2004 2. Surface-Buming Characteristics: Acoustical tiles complying with ASTM E 1264 Class A materials, when tested per ASTM E 84. a. Smoke-Developed lndex: 450 orless. C. Seismic Standard: Comply with the following: I. ASTM E 580. 1.4 EXTRA MATERTALS A. Fumish exta materials described below that match products installed and &at are packaged with protective covering for storage and identified with labels describing contents. 1. Acoustical Ceiling Units: Full-size units equal to 2.0 pe,cent of quantity installed, but not fewer than 12 tiles. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MANT]FACTI]RERS A. In other Part 2 articles where titles below introduce lists, the following requirements apply for product selection: l. Available Products: Subject to conpliance with requirernents, prducts that may be incorporatcd into the Work include, but are not limited to, thc pnoducts sp€cified- 2.2 GENERAL A. Acoustical Tile Standard: Comply with ASTM 8126/'. B. Metal Suspansion System Standard: Comply with ASTM C 635. C. Attachment Devices: Size for five times the desigrr load indicated in ASTM C 635, Table l, "Direct Hung,n unless otherwise indicated. l. Anchors in Concrete: Adhesive anchors fabricated from corrosion-resistant materials. with holes or loops for attaching hangers of qp€ indicated and with capability to sustain, without failure, a load equal to five times that imposed by ceiling constuction, as determined by testing per ASTM E 488 or ASTM E l5l2 as applicable, conducted by a qualified testing and inspecting agency. 2. Power-Actuated Fasteners in Concrete: Fastener systern of tlpe suitable for ap'plication indicated, fabricated from corrosion-resistant materials, with clips or other accessory devices for attaching hangers of type indicated, and with capability to sustain, without failure, a load equal to l0 times that imposed by ceiling construction, as determined by testing per ASTM E I 190, conducted by a qualified testing and inspecting agency. I I I T I I I I I I l t l I I t I t I ACOUSTICAL TILE CEILINGS 09512 -2 I 20021501.08 vArL MoI-TNTIAN LoDGE 3122/2004! I D. Wire Hangers, Braces, and Ties: Zinc-coated carbon-steel wire; ASTM A64llA 641M, Class 1 t zinc coating, soft temper. 11 l. Size: Select wire diameter so its stress at three times hanger desigl load (ASTM C 635, I Table l, "Direct Hung") will be less than yield stress of wire, but provide not less than 0. I 06-inch- (2.69-mm-) diameter wire. fl U E. Seismic struts and seismic clips. - F. Metal Edge Moldings and Trim: Type and profile indicated or, if not indicated, manufacturer's I standard moldings for edges and penetrations that fit acoustical tile edge details and suspensionI systems indicated; formed from sheet metal of same material and finish as that used for exposed flanges of suspension system runners.t, a 2.3 ACOUSTICALTILES I A. Available Products: I l. Armstrong, Fine Fissured, Second Look II, Medium Texture. I B. Classification: , Type lll, mineral base with painted finish; Form 2, rvater felted. t l. Pattem: CEK C. Color: As selected from manufacturer's full range. I D. [R: Not less than 11 E. NRC: Notlessthan 0.55,T1peE400mountingperASTME795. I F. CAC: Not less than 30. r] G. Edge Detail: 9i 16 Angted Tegular.t H. Thickness: 3/4 inch (19 mm).IJ I. Size: 24by49inches (scoringfor?4inchby24inchpattern). n | 2.4 METAL SUSPENSTON SYSTEM A. Available Products: ! L Armshong, 15116 inch helude. I B. Direct-Hung Suspension System: Intermediate duty structural classification.t C. Access: Upward with each access unit identified by manufacturer's standard unobtrusive I markers. I I l ACOUSTICAI TILE CEILINGS 09512 - 3 20021501.08 PART 3 - EXECUTION I I I3.1 VAIL MOT,NTIAN LODGE 3122/2004 INSTALLATION General: Install acoustical tile ceilings to cornply with ASTM C 636 seismic requiremerts indicated, per manufacturer's written instructions and CISCA's "Ceiling Systems Handbook." Measure each ceiling area and establish layout of acoustical tiles to balance border widths at opposite edges ofeach ceiling. Avoid using less-than-half-width tiles at borders. Suspend ceiling hangers from building's stuctural merrfurs, plumb and free from contact with insulation or other objects within ceiling pleaum. Splay hangers only where required to miss obstructions; offset resulting horizontal forces by bracing, countersplaying, or other equally effective means. Where uridth of ducts and other construction within ceiling plenum produces hanger spacings that interfere with location ofhangers, use tapezes or equivalent devices. l. Do not support ceilings directly from permanent metal forms or floor deck anchor into concrete slabs.2. Do not attach hangers to steel deck tabs or to steel roofdeck. Install edge moldings and tim at perimeter of acoustical tile ceiling area and where necessary to conceal edges of acoustical units. Screw attach moldings to zubstrate with concealed fasten€rs at intervals not more than -t6 inches (400 mm) o.c. and not more than 3 inches (75 mm) from ends, leveling with ceiling suspension system to a tolerance of l/8 inch in 12 feet (3.2 mm in 3.66 m). Miter comers accurately and connect secrnely. Install suspension system nrnners so they are square and securely interlocked with one another. Remove and replace dented, bent, or kinked members. Install acoustical tiles in coordination with suspension system and exposed moldings and trim. Place splines or suspension system flanges into kerfed edges so tile-to-tile joints are closed by double lap of material. Fit adjoining tile to form flush, tight joints. Scribe and cut tile for accurate fit at borders and around penefiations through tile. Hold tile field in compression by inserting leaf-t1pe, spring-steel spacers between tile and moldings, spaced 12 inches (305 mm) o,c. END OF SECTION 09512 B.I I I I I I I l I D. F. I I I I t T IACOUSTICAL TILE CEILINGS 09512 - 4 I 2002rs01.08 vArL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3/2rt2004 I sECTroN onur, - sroNE 'AVTNG AND FL.'RTNG I PART1 -GENERAL t l.l '.MMARY h A. This Section includes dimension stone flooring and t}resholds. - 1. See Division 2 Section "Unit Pavers" for rough stone pavers. 2. See Division 9 Section "Dmension Stonc Tile" for stone tilc used as flooring.a a 1.2 PERTORMANCEREQUIREMENTS -, I A. Stone Abrasion Resistance: Minimum value of 10 ased on testing according to ASTM C 241 or ASTM C 1353, unless a higher value is required by the referenced building stone standard. III - 1.3 SUBMITTALS I A. Product Data: For each variety of stone, stone accessories, and other manufactured products I indicated. I B. Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments to other Work. t C. Samples: l. For each stone type. Include two or more Samples in each set and show the full range of variations in appearance characteristics expected in completed Work. 2. For each color of grout required. D. Maintenance data. r.4 QUALTTYASSURANCE I A. Installer Qualifications: An installer who employs experienced mechanics and stone fitters who l' are skilled in installing stone paving and flooring similar in material, design, and extent to those indicated for this Project and whose projects have a record of successful in-service performance. I B. Mockups: Build mockups to veriff selections made under sample Submittals and to , demonstrate aesthetic effects and qualities ofmaterials and execution. 1. Build mockups approximately 96 inches (2400 mm) square. 2. Approved mockups may become part of the completed Work if undisturbed at time of Substantial Completion. I I T I I I I STONE PAVING AND FLOORING 09638 - I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2y2004 I.5 PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Cold-Weather Requirements for Stone Pavinq: l. Do not build on frozen setting beds. 2. Protect stone paving against freezing when atmospheric temperature is 40 deg F (4 deg C) and falling. Heat materials to provide mortar and grout temperatures between 40 and 120 deg F (4 and 49 deg C). 3. Provide the following protection for cornpleted portions of work for 24 hours after installation when mean dailv air temoerature is as indicated: a. Below 40 deg F (4 O.U arl, .ou., *ith *"uther-resistant membrane.b. Below 25 deg F (minus 4 deg C), cover with insulating blankets. c. Below 20 deg F {minus 7 deg C), provide enclosure and temporary heat to marntain temperature above 32 deg F (0 deg C). B. Hot-Weather Requirements for Stone Paving: Protect stone paving when temperature and humidity conditions produce excessive evaporation of sefting beds and grout. Provide artificial shade and windbreaks and use cooled materials as required. Do not apply mortar to substrates with temperatures of 100 deg F (38 deg C) and above. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MANUFACTURERS A. In other Part 2 articles where subparagraph titles below introduce lists, the following requirements apply for product selection: I . Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by the manufacturers specified. 2.2 STONE, GENERAL A. Varieties and Sources: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide stone varieties from sources specified inPart2 "Stone Types" Article. B. Match existing stone for variety, color, and finish where stone is indicated to match existing. C. Provide stone that is free of cracks, seams, and starts impairing structural integrity or function. D. Provide stone from a single quarry for each variety ofstone required. 1. For each stone variety, provide matched blocks exhacted from contiguous locations in a single bed of quarry stratum unless Architect approves stone from blocks randomly selected for aesthetic effect. E. Quarry stone in a manner to ensure that as-quarried block orientations yield finished stone with required characteristics. I I I I I I t I I I l I I t I I I I 't STONE PAVING AND FLOORING 09638 -2 rI 20021501.08 VAILMOUNTTAN LODGE 3t2U2004I I 23 sToNETYPESI A. Granite: Provide granite complying with ASTM C 615 and NBGQA's "Specifications forI Architectural Granite" and as follows: I l. Varieties and Sources: t a' $illll*lTl;.-,4.s indicated bv the lnterior Designer in finish schedule and I b. Exterior Stone: To Match Existing. 2. Finish: As indicated or to match existing.I t B. Slate: Provide slate complying with ASTM C 629, with a fine, even grain and unfading color, ._ from clear, sound stock and as follows: t l. Classification: I Exterior and II Interior.2' Color: As indicated by Interior designer in finish schedule and specification sheets.I 3. Varieties and Sources: I a. As indicated by Interior designer in finish schedule and specification sheets. II 4. Finish: As indicated.t I 2.4 MORTARMATERTALStA. Mortar Pigments: Natural or synthetic iron oxides, compounded for use in mortar mixes andt with a record of satisfactory performance in stone mortars. J l AvailableManufacturers: Ir i: 3:rjJ3;i:."J"tion; rndustriar chemicars Div I ! 3:fiH:"?ffi:31'* J B. Latex additive (water emulsion), serving as rcplacement for part of or all gaging rvater, of type I specifically recommended by latex-additive manufacturer for use ..,,,itlr .yoU-Lixed portlandI cement mortar and not containing a rctardcr. f C. Thin-Set Mortar: t l. Latex-PortlandCementMortar: ANSIAllg.4. - D. Water: Potable. T 2.5 GROUT I A. Grout colors: As selected by Architect from manufacturer's full range. I I STONE PAVING AND FLOORING 09638 - 3 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 Latex-Portland Cement Grout: ANSI Al 18.6, for materials described in Paragraph H2.4, and as follows: I . Factory-Prepared, Dry-Grout Mixture: Factory-prepared mixture of portland cement; dry, redispersible, ethylene vinyl acetate additive; and other ingredients to produce the following: a. Unsanded grout mixture forjoints l/8 inch (3 mm) and narrower.b. Sanded grout mixture for joints l/8 inch (3 mm) and wider. 2. Mixture of Dry-Grout Mix and Latex Additive: Mixture of factory-prepared, dry-grout mix and latex additive cornplying with the following requirements: a. Unsanded grout mixture for joints 1/8 inch (3 mrn) and narrower.b. Sanded grout mixture for joints I /8 inch ( 3 mm; and wider.c. Latex Additive: Styrene-butadiene rubber or acrylic resin. 3. AvailableManufacturers: a. Boiardi Products Corp. b. Bonsal, W. R. Company. c. Bostik. d. C-Cure Corporation. e. Custom Building Products. f. DAP, Inc. C. Laticrete International, lnc.h. Mapei Corporation. i. Southern Grouts & Mortars, Inc.j. Summitville Tiles, Inc. k. TEC Specialty Products Inc. ACCESSORIES Cleavage Membrane: Polyethylene sheeting, ASTMD 4397, 4.0 mils (0.1 mm) thick; or asphalt felt, ASTM D 226,Type I (No. l5). Reinforcing Wire Fabric: Galvanized, welded wire fabric, 2 by 2 inches (50 by 50 mm) by 0.062-inch (1.57-mm) diamcter'; comply with ASTTMA l3-( and ASTMA32 cxcept for minimum wire size. Divider Strips and Edging: Metal or combination of metal and PVC or neoprene base, designed specifically for flooring applications, in longest lengths available, and as follows: l. Exposed-Edge Material: Nickel silver. 2. Cross-Section Profile: Angle or L-shape. 3. Height: Equal to stone thickness plus depth ofselting bed.4. Width: 0.063 inch ( 1.5 mm). 5. Control-Joint Filler: Neoprene, in color selected by Architect from manufaclurer's full range. I I I I I I T I I B. 2.6 I I I I I A. B. C.I I I I I STONE PAVING AND FLOORING 09638 - 4 D. E. F. I I I I t I I I 20021501.08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/2v2004 Cork Joint Filler: Preformed strips complying with ASTM D l7|2,Type II. cleaner: stone cleaner specifically formulated for stone types, finishes, and applications indicated, as recommended by stone producer and, if a sealer is specified, by sealer manufacturer. Do not use cleaning compounds containing acids, caustiis, harsh fillers, or abrasives. Floor Sealer: Colorless, slip- and stain-resistant sealer that does not affect color or physical properties ofstone surfaces, as recommended by stone producer for application indicated. I . Available Manufacturers: a. b. c. d. e, f. o Bostik. Custom Building Products. Hillyard Floor Treatments. HMK Stone Care hoducts. Miracle Sealants Company. Stone Care lntemational. Summitville Tiles- Inc. 2.7 STONE FABRICATION General: Fabricate stone paving and flooring in sizeq and shapes necessary to comply with requirements indicated, including details on Drawings and Shop Drawings. l. For granite, comply with recommendations in NBGQA's "Specifications for Architectural Granite." 2' For marble, comply with reeommendations in MIA's "Dimensional Stone--Desien Manual IV. " 3. For limestone, comply with recommendations in ILI's "Indiana Limestone Handbook."4. Fabricate stone thresholds in sizes and profiles as indicated or required to provide transition between adjacent floor finishes. Pattem Arrangement: Fabricate and arrange stone units rvith vcining and othcr natural markings to comply with the follo'"ving requirements: l- Cut stone from one block or contiguous, matched blocks in rvhich natural n-rarkings occur. 2. Arrange units in blend pattern. MORTARAND GROUTMIXES Mortar: Comply with referenced standards and with manufacturers' written instructions to produce mortar of uniform quality and with optimum performance characteristics. I . Do not use admixtures, unless othenvise indicated. Do not use calcium chloride. Latex-Modified Portland cement Setting Mortar: proportion and mix portland cement, aggregate, and latex additive to comply with written instructions of latex-additive manufachner t I t I I I B. B. 2.8I I I I I STONE PAVING AND FLOORING 09638 - 5 20021501.08 VAIL MOT]NTTAN LODGE 3t21t2004 and as necessary to produce stiff mixture with a moist surface whel bed is ready to receive stone. C' Latex-Modified Portland Cement Bond Coat: Proportion and mix portland cement, aggregate, and latex additive to comply with latex-additive manufacfurer's written mstructions. D' Joint Grout: Comply with mixing requirements of referenced ANSI standards and manufacfurer's written instructions. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.1 PREPARATION A. Vacuum c'lean concrete substrates to remove dirt, dust, debris, and loose particles. B. Remove substances from concrete substrates that could impair mortar bond. C' Clean dirty or slained stone surfaces by thoroughly scrubbing with fiber brushes and thendrenching with clear water. Use only mild cleaning compounds. 3.2 INSTALLATION, GENERAL A' Do necessary field cutting as stone is set. Use power saws with diamond blades to cut stone.cut lines shaight and true, with edges eased slightly to prevent snipping. B. Set stone to comply with Drawings and Shop Drawings. C' Scribe and field-cut stone as necessary to fit at obstructions. Produce tight and neat joints. D' Stone over Waterproofing: Carefully place stone and setting materials over waterproofing soprotection materials are not displaced and waterproofing is not punctured or otherwise damaged. l. Provide cork joint filler, where indicated, at waterproofing that is tumed up on vertical surfaces or, if not indicated, frovidc temporary liller or 1..r,.,..,tcction unlil stole pa.,i,.,- installation is complete. E. Expansion- and Control-Joint lnstallation: Locate and install according to Drarvings and ShopDrawings. Joint-sealant materials and installation are specified in Division 7 Section ,,Joint Sealants." 3.3 INSTALLATIONTOLERANCES A. Variation in Surface Plane of Paving and Flooring: Do not exceed lr'B inch in 10 t'cet (3 nrm in3 m), l/4 inch in 20 leet (6 mm in 6 nr), or 3/8 inch (10 mm) maximum from level or slopeindicated. I I I I I I I l t t I I t t I t I I STONE PAVING AND FLOORING 09638 - 6 B. A. B. 3.4 I I I t I 2002 I 501 .08 F. VAILMOTJNTIAN LODGE 3/21t2004 Variation in Plane between Adjacent Units (Lipping): Do not exceed li32-inch (0.8-mm) difference between planes of adjacent units. INSTALLATION OF STONE DIRECTLY OVER CONCRETE Safurate concrete with clean water several hours before placing setting bed. Remove surface water about one hour before placing setting bed. Apply mortar bed bond coat to damp concrete and broom to provide an even coating that completely covers the concrete. Do not exceed lll6-inch (1.5-mm) thickness. Limit area of mortar bed bond coat to avoid its drying out before placing setting bed. Apply mortar bed immediately after applying mortar-bed bond coat. Spread, tamp, and screed to uniform thickness at elevations required for setting stone to finished elevations indicated. Mix and place only that amount of mortar bed that can be covered with stone before initial set. Cut back, bevel edge, and discard material that has reached initial set before stone can be placed. Place stone before initial set of mortar occurs. Immediately before placing stone on setting bed, apply uniform 1/1 6-inch- ( I .S-mrn-) thick bond coat to bed or to back of each stone unit. Tamp and beat stone to obtain full contact with setting bed and to bring finished surfaces rvithin indicated tolerances. Set each unit in a single operation before initial sct of mortar. Rake outjoints to depth required to receive grout as units are set. Point joints after setting. Tool joints flat, uniform, and smooth, n'itlrout visible voids. INSTALLATION OF STONE OVER CLEAVAGE MEMBRANE OR WATERPROOFING Place cleavage membrane over substrates indicated to reccive stor-re, lapped at least 4 inchcs (100 mm) atjoints. Place reinforcing wire fabric over membrane, lapped at least one full mesh at joints and srrl-rportcd so mesh bccor.ncs crr'.-.1,1,'cl irr ntirltllc of sett, :: L-'r1. Il,.lil ctl3cs L'r;k fi , I vet'l.. ul surfaces approximately li2 inch (13 nrln). Place mortar bed over membrane with rcinforcing wire fabric fully cmbcdded in middle of mortar bed. Spread, tarnp, and screed to uniform thickness at elevations requir;C for setting stone to finished elevations indicated. Mix and place only that amount of mortar bed that can be covered with stone before initial set. Cut back, bevel edge, and discard material that has reached initial set before stone can be placed. Place stone before initial set ofmortar occurs. Immediately before placing stone on setting bed, apply uniform l/16-inch- (1.5-mm-) thick bond coat to bed or to back ofeach stone unit. I I I I I I I I I C. D. E. 3.5 G. H. B. C. D. E, I I I I I STONE PAVING AND FLOORING 09638 -7 2002r50t.08 VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE 3t2v2004 F. Tamp and beat stone to obtain full contact with setting bed and to bring finished surfaces within indicated tolerances. Set each unit in a single operation before initial set of mortar. G. Rake out joints to depth required to receive grout as units are set. 3.6 STONE THRESHOLD INSTALLATION A' At locations adjacent to stone paving and flooring, install stone thresholds in same type of setting bed as abutting stone paving and flooring, unless otherwise indicated. l. Set thresholds in thin-set, latex-portland cement mortar to comply with ANSIAl08.5 at locations where mortar bed would otherwise be exposed above other adjacent paving and flooring. 3.7 GROUTING OF STONE PAVING AND FLOORING A. Grout stone joints to comply with ANSI Al08.l0 and manufacturer's written instructions. L Do not use sanded grout for polished or honed stone. B. Grout joints as soon as possible after initial set of setting bed. Force grout into joints, taking care not to smear grout on adjoining stone and other surfaces. After initial set ofgrout, finish joints by tooling to produce a slightly concave polished joint, free ofdrying cracks. C. Cure grout by maintaining in a damp condition for seven days exccpt as otherwise recommended by latex-additive manufacturer. 3.8 CLEANING AND PROTECTION A. Clean stone paving and flooring after setting and grouting are complete. Use proceclures recommended by stone fabricator lbr types of application. Apply sealer to cleaned stone flooring according to sealer manufacturer's rvritten instmctions. Prohibit traffic fi'orn ir.:trllcd storr.. l.'l r .niinirrunr cl72 ltour'.. Protect stone paving and flooring during construction with nonstaining kraft paper. Wlere adjoining areas require constnrction s.ork access, cover stonc paving and flooring with a minimum of 3i-{-inch (20^mnr) untrerted plywood over nonstaining kaft paper. END OF SECTION 09638 B. C. D. t I t I I I I I I I I I I I t T I I I STONE PAVING AND FLOORINC 09638 - 8 l.l I I I I I 2002 I 501 .08 SECTION 09640 - WOOD FLOORING PART 1 - GENERAL VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t22/2004 I I I I I I I I I I I 1.2 SI.JMMARY This Section includes the following: l. Solid-wood, stip or plank flooring. SUBMITTALS Product Data: For each product indicated. Shop Drawings: Show installation details including location and layout of each type ofwood flooring and accessory. Samples: For each type of wood flooring and accessory, with stain color and finish required. QUALITY ASST]RANCE Hardwood Flooring: Comply with NOFMA grading rules for species, grade, and cut. l. Certification: Provide flooring that carries NOFMA grade stamp on each bundle or piece. PROIECT CONDITIONS Conditioning: Maintain relative humidity planned for building occupants and an ambient temPerature between 65 and 75 deg F (18 and 24 deg C) in spaces to receive wood flooring for at least seven days before installation, during installation, and for at least seven days after installation. After post-installation period, maintain relative humidity and ambient temperahre planned for building occupants. l. Move wood flooring into spaces where it will be installed, at least seven days before installation. 2, For unfinished products, open sealed packages to allow wood flooring to acclimatize.3. Do not install flooring until it adjusts to the relative humidity of and is at the same temperature as the space where it is to be installed. Install factory-finished wood flooring after other finishing operations, including painting, have been completed. A. B. C. 1.3 1.4 B. t I I WOODFLOORING 09640 - I 2002 150 I .08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOTJNTTAN LODGE 3/22/2004 2.1 SOLID-WOOD STRIP OR PLANK FLOORING A. Factory-FinishedProducts: l. Available Products: Subject to compliance with requiremelts, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: a. As indicated in Finish schedule and specification sheets. 2.2 ACCESSORYMATERIALS A. Vapor Retarder: ASTM D 4397 , polyethylene sheet not less than 6.0 mils (0.I 5 mm) thick. B. FeltUnderlayment: ASTMD226,TypeI,No. 15, asphalt-saturatedfelt. C. Wood Flooring Adhesive: Mastic recommended by flooring and adhesive manufacturers for application indicated- D. Fasteners: As recommarded by manufacturer, but not less than that recommended in NOFMA's "Installing Hardwood Flooring." E. Cork Expansion Strip: Composition cork strip cornpllng with FS HH{-576, Type I-B, Class 2. F. Wood Trim: In same species and grade as wood flooring, unless otherwise indicated.l. Ttneshold: Tapered on each side and routed at bottom ofone side to accommodatc wood flooring. 2. Reducer Strip: 2 inches (51 mm) wide, tapered on one side, and in thickness matching flooring. PART 3 - DGCUTION 3.I INSTALLATION A. Comply with flooring manufacturer's written installation instructions, but not less than recommendations in NOFMA's "Installing Hardwood Flooring. " B. Concrete Substrates: Verifu that slabs are dry according to test methods recommended by flooring manufacturer or, if none, by test methods in NOFMA's "Installing Hardwood Flooring." l. Where wood flooring is installed directly over concrete slabs, grind high spots and fill low spots to provide a maximum l/4-inch (6-mm) deviation in any direction when checked with a l0-foot (3-m) straight edge. 2. Where wood flooring is adhesively attached to concrete slabs, veris that slabs are free of curing compounds, sealers, hardeners, and other materials that may interfere with adbesive bond. I l I T I I t I I I I I T I T I I I I WOODFLOORING 096/,0 -2 I I I I I I t I I I t I 20021501.08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE Provide expansion space at walls and other obstructions and terminations of flooring ofnot less than 3i4 inch (19 mm). Vapor Retarder: I . Wood Flooring Installed Directly on Concrete: lnstall a layer of polyethylene sheet according to fl oorin g manufacfu rer's written instructions. Solid-Wood Strip and Plank Flooring: Blind nail or staple flooring to substrate according to NOFMA's written recommendations. L Plank Flooring: For flooring of face width more than 3 inches (7-5 mm): a. Install countersunk screws at each end of each piece in addition to blind nailing. Cover screw heads with wood plugs glued flush with flooring. b. Install not less than 2 countersunk nails at each end ofeach piece, spaced not more than t6 inches (406 mm) along length of each piece, in addition to blind nailing. Fill holes with matching wood filler. Wood Trim: Nail baseboard to wall and nail shoe molding or other trim to baseboard; do not nail to flooring. END OF SECTIONO964O 312212004 C. D. F. I I t t I I I WOODFLOORING o9uo -3 I 20021501.08 vArL MotrNTrAN LoDGE 3/2212004t IT SECTION0965I-RESILIENTFLOORTILE al I PART I-GENERAL -I I.I SUMMARYt A. This Section includes the followine: a l. Solid vinyl floor tile.2. Vinyl cornposition tile rygD.I I 1.2 S{IBMITTALS I A. ProductData: For each product indicated. i- B. Samples: Full-size units ofeach color and pattem ofresilient floor tile required. II I.3 PROJECT CONDITIONSa t A. Maintain temp€ratures within range recommended by manufacturer, but not less than 70 deg F (21 degC) or more than 95 degF (35 degC), in spaces to receive floor tile during the I following time periods: '- 1. 48 hours before installation. ;fr 2. During installation. t 3. 48 hours after installation. - - B. After postinstallation period, maintain temperatures within range recommended by I manufacturer, but not less than 55 deg F (13 deg C) or more than 95 deg F (35 deg C). C. Close spaces to traIfic during floor covering installation.I, I D. Close spaces to haffic for 48 hours after floor covering installation. I E. lnstall resilient products after other finishing operations, including painting, have been I completed. I r.4 ExTRAMATERTALSI A. Fumish exta materials described below that match products installed and that are packaged I with protective covering for storage and identified with labels describing contents.I 1. FloorTile: Furnish I box for every 50 boxes or liaction thereol of eachtype, color, and n pattern of floor tile installed.r t I RESILIENT FLOOR TILE 09651 - I 2.1 20021 501 .08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t22/2004 SOLID VI}ryL FLOOR TILE Solid Vinyl Floor Tile: ASTM F 1700. l. Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the following: a. As indicated by manufacturer's designations in lnterior Design Specification Sheets. Color and Pattem: As indicated by manufacturer's designations in Interior Desigr Specification Sheets. Class: As indicated by product designations. Type: As indicated by product designations. Thickness: Standard Size, as indicated by product designations. Size: 1 8 by 18 inches (457 by 457 mm). Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: l. Critical Radiant Fltx Classification: Class I, not less than 0.45 Wsq. cm per ASTM E 648. 2.2 INSTALLATIONMATERTALS A. Trowelable Leveling and Patching Compounds: Latex-modified, portland cement based or blended hydraulic cement based formulation provided or approved by resilient product manufacturer for applications indicated. B. Adhesives: Water-resistant tlpe recommended by manufacturer to suit resilient products and substrale conditions indicated. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I PREPARATION A. Prepare substrates according to manufacturer's written recommendations to ensure adhesion of resilient products. B. Concrete Subsfates: hepare according to ASTM F 710. l. Veri$/ that substrates are dry and free of curing compounds, sealers, and hardeners. 2. Alkalinity and Adhesion Testing: Perform tests recommended by manufacturer. Proceed with installation only after subst"tes pass testing. 3. Moisttne Testing: I I I I I I I I I T I I I I I I I I B. C. D. E. F. G. RESILIENT FLOOR TILE 09651-2 C. D. F. B. C. D. F. 3.2 I I I t I I I I I I l I I T I T I I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3t22/2004 a. Perform anhydrous calcium chloride test, ASTM F 1869. Proceed with installation only after subshates have maximum moisture-vapor-emission rate of 3 lb of rvater/l 000 sq. ft. ( 1 .36 kg of wateri92.9 sq. m) in 24 hours. b. Perform tesls recorffnended by manufacturer. Proceed with installation only after substrates pass testing. Remove substrate coatings and other substances that are incompatible with adhesives and that contain soap, wax, oil, or silicone, using mechanical methods recommended by manufacturer. Do not use solvents. Use trowelable leveling and patching compound to fill cracks, holes, and depressions in substrates. Move resilient products and installation materials into spaces where they will be installed at least 48 hours in advance ofinstallation. l. Do not install resilient products until they are same temperature as space where they are to be installed. Sweep and vacuum clean substates to be covered by resilient products immediately before installation. After cleaning, examine substrates for moisture, alkaline salts, carbonation, and dust. hoceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. INSTALLATION Lay out tiles from center marks established with principal walls, discounting minor offsets, so tiles at opposite edges of room are of equal width. Adjust as necessary to avoid using cut widths that equal less than one-half tile at perimeter. l. Lay tiles square with room axis. Match tiles for color and pattem by selecting tiles from cartons in the same sequence as manufactured and packaged, if so numbered. Discad broken, cracked, chipped, or deformed tiles. l. Lay tiles with grain direction alternating in adjacent tiles (basket-weave pattern). Scribe, cut, and fit tiles to butt neatly and tightly to vertical surfaces and permanent fixtures including built-in fumiture, cabinets, pipes, outlets, edgings, door frames, thresholds, and nosings. Extend tiles into toe spaces, door reveals, closets, and similar openings. Maintain reference markers, holes, and openings that are in place or marked for future cutting by repeating on floor tiles as marked on subskates. Use chalk or other nonpermanent, nonstaining marking device. Adhere tiles to flooring subshates using a full spread of adhesive applied 1o subsffate to produce a completed installation without open cracks, voids, raising and puckering at joints, telegraphing of adhesive spreader marks, and other surface imperfections. RESILIENT FLOOR TILE 09651 - 3 2002 r s01.08 VAIL MOUNTTAN LODGE 3t2U2W4 G. Perform the following operations immediately after cornpleting resilient product installation: l. Remove adhesive and otherblemishes from exposed surfaces. 2. Sweep and vacuum surfaces thoroughly. 3. Damp-mop surfaces to remove marks and soil. a. Do not wash surfaces until after time period recommerded by manufactr.ner. H. Protect resilient products from mars, marks, indentations, and other damage from construction operations and placement of equipment and fixtures during remainder of construction period. Use protection methods recommended in writing by manufacturer. END OF SECTION 0965I I l I I I I t I I I I I T I t I T I T RESILIENT FLOOR TILE 09651-4 I 20021501.08 vArL MouNTTAN LoDGE 3/zz/2004! f SECTION 09653 - RESILIENT WALL BASE AND ACCESSORIES a- t PART l -GENERAL I l.r suMMARYI A. This Section includes the followine:Ir l. Wall base. 2. Moldingaccessories. I 1,2 SUBMITIALS I A. ProductData: Foreachproductindicated. r B. Samples: For each type of product indicated, in manufacturer's standard-size Samples but not I less than 12 inches (300 mm) long, of each resilient product color, texture, and pattern required. I 13 PRoJECTcoNDrrroNS f A. Maintain temperatures within range recommended by manufactwer, but not less than 70 deg F I (21 deg C) or more than 95 deg F (35 deg C), in spaces to receive floor tile during the following t time periods: I l. 48 hours before installation. f] 2. During installation. 3. 48 hours after installation. I B. After postinstallation period, maintain temperatures within range recommended by - manufacturer, but not less than 55 deg F ( l3 deg C) or rnorc than 95 deg F (35 deg C). I C. Install resilient products after other finishing operations, including painting, have been I completed. t r.4 EXTRAMATERT.ALS I A. Fumish extra materials described below that match products installed and that are packaged I with protective covering for storage and identified with labels describing contents. . l. Furnish not less than l0 linear feet (3 linear m) for every 500 linear feet ( 150 linear m) or I fraction thereof, ofeach type, color, pattern, and size ofiesilient product installed.I I I I RESILIENT WALL BASE AND ACCESSORIES 096s3 - r 20021501.08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MANUFACTURERS A. Available Products: incorporated into the articles. VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t2U2004 Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be Work include, but are not limited to, products listed in other Part 2 T I I t I I I I I I I I T I l I I I I 2.3 COLORS ANDPATTERNS A. Colors and Pattems: As selected from manufacturer's full range. RESILIENT WALL BASE Wdl Base: ASTM F 1861. l. AFCO-USA, American Floor Products Company, Inc. 2. Armstrong World Industies, Inc. 3. Azrock Commercial Flooring, DOMCO. 4. Bwke Mercer Flooring Products. 5. Endura;. 6- Estrie, Anrerican Biltite (Canada) Ltd. 7. Jolmsonite. 8. Marley Flexco (USA), Inc. 9. Mondo Rubber International, Inc. 10. Mussur, R. C. Rubber Co. I l. Nora Rubber Flooring, Freudarberg Building Systans, lnc. 12. Pirelli Rubber Flooring. 13. Roppe Corporation. 14. Stoler Industries. 15. VPI, LLC, Floor hoducts Dvision. Type (Material Requiranent): TS (rubber, wlcanized thermoset) or TP (rubber, thermoptastic). Group (Manufacturing Method): I (solid, homogareous) or II (layered). Style: Cove (with top-set toe). Minimum Thickness: 0.080 inch (2.0 mm). Height: 4 inches (102 rnm). Lengths: Cut lengths 48 inches (1219 mm) long or coils in manufacturer's standard length. Outside Corners: Job formed or prernolded. Inside Corners: Job formed or premolded. Surface: Smooth. RESILIENT WALL BASE AND ACCESSORIES w653 -2 I 20021501.08 vAIL MotrNTtAN LoDcE 3t22t2004 I 2.4 RESTLTENT MoLDTNG ACcESSoRIESI A. Description: Carpet edge for glue-down applications, Nosing for carpet, Nosing for resilient I floor covering, Reducer strip for resilient floor covering, Joiner for tile and carpet.r 1. Burke Mercer Flooring Products. fl 2. Johnsonite;. | 3. Marley Flexco (USA), Inc. 4. Roppe Corporation; . I 5. Stolerlndustries;. r B. Material: Vinyl. I C. Profile and Dimensions: As indicated or required for installation.t I 2.5 INSTALLATIoNMATERTALS I A. Trowelable Leveling and Patching Compotmds: Latex-modified, portland cernent based or I blended hydraulic cement based formulation provided or approved by resilient product I manufacturers for applications indicated. f B. Adhesives: Water-resistant type recommended by manufacturer to suit resilient products and I substrate conditions indicated. - C. Stair-Tread-Nose Filler: Twopart epoxy comporxid recomnrended by resilient tead I manufacturer to fill nosing substrates that do not conform to tread contours. l PART3 -EXECUTION I I 3.1 PREPARATION I A. Prepare subshales according to manufacturer's written recommendations to ensure adhesion of I resiliantproducts. - B. Concrete Substrates for Stair Accessories: Prepare according to ASTM F 710. I l. Verify rhat substrates are dry and fiee of curing compounds, sealers, and hardeners. fl 2. Alkalinity and Adhesion Testing: Perform tests recommended by manufacturer. hoceed |l 3' il11"#:1:Xilt"''lvaftersubstratespasstesting' ! a. Perform anhydrous calcium chloride test, ASTM F 1869. Proceed with installation I only after substrates have maximum moisture-vapor-emission rate of 3 lb ofI b l,#.ifi.L',:;*;ffli.1i-THll,?#":'##5H* instaration onry after ; substates pass testing. T Ia RESILIENT WALL BASE AND ACCESSORIES 09653 - 3Ir 20021501.08 VAILMOUNTTAN LODGE 3t22t2004 C. Remove subsbate coatings and other substances that are incompatible with adhesives and that contain soap, wax, oil, or silicone, using mechanical methods recommended by manufacturer. Do not use solvents. D. Use trowelable leveling and patching compound to fill cracks, holes, and depressions in substrates. E. Move resilient products and installation materials into spaces where they will be insalled at least 48 hours in advance of installation. l. Do not install resilient products until they are the same tenrperature as the space where lhey are to be installed. F. Sweep and vacuum clean substrates to be covered by resilieat products immediately before instrallation. After cleaning, examine subshates for moisture, alkaline salts, carbonation, and dust. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. 3.2 RTSILIENT WALL BASE INSTALLATION A. Apply wall base to walls, colunms, pilasters, casework and cabinets in toe spaces, and other permanent fixtures in rooms and meas where base is required. B. Install wall base in lengths as lmg as practicable without gaps at seams and with tops of adjacent pieces aligned. C. Tightly adhere wall base to substrate tlnoughout length of each piece, with base in continuous contact with horizontal and vertical subst'ates. Do not shetch wall base during installation. On masonry surfaces or other similar inegular substrates, fill voids along top edge of wall base with manufacturer's recommended adhesive filler material. Premolded Corners: Install premolded comers before installing staight pieces. . Job-Formed Corners: I . Outside Corners: Use straight pieces of maximum lengths possible. Form without producing discoloration (whitening) at bends. Shave back ofbase at points where bends occur and remove strips perpendicular to length of base that are only deep enough to produce a snug fit without removing more than half the wall base thickness.2. Inside Comers: Use staight pieces of maximum lengths possible. Form by cutting an inverted V-shaped notch in toe of wall base at the point where corner is formed. Shave back ofbase where necessary to produce a snug fit to substate. 3.3 RESILIENTACCESSORYINSTALLATION A. Resilient Stair Accessories: l. Use stair-tread-nose filler to fill nosing substrates that do not conform to tread contours. D. E. F. G t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I IRESILIENT WALL BASE AND ACCESSORIES 096s3 - 4 I I I 2oo2lsol.o8 VAIL MOTJNTTAN LODGE 3t22/2004 I 2. Tightly adhere to substrates throughout length ofeach piece.r 3. For heads installed as separate, equalJength units, install to produce a flush joint between units. I B. Resilient Molding Accessories: Butt to adjacent materials and tightly adhere to substrates throughout length of each piece. lnstall reducer strips at edges of floor coverings that would I otherwisebe exposed. I I 3.4 CLEANTNG AND PROTECTTON f A. Perform the following operations immediately after completing resilient product installation: L Remove adhesive and other blemishes from exposed surfaces. 2. Sweep and vacuurn surfaces thoroughly. 3. Damp-mop surfaces to remove marks and soil. a. Do not wash surfaces until after time period recommended by manufacturer. I B. Protect resilient products from mars, marks, indentations, and other damage from construction t operations and placonent of equipment and fixtures during remainder ofconstuction period. Use protection methods recommended in writing by manufacturer. I ENDoFsEcrroNoe6s3 I t t I I t I I I I RESILIENT WALL BASE AND ACCESSORIES 09653 - s I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTIAN LoDGE 3t2z/zoo4! I SECTTON 09751 - TNTERTOR STONE FACTNG t PART l -GENERAL I r.l suMMARYt - A. This Section includes interior stone for the following: I l. Base and trimf 2. Countertops. ,l B. See Division 9 Section "Dimension Stone Tile" for stone floor and wall tile. t C. See Division 9 Section "Stone Paving and Flooring" for stone flooring. - 1.2 PERFORMANCEREeUIREMENTS I l' I.3 SUBMITTALS I A. Product Data: For each variety of stone, stone accessories, and other manufactured products I indicated. t B. Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments to other Work. C. Samples: I l. For each stone tJpe. Include two or more Samples in each set and show the full range off variations in appearance characteristics expecte-d in completed Work. 2. For each color of grout required. f D. Maintenance data. l r.4 QUALTTYASST.IRANCE I A. Installer Qualifications: An installer who employs experienced stone masons and stone fitters f who are skilled in installing interior stone facing similar in material, design, and extent to that indicated for this Project and whose products have a record of successful in-service I P'erformance' t 1. Installer's responsibilities include fabricating and installing interior slone facing anchoring system and providing professional engineering services needed to assume I engineering responsibility.t B. Mockups: Build mockups to set quality standard for fabrication and installation. I l. Build mockups for the following kinds of interior stone facing:a. Stone base, approximately 72 inches ( I 800 mm) long.I! INTERIOR STONE FACING 0975I - I I I 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTTAN LODGE 3t22t2004 2. Approved mockups may become part of the completed Work if undisturbed at time of Substantial Completion. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2,1 MANUFACTURERS A. ln other Part 2 articles where subparagraph titles below introduce lists, the following requirements apply for product selection: l. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by the manufacturers specifi ed. 2.2 STONE, GENERAL A. Varieties and Sources: Subject to conpliance with requirements, provide stone varieties from sources specified inPart2 nStone Types" Article. B. Provide stone that is free of cracks, sears, and starts irnpairing stn rctural integrity or function. C. Provide stone from a single quarry for each variety of stone required. l. For each slone variety, provide matched blocks extracted from contiguous locations in a single bed of quarry stratum unless Architect approves stone from blocks randomly selected for aesthetic effect. D. Quarry stone in a manner to ensure that as-quarried block orientations yicld finished stone with required characteristics. 2.3 STONE TYPES A. Granite: Provide granite complying with ASTMC6I5 and NBGQA's "Specifications for Architectural Granite" and as follows: l. Varieties and Sources: a. As indicated in Interior design Finish schedule and Specification Sheets. 2. Finish: As indicated in lnterior design Finish schedule and Specification Sheets. B. Marble: Provide marble complying with ASTM C 503 and as follows: l. Varieties and Sources: a. As indicated in Interior design Finish schedule and Specification Sheets. 2. Finish: As indicated in Interior design Finish schedule and Specification Sheets. I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I I IINTERIOR STONE FACING 0975r -2 I 20021501.08 vATLMouNTIAN LoDGE 3/22/2004r I 2.4 ADHESTVES AND SEALANTS !A. General: Use only adhesives formulated for stone and ceramic tile and recommended by their rt manufacturer for the application indicated. 'l B. Water-Cleanable Epoxy Adhesive: ANSI A118.3. I l. Available Manufacturers:a I i B:;tr:J'#;ffili'*t c. CustomBuildingProducts. d. Laticrete Intemational- Inc. I e. Mapei Corporation. t f. SummiMlleTiles, Inc. I C. Sealani for Countertops: Silicone sealant complying with requirements in Division 7 Section I "Joint Sealants." l. Color: Clear. I 2.5 STONE FABRICATION t A. General: Fabricate interior stone facing in sizes and shapes required to comply with quiremants indicated, including details on Drawings and Shop Drawings. t 1. For granite, comply with recommendations in NBGQA's 'Specifications for Architectural Granite." I 2. For marble, comply with recommendations in MIA's "Dimensional Stone-Design I Manual IV." I B. Fabricate molded work to produce stone shapes with a uniform profile throughout entire unit I length and with precisely formed arris slightly eased to prevent snipping, and matched at jointsr between units. I l. hoduce moldings with machines having abrasive shaping wheels made to reverseI contour of molding shape; do not sculpt moldings. 2. Miter moldings at comers, unless otherwise indicated, with edges of miters slightly eased at outside corners. a C. Stone Countertops: Comply with recommendations in MIA's "Dimensional Stone--Design t Manual [V" and as follows: I l. Seams: Fabricate countertops in sections indicated for joining in field, with sealant-filled seams l/16 inch (1.5 mrn) in width. 11 2. Undercounter Lavatories: Make cutouts for undercounter lavatories in shop usingI :",Tj:1fi'":::T"i"ffi:1i'il,'il.,:fl T::li:j:ffi;"ffi":,i'ffi:"J,tT$lff: {inish edges to match tops. T I!INTERIORSTONEFACING 0975I -3 ltI I I t I I J. 4. 3.1 2002 l 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/22t2004 Counter-Mounted Sinks: Prepare countertops in shop for field cutting openings for counter-mounted sinks. Mark tops for cutouts and drill holes at comers of cutout locations. Make corner holes oflargest radius practical. Fittings: Drill countertops in shop for plumbing fittings, undercounter soap dispensers, and similar items. PART 3 - EXECUTION SETTING OF STONE, GENERAL Do necessary field cutting as stone is set. Use power saws with diamond blades to cut stone. Cut lines straight and true, with edges eased slightly to prevent snipping. Contiguous Work Provide reveals and openings as required to accommodate contiguous work. Set stone to comply with requirements indicated on Drawings and Shop Drawings. lnstall anchors, supports, fastaners, and other attachm€nts indicated or necessary to secure interior stone facing in place. Shim and adjust anchors, supports, and accessories to set stone accurately in locations indicated with uniform joints of widths indicated and with edges and faces aligred according to established relationships and indicated tolerances. Provjde expansion, control, and pressure-relieving joints of widths and at locations indicated. L Sealing expansion and other joints is specified in Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants."2. Keep expansion joints free of plaster, mortar, grout, and other rigid materials. CONSTRUCTION TOLERANCES Variation in Plane between Adjacent Stone Units (Lipping): Do not exceed l/32-nch (0.8-mm) difference betweel planes of adjacent units. INSTALLATION OF STONE BASE, AND TRIM Stone Base and Trim at Walls with Stone: Set units by adhering to interior stone facing with water-cleanable epoxy adhesive. Hold adhesive back from exposed edges ofjoints to allow for grouting. Stone Base and Trim at Walls without Stone Paneling: Adhere units with firll spread of water- cleanable epoxy adhesive. Hold adhesive back from exposed edges of joints to allow for grouting. INSTALLATION OF COUNTERTOPS General: Install countertops over plywood subtops with full spread of water-cleanable epoxy adhesive. General: lnstall cormtertops by adhering to supports with water-cleanable epoxy adhesive. B. c. I I I t I I I D. 3.2 J.J I I T I I I I B. B. 3.4 INTERIOR STONEFACING 09751 - 4 C. D. F. 3.5 I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I 20021 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTI,AN LODGE 3t22/2004 Space seams with l/16-inch (1.5-mm) gap for filling with sealant. Use temporary shims to ensure uniform spacing and clamp units to temporary bracing to eliminate lipping. Complete cutouls not finished in shop. Mask areas of countertops adjacent to cutouts to prevent damage while cutting. Install backsplash and end splash by adhering to wall with water-cleanable epoxy adhesive. Leave l/16-inch (1.5-mm) gap between countertop and splash for filling with sealant. Use temporary shims to ensure uniform spacing. Apply sealant to seams and to gap between countertops and splashes; comply with Division 7 Section "Joint Sealants." CLEANING Clean interior stone facing not less than six days after completion of grouting and pointing, using clean water and soft rags or stiff-bristle fiber brushes. Do not use wire brushes, acid-type cleaning agents, cleaning compounds with caustic or harsh fillers, or other materials or methods that could damage stone. END OF SECTION 09751 INTERIOR STONE FACING 09751 - 5 I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTIAN LoDGE 3/22/2004 ! I SECTTON 09911 - pArNTrNc (CONSUMER LrNE PRODUCTS) I PARTI -GENERAL I l.r suMMARYI A. This Section includes surface preparation and field painting of exposed interior items and t surfaces. I I r.2 SUBMITTALS I! A. Product Data: For each product indicated. I B. Samples: For each type of finish-coat material indicated.I I I.3 QUALITYASSURANCEt A. Benchmark Samples (Mockups): Provide a full-coat benchmark finish sample for each type ofI coating and subshate required. Comply with procedures specified in PDCA P5. I l. Wall Surfaces: hovide samples on at least 100 sq. ft. (9 sq. m). 11 2. Small Areas and ltems: Architect will designate items or areas required. I 3. Final approval of colors will be from benchmark samples. I t.4 PRoJECT coNDrrroNs! A. Store materials not in use in tightly covered containers in a well-ventilated area at a minimum I ambient temperature of 45 deg F (7 <Jeg C). Maintain storage containers in a clean condition, I free of foreigrr materials and residue. I B. Apply waterbome paints only when temperatures of surfaces to be painted and surrounding air I are between 50 and 90 deg F (10 and 32 deg C). I C. Apply solvent-thinned paints only when temperatures of surfaces to be painted and surrounding I air are between 45 and 95 deg F (7 and 35 deg C). r D. Do not apply paint in snow, rain, fog, or mist; or when relative humidity exceeds 85 percent; or I at temperatures less than 5 deg F (3 deg C) above the dew point; or to damp or wet surfaces. I 1.5 EXTRAMATERI,ALS I A. Furnish extra paint materials from the same production run as the materials applied and in the I quantities described below. Package with protective covering for storage and identift with t labels describing contents. Deliver exta materials to Owner. I I PAINTING (CONSUMER LrNE PRODUCTS)0991r - l t t I I I 2.1 20021501.08 VAIL MOIJNTIANLODGE 3t22/2004 1. Quantity: 3 percent, but not less than I gal. (3.8 I-), as appropriate, ofeach material and color applied. PART 2 - PRODUCTS MANUFACTT]RERS Available Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, products listed in other Part 2 articles. Manufacturers' Names: Shortened versions (shown in parentheses) of the following manufacturers' names are used in other Part 2 articles: l. Benjamin Moore & Co. @enjamin Moore).2. Coronado Paint Company (Coronado). 3. ICI Dulux Paint Centers (ICI Dulux Paints). 4. Kelly-Moore Paint Co. (Kelly-Moore). 5. M. A. Bruder & Sons, Inc. (M. A. B. Paint).6. PPG lndustries, Inc. (Pittsburgh Paints). 7. Shenvin-WilliamsCo. (Shenvin-Williams). PAINT MATERI.ALS, GENERAL Material Compatibility: Provide block fillers, primers, and finish+oat materials that me compatible with one another and with the subsbates indicated under conditions of service and application, as demonstated by manufacturer based on testing and field experience, Material Quality: Provide manufacturer's bestquality paint material of the various coating types specified that are factory formulated and recommended by manufacttrer for ap'plication indicated. Paint-material containers not displaying manufacturels product identification will not be acceptable. Colors: As selected from manufacturer's full range. PREPARATORY COATS Concrete Unit Masonry Block Filler: High-performance latex block filler of finish coat manufacturer and recommended in writing by manufacturer for use with finish coat and on substrate indicated. Exterior Primer: Exterior alkyd or latex-based primer of finish coat manufacturer and recommended in wdting by manufacturer for use with finish coat and on substate indicated. l. Ferrous-Metal and Aluminum Substrates: Rust-inhibitive metal primer.2. Zinc-Coated Metal Substrates: Galvanized metal primer. 3. Where manufacturer does not recommend a separate primer formulation on substrate indicated, use paint specified for finish coat. B.I I t I I I I T I I I I I I 2.2 B. c. 2.3 B. PAINTING (CONSI]MER LINE PRODUCTS)09911-2 I 2002150r.08 vArL MouNTtAN LoDGE 3tzztzoo4! I C. lnterior Primer: lnterior latex-based or alkyd pnmer of finish coat manufacturer and I recommended in writing by manufacturer for use with finish coat and on substrate indicated. I l. Ferrous-Metal Substrates: Quick drying, rust-inhibitive metal primer. || 2. Zinc-Coated Metal Subsfates: Galvanized metal primer. 3. Where manufacturer does nol recornmend a separate primer formulation on subsfate indicated, use paint specified for finish coat. I 2.4 INTERIOR FINISH COATSIf A. hterior Flat Acrylic Paint: I l. Benjamin Moore; Regal Wall Satin No. 215 Premium lnterior Finishes Flat Finish. I 2. Coronado; 26Line Gold Acrylic Latex Flat Wall Paint.3. ICI Dulux Paints; l20l-XXXXDulux Ulta Velvet Sheen Interior Flat Latex Wall & I Trim Finish. I 4. Kelly-Moore; 550 Super Latex lnterior Flat Wall Paint.5. M. A. B. Pain! Rich Lux Wal-Shield Latex Flat 041 Line. ,r 6. Pittsburgh Paints; 80-Line Wallhide krterior Wall Flat Latex Paint. I 7. Sherwin-Williams; SuperPaint Interior Latex Flat Wall Paint, ,\86 Series. B. Interior Low-Luster Acrylic Enamel:I I l. Benjamin Moore; Moore's Regal AquaVelvet No. 319.2. Coronado; Tough Walls Acrylic Eggshell Wall & Trim Enamel. ll 3. ICI Dulux Paints; 1403-XXXX Duln* Ult u Eggshell Interior Latex Wall & Trim I Enamel. 4. Kelly-Moore; l610 Sat-N-Sheen lnterior Latex Low Sheen Wall and Trim Finish. I 5. Kelly-Moore; 1686 Dura-Poxy Eggshell Acrylic Enamel. I 6. M. A. B. Paint; fuch Lux Low Luste Latex Enamel 028 Line. 7. Pittsburgh Paints; 89-Line Manor Hall hrterior Eggshell Wall and Trim. - 8. Sherwin-Williams; SuperPaint Interior Latex Satin Wall Paint A87 Series. - C. Interior Semigloss Acrylic Enamel: I l. Benjamin Moore; Regal AquaGlo No. 333 Premium Interior Finishes Latex Semi-Gloss.t 2. Coronado; 22Ltne Tough Walls Acrylic Semi-Gloss Enamel.3. ICI Dulux Paints; 1407-XXXX Dulux Ultra Semi4loss Interior Acrylic Wall & Trim Enamel. fl 4. Kelly-Moore; 1650 Acry-Plex Latex Interior Latex Semi-Gloss Enamel.5. Kelly-Moore; 1685 Dura-Poxy Semi-Gloss Acrylic Enamel. I 6. M. A. B. Paint; Rich Lux Serni-Gloss Latex Enamel 023 Line. t 7. Pittsburgh Paints; 88-l l0 Satinhide Interior Enamel Wall & Trim Lo-Lustre Semi-Gloss Latex. I 8. Sherwin-Williams; SuperPaint Interior Latex Semi-Gloss Enamel A88 Series. '! D. hterior Full{loss Acrvlic Enamel: I l. Benjamin too.o Impervex Enamel No. 309.r 2. Coronado; 414 Line Super Kote 5000 Acrylic High Gloss Enamel. I I PAINTING (CONSTJMER LINE PRODUCTS)09911-3 2002I50r.08 I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t t I t I t. 2. J. 4. 5. 6. 2.5 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/22/2004 ICI Dulux Paints; 3028-XXXX Dulux lnterior/Exterior Acrylic Gloss Finish. Kelly-Moore; 1680 Dura-Poxy Gloss Acrylic Enamel. M. A. B. Paint; Rich Lux Architectural High Gloss Latex Enamel 022-127 Line. Pittsburgh Paints; 5l Line Brilliant Reflections Interior/Exterior Latex Gloss Enamel. Sherwin-Williams; ProMar 200 Interior Latex Gloss Enamel 82lW20l. Benjamin Moore; Irnpervo Enamel No. 133. Coronado; 123 Line Super Kote 5000 High Gloss Alkyd Enamel. ICI Dulux Paints; 4308-XXXX Devguard Alkyd Industrial Gloss Enamel. Kelly-Moore; 1700 Kel-Guard Gloss Allcyd Rust Inhibitive Enamel. M. A. B. Paint; Rich Lux Architectural Bright White Enamel 02G127 Line. Pittsburgh Paints; 7-814 Series Pittsburgh Paints Indusbial Gloss{il InteriorlExterior Enamel. Shenvin-Williams; ProMar 200 Alkyd Gloss Enamel 835W200 Series. G.Interior Full-Gloss Alkyd Enamel for Wood and Metal Surfaces: lnterior Semigloss Alkyd Enamel: Benjamin Moore; Satin Impervo Alkyd Low Lustre Enamel No. 235. Coronado; 23 Line Premium Gold Collection Allcyd Semi-Gloss Enamel. ICI Dulux Paints; l5l6-XXXXulfra-Hide Alkyd Semi-Gloss Interior Wall & Trim Enamel. Kel ly-Moore ; I 630-Kel-Cote lnterior Allcyd Semi-Gloss Enamel. M. A. B. Paint; Fresh Kote Semi-Gloss 403 Line. Pittsburgh Paints; 27 Line Wallhide Low Odor Interior Enamel Wall and Trim Semi- Gloss Oil. Sherwin-Williams; Classic 99 hrterior Alkyd Semi-Gloss Enamel A-40 Series. F.Interior Full-Gloss Alkyd Enamel for Gypsum Board and Plaster: 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. l. 2. )- 4. 5. 6. 7. l. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. INTERIOR WOOD STAINS AND VARNISHES Open-Grain Wood Filler: Benjamin Moore; Impervo Enamel No. 133. Coronado; 123 Line Super Kote 5000 High Gloss Alkyd Enamel. ICI Dulux Paints; 70XX Mirrolac InteriorlExterior Allcyd-Urethane Gloss Enamel. Kelly-Moore; I 630-Kel{ote Interior Allryd Semi-Gloss Enamel. M. A. B. Paint; Rich Lux Architectr:ral Bright White Enamel 026-127 Line. Pittsbwgh Paints; 7-814 Series Pittsburgh Paints Industial GlossOil Interior/Exterior Enamel. Sherwin-Williams; ProMar 200 Alkyd Gloss Enamel B35W200 Series. Banjamin Moore; Benwood Paste Wood Filler No. 238. Coronado; none required. ICI Dulux Paints; non€ required. Kelly-Moore; none required. M. A. B. Paint; Paste Wood Filler. Pittsbtrgh Paints; none required. l. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. PAINTING (CONSUMER LINE PRODUCTS)09911-4 I 20021s01.08 vArL MoUNTTAN LoDGE 3tz2tzo04r T; 7. Sherwin-Williams; Sher-Wood Fast-Dry Filler. I 8. Sherwin-Williams; none recommended. I B. Interior Wood Stain: Alkyd based. I l. Benjamin Moore; Benwood Penetrating Stain No. 234. - 2. Coronado; 69-27 Oll Penetrating Wood Stain. I 3. ICI Dulux Paints; 1700-XXX WoodPride lnterior Solventbome Wood Finishing Stain. - 4. Kelly-Moore; McCloskey Stain.5. M. A. B. Paint; Wood Stain 062 Line. I 6. Pittsburgh Pain ts; 77 -560 Rez lnterior Semi-Transparent Oil Stain.t 7. Sherwin-Williams; Wood Classics Interior Oil Stain A-48 Series. t C. Clear Sanding Sealer: Fastdrying alkyd based. !1. Benjamin Moore; Moore's Interior Wood Finishes Quick-Dry Sanding Sealer No. 413. 11 2. Coronado; 8l-10 Dual Seal. I 3. ICI Dulux Paints; 1902-0000 WoodPride Interior Satin Polyurethane Varnish. 4. Kelly-Moore; 2164EZ Sand Alkyd Q. D. Sealer. a 5. M. A. B. Paint; Minit Dri Sanding Sealer 037-005 Line. t 6. Pittsburgh Paints; 6-10 SpeedHide Quick-Drying hterior Sanding Wood Sealer and Finish.7 Sherwin-Williams; Wood Classics Fast Dry Sanding Sealer 826V43.I t D. Interior Allcyd- or Polyurethane-Based Clear Satin Vamish: I I . Benjamin Moore; Benwood Interior Wood Finishes Polyurethane Finishes Low Lustre I No.435. 2. Coronado; l5l-100 Alkyd Clear Satin Vamish. I 3. ICI Dulux Paints; 1902-0000 WoodPride Interior Satin Polytrethane Varnish. I 4. Kelly-Moore; 2050 Kel-Aqua Stain Base.5. M. A. B. Paint; Rich Lux Water Based Satin Polyurethane. I 6. Pittsbtngh Paints;77-7 Rez Varnish, Interior Satin Oil Clear. I 7. Shenvin-Williams; Wood Classics Fast Dry Oil Vamish, Satin A6G300 Series. E. Interior Waterbome Clear Satin Vamish: Acrylic-based polyurethane. It l. Benjamin Moore; Stays Clear Acrylic Polyurethane No. 423, Satin.2. Coronado; 70-10 Aqua-Plastic Urethane Clear Satin. I 3. ICI Dulux Paints; 1802-0000 WoodPride Interior Waterborne Aquacrylic Satin Vamish. f 4. Kelly-Moore; 2097 Kel-Thane II Clear Acrylic Urethane-Satin.5. M. A. B. Paint; Rich Lux Water Based Satin Polyurethane 088-900s. I 6. Pittsburgh Paints; 77 49 Rez Satin Acrylic Clear Polyurethane. fJ 7. Sherwin-Williams; Wood Classics Waterborne Polyurethane Satin, 4,68 Series. ) F. Interior'Waterbome Clear Gloss Varnish: Acrylic-based polyurethane. I'! l. Benjamin Moore; Benwood Interior Wood Finishes Polywethane Finishes High Gloss I 2. fl;"1'"1", 70-10 Aqua-plastic Urerhane clear Gloss.r 3. ICI Dulux Paints; 1808-0000 WoodPride Interior Waterbome Aquacrylic Gloss Vamish. I I PAINTING (CONSUMER LINE PRODUCTS)099n - 5 2002 I 501 .08 VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE 3/2A2OO4 Kelly-Moore; 2096 Kel-Thane II Clear Acrylic Urethane--Gloss. M. A- B. Paint; Rich Lux Water Based Gloss Polyurethane 088-899 Line. Pittsburgh Paints; 77-45 Rez Full-Gloss Acrylic Clear Polyurethane. Sherwin-Williams; Wood Classics Waterbome Polyurethane Gloss, A68 Series. t I I t I I I t I I T I I I T I I 4. 5. 6. 7. 3.1 G.Paste Wax: As recommended bv manufacturer. PART 3 - EXECUTION APPLICATION Examine substrates, areas, and conditions, with Applicator present, for compliance with requirements for paint application. Coordination of Work: Review other Sections in which primers are provided to ensure compatibility of the total system for various substrates. On request, fumish information on characteristics of finish materials to ensure use of compatible primers. Remove hardware and hardware accessories, plates, machined surfaces, lighting fxhres, and similar items already installed that are not to be painted. If removal is impractical or impossible because of size or weight of the item, provide surface-applied protection before swface preparation and paintin g. I . After completing painting operations in each space or area, reinstall items removed using workers skilled in the trades involved. Surface heparation: Clean and prepare surfaces to be painted according to manufacture/s written instructions for each particular substrate condition and as specified. l. Provide barrier coats over incompatible primers or remove and reprime.2. Cernentitious Materials: Remove efflorescence, chalk, dus! dirt, grease, oils, and release agents. Roughen as required to remove glaze. If hardeners or sealers have been used to improve curing, use mechanical methods of surface preparation.3. Wood: Clean surfaces of dirt, oil, and other foreign substances with scrapers, mineral spirits, and sandpaper, as required. Sand surfaces exposed to view smooth and dust off. a. Scrape and clean small, dry, seasoned knots, and apply a thin coat of white shellac or other recommended knot sealer before applying primer. After priming, fill holes and imperfections in finish surfaces with putty or plastic wood filler. Sand smooth when dried. b. Prime, stain, or seal wood to be painted immediately on delivery. prime edges, ends, faces, undersides, and back sides of wood, including cabinets, cormters, cases, and paneling, c. If transparent finish is required, backprime with spar vamish.d. Backprime paneling on interior partitions where masonry, plaster, or other wet wall construction occurs on back side.e. Seal tops, bottoms, and cutouts of rmprimed wood doors with a healy coat of vamish or sealer immediatelv on deliverv B. C. D. T I PAINTING (CONST]MER LINE PRODUCTS)09911 - 6 E. F. I I I I I I t I I I I I I I t I T I I 20021501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t22/2004 4. Fenous Metals: Clean ungalvanized ferrous-metal surfaces thal have not been shop coated; remove oil, grease, dirt, loose mill scale, and other foreign substances. Use solvent or mechanical cleaning methods that comply with SSPC's recommendations. a. Treat bare and sandblasted or pickled clean metal with a metal heatm€nt wash coat before priming. b. Touch up bare areas and shop-applied prime coats that have been damaged. Wire- brush, clean with solvents recommended by paint manufacturer, and touch up with same primer as the shop coat. 5. Galvanized Surfaces: Clean galvanized surfaces with nonpeholeum-based solvents so surface is free of oil and surface contaminants. Remove pretreatment from galvanized sheet metal fabricated from coil stock bv mechanical methods. Material Preparation: l. Maintain containers used in mixing foreign materials and residue. and applying paint in a clean condition, free of 2. Stir material before application to produce a mixture of uniform density. Stir as required during application. Do not stir surface film into material. If necessary, remove surface film and strain material before using. Exposed Surfaces: Include areas visible when permanent or built-in fixtures, grilles, convector covers, covers for firmed-tube radiation, and similar components are in place. Extend coatings in these areas, as required, to maintain system integrity and provide desired protection. L Paint surfaces behind movable equipment and firrniture the same as similar exposed surfaces. Before final installation of equipment, paint surfaces behind permanently fixed equipment or furniture with prime coat only.2. Paint interior surfaces of ducts with a flat, nonspecular black paint where visible through registers or grilles. 3. Paint back sides of access panels and removable or hinged covers to match exposed surfaces.4. Finish exterior doors on tops, bottoms, and side edges the same as exterior faces. 5. Finish interior of wall and base cabinets and similar field-finished casework to match exterior. Sand lightly between each succeeding enamel or vamish coat. Scheduling Painting: Apply first coat to surfaces that have been cleaned, pretreated, or otherwise prepared for painting as soon as practicable after preparation and before subsequent surface deterioration. 1. Omit primer over metal surfaces that have been shop primed and touchup painted. 2. If undercoats, stains, or other conditions show through final coat of paint, apply additional coats until paint film is of uniform finish, color, and appearance. Application Procedures: Apply paints and coatings by brush, roller, spray, or other applicators according io manufacturer's written instructions. G. H. PAINTING (CONSUMER LINE PRODUCTS)09911-7 2002 r 501 .08 VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t22t2004 Minimum coating Thickness: Apply paint materials no lhinner than manufacturerrs recommended spreading rate. Provide total dry film thiclcress of the enlire system as recommended by manu facfurer. Mechanical and Electrical Work: Painting of mechanical and electrical work is limited to items exposed in equipment rooms and occupied spaces. Block Fillers: Apply block fillers to concrete masonry block at a rate to ensure cornplete coverage with pores filled. Prime Coats: Before applying finish coats, apply a prime coat, as recommended by manufacturer, to material that is required to be painted or finished and that has not been prime coated by others. Recoat prirned and sealed surfaces where evidence of suction spots or tmsealed ,ueas in first coat appears, to ensure a finish coat with no burn-through or other defects due to insufficient sealing. Pigmented (Opaque) Finishes: Cornpletely cover surfaces as necessarj/ to provide a smooth, opaque surface of uniform finish, color, appeaf,ance, and coverage. Cloudiness, spotting, holidays, laps, brush marks, nms, sags, ropiness, or other surface impe.rfections will not be acceptable. Transparent (Clear) Finisbes: Use multiple coats to produce a glass-smooth surface film of even luster. Provide a finish free of laps, runs, cloudiness, color inegularity, brush marks, orange peel, nail holes, or other surface irnperfections. Stipple Enamel Finish: Roll and redistibute paint to an even and fine texture. Leave no evidence of rolling, such as laps, irregularity in texture, skid marks, or other swface imperfections. CLEANING AND PROTECTING At the end of each workday, remove empty cans, rags, rubbish, and other discarded paint materials from Project site. Protect work of other tades, whether being painted or not, againsl damage from painting. correct damage by cleaning, repairing or replacing, and repainting, as approved by Architect. Provide "wet Paint" signs to protect newly painted finishes. After completing painting operations, remove temporary protective wrappings provided by others to protect their work. l. After work of other trades is complete, touch up and restore damaged or defaced painted surfaces. Comply with procedrnes specified in PDCA Pl. EXTERIOR PAINT SCHEDULE Ferrous Metal: 1 . Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats over a rust-inhibitive primer. a. Primer: Exterior ferrous-metal primer (not required on shopprimed items). I I I I I I I T I I I I I I I I I I I J. N. o. P. 3.2 B. C. J.J PAINTING (CONSI.]MER LINE PRODUCTS)09911- 8 I 2002t501.08 vAIL MoLINTTAN LoDGE 3tz2/2004I b. Finish Coats: Exterior low-luster acrylic paint.r 2. Alkyd-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a rust-inhibitive primer. r i ilTr."uill;1*T":Hiffi1,::ffi:.:;H".,o:"'d on shop-primed items) II B. Zinc-Coated Metal:I l. Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats over a galvanized metal primer. I a. Primer: Exterior galvanized metal primer. b. Finish Coats: Exterior lowluster acrylic paint. f| 2. Alkyd-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a galvanized metal primer. 1; a. Primer: Exterior galvanized metal primer. t b. Finish Coats: Exterior full-gloss allcyd enamel. r C. Aluminum: I l. Acrylic-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. I a. Primer: Exterior alurninum primer under acrylic finishes. f b. Finish Coats: Exterior semigloss acrylic enamel. |1 2. Allcyd-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. I a. Primer: Exierior aluminum primer under allqyd {inishes.b. Finish Coats: Exterior full-gloss alkyd enamel. ! 3.4 INTERIORPAINTSCHEDULE I A. Concrete and Masonry (Otber Than Concrete Unit Masonry): I 1. Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. !a. Primer: Interior concrete and masonry primer. b. Finish Coats: Interior flat acrylic paint. I 2. Alkyd-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. ll a. Primer: Interior concrete and masonry primer.I b. Finish Coats: Interior semigloss alkyi enamel. I B. Concrete UnitMasonry:I l. Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats over a block filler.r i 3,*l:1*,";,ffi:'#'jffilH#"'on"oII PATNTTNG (CONSUMER LrNE PRODUCTS) 0991I - 9 r 2002l501 .08 VAIL MOI.]NTIAN LODGE 2. Alkyd-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a filled surface. a. Block Filler: Concrete unit masonry block filler.b. Finish Coat: Interior semigloss alkyd enamel. c. Finish Coats: Interior flat acrylic paint. C. Gypsum Board: l. Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. a. Primer: tnterior glpsum board primer. b. Finish Coats: lnterior flat acrylic paint. 2. Alkyd-Enamel Finish: Two linish coats over a primer. a. Primer: Interior gypsum board primer.b. Finish Coats: Interior semigloss allcyd enamel. D. Wood and Hardboard: l. Acrylic-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. a. Primer: Interior wood primer for acrylic-enamel and finishes. b. Finish Coats: Interior low-luster acrylic enamel. 2. Allcyd-Enamel Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. a. Primer: Interior wood primer for acrylic-enamel and finishes. b. Finish Coats: lnterior semigloss alkyd enamel. E. Ferrous Metal: I . Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. a. Primer: Interior ferrous-metal primer.b. Finjsh Coats: lnterior flat acrylic paint. 2. Allqyd-Enarnel Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. a. Primer: Interior ferrous-metal primer.b. Finish Coats: Interior semigloss alkyd enamel. F. Zinc-Coated Metal: 1. Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats over a primer. a. Primer: Interior zinc-coated metal primer. b. Finish Coats: lnterior flat acrylic paint. 3/22/2004 semigloss alkyd+namel semigloss alkyd-enamel I I I T I I I I I I t I I I I t I I I PAINTING (CONSUMER LINE PRODUCTS)0991I - l0 | 2oo2r5ol.o8 VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODCE 3122t2004 || 2. Alkyd-Enamel Finish: One finish coat over a primer. I a. Primer: Interior zinc-coated metal primer.b. Finish Coats: Interior semigloss alkyd enamel. G. All-Seryice Jacket over Insulatron: t l. Acrylic Finish: Two finish coats. Add fungicidal agent to render fabric mildew proof. a. Finish Coats: Interior flat latex-emulsion size. I 3.5 INTERIOR STAIN AND NATURAL-FINISH WOODWORK SCHEDI]LE I A. Stain-Varnish Finish: Two finish coats of varnish over a sealer coat and interior wood stain. Wipe wood filler before applying stain. I l. Fitler Coar: Open-grain wood filler.2. Stain Coat: lnierioi wood stain. r 3. Sealer Coat: Clear sanding sealer. I 4. Finish Coats: Interior waterborne clear satin varnish. B. Natural-Vamish Finish: Two finish coats of vamish over a sealer coat and a filler coat. I l. Filler Coat: Open-grain wood filler.2. Sealer Coat: Clear sanding sealer. I 3. Finish Coats: Interior waterborne clear satin vamish.!C. Wax-Polished Finish: Three finish coats of pasre vr'ax over a sealer coat and allcyd-basedI interior wood stain. t- 1. Stain Coat: Interior wood stain. .) 2. Sealer Coat: Clear sanding sealer. t 3. Finish Coats: paste wax. I END oF sEcrroNoggllI I t I I - ! I PATNTING (CONS{'MER LINE PRODUCTS)09911 - l I I 2002150r.08 vArL MoITNTIAN LoDGE 3t2ztz004r t SECTION0993l-EXTERIORWOODSTATNS I PARTr -GENERAL I r.r suMMARYI A. This Section includes surface preparation and the application of wood stains and clear wood I finishes to exterior wood surfaces. I I 1.2 SUBMITTALS I A. Product Data: For each type of stain indicated. I B. Samples: For each color and stain material to be applied, with texture to simulate actual - conditions, on representative Samples ofacfual substates. I I . Stained Wood: Provide 6-inch- ( I 50-mm-) square Samples.! 2. Clear Wood Finish: Provide 6-inch- ( 150-mm-) square Samples. t 1.3 PROJECT.CONDITIONS I A. Store materials not in use in tightly covered containers in a well-ventilated area at a minimum t ambient temperature of 45 deg F (7 deg C). Maintain storage containers in a clean condition, fi'ee of foreigrr materials and residue. I B. Apply stains only when temperatures of surfaces to be stained and the surrounding air aret between 45 deg F (7 deg C) and 90 deg F (32 degC) for oil-based stain, or between 50 deg F (10 deg C) and 90 deg F (32 deg C) for latex-based stain. I C. Do not apply stain in snow, rain, fog, or mist; when relative humidity exceeds 85 percent; when temperatures are less than 5 deg F (3 deg C) above the dew point; or to damp or wet stnfaces. t 1.4 EXTRAMATERIALS I A. Furnish extra stain materials from the same production nm as the materials applied and in quantities described below. Package with protective covering for storage and identifu with labels describing contents. Deliver exta materials to Owner. I l. Quantity: 3 percent, but not less than I gal. (3.8 L), as appropriate, ofeach material and color applied. I I EXTERIORWOOD STAINS 0993I - I t 2002 I 501 .08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOTINTIAN LODGE 3/2?,2004 MANUFACTURERS Available Products: Subject to compliance with requiremerts, producls that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, those listed in other Part 2 articles. Manufacturers' Names: Shortened versions (shown in parentheses) of the following manufacturers' names are used in other Part 2 articles: l. Benjamin Moore & Co. (Benjamin Moore). 2. Coronado Paint Cornpany (Coronado). 3. ICI Dulux Paint Centers (ICI Dulux Paints). 4. PPG krdustries, Inc. (Pittsburgh Paints). 5. Samuel Cabot, Inc. (Samuel Cabot). 6. Sherwin-WilliamsCo.(Shenvin-Williams). OEXTERIOR WOOD STAIN MATERIALS, GENERAL Material Compatibility: Provide primers and finish-coat materials that are compatible with one another and with the substrates indicated under conditions of service and application, as demonstated by manufacturer based on testing and field experience. Stain-Material Quality: Provide manufacturer's best-quality stain material of the various stain types specified that are factory formulated and recommended by manufacturer for application indicated. Stain-material containers not displaying manufachne/s product identification will not be acceptable. Colors: Match existing. EXTERIOR WOOD STAIN PRODUCTS Semitansparent OiYAlkyd Stain: l. Benjamin Moore: Moorwood Semi-Transparent Stain & Wood Preservative No. 081.2. Coronado: 92 Line Nordik Semi-Transparealt Stain and heservative.3. ICI Dulux Paints: 2710-XXXX Woodpride Exterior Oil Semi-Transpareat Stain.4. Pittsburgh Paints: 77-900 Series Rez Exterior Water Repellent Serni-Transparent Oil Stains. 5. Samuel Cabot: Semi-Transparent Stains 0300/6300 Series.6. Sherwin-Williams: Exterior Alkyd Semi-Transparent Wood Preservative Stain A14 Series. Semitransparent Acrylic Stain: l. Barjamin Moore: Moorwood Acrylic SerniTransparent Stain 0093.2. ICI Dulux Paints: 2610-XXXX Woodpride Exterior Waterbome Semi-Transparent Stain.3. Pittsburgh Paints: 77460 Rez Exterior Semi-Transparent Latex Stain. I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I 2.1 B. 2.2 2.3 c. A. B. EXTERIOR WOOD STAINS 0993r -2 D. F. B. c. 3.1 I I I I t I I I I t T t I I I I T I I 2002r50l.08 C. VAIL MOUNTI,AN LODGE 3t22/2004 4. Shenvin-Williams: WoodScapes House Stain Exterior Polyurethane Semi-Transparent Stain Al5 Series. Semisolid Oil/Alkyd Stain: l. Samuel Cabot: Semi-Solid Stains 0100/6100 Senes. Solid-Color Oil or Oil/Allcyd Stain: l. Benjamin Moore: Moorwood Solid Color Exterior Stain No. 080.2. Coronado: 97 Line Solid Body Oil Stain.3. ICI Dulux Paints: 2700-XXXX Woodpride Exterior Solid Oil/Alkyd Stain.4. Pittsburgh Paints: 77-600 Series Pittsburgh Paints Exterior Solid Color Alkyd/Oil Stains.5. Samuel Cabot: O.V.T. Solid Color Oil Stain 0500/6500 Series.6. Sherwin-Williams: Exterior Alkvd Solid Color Stain Al4 Series. Solid{olor Acrylic Stain: l Benjamin Moore: Moorcraft Super Spec Acrylic Exterior Stain No. 179.2. Coronado: 96 Line Solid Body Acrylic Stain.3. ICI Dulux Paints: 2600-XXXX Woodpride Exterior Waterborne Solid Color Stain.4. Pittsburgh Paints: 77-400 Series Pittsburgh Paints Exterior Solid Color Acrylic Latex Stains. 5. Samuel Cabot: O.V.T. Solid Color Acrylic Stain 0600 Series.6. Sherwin-Williams: WoodScapes House Stain Exterior Acrylic Solid Color A15 Series. Clear Wood Finish: l. Benjamin Moore: Moorwood Penetrating Clear Wood Finish & Preservative No. 088.2. Coronado: 199-10 Exterior Clear Wood Finish.3. Samuel Cabot: ClearSolutions3000/9100 Series. PART3 -EXECUTION APPLICATION Examine subsfrates, areas, and conditions, with Applicator present, for compliance with requirements for paint application. Remove hardware and hardware accessories, plates, machined surfaces, lighting fixtures, and similar items already installed that are not to be stained. If removal is impractical or impossible because of size or weight of item, provide surface-applied protection before surface preparation and staining. I . After completing staining operations, reinstall items removed using workers skilled in trades involved. Surface heparation: Clean and prepare surfaces to be stained according to manufacturer's written instructions for each particular substrate condition and as specified. Allow unseasoned or shiny new wood to weather three months before staining. EXTERIORWOOD STAINS 09931 - 3 2002 r 501 .08 VAILMOUNTIAN LODGE 3122t2004 l. Countersink steel nails, if used, and fill with putty tinted to final color to eliminate rust leach stains. 2. Previously Stained Work: Renail loose or warped shingles or siding using galvanized or aluminum nails. Mixing: Stir stain thoroughly before applying and frequently during application to maintain color consistency. Maintain containers used in mixing and application in a clean condition, free of foreign materials and residue. Minimum Spreading Rate: Apply stain at manufacturer's recomrnended spreading rate to ensure proper penetration. Use applicators and techniques best suited for substrate and type of stain material being applied. siding: Apply stain evenly with brush, roller, or spray. Thoroughly stain edges and ends of boards. Brush out excess stain that collects in butts of shingles or boards. Avoid staining in direct sunlight. Protect work of other trades, whether being stained or not, against damage from staining. correct damage by cleaning, repairing or replacing, and restaining as approved by Architect. Provide "wet Paint" signs to protect newly stained finishes. After completing staining operations, remove temporary protective wrappings provided by others to protect their work. l. After work of other trades is complete, tough up and restore damaged or defaced stained surfaces. Comply with procedures specified in PDCA Pl. EXTERIOR WOOD STAIN SCHEDULE Exterior Wood Siding: Provide the following on exterior wood siding, and wood trim including fasciae and soffrts: l. Semitransparant CIyAlkyd Stain: Two coats.2. Semihansparent Acrylic Stain: Two coats.3. Semisolid CyAlkyd Stain: Two coats.4. Solid4olor Oil or OiVAlkyd Stain: Two coats. a. Primer Coat: Apply before staining as recommended by rnanufacturer. 5. Solid-Color Acrylic Stain: Two coats. a. Primer Coat: Apply before staining as recommended by manufacfurer.6. Clear Wood Finish: Two coals. END OF SECTION 0993I I I I I I I I t I D. F. G. 3.2 I I I T I I t I I I EXTERIOR WOOD STAINS 09931 - 4 r- 20021501.08 vAIL Mot NTIAN LODGE 3/22/2004 I SECTION IOSOI - TOILET AND BATH ACCESSORIES I PART I - GENERAL I I,I SI]MMARY I A. This Section includes the following: l. Toilet and bath accessories. I 1.2 SI.JBMTITALS I A. ProductData: Foreachproductindicated. I B. Product Schedule: Indicating types, quantities, sizes, and installation locations by room of each I accessory required. Use room and product designations indicated on Drarriings. I 1.3 wARRANTI A. Special Mirror Warranty: Manufacturet's standard form in which manufacturer agrees to repair I oi replace mirrors thaidevelop visible silver spoilage defects within 15 years from date ofI Substantial Comoletion. I PART2-PRODUCTS I 2.r MANUFACTURERS A. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the I following: ! l. Toilet and Bath Accessories: !| a. As indicated in the krterior Design Specification Sheets. | 2.2 MATERTALS I A. Stainless Steel: ASTM A 666, Type 304, No.4 finish (satin), 0.0312-inch (0.8-mm) minimum I nominal thickness, unless otherwise indicated. B. Brass: ASTM B 19, ASTM B l6 (ASTM B 16M), oTASTM B 30 castings. I C. Steel Sheet: ASTM A 3661A 366M,0.0359-inch (0.9-mm) minimum nominal thickness. I D. Galvanized Steel Sheet: ASTM A 653/A 653M, c60 (2180). I I ToILETANDBATHAccESSoRTES 10801- lI 20021501.08 VAIL MOI]NTI,AN LODGE 3/22/2004 E. Chromium Plating: ASTM B 456, Service Condition Number SC 2 (moderate service). F. Baked-Enamel Finish: Factory-applied, gloss-white, baked-acrylic-enamel coating. G. Minor Glass: ASTMCI036, Typel, Classl, Qualityq2, nominal 6.0 mm thich with silvering, electroplated copper coating, and protective organic coating complying with FS DD- M-411. H. Galvanized Steel Mounting Devices: ASTM A 153/A 153M, hot{ip galvanized after fabrication. I. Fasteners: Screws, bolts, and other devices of same material as accessory unit, tamper and theft resistant when exposed, and of galvanized steel when concealed. J. Keys: hovide ruriversal keys for intemal access to accessories for servicing and resupplying. Provide minimum of six keys to Ownerrs representative. PART3 -EXECUTION 3.1 INSTAI-LATION A. Install accessories using fasteners appropriate to subsbate indicated and recommended by unit manufacturer. Install units level, plumb, and firmly anchored in locations and at heights indicated. l. Install grab bars to withstand a downward load of at least 250 lbf (1112 N), when tested according to method in ASTM F 2146. B. Adjust accessories for unencumbered, smooth operation and verifu that mechanisms firnction properly. Replace damaged or defective items. Remove ternporary labels and protective coatings. END OF SECTION 1O8OI I I t I I I I I I I I I T I T I I T ITOILET AND BATH ACCESSORIES 1080r - 2 It I I Vail Mountain Lodge 00220'00 T I sEcrtoN I1,t40 - cAs FIREPLACE APPLIANCE I PARTI-cENERALI I l.l RELATEDDocUMENTS I A. Drawings and general provisions of the Conkact, including General and SupPlem€ntary Corditions and I Division I Specification Sections, apply to this Section. I 1,2 SI.IMMARY t A. This Section includes the following: I l. Residential gas tueplaces. . a. Top Vent.b. Side Vent. r B. Rclated Secrions include the following: l. Dvision 15 Section "Natural Gas Piping" for gas pipe connections to fire places, and venting. 2. Division 16 Scction "Conductors and Cables" for services and connections to elecEical powcr and control motors and equipment I.3 SIJBMITTALS II A. Product Data: For each appliance type required indicating compliance with requircments. Include complete operating and rnaintenance instructions for each appliance. t B. Appliarrc Schcdule: Submit schedulc of appliances, using the sane room designations shown on Drawings. I 1.4 QUALITY ASSIJRANCE I A. Irutalter Qualifications: An experienced installer who is an authorized rcpresentative of the residential t appliarrce manufach,rer for both installation and maintenance of appliances required for this Project' I B. Source Limitations: Obtain residential appliances tluough one source from a single manufacturer' I L Provide appliances by a single manufacturer for entire Project. I C. hoduct Options: Drawings and Specifications indicate sizes, profiles, and dimensional requirernents ofr residential applialrces and are based on the specific rypes and models indicated. Other manufacturers' appliances with equal performance characteristics may be considered. t D. Electrical Apptiances: Listed and labcled as defined in NFPA 70, Article l0O, by a testing agcrrcy acceptable lo authorities having jurisdiction. t cAS r'tREpLAcE AppLlANcE ll'140 ' I I Vail Mountain Lodge tn220.00 IJL and NEMA Compliarrce: Provide electrical components required as part of residential appliances that are listed and labeled by IJL and that comply with applicable NEMA standards. I. Provide unit listed by Underwriter Laboratories as a vcnted decorative gas appliance. AGA and ANSI Standards: Provide gas-buming appliances thal carry the design certification seal of AGA and that corrply wilh ANSI Z2l .50b standards. I.5 DELIVERY A. Deliver appliances only after urility rough-in is complete and construction in the spaces to receive appliances is substantially complele and ready for installation. I.6 WARRANTIES A- General Warranty: Special warranlies specified in this Article shall not deprive Owrrr of other rights Owrrr may have under olher provisions of thc Contract Docuncnts and shall be in addition to, and run concurrent with, other warranlies made by Contractor under rcquirements of thc Contract Docun€nts. B. Special Warranties: Written warranties, crccuted by manufacturcr of each appliance specified agrccing to repair or replace residential appliances ot componenls that fail in rnatef,ials or worlcrnanship within waranty pcriod of I (one) year. PART 2-PRODUCTS 2.1 PRODUCTS AND MANUFACTI'RERS A. Gas Fireplace: hovide gas fireplaces complying with the following: l. Available prodncts include the following: I t I T I I I I I I t I t I I I I T I F. F. G. B. c. D. E. Nominal Size And Type: Nominal 4l inches wide by 19 irches dc"p by 38 irrches high slide-in zero clcarance type. Venling: Systern capable of venting through wall (direcr) or roof. Log Set: Manufacturer's proprietary refractory type log set with detailed log look design, capable of glowing when gas burner is operating. Burner Operation And Conlrols: l. Gas Type Natural. 2. Opa'ation: Soot-free. 3. Performance: Designed for optimum performance at altitude of project site and for varying weather conditions inchding wind, smw, rain, temperature and barometric pressure. 4. Elecronic ignition pilot light remotely controlled; locate as directed by Architect. Glass Door Panel: Clear heal-resistant lempered glass providing unobstructcd view of interior; capable of sealing the fireplace from dre roons intcrior; and easily removable for clcaning and maintenarcc. Circulating Heating: Provide face grilles altowing room air to circulaie lhrough unit's chambered box by GASNREPLACEAPPLTANCE 11440.2 I Vail Mountain Lodge 00220-00 I H. fll|,""tlli' Manufacturer's srandard factory-applied baked-on epoxy, porcelain-enamel or powder coat paint finish. I L Color: As selected from manufacturers srandard range of color and finishes. I PARr3 -ExEcurIoN I 3.I EXAI\4INATION I A. Examinc roughing-in for plurnbing, mechanical, and elcctrical services, with Insraller ptesent, to verify actual locations of services before fireplace appliance installation. I l. Proceed with instatlation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. I 3.2 INsrAIrArIoN I A' General: Comply with manufachuer's written instructions' ! B. Built-in Equipmenl Securely anchor units to supporting structue with concealed fastercrs. Verif that clearances ari adequate for proper functioning and rough openings are complelely corrccaled-II C. Utilities: Refer to Dvisions 15 and 16 for plumbing and elecrical requirements' I 3.3 AD'''TINGAND.LEANIN. I A. Test each itern of fucplacc appliances ro verify proper operation. Make necessary adjustmenB. I B. Verify that accessories required have been furnished and installed. I C. Remove packing material from fireplacc appliances and leave units in clean condition, ready for I operatio[ I ENDoFsEcrIoN lr44o t I I T I 'A'FIREPLA.EAPPLIAN.E 11440'3 I I 2002150r.08 vAILMouNTAINLoDGE 3t2ot2o04rt!l I r SECTION II45I -RESIDENTIAL APPLIANCES I. PART I-GENERAL - ! 1.1 SUMMARY A. This Section includes the following: I L Cooking equipment including cooktops, ranges, wall ovens, and microwave oven. 2. Ventilation range hoods. .t 3 Refrigerator/freezers. \Lj 4. Dishwashers. 5. Clothes washers and drvers.Irr r.z STJBMITTALS I A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated.I B. Sarnples: For each exposed frnish. f C. Appliance Schedule: Use same designations indicated on Drawings. I D. Maintenance data. I | 1.3 QUALITYASSLJRANCE rr A. Installer Qualifications: An employer of workers tained and approved by manufacturer for I installation and maintenance of units required for this Project. I B. Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70, Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for I intendeduse. t C. Gas-Buming Appliances: Comply with ANSI Z2l Series standards. I I D. Residential Appliances: Comply with NAECA standards. I t.4 WARRANTY A. Special Warranty: Manufacturer's standard form in which manufacturer of each appliance I specified ugr""* io repair or replace residential appliances or componants that fail in materialsJ or worlcrnanship within specified warranty period. I I . Electric Range: Five-year limited warranty for in-home service on surface-bumer f elements. I r-tt I \ RESIDENTIAL APPLIANCES 11451- I 20021501.08 VAIL MOI.INTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 2. Microwave Oven: Five-year limited warranty for in-home service on defects in the magnetron fube. 3. Refrigerator/Ireezer: Five-year limited warranty for in-home service on the sealed re fiigeration system. 4. Dishwasher: lO-year warranty for in-home service against deterioration of tub and door liner. 5. Clothes Washer: l0-year limited warranty for in-home service on the inner wash basket and outer tub, and five-year limited warranty for in-home service on the balance suspension system and drive transmission. PART2.PRODUCTS 2.1 MANI.]FACTI.]RERS A. In other Part 2 articles where titles below introduce lists, the following requirernents apply to product selection: l. Products: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide one of the products specified. 2.2 COOKING APPLTANCES A. Cooktop: l. Products: a. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets. B. Range: l. Products: ^. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets C. Wall Oven: l. Products: a. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets. D. Microwave Oven: l. Products: a. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets. 2. E. ExhaustHood: l. Products: a. As indicated in hoduct Specification Sheets. l I I I I il I I I T il ! ) t { I I I I / RESIDENTTAL APPLIANCES t1451 -2 I 2002150r.08 vArL Mor.rNTArN LoDGE 3/20t2004 a) I 2.3 REFRIGERATION APPLIANCES t A. Refrigerator/Freezer:rf' l. Poducts: a. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets. a']ir 2.4 cLEANING APPLIANCES I A. Dishwasher: - i_ l. Products: a. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets. ,l B. Clothes Washer: I. t l. Products: a. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets. J c. clothes Dryer: l. Products: r, a. As indicated in Product Specification Sheets.IIft t PART3-EXECUTION U |'' 3.1 TNSTALLATTON, GENERAL {!' A. Built-in Equipment Securely anchor units to supporting cabinets or colmtertops w'ith concealed fasteners. Verifu that clearances are adequate for proper functioning and rough openings are t cornpletely concealed. B. Freestanding Equipmenl Place units in final locations after finishes have been completed in t each area. Veri$ that clearances are adequate to properly operate equipment. I C. Utilities: Refer to Divisions 15 and 16 for plumbing and electrical requirements. I - END oF sEcrIoN 11451 .I tl l I I t RESIDENTIAL APPLIANCES 1145I - 3 I T T T I I I I I l t T t t t t ! I t I 20021501.08 SECTION 11460 - UNIT KITCHENS PART I - GENERAL VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE 3/20/7004 unit kitchens with laminate-clad and connections to unit kitchen electrical work associated with 1.1 SI.]MMARY This Section includes factory-fabricated and -assembled cabinets, countertops, fixtures, appliances, and accessones. See Division 15 plumbing Sections for plumbing services appliances and fixhres. See Division 16 elect'ical Sections for wiring and other connecting unit kitchens and appliances. B. c. 1.2 SUBMITTAIS A. ProductData: Foreachtypeofproductindicated. 1. Include rated capacities,'operating characteristics, and utility requirements ofappliances. B. Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments to other work. L Include wiring diagrams. C. Samples: For each exposed fmish. D. hoductcertificates. E. Manufacfurercertificate. F. Maintenance data. QUALITY ASSURANCE Manufacturer Qualifications: A qualified manufacturer that fabricates unit kitchens and their components. Manufacturers that only assernble components obtained from other sources are not acceptable. Accessibility Requirements: Provide operating controls for appliances that do not require tight grasping, pinching, or twisting of the wrist, and that operate with a force of not more than 5 lbf (22.2 N). Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70, Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. 1.3 B. C. UNITKITCHENS 11460 - I t I I I I J I I t, I ,l ! I I I I I t I 2002 l s0l .08 SECTION I1460 - LTNIT KITCHENS PART I -GENERAL VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE 3/2012004 l.l SUMMARY This Section includes factory-fabricated and -assembled unit kitchens with laminate-clad cabinets, countertops, fi xtures, appl iances, and accessories. See Division 15 plumbing Sections for plumbing servic€s and connections to unit kitchen appliances and fixtures. See Division 16 electrical Sections for wiring and other electrical work associated with connecting unit kitchens and appliances. SI.JBMITTALS Product Data: For each type ofproduct indicated. l. Include rated capacities, operating characteristics, and ufility requirernents of appliances. . Shop Drawings: Include plans, elevations, sections, details, and attachments to other work. l. Include wiring diagrams. Samples: For each exposed finish. Product cedificates. Manufacfurer certifi cate. Maintenance data. QUALITY ASSURANCE Manufacturer Qualifications: A qualified manufacturer that fabricates unit kitchens and t}eir components. Manufacfurers that only assemble components obtained from other sources are not acceptable. Accessibility Requirements: hovide operating contols for appliances that do not require tight grasping, pinching, or twisting of the wrist, and that operate with a force of not more than 5 lbf (22.2N). Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70, Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. B. c. 1.2 B. 1.3 c. D. E. F. c. B, T]NITKITCHENS 11460 - 1 2002 l 501 .08 VAILMOI.JNTAIN LODGE 3t20/2004 l. Built-in Refrigerators: Listed and labeled for recessed installation. Mount label to be visible after installation of unit; include electrical rating, type of refrigerant, and minimum installation clearances. 2. Refrigerated Unit Kitchens: Listed and labeled for entire unit as a single integrated syslem. Mount label to be visible after installation of unit; include electrical rating, t)?e of refrigerant, and minimum installation clearances. Laminate-Clad Cabinet Fabrication Standard: l. AWI 4008, Custom grade. 2. KCMAA16l.l. Provide cabinets with KCMA's'Certified Cabinet" seal affxed to a semiexposed location of each unit and showing compliance with standard.3. Either fabrication standard above. Appliance Standards: l. RefrigeratorsandFreezers: tll.250. 2. Electric Ranges: UL 858. 3. Microwave Ovens: UL 923. 1.4 WARRANTY A. . Special Warranty: Manufacturer's standard form in which manufacturer agrees to repair o'r replace components of unit kitchens or appliances that fail in materials or worlsnanship within specifi ed warranty period. l. Warranty Period for Refrigerators: Five years from date of Substantial Completion for sealed refrigeration system that includes compressor, condenser, evaporator, ard connecting tubing. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.1 MANT'FACTI.]RERS A. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, manufacturers offering products that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to, the following: l. Acme Kitchenettes Corp. 2. Cervitor Kitchens, Inc. 3. Dwyer Products Corp. MATERIALS Porcelain-Enamel-Finished Steel Sheet: ASTMA424, enameling-grade steel, uncoated thickness indicated; with exposed face and edges coated with primer, ground coat, and color cover coat; and concealed face coated with primer and ground coat; acid resistant. Medium-Density Fiberboard: ANSI 4'208.2, Grade MD. I I D. ,| I I I t I I I I I I I I I I 1 I 2.2 B. TINIT KITCHENS 11460 -2 I T I t I I I I 2.3 2002r50r.08 VAIL MOTINTAIN LODGE 3/20/2004 C. Particleboard: ANSIA208.l,GradeM-2,minimum45-lbrtu. ft. (720-kg/cu. m)density. D. Softwood Plywood: Exterior, DOC PS L E. Hardwood Plywood: HPVA HP-|, Type L F. High-Pressure Decorative Laminate: NEMA LD 3. G. Thermoset Decorative Overlay: Thermally fused, melamine-impregnated decorative paper complying with LMA SAT-1. H. Solid-Surfacing Material: Homogenous solid sheets fabricated from reacted monomers and resins, mineral fillers, and pigmcnts; in thickness indicated; compllng with ISSFA-2. LAMINATE-CLAD CABINETS Frameless-Style Base Cabinets: l. Back Panels: l/4-inch- (6-mm) thick plywood or particleboard with thermoset decorative laminate bonded to inside srnface. 2. Top and Bottom Panels: 3/4-inch- (19-mm-) thick particleboard with thermoset decorative laminate bonded to both sides. 3. End Panels: 5/8-inch- (16-mm-) thick particleboard with thermoset decorative laminate bonded to both sides. 4. Door and Drawer Fronts: 5/8-inch- ( l6-mm-) thick particleboard with thermoset decorative laminate bonded to both sides. a. Wire Pulls: Brushed+hrome finish. 5. Door and Drawer Fronts: 5/8-inch- (16-mm) thick particleboard with thermoset decorative laminate bonded to both sides. Provide continuous bevel edge at tops and bottoms of doors and bottom of drawer fronts in wood-grain laminate. 6. Drawers: Four sided, with l/2-inch- (13-mm-) thick particleboard fronts, backs, and sides, and l/4-inch- (6-mm-) thick particleboard bottom.7. Shelves: 314-inch- ( l9-mm-) thick particleboard with thermoset decorative laminate bonded to both sides and PVC edges. Wall Cabinets: Same material and finish as base cabinets, with adjustable shelves. l. Wall Shields: Fabricated from high-pressure decorative laminate of grade and color to match countertop . Provide wall shields for back wall and side walls between countertop splash and wall cabinets. Scribe Strips for Recessed Cabinets: Same material, finish, and color as cabinet. COUNTERTOPS Countertop for Drop-in Sink: Seamless, one-piece countertop with integral backsplash and side splashes. A. B. c. 2.4 t I l i t I I I tj t TJNITKITCHENS 11460 - 3 2002150t.08 VAIL MOT]NTAIN LODGE 3120t2004 I . High-Pressure Decorative Laminate: Grade HGS, bonded to 3i4-inch ( l9-mm) plywood. 2. High-Pressure Decorative Laminate: Grade HGP, post-formed, bonded to 3/4-inch (19- nrm) particleboard with Grade BKL unfinished backing sheet bonded to reverse side. FXTURES Porcelain-Enamel-Finished Steel Drop-in Sinks: 0.0428 inch (l.l mm) thick; seamless; single compartrnent. Supplies: chrome-plated copper with stops. Sink Faucet: SingleJever consol; polished chrome-plated mixing faucet with limited-swing spout and aerator. Sink Outlet: 3-l/2-inch- (89-mm-) diameter outlet with stainless-steel cup strainer and 1-ll2- inch- (38-mm-) diameter tailpiece. Drain Piping: NPS l-l/2 (DN 40) chrome-plated cast-brass tap, tubular brass waste to wall, and wall escutcheon. APPLI,ANCES Built-in Refrigerators: Fabricated with l-piece seamless steel or ABS plastic inner liner; refrigerator compartnent with slide-out or removable shelves and meat tray; adjustable automatic terpeftrture contol; door with magnetic gaskets and storage shelves; interior light; closed compartrnent for 25-lb- (ll-kg-) minimum storage of prefrozen food and 2 ice cube trays;115-Vac. l. Minimum Capacity:6.4 - undercounter. 2. Defrost Systern: Push button or manual. Built-in Electric Ovens: Porcelain-enamel-finished steel exterior surfaces; coil-element burners w"ith removable rings and reflector bowls, infinitely adjustable heating contols, and individual signal lights. Oven interior fab,ricated from I -piece porcelain-enamel-finished steel with rounded corners, with "Baken and "Broil" oven elements, automatic heat control, signal light, and removable wire oven rack; textured baked-enamel- or porcelain-enamel-finished steel oven door; 208/240-Y ac, with wiring terminated at factory-installed junction box. l. Cooktop Burners: Three elernents, each rated at 1250 W. 2. Oven Elements: Manufacturer's standard. Built-in Microwave Ovens with Exhaust Hood: Undercabinet mounted, minimum 1.0-cu. ft. (0.028-cu. m) capacity with 800 W cooking power; electronic touch controls, variable power contol, digital clock timer, interior light, tumtable, tempered glass door, and exhaust hood wittt integral light and 2-speed fan control; I l5-V ac, with 3-conductor, grounded power cord. 1. Exhaust Hood: Recirculating, nonventing type, with replaceable charcoat filter. I I 2.5 I t I I I I l I I I I I I T I B. c. D. 2.6 c. t I TINIT KITCHENS 11460 - 4 2.7 I I 2002 t 501 .08 VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE 3120/2004 ACCESSORIES Fluorescent Light Fixtures: Surface mounted to underside of overhead cabinet; with 15 W lamp, on-off switch, grounded convenience receptacle, and hanslucent plastic lens. FABRICATION General: Factory fabricate and assemble unit kitchens, with base cabinets, sink, refrigerator, and countertop shipping as a one-piece assembly. Securely fastan components, fixtures, and appliances together. L Providc manufacturer's standard hardware including concealed, adjustable plated-steel hinges; steel drawer slides with nylon rollers; and catches and rubber bumpers on doors and drawers. Unless otherwise indicated, provide chromium-plated metal or satin- finished stainless steel for exposed hardware. FINISHES PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.I INSTALLATION A. Examine roughing-in for electrical power and plumbing system(s) to verifu actual locations of connections before installation of unit kitchens. Proceed with installation onlv after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. B. General: Install level, plumb, and true; shim as required, using concealed shims. Provide fasteners, clips, backing materials, brackets, anchors, fillers, scribes, trim, and accessories necessary for complete installation. l. Anchor unit kitchens at ends and at intervals recommended by manufacturer, but not more than 36 inches (910 mm) o.c. Install anchors through backup reinforcing plates, channels, or blocking as required to prevent material distortion, using concealed fasteners. C. Comply with requirements specified in Division 15 for connecting unit kitchens to plumbing system(s). D. Comply with requirements specified in Dvision 16 for connecting unit kitchens to electrical power system. E. Test, adjust, and veriff operation of each appliance, plumbing fixh:re, and component of unit kitchens. Repair or replace items found to be defective or operating below rated capacity. F. Clean, lubricate, and adjust hardware. Adjust doors and latches to operate easily without binding. T I I I t I 1 I 2.8 2.9I I I I T I J t UNIT KITCHENS 11460 - 5 I t n I I I ti ,l I t L ,l t I 0 I 0 I 2002r501.08 ENDOF SECTION I1460 VAILMOIJNTAIN LODGE I1460 - 6I.JMTKITCHENS I 2002rs01.08 vArL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3/22/2004 I I SECTTON t4240 - HYDRAULTC ELEVATORS t PART l -cENERALI I I.I SUMMARY !A. This Section includes hydraulic passenger elevators. Ii I B. See Division 9 Section "Stone Paving and Flooring" for finish flooring in elevator cars. r 1.2 SUBMITTALS-,l; -z A. hoduct Data: Include capacities, sizes, performances, operations, safety features, finishes, and I similar information for each elevator required.I B. Shop Drawings: Show plans, elevations, sections, and large-scale details indicating service at i each landing, machine ioom layout, relationships with other construction, and locations of t equipment and signals. Indicate maximum and average power demands. a C. Samples: For each exposed finish. |' D. Manufacturer Certificates: Signed by elevator manufacturer certiffing that hoisway, pit, and t machine room layout and dimensions, as exist and shown on Drawings, and electrical service, I as shown and specified, are adequate for elevator systern being provided. - E. Maintenance manuals. t F. Inspection and Acceptance Certificates and Operating Permits: As required by authorities aving jurisdiction for normal, unrestricted elevator use. I.3 QUALITYASSURANCE I A. Regulatory Requirements: Comply with local governing regulations and with applicable provisions in ASME Al7.l, "Safety Code for Elevators and Escalators." I l. Project's Seismic Risk Zone: 0 or l. B. Accessibility Requirernents: ln addition to local governing regulations, comply with SectionL 407 in rcc Al17.l. I r 1.4 MAINTENANCE SERVICE E- A. Initial Maintenance Service: Beginning at Substantial Completion, provide 12 months' full - mainteaance service. Include monthly preventive maintenance, repair or replacement of wom I or defective components, lubrication, cleaning, and adjusting. I HYDRAULICELEVAT.RS I t4240 - 1 20021501 .08 PART 2 - PRODUCTS VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE 3t22t2004 MANUFACTURERS Basis of Design product: 1. ThyssenKrupp Elevator Group North America, Seville 30. Available Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requiremerts, manufacturers offering hydraulic elevators that may be incorporated into the Work include, but are not limited to. the following: l. Fujitec America, Inc. 2. Montgomery KONE hrc. 3. Otis Elevator Co.4. Schindler Elevator Corp.5. Schumacher Elevator Co.6. ThyssenKrupp Elevator Group North America. MATERIALS AND COMPONENTS General: Provide manufactruer's standard elevator systems, published by manufacturer as included in standard preengineered elevator systems and as required for a complete sysrem. Punrp Units: Positive-displacement type with a maximum of l0 percent variation between no load and full load and with minimum pulsations. 1. Pump: Mounted on top of oil tank with vibration isolation mounts and enclosed in prime-painted steel enclosure lined with l-inch- (25-mm-) thick, glass-fiber insulation board or submersible, suspended inside tank frorn vibration isolation mounts.2. Motor Starting: Wye delta or solid state. Hydraulic Silencers: Containing pulsation-absorbing material in a blowout-proof housing at pump unit. Protective Cylinder Coating: Two or more layers of PVC tape with a total thickness not less than 0.040 inches (1.0 mm)or other coating complying with ASME Al7.l . Car Frame and Platform: Welded steel units. Finish Materials: l. satin Stainless Steel: ASTM A 666, Type 304, with No. 6, nondirectional satin finish. OPERATION SYSTEMS Provide manufacturer's standard microprocessor operation system of the type indicated. I . Single Elevator: hovide "selective collective aulomatic ope ation" as defined in ASME AI7.I. Auxiliary Operations: I I I i I t I i t I t I I I t I l I I 2.1 B. 2.2 B. D. E. F. 2.3 B. HYDRAULIC ELEVATORS 14240 -2 a 20021501.08 VArL MOUNTIAN LODGE 3t22t2004 I I l. Battery-Powered Lowering: When power fails, cars are lowered to the lobby level, open t *:#ff;ri:ir.shut down. System includes recbarseable battery and autornatic tf r 2.4 STGNALEQUIPMENT I A. General: Satin stainless-steel signal equipment with hall-call and car<all buttons that light |J when activated and remain lit until call has been fulfilled. Fabricate lighted elements of acrylic or other permanent, nonyellowing hanslucent plastic.t I B. Car Control Stations: Manufacturer's standard car control stations mounted in return panel adjacent to car door, unless otherwise indicated. 'tI C. Emergency Communication System: Compllng with ASME A,17.1 and the U.S. Architectural & Transportation Barriers Compliance Boards "Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA), a Accessibility Guidelines (ADAAG)." On activation, system dials preprograruned number of I monitoring station and identifies elevator locatjon to monitoring station. Systern provides two-r] way voice communication without using a handset and provides visible signals that indicate when system has been activated and when monitoring station has responded. System is I contained in flush-mounted cabinet, with identification, instructions for use, and battery backuprt power supply. I D. Fire Deparhnent Communication System: Telephone jack in each car and required conductorsl| in traveling cable for fire departmant communication system specified in Division 16 Sections. a E. Car Position lndicator: Locate above car door or above car control station and include audible I signal to indicate to passengers that car is either stopping at or passing each ofthe floors served. r l. Include travel direction arrows ifnot included in car control station.I t F. Hall Push-Button Stations: Locate at each landing for each elevator or group of elevators as indicated.I I G. Hall Lanterns: Units with illuminated arrows, I l. With each lantem, include audible signals. Sigrrals sound once for up and twice for J down. i H. Hall Position Indicators: Locate above hoistway entrance at ground floor. l\It I. Corridor Call Station Pictograph Signs: Matching hall push-button stations with text and i graphics according to ASME Al7.l, Appendix H. IIt 2.5 DOOR REOPENING DEVICES I A. Infrared Array: Uniform anay of 36 or more microprocessor-controlled, infrared light beams projecting across car entrance. lntemrption of one or more of the light beams causes doors to a stop and reopelr. I T HYDRAULICELEVAT'RS I 14240 - 3 2002r 501.08 l. 2. J. A 5- I I t I I I I I I I I I t I I I l I t a. b. d- e. 2.6 2.7 2.8 VA]L MOLTNTIAN LODGE 3/22t2004 ELEVATOR CAR ENCLOSURES General: Provide manufacturer's standard enameled-steel car enclosures with removable wall panels , suspended ceiling, trim, accessories, access doors, doors, power door operators, sills (thresholds), lighting, and ventilation. l. Floor Finish: As specified in another Section.2. Wall Panels: Fire treated wood panels to be custom fabricated as specified in Division 9.3. Fabricate car with recesses and cutouts for signal equipment.4. Fabricate car door frame integrally with front wall of car.5. Stainless-Steel Doors: Flush, hollow-metal construction, fabricated from non-directional brushed stainless steel.6. Sills: Nickel Silver, with grooved surface, l/4 inch (6.4 mm) thick.7. Ceiling: Island type brushed stainless steel finish with (6) halogen downlights.8. Handrails: Manufachrer's standard cylindrical l-112" diameler brushed stainless steel handrails. HOISTWAY ENTRANCES General: Manufacturer's standard horizontal-sliding, door-and-frame hoistway entrances cornplete with t'ack systems, hardware, sills, and accessories. l. Where gypsum board wall construction is indicated, provide self-supporting frames with reinforced head sections.2. Stainless-SteelFrames: Formedstainless-steelsheet. 3. Stainless-Steel Doors: Flush, hollow-metal construction, fabricated from stainless steel.4. Sills: Nickel Silver, with grooved surface, l/4 inch (6.4 mm) thick.5. Nonshrink, Nonmetallic Grout: Factory-packaged, nonstaining, noncorroslve, nongaseous grout cornplying with ASTM C I107. ELEVATORS Elevator No.l : Type: Under-the-car single cylinder. Rated Load: 3000 lb ( | 362 kg) . Rated Speed: 200 fpm ( 1.0 nrls). Operation System: Selective collective automatic operation. Car Enclosures: Division 9. f. Door Faces (Interior): Satin stainless steel. Inside Width: 80 inches (2032 mm). lnside Depth: 57 inches (1448 rnm). Inside Height: 88 inches (2235 mm). Front Walls: Satin stainless steel with integral car door frames. Side wall Panels: Fire treated wood panels to be custom fabricated as specified in HYDRAULIC ELEVATORS 14240 - 4 I 20021501.08 VAIL MOLTNTTAN LODGE 3t22t2004 I I 6. Hoistway Entrances: J a. Width: 42 inches 0067 rnm).b. Height: 84 inches (2134 mm). I l. ffisinett-tpeed center opening' l) First Floor: Satin stainless steel- - 2) Basement Floors: Satin stainless steel, r, 3) Other Floors: Satin stainless steel. I e. Doors: 3 1) First Floor: Satin stainless steel I 2) Basement Floors: Satin stainless steel3) Other Floors: Satin stainless steel f 7. Additional Requirements: I ilili:::l5.f."#*tficate in each car, mounted under acrylic cover with satin - I PART 3 -ExECUTIoN a I 3.1 INSTALLATION r A. Excavation for Jack: Drill excavation in each elevator pit to accommodate installation of 1, cylinders; comply with applicable requirements in Dvision 2 Section "Earthwork." ! l. Provide waterproof well casings to retain walls of well hole. I B. Install cylinders in protective casings within well casings afler removing water and debris andI providing a permanent waterproof seal at bottom of well casing. t C. Install cylinders plumb and accurately centered for elevator car position and tavel. Anchor |, securely in place, supported at pit floor. Seal between well casing, protective casing, or cylinder and pit floor with 4 inches (100 mm) of nonshrink, nonmetallic grout. J t D. Leveling Tolerance: l/4 inch (6 mm), up or down, regardless of load and direction of tavel. d E. Set sills flush with finished floor surface at landing. Fill space under sill solidly with nonshdnk, I nonmetallic grout. I 3.2 FrELD QUALTTY CONTROL,I A. Acceptance Testing: On completion of elevator installation and before permitting use (either I temporary or permanent) of elevators, perform acceptance tests as required and recommended f by ASME Al7. I and by governing regulations and agencies. T H'DRAULICELEVAT'RS I 14240 - 5 .)..' 2002rs0r.08 VAIL MOI.JNTIAN LODGE 3t22/2004 DEMONSTRATION A. Engage a factory-authorized service represeltative to train Owner's maintenance personnel to adjust, operate, and maintain elevators. Review emergency provisions and train Owner's personnel in procedures to follow in identiffing sources of operational failures or malfunctions. Refer to Division I Section "Closeout Procedures." PROTECTION A. TemPorary Use: Do not use elevators for construction purposes unless cars are provided with temporary enclosures, either within finished cars or in place of finished cars, to protect finishes Iiom damage. l. hovide full maintenance service by skilled, competent enrployees of elevator Installer for elevators used for construction purpos€s. END OF SECTION 14240 I I I I I 3 I I I I t t I I t I il I I 3.4 HYDRAULIC ELEVATORS 14240 - 6 I I I DIVISION Is_MECHANICAL SPECIFICATIONS II SECTION IsOIO-MECHANICAL GENERAL PRO\ISIONS -r I.OO GENERALI I.OI RELATEDDOCUMENTS t A. The General Conditions, Special Conditions and Contract Documents are part of r these specifications. Consult them further instructions and be govemed by the requirements thereunder. I I.O2 DESCRIPTIONrI A. Work Included l. Furnish all labor and materials and perform all operations necessary for the t installation of complete and operating mechanical systems subject to ther ffi1lffi:i#l:i."#::l.*iJ,Tl;:4i#::Tthe compretion orsuch necessary for the successful operation ofall systems; this includes the fumishing of all materials for filling systems to make them operable,? including water, refrigerant, oil, grease, antifreeze and brine. Prove . satisfactory operation of all equipment and conhols to the MECHANICAL ENGINEER on request.t' B. Work Not Included I I . Certain labor and materials may be furnished and/or installed under other t divisions ofthese specifications. Coordinate with other trades and arrange the work to make the parts fit together. The following items are to be I accomplished mder other divisions of these specifications. fl a. Temporary Heat: See Paragraph I .07, this Section and Division I . b. RoofCurbs: See Paragraph 3.07, this Section. I c. Concrete: See paragraph 3.08, this Section. I d. Electrical Equipment and Wiring: See paragraph 3.09, this section. e. Temporary Water and Toilet: See Division l. f C. Equipment Fumished by OwnerJ I I ;T":r"J#11rilfi't';:Jn:fJ,T:1.il1'":"-mence concurrentrv with this I a. Equipment Installation: Refer to appropriate drawings for equipmant furnished by the Owner. I 2. Rough-in service pipes to locations as required by architectural and mechanical I drawings and equipment shop drawings. Provide service valves on all pipes except waste and vent pipes, plug or cap these. Final connections to equipmenl will be made by the Contractor. t 1.03 PROVISIONSII f X$iibVl+ffiAIY L.DGE MAR.H, 2oo4 l 15010 - I A. Work performed under this division of the specifications shall conform to the requirements of Division 1, and the mechanical drawings and all items hereinafter specified. L Prior to any work being performed under this division, examine architecfural, structural, food service, civil, electrical, specialty systems, and interior design drawings and specifications. If any discrepancies occur between them and the mechanical drawings and specifications, report discrepancies to the Architect in writing and obtain written instructions for the work.2. Mechanical drawings are diagrammatic, but shall be followed as closely as actual construction of the building will permit. All changes from drawings necessary to make the mechanical work conform to the building as constructed shall be made without additional cost to the Owner.3. Coordinate the mechanical work with the General Contractor and be responsible to him for satisfactory progress of the work. Coordinate mechanical work with all other trades on the project without additional cost to the Owner.4. All work and materials covered by drawings and specifications shall be subject to review at any time by representatives of the Architect and Owner. If the Architect or Owner's ag€nt finds any materials or installation that does not conform to these drawings and specifications, Contractor shall rernove the material from the premises and correct the installation to the satisfaction of the agent. 5. ln acceptance or rejection ofinstalled mechanical systems, no allowance will be made for lack of skill on the part of the installers. I.O4 EXAMINATION OF PREMISES/SITE A. Visit the premises site before submitting bid as no extras will be allowed for lack of knowledge of existing conditions. I.O5 CODES AIID STANDARDS A. Conform to applicable sections of NFPA 13. B. Conform to the National Electrical Code. 1999 Edifion. C. Conform to Colorado Department of Health "Rules and Regulations Governing Restaurants in the State ofColorado". D. Conform to all applicable State and Iocal Codes. E. In case of difference between these specifications, codes, laws, industry standards, and/or utility company regulations the most stringent shall govem. F. Americans with Disabilities Acts (ADA) and American National Standards Institute (ANSD 117. I.06 PERMITS. FEES AND NOTICES A. Apply for and pay for all permits, fees, licenses and inspections for this Dvision of work. VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE RENOVATION t I I I I ! I T l I l I I I T t I I I MARCH,2004 15010 - 2 t, I !, l. Do not include the cost of any "Plant Investment Fee" or "System Development t Charge" for sewer and,/or water charged by the City. This will be arranged for and paid for by the Owner. f 2. Do not include the cost of any "Gas Applicalion Fee" charged by the Utility t Company. This will be arranged and paid for by the Owner. r B. Notify proper authorities when work is ready for inspections required by applicable I codes, rules and regulations, allowing sufficient time for inspections to be made without hindering progress of the work. Furnish to the Owner copies of inspection certificates of n acceptance. T I.O7 TEMPORARYHEAT f A. Temporary heat will be fumished by the General Contractor. Use of the permanent t heating system will not be allowed without written authorization from the MECHANICAL ENGINEER. In case the permanent heating system is used for I temporary heat, the General Conhactor shall pay all costs until acceptance by the Owner. I.O8 EXISTINGUTILITIES I A. The plans indicate the location, type and sizes of various utilities within the site wherer known. These utilities are indicated as accurately as possible. Ifutilities are encountered I during construction which are not shown on the drawings, ask for instructions from ther fl:l*'.':,,f#:it?i,'f#',"#:;1il';"f,iffii,#::$*"*:t"i":fffiil'* damage caused by this construction at no extra charge to the Owner. a B. Investigate with proper authorities for all existing water taps, etc. and make arrangements I to pay for all remowal charges in original bid. t C. Owners of all undergromd utilities shall be notified at least 2 business days prior to excavation so that they can locate and mark underground facilities. I 1.09 EXISTING CONDITIONS t A. Existing systems and conditions shown on drawings for existing buildings are to be noted I "for guidance only''. The Mechanical Contractor shall field check all existing conditions prior to bidding and is to include in his bid an allowance for removal and/or relocation of f existing ductwork, piping, fixtures, or other equipmenl and adapt new and existing I mechanical system to all other work as required. - B' Existing ductwork, equipment, piping, etc. which are not indicated for reuse become the I property of the Contactor. However, fixtures, pumps, fans, fire protection equipment, etc. shall become the property of the Owner unless noted otherwise. t C. System outages shall be permitted only at times approved by Owner-in writing. Workf which could result in an accidental outage shall be performed with the Owner's maintenance personnel advised of such work. I D. Service shall be maintained to existing areas during construction. J, f VAIL MOUNTIATY LODGE MARCH,2004 15010 _ 3 RENOVATION I I I.1O DRAWINGS A. Mechanical drawings are diagrammatic and are not tobe scaled for dimensions. Take all dimensions from Architectural drawings, certified equipment drawings, and from the structure itself before fabricating any work. Veri$ all space requirements, coordinating with other trades, and install the systems in the space provided without extra charges to the Owner. B. Conceal all piping in finished areas ofthe building except where othenvise noted on the drawings. C. Install all equipment in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations, unless approval is given in writing by the MECHANICAL ENGINEER for deviation. I.I1 EXAMINATION OFBIDDINGDOCTMEI{TS A. Each bidder shall examine the bidding documents carefully, and not later than seven days prior to the date ofreceipt ofbids, shall make written request to the Architect for interpretation or correction ofany discrepancies, ambiguity, inconsistency, or eror therein which he may discover. Any interpretation or correction will be issued as an addendum by the Architect. Only a writtar interpretation or correction by addendum shall be binding. No bidder shall rely upon interpretations or corrections given by any other method. If discrepancies, ambiguity, inconsistency, or eror are iot covered by addendum or written directive, Contractor shall include in his bid, labor materials and methods of constuction resulting in higher cost. After award of contract, no allowance or extra compensation will be made on behalf of the Contractor due to his failure to make the written requests as described above. B. The person submitting the request will be responsible for its prompt delivery. Failure to so request clarification ofany inadequacy, omission, or conflict will not relieve the Contractor of responsibility. The signing of the Contract will be considered as implicitly danoting that the Contractor has a thorough comprehension offull intent and scope ofthe working drawings and specifications. I,I2 ROUGH.IN A. Verify final locations for rough-ins with field measuements and with the requirements of the actual equipment. B. Refer to equipment specifications in Divisions I through 14 and 16 for additional rough- in requirements. C. Refer to kitchen equipment drawings and equipment cut sheets provided by the Owner for kitchen equipment. 1.13 COORDINATIONDRAWINGS A. Prepare and submit a set of coordination drawings showing major elements, components, and systems of mechanical equipment and materials in relationship with other building components. Prepare drawings to an accurate scale of %"=1"4" or larger. Indicate the VAIL MOTJNTIAN LODGE RENOVATION I I I I I T t I I I I I I I I l I T I MARCII,2OO4 15010 - 4 B. B. C. D. E. F. G. H. I t I t I t I I I I t I l t I J I J I locations ofall equipment and materials, including clearances for servicing and maintaining equipment. Indicate movement and positioning of large equipment into the building during construction. Prepare floor plans, reflected ceiling plans, elevations, sections, and details to conclusively coordinate where space is limited, and where sequencing and coordination of installations are of importance to the efficient flow of the Work, including (but not necessary limited) to the following: l. 2. J. 4. 5. Ductwork Hydronic Piping Plumbing Piping Fire sprinkler piping Electrical conduit mains I.I4 MECHAIYICALINSTALLATIONS Coordinate mechanical equipment and materials installation with other building components. Veriff all dimensions by field measurements. Arrange for chases, slots, and openings in other building components to allow for mechanical installations. Coordinate the installation ofrequired supporting devices and sleeves to be set in poured in place concrete and other structural components, as they are constructed. Sequernce, coordinate, and integrate installations of mechanical materials and equipment for efficient flow of the Work. Give particular attention to large equipment requiring positioning prior to closing-in the building. Coordinate the cutting and patching of building components to accommodate the installation of mechanical equipment and materials. Where mounting heights are not detailed or dimensioned, install mechanical services and overhead equipment to provide the maximum headroom possible, and in accordance with minimum required clearances as specified in codes and regulations. The word "concealed" as used in this specification refers to such spaces as pipe and duct chases, pipe and duct tenches, above plastered ceilings, in walls and buried where pipe and/or duct is inaccessible when building is complete. "Exposed" is intended to be within equipment rooms, unfinished areas, above "push up" ceilings, accessible pipe and duct tunnels. The term "furnish" means supply and deliver to Project, unless otherwise defined in greater detail. The term "install" is used to describe operations at Project, from inspecting and unloading, to completion in place, ready for intended use. The term "provide" means fumish and install, cornplete and ready for intended use, unless otherwise defined in greater detail. 1.I5 SUBMITTALS VAIL MOUNTIANLODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15010 - 5 A. Submit under provisions of Division l. B. Proposed Product List: Include Products specified in Dvision 15 specifications. C. Submit shop drawings and product data grouped to include complete submittals of related systems, Producls, and accessories in a single submittal. D. Mark dimensions and values in units to match those specified. E. Submit miscellaneous items specified on the drawings, but not covered in the specifications. Make no substitutions without prior approval from the Architect. I.16 SHOPDRAWINGS A. Submit shop drawings on all equipment, Temperature Conftols and Fire Protection. Provide shop drawings to the Architect and Engineer showing locations of all access panels. B. Shop drawings required for this project are as follows: L Plumbing fixtures 2. Insulation 3. Boilers 4. Chillers5. Pumps 6. Fans 7. Make-up Air Units 8. Fire hotection 9. Piping 10. Motor Starters I l. Temperature controls C. Present shop drawing submittal data at one time, bound in three-ring binders, indexed in a neat and orderly manner. Partial submittals will not be accepted. Provide five sets of submittal data, unless noted otherwise in Division l. Do not begin work until one (l) copy is retr.nned. D. Provide, with shop drawing submittal, l/4" scale layout drawings of rooms with boilers, chillers, and HVAC equipment. Layouts shall show locations of, and shall be coordinated with electrical equipment, and equipment shall be drawn to scale, E. Place orders for all equipment in time to prevent any delay in constuction schedule or completion of project. If any materials or equipment are not ordered in time, additional charges made by equipment manufacturers to complete their equipment in time to meet construction schedule, together with any special handling charges, shall be bome by the Contractor. F. Contractor agrees that shop drawing submittals processed by the engineer are not change orders. The purpose of shop drawing submittals by the Contractor is to demonstrate to the angineer that the Contractor understands the desigr concept, that he demonstrates his understanding by indicating which equipment and material he intends to flrrnish and VAILMOIJNTIAN LODGE RENOVATION I I I t I T I I I T I t I I l I I l I MARCH.2OO4 15010 - 6 B. A. B. c. I I T I I I I I I I t I I I I I t t I install and by detailing the fabrication and installation methods he intends to use. Contractor further agrees that ifdeviations, discrepancies, or conflicts between shop drawing submittals and contract documents in the form of design drawings and specifications are discovered either prior to or after shop drawings and specifications shall control and shall be followed. G. Contractor to provide manufacturers' recommended installation manuals for equipment. H. Review of shop drawings does not relieve this Contractor from the responsibility of furnishing equipment and materials of proper dimension, size, quantity, quality and all performance characteristics to efficiently perform the requirements and intent of the contract documents. Review does not relieve this Contractor from responsibility for erors on the shop drawings. If the shop &awings deviate from the contract documents, advise the MECHANICAL ENGINEER of the deviations in writing accompanying the shop drawings, including the reasons for the deviations. Coordinate all required changes with the other trades affected. If the changes are occasioned by the Contractor, he shall pay any costs involved. I.I7 PROJECT/SITECONDITIONS lnstall Work in locations shown on Drawings, unless prevented by Project cortditions. Prepare drawings showing proposed rearrangement of Work to meet Project conditions, including changes to Work specified in other.sections. Obtain permission of Architect before proceeding. I.18 PROJECTRECORDDRAWINGS A. During the process of the work, maintain an accurate record of the installation of the mechanical systems. Upon completion of the mechanical systems installation, transfer all record data to blue-line prints of the original drawings. Drawings shall include all adderndum items, charge orders, altemations, reroutings, etc. As a condition of acceptance of the project, deliver to the Architect one copy ofthe record drawings. 1.I9 WARRANTY All materials and equipment shall be new unless otherwise specified. Guarantee all workrnanship, materials and equipment and replace any found defective without cost to the Owner, for one year after final acceptance, as defined in General Conditions. Each warranty for longer than the one year described above (that comes with equipment used on the job) shall be passed on to the owner with dates of start and end of the warranw. I.2O ENGINEERING BY CONTRACTOR A. The construction ofthis building requires the contractor to design several systems or subsystems. All such design shall be the completed responsibility of the contractor. VAIL MO{JNTIAN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15010 - 7 B. Systems or subsystems which require engineering responsibility by the contractor include, but are not limited to: l. Fire sprinkler. 2. Equipment supports, not fully detailed in the drawings. 3. Pipe hangers and anchors not specified in these docurnents, or catalogued by the manufacfurer. 4. Temperature controls. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2.OI EQUPMENTMANUT'ACTURDR A. Equipment in the following categories shall be of one manufacturer or available through one manufacturer for each category to facilitate ease of maintenance for the Owner. l. Motors (open drip-proof squirrel cage) 2. Starters 3. Temperature Controls 4. Plumbing Fixture Trim 5. Thermometers 6. Pressure Gauges 7. Gate Valves 8. Butterfly Valves 9. Plug Valves 10. Globe Valves I l. Check Valves 12. Balancing Valves 13. Dielectric Unions 14. Strainers 15. Air Filters 2,03 SUBSTITUTIONS (CONTRACTOR AND/OR OWNER IMTIATED) A. Materials or equipment listed by several manufacturers' names are intended to be bidder's choice, and any of the listed manufacttners may be used in the base bid. Materials or equipment not listed are considered substitutions. B. Performance Specification: When any item is specified by requirement to meet a performance, industry or regulating body standard or is specified by a generic spec, (no manufacturer's name listed) no prior approval by the Consulting Mechanical Engineer is needed unless specifically called for in these specifications. C. Contractor to be responsible for any changes and costs to accommodate any equipment except the first named in the specification. D. Substitutions for Material l. Equipment and materials not listed as equivalants may be proposed as deductive alternates to specified items by submitting it as a separate line item to the base bid on the Bidder's letterhead. 2. Such altemate proposals shall not be substituted for the base bid and must be accompanied by full descriptive data on the proposed equipment, together with a statement ofthe cost to be deducted for each item and all deviations from VAIL MOI]NTIAIY LODGE RENOVATION I I I I I t I T I I I I I I t I t l t MARCH,2OO4 15010 - 8 t I t I I T I l I I I I I I I 3 I I t specified items. Highlight all difference from specified equipment. If any such altemates are considered, the Contractor shall submit a list of the proposed alternate substitution items within 14 days of award ofcontract. Late requests for proposed substitutions shall not be accepted by the Engineer due to scheduling or delivery concems. 2.04 BID ALTERNATE(S) A. Refer to Division I and all contract documents for additional information. B. Alternate(s) for Material and Equipment 1. Equipment and material bid alternate(s) shall be proposed as additive or deductive alternate(s) to specified items by submitting it as a separate line item from the base bid on the Bidder's letterhead. 2. Such bid altemate proposals shall not be substituted or included in the base bid. Bid altemate proposal(s) must be accompanied by full descriptive data on the proposed equipment, together with a statement of the cost to be added or deducted for each item. The bid altemate shall include all materials, equipment, labor, electrical connections, coordination with all other trades, etc. for a complete and operational system. 3. The Contractor shall submit the bid altemates at the time the base bids are due. 2.05 SAFETYPROVISIONS A. . Any refrigeration system containing CFC-I l, CFC-12, HCFC-123, HCFC-2Z, or any of the other refrigerants listed in the Clean Air Act as a Class I or Class II Ozone Depleting Compound shall comply with the Clean Air Acts and the Colorado Air Quality Control Commission Regulation #1 5. B. As a minimum all systems shall be equipped with refrigerant recovery service valves, relief valves capable ofresetting after activation, and for systern with more than 50 pounds of charge, and isolateable receiver and/or condenser capable ofholding the complete charge. 3.OO EXECUTION 3.01 STORAGE A. Provide for proper storage of all materials and equipment and assume responsibility for losses due to any cause. All storage shall be witbin the contact limit lines of the building site. Cover and store all equipment and naterials out of elements; any rusted or weather damaged item shall not be used. 3.02 PRODUCTINSTALLATION A. Manufacturer'slnstructions l. Except where more stringatt requiremants are indicated, comply with the product manufacfurer's instructions and recommendations' 2. Consult with manufacturer's technical represantatives, who are recognized as technical experts, for specific instructions on special project conditions. VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE RDNOVATION MARCH,2004 15010 - 9 3. Ifa conflict exists, notify the Architect/Engineer in writing and obtain his instruction before proceeding with lhe work in question. B. Movement of Equipment T I I T t T I T I I l I I I t t I l I a. b. c. d. e. 2. 2. 4. 5. D. E. F. l. 2. c.Heavy Equipment l. 2. VAIL MOIJNTIAN LODGE RENOVATION Wherever possible, anange for the movement and positioning of equipment so that enclosing partitions, walls and roofs will not be delayed or need to be removed. Otherwise, advise Contractor of opening requirements to be maintained for the subsequent entry of equipment. Return Air Path: Coordinate mechanical work in retum air plenum to avoid obstructing retum air path. l.Do not make changes in layout which will reduce return air path cross-sectional areas. Minimum cross-sectional area will provide a maximum of 500 fpm velocity through return air plenum at specified supply air quantity unless otherwise noted. Report any obstructions by work of other Divisions to Architect/Engineer. Clearances l. Install piping and ductwork: Shaight and true. Aligned with other work. Close to walls and overhead structure (allowing for insulation). Concealed, where possible, in occupied spaces. Out-of-the-way with maximum passageway and headroom remaining in each space. Except as otherwise indicated, arange mechanical services and overhead equipment with a minimum of: a. 7'0" headroom in storage spaces. b. 8'6" headroom in other spaces. Do not obstruct windows, doors or other openings. Give the right-ofway to piping systerns required to slope for drainage (over other service lines and ductwork). Offsets, transitions and changes in direction in pipes and ducts shall be made as required to maintain proper head room and pitch of sloping pipes whether or not indicated on the drawings. Furnish and install all traps, air vents, sanitary vents, etc., as required to effect these offsets, hansitions and changes in direction. Access l. lnstall all work to permit removal (without damage to other parts) of coils, heat exchanger bundles, boiler tubes, fan shafts and wheels, filters, belt guards, sheaves and drives, and all other parts which might require periodic replacement or maintenance. Arrange pipes, ducts, and equipment to permit ready access to Coordinate the movement of heavy items with shoring and bracing so that the building structure will not be overloaded during the movement and installation. Where mechanical products to be installed on the existing roof are too heavy to be hand-carried, do not transport across the existing roof deck; position by crane or other device so as to avoid overloading the roof deck. MARCH,2004 15010 - 10 II I valves, traps, starters, motors, control components and to clear the openings of I doors and of access panels. I 3.03 PROTECTION OFWORK AND PROPERTY I A. Where there are existing facilities, be responsible for the protection thereof, whether or I not such facility is to be removed or relocated. Moving or removing any facility must be I done so as not to cause interruption ofthe work of Owner's operation. B. Close all pipe and duct openings with caps or plugs during installation. Cover all fixtures I and equipmint and protect agaLst injury. At ihe final completion, clean all work and a deliver in an unblemished condition, or refinish and repaint at the discretion ofthe Architect. I C. Do not allow any fans in the HVAC system to operate before the area served by the fan has been cleaned and vacuumed of all debris and dust which might enter the system' t D. Any equipment, duct or piping systems found to have been damaged or contaminated above "MILL" or "SHOP" conditions shall be replaced or cleaned to the Engineer's 7f satisfaction. E. kritial fill of haps .r I . Provide initial water seal fill for all waste p-traps, condensate traps, or similar ! traps. , 3.04 PROTECTION OF POTABLE WATER SYSTf,MS It A. All temporary water connections shall be made with an approved back flow preventer. I B. All hose bibbs shall have, as a minimum, a vacuum breaker to prevent back flow. t C. Direct connections to hydronic systems shall only be made through a reduced pressure back flow preventer. I 3.05 PROTECTION OF SYSTEMS SERVING OCCUPIED SPACES I A. Where work is being performed in occupied spaces, or occupancy is to be phased in with ongoing construction contractor shall prevent contamination ofall systerns serving the t occupants including but not limited to: I t' fyntr b:'ffi 311"tt o" capped or provided with adequare particulare and gas phase fihration to prevent dust, chemical, or biological contamination. I i;T*ti",:I"TiJl;|l be as a minimum equivalent to those specified for 2. Domestic Watei a. Isolate sterilized portions from non-sterilized portions. t 3.06 DEMONSTRATION I A. Refer to Division I sections of the specifications regarding requirements of Record Drawings and Operation and maintenance Manual submiltal and systems demonstration. t VAIL MOLINTIAN LODGE MARCH,2004 ls0l0 - 1I RENOVATION a l. Demonstrate that each system operates properly. 2. Explain the operation of each system to the Owner's Representative. Explain use of O&M manual in operating and maintaining systems. B. Date and time of demonstration will be determined by the Owner. ROOFCURBS A. Roof curbs and roof flashings for all equipment located on the roof shall be fumished under the Architectural Division (except for any sound curbs or rooftop units'integral curbs specified herein). Furnish and install all counter flashing ofthe same material as the flashing. 3.08 CONCRETE All poured in place concrete shall be fumished under the Architectural Divisions of these Specifications. This Contactor shall coordinate all requirements for concrete surrounding buried duct. Ducts shall be tied down to concrete deadman and completely surrounded with 3l' of concrete. ELECTRICAL EQIiIPMENT AND WIRING FOR MECIHMCAL DTYISION A. Unless otherwise indicated, all motors and controls shall be fumished, set in place and wired in accordance with the following schedule. (MD is Mechanical DMsion - ED is Electrical Division). ITEM FI.JRMSHED I.INDER SET IN PLACEOR MOT]NTED I.JNDER WIREDAND CONNECTED T'NDER l. Equipment Motors and Thermal overloads, resistance heaters (3).MD MD ED 2. Motor Controllers; magnetic starters, reduced voltage starters and overload relays. ED ED(l)ED 3. Disconnect switches, fused or unfused, H.P. rated switches, thermal overload switches and fuses, manual operating switches. ED(l)ED(l)ED 4. Push-button stations, pilot lights, multi-speed switches, float switches, thermostats, control relays, time clocks, control transformers, control panels, motor valves, damper motors, solenoid valves, EP and PE switches and interlocks. MD MD(2)lvD(2) VAIL MOIJNTIAIY LODGE RENOVATION B. t I I I I T I I I I I t I I l I I I I MARCH.2OO4 15010 - 12 I I I T t I I l I I I I I t I I t I I 5. Contactors, 120V control circuit outlets for control panels and for boiler controls and for fire protection controls and smoke detectors. ED ED ED 6. Duct Detectors, firelsmoke dampers, elevator vent dampers.MD MD ED(3) 1) If fumished as part of factory wired equipment, wiring and connections only by ED. 2\ If float switches, line thermostats, P.E. switches, time switches, etc., carry the FULL LOAD CURRENT to any motor, they shall be furnished by the Mechanical Division, but shall be set in place and connected under the Electrical Dvision, except that where such items are no integral part of tbe mechanical equipment, or directly attached to ducts, piping, etc., they shall be set in place tmder the Mechanical Division and connected by the Electrical Division. If they do not carry the FULL LOAD CURRENT to any motor they shall be fumished, set in place and wired under the Mechanical Division. Control devices carrying full load current furnished by Mechanical and wired by Electrical shall be located at the device being controlled, unless shown on drawings or mufual agreement is made between the contractors with no change in the contract price. ' (a) Wiring fiom alarm contacts.to alarm system by ED; all control function wiring bY MD. 3) The above list does not attempt to include all components. AII items necessary for a complete system shall be included in the base contract. B. Connections to all controls directly attached to ducts, piping and mechanical equipment shall be made with flexible connectors. 3.IO IDENTIFICATION A. Piping 1. All exposed piping, except piping in finished spaces, shall be identified in conformance with "Scheme for the Identification of Piping Systems", ANSI Al3. All markers must be in compliance with respect to (l) proper letter color, (2) proper letter size, (3) correct background color, and (4) proper marker length. 2. Directional flow arrows shall be applied adjacent to each pipe mark. 3. For pipes under 3/4" O.D. color coded (as described above) identification tags shall be secwely fastened at all required locations. Tags shall be l-l/2 inches in diameter. 4. All piping shall be marked at the following locations: (1) next to each valve and fitting, (2) at each branch and riser take-ofi (3) at each wall, ceiling or floor penetration, (4) on pipes that lead to and from underground areas, and (5) every 30 feet on horizontal and vertical pipe runs. Identification of all piping systems shall conform to the designations in the mechanical legend on the drawings. B. Valves VAIL MOI.INTIAITLODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 1s010 - 13 1. All valves shall be identified by color coded (to match piping system identification) tags which indicate both service and number. Tags shall be l-ll2 inch in diameter and have I /4 inch high letters to indicate service and 7116 inch high numbers. Tags shall be securely fastened to all valves. Service designations shall match abbreviations for piping systems given in mechanical legend on the drawings. Valve charts shall be provided and shall include ( I ) valve identification number, (2) service, (3) location, and (4) purpose' Valve charts shall be mounted in metal frame with glass enclosure. One valve chart shall be secured on a wall in the boiler room. A second valve chart shall be delivered to the Owner's authorized representative. Also a copy of the valve chart shall be included in the Operations and Maintenance Instructions. C. All fire dampers and their access doors shall be identified by printed stencil secured to the access door or a location approved by the Architect. D. All electric controls, starte6, air handling units, pumps, and all other equipment and controls shall be identified by stencil or permanent labeling. E. Care shall be taken not to paint over nameplates. 3.II FLUSIIING, CLEAIYING & STERILIZING A. lntent: It is the intent of this specification to require that all worlg including the inside of equipment, be left in a clean condition with all dust, grease, and construction debris rernoved. l. Piping and connection equipment to be left free of sediments, core sand, grease, etc. 2. Clean all exposed surfaces ofpiping, ducts and hangers, etc., sufficiently to receive paint. Vacuum ducts as required for debris removal. 3. Air systems shall not be operated without filters. Replace the filters or clean permanent type lilters just prior to substantial completion. All air systems shall be fumished with one additional set of filters for owner replacement. 4. Remove and clean all screens, interceptors, strainers, etc., in piping systems just prior to substantial comPletion. 5. Clean and wipe dry all plunbing fixtures, exposed valves, faucels, and piping, etc., that are exposed just prior to substantial completion. Clean all equipment and fixtures per manufacturer's specifications to avoid scratching finished surfaces. Leave all plumbing fixtures ready to use. 6. Clean interior and exterior of all air handling equipment of all construction debris. Clean exterior ofall exposed ductwork just prior to substantial completion. 7. Thoroughly clean all equipment room floors after completion of equipment, pipe and duct cleaning. A condition of final acceptance will be the cleanliness of all exposed systems, equipment, and equipment rooms. B. Before final connections are made in the piping systems, blow out all piping with air and then wash out with cleaning compounds. Then flush the system to remove of all foreign materials. Fumish all temporary connections, valves, etc, required for this purpose. Clean the boiler and chiller by the same procedure. C. After flushing, sterilize the domestic water system in accordance with Section 15400, VAIL MOT]NTIAN LODGE RENOVATION I t I I I T I ! I I I I T t l T I t I MARCH,2OO4 15010 - 14 I t 3.r2 TESTTNG f A. Test all drain and waste lines with standing water test of twelve feet of head, held long I enough to visually inspect eachjoint. -r B. Test all heating water, snowmelt, and domestic water piping at 150 psig hydrostatic I pressure before connecting to unit. C. Test all gas piping under 60 psig air pressure. I D. All tests must be done to the satisfaction of the local authorities having jurisdiction, r before covering. t E. All hydrostatic tests to be held for a minimum of six hours without loss of pressure. Air tests to be held for a minimum of two hours without loss of pressure.tt F. Fumish all instruments required for testing. I 3.13 PLACING IN OPERATIONIA. Clean all ducts, pipes, equipment, controls etc., ofplaster and other foreign debris. I R. Before final acceptance, clean or rsplace all strainers, oil or gtease all bearings and cleanI out all drains. Clean and recoat all permanent filters, replace throwaway type filters with new filters.tI C. The systems shall be put into operation. l. The Contractor shall verifu that all controls are set to meet operating conditions specified. t a. Example: Boiler operating and limit controls set where specified. 2. The contractor shall verifu that all pieces of equipment are operable and that all I sequences of control are being met. t 3. The contractor to adjust settings through I st year as required by MECHAMCAL ENGINEER. t 3.r4 BALANCING I A. The balancing of the system shall be part of this contract. Include in bid the cost of I balancine and adiustine. - B. At the completion of the installation, the mechanical systems shall be adjusted and I balanced by an indepatdent balancing firm specializing in this work. The firm must have - a Registered Professional Engineer in charge of the work, must have a local office with resident personnel in the greater Vail area or within 100 miles of the project. The hrm I must have experience and qualifications satisfactory to the MECHANICAL ENGINEER t and must be accepted by him prior to bidding. All work must be done under the direct supervision oftbe Registered Professional Engineer. The firm shall submit a booklet showing procedure and data forms to be used in balancing when asking for acceptance. I I VAII- MOTJNTIANLODGE MARCH,2004 1s010 - ls RENOYATION I I C. Before commencing work, verify that systems are complete and operable. Ensure the following: l. Equipment is operable and in a safe and normal condition. 2. Temperature control systems are installed complete and operable. 3. Proper thermal overload protection is in place for electrical equipment. 4. Final filters are clean and in place. If required, install temporary media in addition to final filters. 5. Duct systems are clean of debris. 6. Correct fan rotation. 7. Fire and volume dampers are in place and open. 8. Coil fins have been cleaned and combed. 9. Access doors are closed and duct end caps are in place. 10. Air outlets are installed and connected. I 1. Duct system leakage has been minimized. 12. Hydronic systems have been flushed, filled, and vented. 13. Correct pump rotation. 14. Proper strainer baskets are clean and in place. 15. Service and balance valves are open. 16. Report any defects or deficiencies noted during performance of services to Architect/Engineer. 17 . Promptly report abnormal conditions in mechanical systems or conditions which prevent system balance. 18. I{, for desigr reasons, systan cannot be properly balanced, report as soon as observed. 19. Beginning of work means acceptance of existing conditions. D. The Mechanical Contractor is to fumish and install such iterns as thermometer rvells, pressure test cocks, access doors, etc, as required to allow tests and adjushnents to be made as described in this section. E. The balancing firm shall make any changes of fan belts and sheaves to obtain the required cfm and make other corrections to the systems for proper performance as may be within tbe scope of the conhact as requested by the MECHANICAL ENGINEER. F. Adjust and balance all air and water systems. Check, adjust and balance all systems to meet the design conditions and tabulate all information on acceptable forms. All systems shall be checked for proper performance during desigr conditions, both heating and cooling. Balancing and adjusting shall include but not be limited to the following: l. Adjust all fan systems to deliver design air quantities within a tolerance of -5o/o to +5olo. Measure air volumes at all grilles, registers, diffusers, intake and exhaust louvers, filters and coils. Adjust and balance to meet design. conditions at site altitude.a. All built up fan systems and packaged air handling units shall be adjusted with a 1" static pressure drop developed across the filters. b. Make air quantity rneasurements in ducts by Pitot tube traverse of entire cross sectional area of duct. c. Measure air quantities at air inlets and outlets. d. Adjust distribution system to obtain uniform space temperatures free from objectionable &afts and noise. e. Use volume control devices to regulate air quantities only to the extent that adjustments do not create objectionable air motion or sound levels. I t I I I I I ! T I I I T I l l I I I VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15010 - 16 a. b. c. d. e. f. o h. I t I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I I I Effect volume control by duct intemal devices such as dampers and splitters. f. Vary total system air quantities by adjustrnent of fan speeds. Provide drive changes required. Vary branch air quantities by damper regulation. g. Provide system schematic with required and actual air quantities recorded at each outlet or inlet. h. Measure static air pressure conditions on air supply units, including filter and coil pressure drops, and total pressure across the fan. Make allowances for 50 percent loading of filters. i. Adjust outside air automatic dampers, outside air, retum air, and exhaust dampers for design conditions. j. Measure temperature conditions across outside air, return air, and exhaust dampers to check leakage. k. Where modulating dampers are provided, take measurements and balance at extreme conditions. Balance variable volume systems at maximum air flow rate, full cooling, and at minimum air flow rate, full heating. l. Measure building static pressure and adjust supply, retum, and exhaust air systerns to provide required relationship between each to maintain approximately 0.05 inches (12.5 Pa) positive static pressure near the building entries. 2. Adjust all valves and/or fittings on each piece ofradiation or water coil to provide specified air temperature rise or drop, heating or cooling capacity and gpm flow, all with control valves open. a. Adjust water systems to provide required or design quantities. b. Where flow metering devices are not installed, base flow balance on temperature difference across various heat transfer elements in the system.c. Adjust systems to provide specified pressure drops and flows tlrough heat fansfer elements prior to thermal testing. Perform balancing by measurement of temperafure differential in conjunction with air balancing. d. Effect adjustment of water distribution systems by means of balancing cocks, valves, and fittings' Do not use service or shut-off valves for balancing unless indexed for balance point. e. Where available pump capacity is less than total flow requirements or individual system parts, full flow in one part may be simulated by temporary restriction of flow to other parts. 3. After all balancing is done, tabulate the following and include in a written report to the MECHANICAL ENGINEER. RPM, amperage and voltage input to each motor (include all motors). Nameplate data and overload heater capacity installed for motor. Entrance and exit air pressure at each fan, filter, coil and louver. CFM capacity ofeach fan system, and at each grille, register, diffuser, return intake and exhaust louver. Total static pressure across each fan system. Air temperature of each heated or air conditioned space and at the entrance and exit ofeach automatic damper and coil. Entrance and discharge pressure at each pump. Water temperature and pressure at entrance and exit of each chiller, boiler, heat exchanger, heating coil and cooling coil. VAIL MOUNTIAN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15010 - t7 i. GPM flow of eachPumP. j. Gas flow and pressure to each appliance and gas pressure at meter under flow. G. Make special note of any discrepancy between tabulated conditions and specified conditions and call to the MECHANICAL ENGINEER'S attention. Rebalance and retabulate information as required by the MECHANICAL ENGINEER to meet design conditions. H. Incorporate in the report, reduced size copies of the mechanical drawings. Where the point of measurement cannot be described adequately, provide a cross reference number in the report tabulations and at the point of measurement on the drawings. I. Permanently mark settings of valves, dampers, and other adjustment devices allowing settings to be restored. Set and lock memory stops. J. After adjustment, take measurements to verif balance has not been disrupted or that such disruption has been rectified. K. At final inspection, recheck random selections of data recorded in report. Recheck points or areas as selected and witnessed by the Owner' L. Check and adjust systems approximately six months after final acceptance and submit report. 3.18 OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS A. Books of Operating and Maintenance Instructions shall be personally delivered to the Owner's authorized representative and the Owner instructed as to their use and the equipment involved. (hovide two books for each building). Also, instnrct the Orvner's personnel on each valve and the valve chart previously specified. B. The book shall contain, but not be limited to, the following general items: l. Spare parts lists for each piece of equipmant. 2. Operating manuals for each piece of equipment and control. 3. Lubrication charts showing type of lubricant and application methods and frequencies. Filter cleaning or replacement schedule. (On Contractor's letterhead stationary). Preventive maintenance schedule for checking all items such as belt drive, safety controls and oil and refrigerant charges. Cleaning schedule of all strainers, traps, coils, tubes, tower pans, sprays, etc. (On Conhactor's letterhead stationary). Water treatment recommendations for boiler, tower, etc. Normal operating instructions including a sequence of operation for each system. (On Conhactor's letterhead stationary). Instructions as to procedure to be followed for any emergency situation, such as alarms or safety items being tripped. (On Contractor's letterhead stationary). Instructions on who to call for service during guarantee period. (On Contactor's letterhead stationary). Record of equipment installed (copy ofeach shop drawing as set forth under " Shop Drawing" Paragraph). VAIL MOTJNTIAI\ LODGE RENOVATION 4. 5. I I I t I I I ! I T I I l I l I I I I 6. 8. 9. 10. MARCH.2OO4 15010 - 18 I I I 1. All warranties provided by Manufacturers on their equipment that run longer I than the one year guarantee by the Contractor' ,. C. Books shall be arranged in sequence to match the equipment schedules included in the I soecifications. D. Approval will not be given for final payment until the tests, balancing and operating I instruction portions have been completed. 3.T9 EOUIPMENTSTART-UP f All refrigeration, boilers, and packaged equipment shall be started by the manufacturer or under the manifacturer's supervision. Start-up data shall be recorded in logs' Copies ofstart-up logs I shall be forwarded to Mechanical Engineer and included in Operation and Maintenance manuals. I I ENDoFsEcrroN T t I I I I I I I I I vArL M'TINTHN L.DGE MARcH,2oo4 RENOVATION I 1s010 - t9 VAILMOIINTIANLODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 15010 - 20 I I I T I SECTION IsIOO_BASIC MATERJAL AND METHOD 1.OO GENERAL 1.OI RELATED DOCUMENTS A. The General Conditions, Special Conditions and Contract Documents are a part of these specifications. Consult them for further instructions and be governed by the requirernents thereunder. I.O2 STANDARDS FOR MATERIALS A. All materials shall conform to current applicable industry standards. Workrnanship and neat appearance shall be as important as the electrical and mechanical operation. Defective or damaged materials shall be replaced or repaired, prior to final acceptance, in a manner acceptable to the Architect or Owner at no additional cost to the Owner. B. All equipment shall have housings suitable for the location installed. C. Provide products and materials that are new, clean, free of defects, and free of damage 'and corrosion, unless specifically directed to reuse any existing materials. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2.01 MoToRs A. Fumish ball bearing, squirrel cage, open dripproof, normal starting torque motor of the horsepower and current characteristics specified with thermal overload protection and dustproof and leak proofbearing rings and consrmcred for use at the altitude where the work is'to be located. Motors guaranteed to operate continuously at full load with temperature rise in any part not to exceed NEMA Standards. Motors shall be commercially, dynamically balanced and tested at the factory before shipment and selected for quiet operation. Provide motors for V-belt &ives with a cast iron and steel base, with slide rail and adjustable screw device and belt guard. Line up motors and drives and place motors and equipment on foundations ready for operation. B. Motors rated I horsepower or greater shall be Department of Energy (DOE) approved "energy efficient", meeting the requirernents ofEP Act92, and shall meet NEMA l2-6C full load efficiencies. Where not commercially available, power factors shall be capacitor corrected by equipment manufacturer to at least 90 percent under rated load conditions. 2.02 BELT DRIVES A. Provide belt drives with cast iron sheaves, either companion driven sheaves (except for two groove) or fixed pitch sheaves. If fixed pitch sheaves are used, the MECHANICAL ENGINEER reserves the right to direct speed changes be made, if in his opinion, these are warranted after final balancing. Fixed pitch sheaves shall be bushed type. Provide two groove adjustable VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I I I I I t I I I 3 I I I I MARCII.2()()4 15100 - I drive sheaves with a key for holding pitch adjustment. Use standard FHP, A, B, C and D Sections. FHP belt drives may be used for motors less than tltee horsepower. Select belt sections for drives for three horsepower and over from the following chart: MOTOR SPEEDS HP 1750 a.3A b.5A c. 7.5 B e. 108 B. Provide matched belts sized for 150% of motor schedule horsepower. When A-B sheaves are used. use B Section belts onlv. 2.03 ACCESS DOORS A. Provide painted, steel access doors with key lock suitable for the strface in which they are installed and satisfactory to the Architect. Recessed style to accept plaster finish, recessed bpe to accept acoustical tile, flush panel for drywall or flanged flushed panel for remodeling. ln installed in fire rated surface, access door to carry proper rating. 2.05 ALTITUDE RATINGS A. Except as otherwise noted, all equipment capacities, air qualities, etc., are adjusted ratings for the elevation of this project as noted on drawings. Manufacturer's ratings shall be adjusted to provide net ratings shown. 2.06 FLEXIBLE PIPE CONNECTIONS A. For steel piping, construct with stainless steel inner hose and braided exterior sleeve. B. For copper piping, construct with bronze inner hose and braided exterior sleeve. C. Use connectors suitabl€ for minimum 125 psi WSP and 450" and 200 psi WOG and 250"F. D. Construct spool pieces to exact size for insertion of flexible cormection. 2,07 FIR.E STOPPING MATERIAL A. General: l. Products to be used shall have been tested in accordance with ASTM E 814-88 and be listed in the UL Fire Resistance Drectorv. B. Bare Piping: l. Model FD 150 or CP-25. VAIL MOIINT{N LODGE RXNOVATION I T I t I I I I I I I I t I l I I t I ll60 A A B B MARCH.2OO4 15100 - 2 t I I t I t C. lnsulated Piping: l. Model: CP-25 or FS-195. Intumescent. 2. "No-sag" or "selfleveling" as required. D. Plastic Piping: l. Model: CP-25 or FS-195 lntumescent. 2. "No-Sag" or "Self leveling" as required. E. Accessories: l. Provide Fasteners, Restricting collars, backing materials, and protective coatings as required to comply with the UL system listing. F. Manufacturers: 1. 3M or G.E. 3.OO EXECUTION ) t 3.01 FREEZE PROTECTION I A. Proximity of any equipment component or fluid piping to potential damager ffi;ffrl':lxilHl".l';l:111*lffiH:""1''j;"ffT:1'"j"Ti deJces and/or heat sources as necessary to prevent or minimi ze freeze ! damage potential. The Architect/Engineer will neitber guarantee nor be responsible for any consequences of freezing. I 3.02 \rBRATroN rsoLATroNI A. Equipment I l. Erect all floor mounted equipment on 4" high concrete pads over the I complete floor area of the equipment. 2. Where inertia bases are indicated, pow these bases within structural channel ;; frames having mountings attached to the inside perimeter and furnished with I supplementary spring units. Furnish bases with an 18 gauge sheet metal bottom welded in place to retain the concrete. Anchor bolts and reinforcing bars are to I be set in the field, #5 reinforcing bars top and bottom, 12" o.c. both ways.I il::ffi$iffi#:ff""fir:;:"f":J*"["#'"1J"',#"1-,.]h'"Tiill'li"-",,, No damping material shall be used between the inner and outer housing on I mountings and mountings shall have a combination lifting and leveling adjustment and ll4" thick neoprene acoustical friction pads bonded to the steel base. I 3. Mount supply and return cenkifugal fans, cabinet fans and air handling units t (where called for on plans) on inertia base with a weight equal to not less than l- l/2 times the combined weight of the fan and motor. Where centrifugal fan is I used, mount fan and motor on common steel base. f] 4. Support each air or refrigeration compressor, (including temperature conffol compressor) base mounted pump, factory assembled air handing unit and fan by Mason Industries or equivalent spring type vibration isolators, as follows: I I vArL M.'NTATNL'DGE MARcH,2oo4 RENOVATION I 15100 - 3 EQUIPMENT GROTIND SUPPORTED SLAB ORBASEMENT MASON 20'FLOOR SPAN POSSIBLE FLOOR DEFL 0.67* MASON Engr. Spec Min Static Defl. (in.) Engr' Spec. Min Static Defl. (in.) Refrigeration Machines (Note 2) I . Absorption Machines 2. Centrifugal Chillers or Heat Pumps a. Cooler condenser Mounted Hermetic- Compressors b. Cooler condenser alongside Hermetic- compressors c. Open Type Compressors Note3) 3. Refrigeration Reciprocating Cornpressors ^. 500 RPM to 750 RPM b. 751 RMP and over 4. Reciprocating Chillers or Heat Pumps a. 500RPMto750RPM b. 751 RMP and over AK A-K A-K A-G-K B B C-K c-K 0.3s 0.35 0.35 0.35 0.75 0.7s 0.75 0.75 c-K C-K C-K C.G.K B B C-K C.K 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 1.5 0.75 1.5 0.75 b. Pumpsffi#al 1. Close Coupled a. Ttru 5 HP b. TYzHP andlarger c. A-J.K B-J-K 0.35 0.75 B-J-K B-J-K 0.75 0.75 c. FactoryAssembledH&VUnits L Suspended Units a. Thru 5 HP b. 7-ll2l{F and larger - 275 RPM TO 4OO RPM c. 7-l/2HP and larger - 401 RPM and over 2.Floor Mounted Units a. Thru5HPb. l-llzHP and larger - 275 to40l RPM D D D A A 1.0 1.5 1.0 0.35 0.35 D D D B B-H 1.0 1.5 1.0 0.75 1.5 I I I VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION t I I I I l I I I I I l T I I T MARCH,2004 15100 - 4 B. t I I T t I I I T ! I I I I I I I I I 5. All mountings used out ofdoors shall be hot dipped galvanized' 6. Equipment with operating weight different than the installed weight, such as chillers and cooling towers and equipment exposed to wind, such as roof fans, cooling towers, etc., shall be mounted on sPring mountings as directed in Mason Engineering Spec. B, but a housing shall be provided that includes vertical limit stops to prevent spring extension when weight is removed' Limit stops shall be out of contract during normal operation. Piping l. Chillers, a. Isolate all refrigerant piping from the structure throughout by double deflection spring and neoprene hangers with 1" deflection. Hang piping so that it does not touch any part of the structure. Connect pipes to compressor or condensing unit with convoluted bellows braided metallic flexible pipe connectors. b. Isolate all condenser water piping, connected to condenser on any packaged chiller with a reciprocating compressor' from the structure throughout the equipment room by double deflection spring and neoprene hangers with l" deflection' Hang piping so that it does not touch any part of the structure. Connect pipes to condenser and to cooling tower with Teflon flexible equipment connectors' VAIL MOI'NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION d. Air Compressors (Note2) l. TankType 2. Hoiz, Vert, 1 or 2 CYlinder lNoie s) a. 275 RPMto499RPM b. 500 RPM to 800 RPM B-J-L B-I-L B.I-L 0.75 2.5 1.5 B.J-L B.J-L B-J-L 0.75 2.5 1.5 e. Blowers I . Utilities Sets a. Floor Mounted (Note tl b. Roof Mounted c. SuspendedUnit (!fd€ z. Centrifugal Blowers (l iefr) A 1l A.J 0.35 0.35 B c D B-J 0.75 0.75 2.5 3. Tubular Centrifugal and Axial Fansffjffi a. Suspended Units b. Floor Mounted w,Motor on/in Fan Casing c. Floor Mounted Arrangement 1 or anY Separately Mounted Motor A-J D A Refer to Guide. 0.35 B-J 0.35 B 0.75 MARCH.2OO4 15100 - 5 c. Isolate all chilled water piping, connected to evaporator on packaged chiller with reciprocating compressor, from the structure throughout the equipment room by double deflection spring and neoprene hangers with l " deflection. Hang piping so that it does not touch any part of the structure. Connect pipes to evaporator with Teflon flexible equipment connectors. 2. Domestic Hot and Cold Water, Heating Water and Waste Piping a. Domestic hot and cold water piping one inch diameter and smaller shall be isolated with the Acousto-Plumb System of orange and blue pipe isolators, holders, and guide, as manufactured by LSP/Specialty Products CompanY, Tel (800) 854-3215. b. Isolate waste piping and domestic hot and cold water piping larger than one inch in diameter with Trisolator system of pipe isolators as manufactured by Elmdor/Stoneman, Te!. (818) 968-8699. c. Do not allow the piping, pipe connectors, pipe hangers or valve to directly touch the structure, studs, glpsum board, or other pipes. d. Copper waste piping must be completely wrapped with Lowry's acoustical pipe wrap. The wrap is manufactured by Harry A' Lowry' Tel. (818) 768466r' Flexible Connections 1. Where ductwork or piping is connected to fans, air handling units, pumps, or other equipment that may transmit vibration along the piping or ductwork, connect by means of a flexible connection constructed of fire resistant canvas, flex piping, or other approved method. Connections shall be suitable for pressures developed at the point of installation. Flexible material shall be waterproof for weather exposed ductwork, shall show no visible strain during operating conditions, and shall comply with code requirements. Flex connections for range exhaust systems shall be fire rated. 3.03 PIPE HANGERS A. General 1. Provide pipe supports for vertical lines at each floor. Provide pipe hangers to support the systems without sagging, including hangers at each offset or change in direction, at ends of branches over five feet in lenglh and at the following maximum sPacing: Hanger Rod Diameter Pipe Size Haneer Spacine (Minimum) 3/4" and smaller 6 ft.3/8" 3/8" 3/8" v2" l/2" 5/8' 7/8" lu I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I t I T I 8ft. C. B. 1-ll4" through 2" 10 ft. 2-112" through 3" l0 ft. 4" through 5' l0 ft. 6" throueh 10" 2ff 12" and larger Cast iron no hub hrdividual Hangers t2ft. 5 ft. and atjoints VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 15100 - 6 l. 2. J. I I t t I T I Individual hangers for non-insulated copper piping and insulated copper heating piping and insulated domestic hot water and circulating water piping shall be copper plated, adjustable swivel ring hangers similar to Auto Grip 500, Kin-Line felt lined 440-F or Michigan Hanger Company Series 102 with polyvinyl coating, with insulation over hangers. krdividual hangers for insulated cold piping (steel or copper) shall be zinc plated, adjustable swivel ring hangers similar to Auto Grip Figure 800, Kin Line 400 Series, Michigan Series 103. Hangers shall support pipe with hangers over the insulation. The system shall be complete with Auto Grip or MichiganZinc plated steel shield' Pipe Shields or Kin-Line 460 zinc plated steel shield. Provide insulation insert of high density polyethylene foam, calcium silicate, higb density glass fiber or expanded perlite divided in longitudinal half sections and covered with fire resistant vapor banierjacket' High density inserts are not required in plumbing walls behind plumbing fixtures. Individual hangers for all insulated or non-insulated steel piping (except steam and high temperature hot water) shall be zinc plated, adjustable swivel ring hangers similar to Auto Grip Figure 400, Kin- Line 400 Series, Michigan Series 100. Hangers shall support pipe with insulation over hangers. Individual hangers for steam and high temperature water piping (250T and above) shall be adjustable swivel pipe rolls, similar to Grinnel No. l7l' l8l or 174 with pipe covering protection saddle, similar to Grinnel No. 185-186 or 360o zinc plated steel shield for insulation thickness specified. Trapeze Hangers 1. Parallel runs of piping may be supported on trapeze hangers- Trapeze shall be unistrut P-1000-3 or Kin Line 211,371or 372 equivalort by Elcen or Kindorff. System shall be selected to support five times the weight of thrust applied without failure. All non-insulated steel pipe and insulated steel heating water pipe shall have standard pipe straps at each support. All non-insulated copper pipe, insulated copper domestic hot and re-circulating water piping and insulated copper heating piping shall rest on n€oprene sleeves and have standard pipe straps at each support. All cold insulated pipe (steel or copper) shall rest on Fee and Mason Figure 8l or equivalent by unistrut, or Kin-Line, galvanized steel insulation shield or 360o galvanized steel shield. Provide insulation insert of high density polyethylene foam, calcium silicate, high density fiber glass or expanded perlite divided in longitudinal halfsections and covered with fire resistant vapor barrierjacket' Provide pipe strap over insulation at each support. High density inserts are not required in plumbing walls behind plumbing fixtures. All steam and high temperature hot water pipe shall have pipe covering protection saddle and shall be supported on Unistrut P-2474-3,pipe rollers or equivalent at each support. See this Section, 3.02, Vibration Isolation for special hangers. T t A 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. I I t I I I T I I I C. 3.04 CONTROL VALVE PIPING VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE MARCII. 2OO4 RENOVATION 15100 - 7 A. If the control valve size is smaller than the pipe size marked on the drawing, the reduction in size pertains to the valve only. Gate valves, globe valves, and strainers on either side of the automatic valve shall be a minimum of the pipe size marked on the drawings. 3.05 PI]MP CONNECTIONS A. Where the suction or discharge of any pump unit is smaller than the pipe size noted on the drawings, all strainers, valves, flexible connections, expansion joints, etc., shall be a minimum of the pipe size noted on the drawings. 3.06 ACCESS DOORS A. Fumish an access door for each pipe chase for each floor. This includes both toilet plumbing chases and pipe riser chases. Access doors assembly to be minimum size of 16" x 16". B. Also, furnish access doors in all non-removable ceilings and in paflitions and walls where necessary to maintain access to plumbing cleanouts, shock absorbers, fire dampers, manual dampers, valves and other mechanical devices rgquiring access. Size these as required for access. C. Provide all access doors to the General Contractor for him to constuct into the building. D. Submit shop drawing indicating the locations of all access doors' 3.07 WELDING A. Provide all welding in accordance with the welding procedrnes of the National Certified Pipe Welding Bureau or other approved procedure conforming to the requirements of the ASME Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code, or the ASA Code for Pressure Piping. Only welders who have been fully qualified under the specified procedure shall be employed. 3.09 PIPE DEPTHS A. Interior pipe below slabs shall be a minimum of 4 inches below slab and shall not be in contact with concrete at any point. Minimum extsrior cover over water piping, unless otherwise shown or required by code, shall be 8 feet above the top ofthe pipe. Area drains shall have maximum cover possible consistent with finished landscape and acceptable flow lines. Gas piping shall have minimum of 3 foot cover with waming tape 12" above pipe. Sanitary waste and storm drain lines shall have 3 foot cover minimum. 3.IO PIPE AND PIPE FITTINGS A. Full length pipe in longest lengths possible shall be used. All threads shall be right hand, pipe standard, clean cut, full depth and tapering. hstall piping so as to permit complete draining. Provide drains at all low points. All interior soil, waste and condensate lines shall have uniform pitch in the direction of flow ofnot less than l/4 inch per foot unless otherwise noted. Ream out all pipe ends, tum on ends and rattle before installing. 3.11 DUCTS VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION t T I I I T I I T I t I T I I I I I I MARCH,2OO4 15100 - 8 t I I I I T I t I t t I t I I I t I ,l A. Constn:ct straight and smooth with neatly finished joints, air-tight and free from vibration. lntemal ends of slip joints shall be made in the direction of flow. Changes in duct dimensions and shape shall be gradual and uniform. Curved elbows, unless otherwise noted, to have centerline radius of at least l-l12 times the duct width. Air tums shall be installed in all abrupt elbows and shall be arranged to permit air to make turns without appreciable turbulence and to remain quiet when the system is in operation. Construction ofducts shall be per the details and recommendations of the latest edition of the ASHRAE handbook and U.M.C. The most stringent requirement govern in conflicts. "Duct mate" joint method may be utilized provided all portions of seam/joint materials are provided by "duct mate" and installed in strict compliance with manufacturer's standards. 3.12 FIRE DAMPERS AIYD FIRE/SMOKE DAMPERS A. tnstall as required by NFPA pamphlet No. 90A, the Uniform Building Code, Uniform Mechanical Code and as required by local codes. Provide a duct access door to each fire damper and service access when architecture is restrictive. Fumish UL 5555 labeled fire and fire/smoke dampers. Refer to architectural drawings for fire resistive ratings of walls, floors, ceilings, etc. 3.13 FLE)(IBLECONNECTIONS A. Where ductwork or piping is connected to fans, air handling units, pumps, or other equipment that may traismit vibration along the piping or ductwork, connect by means of a flexible connection constructed of fire resistant canvas, flex piping, or other approved method. Connections shall be suitable for pressures developed at the point of installation. Flexible material shall be waterproof for weather exposed ductwork, shall show no visible shain during operating conditions, and shall comply with code requirements. FIex connections for range exhaust systems shall be fire rated. 3.I4 CLEAI\'ING A. Intent: It is the intcnt of this specification to require that all work, including the inside of equipment, be left in a clean condition with all dust, grease, and construction debris removed. Refer also to specification Section 01710. B. Piping and connected equipment to be left free of sediments, core sand, grease, etc' C. Clean all exposed surfaces of piping, ducts and hangers, etc., sufficiently to receive paint. Vacuum ducts as required for debris removal. D. Air systems shall not be operated without filters. Replace the filters or clean pennanent type filters just prior to substantial completion. All air systems with disposable filters shall be fumished with one additional set of boxed filters for owner replacement. E. Remove and clean all screens, interceptors, strainers, etc., in piping systems just prior to substantial completion. F. Clean and wipe dry all plumbing fixtures, exposed valves, faucets, and piping, etc. that are exposed just prior to substantial completion. Clean all equipment and fixtures per VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE RENOVATTON MARCH.2OO4 15100 - 9 manufacturer's specifications to avoid scratching finished surfaces. Leave all plumbing fixtures readY to use. G. Clean interior and exterior of all air handling equipment of all constnrction deb,ris. Clean exterior of all exposed ductwork just prior to substantial cornpletion' H. Thoroughly clean all equipment room floors after completion of equipment, pipe and duct cleaning. A condition of final acceptance will be the cleanliness of all exposed systems, equipment, and equipment rooms. 3.I5 EXPANSIONCOMPENSATION A. Examine piping layout and provide anchors or expansion joints required to adequately Protect system. B. Install flexible pipe connectors on pipes connected to equipment supported by vibration isolation. C. Accomplish structural work and provide equipment required to control expansion and contraction of piping, loops, pipe offsets, and swing joints, and provide comrgated bellows type expansion joints where required. 3.16 SLEEVES, CUTTING, PATCHING A. Major openings in the structure for mechanical work may be shown on the structural drawings, these will be done under the Architectural Dvision of these Specifications. It is the Contracto/s responsibility to set necessary sleeves and boxes for pipe and ducts (not shown on the structural drawings) before erection of structure. This Contractor is responsible for the correct size and location of all openings including coordination with the other trades. All sleeves shall be large enough to allow for continuous insulation to pass through the sleeve. B. ln mechanical equipment room floors, all pipe sleeves to the Schedule 40 pipe and shall extend I " above finished floor. In mechanical equipment room floors, all ducts shall have a 4" high concrete curb arormd duct' C. Caulk all pipes and ducts leaving equipment rooms between sleeve and duct or pipe, l" deep on each side of wall, floor, or roof. Caulk bare pipes and ducts with lead wool. Caulk insulated pipes with I or 2 part polysulphide caulking compound. D. In the same marmer as described in Paragraph C above, caulk all other pipes and ducts tbroughout the buitding which p€netate walls and floors and roofs this includes prpe and ducts to rooftoP units. E. All pipes which may be in view shall be finished with chrome floor, wall and ceiling plates, excePt in equiPment rooms. 3.T7 FOUNDATIONS AI{D SIJPPORTS A. Furnish and install as indicated on the plans and/or as may be necessary for the proper installation of all equipment furnished under this Division, all foundations, bases and VAIL MOT]NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I T I I I I I I t I I I t I I I I I t' MARCH,2OO4 15100 - l0 t f supports. Contractor shall be responsible for their correct location and sizes to fit allI ilffiil:il,f.H;::,rH,::il"':lll,'"::,'jff:il#*?:'"::il'"il,il"';"J""1,"il1' I B. Fumish all hangers, anchors, sway bracing, guides, etc., for the various piping and duct systems as required for their proper installation. I 3.19 FrRE sroPPrNGa _ A. lnstall firestopping materials in accordance with their UL and ASTM tested methods. I B. Coordinate required annular space with size of pipe and sleeve' I C. Requirements for specific systems: I . Cold piping: Includes chilled water, domestic water, storm water and I refrigerant: Insulation and vapor barrier shall be continued through t wall and firestopping for "insulated piping" shall be provided. 2. Hot piping to 250oF includes domestic hot water, steam to 15 psig - and heating hot water: The Conhactor has the option of continuingt :T,'$:*il';"[:::l;T,ffffHiff:il1'4";':?,?:l':"i:T;if."' penetration and using firestopping for uninsulated piping".r 3 E:?if#"fiH:,:Tll3#iJ,''#;l,T,ll!"l,.l,iif,,1l!.T; "','temperature piping". . EI\ID OF SECTIONI I I I I I I I vArL M.'NTATN L.DGE MARcH,2oo4 RENOVATION I 15100 - 1l t t I t I SECTION T525o--INSULATION 1.OO GBNERAL 1.OI RELATED DOCUMENTS A. The General Conditions, Special Conditions and Contract Documents are a part of these Specifications. Consult them for further instructions and be govemed by the requiremarts thereunder. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2.OI ACCEPTABLEMANUFACTURDRS Owens Corning, Johns Manville, Armstrong, Keene and Knauf insulation will be considered equal names to the insulation specified and will be acceptable without prior approval by the MECHANICAL ENGINEER. 2.O2,A.CCEPTABLEPRODUCTS A. This specification allows several methods of insulating valves, fittings, etc., but it is the contractor's and the manufacturer's responsibility to assrne themselves that the code authorities will approve any product to be installed on the project' 3.OO DGCUTION 3.01 DOMESTIC COLD WATER PIPING A. Generall. It is the intention ofthis specification to insulate and provide a vapor barrier on all surfaces in the piping system. B. Insulate with U.L. approved, flame resistant, l/2" thick glass fiber, 850o pipe insulation with white, vapor barrier jacket with self-sealing lap as made by Johns Manville Company or equivalent. Seal longitudinal seam overlap with staples with vapor barrier adhesive over staples. Seal ofends of the pipe insulation atall valves, fittings, flanges and hangers with vapor barrier coating. C. Valves, Flanges, Unions and Fittings l. Insulate with pre-molded insulation sections. Secure sections in place with tape and trim insulation to assure an even transition with adjacent pipe insulation. Apply glass fabric circumferentially around insulation sections and then apply a vapor barrier mastic over the entire surface to provide a vapor seal. 2. Apply cement over surface, smooth and finish cement to make a flush transition with adjacent pipe insulation. After cement has dried, apply glass fabric circumferentially around cement. Apply a vapor-barrier mastic over entire surface to provide a vapor seal. 3. Insulate with factory precut, 2 layer insulation and cover with factory premolded, one piece, PVC insulation fitting covers (covers to beUL 25/50 rated). Tuck the ends ofthe insulation snugly into the throat ofthe fitting and the edges adjacent I I t I I I I I I I I I I I VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15250 - I to the pipe fitting. Secure the one piece PVC fitting cover by stapling and taping the ends to the adjacent pipe covering. All seam edges of cover sealed with vapor barrier pressure sensilive color matched tape. The tape shall extend over the adjacent pipe insulation and have an overlap on itselfat least 2 inches on the dorvnward side. 3.02 DOMESTIC HOT WATER PIPING A. lnsulate all hot water supply lines and circulating water lines with U.L. approved, flame resistant, I " thick glass fiber, 850" pipe insulation with white, flame resistant jacket with self-sealing lap as made by Johns Manville Company or equivalent, with ends butted. Seal off the ends of the pipe insulation at all valves, fittings' flanges, etc' B. Valves, Flanges, Unions and Fittings l. lnsulate with pre-molded insulation sections. Secure sections in place with tape and trim insulation to assure an even hansition with adjacent pipe insulation. Apply glass fabric circumferentially around insulation sections. Z. Apply cement over surface, smooth and finish cement to make a flush transition with adjacent pipe insulation. After cement has dried, apply glass fabric circumferentially around cement. 3. lnsulate with factory precut, 2 layer insulation and cover with factory premolded, one piece, PVC insulation fitting covers (covers to be UL 25150 rated). Tuck the ends of the insulation snugly into the throat of the fitting and the edges adjacent to the pipe fitting. Secure the one piece PVC fitting cover by stapling and taping the ends to the adjacent pipe covering' 3.03 IIEATING PIPING; SNOWMELT MAINS,IIEATING WATER AI\D ANTIFREEZE PIPING A. PiPe l. lnsulate with U.L. approved, flame resistant, glass fiber, 850" pipe insulation with white, flame resistant jacket with self-sealing lap as made by Johns Manville Company or equivalent. Seal offends of the pipe insulation at all valves, fittings, flanges, etc' 2. Piping connections between baseboard radiation elements and radiant ceiling panels need to be insulated. B. Valves, Flanges, Unions, Fittings and Air Separators' l. Insulate wilh pre-molded insulation sections. Secure sections in place with tape and trim insulation to assure an even transition with adjacent pipe insulation. Apply glass fabric circumferentially around insulation sections and then apply a vapor barrier mastic over the entire swface to provide a vapor seal' 2. Apply cement over surface, smooth and finish cement to make a flush transition with adjacent pipe insulation. After cement has dried, apply glass fabric circumferentially around cement. Apply a vapor-barrier mastic over entire surface to Provide a vaPor seal' 3. Insulate with factory precut, 2 layer insulation and cover with factory premolded, one piece, PVC insulation fitting covers (covers to beUL25/50 rated). Tuck tbe ends ofthe insulation snugly into the throat ofthe fitting and the edges adjacant to the PiPe covering. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION t T I T I t I I I I t I t I I I I I I MARCH,2OO4 t5250 -2 t I T I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I 4. On fittings where temperature exceeds 250"F 'zlayers of the factory precut insulation inserts shall be applied with a few wrapping of twine on the first layer to be sure lhere are no voids or hot spots. The fitting cover shall then be applied over the insulation as described above. C. Expansion Joints I . tnsulate all expansion joints in piping with blanket type insulation of same thickness as the pipe insulation. Hold the blanket in place by wire or galvanized straps for ease of removal' 3.04 CHILLED WATER PIPING A. General l. It is the intention ofthis specification to insulate and provide a vapor barrier on all surfaces in the PiPing system. B. Pipe l. Insulate with U.L. approved, flame resistant, glass fiber 850" pipe insulation with white, vapor barrier jacket witb self sealing lap as made by Johns Manville Company or Armstrong's "Accotherm" a molded rigid phenolic form pipe insulation or equivalent. Vapor barrier jacket to have vapor transmission rate of less than .01 perms. Seal longitudinal seam overlap with staples with vapor barrier adhesive over staples. End joints to be secured with factory fumished vapor barrier tape and adhesive. Seal off ends of the pipe insulation at all valves, fittings, flanges and hangers with vapor barrier coating' C. Valves, Flanges, Unions, Fittings, Air Separators and Pump Casings. l. lnsulate with pre-molded insulation sections. Secure sections in place with tape and trim insulation to assure an even transition with adjacent pipe insulation. Apply glass fabric circumferentially around insulation sections and then apply a vapor barrier mastic over the entire srnface to provide a vapor seal. 2. Apply cement over surface, smooth and finish cement to make a flush transition with adjacent pipe insulation. After cement has dried, apply glass fabric circumferentially around cement. Apply a vapor-barrier mastic over entire surface to provide a vapor seal. 3. Insulate with factory precut, 2 layer insulation and cover with factory premolded, one piece, PVC insulation fitting covers (covers to be UL 25150 nted). Tuck the ends ofthe insulation snugly into the throat ofthe fitting and the edges adjacent to the pipe fitting. Secure the one piece PVC fitting cover by stapling and taping the ends to the adjacent pipe covering. All seam edges of cover sealed with vapor barrier adhesive. The circumferential edges of cover shall be wrapped with vapor barrier pressure sensitive color matched tape. The tape shall extend over the adjacent pipe insulation and have an overlap on itselfat least 2 inches on the downward side. 3.05 PIPE INSI]LATION SCHEDULE VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15250 - 3 PIPING SYSTEM TYPES FLUID TEMPERATURE RANGE, OF. PIPE SIZES Run Outs up to 2" (l) I" and Less t-t/4 to 2" 2-t/2 to 4" 5" to 6" 8" and Larger Low temperanne r20-200 %%I t-r/2 l-112 l-U2 Chilled Water 40-50 %Y2 314 I I I (1) Runouts not exceeding 12' in length to Individual Terminal Units. 3.06 DUCT INSULATION A. Inside Duct Liner. See Section 15800 Ductwork. B. Boiler Breeching: l. Emergancy Cenerator Exhaust Pipe and Muffler Insulate with factory pre- molded, flame resistant, hydrous calcium silicate rated 1400T. 2. lnsulate with 2" mineral fiber blanket insulation, 14001F service temperature, Eagle Pitcher or equivalent. Cover with l8 gauge, l" mesh galvanized wire, apply 712" insulating cement, trowel smooth and finish with 8 oz. canvas jacket applied with fire retardant lagging adhesive, or finish over the galvanized wire' with glass cloth and vinyl acrylic mastic coating with dry film thickness of 1/16". EI\[D OF SECTION VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I T I I t I I T I I I I I I I I I t I MARCH.2OO4 15250 - 4 I I I I T I I I I I I I I I t I T I I SECTION Is4OO-PLUMBING r.OO GENERAL I.O1 RELATEDDOCUMENTS A. The General Conditions, Special Conditions and Contract Documents are a part of these Specifications. Consult them for further instructions and be govemed by the requirements theretmder. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2.OT WATER PIPING MATERIALS A. Piping Outside Building l. All pipe outside the building to the service termination inside the building, 4" and larger; class 250, cement lined, cast iron, or ductile iron of manufacturer's recommended thickness class, mechanical joint or push on joint. 3" and smaller; Type "K", hard drawn copper using hard solder having a minimum melting point of I l00iF' B. Piping Inside Building 1.. Piping from the service termination throughout the rest ofthe building, for buried lines; Type "K", hard drawn copper, wrought copper fittings and hard iolder having a minimum melting point of 1100"F: for non-buried lines, Type "L", hard drawn copper, wrought copper fittings and 95-5 solder' Where copper tube is joined to brass, steel or other dissimilar metal, use I l00o solder. C. Valves and Specialty Schedule I . Gate Valves a. Bronze, Class 125, 200 psi W.O.G. screwed, or iron body, brass trim, class 125' 200psi W.O'G. flanged. 2. Globe Valves a. Bronze, class 150, 300 psi W'O.G. screwed, or iron body, brass trim, class 125,200 Psi W'O.G. flanged. 3. Check Valves a. Bronze, Class 125, 200 psi W'O.G' screwed, or iron body, brass trim, class 125, 200 Psi W.O'G. flanged. 4. Pressure Gauges a. 4-l/2" dial,bronze bourdon tube. Pressure ranges as required' Brass level handled cock and pigtail. U.S. Gauge Figure 5801, Trerice 600, Danton 101 or equivalent. 5. Thermometers a. Multi angle with separable socket, red reading mercury. U'S' Gauge MN-9, Trerice B X 9, Duro 9 EZ or equivalent. 6. Dielectric Unions a. Provide dielectric pipe unions at all cormections where ferrous material is connected to non-ferrous material. 7. Strainers VAILMOI'NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15400 - I a. 250 lb. semi steel or case iron "Y" type flanged with brass screen, or 250 lb. semi steel "Y" screwed with monel screen. 8. Press Temp Taps a. Universal Controls Corporation #45-PT-N or Sisco BNO-500, l/2'NPT, Nordel Core. 2.02 SOIL, WASTE, VENT AND STORM DRAIN MATERIALS (to 10 ft. outside building) A. Pipe I.Waste and vent lines buried below ground to a distance of l0 ft. from the building; coated, standard weight, cast iron soil pipe and fittings, Class 50 ductile iron pipe and fittings or hubless, cast iron soil pipe with cast iron couplings approved for below grade installation. From this point on shall be as specified under "Sanitary Sewer." Waste lines above ground 3" and over; standard weight, cast iron soil pipe and fittings, or hubless, cast iron soil pipe and fittings. Pipe up through 2-712" in size; standard weight, galvanized steel pipe and black cast iron recessed drainage fittings, or standard weight, cast iron soil pipe and fittings, or hubless cast iron soil pipe and fittings. Vent piping above ground 2" and over; standard weight, cast iron soil pipe and fittings, or standard weight, galvanized steel pipe with 150 lb. galvanized malleable iron fittings. Pipe l-l/2" and under; standard weight, galvanized steel pipe with black cast iron fittings for 125 lb. SWP. Waste and vent piping above ground may be DWV copper drainage pipe and fittings using 50-50 solder. Storm drainage pipe and Iittings above ground; standard weight, galvanized steel pipe with black cast iron recessed drainage fittings, or DWV copper drainage pipe and fittings using 50-50 solder, or standard weight, cast iron soil pipe and fittings or hubless (use clamps rated to max. head pressures of50'on l-l/2 to 4"; 40'on 5" and 6"; 30'on 8" and 10" when building is 3 stories or more in height), cast iron soil pipe and fittings. All drains within the building below ground to a distance of 10 ft. from the building, standard weight, cast jron soil pipe and fittings, Class 50 ductile iron pipe and fittings or hubless cast iron soil pipe with cast iron couplings approved for below grade installation. From this point on shall be a specified under " Storm Sewer". The following table indicates the permissible joints for the various type of pipes. All joints in vitreous clay pipe shall be installed in accordance with ASTM desigration C-12 and joints using materials having resilient properties in accordance with ASTM C425-64 and C425-'7 | . PIPE HOTPOI.]RED BITUMINOUS COMPOUND RESILIENT JOINT l. Clay X (only when water table is below pipe)X 2. Cast Iron X X C.Hangers B. Joints 1. VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I t I t I I I I t I T I t I T t I I I 2. 4. 5. MARCII,2OO4 15400 - 2 I t I I I T I I I T I T I I I I I I I l. Suspend all horizontal lines in building with adjustable split swivel hangers similar to Grinnel No. I t 5. or as shown' with rod and suitable base' 2.05 GAS PIPING MATERIALS A. Pipe and Fittings: Schedule 40 black (or galvanized) steel pipe. l. Above grade piping; 2 inches and smaller, use 150 lb. malleable iron fittings and threaded joints in exposed locations and standard weight socket weld fittings and welded joints in inaccessible locations. Over 2 inches, use seamless steel butt weld fittings and welded joints in exposed locations and standard weight socket weld fittings, same thickness as pipe, and welded joints in inaccessible locations. B. Valves l. Lubricated Plug Valves 2. Class 125, 175 lb. W.O.G. cast iron, screwed, or flanged with low friction coated plumb. 3. Non Lubricated Plug Valves 4. Class 150, 175 lb. W.O.G. semi steel, screwed or flanged, DeZuik435, Rs49 or Homestead l5l2 or 1522. 2.06 FIXTURE EQUIPMENT SCIIEDULE 3.OO EXECUTION 3.OI PREPARATION A. Ream pipe and tube ends. Remove burrs. B. Remove scale and dirt, on inside and outside, before assembly. C. Prepare piping connections to equipment with flanges or unions. 3.02 INSTALLATION A. hovide non-conducting dielectric connections wherever jointing dissimilar metals. B. Route piping in orderly manner and maintain gradient' C. Install piping to conserve building space and not interfere with use of space. D. Group piping whenever practical at common elevations' E. Install piping to allow for expansion and conhaction without stressing pipe, joints, or connected equipment. Provide clearance for installation ofinsulation and access to valves and fittings. Provide access where valves and fittings are not exposed. Coordinate size and location of access doors with Architect. H. Slope water piping and arrange to drain at low points. YAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION F. G, MARCH.2OO4 15400 - 3 I. Where pipe support members are welded to structural building framing, scrape, brush clean, and apply one coat of zinc rich primer to welding. J. Prepare pipe, fittings, supports, and accessories not prefinished, ready for finish painting. Refer to Division 9. K. Excavate in accordance with Division 2 for work of this Section. L. Backfill in accordance with Division 2 for work of this Section. M. Install valves with stems upright or horizontal, not inverted' 3.03 APPLICATION A. Install unions downstream of valves and at equipment or apparafus connections. B. Install butterfly valves or gate valves for shut-off and to isolate equipment, part of sy$ems, or vertical risers, and where indicated on drawings. C. Instatl butterfly valves for throttling, bypass, or manual flow control services, and where indicated on drawings. 3.04 WATER PIPING A. Inside Building l. Terminate domestic service inside building wall or above floor slab. Piping ro be continued under this section. 2. lnsulate all buried pipe within the building as per Insulation Section ofthese Specifications and surround with 4" or clean sand. 3.05 SOIL, WASTE, VENT & STORM DRAIN (to 10 ft. outside bldg.) A. General L Main lines within the building; provide a uniform fall of not less than one inch in eight feet. 2. Branches; provide a uniform fall ofnot less than one inch in fow feet. 3. Horizontal lines suspended from structure; provide hangers at five feet intervals or wherever necessary to inswe proper grading' 4. Vertical lines: anchor at each floor level. 5. Fixtures; vent in accordance with sound plumbing practice and applicable codes. B. Cleanouts 1. Install full size brass cleanout plugs wherever pipes change direction or otherwise require cleanouts for proper cleaning of entire drainage systems. All wall cleanouts shall be located [4'-6" above floors in (commercial) areas] and [l'- 6" (residantial) areas]. Provide cleanouts at 50 feet maximum intervals for pipe 4" and less in size, 100 feet with interv'als for 5" prpe and larger. Cleanouts to have brass plugs with ch'rome plated cover plates for walls, scoriated brass cover VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I T I I I I I I I I t I T I I I I I I MARCH,2OO4 15400 - 4 B. C. D. I I I I I T I I I I I I I T t I t I T for floor, flush with floor or wall. Avoid locating floor and wall cleanouts in visible living and sleeping areas. 3.06 GAS PIPING General I . All underground pipe shall be buried 24 inches minimum and surrounded with 4" clean sand before backfilling. All buried joints shall be welded and left exposed until testing has been completed. 2. (All except Colorado Springs) ^. Gas meter and service from the main to the meter will be furnished and installed by the utility company, paid for by the Owner. Fumish and install all gas piping from the meter throughout the building and connect to all equipment required. 3. Provide "Tee" will plug in line on house side of meter for measuring pressures and flows. 4. Buried Pipe Coating 3.07 FIXTT'RES AND EQUIPMENT Fixhres l. Install all fixtures and/or rough in according to the fixture schedule. 2. All fixtures shall be secured to walls, floors or countertops in accordance with manufacturer's roughing in and setting requirements to form a rigid installation. 3. All pipe at all the fixtures, which may be exposed to view, shall be brass chrome finish, finished with chrome escutcheons where they project from walls and floors. 4. All floor drains connected to the sewer system shall be equipped with rap primers. Provide trap primers with backllow preventers and connect to the nearest cold water piping adjacent to a flushing fixture. Install in accordance with manufacfurer's recommendations. 5. Stop valves shall be fumished and installed at all fixtures, for all equipment and at rough in locations. 6. Vacuum breakers shall be provided at all outlets with hose connections. 7. All exposed domestic hot water and waste at handicapped accessible fixtures shall be insulated with Truebro "Lav Guard" or equivalent. Kitchen Equipment l. All water, waste and vent piping which may be in view shall be brass or copper, chrome finish. Valving 1. Provide valves on all water and gas piping lines before they leave the basement, crawl space or trench. Install shut off valves and access panels for all plumbing groups of more than 4 fixtures. Hose Bibbs 1. Provide and install hose bibb in each equipment room where there is a cold water line present. 3.08 FLASIIINGS VAIL MOI.'NTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 15400 - 5 A. Flash each vent and stack through roof in accordance with the roofing manufacturer's recommendations. B. Flash roof drains in accordance with roofing manufacturer's recommendations. Clamp flashing into roof with roofing. 3.09 DISINFECTION OFDOMESTIC WATER PIPING SYSTEM A. Prior to starting work, veriff system is complete, flushed and clean. B. Ensure pH of water to b€ treated is between 7.4 and 7.6 by adding alkali (caustic soda or soda ash) or acid (hydrochloric). C. tnj ect disinfectant, free chlorine in liquid, powder, tablet or gas form, throughout system to obtain 50 to 80 mell residual. D. Bleed water Uorn or'ir.o to ensure distribution and test for disinfectant residual at minimum l5 percent of outlets. E. Maintain disinfectant in svstem for 24 hours. F. If final disinfectant residual tests less than 25 mg/L, repeat treahnent. G. Flush disinfectant from system until residual equal to that of incoming water or l.mg/L. H. Take samples no sooner than24 hours after flushing, from l0 percent of outlets and from water entry, and analyze in accordance with AWWA C60l and local health deparfrnent standards. 3.IO PLUMBING PIPING TESTINC A. Prior to starting work, veriff system is completc, flushed and clean. B. Soil, waste and vent system shall be tested with water equal to the maximum height of the system, but not less than l0 feet. System shall maintain water level for period of four (4) hours with no noticeable water loss. C. Water piping shall be tested to 125 psig for four (4) hours with no pressure drop. D. Gas piping shall be tested in accordance with applicable requirements set forth in the Uniform Plumbing Code. E. Compressed air piping shall be tested to 200 psig. for four (4) hours with no pressure drop. END OF SECTION VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I I I I I T I I I I I I t t I I I I I MARCH,2OO4 15400 - 6 I I I I I I I I I T I I I I I t I t t sEcTroN 15600--HEAT GENERATION, REFRIGERATION AIYD LIQUID HEAT TRANSFER 1.OO GENERAL 1.OI RELATED DOCUMENTS The General Conditions, Special Conditions and Contract Documents are a part ot these Specifications. Consult them for further instructions and be governed by the requirements thereunder. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2.OI PIPING MATER]ALS A. Low Pressure (124 psi and less) l. Low Temperafure (249'F and less) Contactor's option, either steel or copper for water pipe as outlined below. All fittings to be long radius pattem' 2. Steel Pipe a Anti-freeze, , chilled water, and heating water piping; Schedule 40' black steel. butt weld ASTM-A-53. b Fittings on exposed pipe 2" and under may be 125 lb' cast iron screwed, or for any water lines, 150 lb. malleable iron screwed. Fittings on concealed pipe, use forged steel, standard weight, butt weld or socket welded. Fittings on plPe 2-l/2" and over, use forged steel, standard weight, butt weld. Where flanging to valves equipment, etc., use 150 lb. forged steel flanges or 125 lb. cat iron flanges. For branch lines on welded installation welding tees, thread-o-lets or weld-o-lets shall be used. No stub-in branches will be approved except in radiant panel grids. c All fittings for anti-freeze systems shall be butt weld or socket weld. 3. CopperPipe a Heating water piping, chilled water piping; type "K" copper with wrought copper fittings and I1001F solder for all buried lines. For non-buried lines; type "L" copper with wrought copper fittings and 95-5 solder. Where copper pipe isjointed to brass, steel or other dissimilar metal, use I l00T solder. b Drain pan piping; type "M" copper with wrought copper fittings and 95-5 solder on all lines not buried. Type "L" copper with wrought copper fittings and 95-5 solder for all buried lines' B. Mechanical Pipe Coupling (Contractor's Option for 3" and larger heating water, dual temperature, condenser water or chilled water piping at presswes of 124 psi and less.) 1. Couplings a Mechanical pipe couplings may be used to connect mechanical equipment to piping system and may be used in lieu of unions or welded, flanged, or screwed pipe. b Couplings shall be self-centered and shall engage and lock in place the grooved or shouldered pipe and pipe fitting ends in a positive watertight couple. Some degree of angular pipe deflection, contraction and expansion should be allowed. VAIL MOIJNTIAII LODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 15600 - r I I I I t I I I I T I I I I I I I T I C. c Couplings housing clamps shall be fabricated in two or more parts of malleable iron castings. Housing clamps shall hold in place a composition water sealing gasket designed so, that intemal water pressue serves to increase the seals water tightness. Water sealing gasket shall be molded synthetic rubber in accordance with ASTM Specifications with special heat resistance test of 16 hours at 200 degrees F., and maximum elongation charge or minus 30 percent. d Coupling assembly shall be securely held together by two or more tackhead. oval neck, steel bolts. Bolts and nuts shall be heat-treated carbon steel and shall be in accordance with ASTM-A-183. e All pipe fittings used in connection with pipe couplings shall have grooved or shouldered ends and shall be fabricatcd of malleable iron castings in accordance with Federal Specification, QQ-I-666 D. Grade II. f Before assembling couplings, lightly coat pipe ends and outside of gaskets with cup grease or graphite paste to facilitate installation. g Pipes, fittings and valves shall be provided with grooved or shouldered ends in accordance with pipe coupling manufacturer's latest published literature. Flanged or threaded end valves may be used with grooved adapters. h Couplings and fittings shall withstand a system pressure ofnot less than 150 psi. i Entire coupling installation shall be done in accordance with manufacturer's latest published literature. Snowmelt Tubing: l. 2. J. 4. 5. 6. VAIL MOIII\TIAN LODGE RENOVATION VALYE AND SPECIALTY SCIIEDT]LE A. Steel, Low Pressure (l24psi and less) B. Low Temperature (249iF and less) l. Gate Valves: Class 125, 200 lb. W.O.G. bronze screwed, or iron body, bronze mounted, flanged. 2. Butterfly Valves: 150 psi W.P. for 250T service, positive tight shut off for flow in either direction. Provide level handle for services through 6", totally enclosed gear actuator 8" and larger. Full lug iron body to permit retention ofvalve to one flange only. Rigid back field replaceable resilient seat and bronze or welded All tubing to be cross linked polyethylene with an oxygen diffusion barrier. Tubing to be rated for continuous operation of 100 psig and a temperature suitable for the specific application. Factory manifolds shall be equipped with manual shut of?balance valves for each loop and be equipped with zone valves as required. System shall be capable of withstanding temperatures l80oF to 230"F for limited periods of time. Install piping and manifold in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations. Snowmelt piping shall be placed on 9 inch centers and shall be capable of producing 150 btuh/sq.ft with 100'F ewt, 30oF wtd. Tube diameter, nominal 5/8',. Wirsbo pePex or Stadler, EHT equivalent. Polybutylene and rubber type piping not permitted. MARCH.2OO4 15600 - 2 J I a I I I I 0 il I I I E I h T il ! I I nickel edge disc. Extended neck to allow for 2" of insulation when used in insulated lines. Centerline Series LT, Crane #14N, Demco NE 'DeZuik 632 L, ITT Grinnell Series 8000, Keystone 228, Stockham LD-31l-B33-B Hammond 382 Series or equivalent. Plug Valves: 176 lb. W.O.G., 150 psi W'P. for 250oF service. Eccentric, positive tight shut offvalve with permanently lubricated stem bearing surfaces in upper and lower joumals. hovide adjustable position stop for all valves used in balancing service. Level actuated on sizes 5 "-8" where pressures do not exceed 100 psi. Gear actuated on higher pressures and on all sizes 10" and larger' Gears to have adjustable position stop. l/2" through 4"; DeZurik Figure #435. 5" and larger; DeZurik Figure #1 18, Homestead lndustries Series 1500 series or equivalent. Globe Valves: Class 150, 300 ]b. W.O.G. bronze screwed, or Class 125' 200 lb' W.O.G. iron flanged. Check Valves: Class 125, 200 lb. W.O.G' bronze screwed, or iron flanged or 125 psi W.P. iron noiseless check valve for purnp discharges, "Muessco" l0l-AP' "Miller Streamflow" 153, Gulf Valve MB12 or equivalent. Flo-Control Valve: Bell & Gossett Flo-Control, Taco Flo-Chek or Hoffman Flo- Control Valve. Balancing Shut Off Valve: 125 psi W.P. for 250o service, tight shut off brass valve. internal mechanism which can be set at balancing position, Illinois Dual Purpose Balancing/Shut Offvalve, Milwaukee BBI-100, Hoffman, Sarco or equivalent. Unions: 300 lb. w.O.G. malleable iron screwed or 125 lb. cast iron flanged union. Strainers: 250 lb. semi-steel or cast iron uYu type, screwed with monel screen or flanged with brass screen. (for steam or water as required). Pressure Gauges: 4-112" dial,bronze bourdon tube' Presswe ranges as required. Brass lever handled cock and piglail. U.S. Gauge figrne 5801, Trerice 600' Danton l0l or equivalent. Press.-Temp. Taps: Universal Controls Corp. #45-PT-N, Sisco ENO-500' 1/2" NPT, Nordel core or equivalent. Thermometers: Multi-angle with separable socket, red reading mercury. U.S. Gauge MN-9, Trerice B x 9, Duro 9 EZ or equivalent. C.Copper, Low Pressure (124 psi and less) Gate Valves Low Temperature (249'F and less): ends. Class 125, 200 lb. W.O.G. bronze, solder Globe Valves: Class 150, 300 lb. W.O.G. bronze, solder ends' Check Valves: Class 125, 200 lb. W.O.G. bronze, solder ends. Balancing Valves: 125 psi W.P. for 2500 service, tight shut off brass valve with internal mechanism which can be set at balancing position, Illinois Dual Purpose Balancing/Shut Off Valve, Milwaukee BB1-350, Hoffman, Sarco or equivalent. Flo-Control Valves, Radiator Valves, Pressure Gauges, Pressure Temperature Taps, Thermometers. Same as specified for steel suitable for use in copper pipe. EQUIPMENT SCIIEDULE 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 1. 2. J. 4. 5. 3.OO E)GCUTION 3.01 PIPEWORK VAIL MOI]NTIAN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 15600 - 3 t IA. Grade and valve all heating, snowmelt, and chilled water piping systems with 3/4" hose and end valves to permit complete drainage of the system. All high points in equipment rooms shall be vented with automatic air vents piped to convenient drain. All high points in system outside of equipment rooms to be vented with combination automatic/manual air vents to relieve air in the system. B. All buried pipe to be insulated as per Insulation Section of these Specifications. All buried pipe shall be surrounded by 4" clean sand. C. Valve off each individual piece of radiation or equipment with valve for shut off service on supply, valve for balancing service on return. D. Route piping in orderly manner, plumb and parallel to building structure, and maintain gradient. E. Install piping to conserve building space, and not interfere with use ofspace and other work. F. Group piping whenever practical at common elevations. G. Install piping to allow for expansion and contraction without stessing pipe, joints, or connected equipment. H. Provide clearance for installation of insulation, and access to valves and httings. I. Slope piping and arrange systems to drain at low points. Use eccentric reducers to maintain top ofpipe level. J. Where pipe support members are welded to structural building framing, scrape, brush clean, and apply one coat of zinc rich primer to welding. K. Install valves with stems upright or horizontal, not inverted. 3.02 VALVES AND SPECIALTIES. A. Gate Valves, plug valves or butterlly valves may be used on all water services for shut off service. B. Plug valves shall be used for balancing service on all steel lines l-l/2" and above. Globe or ball valves shall be used for balancing service on all copper lines l-ll2" and above (plug valve symbols are used on drawings). For lines l-1/4" and below balancing/shut- offvalves, globe, ball or plug valves may be used. C. Globe valves, where shown, are the only suitable valve. D. Check valves on all base mounted pump discharges are to be "noiseless check valves", other check valves to be horizontal swing check valves. E. Unions or flanges are to be used wherever necessary and in piping at all equipment so that piping may be conveniently broken and moved to facilitate equipmort maintenance. VAILMOI]NTIAN LODGE RENOVATION I I I I I fl I I , I $ I I !, T I a MARCH.2OO4 15600 - 4 ! t F. Dielectric unions are to be used at all connections where ferrous material is connected to buried non-fenous material and where ferrous material is connected to domestic water - PiPing' f.r| G. pressure Gauges and Press.-Temp. Taps are to be used wherever shown on drawings. L), Gauges and taps shatl be installed in pipe immediately before and after equipment with ifj ,,o uulrr. or fitting between gauge or tap and equipment. Taps shall be located in anY accessible Position. I, H. Thermometers or Press-Temp. Taps are to be used on each side of each piece of I equipment where a change in temperature takes place. This does not include distribution t, eq"ipme"t located in finished rooms such as radiation, fan coils or unit ventilators. f 3-03 SNowMELT PAIYELS I A. Connections between the main and snowmelt manifold box shall have swing joints before I tuming up into box and arranged in a manner to allow for expansion. t B. Panels embedded in concrete shall be graded level and laid in a manner that will allow I concrete to enveloPe the PiPe. I C. Panels embedded in sand beneath pavers shall be graded level and laid in a manner that J will allow concrete to envelope the pipe. ^ 3.04 VALVING OF BRANCIIES I' A. Valve all lines, except drain pipes, before they leave the basement, crawl space or trench. It 3.05 AUToMATIc coLD wATERFTLL ASSEMBLY t A. Pressure reducing valve, reduced pressure double check back flow preventer, test cocks, rl strainer, vacuum breaker, and valved by-pass. u ^ 3.06 MA|IUALATRVENTS ! A. :l,Xt fr*ir'ff::t":f 2" diameter pipe to form air chamber' with l/8" brass needle | 3.07 PUMPS I A. Install pumps in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. I B. provrde access space around pumps for service. Provide no less than minimum as I recommanded bY manufacturer. I C. Ensure purnps operate at specified system fluid temperatures without vapor binding and cavitation, are non-overloading in parallel or individual operation, and operate within 25 n percent of midpoint of published maximum efficiency curve' I t f vArL MoUNTIAI\ LoDGE MARcrI, 2004 1s600 - s RENOVATION I D.Decrease from line size with long radius reducing elbows or reducers. Support piping a jacent to pump such that no weight is carried on pump casings. For base mounted pumps, provide supports under elbows on pump suction and discharge line sizes 4 inches and over. Provide line sized shut-off valve on pump suction, and line sized non-slam soft seat check valve and balancing valve on pump discharge. Provide air cock and drain connection on horizontal pump casings. Provide drains for bases, piped to and discharging into floor drains. Lubricate pumps before start-uP. Provide field representative for starting unit and fraining operator. provide combustion test for each boiler and submit report. Test shall include boiler firing rate, overfire draft, gas flow rate, heat input, burner manifold gas pressr.ne, percent carbon monoxide (co), percent oxygar (oX), percent excess air, flue gas temperature at outlet, ambient temperature, net stack temperafure, percent stack loss, percent combustion efficiency, and heat outPut. I t I fi t 'l I I I I I I 0 I I I I ar I F. G. H. A. B. 3.08 BOILERS 3.09 CIIILLERS VAIL MOIINTIAN LODGE RENOVATION A. B. C. D. E. Align chiller package on steel or concrete forn:dations. Arrange piping for easy dismantling to permit tube cleaning. Supply service of factory fiained representative for a period ofone day to supervise testing, dehydration and cbarging of machine, start-up, and instruction on operation and maintenance to Owner. Supply initial charge ofrefrigerant and oil. Demonstrate system operation and verifr specified performance. END OF SECTION MARCH.2OO4 15600 - 6 T t t ill T IT I T l) t 'l t t Il I I I VAIL MOIINTIAN LODGE MARCH,2OO4 15600.7 A RENovATIoN a I I SECTIoN ls8oo-AIR DISTRTBUTIoNrlII.OO GENERAL2 I r.or RELATEDDocLMENTs 3 T LOz REFERENCES I I The General Conditions, Special Conditions and Contract Documents are a part of these Specifications. Consult them for further instructions and be governed by the requirements thereunder. A. ASHRAE Handbook 2001 Fundamentals; Chapter 32 - Duct Design. B. ASHRAE Handbook 2000 tMC Systems and Equipment; Chapter 16 - Duct Construction C. NFPA 90A - Installation of Air Conditioning and Ventilating Systems. D. SMACNA HVAC Duct Construction Standards. E. UL 33 - Heat Responsive Links for Fire hotection Service. F. UL 5555 - Fire Dampers, Fire/Smoke Dampers and Ceiling Dampers.t, t 1.03 DEFIMTIONS tIltll|l A. Duct Sizes: Outside sheetmetal dimensions. Sheetmetal dimensions shown on drawings account for duct liner. B. Low Pressure: Two classifications. 1 . Up to /2" water gauge (WG) positive or negative static pressure and ). velocities less than 2,000 fpm to be SMACNA Duct Pressure Class l/2" U w'g' 2. Over /2" up to 2" WG positive or negative static pressure and velocities less I than 2,000 fpm to be SMACNA Duct Pressure Class 2" w.g' -lU- 2.00 PRODUCTS rn[ 2.ot MATERTALSa L, A. Steel Ducts: ASTM A52 or ASTM A527 galvanized steel sheet, lock-forming l, quality, having zinc coating of 1.25 oz per sq. ft. for each side in conformance witha ASTMAS0. f, B. Fabric supported by helically wound spring steel wire or flat steel bands; rated to 2" J WG positive and 1.5" WG negative for low pressure ducts. I C. tnsulated Flexible Ducts: Flexible duct rwapped with flexible glass fiber insulation, f anclosed by seamless aluminum pigmented plastic vapor barrier j acket; maximum 0.23 K value at 75T.a al vArL MoTJNTAIN LoDGE MARcH,2004 1s800 - I OVATION ! D. Stainless Steel Ducts: ASTM A167, Type 304. E. Fasteners: Rivets, bolts, or sheet metal screws. F. Sealant: Non-hardening, water resistant, fire resistive, compatible with mating materials; liquid used alone or with tape, or heavy mastic. Arabol and canvas. G. Hanger Rod: Steel, galvanized; threaded bolh ends, threaded one end, or continuously threaded. 2.02 LOW PRESSURE DUCTWORK (l/2 and 2 inch Classificrtion) A. Fabricate and support in accordance with SMACNA Duct Construction Standards and ASHRAE handbooks, except as indicated. Provide duct material, gages, reinforcing, and sealing for %" and 2" operating pressures. B. Size round ducts installed in place of rectangular ducts in accordance with ASHRAE table of equivalent rectangular and round ducts. No variation of duct configuration or sizes permitted except by written permission. C. Construct T's, bends, and elbows with radius of not less than l-ll2 times width of duct on centerline. Where not possible and wherd rectangular elbows are used, provide [air foil] turning vanes. Where acoustical lining is indicated, provide turning vanes ofperforated metal with glass fiber insulation. D. Increase duct sizes gradually, not exceeding 15o divergence wherever possible. Divergence upstream of equipment shall not exceed 30o; convergence downstream shall not exceed 45o. E. Provide easements where low pressure ductwork conflicts with piping and structwe. Where easements exceed l0 percent duct area, split into two ducts maintaining original duct area. F. Connect flexible ducts to metal ducts with draw bands and sheet metal screws. G. Use crimp joints with or without bead for joining round duct sizes 8" and smaller with crimp in direction of air flow. Use mechanical joints for exposed round duct joints. H. Use double nuts and lock washers on threaded rod supports. I. If glass hber supply and return duct system is used, furnish and install in accordance with NAMA Fibrous Glass Construction Manual and the recommendations for the manufacturer. Only concealed ductwork may be glass fiber type. All ducts in equipment rooms or otherwise exposed shall be metal with lines as specified. 2.03 BURTEDUNDERGROUNDDUCTS A. Buried ducts may be stainless steel or spiral lockseam or PVC jacketed and lined sheet metal. Where exhaust tubing contacts duct, provide stainless steel near surface. I I I t T I |t I e I I I I ,i 'l VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I ,f I MARCH.2OO4 15800 - 2 I I I c B. Fabricate metal ductwork in accordance with SMACNA Duct Construction Standards, except as indicated. 2,04 LATJNDRY EXHAUST DUCTS A. All laundry exhaust ducts from exhaust collar through exhaust fan to outside of building to be (aluminum) (copper) ductwork watertight construction of weights as called for. All ductwork exposed to view to be stainless steel with ground and polished welded joints. All ducts to have radius elbows as no tuming vanes will be allowed. t B. All dryer exhaust ducts from exhaust collar to outside ofbuilding to be galvanized steel I ductwork watertight 26 gauge construction. All ducts to have radius elbows. Wall cap to I be galvanized steel consruction with prime coat finish, hood, and backdraft danrper. ' 2.09 VOLTMECONTROLDAMPERS I T t, A. Fabricate in accordance with SMACNA Low Pressure Duct Construction Standards, and as indicated. B. Fabricate splitter dampers of material same gauge as duct to 24" siz.e in either direction, and two gages heavier for sizes for 24". C. Fabricate splitter dampers of single thickness sheet metal to streamline shape. Secure blade with continuous hinge or rod. Operate with minimum %" diameter rod in self aligning, universal joint action flanged bushing with set screw. I D. Fabricate single blade dampers for duct sizes to 9 - %" x 30". I E. Fabricate multi-blade damper of opposed bladc pattem with maximum blade sizes I 12" x 72" . Assemble center and edge crimped blades in prime coated or galvanized t channel frame with suitable hardware. A F. Except in round ductwork 12" and smaller, provide end bearings. On multiple blade t dampers, provide oil-impregnated nylon or sintered bronze bearings. il G. Provide locking, indicating quadrant regulators on single and multi-blade dampers. I( Where rod lengths exceed 20" provide regulator at both ends. I H. On insulated ducts mount quadrant regulators on stand-off mounting brackets, bases,r or adapters.rt ^ 2.IO FIRE DAMPERSIr A. Fabricate in accordance with NFPA 90A and UL 5555. I B. Fabricate ceiling firestop flaps ofgalvanized steel, 22 gage frame and 16 gage flap, af two layers 0.125" ceramic fiber on top side, and one layer on bottom side for round flaps, with locking clip. I\ I VArL MOTTNTATN LODGE MARCH,2004 15800 - 3 RENOVATION aI C. Fabricate curtain type dampers of galvanized steel with interlocking blades. Provide stainless steel closure springs and latches for horizontal installations. Configure with blades out of air stream. D. Fabricate multiple blade fire dampers with 16 gage galvanized steel frame and air foil blades, oil-impregnated bronze or stainless steel sleeve bearings and plated steel axles, l/8" or %" plated steel concealed linkage, stainless steel closure spring, blade stops, and lock. E. Fusible links, UL 33, shall separate at 160oF. Provide adjustable link straps for combination fi relbalancing dampers. F. Acceptable Manufacturers: l. Ruskin 2. Air Balance 3. Prefco 4. Louvers and darnpers. 2.II FIRE/SMOKEDAMPERS A. Fabricate in accordance with NFPA 90A and UL 5555. B. Fabricate ceiling firestop flaps ofgalvanized steel, 22 gatge frame and 16 gauge flap, two layers 0.125" ceramic fiber on top side, and one layer on bottom side for round flaps, with locking clip. C. Fabricate multiple blade fire dampers with 16 gauge galvanized steel frame and air foil blades, oil-impregnated bronze or stainless steel sleeve bearings and plated steel axles, l/8" xtA" plated steel concealed linkage, stainless steel closure spring, blade stops, and lock. D. Fusible links, UL 33, shall separate at l60oF. Provide adjustable link staps for combination fire/balancing dampers. E. Dampers shall meet minimum UL 5553 250'F elevated temperature rating, Class Il leakage rating. F. Darnper operator actuator to power open and fail close' G. Interface damper with smoke detector and fire alarm systern for closure. H. Acceptable Manufacturers: 1. Ruskin 2. Air Balance 3. Prefco 4. Louvers and dampers 2.12 FLE}ilBLE DUCT CONNECTIONS A. Fabricate in accordance with SMACNA Duct Construction Standards, and as indicated. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION I I ; c I I I I I I T I g I I ,l I I il MARCH,2OO4 1s800 - 4 I I t t I f B. UL listed fire-retardant neoprene coated woven glass fiber fabric to NFPA 90A, minimum density 36 oz per sq. yd, approximately 6 inches wide, crimped into metal edging strip. A. Fabricate in accordance with SMACNA Duct Construction Standards and as indicated. B. Coordinate locations with Architect prior to fabrication. C. Fabricate rigid and close-fitting doors ofgalvanized steel with sealing gaskets and quick fastening locking devices. For insulated ductwork, install minimum one inch thick insulation with sheet metal cover. D. Access doors smaller than 12" square may be secured with sash locks. E. Provide two hinges and two sash locks for sizes up to 18" square, three hinges and two compression latches with outside and inside handles for sizes tp to 24" x 48". Provide an additional hinge for larger sizes.r! F. Access doors with sheet metal screw fasteners are not acceptable. l.: 2.14 DUCT TEST HOLES I:tr A. Cut or drill temporary test holis in ducts as required. Cap with neat patches, neoprene - plugs, threaded plugs, or threaded or twist-on metal caps. t B. Permanent test holes shall be factory fabricated, air tight flanged fittings with screw cap. _ hovide extended neck fittings to clear insulation. t z.ts GRILLE, REGISTERS, AND DIFFUSERS A. Rectangular Ceiling Diffusers 1. Rectangular, adjustable pattem, stamped multi-core b,pe diffuser to discharge air in 360 degree pattem with sectoring baffles where indicated. 2. Provide surface mount and inverted T-bar type fiames. ln plaster ceilings, provide plaster frame and ceiling frame. 3. Fabricate of steel with baked enamel off-white finish. 4. hovide opposed blade damper and multilouvered equalizing grid with damper adjustable from diffuser face. B. Ceiling Exhaust And Return Registers/Grilles 1. Streamlined blades, depth of which exceeds 3/4 inch spacing, with spring or other device to set blades, vertical face, double deflection. 2. Fabricate of steel with 20 gage minimum frames and 22 gage minimum blades, steel and aluminum with 20 gage minimum frame, or aluminum extrusions, with factory baked enamel finish. 3. hovide integral, gang-operated opposed blade dampers with removable key / z.r3 DucrAccEss DooRS operator, operable from face. D. 2.I7 LOW VELOCITYFLE)ilBLE DUCTS iJ vArLMor.nrrArNLoDGE MARCH,2''4 RENOVATION I I I t 'c t 15800 - 5 A. Acoustically insulated flexible duct, consisting of inner core of perforated one ply corrugated duct, I " thick insulation and air tight vapor barrier cover. The flexible duct must be approved by code authority for the specific application. Duct must have the following insertion loss in dB/ft. I . Clevaflex Clevaform type DBA or equivalent' 2.I8 TWIST-IN FITTING FOR ROUND DUCT CONNECTION A. Factory fabricated galvanized for insulated ducts, steel adaptor plate on glass fiber ducts. Butterhy damper with quadrant opsrator and lock nut on all applications excePt VAV systems upstream of VAV box' 2.Ig VOLUME EXTRACTORS (ALL RECTAI\GIILAR TAKEOFFS) A. Steel or aluminum construction dvanes on 2" centers, gang operated. Manual operator attached to branch duct. Cames 1250, Titus AG-225, T & B VLR, Anemostat DT2M, Krueger EX-88A, Agitair Branchbol s-2, J & J EX 9, Metalaire EX-l or equivalott. 2.20 INSULATION A. Type A: Flexible glass fiber; All ducts shall be insulated on the outside with flexible giass fiber blanket-. Microlite Typ e 7 5 - 2 inches thick Fiber Glass Duct Wrap Insulation per ASTM C 553 Type I or approved equal with a minimum installed R-Value of 5.6. The FSK facing should have a permeance of '02 or less' B. Type B: Flexible glass fiber; All sheet metal shall be lined wi0r Factory edge coated Johns Manville Permacote II or approved equal. The liner shall meet ASTM C-I071 and NFPA 90A and 90B with an Air Sfieam Acrylic Coating, which contains an immobilized, EpA Registered, anti-microbial agent as tested in accordance with ASTM G-21 and G- 22. T\eliner shall have an R-Value of 4.2 and a NRC of .70 [tested in accordance to ASTM C 423'"fype A Mounting". Maximum velocity - 6000 sm. Adhesive shall conform to ASTM C 916, with liner adhered to the Duct with 90 percent minimum coverage. Pin placement per manufacturer's data sheet [Johns Manville AHS-I97]. Shop oi field cuts shall be liberally coated with Johns Manville Super Seal Edge Treatment or approved equal. Note: when velocity exceeds 4000 frm, use metal nosing on every leading edge. C. Adhesives: Waterproof fire-retardant type' D. Joint Tape: Glass fiber cloth' open mesh' E. Tie Wire: Annealed steel, 16 gage. F. Any of the following manufacturers may be used in the base bid: 1. Ultralite Number 200 2. Pittsburgh Plate Glass uTextrafine" 3. Owens Corning "Aeroflex"4. Certainteed I I I t I I I I I I t I I I i I I c I VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2OO4 15800 - 6 I I 2.2r EeUIPMENT ScHEDULE 3.OO EXECUTION | 3.or AccEssoRr's IN.TALLATI'N I I I A. Install accessories in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. B. Provide balancing dampers where indicated. Use splitter dampers only where indicated. C. hovide fire dampers and fire/smoke dampers at locations indicated, and where ducts and outlets pass through fire rated components. hstall with required perimeter mounting angles, sleeves, breakarvay duct connections, corrosion resistant springs, bearings, bushings and hinges. D. Demonstate re-setting of fire and fire/smoke dampers to authorities having jurisdiction and Owner's representative. E. hovide backdraft dampers on exhaust fans or exhaust ducts nearest to outside and where indicated. F. Provide flexible connections immediately adjacent to equipment in ducts associated with fans and motorized equiprnent. G. Provide duct access doors for inspection and cleaning before and after aulomatic dampers at fire dampers, and elsewhere as indicated. Provide minimum 8" x 8" size for hand access, 18" x 18" size for shoulder access, and as indicated. H. Provide duct test holes where indicated and required for testing and balancing purposes. I 3.02 cRrLLE, REGI'TER, DIFFU'ER AN'D LouvER TNSTALLATI'N r t I I t 'tI il I A. Check location of outlets and inlets and make necessary adjustments in position to conform with architectural featwes, symmeFy, and lighting alrangement. B. Install diffusers to ductwork with air tight connection. C. Paint ductwork visible behind air outlets and inlets matte black. | 3.03 DU.T*.RKIN'TALLATT'N A. Duct sizes shown on the drawings are outside (sheet metal) duct dimensions. Ductwork shall be fumished and installed in accordance with SMACNA Low Pressure (STD) Duct Construction Standards and High Pressure (STV) Duct Construction Standards Manual. B. Provide openings in ductwork where required to accommodate thermometers and controllers. Provide pilot tube openings where required for testing of systems, complete with metal can with spring device or screw to ensure against air leakage. Where openings are provided in insulated ducfwork, install insulation material inside a metal nng. ! VAILMOUNTATN LODGE MARCH,2004 RENOVATION Ox ! 1s800 - 7 Locate ducts with sufficient space around equipment to allow normal operating and maintenance activities. Slope underground ducts to plenums or low pumpout points at l:500. Connect terminal units to ducts with one foot maximum length of flexible duct. Do not use flexible duct to change direction. Connect diffusers to low pressure ducts with 5 feet maximum length of flexible duct, Hold in place with strap or clamp. During construction provide temporary closures of metal or taped polyethylene on open ductwork to prevent construction dust from entering ductwork system. When low pressure supply air ducts are not located in the conditioned room itself, these ducts shall be sealed as per SMACNA Class B Standards. This Standard includes the sealing of all transverse joint and fitting connections and snap lock seams. Not more than one unsealed longitudinal seam on the perimeter shall be allowed. All ductwork shall be sealed by using mastic or masticplus type. The sealer shall be non-toxic, non- combustible and non-flammable and have approved fire rating for sealing ducts in plenums as required by appropriate authority having jurisdiction Do not install takeoffs on elbows or other points of the system where air velocity is not uniform. Suspend ducts from structure with proper hangers at 4' -0" intervals, at each floor and wherever necessary. Make all duct coffiections to motor driven equipment with flexible connections, unless specifically indicated otherwise on the plans. Install tuming vanes in all 90o square elbows, whether shown on Plans or not. lnstall manual splitter dampers and/or opposed blade dampers in all velocity duct division and splits where shown. Splitter dampers shall have push rod and extemal locking device. Install adjustable volume extractors in low velocity duct takeoffs with linkage for external operator. Make all duct offsets with 15 degree transitions. Sharper tansitions can be made only when space does not allow l5 degree offsets, 30 degree offsets minimum. Make all radius elbows with radius of one and one half times the diameter or width of duct and an inside throat radius of one times the diameter or width. Make all ducts on indoor cooling towers and ducts exposed to weather; watertight by welding all joints and connections or by using duct sealants recommended by the manufachrer. 3.04 DUCTWORKAPPLICATIONSCIIEDULE AIR SYSTEM MATERIAL Low Pressure Supply (Heating Systems)Steel T I I I I I t I I I T D I I I T I t I C. D. E. F. G. H. J. K. L. M. VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH.2OO4 15800 - 8 I 0 I I I l I l I I t I t I I f, I t t Low Pressure Supply (System with Cooling Coils)Steel Buried Supply or Return PVC Coated and Lined. or Stainless Steel Retum and Relief Steel General Exhaust Steel 3.05 CASINGS AND PLENUMS A. Secure the casing to floors, walls and ceilings by a 2" x 2" x ll8" angle grouted between angle and floor, wall or ceiling. Secure the angle by 1/4" bolts at one foot centers shot into floor, wall or ceiling by 1/4" J-bolts set in concrete. Se cure casing to the angle by bolts on one foot centers. Seal all joints airtight. Seal all bolts through casing airtight by covering heads inside with sealer. B. Construct all casings of 16 gauge galvanized steel panels. Maximum width of panels to be 2l inches. One side ofa panel shall be flanged 1" and the opposite side formed with 1" double standing seam. Assemble panels by interlocking the flanged side with double standing seam and bolting together on 18" centers. Apply sealer into double standing seam prior to assembly and allow 24 hours to dry. C. Brace panels by l-112" xl-ll2" x l/8" angles spaced on 4 ft. centers maximum, and run continuously for the full length and width of casing. D. Make all opanings through the casing for piping connections with a flanged telescoping collar 1" inside diamcter greater than the pipe outside diameter. Solder the flanges to the casing entirely around the circumference of flange of both the inside and the outside of the flange. Pack the pipe tightly into the opening with Oakum, held in place by a metal flange on both sides ofthe casing and cut to fit tightly around the pipe and sheet metal screwed to the telescope flange. Seal all sheet metal screws on the inside with liquid fype sealer. 3.06 FIRE AND FTRE/SMOKE DAMPERS A. Install fire dampers with code approval sleeves in all duct openings where shown on drawings. Installed in accordance with the U.L. requirement with access door in duct. Use frame CR for all round ducts. Use frame B for rectangular and square ducts. 3,07 ACCESS DOORS A. Provide sheet metal access of the size as noted or as required for proper access to the equipment. Access doors shall occur on each side of each coil and filter bank, inlet to each fan and wherever else shown. Construct these doors ofNo. 22 gauge galvanized metal. Provide doors with a flat iron or angle iron stiffening frame and so constructed that they can be operated without twisting or distortion. VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2OO4 15800 - 9 B. Provide duct opening at each door with a continuous reinforcing galvanized bar with a sponge rubber gasket to make the door airtight. Provide doors with not less than two galvanized iron hinges and latches sized to suite door size, each hinge having a bronze pin. Construct all parts ofdoors of galvanized iron and make airtight. Doors shall be double thickness with 1" insulation between sheet metal walls when located in insulation duct. Access doors shall open against air pressure' 3.08 DUCT INSULATION A. lnstall materials in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. hovide insulation with vapor barrier. Exterior lnsulation (Type A) Application: I . Secure insulation with vapor barrier with wires and seal jacket joints with vapor barrier adhesive or tape to matchjacket. 2. Install without sag or underside of ductwork. Use adhesive or mechanical fasteners where necessary to prevent sagging. Seal vapor barrier penetrations by mechanical fasteners with vapor barrier adhesive. Stop and point insulation around access doors and damper operators to allow operation without distnbuting wrapping. Liner (Type B) Application: l. Adhere insulation with adhesive for 100 percent coverage. Secure insulation with mechanical fasteners on 15" centers maximum on top and side of ductwork with dimension exceeding 20". Seal and smooth joints. Do not use nail-type fasteners. Seal vapor barrier penetrations by mechanical fasteners with vapor barrier adhesive. 2. Ductwork dimensions indicated are net outside dimansions required for air flow. Ductrvork sizes to allow for insulation thickness. Continue insulation with vapor barrier through penetrations. lnsulation Schedule I t I I I I t ! I I I I I t I I I t I B A B. C. D. F. DUCTWORK l. Exhaust Ducts Within 10 ft. of Fan (except Grease) 2. Rectilinear Supply/Retum Air Ducts 3. Round SupplyiRetum Air Ducts 4. Supply Ducts in EvaporativelY Cooled Svstems 3.09 FLEXIBLE DUCTS VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION TYPE INSULATION THICKNESS B1' l' 2" A. Attach all flexible ducts inner to duct connectors, diffuser necks, or ductwork with stainless steel worm driven clamp. Tape outer vapor barrier securely over clamp with vapor barrier tape. MARCH.2OO4 15800 - 10 I! T 3.IO DUCT SYSTEM ADJUSTING AND CLEANING !- A. Clean duct system and force air at high velocity through duct to remove accumulated a dust. To obtain sufficient air, clean half the system at a time. Protect equipment which I may be harmed by excessive dirt with temporary filters, or bypass during cleaning. l a. B. Clean duct systems with high power vacuum machines. Protect equipment which may be I lf#fi"i#i"ff::tu1[#H*"J: or bvpass during creaning' Provide adequate access END OF SECTION, I I I I I I I I I t I T\ I 'ATLM'TNTATNL.DGE MARcH,2oo4 RENOVATION I 15800 - 11 VAIL MOT'NTAINLODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 158tn - 12 t I I I I I I I t I I I I I t t I I I SECTION IsgOO--CONTROLS AND INSTRUMENTATION I.OO GENERAL r.OI RELATEDDOCUMENTS A. The General Conditions, Special Conditions and Contract Documents are a part of these Specifications. Consult them for further instructions and be governed by the requirements thereunder. I.O2 WORKINCLUDEI) A. Provide a solid state electronic control system as described on the drawings with components fumished and installed by the temperature control manufacturer or by the manufactwer's representative. Provide all components, materials and wiring (except as noted herein) to make a complete system capable ofall conhol requirements and functions described herein. Coordinate control requirements with project conhactors and equipment suppliers to avoid conflict or omissions. The system shall be complete in all respects, put in operation and calibrated under occupied conditions. B. The controls and instrumentation system required for this work includes, but is not necessarily limited to: l. Boiler conkols. 2. Circulation pump conftols. 3. HVAC system controls. 4. Make-up and exhaust air unit controls. 5. Domestic hot water controls. 6. Hydronic baseboard and fan coil controls. 7. All other control items indicated on the drawings, specified herein, or needed for a complete and proper control installation in accordance with all pertinent codes and regulations. 1,03 GENERAL A. All automatic control valves shall be furnished by the Temperature Control Manufacturer and installed under his supervision under the Mechanical Division, Section 15600. All automatic control dampers, unless otherwise specified, shall be fumished by the Ternperature Conhol Manufacturer and installed rmder his supervision under the Air Distribution Section 15800. 1.04 WIRING A. All wiring shall comply with the National Electric Code, local codes and the Electrical Division of these specifications. B. All wiring shall be run in metallic conduit, tubing or raceways. l. Exceptions: 2. NEC class 2 low voltage wiring where not exposed to view such as above suspanded ceilings, in shafts, etc., may be run in cable. Not allowable above ceilings used as return air plenums. 3. Wiring enclosed in Temperature Contol panels. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE MARCH.2OO4 RENOVATION 15900 - I c.All low voltage conductors shall be l8 gauge minimum, except 19 gauge may be used for home runs to cenhal control panels, and 22 gauge minimum for resistance or thermistor sensing element connections. All control interlocla and control panels shall be wired by the Temperature Control Manufacturer, except one 120 volt power circuit to each control panel shall be provided under the Electrical Division. All other 120 volt power shall be by the Mechanical Division. 1.05 DRAWINGS A. The Temperature Control Manufacturer shall submit shop drawings of equipment, control panels and wiring diagrams to the MECHAMCAL ENGINEER forreview. B. Upon review and return of above shop drawings, the Temperature Control Manufacturer shall disperse the required information to other trades involved in the work. C. Shop drawings shall consist of descriptive literatwe, control diagrams, wiring diagrams, damper schedule, auto valve schedule, sequence of control, piping diagrams for all valves and shall show equipment arrangement in all panel fronts. Show location in buitding for all panels. I.06 DAMPERANDVALVEOPERATION A. Provide pilot positioners with positive shaft feedback for all sequencing applications. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2.OI ACCEPTABLEMAIruFACTT'RERS A. This specification is based on Johnson Control Company equipment. Acceptable manufacfurers are Trane, Honeywell or Barber Coleman. Others must be approved by the mechanical engineer before bidding. It is recognized that packaged equipment comes dother names on controls and that some functions are accomplished w/other named components. This specification does not intend to prohibit this practice. 2.02 LOWVOLTAGEPOWER A. All control devices and panels containing low voltage power sources shall inherently comply with NEC Class 2 requirernents (current limiting), or shall be supplied with branch circuit fusing to limit control circuit current to NEC Class 2. All control transformers shall be of the inherent current limiting type, or shall be installed with primary disconnect and overload protection. 2.03 THERMOSTATS A. Transmitters shall be liquid filled capillary averaging bulbs of maximum length unless specified otherwise. Liquid insertion thermostats shall be provided with separable wells. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE MARCH.2OO4 RENOVATION t I I t l t I I I T I I t I I I I t I D. 1s900 - 2 I I t t I l J I I I I I T I I i I T I Solid State sensors for duct and air handling equipment shall be averaging type unless specified otherwise. Liquid sensors shall be provided with separable wells' All thermostats shall have a fully adjustable setpoints. Provide visible thermometer scale on thermostats in apartments, condominiums, residences, and u/herever required by owner. All room thermostats shall have concealed adjustment and locking cover in the fo'llowing areas: Provide guards on any electric thermostats in areas deemed necessary by Owner: 2,04 PRESSURE CONTROLS Static and differential pressure controllers and indicators shall be transmitter and panel rnounted receiver controller type, unless specified otherwise. Provide panel mounted pressure indication at each sensing point. 2.05 DAMPERS Damper frames shall be 13 gauge galvanized steel channel on l/8" extruded aluminum with reinforced comer bracing. Damper bearings shall be nylon or Teflon. Bushings that tum in the bearing are to be oil impregnated sintered metal. .Damper blades shall not exceed (6) inches in width. Blades are to be suitable for high velocity performance. A1l edges ofthe blades and top, bottom and sides ofthe frame shall be provided with replaceable, butyl rubber or neoprene seals. Side seals may be spring loaded stainless steel. The seals shall provide a maximum of 1% leakage when sized at a wide open face velocity of 1500 fpm 4" static pressure. The damper linkage shall provide a linear flow of equal percentage characteristic is required. Dampers to be Pacific Series 210, Johnson "Proportion/Air", Honeywell "Moduflow low leakage", Ruskin "CD50 low leakage," Penn Air Control Damper PBD or OBD or equivalent. 2.06 VALVES Valves in water and anti-freeze system shall be sized for not more than 3 psi drop. All valves shall open for full supply water flow from heating or cooling generation plant whenever a loss ofpower or air supply to the valves occur. Ifvalves are involved with a changeover fype operation the valves shall fail open to the heating water supply. 2.07 FREEZE DETECTION TI{ERMOSTATS Each supply system with water and steam coils taking outside air shall have a freeze protection thermostat located on the downstream side of the coil. Thermostals shall be adjustable electric contact type silver plated, having manual reset with 20' flexible sensing bulb of increment type with any section capable of actuating mechanism on temperature drop below setpoint. When temperature drops below setpoint, thermostat B. c. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE MARCH.2OO4 RENOVATTON D. E. B. A. B. 15900 - 3 shall stop fan(s) and close outside air damper. They shall have an isolated set ofcontacts for alarm system. 2.08 SMOKE DETECTORS (NFPA REQUIREMENTS) A. No smoke detector devices required on systems 1999 cfm and less' B. All air handling units shall be equipped with a manual emergency stop control located at a convenient and accessible point for shutting down the fan in case of fire. For the purposes of this specification, the disconnect sw'itch will serve this purpose. C. In systems of over 2,000 cfin capacity, smoke detectors approved for duct installation shall be installed at a suitable location in: The main supply duct on the downstream side of the filters to automatically stop the fan, and In the return system on each floor at the point of entry into the common retum, or a system of smoke detectors providing total area coverage. D. Exception No. I The smoke detector in the retum air stream may be omitted in systems ofless than 15,000 cfm capacity. E. Exception No. 2 Supply and rehrm detectors may be omitted provided That the system is less than I 5,000 cfm capacity, the entire systern is within the space served and such space is protected by an area smoke detection system. 2.09 DIRTY FILTTR GAUGES A. Provide and install differential pressure air filter gauges of zuitable range with sensing tips located on the inlet and outlet side of all supply fan filters. Differential pressure gauges Dwyer Series 2000-AF Magrehelic or equivalant with scale range approximately twice the pressure drop recommended for filter change. 3.OO EXECUTION 3.01 THERMOSTATS Provide and install a3-l/2" dial, remote bulb thermometer adjacant to each remote bulb thermostat which is not provided with temperature indication by another part of this contract. 3.02 LOCALCONTROLPANELS Provide and install local control panels at each HVAC, H & V, AC, Make Up Air System and Domestic Water System. Group these together into one panel whan equipment is located in one equipment room. The panels shall be totally enclosed with hinged door and containing all relays, switches, gauges, etc. 3.03 WIRING OF CONTROL DEVICES I t I l I T I I t I T I I I I I I t T l. 2. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE RENOVATION MARCH,2004 15900 - 4 I I A. Control devices carrying full load current furnished by Mechanical and wired by Electrical shall be located at the device being controlled, unless shown on the drawings or mutual agreement is made between the contractors with no change in the contract price. I 3.04 sYsrEM cHEcKour ,:--: A. Prior to control persons leaving job site, they must confirm in writing to the Architect or a At*T::** all systems are operating satisfactorily as shown on approved shop I 3.os sEeuENcE oF coNTRoL{rI A. Refer to Drawinss.t\t END OF SECTION I t t I l I I I T T I I vArL MouNTATN LoDGE MARCH,2oo4 - RENOVATION I 1s900 - 5 B. I I 1 I ,f, I J I I ! I DIVISION 16 -- ELECTRJCAL SPECIFICATIONS SECTION I6OTO--ELECTRICAL GENERAL PROVISIONS 1.OO GENERAL 1.OI RELATEDDOCUNIENTS A. The General Conditions, Special Conditions, and Contract Documents are part of these specifications. Consult them further for instructions and be governed by the requirements contained thereunder. I.O2 DESCRIPTION Work Included l. Work shall consist of fumishing all labor, equipment, supplies and materials, unless otherwise specified, necessary for the installation of complete electrical systems as required by the specifications and as shown on the drawings, subject to the terms and conditions of the conhact. The work shall also include the completion of those details of electrical work not mentioned or shown which are necessary for the successful operation of all electrical systems. Work Not Included l. Certain labor, materials, and equipment may be furnished under other sections of these specifications, by Utility Companies or by the Owner; when this is the case, the extent, source, and description ofthese items will be as indicated on the drawings or as described in the specification. I.O3 PROVISIONS Work performed under this division of the specifications shall conform to the requirements of Division l, the electrical drawings, and all items hereinafter specified- -l Prior to any work being performed under this division, examine architectural, structural, food service, civil, mechanical, specialty systems, and interior design drawings and specifications. If any discrepancies occur between them and the electrical drawings and specifications, report discrepancies to the Architect in writing and obtain written instructions for the work. Electrical drawings are diagrammatic, but shall be followed as closely as actual construction of the building will permit. All changes from drawings necessary lo make the electrical work conform to the building as constructed shall be made without additional cost to the Owner. Coordinate the electrical work with the General Contractor and be responsible to him for satisfactory progress of the same. Coordinate electrical work with all other trades on the project without additional cost to the Owner. All work and materials covered by drawings and specifications shall be subject to review at any time by representatives of the Architect and Owner. If the Architect or Owner's agent finds any materials or installation that does not conform to these drawings and specifications, Contractor shall remove the material from the premises and correct the installation to the satisfaction of the agent. VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822,17 A. 2. l I 3. 4. I t I I I MARCH.2OO4 16010 - I ln acceptance or rejection of installed electrical systems, no allowance will be made for lack of skill on the part of the installers. I.O4 CODES AND STANDARDS The latest editions of the following standards (including supplements and official interpretations) are minimum requirements: I T I T I t t T I I t I I I I 1. 2. 3. A VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 14. 15. 16. NFPA 70 - National Electrical Code (NEC). NFPA 72 - National Fire Alarm Code. NFPA 101 - Life Safety Code. NFPA I l0 - Emergency Power Systems Conform to all applicable State and Local Codes. American National Standards lnstitute (ANSI). National Electrical Safety Code (NESC). Americans with Disabilities Acts (ADA) and American National Standards lnstiture (ANSD I17. National Electrical Manu facturer' s Association G\fEMA). Underwriter's Laboratories (UL). Insulated Cable Engineers Association (ICEA). Intemational Building Code. Intemational Mechanical Code. lntemational Fire Code. lnstitute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers (IEEE). Sheet Metal and Air Conditioning Contractors National Association (SMACNA). B. The complete installation shall comply with requirements of the utility and telephone companies fumishing service to this installation. The drawings and specifications take precedence when they are more stringent than codes, statutes, or ordinances in effect. Applicable codes, ordinances, standards and statutes take precedence when they are more shingent or conflict with the drawings and specifications. I.O5 SPECIALREQUIREMENTS A. Definitions: "Provide" shall mean "fumish and install". "Fumish" means to supply all materials, labor, equipment, testing apparatus, controls, tests, accessories and all other items customarily required for the proper and complete application. "Install" means to join, unit, fasten, link, attach, set up or otherwise connect together before testing and tuming over to Owner, complete and ready for regular operation. The words "accept" or "acceptable" denote only that the equipment items are in general conformance with the design concept of the project. B. Drawings: I . The drawings indicate the general arrangement of circuits and outlets, locations of switches, panelboards and other work. lnformation shown on the drawings is schematic, however, re-circuiting will not be permitted without specific acceptance. Drawings and specifications are complementary to each other. Wlrat is called for by one shall be as binding as if called for by both. Data presented on these drawings is accurate as planning can be determined, but accuracy is not guaranteed and field verification of all dimensions, locations, levels, etc., to suit I l I MARCH,2004 16010 - 2 B. C, A. B. C. I l I I I I I I I I T I t I field conditions is directed. Review all Architectural, Structural and Mechanical Drawings and Specifications; adjust all work to conform to all conditions shown therein. The Architectural drawings shall take precedence over all other drawings. 2. Discrepancies between different plans, between plans and specifications, between specifications or regulations and codes governing this installation shall be brought to the attention of the Architect in writing before the date of bid opening. ln the event such discrepancies exist, and the Architect is not so notified, the adjudication of responsibility shall be solely at the discretion of the Architect. 1.06 RECORDDRAWINGS Maintain a current set of electrical drawings at the site. Neatly mark all changes and deviations from the original drawings. Use a color which contrasts with the prints. This shall be a separate set of drawings, not used for construction purposes, and shall be kept up to date as the job progresses and shall be made available for inspection by the Architect at all times. These updated progress drawings shall be used to produce the final record drawings that shall be in AutoCad electronic format media upon project completion. Upon completion of the contract, both sets (electronic and hard copy drawings) ofrecord drawings shall be delivered to the Architect. The Contractor shall mark all record drawings on the front lower right hand corner with a stamp impression that reads'RECORD DRAWINGS' or similar. I.O7 PROJECT/SITECONDITIONS Install work in locations shown on Drawings, unless prevented by Project conditions. Prior to submitting a bid, visit the site ofjob and ascertain all conditions affecting the proposed installation and adjust all work accordingly. Make provisions for these costs. Coordinate the work with that of all other trades. Where conflicts of work occur and departure from the indicated arrangements are necessary, consult with other Contractors involved; come to agreement as to changed locations and elevations, etc., and obtain written acceptance from the Architect ofproposed changes before proceeding with work. All outages of electrical service shall be scheduled with the Owner and Utility Company five (5) days in advance of proposed outage. Include an overtime allowance in the bid for the performance of all work requiring outages at such time as it is approved by the Owner. Outages shall be at a time and of such duration as accepted by the Owner. r.O8 EXAMINATION OF BIDDING DOCIJMENTS Each bidder shall examine the bidding documents carefully, and not later than sevor days prior to the date of receipt of bids, shall make written request to the Engineer for interpretation or correction of any discrepancies, ambiguity, inconsistency' or error VAILMOI]NTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 D. I I I I I MARCII,2OO4 16010 - 3 I Itherein which he may discover. Any interpretation or corection will be issued as an addendum by the Architect. Only a written interpretation or correction by addendum shall be binding. No bidder shall rely upon interpretations or corrections given by any other method. If discrepancies, ambiguity, inconsistency, or eror are not covered by addendum or written directive, Contractor shall include in his bid, labor materials and methods of construction resulting in higher cost. After award of contract, no allowance or extra compensation will be made on behalf of the Contractor due to his failure to make the written requests as described above. B. Failure to request clarification during the bid period of any inadequacy, omission, or conflict will not relieve the Contractor of their responsibilities. The signing of the contract will be considered as implicitly denoting that the Contractor has a thorough comprehension ofthe full intent and scope of the working drawings and specifications. 1.09 SUBMITTALS A. Submit under provision of Division I . B. Listing of Equipment: The Contractor shall submit, within thirty days after the arvard of the contract, a complete tlperwitten list of those items of equipment which will be fumished under this contract. lnclude the name or description of the item, name of manufacturer, model, type, and catalog number. c. Submit five (5) copies of shop drawings, layouts, manufacturer's data, wiring diagrams and material schedules that may be requested by the Architect for his review. The review by the Architect will not constitute concurence with any deviation from the plans and specifications unless such deviations are specifically identified by the method described below, nor shall it relieve the Contractor of responsibility for crrors or omissions in the submitted data. D. Processed shop drawings shall not be construed as change orders. The shop drawings shall demonshate that the Contractor understands the design concept, indicate which equipment and materials he intends to provide, and detail the fabrication and installation methods he intends to use. If deviations, discrepancies or conflicts betwean shop drawing submittals and the design drawings and specifications are discovered, the design drawings and specifications shall govern' E. Contractor shall be responsible for dimensions (which he shall confirm and correlate at the job site), fabrication processes and techniques of construction and coordination ofhis work with that of other trades. The Contraclor shall check and verif all measurements and review shop drawings before submitting them and sign a statement on the shop drawings which signifies that they comply with plans and specifications and that equipment is dimensionally suitable for the application. If any deviations from the specified requirements for any item of material or equipment exist, such deviation shall be expressly stated in writing and incorporated with the submittal. The Owner's copies (two of each) of the reviewed submittals shall be retained by the Contractor until completion of the project and presented in bound form to the Owner. F. Shop drawings and manufacturer's published data shall be submitted for: l. All panelboards VAIL MOI.INTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 I t l I I I MARCH.2OO4 16010 - 4 A. B. B. c. D. I l I t I I I t I I I I I I I I I I I Lighting fixtures (catalog cuts) Fire alarm and detection system Telecommunication devices and equipment G. Provide, with shop drawing submittal, 1/4" scale layout drawings of room with switchboards, transformers, telephone backboards, panelboards, and data equipment. Layouts shall show tocations of, and shall be coordinated with mechanical equipment. Equipment shall be drawr to scale. I.IO USE OF TIIE ARCHITECT'S AND/OR ENGINEER'S DRAWINGS The Conhactor shall obtain, at the Contractor's expense, from the Architect or Engineer a set of AutoCad or compatible format architectural and engineering drawings on electronic rnedia where desired by the Contractor and/or required by the Specifications for use in preparing the shop drawings, coordination drawings, and record drawings- The Conhactor shall provide to the Architect and Engineer a rvritten release of liability acceptable to the Architect and Engineer prior to receiving the electronic media' 2. J. 4. 2.00 2.01 PRODUCTS STANDARD FORMATERIALS All materials shall conform to current applicable industry standards. Workmanship and neat appearance shall be as important as the'electrical and mechanical operation. Defective or damaged materials shall be replaced or repaired, prior to final acceptance, in a manner acceptable to the Architect or Owner at no additional cost to the Owner. All electrical materials shall be acceptable for installation only if labeled or listed by a nationally recognized testing laboratory and if accepted by local authorities. 2.02 SUBSTITUTIONS (CONTRACTOR AND/OR OWNER II{ITIATED) Materials or equipment listed by several manufacturers' names are intended to be bidder's choice, and any of the listed manufacturers may be used in the base bid. Materials or equipment not listed are considered substitutions. Performance Specification: When any item is specified by requirement to meet a performance, industry or regulating body standard or is specified generically (no manufactwer's name listed), no prior review by the Consulting Electical Engineer is needed unless specifically called for in these specifications. Conhactor to be responsible for any changes and costs to accommodate any equipment except the first named in the specification. Substitutions for Material l. Equipment and materials not listed as equivalents may be proposed as deductive altemates to specified items by submitting it as a separate line item to the base bid on the Bidder's letterhead. 2. Such substitutions shall not be substituted for the base bid and must be accompanied by a full description of the difference between the Contact VAIL MOIINTAINLODGE Project #5822.17 MARCII.2OO4 16010 - 5 Document requirements and that of the substitution, the comparative features of each, and the effect of the change on the end result performance. lnclude the impact of all changes on other contractors and acknowledge the inclusion of additional costs to the other trades. If any such alternates are considered, the Contractor shall submit a list of the proposed alternate substitution items within 14 days of award of contract. Late requests for proposed substitutions will not be accepted by the Engineer due to scheduling or delivery concems. 2.03 BID ALTERNATE(S) Refer to Division 1 and all contract documents for additional information' Altemate(s) for Material and Equipment I I I t I I t l T I I t I I I l I I I 3. B. 1. 2. Equipment and material bid altemate(s) shall be proposed as additive or deductive alternate(s) to specified items by submitting it as a separate line item from the base bid on the Bidder's letterhead. Such bid alternate proposals shall not be substituted or included in the base bid. Bid alternate proposal(s) must be accompanied by full descriptive data on the proposed equipment, together with a statement of the cost to be added or deducted for each item. The bid altemate shall include all materials, equipment, labor, electrical connections, coordination with all other trades, etc. for a complete and operational system. The Contractor shall submit the bid alternates at the time the base bids are due' 3.OO EXECUTION 3.01 WORKMANSHIP AND COMPLETION OF INSTALLATION VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 A. Contractor's personnel and subconbactors selected to perform the work shall be well versed and skilled in the hades involved. B. Coordinate electrical equipment and materials installation with other building components. C. Sequence, coordinate, and integrate installations of electrical materials and equipment for efficient flow of the Work. Give particular attention to large equipment requiring positioning prior to closing-in the building. D. Any changes or deviations from the drawings and specifications must be accepted in writing by the Architect/Engineer. All errors in installation shall be corrected at the expense of the Contractor. All specialties shall be installed as detailed on the drawings. Where detail or specific installation requirements are not provided, manufacturer's recommendations shall be followed. E. Upon completion of work, all equipment and materials shall be installed complete, thoroughly checked, correctly adjusted, and left ready for intended use or operation. All work shall be thoroughly cleaned and all residue shall be removed from surfaces. Exterior surfaces of all material and equipment shall be delivered in a perfect, unblemished condition. MARCH.2OO4 16010 - 6 I I I I I I I I I I I I I ! F. Contractor shall provide a complete installation, including all required labor, material, cartage, insurance, permits, and taxes. 3.02 CHASES, OPENINGS, CUTTING, AND PATCIIING A. Carefully lay out all work in advance so as lo eliminate where possible, cutting, channeling, chasing or drilling of floors, walls, partitions, ceilings and roofs. Any damage to the building, structure, piping, ducts, equipment or any defaced finish shall be repaired by skilled mechanics of the trades involved at no additional cost to the Owner and to the satisfaction of the Architect. Any necessary cutting, channeling, drilling or anchoring of raceways, outlets, or other electrical equipment shall be performed in a careful manner, and as accepted by the Architect' B. All openings made in fire-rated walls, floors, or ceilings shall be patched and made tight inamannertoconformtothefireratingforthesurfacepenetrated. C. All penetrations required through existing concrete construction shall be core drilled at minimum size required. Precautions shall be taken when drilling to prevent damage to structural ,on...i.. Contractor shall obtain permission from the Architect before proceeding with drilling. 3.03 PROGRESS OF \ilORK A. Order the progress of electrical work to conform to the progress of the work of the other trades. Comilete the entire installation as soon as the condition of the building will permit. Any cost resulting from defective or ill timed work performed under this Section shall be borne bY this Conhactor. 3.04 PERMITS AND INSPECTIONS A. Obtain and pay for all permits and licenses required and fumish the Architect (for the Owner), a tertificate of final inspection and approval from the authorities having jurisdiction over the electrical installation' 3.05 CUTTING AND PATCIITNG A. provide all cutting, trenching, backfrlling, patching and refinishing or resurfacing required for elecrical work in-a manner meeting the approval of the Engineer and at no additional cost to the Owner. 3.06 DELIVERY AND STORAGE OF MATERIALS A. Arrange and be held responsible for delivery and safe storage of materials and equipment for electrical installation. B. Store materials and equipment for easy inspection and checking' C. Carefully mark and store all materials. D. Deliver materials to the job site in stages of the work that will expedite the work as a whole' VAILMOUNTAIN LODGE Project#5822.17 I I I I MARCH.2OO4 16010 - 7 E. Carefully check materials furnished to this Contractor for installation, and provide receipt acknowledging acceptance of delivery and condition of the materials received. Thereafter, assume full responsibility for its safekeeping until the final installation has been reviewed and accePted. 3.07 PROTECTION OF WORK AND PROPERTY A. Where there are existing facilities, be responsible for the protection thereof, whether or not such facility is to be removed or relocated. Moving or removing any facility must be done so as not to cause intemrption of the work of Owner's operation. B. Close all conduit openings with caps or plugs during installation. Cover all fixtures and equipment and protect against injury. At the final completion, clean all work and deliver in an unblemished condition, or refinish and repaint at the discretion of the Architect. C. Any equipment or conduit systems found to have been damaged or contaminated above "MILL" or "SHOP" conditions shall be replaced or cleaned to the Engineer's satisfaction. 3.08 GUARANTEE The entire electrical system installed under this Contract shall be left in proper working order. Replace, without additional cost, any work, material or equipment, which develops defects in design or worlsnanship within one (1) year from date of final acceptance. 3.09 FINAL ACCEPTANCE Final acceptance by the Owner will not occur until all operating instructions are received and Owner's personnel have been thoroughly indoctrinated in the maintenance and operation of all equipment. Operating manual, parts lists, and indoctrination of operating and maintenance personnel: Furnish the services of a qualified representative of the supplier for each item or system itemized below who shall instruct specific personnel, as designated by the Owner, in the operation and maintenance of that item or system. Inskuction shall be made when the particular system is complete and shall be of the number of hours indicated and at the time requested by the Owner. A representative of the Electrical Contractor shall be present for all demonstrations. I I I I I I I I I I t I I T T I I I B. C. D, SYSTEM l. Fire alarm system 2. Data system HRS. OF INSTRUCTION 2 A Deliver three (3) complete operating manuals and parts lists to the Owner (or his designated representative) at the time of the above required indoctrination. Fully explain the contents of the manuals as part of required indoctrination and instruct the Owner's personnel in the correct procedure in obtaining service, both during and after the guarantee period. The operating manual and parts lists shall give complete information as to whom the Owner shall contact for service VAIL MOI]NTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCII.2OO4 16010 - 8 I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t I I I and pa s, including the address and phone number. Fumish evidence that an authorized service organization regularly carries a complete stock of repair parts for these items (or systems), and that the organization is available for service. Service shall be furnished within twenty four (24) hours after requested. E. Clean-up: Remove all materials, scrap, etc., relative to the electrical installation and leave the premises and all equipment, lamps, fixtures, etc. in a clean, orderly condition. Any costs to the Owner for clean-up of the site will be charged against the Contractor. F. Acceptance Demonstration: Upon completion of the work, at a time to be designated by the Architect. the Conkactor shall demonshate for the Owner the operation of the entire installation, including all systems provided under this conftact. G. Operating and Acceptance Tests: Provide all labor, instruments, and equipment for the performance of tests as specified. Submit three (3) copies of a typewritten test report for the Architect for his approval. L Record the full load current in each phase or line at the main service enfiance and for each feeder leaving the main distribution panelboard. Readings shall be taken with the maximum installed load connected and in operation' 2. Perform a careful inspection ofthe main switchboard bus structure and cable connections to verify that all connections are mechanically and electrically tight. 3. Measure the resistance to ground for the service ground, which shall not exceed ten (10) ohms under normal soil moisture conditions. If required, install additional ground provisions in a manner accepted by the Engineer at no additional cost to the Owner. 3.10 IDENTIFICATION A. General: Provide the following services and materials to assist the Owner in operation and maintenance. B. Directory cards, Nameplates and Labels: No temporary markings, which are visible on equipment, shall remain after the project is complete. Repaint trims, housing, etc., where such markings cannot be readily removed. Defaced finishes must be refinished. All engraved metal or plastic nameplates shall be white letters on a black or gray background. Raised letter t1pe tape shall not be used. No abbreviations in labeling will be permitted without special approval. All panelboards shall be labeled as designated on the elecfical drawings. Thoroughly clean surface to which pressure sensitive type labels are applied to assure adherence of label. Directory cards, nameplates, and labels shall indicate the general area and type of electrical load served by each circuit. Provide the following types of labels at these locations. 1. On each feeder switch, combination starter, or circuit breaker located in motor control centers, main service equipment, the main switchboard or panelboard, subdistribution panelboards, and all special equipment housed in cabinets, the labeling shall be one fourth inch (l/4") minimum height letters. 2. On each separate mounted disconnect and starter for a motor or fixed appliance, indicate motor or appliance designation, voltage, and phase. (Motor or appliance designations shall be as given on the Mechanical or Architectural plans.) Use three-sixteenth inch (3/16") minimum height letters. 3. On telephone terminals indicate terminal number. VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCH,2OO4 16010 - 9 4. On all branch circuit panelboards indicate panel designation, voltage and phase. Use three-fourths inch (3/4") minimum height stenciled letters in metal tape or one-half inch (1/2") engraved letters on laminated nameplate. Apply to the inside ofeach door. All emergency panels and disconnects shall be painted with red enamel. 5. For all branch circuit panelboard directories, provide neatly typed, removable cards and protective plastic faces. Spare circuit breakers shall be identified as such. 6. For all device plates for switches used to control exhaust fans or other equipment, provide one-eighth inch (1/8") minimum height black filled, engraved letters on stainless steel device plates. 7. For all exposed conduits, junction boxes, wiring gutters, etc., provide three- fourths inch (3/4") minimum height stenciled letters, or one-half inch (1/2") minimum height pressure sensitive labels equal to Brady self-sticking vinyl cloth. Labels shall be provided at the foilowing locations: a. Entering or leaving panels or switchgear or enclosures. b. All junction boxes shall be identified as to circuits contained within. c. Exposed conduits containing circuits above 600 volts shall have voltage labeled at least once for each exposed length or not more than fifteen feet (15'-0") apart. 3.11 ELECTRICAL PROVISIONS FOR ROOFS Raceways penetrating roofs shall be installed in a manner to preserve the integrity of the roof. Provide flashing and counter flashing for all roof penetrations required for the work. Conduits routed above roofs shall be installed a minimum of twelve inches (12") above the finished roof surface, supported on metal stands installed with flashing and counter flashing, with maximum spacing of ten feet (10'-0'). 3.12 CONSTRUCTION LIGIITING AI{D POWER C. Provide all temporary facilities required to supply construction power and ligbt. Install and maintain facilities in a manner that will protect the public and worlsnen. Comply with all applicable laws and regulations. Provide covered walkway lights and obstruction lights which shall be kept buming continuously between sunset and sunrise where required. Upon completion of the work, remove all temporary facilities from the site. The General Conhactor shall pay for all power and light used by him and his subcontractors where construction power is separately metered, or is taken from the permanent project metered service solely for construction use. The cutoff date for power cost allocation where permanent meters are used shall be either the agreed date of occupancy by the Owner or the date of final acceptance of the project, whichever shall be the earlier date. 3.r4 MECHAMCAL EQUTPMENT WIRTNG AND CONNECTTONS VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 I I I I I I I I I B. A. B. D. t I I I I I I I I I E. MARCH,2OO4 16010 - l0 I I I I I I I I A. Fumish, set in place, and wire, except as indicated, all heating, ventilating, air conditioning, plumbing, fire protection, motors and controls in accordance with the following schedule. Carefully coordinate with work performed under the Mechanical Division of these specifications. I I ITEM FURNISHED UNDER SET IN PLACE OR MTD. UNDER WIRED CONNECTED T]NDER I . Equipment motors and thermal overload. resistance heaters. (3) MD MD ED 2. Motor confiollers, magnetic starters, reduced voltage starters and overload relays.MD ED(a)ED 3. Disconnect switches. fused or unfused, h.p. rated switches, thermal overload switches and fuses, manual operating switches. ED(a)ED(a)ED 4. Pushbutton stations, pilot lights, multi-speed switches, float switches, thermostats, control relays, time clocks, control transformers, control panels, motor valves, damper motors, solenoid valves. EP and PE switches and interlocks.MD MD(b)MD(b) 5. Contactors. l20V control circuit outlets for control panels and for boiler controls and for fire protection controls and moke detectors.ED ED ED 6. Duct Detectors, Fire/Smoke Dampers, and Elevator Vent Dampers.MD MD ED(c) I I I I | ffi ED=EIectrical, Division I 6. 1; a. If fumished as part of factory wired equipment, then wiring and connections only by ED. I b. If float switches, line thermostats, p.e. switches, time switches, etc., carry the I FULL LOAD CURRENT to any motor, the Mechanical Division shall fumish them. They shall be set in place and connected under the Electrical Division, lI vArL MOTJNTATN LODGE MARCH,2004 16010 - 1r- Project #5822.17 I except there where such items are an integral part of the mechanical equipment, or directly attached to ducts, piping, etc., they shall be set in place under the Mechanical Division and connected by the Electrical Division. If they do not carry the full load current to any motor, they shall be furnished, set in place and wired under the Mechanical Division' c. Wiring from alarm contacts to alarm system by ED; all control function wiring by MD. Provide electrical connections to mechanical equipment. Refer to the Mechanical specifications and plans covering sprinkler systems, motor interlocks, switching, etc. Provide wiring, conduit, outlets and final electrical connections to all equipment. Where motor controllers are furnished by others, install controller and provide connections at line and load side of controllers. Where reduced voltage, multiple speed, duplex, triplex, lead-lag, pony motor and other unusual controller types are utilized, coordinate specific requirements of motor(s) and controller and provide required wiring between motor(s) and controller. Provide branch circuits and connections to sump and sewage ejector pump alarm bell system' Connect to emergency power distribution system' Where electric duct heaters are provided with remote power panels, provide branch circuits between remote panel and duct heater elements in accordance with the equpment manufacturer's recofinnendations. For electric water coolers veri$ whether the equipment is hard wired, cord and plug connected and whether a remote chiller is provided. Provide circuiting and cormections to match. 3.15 ELEVATORS Locate equipment and points of cormeclion in elevator machine rooms and elevator pits in -accordance with the requirements of the elevator vendor and the Authority Having Jurisdiction. t Provide a fused switch or circuit breaker, dedicated 3 phase branch circuit, and power connection r for each elevator. Fused switch or circuit breaker shall be located within elevator machine room. ! Circuit breaker rating shall be in accordance with elevator manufacturer's requirements. ! provide a dedicated 120V, 20A circuit with lockable disconnect switch and connection to each -elevator cab for elevator cab lighting and ventilation I D. Provide a dedicated 120V, 20A circuit and connect to elevator system intercom in elevator .machineroom a E. Provide a dedicated circuit and connect to each elevator controller for control power. Circuit rating shall be in accordance with the elevator vendor's requirements. I F. Provide a dedicated circuit for weatherproof lighting receptacles within each elevator pit. fixtures, lighting switches and duplex G. Provide a dedicated telephone outlet for each elevator. Provide and VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 I I I I I I I I I I t B. C. D. E. F. G. B. C. empty %"raceway U"- I 16010-12 | I MARCII.2OO4 I t I t I T I I I I I I t I I I I I I each telephone outlet to the nearest telephone backboard. 3.16 PERMANENTLY INSTALLED EXTERIOR SPAS A. Provide an emergency power off switch within 5 feet from the inside walls of the spa. Emergency power off switch shall be Allen-Bradley Bulletin 800T push button station NEMA type 3R with hinged clear plastic cover. Provide a legend plate for each unit with designation: POWER/AC SIIUTDOWN. B. Provide controls, relays, contactors, conduit and wire to activate shunt trip breakers and contactors to disconnect power spa motors and heater. C. Provide a 120-volt receptacle located a minimum of 10 feet from the inside wall of the spa and not more than 20 feet. The receptacle shall not be located more than 78 inches above the level of the spa. The receptacle branch circuit shall have GFCI protection' D. Branch circuit conductors with GFCI protection shall be in dedicated raceway systems without conductors that do not have GFCI protection' 3.IX REMODELINGPRO\TSIONS A. Existing systems and conditions shown on the drawings are provided for guidance only. The Electrical Contractor shall'field check all existing conditions prior to bidding and shall include in his bid an allowance for the removal and relocation of existing conduits, wires, devices, fixtures, or other equipment as indicated on the plans or as required to coordinate and adapt new and existing electrical systems to all other work required for this project. B. Where the reuse of existing conduits, outlets, junction boxes, etc., is permissible, make certain that the wiring form them is continuous from outlet to outlet. Provide modifications to assure that circuits, or system, shall not pass through outlets or junction boxes which may be rendered inaccessible by changes to be made to the building. Existing conduits, wire, devices, fixtures, etc., which shall be removed shall become the property of this Contractor unless otherwise noted. C. Connect new work to existing in a manner that will assure proper raceway grounding throughout in conformance with the National Electrical Code. D. Remodel Work Cutting and Patching: The Contractor shall perform cutting, channeling, chasing, drilling, etc., as required to install or remove electrical equipment in areas of remodeling. This work shall be performed so as to minimize damage to portions of wall finishes, surfaces, plastering, or the structure which are to be reused, resurfaced, plastered or painted under another division of these specifications. E. Carefully coordinate rvith the required remodeling work, cutting and patching etc., performed by the other trades. Remove or relocate existing electrical conduits, wires, devices, fixtures and other equipment as necessary. F. All outages on portions of existing electrical systems shall be minimized and shall be at a time and of duration as accepted by the Owner. VAIL MOIJNTAINLODGE Project #5822.17 MARCTI,2OO4 16010 - 13 I I3.I8 ELECTRICALDEMOLITION Examination 1. Verity field measurements and circuiting anangements are as shown on drawings. I2. Verify that abandoned wiring and equipment serve only abandoned facilities. I3. Demolition drawings are based on casual field observation and existing record - documents. Report discrepancies to Architect before disturbing existing installation. I4. Beginning of demolition means installer accepts existing conditions. I Preparation l. Disconnect electrical systems in walls, floors, and ceilings scheduled for -^-^"^' I 2. coordination outages with Architect/o*rraa. ot't r'Errrrr'r sertEuureu rvr rErrruvor' I 3. Provide temporary wiring and connections to maintain existing systems in service during _ construction. When work must be performed on energized equipment or circuits, use Ipersonnel experienced in such operations. 4. Existing telephone system: Maintain existing system in service. Disable system only to make switchovers and connections. Noti$ Owner/Architect in writing at least 24 hours I before partially or completely disabling system. Minimize outage duration. t Demolition and Extension of Existing Electrical Work !l. Demolish and extend existing electrical work under provisions of Division l, Division 2, a and this section. 2. Remove, relocate, and extend existing installations to accommodate new construction. I3. Remove abandoned wiring to source of supply. I4. Remove exposed abandoned conduit, including abandoned conduit above accessible ceiling finishes. Cut conduit flush with walls and floors, and patch surfaces. I5. Disconnect abandoned outlets and remove devices. Remove abandoned outlets if J conduit servicing them is abandoned and removed. Provide blank cover for abandoned outlets, which are not removed. I6. Disconnect and remove abandoned panelboards and dishibution equipment. I 7 . Disconnect and remove electrical devices and equipment serving utilization equipment 8. $i.t:n:fHffiHi;" abandoned ruminaires. Remove brackets, stems, hangers, ""d Iother accessories. I 9. Repair adjacent construction and finishes damaged during demolition and extension ,work. """ "--- .-.."- -,- .", . ." ,,,-:-" - -.-,_, _. I10. Maintain access to existing electrical installations, which remain active. Modify r installation or provide access panel as appropriate. 1 1. Extend existing installations using materials and methods comoatible with existine Ielectrical instaliation, or as specified in individual section. - I D' cleaning andnRePairpair existing materials and equipment, which remain or are to be reused. I 2. Panelboards: Clean exposed surfaces and check tightness of electrical connections. Replace damaged circuit breakers and provide closure plates for vacant positions. I Provide typed circuit directory showing revised circuiting arrangement. ! 3. Luminaries: Remove existing luminaires for cleaning. Use mild detergent to clean all exterior and interior surfaces; rinse with clean water and wipe dry. Replace lamps, non- | operational ballasts, and broken electrical parts. I VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 A. B. C. I I MARCH,2004 16010 - 14 f - E. Installation ! l. Install relocated materials and equipment under the provisions of Division 1. I Er{D oF sECrIoN If vArL MottNTArN LoDGE MARCH,2004 16'010 - 15 Project #5822.17 D A. B. C. D, A. B. D. I t I I I t I I I I I I I I I l I I I SECTION I6IOO_BASIC MATERIALS AND METHODS I.OO GENERAL I,O1 STANDARDSFORMATERIALS All materials shall conform to current applicable industry standards. Workmanship and neat appearance shall be as important as the electrical and mechanical operation. Defective or damaged materials shall be replaced or repaired, prior to final acceptance, in a manner acceptable to the Architect or Owner at no additional cost to the Owner. All electrical materials shall be acceptable for installation only if labeled or listed by a nationally recogrized testing laboratory and if accepted by local authorities. All electrical equipment shall have a NEMA rated housing suilable for the location installed. Provide products and materials that are new, clean, free of defects, and free of damage and corrosion, unless specifically directed to reuse any existing materials. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2,OI INDIVIDUALMOTORCONTROL STARTERS C. VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 krdividual motor controlled starters shall be manufactured by Cutler Hammer, General Electric, Siemens, Allen-Bradley, or Square D equivalent, and all starters shall be by the same manufacfurer. Single-phase manual starters shall consist of a toggle switch, single or double-pole, with a thermal overload heater element capable of intemrpting the circuit in case of overload. Install flush or surface mounted as required and specihed. For motors of 3l4W to 25HP, provide full voltage, non reversing, (FVllR) magnetic type combination individual motor starters (switch twe, fusible or non-fusible as required) having undervoltage release, two-wire (maintained contact), automatic restarting control, and a trip-free, thermal overload relay in each ungrounded phase conductor, or the manual reset type. All contacts shall be maintenance-free, double- break, solid silver cadmium oxide alloy. Starters shall be designed to allow installation of auxiliary contacts without removing the starter from its enclosure. Contactor coils and control circuit devices shall be suitable for operation with 120 volt control power. hovide control power transformers, ,uranged to deenergize the control circuits whenever the operating power supply to the particular equipment is disconnected. Control circuit conductors shall be protected in accordance with National Electrical Code Article 430- 72. Provide hand-off-automatic switches on the starter face for all features. The hand position shall not bypass firestats or other safety features. Provide one normally open and one normally closed auxiliary contact for each starter. Each three-phase motor rated 5 hp and larger shall have a phase monitor and control relay, wired to protect against under voltage, phase failure, and phase reversal conditions. Phase monitors and relays shall be integral with the starter enclosure- MARCH,2004 16100 - I 2.02 RACEWAYS A. Provide raceways as required for all electrical systems. B. Rigid conduit shall be hot-dipped, galvanized steel with zinc coating or corrosion resistant lacquer on the inside, and shall comply with Underwriter's Laboratories Standard UL6 and American National Standards Institute C80-1. Fittings shall be threaded. C. Plastic coated conduit shall be rigid steel conduit having a 0.030 inch minimum thiclcress; factoy bonded PVC jacket. D. Electrical metallic tubing (EMT) shall be galvanized on the outside and coated on tbe inside with a smooth hard finish of lacquer, vamish or enamel. EMT shall comply *'ith UL Standard UL797 and ANSI C80-3. EMT fittings shall be steel compression gland t1pe. Two and one half inch (2-112") and larger may be steel setscrew type. Where a grounding conductor is pulled, set screw type frttings ofany size are allowed. E. Flexible conduit shall be galvanized steel with steel fittings as manufactured by Triangle. Liquid tight flexible conduit shall be Acaconda, Carol or Gould, with Appleton "ST" connectors, or equivalent. One-half inch (1/2") minimum trade size; except that thLree eighths (3/8") minimum trade size will be acceptable for recessed fixtures only. F. Surface raceways shall be Wiremold or equivalent. Raceways, elbows, fittings, outlets, and devices shall be of the same manufacturer, and designed for use together. G. Wireways,, where indicated on the drawings, shall be hinged cover type, sized as indicated; complete with elbows, tees, connectors, adapters, etc. All parts shall be factory fabricated and ofthe same manufacturer, and designed for use together. H. Rigid, heavywall, Schedule-40, polyvinyl chloride (PVC) plastic conduit, for direct burial shall meet requirements of Underwriters' Laboratories. All offsets and ells shall be rigid, galvanized steel conduit having a 0.030 inch minimum thickness, factory bonded PVC jacket, using a prejacketed couplings to provide substantially watertight jacketing system. L Flexible Metal Cable: l. Formed ofone continuous length of spirally wound electro galvanized steel strip. Use for wiring within casework and millwork and residential units] [in all concealed locations. Type MC for panel and switchboard feeders. Cable sizes as required. 2. Flexible Metal Conduit Fittings: Squeeze or screw type galvanized malleable iron or steel with nvlon insulated throats. OUTLET BOXES A. Outlet boxes shall be constructed of zinc-coated or cadmium plated sheet steel. B. Tile boxes shall be Steel City GW or equivalent. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 I I I I I T I I T I I I I I T T t I I MARCH.2OO4 16100 - 2 I I I t I I I I I t I I I I I I I I I C. All boxes provided shall be of sufficient size to accommodate the number of conductors entering the box in addition to the devices installed in the box, per the National Electrical Code. D. Equip fixture outlet boxes with three-eighths inch (3/8") fixture studs. 2.04 JUNCTION BOXES. PULL BOXES, AND CABINETS A. Iunction and Pull Boxes l. Construct junction or pull boxes not over 150 cubic inches as standard outlet boxes, and those over I50 cubic inches the same as "cabinets", with screw covers of the same gauge metal. Removable covers must be accessible at all times. Mount per "Outlets" Section. 2. Provide a standard access panel having a hinged metal door neatly fitted into a flush metal trim, where a junction box or equipment is located above furred ceilings or in finished walls. Coordinate location and type with the Architect. B. Cabinets I . Cabinets shall meet National Electrical Code requirements, be of standard make, UL labeled, of sheet steel with corrosion resistant finish, and with ample space for all wires, connections and equipment. Provide each cabinet with a door and flush catch and lock. All locks shall be keyed alike. Furnish the Owner with two (2) keys per panel. 2. Cabinet fronts shall consist of sheet steel panels with hinged doors. Fronts for flush cabinets shall be approximately three-fourths (3/4") larger on all sided than cabinet and set so the front will rest firmly against the finished wall surface. 3. Provide suitable devices for securing, supporting and adjusting panelboard interiors and fronts. Cabinets shall be arranged to provide a wiring gutter not less than three inches (3") (larger where specified by the National Eleckic Code). C. Boxes and cabinets shall be weatherproof construction wherever applicable. 2.05 WIRE AND CABLE A. Conductors shall be in accordance with the applicable sections of UL and IPCEA Standards. Minimum conductor size shall be No. 12 AWG for light and power, and No. 14 AWG for control, unless noted otherwise on the drawings or in the specifications. No. l0 AWG and smaller shall be solid, and No. 8 AWG and larger shall be stranded. B. Voltage range 0 - 24: High conductivity copper, thermo-plastic insulation, 300 volt rating. C. Voltage range 24 - 600: High conductivity copper, moisture-resistant thermo-plastic insulation, 600 volt 75oC rating for general use. For HID fixtures and wiring within 3 inches of fluorescent ballasts wire shall be copper, minimum 90"C rated. Sizes indicated are for installation in a maximum 30oC ambient. Conductor ampacity shall be derated for higher ambient installations. 600 volt aluminum wire and cable in sizes l/0 and VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCH,2004 16100 - 3 larger may be substituted for copper on services and feeders, if ampacity is equal to or greater than copper and voltage drop is equal to or less than copper. Aluminum wire and cable shall be terminated at switches, lugs, circuit breakers, etc. with Mac-adapt series "MPT" machine compression adapters or equivalent. Terminating fittings or connectors shall be a type suitable for the specific cable fumished. Insulation: Conductor insulation types shall be rated for wet and dry locations (unless specifically noted otherwise) and shall be accepted by the National Electrical Code for the particular application. Wire and cable shall have the following (or better) insulation classes: l. Wiring in high temperature areas, where the temperature will exceed l65oF, shall be rated l05oC (221"F) minimum, and a type accepted by local code. This shall include any wiring within th,ree feet (3'-0") horizontally or ten feet (10'-0') above any boiler or heating appliance. 2. Wiring installed in floor slabs on earth fill, in conduit in fill under floor slabs, and wiring to exterior fixtures, devices, outlets, etc., subject to weather, Type THW. 3. Feeders and other wiring No. 4 AWG and larger, Type THW. 4. Other wiring No. 6 AWG and smaller, Type TW. Color Coding: 1. Wiring for control systems to be installed in conjunction with mechanical and miscellaneous equipment shall be color coded in accordance with the wiring diagrams fumished with the equipment. Branch circuit wiring, including circuits to motors, and all feeders shall be coded by line or phase as follows: 2. Wire No. 2 AWG and smaller shall be factory color coded. Wire No. 1 AWG and larger may be color coded by field painting or color taping ofsix inch (6") length ofexposed ends. 120/208 Volts A : Black B=Red C = Blue Neutral = White Ground = Green Switch Travelers = PinkSwitch Travelers = Purple G. Wire pulling lubricant shall be equal to Ideal "Yellow" or Dow-Coming "Compound 1'tu, - METAL CLAD CABLE -TYPE MC A. Steel metal clad cable, Type MC, employing circuit conductor #14 to #2 AWG, solid or stranded copper with THHN insulation, an insulated green grounding conductor and galvanized steel interlocked armor cladding. The cables shall be suitable for use in dry locations at temperatures not exceeding 90oC on AC circuits up to 600 volts in accordance with NEC., Article 334. The cable shall be one and two hour fire rated per I I T t I I T I T I T I t I t I I I I D. E. F. VAILMOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCII.2OO4 16100 - 4 t ANSVUL 1479 for use in wall, ceiling and floor assemblies' l - black, white, red, blue. The grounding conductor in each cable shall be green' I- C. A galvanized steel interlocked armor shall be applied over the cable core complying with I the requirements of UL Standard 1569.r- D. Only UL compatible fittings shall be used. | 2.oi wrRE coNNEcrIoNSI A. No. 6 AWG and larger wire: Connectors and lugs shall be solderless or compression I type, Blackburn, BurndS Penn-Union, T&B, or equivalent. No. 8 AWG and smaller ! wire: Twist tight and apply insulated pressrre connectors. Connectors shall be pressue, I ;"J.tfi"f:i;lJ:i;T:::"li?' sprice caps with nvron insurator as manuractured bv I 2.08 SAFETY AND DISCONIYECT SWITCHES,l I A. Provide enclosed, fusible or nonfusible safety switches where indicated and herein specified. Safety switches shall bear UL label and each enclosure shall be the NEMA I fype suitable foi the surrounding area and conditions. Switches shall be minimum I normal duty, horsepower rated, and shall have quick-break mechanisms. Switches used on motor circuits shall have adequate horsepower ratings for the motors served. f B. Safety switches employed as motor disconnect devices for two (2) or more loads shall be of the fusible type for rejection Upe fuses. .- I C. Heavy-duty indushial type safety switches shall be used for 480 volt application and shall be horsepower rated with quick-make, quick-break mechanisms and interlocked covers. I'l D. Sw'itches shall be as manufactured by Cutler-Harnmer, General Electric, Siemens, Square-D, or equivalent, and all switches provided shall be by the same manufacturer. I ' z.o9 FUSES A. Fuses shall be as manufactured by Bussmann or Gould-Shawmut. B. Fuses for application under 600 volts and rated at 600 amps or less shall be as follows: l. For all fuses in the main service equipment, except for motor circuits, provide current limiting, 200,000 nns amperes symmetrical intemrpting capacity' Bussmarm "Fusetron" or equivalent unless noted otherwise on the drawings. 2. For all other fuses, provide rejection type with 200,000 rms amperes symmetrical intemrpting capacity, Bussmann "Fusetron" or equivalent unless noted othenvise on the drawinss. C. Control Fuses shall be Bussmann one-time nonrenewable fuses. I I I I I 'ATLM'TTNTATNL.DGE MARcH,2oo4 Project #5822,17 I 16100 - 5 2.IO WIRING DEVICES AND DEVICE PLATES Provide the following devices where indicated on the drawings. Device color shall be determined. Types or devices other than those listed below shall be of the same standard or quality. The catalog numbers and manufacturers listed are intended to indicate the type and quality. Residential grade devices and plates shall be as manufactured by Arrow-Hart, Bryant, Hubbell, Leviton, Pass and Seymour, or as equivalent. Devices shall have screw type terminals. 1. Receptacles: Where special receptacles are required, verify the exact type required to mate with equipment cord-caps before ordering. Receptacles and plug configurations shall conform with NEMA Standards for amperage and voltage classification and shall comply with NEMA WD-l and UL 20 tests. a. Groundingtypeduplexthroughout:[ubbell"Styleline". b. Duplex weatherproof receptacle shall have integral ground-fault orotection Hubbell GF5262 with 5210 cover. Clock outlet: Hubbell 5235. Floor receptacle: Hubbell 82529 with 5-3925 cover. Neon type pilot light: Arrow-Hart 1720-Red or 1722-Red. Range outlet: Hubbell 94504. Dryer outlet: Hubbell 94304. Special outlets: As indicated on the drawings. 2.rl 2. Floor mounted telephone outlet: HubbellB2529 with 52525 cover. 3. Lampholders: a. Keyless: Pass and Seymour ll0. b. Pullchain: PassandSeymour33. c. Provide 100W, 130v lamps unless otherwise noted. 4. Switches: Switches, unless noted, shall be the a-c, tumbler, quiet fpe;20A Hubbell Styleline series. Switches shall be fully rated for either inductive or incandescent loads. Key switches shall be Leviton l 12lL series. 5. Device Plates: Provide a device plate for each outlet to suit the device installed and blank plates or covers for junction boxes or empty outlets. Flush device plates shall be satin brush finish stainless steel, 0.030 inch thick and provided in garages, mechanical and electrical rooms and utility areas. Flush device plates shall be high abuse nylon, Bryant 88000 Series or equivalent and provided in all public, retail and residential areas. a. Device plates shall be as manufactured by any of the manufacturers listed above for devices. b. Device plates shall be one-piece type and a shape suitable for the devices and outlets installed. Sectional device plates will not be permitted. Where exposed wiring is permitted, device plates shall be galvanized. c. Provide blank plates for all unused telephone outlets. Finish shall match other plates in area. d. Where the device plate does not cover the outlet opening, the Contractor shall patch the opening to the satisfaction of the Architect. e. Telephone plates shall have bushed center or telephone jack opening. SUPPORTS AIYD HANGERS Brackets or hangers shall be Binkley, Elce'n, Super-Strut, Unistrut, or as accepted. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 I I I I I T I t T I I I I I I I I I I d. f. 0 h. MARCH.2OO4 16100 - 6 2. J. +. 5. B. I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I 3.OO EXECUTION 3.01 MOTORCONTROL A. Thermal overload relays shall be set at one-hundred fifteen percent (115%) of the nameplate full load motor current for 40oC rise motors. B. Dual element fuses shall be sized at one-hundred fifty percent (150%) of nameplate full load motor current. 3.02 CONDUIT SYSTEMS General: 1. Provide conduits as required below for all systems, unless noted. The cut ends of all conduits shall be reamed properly to prevent damage to conductor insulation. Conduit sizes not noted on the drawings shall be in accordance with requirements of the National Electrical Code, Table 3C, (except flexible connections for lighting fixtures, use Table 350-12) for the quantities and sizes of wire installed. Where nonmetallic conduit is utilized, the Contractor shall provide sizes as required to conform with the fill requirements calculating the grounding wire as an additional insulated conductor. Securely fasten all conduits. Embedded conduit shall be securely tied in place to rebar and/or wire mesh. Lay out work in advance to avoid excessive concentrations of multiple conduit nrns. Locate conduits so that tlre strength of strucfural members is unaffected and the conduits do not conflict with the services of the other trades. Install one-inch (1") or larger, conduit in or through sfuctural members (beams, slabs, etc.) only when and in a marurer acceoted bv the Architect. Above Grade Conduit Installation 1. Above-Grade: Defined as the area above finished grade for a building exterior and above the bottom floor slab for a building interior. Installation of all materials for above-grade conduits shall conform with the following: a. Install conduits concealed except at surface cabinets, motor and equipment connections, and in mechanical equipment rooms. lnstall a minimum of six inches (6") from flues, steam pipes or other heated lines. b. Provide flashing and counter-flashing for waterproofing conduits, outlets, fittings, etc., that penetrate the roof. Route all (exposed or concealed) conduit as high as possible, parallel or perpendicular to building lines using right-angle tums and symmetrical, concentric bends. c. Support all horizontal and vertical runs of conduit a minimum five feet (5'-0") on center from structural members by using Unistrut and/or Brady clips manufactured for securing conduit. d. Provide sleeves in forms for new conflete walls. floor slabs and partitions for passage of empty three-fourths inch (3/4") conduit for every four (4) spares, spaces or unused poles of each flush mounted branch circuit panelboard. Terminate these empty three-fourths inch (3/4") conduits in a junction box which, after construction is complete, VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCH,2OO4 16100 - 7 is accessible and will enable future branch circuit extensions liom the panel. e. Provide conduit expansion joints with necessary bonding conductor at building expansion joints where required to compensate for conduit or building thermal expansion and contraction. f. Terminate conduits one and one-fourth inch (l/4") and larger with insulated bushings or raintight connectors with insulated throats. 2. Rigid Conduit: Hot-dipped, galvanized rigld steel conduit (GRC) shall be installed in the following above-gtade areas: Embedded in above-grade concrete walls and floor slabs. Where exposed to weather. Wherc exposed to mechanical injury. Where specifically required by the National Electrical Code. All remaining areas except where other conduit is specially permitted in the following paragraphs. Provide double locknuts and bushings on conduits terminating at outlet boxes, cabinets, gutters, etc. 3. Electrical metallic tubing (EMT) may be installed as follows: Concealed locations in funed walls or ceilings. Embedded in above-grade concrete walls and floor slabs. Exposed, when at least five feet (5'-0') above floor. EMT fittings shall be steel compression gland type for EMT two inches (2') and smaller. Setscrew steel fittings will be equivalent for larger sizes. All fittings shall be made up wrench tight. 4. Flexible metal conduit shall be provided in sufficient (minimum 2'-0"), maximum of 6'-0') lengths for: a. Makeup of motor or equipment and raceway connections where isolation of sound and vibration transmission is required. For these equipment connections in locations exposed to weather or in interior locations subject to moisture, liquidtight flexiblc conduit shall be used. b. Connections to recessed lighting fixtures. c. In remodel areas where raceways must be fished in existing walls and cerlings as specified by the Engineer. d. All lengths of flexible metal conduit (including liquidtight) shall contain a separate grounding conductor as outlined under "Grounding". 5. Surface Raceway: Surface wiring permitted in the finish areas in the existing portion ofthe building shall be enclosed in surface raceway as specified by the Engineer. C. Below Grade Conduit lnstallation: 1. Below4rade: Defined as the area below finished grade for a building exterior and below or within the boftom floor slab for a building interior and within exterior building walls that are below grade. Below-grade conduit terminated under main service equipment, padmounted hansformers, etc., above floor slabs and equipment foundations shall project two inches (2") minimum above floor or foundation frnish to prevent water entry. Install exterior underground conduits thirty inches (30") minimum below finished grade. a. Non-Encased Conduit: Unless specifically noted on the drawings for concrete encasement, provide rigid PVC conduit for installations in or below slabs-on-grade, in earth, or in gravel. Offsets and ninety-degree a. b. c. d. e. f. a. b. d. t I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I I I I VAIL MOTII\TAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCH,2OO4 16100 - 8 B. c. D. E. I T I I I I I I I t I I I I I I I elbows shall be rigid, galvanized, steel conduit with a 0.030 inch minimum thickness, factory bonded, PVC jacket and pre-jacketed couplings to provide substantially watertight j acketing. 3.03 OUTLETS The exact location of outlets and equipment shall be govemed by structural conditions and obstructions, or other equipment items. When necessary, relocate outlets so that when fixtures or other devices are installed, they will be symmetrically located according to the room layout and will not interfere with other work or equipment. veris final location of all outlets, panels, equipment, etc., with Architect prior to rough-in. Locations may be adjusted by the Architect up to ten feet (10'-0") from the locations shown without additional cost. Where fixtures are mounted on or in an accessible type ceiling, provide ajunction box and extend flexible conduit to each fixture. Outlet boxes in finished ceilings or walls shall be fitted with appropriate covers, set flush with the finished surface. Where more than one switch or device is located at one point, use gang boxes and covers, unless otherwise indicated. Provide barrier partitions between adjacent switches located in the same box when voltage between switches exceeds 300 .volts. Sectional switch boxes or utility boxes will not be permitted. ln lieu of grounding separate or isolate section boxes, the Contractor may provide factory prewired, pigtailed switches; sierra 5400 series oI equal, ganged in a common outlet box. Partitions having grommeted hole between sections are also acceptable. Back-to-back outlets in a wall, or "Tluough-wa1l" type boxes are not permitted. Provide minimum twelve-inch (12") long nipple to offset outlets shown on opposite sides of a common wall to minimize sound transmission. Mounting Heights: Dimensions given are from finished floor to centerline of outlets. Adjust heights of outlets in masonry walls to correspond with consistent brick or block courses, Outlets in block walls shall be installed in the core of the block. (Notations on the drawings supersede the following): 3.04 CABINETS AND PANELBOARDS A. Cabinets shall be set rigidly in place with fronts straight plumb. Center panelboard interiors in panelboard door opening and adjust dead fronts fully outward to meet the trim. 3.05 WIRE AI\D CABLE A. Provide a complete system of conductors in raceway systems. Wiring shall be routed through an accepted raceway regardless of voltage application. Branch circuits whose length from panel to first outlet exceeds seventy-five (75'-0') for 120 volt circuits shall be No. l0 AWG, or larger, as required to limit voltage drop to 3%. B. All wire shall be insulated for 600 volts. Wire sizing noted on drawings shall extend for the entire length ofa circuit (e.g. taps and risers up lighting poles) unless noted. I VATLM''NTATNL.DGE Project #5822.17 I MARCH,2004 r6100 - 9 C. lnstall wire in raceways in strict conformance with the manufacturer's recommendations. Use an accepted wire-pulling lubricant. Strip insulation so as to avoid nicking wire. 3.06 WIRE AND CABLE CONNECTIONS A. General: Terminating fittings, connectors, etc., shall be a type suitable for the specific cable fumished. Fittings shall be made up tight. Make up all terminations in strict conformance with manufacturer's recommendations using special washers, nuts, etc., as required. B. Connectors and Lugs: Splices and connections shall be made as follows: l. Connect No. 6 AWG and larger wire to panels and apparatus with properly sized solderless or compression lugs or connectors. 2. Connect No. 8 AWG and smaller wire by twisting tight, then applying wire-nut or pressure connectors. 3. Flashover or insulation value of joints shall equal that of the conductor. Connectors shall be rated at 600 volts for qeneral use and 1.000 volts for use within fixtures. 3.07 SAFETY AI{D DISCONNECT SWITCHES A. Install safety and disconnect switches in general area or on equipment and accessible to maintenance personnel. Secure switches firmly to supporting structure with acceptable fasteners. Verifo size of switches for each installation. Where practicable, switches shall be mounted so that the top ofthe switch is six feet, three inches (6'-3") above the finished floor or surface. 3.08 MOTORCONTROLLERS A. Install in accessible locations to serve respective motor, and where high ambient temperatures will not affect overload relay calibration. Controllers shall not be located on roof, regardless of plan notation. Provide controllers having ambient temperature compensated overload relays for all controllers installed where the maximum ambient temperafure will exceed I l5oF, or as noted. 3.09 WIRING DEVICES A. Install wiring devices of the types indicated on the drawings. All connections shall be made up tight and the devices set plumb. Use care in installing devices in order to prevent damage to the device and the wires in the outlet box. B. Device Plates: Provide a device plate for each outlet to suit the device installed, and install blank plates or covers for junction boxes and empty outlets. 3.IO SUPPORT AND HANGERS A. Support and align all raceways, cabinets, equipment, transformers, boxes, fixtures, etc., in an accepted manner and as herein specified. Support raceways on accepted types of VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 T I I I I T I I t I I I 7 I I T I I I MARCH,2004 16100 - 10 B. B. c. D. ! l I t I I I I I I I I I T I I I I I wall brackets, specialty spring steel clips or hangers, ceiling trapeze hangers, or mallable iron straps. Plumbers perforated straps and twisted iron wire not permitted. Do not suspend raceways or equipment from ductwork, or from steam, water, or other piping, but provide independent and secure support methods. hovide toggle bolts or expansion (spider type) anchors in hollow masonry units; lead expansion shields in solid masonry or concrete (or preferably use preset bolts in concrete); machine screu/s, bolts, or welding on metal surfaces; and wood screws on wooden construction. Note: Nails, of proper type, may be used for anchoring in wooden construction, in lieu of screws, only where rigid support will be provided by their use. Use of power driven studs is prohibited without permission from the Architect. Where suspended ceilings ale twenty-four inches (24") ot more below the structure (bar joists, concrete, etc.), provide independent support from the stucture for all raceways' Where a space less than twenty-four inches (24") to the suspended ceiling occurs, the suspending wires or hangers may be utilized to support conduits ofthree-fourths (3/4")' or less, trade size. Mount conduits above any accessible type ceiling at a height sufficient to permit relocation of recessed fixtures to any location' Racking of conduits will not be permitted from ceiling suspension wires' Provide accurately calibrated fuses of the correct capacity for overcurrent protection for all circuits utilizing fused protective devices. Fuses shall be rated for voltages at which they are to be applied. Paralleling of fuses will not be permitted. Fuses shall be properly coordinated and by the same manufacturer. Fuses for application at over 600 volts shall be as specified under Section 16300 of this specification. Provide two (2) spare sets of three (3) fuses for every fuse size installed. Provide a metal cabinet with a hinged door and shelves, or holders' for neatly storing boxed fuses. Mount the cabinet neal the main service equipment. Label "Spare Fuses" on face of cabinet. 3.I1 FUSES END OF SECTION VAILMOIJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCH,2OO4 16100 - 1l SECTION I64OO-SERVICE & DISTRIBUTION r.OO GENERAL A. Submit complete shop drawings with outline dimensions, descriptive literature and complete description of the frarne size, trip setting, class, and intemrpting rating of all breakers. Available spaces shall be identified. PRODUCTS 2.OI ACCEPTABLEMA}IUFACTURERS A. Cutler-Hammer, General Electric, Siemens, or Square D. Panelboards, main switchboard and/or motor control centers shall all be of the same manufacfure' 2.02 PANELBOARDS AND LOAD CENTERS A. Panelboards and loadcenters shall be of the ratings and configurations shown on the Drawings. Panelboards, loadcenters and overcurrent protection devices shall have a minimum short circuit rating as specified herein or greater where indicated on the Drawings. l. . 24Oll2O and 2O8Y/120 volt branch loadcenters: 10,000 RMS syrnmetrical amperes minimum intemrpting capacity. 2. 208Y1120 volt branch panelboards: 10,000 RMS symmetrical amperes minimum intemrpting caPacitY. 3. 208Y1120 volt distribution panelboards: 18,000 RMS symmetrical amperes minimum intemrPting caPacitY. B. Enclosures shall be corrosion resistant galvanized (zinc finished) sheet steel. Fronts shall be cold rolled steel, finish coated with ANSI 61 grey enamel over a rust inhibitor. Panel locks shall be keyed alike. Recessed flush mounted panels shall have overlapping front. C. Doors for branch loadcenters and/or panelboards shall be one piece bolt on front with a lockable hinged door over the overcurrent protection devices. D. Space for future devices shall include all necessary bus, supports, and connections. E. Bus bars shall be sequence phased, rigidly supported by high impact resistant, insulated supporting bus assemblies to prevent vibration and resulting damage when subjected to stress, vibration, or short circuits. Solderless terminations shall be suitable for either copper or aluminum wire or cable. F. Bus bars shall be of the ampere rating shown on the Drawings. Bus bars shall be plated aluminum or copper sized in accordance with UL standards to limit temperature rise on any current carrying part to a maximum of 65 degrees C above an ambient of 40 degrees C maximum. VAILMOTJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 T I I I t T T I T I I I I I T T I I I MARCH.2OO4 16400 - t2 t I I I l T I I I I T I I I I I I G. Neutral bus shall be full size. Neutal bus shall be 200% rated when supplied from an oversized neutral conductor. Neutral bus shall be capable of terminating one conductor per pole position minimum. H. Provide a copper equipment ground bus in each loadcenter and/or panelboard. In addition to the equipment ground bus, provide a copper isolated ground bus when supplied from a feeder that includes an isolated grounding conductor. Each ground bus shall be capable of terminating one conductor per pole position minimum. I. Provide sub-feed or feed through lugs for loadcenters and /or panelboards that feed a additional panel without an overcurrent protection device. J. Loadcenters: 1. Panels within residential units only shall be load centers. 2. Maximum allowable physical dimensions: 16 inches wide by 4 inches deep per section. K. Branch Circuit Panelboards: Maximum allowable physical dimensions: 24 inches wide by 6 inches deep per section. L. Distribution Panelboards: Maximum allowable physical dimensions: 44 inches wide by l2 inches deep per section. M. All loadcenters and panelboards shall use molded case circuit breakers: l. Completely sealed enclosure. Toggle type operating handle. Trip ampere rating and ON/OFF indication clearly visible. 2. Thermal-magnetic trip-free, trip-indicating, quick-make, quick-break, with inverse time characteristic. Single-handle and common t'ipping on multi-pole breakers. 3. Extemal handle shall be suitable for locking in the OFF position. 4. Silver alloy contacts with auxiliary arc-quenching devices. 5. Breakers for lighting circuits shall be SWD rated' 6. Provide main breakers in panelboards seryed from transformers. 7 . Shunt trip breakers shall be supplied with l20V AC coils. 3.OO E)GCUTION 3.OT GROI.]NDING A. Provide a separate grounding conductor, securely grounded on each side of all raceways containing sections of plastic or flexible raceways. Size in accordance with the National Electrical Code and route inside raceway. B. Provide grounding fype bushings for all secondary feeder conduits that originate from the secondary section of the main distribution panel and individually bond this raceway to the ground bus in the secondary section ofthe distribution panel. C. Provide a separate grounding conductor for all feeders, branch circuits, and multi-outlet assemblies. 3.02 PANELBOARDSANDLOADCENTERS I ;ffi.y-$ilrArN L'DGE t MARCH,2004 16400 - t3 A. brstall panelboards and loadcenters with the top ofthe trim six-feet, three-inches (6'-3") from the finished floor. B. Field check all panelboard and loadcenters loading and reconnect circuits as required to provide balanced phase and line loads. C. Cables installed in wire gutters ofpanelboards and loadcenters shall be neatly bundled, routed and supported. Minimum bending radii as recommended by the wire and cable manufacturer shall not be reduced. D. Where panelboards are mounted r€cessed flush in wall, maintain frre integrity of wall. END OF SECTION T I ,! t I t I I I I T I I t t t I I I VAILMOIJNTAINLODGE Proiect #5822.17 MARCH.2OO4 16400 - 14 D. E. F. I I I I I I I I I I I I I I t T I I I SECTION I 65OO_LIGHTING I.OO GENERAL I.OI GENERAL A. The Contractor shall provide all lighting equipment and lighting fixtures included in the Fixture Schedule and as required for all outlets indicated on the drawings. B. Lighting fixtures shall bear the Underwriter's Laboratories label and the manufacturer's label. 2.OO PRODUCTS 2.OI LIGHTINGFIXTI]RES A. Provide lighting equipment as shown on the drawings and as specified. Provide complete lighting equipment, including canopies, suspensions, supporting brackets, hickeys, cashing, sockets, holders, reflectors, ballasts, diffusing material, louvers, lamps, plaster.frames and flanges appropriate for the ceiling type. Provide special plates, barriers, rings, etc., as required to comply with the National Electrical Code. B. For the design and construction of luminaires utilizing ballasts, the ballast case temperature shall not exceed the UL 90'C limit in a 25"C ambient. Luminaires to be installed in a damp or wet location shall be constructed with proper gasketing and corrosion resistant materials or coatings. Construct steel fixture channels, end caps, interior barriers, reflectors, etc., of adequate gauge. C. Provide all ferrous metal surfaces with a protective finish having rust inhibiting properties. Painted finishes shall be a minimum of 1.5 mils thickness and shall have a balance between hardness and bending properties suitable for the application. White finishes shall have eighty-seven (87%) percent minimum reflectance. Application and cleaning shall be done in a manner that will not cause yellowing or otherwise damage the finish. Fixture wire shall conform to the latest requirements of Underwriter's Laboratories and be concealed within fixture construction. Plastics used for light transmission shall be one hundred percent (100%) virgin materials and 0.125 inch thick. Minimum unpenetrated thickness shall be 0.035 inch. No blends or copolymers permitted. Plastics shall be ETL certified as light stabilized and non- yellowing. Ballasts l. Ballasts fumished shall meet Underwriter's Laboratories specifications for Class P listing and applicable ANSI Standards. Provide CMB-ETL certified, high power factor (minimum 90%) solid state ballasts which will operate on the nominal applied system voltage variation. Ballasts shall be capable of starting with minimum starting temperature of 50"F. Ballasts shall be high frequency VAIL MOI'IITAIN LODGE Proiect#5822.17 MARCH.2OO4 16500 - I (20ktlz or greater) and operate without a detectable flicker. Ballasts shall be equipped with surge protection. Ballasts shall meet ANSI acceptable performance tolerances. Fluorescent ballasts shall be General Electric, Advance, Triad-Ultrad, E.B.T., or Universal. 2. Mercury and metal halide ballasts shall be high power factor constant wattage autotrans former type. 3. High pressure sodium ballasts shall be high power factor auto-transformer or reactor type. G. Fluorescent lighting fixtures furnished shall be "ambient rated" by the fixture manufacturer. The "ambient rating" shall be submitted in writing and shall state the maximum ambient temperature, in degrees Fahrenheit, in which the fixture will function continuously without actuation of the protector employed in the Class P ballast. H. Exit sigrrs shall conform with local code requirements. I. Lamps shall bear labels of General Electric, Phillips or Sylvania, and be per General Electric lamp designations shown on the Luminaire Schedule. Install fluorescent lamps aligned for proper lamp contact. J. lncandescent lamps shall be as follows: 1. 'A" lamps shall be 99 Series, 130 volts. 2. '?AR" and "R" lamps shall be 130 volts. 3.OO EXECUTION 3.OI MOUNTING Set luminaires true, free of light leaks, warps, dents, or other irregularities. Provide the Iength of stems as required to hang all luminaires level and in the same horizontal plane. Veriff the type of all ceilings before biddine, and provide fixtures and mounting to suit the ceiling type. Mount all outlets at a position and height to clear equipment, ductworlg piping etc., in mechanical equipment rooms, storage rooms, etc. Securely fasten all recessed frxtures in suspended ceilings to the ceiling frame members. Surface-mounted luminaires containing ballasts shall be mounted with a minimum one and one-half inch (1-l/2") spacer where mounted on a combustible material, unless specifically approved for the application. Support luminaires only from structural elements which are capable of carrying the total weight. All luminaires shall be mounted rigidly, without "rocking" action. Where fixtures are surface mounted on suspended gnd type ceiling, provide two (2) supports, spaced at least five inches (5") apart and normal to the longitudinal axis, at each end of each forty-eight inch section (a8") of luminaire (or on forty-eight inch (48") minimum centers at tees). Luminaires shall be supported from (load bearing) tees only. Where the fixture orientation does not permit such support to main tees, provide additional cross supports above the ceiling to provide bearing from the main tees, or ex tend supports directly to the struchual system. T I T I I I I I t I I t I t T I I t I A. B. c. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 MARCH.2OO4 r6s00 - 2 ! t D. Protect wiring with tape or tubing at all points where abrasion is likely to occur. Provide I chase nipples where field wiring through knockouts. Wiring in fluorescent luminaires shall be suitable for temperature conditions and in no case less than 90oC (194'F) rating. I E. hrstall all incandescent and fluorescent lamps in accordance with the type indicated on Fixture Schedule. I 3,02 ADJUSTMENT TO LUMINAIRES f Luminaires having an adjustable type of beam spread or of the adjustable aiming type (e.9. I floodlights, track light, wall washers, spotlights, etc.) shall be field adjusted or aimed to ther satisfaction of the Architect. VeriD/ the final placement of these luminaires and field adjust in - accordance with the manufacturer's aiming recommendations, as indicated on the drawings, and I as required in the field. Include an allowance in the bid to cover all costs of aiming and adjustingt these fixtures. Include an overtime allowance in the bid for aiming and adjusting exterior luminaires at night. . 3.03 CLEA}IING OF LIMINAIRES t All luminaire lenses and lamps shall be cleaned prior to final acceptance by the Owner. t 3.04 USE OF LUMINAIRES DURING CONSTRUCTION t Luminaires required by the construction documents shall not be used for ternporary or construction lighting except when permission for such use is granted in writing by the Owner. END OF SECTION I T I t I I I I t 'ATLM.TNTATNL'DGE MARcH,2oo4 Project #5822.17 T 16500 - 3 t I SECTION I6720--FIRE ALARM AND SMOKE DETECTION SYSTEMS '' r.oo GENERAL I 1.01 WORKINCLUDED .t A. The work covered by this section of the specifications includes the fumishing of allI l::,ffi:;*s1l:ff:"t?trrlifrffff:ffi:::ffifi:Hffil:il',$:''" I B. The requirements of the conditions of the Conhact, Supplementary Conditions, and I General Requirements apply to the work specified in this section. t r.o2 RELATED sEcrIoN AND DrvrsloNsI A. Divisions 8 - Door Hardware: Door closers. I B. Division 14 - Elevators I C. Division 15 - Mechanical I D. Section 16010 - Basic Electrical Requirements I E. Section 16100-BasicMaterialsandMethods I 1.03 REGIILATORYREQI]IREMENTS I A. NFPA 72 - National Fire Alarm Code' I B. All Local Codes and Ordinances. C. NFPA 70 - National Electrical Code T! D. NFPA lo1 - Life safety code. I E. Uniform Fire CodeI F. System: UL and FM listed. I 1.04 SYSTEM DESCRJPTION I A. General: Combination automatic and manual fire alarm system. Devices shown on I Drawings are the minimum acceptable, additional devices and zoning may be required by the Authority Having Jurisdiction (AHJ) and shall be provided at no additional cost to I the Owner. Alarm shall achieve minimum of 80db throughout occupiable spaces and I meet ADA Requirements. I t I**il?rHrArN L.DGE MAR.H' 2004 I 16720 - | B. System Supervision: Provide electrically supervised non-coded power limited system, with supervised alarm initiating and alarm sigrraling circuits and be capable of having all addressable initiation devices in alarm at one time. C. Alarm Sequence of Operation: Actuation of manual fire alarm station or automatic initiating device except for condominium unit smoke detectors (local alarm only) causes system to enter ALARM, which includes the following operations: 1. Sound and display evacuation fire alarm signaling devices. 2. Transmit signal to authorized remote station equipment. 3. lndicate location ofalarms and supervisory conditions on fire alarm control panel and on remote annunciator panels. 4. Transmit signals to building elevator conhol panel to initiate retum to main floor or altemate floor. 5. Transmit sigral to building mechanical systems to initiate shutdown of fans and damper operation. 6. Transmit signal to release door hold-open devices. D. Alarm Reset: Key-accessible RESET function resets alarm system out of ALARM if alarm initiating circuits have cleared. E. Trouble Sequence of Operation: System trouble, including grounding or open circuit of supervised circuits, or power or system failure causes systgm to enter TROUBLE mode, . including the following operations: l. Visual and audible trouble alarm by zone at conhol panel. 2. Visual and audible trouble alarin at armunciator panel. 3. Manual ACKNOWLEDGE function at control panel silences audible trouble alarm; visual alarm is displayed until initiating trouble is cleared. 4. Transmit trouble signal to remote station. The specifications includes the fumishing of all labor, equipment, materials, and performance of all operations associated with the installation of the Fire Alarm System as shown on the drawings and as herein sPecified. F. Lamp Test: Manual LAMP TEST function causes alarm indication at each zone at fire alarm conhol panel and at annunciator panel. G. Drill Sequence of Operation: Manual DRILL function causes ALARM mode operation to: l. Sound and display local fire alarm signaling devices. 2. lndicate location ofalarm zone on fire alarm control panel and on remote annunciator Panel. H. Zoning: As indicated on Drawings and as required by local Fire Marshal. I.O5 QUALIFICATIONS A. Manufacturer: Company specializing in smoke detection and fire alarm systems with five years documented experience with addressable alarm systems. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 t I I I I I I I t I T I I I T I t I I MARCH,2OO4 16720 -2 ! I B. Installer: Company specializing in smoke detection and fire alarm systems with five t years documented experience, certified by manufacturer as fire alarm installing contractor. I 1.06 SUBMITTALS A. Submit Fire Marshal approved shop drawings and product data under provisions of I Division I.t B. Provide drawing which indicate building from plans, locations ofdevices, conduitI routing, wiring diagrams, fire alarm panel, data sheets, connection details and equiprnent I ratings, layout, dimensions, and finishes. I C. Submit manufacturer's installation inskuctions under provisions of Division I. I D. Submit manufacturer's certificate under provisions of Division I that system meets or exceeds specified requirements. I I,O7 PROJECTRECORDDRAWINGS I A. Submit documents under the provisions of Division I and specification Section 16010. I '1.08 OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE DATA I A. Submit data under provisions of Division I. I B. Include operating inr*.,ionr, and maintenance and repair procedwes. ) C. Include manufacturer representative's letter stating that system is operational. I 1.09 DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND IIANDLING I A. Deliver products to site under provisions of Division I. B Store and protect products under provisions ofDivision I.II I.1O EXTRA MATERIALS I A. Provide two keys ofeach type.I B. Provide five smoke detectors.I! 2.OO PRODUCTS I 2.OI MANUFACTURERS I A. Any of the following manufacturers may be used in the base bid. l. Edwards I 2. Pyrotronics I vArL M.'NTATN L.DGE MARcH,2oo4r Projectr5822.l7 I 16720 -3 J. 4. I I t I I T I I t I I I t I I I I I I I 2. J. ..|. 5. 6. '1. Simplex Notifier B. Substitutions: Under provisions of Section 16100' 2.OI FIRE ALARM AND SMOKE DETECTION CONTROL PAI\TEL VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 A. The control panel shall be microprocessor based and totally power limited. The panel shall be capable of supporting Class A (Style 6) or Class B (Style 4) Network Communications Lines and Class A (Style Z) or Class B (Style Y) Indicating Appliance Circuits. The panel shall have the following features: Totally Field Programmable Password Access Protection Built in Panel Diagnostics Alarm and Trouble Resound Trouble Status Buffer Point Identifi cation Display 24-Hour Trouble Resound 8. One Man Walk Test 9. Alarm Verification 10. Positive Alarm Sequence B. The panel shall have the following relays with a form C configuration: 1. Alarm 2. Trouble 3. Supervisory 4. Default Alarm Mode (allows alarm reporting during microprocessor failure) C. The control panel shall be designed to monitor two or four Network Communications Line. The system shall process up to 256 addressable inputs (smoke detectors, manual stations, water flow devices, etc.) and up to 128 addressable control relays. The Network Communications Lines shall support various annunciation devices (i.e. LED Annunciators, Alphanumeric Displays, Printers) in addition to the addressable inputs and outputs described above. The system architecture shall allow for T-tapping ofthe Network Communications Lines and the use of the Conventional Zone Interface devices on the Communications Line of a group of conventional detection devices (standard smoke detectors, manual stations, waterflow and temper switches) to be interfaced into the system as an address point. The control panel shall contain two indicating circuits, supplying 2 amps of power for each circuit. These circuits shall be field programmable independently to operate a Steady, March Time or Zone Coded signaling. D. The control panel shall contain an Alphanumeric Display/Printer interface which contains a microprocessor with non-volatile memory to store field programmable alarm and trouble messages. The Alphanumeric Display shall consist of two 40 character lines for alarm, supervisor and trouble identification, and in quiescent mode, indicates systern status. The Alphanumeric shall be back illuminated and have an adjustable viewing angle. Provide Cerberus Pyrotronics model LAN or equivalent MARCH,2004 16720 - 4 I I E. Power Supply: Adequate to serve control panel modules, remote detectors, remote I annunciators, door holders, smoke dampers, relays, and alarm signaling devices. krclude battery-operated emergency power supply with capacity for operating system in standby mode for 24 hours followed by alarm mode for 5 minutes. F. Detection Circuits: Supervised zone module with alarm and trouble indication. I G. Signal Circuits: Supervised zone coded signal module, sufficient for signal devices connected to system. I H. Municipal Trip Circuit: Provide output connections for connection to remote stationr transmitter. lnctude municipat trip bTSCONNECT switch- I I. Remote Station Signal Transmitter: Electrically supervised, capable ofreceiving signalsI from remote station transmitter over telephone lines with up to 4000 ohms loop resistance, and visually annunciating alarm signals by addressable device and cornmon trouble signal.I 2.02 INITIATINGDEVICES I A. Manual Station: Addressabte semi-flush mounted, double action, manual station. I B. Heat Detector: Addressable fixed temperature, rated 135oF. !C. Area Smoke Detector: Addressable photoelectric type with plug-in base, and visual indication of detector actuation, suitable for mormting on 4 inch outlet box. I D. Dwellins Unit Smoke Heat Detector: Combination Heat/Photoelectric smoke with self- containel audible device, integral thermal cleanout rated 135oF and auxiliary relay I contact. I E. Remote Test Switch: Key-operated switch mounted on flush cover with lamp to indicate t detector actuation. (provide one switch for each duct mounted smoke detector.) r F. A Conventional Zone Interface shall be provided for WaterFlow devices and Tamper - switches or any contact type devices. This Convention al Zone Interface shall have a Class B (Style B) circuit. I G. A Conventional Zone Interfac e (CT)shall be provided which can monitor conventionalI detectors such as lon, Photo+lectric or Thermal and either UV or IR Flame detectors or a Beam detector set and any number of contact devices. The CZI shall incorporate an I integral pulsing LED for confirmation that the CZI is active. This LED shall change I from pulsing to steady state upon an alarm condition for quick identification ofthe alarming device. I 2.03 SIGNALING DEVICES I A. Alarm Hom: NFPA 72; Flush type fire alarm hom. Sound Rating: [87] [95] clB at l0 I feet. Provide integral ADA strobe larnp and flasher with red lettered FIRE on white lens. I vArL M.'NTATN L.DGE MARcH,2oo4 Project #5822.17 I 16720 - 5 B. Remote Annunciator: Provide supervised remote annunciator including audible and visual indication of fire alarm by addressable device, and audible and visual indication of system trouble. lnstall in flush wall-mounted enclosure. C. Remote printer shall be supplied and shall be connected to the Network Communications Line. The serial printer shall be supervised for troubles via the interface module. The user text shall be totally field progrannnable with customer's defined message (80 characters max.) including time and date. 2.04 AUXILIARY DEVICES A. Door Release: Door closer as specified in Division 8' 2.05 FIRE ALARM WIR.E AND CABLE A. Fire Alarm Power Branch Circuits: Building wire as specified in Section 16100 or as permitted in Article 760 ofN.E.C. B. Initiating and Signal Circuits: All Nehvork Communications Lines shall be three conductor shielded or wiring approved by the Manufacturer. Building wire as specified in Section 16100. Power limited fire-protective sigraling cable classified for fire and smoke characteristics, copper conductor, 300 volts insulation rated l05oC, suitable for. use in air handling ducts, hollow spaces used as ducts, and plenums. 3.OO EXECUTION 3.01 INSTALLATION A. Install system in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. B. Mount outlet box for electric door holder to withstand 80 pounds pulling force. C. Make conduit and wiring connections to door release devices, sprinkler flow switches, sprinkler valve tamper switches, fire suppression system confrol panels, duct smoke detectors, and other systems or devices required by applicable codes. D. Automatic Detector lnstallation: NFPA 72. 3.02 FIELD QUALITY CONTROL A. Field inspection and testing will be performed under provisions of Division I . B. Test in accordance with NFPA 72 andlocal fire deparunant requirements. 3.03 MAIYUT'ACTURER'SFIELDSERVICES A. Provide manufacturer's field services under provisions of Division l. VAIL MOTJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 T t I I I I I I t I I I t I I I I I I MARCH,2004 16720 - 6 I I B. lnclude services of certified technician to supervise installation, adjustments, final I connections, and system testing. r 3.04 FIRE ALARM WIRE AND CABLE COLOR CODE It A. Provide fire alarm circuit conductors with color coded insulated, or use color coded tape .r at each conductor termination and in each junction box as follows: r ) ilffii#:l':'til"?x*frsBrackandwhite' 3. Detector Power Supply: Violet and brown. .. 4. Signal Device Circuit: Blue (positive), white (negative). 5. Door Release: Gray, gray. END OF SECTIONI I I I I I I I I T I t I 'ArLM''NTATNL'DGE MARcH,2oo4 Project #5822.17 I 16720 -7 r SECTION T6750-TELECOMMUNICATIONS SYSTEMS r 1.OO GENERAL - I.OI RELATEDDOCIJMENTS I A. Drawings and general provisions of the Contract, including General and Supplementaryt Conditions and Division I Specification Sections, apply to this Section. I I.O2 SUMMARY I A. This Section includes wire, cable, connecting devices, installation, and testing for wiring I systems to be used as sigrral pathways for voice, high-speed data transmission, and master antenna television svstems. I.O3 DEFINITIONS I A. EMI: Elechomagnetic interference.r B. IDC: Insulation displacement connector. I C. LAN: Local area network. I D. PVC: Polyvinyl chloride. I E. STP: Shielded twisted pair. I F. UTP: Unshielded trvisted pair. (1 MATV: Master antenna televisionII H. CATV: Community antenna television (cable television) I I. SUBMITTALS I A. hoduct Data: Include manufacturer's data on features, ratings, and performance for I each component specified. I B. System Labeling Schedules: Include electronic copy oflabeling schedules, as specified I in Part 3, in software and format specified by Owner. 1. Wiring diagrams: Show typical wiring schematics including the following: I a Outlets,jacks, andjack assemblies. b Patch panels. ! C. Cable Administration Drawings: As specified in Part 3. t VAIL MOLINTATN LODGE MARCE,2004 167s0 - 1 Project #5822.17 I Manufacturer Seismic Qualification Certification: Submit certification that distribution racks and their components will withstand seismic forces defined in Division 16 Section "seismic Controls for Electrical Work." Include the following: l. Basis for Certification: Base certification on the maximum number of components capable ofbeing mounted in each rack type. Identify components on which certification is based. lndicate whether withstand certification is based on actual test of assembled components or on calculation. a The term "withstand" means "the unit will remain in place without separation ofany parts from the device when subjected to the seismic forces specified and the unit will be fully operational after the seismic event." 2. Dimensioned Outline Drawings of Equipment Unit: Identiff center of gravity of each rack-mounted component and ofeach assembled rack type, and locate and describe mounting and anchorage provisions. 3. Detailed description of equipment anchorage devices on which the certification is based and their installation requirements. Qualification Data: For Installer. Operation and Maintenance Data: For voice and data communication cabling to include in emergency, operation, and maintenance manuals. 1.01 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Installer Qualifications: Building lndustry Consulting Service International (BICSI) certified firms with at least five (5) years of successful installation experience with projects utilizing voice and data systems and equipment similar to that required for this project. B. Source Limitations: Obtain all products except twisted-pair and fiber-optic cables thLrough one source from a single manufacturer. C. Electrical Components, Devices, and Accessories: Listed and labeled as defined in NFPA 70 (NEC), Article 100, by a testing agency acceptable to authorities having jurisdiction, and marked for intended use. D. Comply with NFPA 70 (NEC). E. CATV systems will comply with 47 CFR 15,17, and76. F. All copper termination materials shall be from the same manufacturer. All copper cabling shall be from the same manufacturer. I.O2 COORDINATION VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 I t- I I I I I I t I I I I t I I I I I D. E. F. MARCH.2OO4 16750 -2 I I I I t t A. Voice/Data Systems: Coordinate layout and installation of voice and data communication cabling with Orvner's telecommunications and LAN equipment suppliers. Coordinate service entrance arrangement with local exchange carrier. l. Meet jointly with telecommunications and LAN equipment suppliers, local exchange carrier representatives, and Owner to exchange information and agree on details of equipment arrangements and installation interfaces. 2. Record agreements reached in meetings and distribute to other participants. 3. Adjust anangements and locations of distribution frames and cross-connect and patch panels in equipment rooms and wiring closets to accommodate and optimize arrangement and space requirements of telephone switch and LAN equipment. B. MATV Systems: Coordinate layout and installation of television cabling with Owner's CATV and satellite equipment suppliers. Coordinate service entrance arrangement with local CATV and satellite service providers. I 2.oo PRoDUcrs! I 2.OI MANUFACTIJRERS I A. Manufacturers: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: t l. cable: r i 3.lf+#i;Xffi'::il::,: c. Black Box Network Services d. The Siemon CompanyI e. Libertv Cable f. Commscope C. PanduitCorp.! 2. Terminal and Connector Components and Distribution Racks: t a. AMP lncorporated; a Tyco International Ltd. Company. b. Leviton Telecom. c. Black Box Network Services I d. The Siemon Company e. Orhonics 3. Television Cable and Distribution Equipment: a. Anderson Manufacturing, Inc. b. Blonder Tongue Laboratories, Inc. c. Channel Master. Inc. d. Chaparral Communications, Inc. e. Comtech Antenna Svstems. Inc. I I I I vArLMouNTArNLoDcE MARCH,2'.4 Project#5822.17 I 16750 - 3 2.02 SYSTEMREQUIREMENTS A. General: Coordinate the features of materials and equipment so they form an integrated system. Match components and interconnections for optimum future performance. B. Expansion Capability: Unless otherwise indicated, provide spare fibers and conductor pairs in cables, positions in cross-connect and patch panels, and terminal strips to accommodate 20 percent fufure increase. 2.03 MOUNTING ELEMENTS A. Raceways and Boxes: Comply with Division l6 Section "Raceways and Boxes." B. Backboards: 3/4-inch (l9-nrm), interior-grade, fire-retardant-treatedplywood. C. Distribution Racls: Freestanding and wall-mounted, modular-steel units designed for telecommunications terminal support and coordinated with dimensions of units to be supported. Racks will meet ANSVTLA,/EIA-568A standards. Racks shall be complete with mounting hardware, wire management rings, and Velcro cable supports' l. Approximate Module Dimensions: 8.1 inches (2130 mm) high by 22 inches (560 mm) wide. 2. Finish: Baked-polyester powder coat. 3. Mountine width: 19" 2.04 TWISTED-PAIR CABLES, CONNECTORS, AI{D TERMINAL EQIIIPMENT A. Cables: Listed as compllng with Category 5e of TIA./EIA-568-A. Conductors: Solid copper. UTP Cable: Comply with TIA,/E[A-568-A. Four, thermoplastic-insulated, individually twisted pairs of conductors; No. 24 AWG, color-coded; enclosed in PVC jacket. UTP Plenum Cable: Listed for use in air-handling (plenum) spaces. UTP Cable Connecting Hardware: Connecting hardware to be IDC type, complying with TIA/EIA-568-A, unless otherwise noted. F. Cross-Connect Panel: Modular array of IDC terrninal blocks arranged to terminate building cables and permit interconnection between cables. I . Number of Terminals per Field: One for each conductor in assigred cables. 2. Mounting: Backboard or Rack. G. Patch Panel: Modular panels housing multiple-numbered jack units with IDC-type connectors at each jack for permanent termination of pair groups of installed cables. l. Number of Jacks per Field: One for each four-pair conductor group of indicated cables. VAIL MOIJNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 I I I I I I I I I I I I III t I t I I I B. C. D. E. MARCII,2OO4 16750 - 4 I T I 2. Mounting: Backboard or Rack. H. Jacks and Jack Assemblies for UTP Cable: Modular, color-coded receptacle units with inte gral IDC-type terminals. I. UTP Patch Cords: Four-pair cables in 48-inch ( I 200-nrnr) lengths, terminated with RJ- 45 plug at each end. Use keyed plugs for data service. t 2.05 TELEvISToN cABLEs, coNNECToRS, AND TERMINAL EQUIPMENT A Components: Modular plug-in, heary-duty, industrial-, or commercial-grade units.II B. Equipment: Silicon-based, solid-state, integrated circuit devices. I C. Cable: Coaxial cable elements shall be RG-6ru, 75-ohm nominal impedance, quad- I shielded, cellular-polyethylene dielectric, #18awg solid copper-clad steel conductor, PVC jacket. I D. Plenum Cable: Listed for use in air-handling (plenum) spaces. I E. Patch Panel: Modular panels, wall- or rack-mounted, housing multiple-numbered pass- I through cable connectors for termination of installed cables. - F. Cable Connectors: Type 'F', 75-ohm nominal impedance. I 2.06 IDENTIFICATIONPRODUCTS f A. Comply with Division 16 Section "Electrical Identification" and the following: I L Cable Labels: Self-adhesive vinyl or vinyl-cloth rwaparound tape markers, I machine printed with alphanumeric cable designations' I 2.07 TELECOMMUNICATIONS OUTLETS I A. Voice Outlet r '1 ft:::'.3,:l'j;-ff1i,'fi:i,t',fJffi#*"'i11"filf,11-';"T,iff:fl:ii:ff:$"' one (l) RJ-l l, Category 3 jack. I 2. Cabling: Two (2) Category 5e UTP Cables. Two (2) pairs of one cable will be terminated in outlet jack. Homerun all cables to Unit Media Center Panel. I Splice points will not be acceptable. 3. Terminations: One (l) Category 5e cable will be terminated in the Voice/Data I module in the Unit Media Center Panel. Opposite end of terminated cable will I be cormected to outlet. One cable will be spare; loop end in outlet box. All spare cables shall be bundled and looped in Unit Media Center Panel. t B. High Speed Internet / Data Outlet I VArL MOTJNTAIN LODGE MARCH,2004 167s0 - 5 Project #5822.17 I l. Outlet: Double-gang steel outlet box with single-gang high-impact plastic outlet plate. Color of outlet plate to be determined by Architect. Outlet shall contain one (l) RJ-l l, Category 3 jack and one (1) RI45, Category 5ejack. 2. Cabling: Two (2) Category 5e UTP Cables. Homerun all cables to Unit Media Center Panel. Splice points will not be acceptable. 3. Terminations: One (1) Category 5e cable will be terminated in the VoicelData module in the Unit Media Center Panel. Opposite end will be connected to RI- I I jack in outlet. One (l) Category 5e cable will be terminated in the internet Gateway. Opposite end will be connected to RI45 jack in outlet. C. Television Outlet (Refer to plans for requirements where TV outlets are shown adjacent to voice/data outlets). 1. Outlet: Double Gang steel outlet box with single-gang high impact plastic outlet plate. Color of outlet plate to be determined by Architect. Outlet shall contain one (1) female,'F'-type coaxial connectors. 2. Cabling: Two (2) RG-6 coaxial cables. Homerun all cables to Unit Media Center Panel. Splice points will not be acceptable. 3. Terminations: One (1) RG{ cable will be terminated in the Advanced Home Telephone/Video panel in the Unit Media Center Panel. Opposite ends will be connected to outlet. One (l) RG-6 cable will be spare; loop ends in outlet box. All spare cables shall be bundled and looped in Unit Media Center Panel. 3.OO EXECUTION 3.OI EXAMINATION A. Examine pathway elements intended for cables. Check raceways, cable trays, and other elements for cornpliance with space allocations, installation tolerances, hazards to cable installation, and other conditions affecting installation. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactorv conditions have been corrected. INSTALLATION A. Wiring Method: Install wiring and optical fiber in raceway up to accessible ceiling spaces in non-residential unit areas, Use Ul--listed plenum cable in environmental air spaces, including plenum ceilings. Conceal raceway and cables except in unfinished spaces. Route cables concealed in walls and ceilings in residential units (raceway not required). B. Install cables using techniques, practices, and methods that are consistent with Category 5e rating of components and that ensure Category 5e performance of completed and linked sigrral paths, end to end. C. lnstall cables without damaging conductors, shield, orjacket. VAILMO{JNTAIN LODGE Project#5822.17 I T I I I T I I T I I I I t t I t I t MARCH,2004 16750 - 6 D. E. F. G. H. J. K. L. M. N. I I t I I T I I I I I I II t I I I t t Do not bend cables, in handling or in installing, to smaller radii than minimums recommended by manufacturer. Pull cables without exceeding cable manufacturer's recommended pulling tensions. l. Pull cables simultaneously if more than one is being installed in same raceway. 2. Use pulling compound or lubricant if necessary. Use compounds that will not damage conductor or insulation. 3. Use pulling means, including fish tape, cable, rope, and basket-weave wire or cable grips, that will not damage media or raceway' Secure and support cables at intervals not exceeding 30 inches (760 mm; and not more than 6 inches (i-50 mm) from cabinets, boxes, fittings, outlets, racks, frames, and terminals. Wiring within Wiring Closets and Enclosures: Provide conductors of adequate length. Train conductors to terminal points with no excess. Use wire management devices to resfrain cables, to prevent sfraining connections, and to prevent bending cables to srnaller radii than minimums recommended by manufacfurer. Separation of Wires: Comply with TIA/EIA-569-A rules for separating unshielded copper voice and data communication cabling from potential EMI sources, including electrical power lines and equipment. Make terminations only at indicated outlets, terminals, and cross-connect and patch panels. All pathways designated for telecommwrications use shall be dedicated for telecommunications use only and shall not be shared with other building services. All installed pathways shall be accessible for the additions, moves, or removal of cables. Enclosed pathways shall have pull points within 100 feet ofeach other. Cable supports and pathways shall be provided by means that are structurally independent of the suspended ceiling, its frameworl or its supports. For open ceiling cable pathways, cable support systems shall be designed and installed to be a minimum of 3 inches above the ceiling grid which supports the tiles. Properly installed Ullisted fire stop systems shall be installed to prevent or retard the spread of fire, smoke, water, and gases through the building. Elevator shafts shall not be used as a cable pathway. GROUNDING A. Comply with Division 16 Section "Grounding and Bonding." B. Ground cable shields, drain conductors, metallic raceways, and equipment to eliminate shock hazard and to minimize ground loops, common-mode returns, noise pickup, cross talk, and other impairments. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822J7 MARCII,2OO4 16750 - 7 Bond shields and drain conductors to ground at only one point in each circuit. Telecommunications Grounding Bar (TGB): Provide #6 12"x4" grounding bar with insulated bushings in each IDF. Using #6awg copper conductor, bond TGB to TBB and structural steel. if available. Signal Ground Terminal: Locate in each equipment room and wiring closet; isolate from power system and equipment grounding. Signal Ground Bus: Mount on wall of main equipment room with standoff insulators. Signal Ground Backbone Cable: Extend from signal ground bus to signal ground terminal in each equipment room and wiring closet. 3.04 TNSTALLATTON IN EQTIIPMENT ROOMS AIYD WIRTNG CLOSETS A. lnstall plywood backboards on walls of equipment rooms and wiring closets as indicated on drawings. B. Mount patch panels, terminal strips, and other connecting hardware on backboards, unless otherwise indicated. C. Group connecting hardware for cables into separate logical fields. D. Use patch panels to terminate cables entering the space, rmless otherwise indicated. E. Organize all cabling utilizing adjustable/removable wire management devices. 3.05 INSTALLATIONSTANDARDS l. Comply with requirements in TIA/ELA-568-A and TIA/EIA-569-A. 3.06 IDENTIFICATION A. In addition to requiremants in this Article, comply with applicable requirements in Division 16 Section "Electrical ldentification" and TIA/E[A-606. B. System: Use a unique, three-syllable, alphanumeric designation for each cable, and label cable and jacks, connectors, and terminals to which it connects with same designation. Use logical and systematic designations for facility's architectural arrangernent. l. First syllable identifies and locates equipment room or wiring closet where cables originate. 2. Second syllable identifies and locates cross-connect- or patch-panel freld in which cables terminate. 3. Third syllable designates type ofmedia (copper or fiber) and position occupied by cable pairs or fibers in field. C. Outlets: Label cables within outlet boxes. VAIL MOUNTAIN LODGE Project #5822.17 c. D. F. G. E. I T I I I I I I T I I I t I t I T I I MARCH,2OO4 16750 - 8 t D. Distribution Racks and Frames: Label each unit and field within that unit. I E. Within Connector Fields in Equipment Rooms and Wiring Closets: Label each I connector and each discrete unit of cable-terminating and connecting hardware. Where similar jacls and plugs are used for both voice and data communication cabling, use a different color forjacks and plugs ofeach service. I F. Cables. General: Label each cable within 4 inches (100 mm) of each termination and tap, where it is accessible in a cabinet orjunction or outlet box, and elsewhere as t indicated. I G. Cable Schedule: Post in prominent location in each equipment room and wiring closet.I H:Hffiililff;:*::Xi:t*'#$,T:'J"i::',il*lTf':i:ffilij#?li; comprehensive schedules for Project, in software and format selected by Owner. r H. Cable Adminishation Drawings: Show building floor plans with cable administration I :-,'lj'fh1x;13il1"y,,:1"'l;fff:::*.*:';:ilJ:l:H":[[:1ffiil:iT;H;,"f and positions, horizontal cables, work areas and workstation terminal positions, grounding buses and pathways, and equipment grounding conductors. Follow I convention of TIA/ELA-606. Fumish electronic record of all drawings, in software and I format selected by Owner. I 3.07 TESTING I A. After completion, all systems and installation shall be thoroughly tested and adjusted to I provide a complete system in accordance w'ith the intent of this specification. For all t areas where cable is not installed in conduit systems, test the cable prior to the installation of drywall and after the installation of drywall. Improperly installed and wired devices or cable to be replaced or rewired at no cost to the Owner. r B. Results of these tests will be included in the final documentation package. I 4.oo DEMoNsTRATToNI 4.01 SYSTEMDEMONSTRATION t A. Upon completion and installation of systems, and after communications wire circuitry has been energized, demonstrate capability and compliance with requirernants. I Demonstrate to Owner that requirements for basic output signal levels as well as values I for attenuation and signal-to-noise ratios have been achieved. END OF SECTION T6750 I I vArL Mor.iNTArN L'DGE MARcrr,2004 r6zs0 - 9 Project #5822.17 I II I